Skip to main content

Full text of "[ William Crain] Theories Of Development Concepts"

See other formats


PEARSON  NEW  INTERNATIONAL  EDITION 


Theories  of  Development 
Concepts  and  Applications 
William  Crain 
Sixth  Edition 


Pearson  New  International  Edition 


Theories  of  Development 
Concepts  and  Applications 
William  Crain 
Sixth  Edition 


PEARSON 


Pearson  Education  Limited 

Edinburgh  Gate 
Harlow 

Essex  CM20  2JE 

England  and  Associated  Companies  throughout  the  world 
Visit  us  on  the  World  Wide  Web  at:  www.pearsoned.co.uk 
©  Pearson  Education  Limited  2014 


All  rights  reserved.  No  part  of  this  publication  may  be  reproduced,  stored  in  a  retrieval  system,  or  transmitted 
in  any  form  or  by  any  means,  electronic,  mechanical,  photocopying,  recording  or  otherwise,  without  either  the 
prior  written  permission  of  the  publisher  or  a  licence  permitting  restricted  copying  in  the  United  Kingdom 
issued  by  the  Copyright  Licensing  Agency  Ltd,  Saffron  House,  6-10  Kirby  Street,  London  EC1N  8TS. 

All  trademarks  used  herein  are  the  property  of  their  respective  owners.  The  use  of  any  trademark 
in  this  text  does  not  vest  in  the  author  or  publisher  any  trademark  ownership  rights  in  such 
trademarks,  nor  does  the  use  of  such  trademarks  imply  any  affiliation  with  or  endorsement  of  this 
book  by  such  owners. 


ISBN  10:  1-292-02262-0 
ISBN  13:  978-1-292-02262-8 


British  Library  Cataloguing-in-Publication  Data 

A  catalogue  record  for  this  book  is  available  from  the  British  Library 


Printed  in  the  United  States  of  America 


PEARSON 


CUSTOM 


LIBRARY 


Table  of  Contents 


1 .  Early  Theories:  Performationism,  Locke,  and  Rousseau 

William  Crain  1 

2.  Gesell's  Maturational  Theory 

William  Crain  21 

3.  Ethological  Theories:  Darwin,  Lorenz  and  Tinbergen,  and  Bowlby  and  Ainsworth 

William  Crain  35 

4.  Montessori's  Educational  Philosophy 

William  Crain  71 

5.  Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 

William  Crain  93 

6.  Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 

William  Crain  119 

7.  Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 

William  Crain  159 

8.  Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 

William  Crain  183 

9.  Bandura's  Social  Learning  Theory 

William  Crain  209 

1 0.  Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 

William  Crain  231 

I  I .  Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 

William  Crain  261 

1 2.  Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 

William  Crain  289 

13.  Mahler's  Separation/Individuation  Theory 

William  Crain  315 


I 


14.  A  Case  Study  in  Psychoanalytic  Treatment:  Bettleheim  on  Autism 

William  Crain 

331 

1  5.  Schachtel  on  Childhood  Experiences 

William  Crain 

341 

1  6.  Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 

William  Crain 

351 

1  7.  Jung's  Theory  on  Adulthood 

William  Crain 

373 

18.  Humanistic  Psychology  and  Developmental  Theory 

William  Crain 

387 

References 

William  Crain 

399 

Index 

421 

II 


Early  Theories: 
Preformationism, 
Locke,  and  Rousseau 


The  two  great  pioneers  in  child  psychology  were  John  Locke  and 
Jean-Jacques  Rousseau.  Locke  was  the  father  of  environmentalism 
and  learning  theory;  his  heirs  are  scientists  such  as  Ivan  Pavlov  and 
B.  F.  Skinner.  Rousseau  began  the  developmental  tradition  in  psy¬ 
chology;  his  followers  include  Arnold  Gesell,  Maria  Montessori, 
Heinz  Werner,  and  Jean  Piaget.  Both  Locke  and  Rousseau  made  rad¬ 
ical  departures  from  an  earlier  outlook  called  preformationism. 


PREFORMATIONISM 

For  centuries,  people  seem  to  have  looked  on  children  as  fully  formed 
miniature  adults.  The  French  historian  Philippe  Aries  (1914-1984) 
described  how  this  view  was  predominant  during  the  Middle  Ages. 
Medieval  paintings  and  sculptures,  for  example,  routinely  portrayed 
children — even  newborns — with  adult  body  proportions  and  facial 
characteristics.  The  children  were  distinguished  only  by  their  size.  It 
was  as  if  the  children  had  arrived  preformed  in  the  adult  mold  (Aries, 
1960,  pp.  33-34). 

In  medieval  social  life,  too,  Aries  argued,  children  were  treated 
like  adults.  When  they  were  6  or  7  years  old,  they  were  typically  sent 
off  to  other  villages  to  begin  working  as  apprentices.  They  learned  car¬ 
pentry,  farming,  domestic  service,  weaving,  and  other  crafts  and  trades 
on  the  job.  The  child  lived  as  a  boarder  in  a  master's  house  and  often 
worked  alongside  other  apprentices  who  were  much  older  than  he  or 
she.  No  one  paid  much  attention  to  the  child's  age,  for  the  child  had 
basically  entered  adult  society.  The  child  wore  the  same  clothes,  played 
the  same  games,  and  participated  in  the  same  festivals  as  the  grownups 


From  Theories  of  Development:  Concepts  and  Applications,  Sixth  Edition.  William 
Crain.  Copyright  ©  2011  by  Pearson  Education,  Inc.  Published  by  Pearson 
Prentice  Hall.  All  rights  reserved. 


1 


Early  Theories 


(Aries,  1960,  pp.  71-72,  411).  "Wherever  people  worked,"  Aries  said,  "and 
also  wherever  they  amused  themselves,  even  in  the  taverns  of  ill  repute, 
children  mingled  with  the  adults"  (p.  368). 

Aries  acknowledged  that  younger  children — before  the  age  of  6  or  7 — 
were  treated  differently.  People  recognized  their  need  for  protection  and  care. 
But  on  the  whole,  Aries  suggested,  people  were  indifferent  to  children's 
special  characteristics.  No  one  bothered  to  study,  for  example,  the  infant's 
developing  speech  or  motor  development;  and  when  artists  included  chil¬ 
dren  in  their  paintings,  they  depicted  even  newborns  as  miniature  adults. 

Some  historians  have  challenged  Aries's  views.  Because  medieval 
written  documents  are  sparse,  it's  difficult  to  evaluate  all  the  disagree¬ 
ments,  but  historians  such  as  Barbara  Hanawalt  (1986)  and  Shulamith 
Shahar  (1990)  have  gathered  enough  evidence  to  indicate  that  Aries  was 
sometimes  prone  to  overstatement.  It  appears  that  apprenticeships,  while 
common,  were  not  as  universal  as  Aries  claimed,  and  that  6-  and  7-year-olds 
sometimes  entered  the  adult  workplace  more  gradually  than  Aries  implied. 
Still,  by  the  age  of  12  or  so,  most  children  were  carrying  out  adult  respon¬ 
sibilities,  and  I  believe  that  Aries's  critics  have  done  more  to  qualify  Aries's 
accounts  than  to  refute  them. 

Moreover,  other  sources  have  shown  that  the  image  of  children  that  Aries 
highlighted — that  of  the  child  as  a  little  adult — has  been  prevalent  through¬ 
out  the  ages.  This  image  is  perhaps  most  evident  in  preformationistic  theories 
in  embryology.  For  centuries,  many  scientists  believed  that  a  tiny,  fully  formed 
human,  or  homunculus,  is  implanted  in  the  sperm  or  the  egg  at  conception 
(see  Figure  1).  They  believed  that  the  human  is  "preformed"  at  the  instant  of 


Figure  1 

Drawing  by  Hartsoeker  (1694)  of  a  fully 
formed  human  in  the  sperm. 
(Reprinted  in  Needham,  1959,  p.  206.) 


2 


Early  Theories 


conception  and  only  grows  in  size  and  bulk  until  birth.  Preformationism  in 
embryology  dates  back  at  least  to  the  fifth  century  b.C.e.  and  is  found  in 
scientific  thinking  throughout  the  ages.  As  late  as  the  18th  century,  most  sci¬ 
entists  held  preformationist  views.  They  admitted  that  they  had  no  direct 
evidence  for  a  fully  formed  homunculus,  but  they  argued  that  this  was  only 
because  it  is  transparent  or  too  small  to  see  (Balinsky,  1981,  p.  11;  Needham, 
1959,  pp.  34-35,  91, 213-222). 

As  we  look  back  on  the  "little  adult"  views  of  the  past,  it's  easy  to  regard 
them  as  quaint  and  antiquated.  But  we  often  lapse  into  the  same  thinking 
today,  as  when  we  expect  young  children  to  be  able  to  sit  as  still  as  we  can 
in  social  settings,  or  when  we  assume  that  their  thinking  is  the  same  as  ours. 
For  example,  I  was  recently  standing  in  a  supermarket  checkout  line  and 
heard  a  mother  next  to  me  upbraid  her  toddler  for  having  put  several  items 
that  he  liked  into  the  shopping  cart:  "You  know  I  can't  afford  those  things," 
the  mother  said,  as  if  the  toddler  had  an  adult  knowledge  of  grocery  budgets. 
We  are  vulnerable  to  an  adult  egocentrism  and  assume  that  even  young  chil¬ 
dren  think  as  we  do,  even  if  our  attitude  isn't  as  dominant  as  it  once  was 
(Ausubel,  1958,  p.  24). 

In  embryology,  preformationism  gave  way  during  the  18th  century, 
when  microscopic  investigations  showed  that  the  embryo  developed  in  a 
gradual,  sequential  manner.  In  European  social  thought,  preformationism 
began  to  decline  earlier,  in  the  16th  century,  accompanying  changes  in  the 
occupational  world. 

During  the  Middle  Ages,  most  of  the  occupations — such  as  farming,  car¬ 
pentry,  domestic  service,  metal  work,  and  weaving — required  skill,  but  the 
adults  believed  that  6-  and  7-year-olds  could  begin  learning  them  on  the  job. 
Children,  therefore,  were  able  to  mix  in  with  adults.  After  1500  or  so,  the  occu¬ 
pational  world  showed  clear  signs  of  change.  With  the  invention  of  the  print¬ 
ing  press,  the  growth  of  commerce  and  market  economies,  and  the  rise  of 
cities  and  nation-states,  the  occupational  world  began  to  take  on  a  "white- 
collar"  look.  New  opportunities  arose  for  merchants,  lawyers,  bankers,  jour¬ 
nalists,  and  government  officials — occupations  that  required  reading,  writing, 
and  math.  The  members  of  a  rising  middle  class  saw  that  they  could  advance 
their  families'  fortunes  by  providing  their  children  with  the  academic  instruc¬ 
tion  that  these  new  occupations  required.  This  new  demand  for  education 
sparked  a  tremendous  growth  of  schools  in  16th-  and  17th-century  Europe 
(Crain,  1993). 

The  upshot  was  that  growing  numbers  of  parents  (especially  in  the 
middle  class)  were  no  longer  willing  to  send  their  children  off  to  work  at  the 
age  of  6  or  7  years.  Parents  wanted  their  children  to  go  to  school  first.  Parents 
began  keeping  their  children  in  school  at  least  until  they  were  12  years  old,  and 
often  until  they  were  well  into  their  teens.  Thus  the  growth  of  schools  gave  the 
child  a  new  status.  The  child  was  no  longer  someone  who  was  ready  for  the 
adult  world,  but  someone  who  had  to  be  kept  apart  from  it  while  undergoing 


3 


Early  Theories 


an  extensive  education.  The  child  was  seen  less  as  a  little  adult  and  more  as 
a  future  adult  (Aries,  1960,  pp.  329,  412). 


LOCKE’S  ENVIRONMENTALISM 
Biographical  Introduction 

As  the  rising  middle  class  pursued  new  opportunities,  it  challenged  the  tra¬ 
ditional  feudal  order.  The  middle  class  no  longer  accepted  a  society  in  which 
everyone's  place  was  predetermined  by  birth.  It  sought  a  brighter  future,  pin¬ 
ning  great  hopes  on  education  to  bring  it  about.  In  so  doing,  it  helped  usher 
in  the  modern  way  of  life. 

But  the  feudal  regime  wasn't  about  to  just  hand  over  its  authority.  It 
imposed  economic  regulations  and  waged  an  ideological  war.  It  accused  the 
new  middle  class — the  bourgeoisie — of  selfishly  abandoning  loyalty,  honor, 
and  the  old  ways. 

In  these  battles,  those  seeking  change  drew  inspiration  from  the  intellec¬ 
tuals  of  the  18th-century  Enlightenment,  such  as  Denis  Diderot  and  Nicolas  de 
Condorcet.  These  writers  argued  that  if  people  could  rid  themselves  of  the 
authoritarian  state  and  church,  people  could  live  freely  and  democratically,  and 
science,  technology,  and  education  would  produce  great  progress  for  all.  These 
writers,  in  turn,  drew  heavily  on  the  late-17th-century  theories  of  the  British 
philosopher  John  Locke  (1632-1704). 

Writing  in  language  that  was  refreshingly  clear  and  sensible,  Locke  rejected 
the  widespread  belief  that  there  are  vast,  innate  differences  among  people. 
Instead,  Locke  argued,  people  are  largely  shaped  by  their  social  environments, 
especially  by  their  education.  Locke  then  showed  how  this  happens  and  how 
education  could  be  improved.  To  many  Enlightenment  thinkers,  Locke's  writings 
were  full  of  wonderful  possibilities.  If  one  could  change  people's  environments 
and  education,  one  could  produce  an  egalitarian,  democratic  society  (Gay,  1969, 
pp.  511-516). 

Locke  was  born  in  the  village  of  Somerset,  England.  His  father,  a  small 
landowner,  was  the  first  to  instill  in  him  a  belief  in  democracy.  Locke 
attended  the  Westminster  School  and  Oxford  University,  but  found  both 
plagued  by  the  pedantic  lessons  so  prevalent  in  his  day.  Although  he  seems 
to  have  been  a  rather  shy  boy,  he  frequently  became  so  bored  and  restless 
in  class  that  he  preferred  to  talk  to  his  classmates  rather  than  pay  attention 
to  the  instructor  (Pheardon,  1952,  p.  vii;  Quick,  1880,  p.  xx;  Sahakian  & 
Sahakian,  1975). 

Still,  Locke  did  well  enough  at  Oxford  to  gain  appointments  at  the  uni¬ 
versity  tutoring  Greek  and  moral  philosophy.  Lor  a  while,  Locke  had  trouble 
deciding  on  his  future.  A  devout  Christian,  he  thought  he  might  become 
ordained  in  the  Church  of  England,  but  he  decided  to  study  medicine  instead. 


4 


Early  Theories 


primarily  so  he  could  learn  about  the  natural  sciences.  He  assisted  a  note¬ 
worthy  chemist,  Robert  Boyle,  and  was  deeply  impressed  by  the  scientific 
method  and  its  reliance  on  empirical  evidence.  As  a  physician,  Locke  suc¬ 
cessfully  treated  Lord  Ashley,  later  the  Earl  of  Shaftesbury;  became  Shaftes¬ 
bury's  friend  and  personal  secretary;  and  also  tutored  his  grandson.  His 
association  with  Shaftesbury,  however,  eventually  proved  troublesome.  When 
Shaftesbury  was  imprisoned  for  criticizing  the  king,  Locke  was  forced  to  flee 
England  and  find  asylum  in  Holland.  There,  Locke  wrote  a  series  of  letters  to 
his  friend  Edward  Clark,  offering  advice  on  the  upbringing  of  Clark's  son. 
These  letters  inspired  Locke's  most  important  work  on  education.  Some 
Thoughts  Concerning  Education  (1693).  After  the  successful  Revolution  of  1688, 
Locke  returned  to  England  and  saw  the  publication  of  two  other  great  books. 
The  first  was  his  Essay  Concerning  Human  Understanding  (1690),  which  esta¬ 
blished  him  as  the  father  of  empiricism  in  philosophy  and  learning  theory  in 
psychology.  His  other  great  book  was  Two  Treatises  on  Government  (1689),  which 
set  forth  many  of  the  central  ideas  in  the  U.S.  Constitution  (Lamprecht,  1928; 
Russell,  1945). 


Locke’s  View  of  Development 

The  starting  point  of  Locke's  theory  was  his  refutation  of  the  doctrine  of 
innate  ideas.  Prior  to  Locke,  many  philosophers  held  that  some  ideas,  such 
as  mathematical  truths  and  beliefs  in  God,  are  innate,  existing  in  the  mind 
prior  to  experience.  Locke  argued  that  observations  of  children  will  show 
that  these  ideas  are  not  present  from  the  beginning  and  that  they  are 
learned.  He  said  it  is  more  accurate  to  think  of  the  child's  mind  as  a  blank 
slate,  and  whatever  comes  into  the  mind  comes  from  the  environment.  We 
might  consider 

the  mind  to  be,  as  we  say,  white  paper  void  of  all  characteristics,  with¬ 
out  any  ideas.  How  comes  it  to  be  furnished?  .  .  .  Whence  has  it  all  the 
materials  of  reason  and  knowledge?  To  this  I  answer,  in  one  word,  from 
experience ;  in  that  all  our  knowledge  is  founded,  and  from  that  it  ulti¬ 
mately  derives  itself.  (1690,  vol.  1,  bk.  2,  sec.  2,  emphasis  in  original) 

Locke  did  qualify  this  statement  a  bit.  He  noted  that  although  most  of  a 
person's  knowledge  comes  from  the  environment,  a  person  also  can  learn,  in 
time,  by  reflecting  on  his  or  her  own  thinking  and  beliefs  (1690,  vol.  1,  bk.  2, 
chap.  1).  Locke  also  acknowledged  that  there  are  some  innate  differences 
among  individuals  (1693,  sec.  1). 

But  on  the  whole,  Locke  said,  it's  the  environment  that  molds  the  mind. 
And  the  environment's  influence,  Locke  emphasized,  is  especially  powerful 
in  the  child's  early  years.  This  is  when  the  child's  mind  is  most  pliable,  when 


5 


Early  Theories 


we  can  mold  it  as  we  wish.  And  once  we  do  so,  its  basic  nature  is  set  for  life 
(1693,  secs.  1,  32). 

Precisely  how  does  the  environment  exert  its  effects?  First,  many  of  our 
thoughts  and  feelings  develop  through  associations.  Two  ideas  regularly  occur 
together,  so  we  cannot  think  of  one  without  simultaneously  thinking  of  the 
other.  For  example,  if  a  child  has  had  bad  experiences  in  a  particular  room,  the 
child  cannot  enter  it  without  automatically  experiencing  a  negative  feeling 
(Locke,  1690,  vol.  1,  bk.  2,  chap.  33,  sec.  15). 

Much  of  our  behavior  also  develops  through  repetition.  When  we  do 
something  over  and  over,  such  as  brushing  our  teeth,  the  practice  becomes  a 
natural  habit,  and  we  feel  uneasy  when  we  have  failed  to  perform  it  (Locke, 
1693,  sec.  66). 

We  also  learn  through  imitation.  We  are  prone  to  do  what  we  see  others 
do,  so  models  influence  our  character.  If  we  are  frequently  exposed  to  silly 
and  quarrelsome  people,  we  become  silly  and  quarrelsome  ourselves;  if  we  are 
exposed  to  more  noble  minds,  we  too  become  more  noble  (1693,  sec.  67). 

Finally,  and  most  important,  we  learn  through  rewards  and  punishments. 
We  engage  in  behavior  that  brings  praise,  compliments,  and  other  rewards;  we 
refrain  from  those  actions  that  produce  unpleasant  consequences  (sec.  54). 

These  principles,  Locke  believed,  often  work  together  in  the  develop¬ 
ment  of  character.  For  example,  a  little  girl  is  likely  to  hang  up  her  clothes 
if  she  sees  her  parents  hang  theirs  up,  through  imitation.  After  she  hangs 
up  her  clothes  a  few  times  in  succession,  this  good  trait  becomes  a  habit, 
and  this  habit  becomes  all  the  stronger  if  she  receives  some  praise  or  com¬ 
pliment  for  it. 

The  previous  example  illustrates  the  usefulness  of  Locke's  ideas  for 
bringing  up  a  child.  Let  us  now  look  more  closely  at  his  views  on  education. 

Locke’s  Educational  Philosophy 

Locke  thought  of  education  broadly,  as  the  formation  of  the  child's  character 
as  well  as  academic  learning.  In  fact,  he  gave  greater  weight  to  character  devel¬ 
opment,  so  we  will  consider  this  first. 

Self-Control.  Locke  said  the  main  goal  of  education  is  self-control:  "It 
seems  plain  to  me  that  the  principle  of  all  virtue  and  excellency  lies  in  a  power 
of  denying  ourselves  the  satisfaction  of  our  own  desires,  where  reason  does 
not  authorize  them"  (1693,  sec.  38). 

To  instill  self-discipline,  we  first  should  tend  to  the  child's  physical 
health.  When  the  body  is  sick  and  weak,  one  has  little  ability  to  control  its 
demands.  Accordingly,  Locke  advised  us  to  give  children  plenty  of  exercise  so 
their  bodies  will  become  strong,  and  he  suggested  that  children  play  outdoors 
in  all  seasons  so  they  will  learn  to  endure  the  hardships  of  all  kinds  of  weather 
(secs.  1-16, 33). 


6 


Early  Theories 


If  children  are  to  acquire  discipline,  we  must  be  firm  with  them  from 
the  start.  Many  parents  coddle  their  children  and  give  in  to  their  every  whim; 
the  parents  think  that  such  indulgence  is  all  right  because  their  children  are 
still  small.  But  the  adults  fail  to  realize  that  early  habits  are  difficult  to  break. 
Children  who  find  that  they  can  get  whatever  they  want,  simply  by  asking  or 
crying  out,  never  unlearn  this  bad  habit.  So  parents  should  never  reward  chil¬ 
dren  when  they  desire  things  they  do  not  need.  Children  should  learn  that 
they  will  get  favorable  results  only  when  they  ask  for  things  that  their  parents 
consider  appropriate  (secs.  38-40). 

The  Best  Rewards  and  Punishments.  From  the  beginning,  then,  we 
should  pay  close  attention  to  how  we  reinforce  our  children's  behavior.  We 
should  reward  only  reasonable  behavior,  never  behavior  that  is  unreasonable  or 
self-indulgent. 

The  use  of  rewards  and  punishments,  however,  is  a  tricky  matter.  Not  all 
rewards  and  punishments  produce  desirable  effects.  Locke  was  especially 
opposed  to  the  use  of  physical  punishment.  In  the  first  place,  its  use  establishes 
undesirable  associations.  If  a  child  is  beaten  or  chastised  for  letting  her  mind 
wander  during  reading  lessons,  she  will  not  only  associate  pain  with  mind 
wandering,  but  with  the  sight  of  books  as  well.  Further,  physical  punishment 
is  often  ineffective.  The  child  submits  while  the  rod  is  in  sight,  but  just  as  soon 
as  the  child  sees  that  no  one  is  looking,  she  does  whatever  she  wants.  Finally, 
when  physical  punishment  does  work,  it  usually  works  too  well.  It  succeeds 
in  "breaking  the  mind;  and  then,  in  the  place  of  a  disorderly  young  fellow, 
you  have  a  low-spirited  moped  creature"  (sec.  51). 

Similarly,  not  all  kinds  of  rewards  are  desirable.  Locke  opposed  the 
use  of  money  or  sweets  as  rewards  because  their  use  undermines  the  main 
goal  of  education:  to  curb  desires  and  to  submit  to  reason.  When  we  reward 
with  food  or  money,  we  only  encourage  children  to  find  happiness  in  these 
things  (sec.  52). 

The  best  rewards  are  praise  and  flattery,  and  the  best  punishment  is  dis¬ 
approval.  When  children  do  well,  we  should  compliment  them,  making  them 
feel  proud;  when  they  do  poorly,  we  should  give  them  a  cold  glance,  making 
them  feel  ashamed.  Children  are  very  sensitive  to  approval  and  disapproval, 
especially  from  their  parents  and  those  on  whom  they  depend.  So  we  can  use 
these  reactions  to  instill  rational  and  virtuous  behavior  (sec.  57). 

We  also  can  strengthen  the  effectiveness  of  our  approval  and  disapproval 
by  pairing  these  reactions  with  other  consequences.  For  example,  when  a  little 
boy  asks  politely  for  a  piece  of  fruit,  we  give  it  to  him,  and  we  also  compliment 
him  on  his  politeness.  In  this  way,  he  learns  to  associate  approval  with  agreeable 
consequences  and  thus  becomes  more  concerned  about  it.  Alternatively,  when 
he  breaks  something  he  likes,  we  add  a  look  of  disappointment  in  him,  so  he 
will  come  to  associate  our  disapproval  with  negative  consequences.  Through 
such  practices,  we  deepen  the  child's  concern  for  the  opinions  of  others.  Locke 


7 


Early  Theories 


said  that  if  you  can  make  children  "in  love  with  the  pleasure  of  being  well 
thought  on,  you  may  turn  them  as  you  please,  and  they  will  be  in  love  with  all 
the  ways  of  virtue"  (sec.  58). 

Small  Steps.  Locke  was  concerned  that  children  acquire  many  fears. 
For  example,  children  are  initially  attracted  to  animals,  but  when  one  hurts 
a  child's  finger,  she  associates  the  sight  of  the  animal  with  pain  and  fears 
all  animals  of  the  same  species.  Locke  wanted  children  to  grow  up  to  be 
brave  adults,  so  he  recommended  a  method  for  eliminating  fears.  He  didn't 
advise  adults  to  just  rush  in  and  try  to  break  the  child  of  fears,  but  to  elim¬ 
inate  them  by  "gentle  degrees"  (sec.  115).  If  a  child  fears  a  chicken,  we  should 
first  let  someone  else  sit  beside  the  chicken  at  some  distance  from  the  child, 
until  the  child  can  watch  the  animal  without  fear.  Then  we  should  slowly  and 
gradually  bring  the  child  closer  to  the  chicken,  making  sure  the  child  can 
observe  the  chicken  without  anxiety.  Finally,  we  let  the  child  touch  the 
chicken  while  the  chicken  is  held  by  another,  until  the  child  herself  can  han¬ 
dle  the  animal  comfortably. 

Rules.  Most  parents  set  down  all  kinds  of  rules  and  then  punish  their 
children  when  they  disobey  them.  This  practice  is  basically  useless.  Children 
have  great  difficulty  comprehending  and  remembering  rules  in  the  abstract, 
and  they  naturally  resent  getting  punished  for  failing  to  comply  with  a  rule 
that  they  could  barely  keep  in  mind.  As  an  alternative  to  commands,  Locke 
suggested  two  procedures. 

First,  since  children  learn  more  from  example  than  precept,  we  can  teach 
them  much  by  exposing  them  to  good  models.  Children  will  eagerly  model 
their  behavior  after  that  of  a  virtuous  person,  especially  when  we  compliment 
them  for  doing  so  (sec.  68). 

Second,  Locke  suggested  that,  instead  of  issuing  commands,  we  have 
children  practice  the  desired  behavior.  For  example,  instead  of  instructing 
children  to  bow  whenever  they  meet  a  lady,  it  is  better  to  give  them  actual 
practice  in  bowing,  complimenting  them  each  time  they  bow  correctly.  After 
repeated  practice,  they  will  bow  as  naturally  as  they  breathe,  without  any 
thought  or  reflection,  which  is  essentially  foreign  to  them  anyway  (sec.  66). 

Children ’s  Special  Characteristics.  Locke's  discussion  of  the  futility 
of  teaching  rules  that  exceed  a  child's  understanding  introduced  something 
new  into  his  system.  Before  this,  he  had  written  as  if  the  child's  mind  were  a 
lump  of  clay  that  we  could  mold  in  any  way  we  wished.  Now,  however,  he 
was  saying  that  children  have  their  own  cognitive  capacities  that  set  limits 
on  what  we  can  teach.  He  also  suggested  that  children  have  temperaments 
peculiar  to  their  age,  such  as  a  liking  for  noise,  raucous  games,  and  gaiety, 
and  he  added  that  it  would  be  foolish  to  try  to  change  their  natural  disposi¬ 
tions  (sec.  63).  Thus  Locke  seemed  to  admit  that  children  are  not  blank  slates 


8 


Early  Theories 


after  all.  As  various  scholars  have  pointed  out  (e.g.,  Kessen,  1965,  pp.  59,  72; 
Russell,  1945,  p.  606),  Locke  was  not  above  a  certain  amount  of  inconsistency. 
If  he  had  insights  that  contradicted  his  basic  environmentalism,  the  inconsis¬ 
tency  didn't  trouble  him. 

Academic  Instruction.  Locke  was  upset  by  the  academic  instruc¬ 
tion  of  his  time,  which  forced  children  to  spend  long  hours  a  day  struggling 
with  material  that  made  no  sense  to  them.  Locke  pointed  out  that  instruc¬ 
tion  is  most  effective  when  children  enjoy  it.  He  suggested  that  children 
could  learn  many  things,  such  as  reading  letters  and  words,  through  games 
(secs.  148,  150).  Locke  also  recommended  that  instruction  be  arranged  in 
steps,  so  children  could  thoroughly  master  one  topic  before  going  on  to  the 
next,  and  he  wanted  children  to  see  the  order  and  usefulness  of  their  stud¬ 
ies  (secs.  180, 195). 

Locke  acknowledged  that  children  will  dislike  some  of  the  lessons  that 
adults  consider  necessary  for  their  future.  In  these  cases,  the  teacher  should 
try  to  ease  the  children  through  them.  Certainly  the  teacher  should  avoid 
physical  punishment  or  strong  verbal  rebukes.  Harsh  discipline  simply  makes 
the  child  fearful,  and  a  teacher  can't  do  much  with  a  fearful  child.  As  Locke 
put  it,  "'Tis  as  impossible  to  draw  fair  and  regular  characters  on  a  trembling 
mind  as  on  shaking  paper"  (1693,  sec.  167).  It  is  better  to  rely  on  the  kinds  of 
rewards  and  punishments  discussed  earlier — praise  and  disapproval. 

In  an  interesting  passage  (secs.  118-119),  Locke  emphasized  the  need 
to  take  advantage  of  the  child's  natural  curiosity.  Children,  he  said,  learn 
for  the  sake  of  learning;  their  minds  seek  knowledge  like  the  eye  seeks  light. 
If  we  simply  listen  to  their  questions  and  answer  them  directly,  their  minds 
will  expand  beyond  what  we  would  have  imagined  possible.  In  fact,  Locke 
attributed  such  power  to  the  child's  natural  curiosity  that  it  makes  one  won¬ 
der  about  his  general  thesis.  If  the  child's  curiosity  is  so  powerful,  why  do 
we  need  to  use  external  rewards  and  punishments  for  learning?  Perhaps 
they  are  necessary  in  the  training  of  the  child's  character,  but  it  may  be  that 
children  will  develop  their  intellectual  powers  through  intrinsic  curiosity 
alone.  But  if  Locke  saw  such  a  possibility,  he  didn't  say  anything  about  it,  and 
in  the  end  he  reverted  to  his  environmental  thesis.  When  children  reason 
clearly,  we  should  compliment  and  flatter  them.  In  this  way,  we  teach  them 
to  reason  (sec.  119). 

Evaluation 

As  a  psychologist,  Locke  was  far  ahead  of  his  time.  His  principles  of  learning — 
the  principles  of  association,  repetition,  modeling,  and  rewards  and 
punishments — all  have  become  cornerstones  of  one  or  another  version  of 
modern  learning  theory.  His  thoughts  on  changing  behavior  by  "gentle 
degrees"  is  fundamental  to  some  of  the  most  contemporary  thinking  in 


9 


Early  Theories 


the  field.  We  shall  see  the  extent  to  which  Locke  anticipated  modern  think¬ 
ing  in  later  chapters. 

Locke's  ideas  on  education,  in  addition,  are  pretty  much  those  of  the 
contemporary  educator.  Most  teachers  use  rewards  and  punishments,  such 
as  praise,  grades,  and  criticism,  to  motivate  children  to  leam.  Most  enlightened 
teachers  are  also  aware  of  the  influence  of  models  and  the  need  to  proceed  in 
arranged  steps  and  are  opposed  to  physical  punishment. 

Most  modem  educators  even  share  Locke's  inconsistencies.  Although  they 
believe  it  is  necessary  to  shape  or  mold  the  child  through  rewards  and  punish¬ 
ments,  they  also  recognize  that  such  social  influences  are  not  all-powerful.  They 
are  sensitive  to  the  child's  readiness  to  learn  different  things,  and  they  recognize 
that  children  leam  best  when  they  are  spontaneously  curious  about  a  particular 
subject.  Nevertheless,  like  Locke,  educators  are  not  prepared  to  rely  too  heavily 
on  children's  intrinsic  motivation  to  learn  on  their  own.  Teachers  believe  it  is  up 
to  them,  the  adults,  to  teach  children  the  right  things.  They  do  not  really  believe 
children  would  learn  what  they  should  without  external  inducements  such  as 
praise  and  grades.  In  general,  they  share  Locke's  view  that  education  is  essen¬ 
tially  a  socialization  process.  The  child  learns  to  gain  adults'  approval,  and  in 
this  way  the  child  learns  what  he  or  she  needs  to  know  to  become  a  useful  and 
virtuous  member  of  society. 


ROUSSEAU’S  ROMANTIC  NATURALISM1 
Biographical  Introduction 

We  have  now  reviewed  two  early  conceptions  of  development.  We  have  dis¬ 
cussed  the  preformationist  view,  which  considered  the  child  as  a  miniature 
adult.  We  also  have  looked  at  the  views  of  Locke,  who  argued  that  children 
are  like  empty  containers  that  are  filled  by  adult  teachings. 

The  true  developmentalist  position  is  different  again.  Its  first  forceful 
expression  is  found  in  the  work  of  Jean-Jacques  Rousseau  (1712-1778). 
Rousseau  agreed  with  Locke  that  children  are  different  from  adults,  but  he 
made  the  point  more  positively.  Children  are  not  empty  containers  or  blank 
slates  but  have  their  own  modes  of  feeling  and  thinking.  This  is  because  they 
grow  according  to  nature's  plan,  which  urges  them  to  develop  different  capac¬ 
ities  and  modalities  at  different  stages. 

Rousseau  believed  that  it  is  vital  for  us  to  give  nature  the  chance  to  guide 
the  child's  growth.  Unlike  Locke,  he  had  no  faith  in  the  powers  of  the  envi¬ 
ronment,  especially  the  social  environment,  to  form  a  healthy  individual.  Well- 
socialized  adults,  he  felt,  are  far  too  dependent  on  the  opinions  of  others.  They 
have  forgotten  how  to  see  with  their  own  eyes  and  to  think  with  their  own 


'This  heading  is  suggested  by  Muuss  (1975,  p.  27). 


10 


Early  Theories 


minds;  they  see  and  think  only  what  society  expects  them  to.  So,  instead  of 
rushing  in  to  teach  children  to  think  in  the  "correct"  ways,  we  should  allow 
them  to  perfect  their  own  capacities  and  to  learn  in  their  own  ways,  as  nature 
intends.  Then  they  will  learn  to  trust  their  own  powers  of  judgment. 

Rousseau's  beliefs,  especially  his  faith  in  nature  as  opposed  to  societal 
influences,  sparked  the  Romantic  movement  in  the  history  of  ideas.  At  the 
same  time,  his  belief  in  a  natural  ground  plan  for  healthy  growth  ushered  in 
the  developmental  tradition  in  psychology. 

Rousseau's  revolt  against  society  grew  out  of  his  personal  life.  He  was 
born  in  Geneva,  the  son  of  a  watchmaker  and  a  beautiful,  sentimental  mother 
who  died  giving  birth  to  him.  For  the  first  8  years  of  his  life,  he  was  raised 
by  his  father  and  an  aunt.  He  said  his  father  was  devoted  to  him,  but  he 
added  that  his  father  never  let  him  forget  he  had  caused  his  mother's  death 
(Rousseau,  1788,  p.  5).  His  aunt  also  was  kind,  but  she  refused  to  let  him  play 
in  the  street  with  the  other  children.  Rousseau  therefore  spent  most  of  his 
time  reading,  and  by  the  age  of  7  he  had  read  every  novel  in  his  mother's 
library. 

When  Rousseau  was  10  years  old,  his  father  got  into  a  bitter  dispute  and 
had  to  flee  Geneva  to  avoid  prison.  For  the  next  6  years,  Rousseau  was  shut¬ 
tled  through  several  homes.  He  rarely  got  along  with  his  masters,  who  often 
humiliated  him,  intensifying  his  already  timid  and  self-conscious  nature.  He 
told,  for  example,  of  wanting  to  buy  some  pastry  but  of  being  afraid  to  enter 
the  shop  because  he  imagined  that  acquaintances  would  spot  him  and  laugh 
at  him  (1788,  p.  36).  His  main  relief  came  from  fantasies,  in  which  he  imagined 
himself  in  the  heroic  situations  he  had  read  about.  He  also  engaged  in  a  good 
deal  of  stealing  and  cheating. 

When  Rousseau  was  16  he  began  the  life  of  a  vagabond.  He  traveled 
about,  trying  to  earn  what  money  he  could,  but  he  was  never  successful.  His 
main  talent,  he  found,  was  winning  the  favors  of  older  women.  He  was  not 
exactly  a  Don  Juan — he  was  very  timid  when  it  came  to  sex — but  he  did  get 
several  ladies  to  take  care  of  him. 

At  the  age  of  29,  Rousseau  invented  a  new  system  of  musical  nota¬ 
tion,  which  he  took  to  Paris.  It  was  poorly  received,  and  he  was  deeply  dis¬ 
appointed.  Still,  his  efforts  to  publish  the  system  brought  him  into  contact 
with  some  of  the  great  minds  of  the  18th-century  Enlightenment — people 
such  as  Diderot,  Voltaire,  and  Condorcet.  Rousseau  even  contributed  some 
articles  (mostly  on  music)  to  Diderot's  Encyclopedia.  But  even  among  such 
creative  and  courageous  thinkers — who  were  frequently  arrested  for  their 
writings — Rousseau  felt  like  an  outsider.  For  one  thing,  he  felt  too  shy  to 
participate  in  the  witty  and  clever  dialogue  of  the  Paris  salons  and  social  life. 
Moreover,  Rousseau  was  developing  a  viewpoint  that  differed  from  that  of 
other  Enlightenment  intellectuals.  He,  too,  rejected  dogmatic  authority,  but 
he  didn't  share  their  optimistic  belief  in  progress.  In  some  ways,  Rousseau 
believed,  people  in  the  modern  metropolis  were  worse  off  than  ever.  They 


11 


Early  Theories 


were  so  busy  making  a  good  impression  and  saying  the  right  things  that 
they  had  no  thoughts  or  feelings  of  their  own  (Berman,  1970;  Cranston, 
1982,  pp.  163-164,  217-221;  Rousseau,  1788,  pp.  267-268,  346,  354). 

At  the  age  of  33,  Rousseau's  personal  life  underwent  a  major  change. 
He  took  up  with  an  illiterate  servant  girl  named  Therese,  with  whom  he  spent 
the  rest  of  his  life.  She  gave  birth  to  five  children,  but  Rousseau  placed  them 
all  in  a  state  foundling  home.  He  said  that  he  later  realized  his  action  was 
wrong,  but  at  the  time  he  did  not  have  the  money  to  raise  them,  and  he  felt 
that  if  he  did  they  would  wind  up  living  a  life  as  miserable  as  his  own 
(Rousseau,  1788,  p.  367). 

Rousseau's  first  major  literary  success  came  at  the  age  of  37,  when  he 
entered  an  essay  contest  that  asked  whether  the  arts  and  sciences  had  con¬ 
tributed  to  the  betterment  of  morals.  Rousseau  argued  in  the  negative  and 
won  the  prize  (Rousseau,  1750).  During  the  next  several  years,  he  wrote  sev¬ 
eral  essays  and  books,  the  most  important  of  which  are  The  Social  Contract 
(1762a)  and  Emile  (1762b).  The  Social  Contract  opens  with  the  famous  line, 
"Man  is  born  free,  and  everywhere  he  is  in  chains."  That  is,  humans  are  natu¬ 
rally  good  and  could  live  happily  according  to  their  spontaneous  passions, 
but  they  are  enslaved  by  social  forces.  This  book  describes  a  better  society. 
Emile  is  Rousseau's  main  book  on  child  development  and  education.  It  is  titled 
after  the  fictitious  boy  whom  Rousseau  proposed  to  tutor  according  to  nature's 
plan  for  healthy  development. 

In  the  course  of  his  writings,  Rousseau  challenged  the  feudal  state  and 
church.  He  considered  himself  a  devout  Christian,  but  he  argued  against 
uncritical  conformity  to  religious  authority.  As  a  result,  officials  in  Paris  tried 
to  arrest  him  and  those  in  Geneva  barred  him  from  the  city,  and  he  spent 
many  of  his  last  years  in  exile,  paranoid  and  miserable.  When  Rousseau 
died,  he  was  buried  in  the  French  countryside,  where  his  body  remained 
until  after  the  French  Revolution,  which  his  writings  had  helped  inspire. 
His  remains  were  then  triumphantly  removed  to  Paris  and  placed  in  the 
Pantheon. 

Many  people  have  found  Rousseau  so  deficient  as  a  man  that  they  have 
refused  to  take  his  ideas  seriously,  especially  on  education.  How  can  a  man 
who  abandoned  his  own  children  to  an  orphanage  have  the  audacity  to  pre¬ 
scribe  the  right  upbringing  for  others?  However,  it  sometimes  takes  one  who 
has  lived  on  the  outside  of  the  conventional  social  order  to  create  a  radical 
vision.  Rousseau  said  that  he  was  "thrown,  in  spite  of  myself,  into  the  great 
world,  without  possessing  its  manners,  and  unable  to  acquire  or  conform  to 
them"  (1788,  p.  379).  He  believed  his  only  legitimate  response  was  to  rail 
against  society  and  to  seek,  in  its  place,  a  different  vision  of  how  life  might 
unfold.  He  tried  to  show  how  the  healthiest  development  might  come  not 
from  society's  influence,  but  from  nature.  In  so  doing,  Rousseau  became  the 
father  of  developmental  psychology. 


12 


Early  Theories 


Rousseau’s  Theory  of  Development 

Childhood  has  a  special  place  in  the  sequence  of  human  life,  yet  we  know 
nothing  about  it.  This  is  because  we  are  so  exclusively  concerned  with  the 
child's  future — with  the  things  the  child  will  need  to  know  to  fit  into  adult  soci¬ 
ety.  Even  "the  wisest  writers  devote  themselves  to  what  a  man  ought  to  know, 
without  asking  themselves  what  a  child  is  capable  of  learning.  They  are  always 
looking  for  the  man  in  the  child,  without  considering  what  he  is  before  he 
becomes  a  man"  (Rousseau,  1762b,  p.  1). 

When  we  take  the  time  simply  to  observe  children,  we  find  that  they  are 
very  different  from  us.  "Childhood  has  its  own  ways  of  seeing,  thinking,  and 
feeling"  (Rousseau,  1762b,  p.  54).  This  is  according  to  nature's  design.  Nature 
is  like  a  hidden  tutor  who  prompts  the  child  to  develop  different  capacities  at 
different  stages  of  growth  (p.  181).  Her  product  might  not  be  an  individual  well 
trained  to  fit  into  a  social  niche,  but  rather  a  strong,  complete  person.  If  we 
wish  to  aid  nature  in  this  process,  we  must  first  learn  all  we  can  about  the 
stages  of  development.  Rousseau  believed  there  are  four  main  stages. 

Stage  1 -.Infancy  (birth  to  about  2 years).  Infants  experience  the  world 
directly  through  the  senses.  They  know  nothing  of  ideas  or  reason;  they  sim¬ 
ply  experience  pleasure  and  pain  (p.  29).  Nevertheless,  babies  are  active  and 
curious  and  learn  a  great  deal.  They  constantly  try  to  touch  everything  they 
can,  and  by  doing  so  they  learn  about  heat,  cold,  hardness,  softness,  and  other 
qualities  of  objects  (p.  31).  Infants  also  begin  to  acquire  language,  which  they 
do  almost  entirely  on  their  own.  In  a  sense,  they  develop  a  grammar  that  is 
more  perfect  than  ours;  they  employ  grammatical  rules  without  all  the  excep¬ 
tions  that  plague  adult  speech.  Pedantically,  we  correct  their  mistakes,  even 
though  children  will  always  correct  themselves  in  time  (p.  37). 

Stage  2:  Childhood  (about  2  to  12  years).  This  stage  begins  when 
children  gain  a  new  independence;  they  can  now  walk,  talk,  feed  themselves, 
and  run  about.  They  develop  these  abilities,  too,  on  their  own  (p.  42). 

During  this  stage,  children  possess  a  kind  of  reason.  But  it  is  not  the  kind 
that  deals  with  remote  events  or  abstractions.  Rather,  it  is  an  intuitive  reason 
that  is  directly  tied  to  body  movement  and  the  senses.  For  example,  when  a  girl 
accurately  throws  a  ball,  she  demonstrates  an  intuitive  knowledge  of  velocity 
and  distance.  Or  when  a  boy  digs  with  a  stick,  he  reveals  an  intuitive  knowle¬ 
dge  of  leverage.  However,  thinking  is  still  extremely  concrete.  A  child  can  be 
taught  about  a  globe,  with  all  the  countries,  towns,  and  rivers.  But  when  asked, 
"What  is  the  world?,"  he  is  likely  to  say,  "Apiece  of  cardboard"  (p.  74). 

Stage  3:  Late  Childhood  (about  12  to  15  years).  This  third  stage  is  a 
transitional  one  between  childhood  and  adolescence.  During  this  period,  chil¬ 
dren  gain  an  enormous  amount  of  physical  strength;  they  can  plow,  push 


13 


Early  Theories 


carts,  hoe,  and  do  the  work  of  adults  (p.  128).  They  also  make  substantial 
progress  in  the  cognitive  sphere  and  can,  for  example,  do  relatively  advanced 
problems  in  geometry  and  science.  Still,  they  are  not  yet  disposed  to  think 
about  purely  theoretical  and  verbal  matters.  Instead,  they  can  best  exercise 
their  cognitive  functions  through  concrete  and  useful  tasks,  such  as  farming, 
carpentry,  and  mapmaking. 

During  the  first  three  stages,  children  are  by  nature  presocial.  That  is, 
they  are  primarily  concerned  with  what  is  necessary  and  useful  to  them¬ 
selves  and  have  little  interest  in  social  relationships.  They  enjoy  working 
with  physical  things  and  learning  from  nature;  the  world  of  books  and  soci¬ 
ety  is  foreign  to  them.  Even  as  late  as  the  third  stage,  between  12  and  15 
years,  the  model  for  the  child's  life  should  be  Robinson  Crusoe,  a  man  who 
lived  alone  on  an  island  and  who  became  self-sufficient  by  dealing  effec¬ 
tively  with  the  physical  environment  (p.  147). 

Stage  4:  Adolescence.  Children  become  distinctly  social  beings  only  at 
the  fourth  stage,  which  begins  with  puberty.  Rousseau  said  that  puberty  begins 
at  age  15,  somewhat  later  than  we  would  date  it  today.  At  this  time,  the  child 
undergoes  a  second  birth.  The  body  changes  and  the  passions  well  up  from 
within.  "A  change  of  temper,  frequent  outbreaks  of  anger,  a  perpetual  stirring 
of  the  mind,  make  the  child  almost  ungovernable"  (p.  172).  The  young  person, 
who  is  neither  child  nor  adult,  begins  to  blush  in  the  presence  of  the  opposite 
sex,  for  he  or  she  is  dimly  aware  of  sexual  feelings.  At  this  point,  the  youngster 
is  no  longer  self-sufficient.  The  adolescent  is  attracted  to  and  needs  others. 

The  adolescent  also  develops  cognitively.  He  or  she  can  now  deal  with 
abstract  concepts  and  takes  an  interest  in  theoretical  matters  in  science  and 
morals. 

These,  then,  are  Rousseau's  four  stages,  which  he  believed  unfold  in  an 
invariant  sequence  according  to  nature's  plan.  His  stages,  especially  adoles¬ 
cence,  would  seem  to  emerge  more  slowly  than  we  would  expect  today,  and 
this  might  partly  reflect  a  genuine  historical  difference.  Rousseau,  however, 
also  believed  that  the  true  course  of  human  development  is  slower  than  we 
ordinarily  recognize.  We  are  always  looking  at  children  as  if  they  were  already 
adults,  whereas  nature  would  have  children  take  the  time  to  develop  the 
capacities  and  interests  of  childhood  (p.  181). 

Rousseau  also  proposed  that  these  stages  recapitulate  the  general  evolu¬ 
tion  of  the  human  species.  Infants  are  similar  to  the  earliest  "primitives,"  who 
dealt  with  the  world  directly  through  their  senses  and  were  concerned  only 
with  pleasure  and  pain.  The  next  two  stages  of  childhood  parallel  the  "savage" 
era,  when  people  learned  to  build  huts,  make  tools,  fish,  trap,  and  utilize  other 
skills.  People  formed  loose  associations  with  others,  but  they  still  were  largely 
self-sufficient. 

Adolescence,  finally,  parallels  the  beginning  of  true  social  life.  Historically, 
social  existence  began  with  the  division  of  labor.  As  work  became  specialized. 


14 


Early  Theories 


people  could  no  longer  produce  all  they  needed  by  themselves.  Thus  they  had 
to  rely  on  others.  As  they  became  increasingly  immersed  in  society  they  became 
the  slaves  of  conventions  and  social  approval.  Even  savages,  to  be  sure,  were 
somewhat  concerned  with  the  opinions  of  others,  but  this  concern  deepened  as 
people  became  embedded  in  social  life.  As  a  result,  modem  individuals  no  longer 
think  for  themselves.  "The  savage,"  Rousseau  said,  "lives  within  himself;  the 
sociable  man,  always  outside  himself,  knows  how  to  live  only  in  the  opinion  of 
others"  (Rousseau,  1755,  p.  179). 

Rousseau’s  Educational  Method 

Rousseau  thought  we  were  most  fulfilled  as  savages,  but  he  realized  that  those 
days  are  gone  forever.  Still,  we  do  not  need  to  become  the  weak  conformists 
that  we  presently  are.  Nature  will  continue  to  guide  children's  development 
along  the  road  to  independence.  Under  its  urging,  children  will  spontaneously 
perfect  their  capacities  and  powers  of  discrimination  by  dealing  with  physi¬ 
cal  things,  without  adult  teaching.  So,  if  one  follows  nature's  guidance,  it 
should  be  possible  to  bring  the  child  to  adolescence  with  an  independent 
mind.  Then,  when  the  young  person  does  enter  the  social  world,  he  or  she 
can  cope  effectively  with  it. 

Rousseau  told  how  this  would  happen  in  the  case  of  Emile,  his  imagi¬ 
nary  pupil. 

Emile ’s  Education.  Rousseau  would  have  a  basic  faith  in  Emile's  capa¬ 
city  to  leam  much  on  his  own,  from  nature's  inner  promptings.  For  example,  as 
an  infant  Emile  would  have  a  strong  urge  to  explore  the  world  through  his  senses. 
Accordingly,  Rousseau  would  remove  all  harmful  objects  from  the  house  and  let 
Emile  explore  it.  If  Emile  wished  to  inspect  an  object,  Rousseau  would  bring  it 
to  him.  No  adult  guidance  would  be  necessary  (Rousseau,  1762b,  pp.  31, 35). 

At  the  same  time,  Rousseau  would  not  permit  Emile  to  rule  over  him.  He 
would  bring  Emile  an  object  when  Emile  had  a  genuine  need  to  learn  about 
it,  but  never  when  Emile  simply  had  a  capricious  desire  to  have  his  tutor  do 
his  bidding  (p.  52). 

Emile  also  would  learn  to  walk  and  talk  on  his  own.  Rousseau  would 
never  push  or  correct  his  pupil.  Such  practices  only  make  children  timid  and 
anxious.  They  begin  looking  to  others  for  correction  and  thereby  lose  their 
independence  (pp.  39-40). 

As  Emile  moved  into  the  second  stage,  that  of  childhood,  he  would  have 
an  urge  to  run,  jump,  shout,  and  play.  Rousseau  would  never  check  these 
activities,  for  Emile  would  be  following  nature's  inner  prompting  to  develop 
his  body  through  vigorous  exercise.  Rousseau  would  not,  like  many  adults, 
always  be  saying,  "Come  here,  go  there,  stop,  do  this,  don't  do  that"  (p.  82), 
for  Emile  would  then  turn  to  his  tutor  for  guidance  and  "his  own  mind  would 
become  useless"  (p.  82). 


15 


Early  Theories 


Rousseau  would  present  various  lessons,  but  only  those  that  fit  Emile's 
age.  Since  children  at  this  stage  are  developing  their  senses,  Rousseau  would 
suggest  games  such  as  finding  one's  way  in  a  completely  dark  room,  thus 
developing  the  sense  of  touch  (p.  98).  Because  children  do  anything  that 
keeps  them  moving  freely,  he  would  take  advantage  of  this  impulse  to  help 
Emile  learn  to  judge  heights,  lengths,  and  distances.  He  would  point  to  a 
cherry  tree  and  ask  Emile  to  select  a  ladder  of  the  proper  height.  Or  he  would 
suggest  that  they  cross  a  river,  and  ask  Emile  which  plank  would  extend 
across  the  banks  (p.  105). 

In  all  such  lessons,  Emile  would  be  able  to  judge  his  successes  by  him¬ 
self.  Emile  could  see  for  himself  if  he  had  chosen  a  plank  that  was  large  enough 
to  extend  across  the  river.  He  could  make  this  judgment  because  the  lesson  cor¬ 
responds  to  his  current  capacities.  It  requires  only  the  use  of  his  senses.  There 
is  nothing  in  the  lesson  that  is  beyond  his  grasp,  nothing  that  would  force 
him  to  turn  to  his  tutor  for  help  (p.  141). 

Rousseau  said  that  each  stage  "has  a  perfection,  a  ripeness,  of  its  own" 
(p.  122).  We  are  used  to  thinking  about  a  "grown  man,"  but  it  is  no  less 
pleasing  to  consider  a  "grown  child,"  and  to  look  at  Emile  at  age  10  or  12. 

His  face,  his  bearing,  his  expression  speak  of  confidence  and  content¬ 
ment;  health  shines  in  his  countenance. ...  I  see  him  keen,  eager,  and  full 
of  life. . . .  His  manner  is  free  and  open. . . .  [He  excels]  at  running,  jump¬ 
ing,  raising  weights,  estimating  distances,  inventing  games.  .  .  .  He  will 
not  be  so  stupid  as  to  go  ask  other  people  about  what  he  sees;  he  will 
examine  it  on  his  own  account.  .  .  .  His  ideas  are  few  but  precise,  he 
knows  nothing  by  rote  and  much  by  experience.  ...  So  do  not  expect 
set  speeches  or  studied  manners  from  him,  but  just  the  faithful  expres¬ 
sion  of  his  thoughts  and  the  conduct  that  springs  from  his  inclinations. 

(pp.  122-126) 

To  most  observers,  Emile  will  be  simply  a  rough,  happy  boy,  but  raised  in  con¬ 
cert  with  nature  he  will  have  "reached  the  perfection  of  childhood"  (p.  126). 

During  the  third  stage,  that  of  late  childhood,  Emile's  maturing  cog¬ 
nitive  powers  would  enable  him  to  learn  mathematics  and  science,  but  he 
would  reason  effectively  in  these  spheres  only  in  connection  with  concrete 
activities.  Accordingly,  Rousseau  would  encourage  him  to  think  about  mathe¬ 
matical  problems  that  naturally  emerged  in  the  course  of  activities  such  as 
farming  and  carpentry.  Rousseau  would  provide  only  minimal  guidance 
and,  again,  he  would  never  correct  Emile's  mistakes.  His  goal  would  not  be 
to  teach  Emile  the  right  answers  but  to  help  him  learn  to  solve  problems  on 
his  own. 

Let  him  know  nothing  because  you  have  told  him,  but  because  he  has 
learned  it  for  himself.  Let  him  not  be  taught  science,  let  him  discover  it. 


16 


Early  Theories 


If  ever  you  substitute  authority  for  reason  he  will  cease  to  reason;  he 

will  be  a  mere  plaything  of  other  people's  thoughts,  (p.  131) 

Only  at  adolescence  would  Emile  begin  reading  many  books  and 
receive  his  introduction  into  the  larger  social  world.  By  this  time  he  would 
have  developed  an  independent  nature,  and  with  his  new  capacities  for 
theoretical  reasoning,  he  could  judge  society  at  its  true  worth  (p.  183). 

Comparison  with  the  Usual  Practices.  Rousseau,  then,  would  encour¬ 
age  Emile  to  perfect  his  capacities  at  each  stage,  according  to  nature's  own 
schedule,  and  he  would  never  present  anything  that  Emile  could  not  judge 
for  himself.  Rousseau's  method  would  differ  radically  from  that  of  most 
educators. 

Most  schools  are  not  content  to  treat  children  as  children,  with  their  own 
needs  and  ways  of  learning.  Instead,  they  try  to  instill  adult  knowledge  as 
quickly  as  possible.  As  a  result,  they  present  many  lessons  that  exceed  the 
child's  understanding.  For  example,  they  give  lessons  in  history,  geography, 
and  mathematics  that  have  nothing  to  do  with  the  child's  direct  experience  and 
assume  a  capacity  for  reasoning  that  the  child  lacks.  As  children  struggle  with 
such  lessons,  they  find  learning  a  miserable  experience.  And  not  only  this. 
Because  they  cannot  fully  comprehend  what  the  adult  is  saying,  they  are 
forced  to  take  things  on  faith,  to  accept  answers  simply  because  the  adult  has 
explained  them  to  be  true.  They  have  no  recourse  but  to  ask  their  parents  or 
teachers,  "Did  I  get  the  right  answer  here?"  "Is  this  right?"  They  thereby  learn 
to  depend  on  others  and  cease  to  think  for  themselves. 

When  children  are  asked  to  learn  things  that  exceed  their  grasp,  they 
become  lazy  and  unmotivated.  To  motivate  them,  teachers  use  threats,  bribes, 
disapproval,  and  flattery.  They  try  to  get  children  to  learn  in  order  to  win  the 
adult's  approval.  Such  procedures  only  reinforce  the  child's  dependency  on 
the  approval  of  others  (p.  54). 

Rousseau  said  that  his  own  method,  in  contrast,  would  be  "merely 
negative"  (p.  57).  That  is,  he  would  exercise  Emile's  body  and  senses  but 
keep  his  mind  idle  as  long  as  possible.  He  would  shield  Emile  from  all  opin¬ 
ions  until  his  capacity  for  reasoning  had  developed,  at  which  point  he  could 
judge  them  for  himself.  At  the  age  of  12  or  15  years,  Emile  would  appear 
ignorant  in  the  conventional  sense.  He  would  know  nothing  of  society  or 
morals  and  have  no  precocious  knowledge  to  display.  But  he  would  have 
learned  to  judge  everything  according  to  his  own  experience.  He  therefore 
would  be  capable  of  real  thinking  (pp.  127, 170). 

Rousseau  anticipated  the  impatience  others  would  have  with  his  advice. 
It  would  seem  as  if  he  were  failing  to  prepare  the  child  for  the  future.  How 
could  we  be  certain  that  the  child  would  know  what  was  necessary  when  the 
time  came?  Rousseau's  reply  was  that  societies  change  so  rapidly  that  it  is  really 
impossible  to  predict  what  knowledge  will  be  useful.  But  more  importantly. 


17 


Early  Theories 


our  obsession  with  the  future  contains  the  greatest  of  all  traps;  in  our  hurry  to 
teach  children  what  we  think  they  will  need,  we  present  lessons  that  exceed 
their  understanding  and  force  them  to  turn  to  us  for  help.  Rousseau  wanted  us 
to  slow  down  and  give  children  a  chance  to  learn  in  ways  that  come  naturally 
to  them  and  to  learn  on  their  own  (pp.  141, 157). 


Evaluation 

Rousseau  introduced  several  key  ideas  into  developmental  theory.  First,  he 
proposed  that  development  proceeds  according  to  an  inner,  biological 
timetable.  For  the  first  time,  we  have  a  picture  of  development  unfolding  fairly 
independently  from  environmental  influences.  Children  are  no  longer  sim¬ 
ply  shaped  by  external  forces,  such  as  adult  teachings  and  social  reinforce¬ 
ments.  They  grow  and  learn  largely  on  their  own,  according  to  nature's  plan. 
Today  we  would  call  this  plan  biological  maturation. 

Second,  Rousseau  suggested  that  development  unfolds  in  a  series  of 
stages,  periods  during  which  children  experience  the  world  in  different  ways. 
Children  differ  from  adults  not  because  they  are  blank  slates  that  will  gradu¬ 
ally  take  on  adult  teachings;  rather,  at  each  stage,  the  child's  patterns  of 
thought  and  behavior  have  their  own  unique  characteristics. 

Third,  Rousseau  proposed  a  new  philosophy  of  education,  one  which 
we  would  today  call  child  centered.  He  said,  "Treat  your  scholar  according  to 
his  age"  (p.  55),  by  which  he  meant  we  should  fit  our  lessons  to  the  child's 
particular  stage.  In  this  way,  children  will  be  able  to  judge  matters  according 
to  their  own  experience  and  powers  of  understanding. 

All  three  of  these  ideas  have  become  central  tenets  of  many  develop¬ 
mental  theories.  At  the  same  time,  though,  many  developmental  theorists 
would  disagree  with  parts  of  Rousseau's  theory.  Many  would  argue,  in  par¬ 
ticular,  that  the  child  is  not  nearly  as  asocial  as  Rousseau  suggested.  For  exam¬ 
ple,  modern  ethologists  point  out  how  babies  become  strongly  attached  to 
their  caretakers.  This  attachment,  they  say,  is  genetically  governed;  it  has 
evolved  because  proximity  to  parents  has  enhanced  babies'  chances  for  sur¬ 
vival.  Actually,  Rousseau  was  aware  of  such  attachments  (p.  174),  but  he  con¬ 
veniently  ignored  them  when  outlining  his  overall  theory.  He  wanted  children 
to  learn  to  reason  on  their  own,  apart  from  society's  corrupting  influences, 
and  he  therefore  declared  that  nature  intends  for  them  to  live  apart  from  the 
social  world,  even  if  he  knew  better. 

When  Rousseau  argued  that  we  should  protect  children  from  society, 
he  had  particular  concerns  in  mind.  He  saw  adults  teaching  children  social 
manners  and  beliefs  before  children  have  the  ability  to  judge  them  according 
to  their  own  powers  of  reasoning.  In  this  process,  adults  make  children  the 
slaves  of  social  conventions. 


18 


Early  Theories 


But  contemporary  psychology  includes  developmentalists  (e.g., 
Kohlberg)  who  prize  independent  thinking  as  much  as  Rousseau  did,  but  who 
believe,  nevertheless,  that  children  can  make  their  way  through  the  social 
world.  They  believe  that  children  will  form  social  and  moral  theories  on  their 
own,  fairly  independent  of  adult  teachings.  Furthermore,  if  children  think  long 
and  hard  about  social  problems,  they  will  reach  stages  that  transcend  conven¬ 
tional  modes  of  social  thought.  So  it  may  be  that  children  can  live  in  the  social 
world  without  being  undone  by  it. 

All  the  same,  it  was  Rousseau  who  introduced  the  crucial  question  into 
modern  developmental  and  humanistic  thinking:  Can  inner  growth  lead  to 
ways  of  experiencing  and  feeling  that  can  stand  up  to  the  crushing  pressure 
of  social  conformity? 


19 


This  page  intentionally  left  blank 


Gesell’s  Maturational 

Theory 


From  Theories  of  Development:  Concepts  and  Applications,  Sixth  Edition.  William 
Crain.  Copyright  ©  2011  by  Pearson  Education,  Inc.  Published  by  Pearson 
Prentice  Hall.  All  rights  reserved. 


21 


Gesell ’s  Maturational 

Theory 


BIOGRAPHICAL  INTRODUCTION 

Rousseau  believed  behavior  unfolds  according  to  nature's  inner  plan 
or  timetable.  Today  we  would  call  this  process  biological  maturation, 
and  the  person  who  did  the  most  to  initiate  the  study  of  maturation 
was  Arnold  Gesell  (1880-1961). 

Gesell  grew  up  in  Alma,  Wisconsin,  a  small  town  on  the  bank 
of  the  upper  Mississippi  River.  In  an  autobiographical  account,  he 
described  an  almost  idyllic  midwestern  childhood,  in  which  "hills, 
valley,  water  and  climate  concurred  to  make  the  seasons  distinct  and 
intense  in  my  home  town.  Each  season  had  its  own  challenges  and 
keen  pleasures,  accentuated  by  the  ever-changing,  yet  enduring 
river"  (Gesell,  1952a,  p.  124).  Gesell  used  similar  language  to  describe 
the  beauty  he  saw  in  the  growth  process,  with  "its  seasons  and 
sequences"  (Gesell  &  Ilg,  1943,  p.  57).  This  is  not  to  say,  however, 
that  Gesell  was  merely  a  gushing  romantic.  He  studied  children's 
development  with  painstaking  observation.  To  increase  his  knowl¬ 
edge  of  the  underlying  physiological  processes,  he  went  to  medical 
school  at  the  age  of  30,  even  though  he  already  had  a  Ph.D.  and  had 
been  working  successfully  as  a  psychologist.  In  his  50  years  at  the 
Yale  Clinic  of  Child  Development,  he  and  his  colleagues  engaged  in 
incredibly  extensive  and  detailed  studies  of  the  neuromotor  develop¬ 
ment  of  babies  and  children.  They  developed  behavior  norms  that  are 
so  complete  that  they  still  serve  as  a  primary  source  of  information 
for  pediatricians  and  psychologists  today.  Gesell  also  developed  one 
of  the  first  tests  of  infant  intelligence  (Gesell  &  Amatruda,  1941)  and 
was  one  of  the  first  researchers  to  make  extensive  use  of  film 
observations. 

Gesell  also  wrote  on  child  rearing,  advocating  a  child-centered 
approach.  He  was  the  best  known  "baby  doctor"  in  the  early  1940s,  until 


22 


Gesell's  Maturational  Theory 


Dr.  Benjamin  Spock  published  his  famous  book  in  1946.  Nevertheless,  Spock 
was  partly  influenced  by  Gesell. 


PRINCIPLES  OF  DEVELOPMENT 
The  Concept  of  Maturation 

The  child's  growth  or  development,  Gesell  said,  is  influenced  by  two  major 
forces.  First,  the  child  is  a  product  of  his  or  her  environment.  But  more  fun¬ 
damentally,  Gesell  believed,  the  child's  development  is  directed  from 
within,  by  the  action  of  the  genes.  Gesell  called  this  process  maturation 
(Gesell  &  Ilg,  1943,  p.  41). 

An  outstanding  feature  of  maturational  development  is  that  it  always 
unfolds  in  fixed  sequences.  This  can  first  be  seen  in  the  developing  embryo, 
where,  for  example,  the  heart  is  always  the  first  organ  to  develop  and  func¬ 
tion.  Soon  afterward,  the  rapidly  differentiating  cells  begin  to  form  the  cen¬ 
tral  nervous  system — the  brain  and  the  spinal  cord.  The  development  of  the 
brain  and  the  head,  in  turn,  begins  before  the  other  parts,  such  as  the  arms 
and  the  legs.  This  order,  which  is  directed  by  the  genetic  blueprint,  is  never 
violated. 

Similarly,  sequential  development  continues  after  birth.  For  example, 
just  as  the  head  develops  early  in  the  embryo,  it  also  takes  the  lead  in  early 
postnatal  development.  Babies  first  have  control  over  their  lips  and  tongues, 
then  gain  control  over  their  eye  movements,  followed  by  control  over  the 
neck,  shoulders,  arms,  hands,  fingers,  trunk,  legs,  and  feet.  In  both  prenatal 
and  postnatal  development  there  is  a  head-to-foot  (cephalocaudal)  trend 
(Gesell,  1946,  p.  339). 

As  babies  grow,  they  learn  to  sit  up,  to  stand,  to  walk,  and  to  run,  and 
these  capacities,  too,  develop  in  a  specific  order.  They  emerge  with  the  growth 
of  the  nervous  system,  which  itself  is  directed  by  the  genes. 

Children,  of  course,  vary  in  their  rates  of  development.  They  do  not  all 
stand  up  and  walk  at  the  same  age.  Nevertheless,  they  all  proceed  through 
the  same  sequences.  Moreover,  individual  differences  in  growth  rates,  in 
Gesell's  view,  are  largely  controlled  by  the  internal  genetic  mechanism 
(Gesell,  1945,  p.  161). 

As  indicated,  the  effects  of  maturation  are  contrasted  with  those  of  the 
environment.  In  prenatal  development,  this  means  that  maturation  is  distin¬ 
guished  from  aspects  of  the  internal  environment,  such  as  the  embryo's  tem¬ 
perature  and  the  oxygen  it  receives  from  its  mother.  These  environmental 
factors  are  certainly  vital — they  support  proper  growth — but  they  play  no 
direct  role  in  the  sequential  unfolding  of  structures  and  action  patterns.  This 
is  the  work  of  the  maturational  mechanism. 


23 


Gesell's  Maturational  Theory 


Once  the  baby  is  born,  she  enters  a  different  kind  of  environment.  It  is 
not  only  an  environment  that  meets  the  child's  physical  needs  but  also  a 
social  and  cultural  environment  that  tries  to  induce  the  child  to  behave  in 
the  proper  ways.  Gesell  said  that  the  child  clearly  needs  the  social  environ¬ 
ment  to  realize  his  or  her  potentials,  but  he  also  argued  that  socializing  forces 
work  best  when  they  are  in  tune  with  inner  maturational  principles  (Gesell 
&  Ilg,  1943,  p.  41). 

Gesell  was  particularly  opposed  to  efforts  to  teach  children  things  ahead 
of  schedule.  Children  will  sit  up,  walk,  and  talk  when  they  are  ready,  when 
their  nervous  systems  have  sufficiently  matured.  At  the  right  moment,  they 
will  simply  begin  to  master  a  task,  from  their  own  inner  urges.  Until  then, 
teaching  will  be  of  little  value,  and  may  create  tensions  between  caretakers  and 
children. 

Some  evidence  for  the  maturational  position  on  teaching  has  come  from 
studies  with  identical  twins.  For  example,  Gesell  and  Thompson  (1929)  gave 
one  twin  practice  at  such  activities  as  stair-climbing  and  the  grasping  and 
manipulation  of  cubes.  This  twin  did  show  some  skill  superior  to  that  of  the 
other,  but  the  untrained  twin  soon  caught  up,  with  much  less  practice.  And 
he  did  so  at  about  the  age  at  which  we  would  expect  him  to  perform  the  var¬ 
ious  tasks.  Apparently,  then,  there  is  an  inner  timetable  that  determines  the 
readiness  to  do  things,  and  the  benefits  of  early  training  are  relatively  tem¬ 
porary.  The  question  of  early  stimulation  is  controversial,  but  it  does  seem  that 
our  efforts  to  speed  up  early  motor  development  produce  only  small  effects 
(De  Hart,  Sroufe,  &  Cooper,  2004,  p.  145;  Zelazo,  Zelazo,  &  Kolb,  1972). 

Maturation,  then,  refers  to  the  process  by  which  development  is  gov¬ 
erned  by  intrinsic  factors — principally  the  genes,  which  are  chemical  sub¬ 
stances  contained  within  the  nucleus  of  each  cell  (see  Figure  1).  The  genes 
determine  the  sequence,  timing,  and  form  of  emerging  action-patterns. 

However,  the  mechanisms  by  which  the  genes  work  are  complex.  Even 
today,  not  everything  is  completely  understood.  We  know  that  the  genes  do 
not  work  in  isolation  from  one  another,  and  they  respond  to  outside  signals. 
Some  signals  come  from  other  parts  of  the  nucleus  and  from  the  cell's  cyto¬ 
plasm  (see  Figure  1).  Other  signals  come  from  outside  the  cell  (Campbell  & 
Reece,  2005,  pp.  362, 420).  So  even  when  describing  the  action  of  the  gene,  we 
must  consider  its  external  environment.  Nevertheless,  we  can  still  think  of 


Figure  1 

A  group  of  cells.  The  nucleus  contains 
chromosomes,  which  contain  genes. 


24 


Gesell's  Maturational  Theory 


maturation  as  the  process  by  which  the  genes  direct  development,  albeit  in 
conjunction  with  environmental  factors. 

So  far,  I  have  primarily  been  illustrating  maturational  growth  with  early 
motor  behavior,  which  was  Gesell's  main  scientific  focus.  However,  Gesell 
believed  that  maturation  governs  the  growth  of  the  entire  personality.  He  said, 
for  example, 

[The  child's]  nervous  system  matures  by  stages  and  natural  sequences. 
He  sits  before  he  stands;  he  babbles  before  he  talks;  he  fabricates  before 
he  tells  the  truth;  he  draws  a  circle  before  he  draws  a  square;  he  is  self¬ 
ish  before  he  is  altruistic;  he  is  dependent  on  others  before  he  achieves 
dependence  on  self.  All  his  capacities,  including  his  morals,  are  subject 
to  the  laws  of  growth.  (Gesell  &  Ilg,  1943,  p.  11) 


The  Study  of  Patterns 

Gesell  said  that  when  we  study  growth  we  should  not  just  measure  things  in 
quantitative  form  but  should  examine  patterns.  A  pattern  maybe  anything  that 
has  a  definite  shape  or  form — for  example,  an  eyeblink.  But  what  is  most 
important  is  the  patterning  process,  the  process  by  which  actions  become 
organized  (Gesell  &  Ilg,  1943,  pp.  16-17). 

We  find  good  illustrations  of  the  patterning  process  in  the  case  of  babies' 
vision.  At  birth,  babies'  eyes  are  apt  to  rove  around  aimlessly,  but  after  a  few 
days  or  even  hours  babies  are  able  to  stop  their  eyes  and  look  at  objects  for 
brief  periods.  They  can  stop  their  eyes  and  stare  "at  will"  because  a  new  pat¬ 
terned  connection  has  been  made  between  the  nerve  impulses  in  the  brain 
and  the  tiny  muscles  that  move  the  eyes  (pp.  17-18). 

By  the  age  of  1  month,  babies  can  usually  regard  a  ring  that  is  dangled 
before  them  and  then  follow  it  through  an  arc  of  about  90°.  This  ability  implies 
a  new  organization — that  between  the  eye  muscles  and  the  grosser  muscles 
that  rotate  the  head  (p.  19). 

Patterning  continues  to  widen  when  babies  organize  their  eye  move¬ 
ments  with  their  hand  movements,  when  they  look  at  what  they  hold.  By 
4  months,  babies  can  usually  look  at  a  rattle  that  they  have  been  holding.  "This 
is  a  significant  growth  gain.  It  means  that  eyes  and  hands  are  doing  team 
work,  coming  into  more  effective  coordination.  Mental  growth  cannot  be  mea¬ 
sured  in  inches  and  pounds.  So  it  is  appraised  by  patterns"  (p.  19). 

Still,  hand-eye  coordination  is  by  no  means  complete  at  4  months.  For 
some  time,  the  eyes  will  be  in  the  lead.  At  4  months,  for  example,  babies  can 
often  "pick  up"  a  1-inch  cube  or  even  a  small  candy  pellet  with  their  eyes; 
that  is,  they  can  focus  intently  on  the  cube  or  pellet  and  consider  it  from 
slightly  different  angles.  But  they  cannot  yet  grasp  it  with  their  hands.  Babies 
may  be  seen  looking  at  the  cube  and  then  looking  at  their  hands,  as  if  they  have 
an  idea  of  grasping  the  cube,  but  they  simply  cannot  do  it.  The  nervous 


25 


GeselYs  Maturational  Theory 


(a)  Four  months:  (b)  Six  months:  (c)  Ten  months: 

sees  but  cannot  contact.  palmar  grasp.  pincer  grasp 

(index  finger  and  thumb). 

Figure  2 

Developments  in  hand-eye  coordination. 

(From  A.  Gesell,  An  Atlas  of  Infant  Behavior,  Vol.  1 ,  New  Flaven, 

CT:  Yale  University  Press,  1934.  By  permission.) 

system  has  not  yet  sufficiently  grown.  It  is  not  until  6  months  that  babies  are 
usually  able  to  pick  up  the  cube  with  a  crude  palmar  grasp,  and  not  until 
10  months  that  they  can  pick  up  the  cube  or  a  pellet  with  a  pincer  grasp,  with 
opposing  thumb  and  index  finger  (see  Figure  2).  Hand-eye  coordination  devel¬ 
ops  slowly — it  becomes  gradually  more  organized  and  comes  to  include  more 
differentiated  or  refined  movements. 


Other  Principles  of  Development 

Gesell's  observations  suggested  several  other  principles  of  growth.  We  will  con¬ 
sider  three:  reciprocal  interweaving,  functional  asymmetry,  and  self-regulation. 

Reciprocal  Interweaving.  Humans  are  built  on  a  bilateral  basis;  we 
have  two  hemispheres  of  the  brain,  two  eyes,  two  hands,  two  legs,  and  so  on. 
Our  actions,  too,  have  a  dualistic  quality,  as  when  we  either  flex  or  extend  our 
limbs.  Reciprocal  interweaving  refers  to  the  developmental  process  by  which 
two  tendencies  gradually  reach  an  effective  organization.  For  example,  in  the 
development  of  handedness,  the  baby  first  uses  one  hand,  then  both  together 
again,  then  prefers  the  other  hand,  then  both  together  again,  and  so  on,  until 
he  or  she  ultimately  reaches  one-handed  dominance.  This  back-and-forth  qual¬ 
ity  of  preferences  suggests  the  metaphor  of  weaving,  hence  the  term  "recip¬ 
rocal  interweaving."  Gesell  showed  how  reciprocal  interweaving  describes 
the  patterning  of  many  behaviors,  including  visual  behavior  and  crawling 
and  walking  (Gesell,  1946,  pp.  342-349). 

Gesell  also  believed  that  reciprocal  interweaving  characterizes  the 
growth  of  the  personality.  Here,  we  see  the  organism  integrating  introverted 
and  extroverted  tendencies.  For  example,  the  child  who  was  self-composed  at 
age  3  turns  inward  at  3  ^  becoming  timid  and  unsettled.  This  period  of  intro¬ 
version  is  followed  by  a  swing  to  extroversion  at  age  4,  and  the  two  tendencies 


26 


Gesell's  Maturational  Theory 


finally  become  integrated  and  balanced  at  5.  Cycles  such  as  this  begin  in 
infancy  and  continue  at  least  until  age  16.  The  organism  temporarily  loses  its 
equilibrium  as  it  expands  into  new  inner  or  outer  realms,  but  it  then  reorga¬ 
nizes  itself  at  new  levels  (Gesell,  Ilg,  &  Ames,  1956,  pp.  16-20). 

Functional  Asymmetry.  Through  the  process  of  reciprocal  interweav¬ 
ing,  then,  we  balance  the  dualities  of  our  nature.  But  we  rarely  achieve  perfect 
balance  or  symmetry.  In  fact,  a  degree  of  asymmetry  is  highly  functional;  we  are 
most  effective  when  we  confront  the  world  from  an  angle,  favoring  one  hand, 
one  eye,  and  so  on. 

The  infant's  asymmetric  tendency  is  seen  in  the  tonic  neck  reflex,  a  reflex 
Gesell  discovered  in  humans.  Gesell  noted  that  babies  prefer  to  lie  with  their 
heads  turned  to  one  side,  and  when  they  do  so  they  automatically  assume  the 
tonic  neck  reflex  posture.  They  extend  the  arm  on  the  side  to  which  the  head 
is  turned  (as  if  looking  at  the  hand)  and  flex  the  other  arm  behind  the  head. 
The  tonic  neck  reflex  posture  looks  very  much  like  the  basic  stance  of  a  fencer 
(see  Figure  3).  This  reflex  is  dominant  during  the  first  3  months  after  birth 


Figure  3 

The  tonic  neck  reflex. 


27 


Gesell's  Maturational  Theory 


and  then  eclipses,  with  new  developments  in  the  nervous  system  (Gesell, 
1946,  pp.  349-354). 

Self-Regulation.  Gesell  believed  that  intrinsic  developmental  mech¬ 
anisms  are  so  powerful  that  an  organism  can,  to  a  considerable  degree,  regu¬ 
late  its  own  development.  In  one  series  of  studies,  he  showed  how  babies  can 
regulate  their  cycles  of  feeding,  sleep,  and  wakefulness.  When  the  babies  were 
permitted  to  determine  when  they  needed  to  nurse  and  sleep,  they  gradually 
required  fewer  feedings  per  day  and  stayed  awake  for  longer  periods  during 
the  daytime.  Progress  did  not  follow  a  straight  line;  there  were  many  fluctu¬ 
ations,  including  regressions.  But  the  babies  did  gradually  work  out  stable 
schedules  (pp.  358-364). 

Gesell  also  wrote  about  self-regulation  from  a  slightly  different  angle, 
focusing  on  the  organism's  capacity  to  maintain  an  overall  integration  and 
equilibrium.  Growth,  of  course,  also  involves  disequilibrium.  As  we  just  saw, 
infants'  sleeping  and  feeding  patterns  frequently  fluctuate.  We  also  saw  com¬ 
parable  fluctuations  in  the  development  of  the  personality,  where  periods  of 
stability  are  followed  by  periods  of  instability  as  children  enter  new  intro¬ 
verted  or  extroverted  phases.  Tensions  arise  when  children  venture  into  new 
unknowns.  But  self-regulatory  mechanisms  are  always  at  work,  ensuring  that 
the  organism  never  goes  too  far  in  one  direction  before  it  catches  its  balance, 
consolidating  its  gains  before  moving  forward  once  again. 

Because  of  intrinsic  self-regulating  processes,  children  sometimes  resist 
our  efforts  to  teach  them  new  things.  It  is  as  if  something  inside  tells  them  not 
to  learn  too  much  too  soon.  The  integrity  of  the  organism  must  be  preserved. 


Individuality 

We  have  now  reviewed  many  of  Gesell's  ideas  about  growth.  One  general  issue, 
however,  needs  to  be  discussed.  This  is  the  problem  of  individuality.  Gesell 
strongly  believed  in  the  uniqueness  of  each  child.  Unfortunately,  however,  his 
position  was  obscured  by  the  way  in  which  he  summarized  his  findings.  For 
example,  he  wrote  about  the  child  at  ages  2,  2  y2,  3,  and  so  on,  as  if  we  could 
expect  all  children  at  each  age  to  behave  in  exactly  the  same  way.  He  did  warn 
that  he  was  using  age  norms  only  as  shortcut  devices  (Gesell  &  Ilg,  1943, 
pp.  60-61),  but  he  never  indicated  the  actual  amount  of  individual  variation  that 
does  occur  at  each  age,  so  individuality  did  often  become  lost  in  his  writings. 

Gesell's  actual  position,  as  mentioned,  was  that  all  normal  children  go 
through  the  same  sequences,  but  they  vary  in  their  rates  of  growth.  He  also 
suggested  that  growth  rates  might  be  related  to  differences  in  temperament 
and  personality.  In  an  interesting  discussion  (pp.  44-45),  Gesell  presented 
three  hypothetical  children — one  who  grows  slowly,  one  who  grows  rapidly, 
and  one  who  grows  irregularly — and  suggested  how  each  growth  style  might 
show  up  in  a  variety  of  personal  dispositions.  Child  A,  who  grows  slowly. 


28 


Gesell's  Maturational  Theory 


might  be  generally  slow  and  cautious,  able  to  wait,  even-tempered,  and  gen¬ 
erally  wise  about  life's  problems.  Child  B,  who  develops  rapidly,  might  be 
quick-reacting,  blithe  and  happy,  up  and  at  it,  and  generally  bright  and  clever. 
Child  C,  who  develops  irregularly,  might  sometimes  be  overcautious  and 
sometimes  undercautious,  be  moody,  have  trouble  waiting,  and  show  flashes 
of  brilliance.  Gesell  believed  that  each  individual  temperament  and  growth 
style  makes  different  demands  on  the  culture,  and  that  the  culture  should  try 
to  adjust  to  each  child's  uniqueness. 


PHILOSOPHY  OF  CHILD  REARING 

According  to  Gesell,  child  rearing  should  begin  with  a  recognition  of  the  implicit 
wisdom  of  maturational  laws.  Babies  enter  the  world  with  an  inborn  schedule, 
which  is  the  product  of  at  least  3  million  years  of  biological  evolution;  they  are 
preeminently  "wise"  about  their  needs,  and  what  they  are  ready  and  not  ready 
to  do.  Thus  parents  should  not  try  to  force  their  children  into  any  preconceived 
pattern  but  should  take  their  cues  from  the  children  themselves. 

On  the  topic  of  feeding,  for  example,  Gesell  strongly  advocated  demand 
feeding — feeding  when  the  baby  indicates  a  readiness — as  opposed  to  feeding 
by  any  predetermined  schedule.  He  wrote. 

There  are  two  kinds  of  time — organic  time  and  clock  time.  The  former 
is  based  on  the  wisdom  of  the  body,  the  latter  on  astronomical  science 
and  cultural  conventions.  A  self-demand  schedule  takes  its  departure 
from  organic  time.  The  infant  is  fed  when  he  is  hungry;  he  is  allowed  to 
sleep  when  he  is  sleepy;  he  is  not  roused  to  be  fed;  he  is  "changed"  if  he 
fusses  on  being  wet;  he  is  granted  some  social  play  when  he  craves  it.  He 
is  not  made  to  live  by  the  clock  on  the  wall,  but  rather  by  the  internal 
clock  of  his  fluctuating  needs.  (Gesell  &  Ilg,  1943,  p.  51) 

As  parents  suspend  their  ideas  about  what  the  baby  "ought"  to  be 
doing — and  instead  follow  the  baby's  signals  and  cues — they  begin  to  appre¬ 
ciate  the  baby's  inherent  capacity  for  self-regulated  growth.  They  see  how 
the  baby  regulates  her  own  cycles  of  feeding,  sleep,  and  wakefulness.  A  little 
later,  they  see  how  the  baby  learns  to  sit  up,  creep,  and  crawl  on  her  own, 
without  pushing  and  prodding.  Parents  begin  to  trust  the  child  and  the 
growth  process. 

Gesell  emphasized  that  the  first  year  is  the  best  time  for  learning  to 
respect  the  child's  individuality  (p.  57).  Parents  who  are  alertly  responsive  to 
the  child's  needs  during  infancy  will  naturally  be  sensitive  to  the  child's 
unique  interests  and  capacities  later  on.  They  will  be  less  inclined  to  impose 
their  own  expectations  and  ambitions  on  the  child  and  more  inclined  to  give 
the  child's  individuality  a  chance  to  grow  and  find  itself. 


29 


Gesell's  Maturationnl  Theory 


Gesell  believed  that  parents  need,  besides  an  intuitive  sensitivity  to  the 
child,  some  theoretical  knowledge  of  the  trends  and  sequences  of  develop¬ 
ment.  In  particular,  they  need  to  realize  that  development  fluctuates  between 
periods  of  stability  and  instability.  This  knowledge  fosters  patience  and  under¬ 
standing.  For  example,  the  parent  will  be  helped  by  the  knowledge  that 
2  y2-year-olds  go  through  a  troubled  period  during  which  they  can  be  very 
obstinate.  Knowing  this,  the  parent  will  not  feel  an  urgent  need  to  stamp  out 
this  behavior  before  it  is  too  late.  Instead,  the  parent  will  be  able  to  deal  with 
the  child  more  flexibly,  and  perhaps  even  enjoy  this  child  who  so  intently  tries 
to  establish  her  independence  (pp.  197,  296). 

One  of  Gesell's  followers,  Louise  Bates  Ames  (1971),  offered  parents  the 
following  advice: 

1 .  Give  up  the  notion  that  how  your  child  turns  out  is  all  up  to  you  and 
there  isn't  a  minute  to  waste. 

2.  Try  to  appreciate  the  wonder  of  growth.  Observe  and  relish  the  fact  that 
every  week  and  every  month  brings  new  developments. 

3.  Respect  his  immaturity.  Anticipate  the  fact  that  he  will,  in  all  likelihood, 
need  to  creep  before  he  walks,  express  himself  with  single  words  before 
he  talks  in  sentences,  and  say  "No"  before  he  says  "Yes." 

4.  Try  to  avoid  thinking  always  in  terms  of  what  comes  next.  Enjoy,  and  let 
your  child  enjoy  each  stage  he  reaches  before  he  travels  on  (pp.  108, 125). 

So  far,  Gesell's  philosophy  sounds  like  one  of  extreme  indulgence  and 
permissiveness.  One  might  ask,  "Doesn't  this  attitude  lead  to  spoiling?" 
"Won't  children  start  becoming  bossy,  always  wanting  their  own  way?" 

Gesell's  answer  was  that,  of  course,  children  must  learn  to  control  their 
impulses  and  get  along  with  the  demands  of  their  culture.  However,  he 
argued  that  children  best  learn  to  do  this  when  we  pay  attention  to  their  own 
maturing  ability  to  tolerate  controls.  For  example,  with  respect  to  feedings, 
the  baby  at  first  should  not  be  made  to  wait  too  long.  "The  most  vital  crav¬ 
ings  of  the  infant  have  to  do  with  food  and  sleep.  These  cravings  have  an 
individual,  organic  nature.  They  cannot  be  transformed  or  transgressed" 
(Gesell  &  Ilg,  1943,  p.  56).  But  a  little  later — by  4  months  or  so — the  baby's 
gastrointestinal  tract  no  longer  dominates  life  as  it  did  before,  and  the  baby's 
less  intense  and  less  frequent  cries  tell  the  parent  that  she  is  now  able  to 
wait  for  feedings. 

Later  on,  developments  in  language  and  an  increased  time  perspective 
help  children  delay  immediate  gratification.  At  2  ly  years,  they  do  not  need 
their  juice  immediately  because  they  understand  when  the  parent  says,  "Pretty 
soon."  At  3  they  may  understand,  "When  it's  time."  And  by  4,  they  want  to 
help  prepare  the  meals  themselves.  The  culture,  then,  can  ease  children  into 
its  fabric  by  gearing  itself  to  children's  own  maturing  readiness  to  tolerate 
controls  (p.  54). 


30 


Gesell's  Maturational  Theory 


Thus  Gesell  believed  that  alert  caretakers  can  achieve  a  reasonable  bal¬ 
ance  between  maturational  forces  and  enculturation.  But  it  is  clear  that  Gesell 
wanted  the  culture  to  do  most  of  the  adjusting.  Enculturation,  he  said,  is  nec¬ 
essary,  but  our  first  goal  should  not  be  to  fit  the  child  into  the  social  mold. 
This  is  the  aim  of  authoritarian  regimes.  In  democracies  we  prize  autonomy 
and  individuality,  qualities  that  have  their  deepest  roots  in  the  biological 
impulse  toward  optimal  growth  (p.  10). 

Enculturation  takes  place  in  the  school  as  well  as  in  the  home.  Schools 
teach  children  the  skills  and  habits  they  will  need  as  adult  members  of  soci¬ 
ety.  But  teachers,  like  parents,  should  not  think  so  exclusively  in  terms  of  cul¬ 
tural  goals  that  they  overlook  the  manner  in  which  the  child  grows.  For 
example,  although  our  culture  values  accurate  work,  teachers  need  to  recog¬ 
nize  that  children  are  naturally  less  precise  at  one  age  than  another.  Vigorous, 
unstable  6-year-olds  are  error  prone,  whereas  more  stable  7-year-olds  readily 
take  to  drills  and  perfectionistic  work.  Accordingly,  the  developmentally 
minded  teacher  will  not  force  6-year-olds  to  learn  in  a  way  that  runs  counter 
to  their  nature,  but  will  save  drills  for  the  time  when  the  child  benefits  from 
them  (Gesell  &  Ilg,  1946,  pp.  374-381). 

At  the  same  time,  it  is  not  enough  to  adjust  techniques  to  each  age  or 
grade;  for  children  also  vary  widely  in  their  growth  rates,  as  well  as  in  their 
special  talents.  Accordingly,  teachers  need  to  gear  their  work  to  the  individ¬ 
ual  child's  state  of  readiness  and  special  abilities.  At  present,  most  schools  do 
not  do  this.  They  overemphasize  uniform  achievement  standards,  such  as 
grade-level  reading  scores,  thereby  ignoring  children's  need  to  grow  accord¬ 
ing  to  their  own  timing  and  to  develop  their  unique  potentials.  Schools,  of 
course,  do  need  to  teach  standard  cultural  skills,  but  in  a  democracy  their  first 
task  is  to  help  children  develop  their  full  personalities.  To  do  this,  they  must 
let  children  guide  them,  just  as  children  themselves  are  guided  by  a  biologi¬ 
cal  ground  plan  for  optimal  growth  (pp.  388-392). 


EVALUATION 

In  Gesell's  hands,  Rousseau's  idea  of  an  inner  developmental  force  became 
the  guiding  principle  behind  extensive  scholarship  and  research.  Gesell 
showed  how  the  maturational  mechanism,  while  still  hidden,  manifests  itself 
in  intricate  developmental  sequences  and  self-regulatory  processes.  Gesell 
indicated  that  there  are  good  reasons  to  suppose  that  development  follows 
an  inner  plan. 

Nevertheless,  most  contemporary  psychologists  would  consider  Gesell's 
maturational  position  too  extreme.  Most  psychologists  acknowledge  the  role 
of  maturation  but  nevertheless  believe  teaching  and  learning  are  much  more 
important  than  Gesell  claimed.  They  believe  the  environment  does  more  than 
merely  support  inner  patterning;  it  also  structures  behavior.  For  example. 


31 


Gesell's  Maturational  Theory 


although  children  cannot  learn  to  throw  a  ball  or  play  a  piano  before  attain¬ 
ing  some  level  of  neuromotor  maturation,  they  also  acquire  such  behavior 
patterns  through  teaching  and  reinforcement.  Still,  it  is  largely  because  of 
Gesell's  work  that  even  the  most  ardent  learning  theorists  take  some  notice 
of  inner  maturational  processes. 

The  most  frequently  voiced  criticisms  of  Gesell  center  on  his  manner  of 
presenting  age  norms.  As  mentioned,  his  norms  imply  too  much  uniformity 
and  give  us  no  idea  of  how  much  variation  to  expect  at  any  given  age.  More¬ 
over,  Gesell's  norms  were  based  on  middle-class  children  in  a  university 
setting  (Yale)  and  may  not  apply  perfectly  in  other  cultural  contexts. 

In  recent  years,  Gesell's  age  norms  have  been  challenged  by  research 
focusing  on  newborns  (babies  under  1  month  of  age).  Newborns,  it  now  seems, 
have  many  surprising  capacities.  Under  the  right  conditions,  they  can  visually 
follow  moving  objects  for  short  distances,  can  reach  for  objects,  and  can  dis¬ 
criminate  among  shapes,  colors,  sounds,  tastes,  and  odors.  They  can  imitate 
movements  such  as  tongue-protrusions  and  they  exhibit  a  walking  reflex 
(Fogel,  2009,  pp.  247-249, 221;  McFarlane,  1981).  In  light  of  such  findings,  the 
developmental  picture  provided  by  Gesell  seems  too  slow.  Newborns  now 
appear  to  be  "a  lot  smarter"  than  anyone  thought,  and  researchers  are  find¬ 
ing  remarkable  qualities  of  babies'  minds  in  the  following  few  months  as  well 
(Lipsitt,  1971;  Siegler  &  Alibali,  2005,  p.  180).  Indeed,  researchers  sometimes 
make  it  sound  as  if  babies  are  so  advanced  that  they  are  really  little  adults,  as 
the  preformationists  said. 

These  new  findings  are  important,  but  they  must  be  viewed  with  cau¬ 
tion.  In  the  first  place,  many  of  the  newborn's  advanced  competencies, 
including  visual  following  and  hand-reaching,  are  very  fragile  and  diffi¬ 
cult  to  elicit.  Experimenters  must  sometimes  wait  for  hours  and  even  days 
for  babies  to  demonstrate  them  (Als,  1978;  Bower,  1982,  p.  169;  Fogel,  2009, 
p.  227;  MacFarlane,  1981). 

Furthermore,  some  precocious  abilities,  including  reflexive  walking, 
reaching,  and  imitation,  ordinarily  disappear  after  a  month  or  two.  Some  of 
these,  to  be  sure,  may  be  maintained  by  exercise  (Bower,  1982),  but  they  ordi¬ 
narily  seem  to  drop  out  as  behavior  comes  under  the  control  of  higher  corti¬ 
cal  centers.  Then,  when  they  do  reappear,  they  have  a  much  more  voluntary 
appearance  (Hofer,  1981,  pp.  120-123).  Thus  some  of  the  early,  precocious 
capacities  are  only  temporary.  Perhaps  they  are  vestiges  of  our  evolutionary 
past,  of  a  time  when  we  developed  much  more  rapidly  than  we  now  do. 

In  any  case,  the  new  research  on  newborns  at  most  supplements,  rather 
than  directly  contradicts,  the  developmental  picture  Gesell  provided.  Con¬ 
temporary  pediatricians  and  infant  specialists  still  consider  Gesell's  norms  of 
great  value,  using  them  to  help  determine  what  babies  should  be  able  to  do 
at  various  ages. 

Gesell  also  provided  a  coherent  philosophy  of  child  rearing.  We  should 
not,  he  said,  try  to  force  children  into  our  predetermined  designs,  but  should 


32 


Gesell's  Maturational  Theory 


follow  their  cues  as  they  express  basic  biological  forces  of  growth.  The  research 
findings  bearing  on  Gesell's  position  have  often  been  ambiguous  (Caldwell, 
1964),  but  some  interesting  studies  do  support  him  (Appleton,  Clifton  & 
Goldberg,  1975).  In  a  particularly  impressive  study.  Bell  and  Ainsworth  (1972) 
asked  what  happens  when  parents  respond  promptly  to  their  babies'  cries 
(rather  than  acting  on  their  own  ideas  about  when  it  is  all  right  for  them  to  cry). 
The  clear  finding  was  that  responsiveness  does  not  lead  to  spoiling.  On  the 
contrary,  by  the  age  of  1  year  these  babies,  in  comparison  to  babies  of  less 
responsive  parents,  cried  less  and  were  more  independent.  They  enjoyed  being 
held,  but  if  the  mother  put  them  down  they  did  not  cry  or  protest  but  happily 
ventured  off  into  exploratory  play.  They  might  check  back  on  the  mother's 
presence  from  time  to  time,  as  is  natural  at  this  age,  but  they  were  basically 
quite  independent.  Apparently,  then,  when  babies'  signals  are  heeded,  they 
become  confident  that  they  can  always  get  help  when  needed  and  therefore 
can  relax  and  venture  forth  on  their  own. 

There  also  is  some  evidence,  though  only  impressionistic  and  anecdo¬ 
tal,  that  things  can  go  very  wrong  when  Gesell's  principles  are  excessively 
violated.  This  evidence  comes  from  the  study  of  schizophrenic  patients, 
whose  childhood  experiences  often  seem  precisely  the  opposite  of  those  that 
Gesell  recommended.  These  patients  seem  to  have  felt,  as  children,  that  their 
own  natural  impulses  and  desires  counted  for  little,  or  threatened  others, 
and  that  they  were  forced  to  fulfill  others'  predetermined  images  and  expec¬ 
tations  (Laing,  1965;  R.  White,  1963).  I  would  like  to  illustrate  the  point  with 
a  brief  description  of  a  9-year-old  boy  whom  I  saw  for  a  psychological  eval¬ 
uation.  The  boy  found  life  very  frightening  and  probably  was  on  the  verge 
of  psychosis.  The  parents  had  not  wanted  a  child — they  were  in  their  40s  and 
the  mother  had  a  number  of  physical  ailments  that  made  it  taxing  for  her  to 
care  for  him.  Consequently,  she  wanted  a  good,  well-disciplined  boy — an 
adult,  really — who  would  cause  her  no  trouble.  She  tried  to  toilet- train  him 
at  6  months  of  age,  long  before  he  showed  any  readiness  to  participate  in  the 
process.  And  when  he  began  walking  and  vigorously  exploring  the  world  at 
1  year,  she  became  distressed;  he  was  becoming  a  nuisance  and  "getting  into 
things."  She  even  perceived  his  behavior  as  abnormal.  Because  of  her  cir¬ 
cumstances,  then,  she  practically  reversed  Gesell's  advice:  She  had  a  fixed 
image  of  the  good  child  she  wanted  and  was  unable  to  accept  and  follow  her 
son's  natural  inclinations.  As  a  result,  the  boy  developed  an  intense  fear  that 
any  action  he  might  take,  unless  approved  by  his  parents  beforehand,  was 
extremely  dangerous.  He  did  not  trust  himself  or  his  natural  impulses. 

There  is  some  evidence,  then,  in  support  of  Gesell's  position — that  it  is 
desirable  to  respond  to  children's  cues  and  inclinations  as  they  follow  an  inner, 
biological  schedule.  But  there  also  is  evidence  that  might  argue  partly  against 
Gesell.  In  particular,  research  by  Baumrind  (1967,  1989)  suggests  that  inde¬ 
pendent,  self-reliant,  and  mature  children  have  parents  who  demand  a  great 
deal  of  them.  Baumrind  thinks  these  parents  set  tasks  that  are  within  their 


33 


Gesell's  Maturationnl  Theory 


children's  abilities,  and  to  this  extent  the  parents  follow  Gesell's  recommen¬ 
dations.  But  these  parents  also  seem  more  demanding  and  controlling  than 
Gesell  might  have  thought  necessary. 

Perhaps  philosophies  such  as  Gesell's  will  never  be  completely  proven 
or  refuted  by  empirical  evidence  alone;  too  much  may  depend  on  one's 
own  values.  All  the  same,  it  would  seem  that  we  have  much  to  gain  by  lis¬ 
tening  to  Gesell.  Although  it  is  true  that  we  must  control,  direct,  and  instruct 
our  children  to  some  extent,  we  usually  seem  to  be  in  quite  a  hurry  to  do 
these  things.  What  seems  more  difficult  for  us  is  to  take  the  time  to  watch, 
enjoy,  and  appreciate  our  children  as  we  give  them  a  chance  to  do  their 
own  growing. 


34 


Ethological  Theories: 
Darwin,  Lorenz 
and  Tinbergen,  and 
Bowlby  and  Ainsworth 


Ethology  is  the  study  of  animal  and  human  behavior  within  an 
evolutionary  context  (Lorenz,  1981,  p.  1).  The  person  most  identified 
with  modern  evolutionary  theory  is  Darwin. 


DARWIN  AND  THE  THEORY 
OF  EVOLUTION 

Biographical  Introduction 

Charles  Darwin  (1809-1882)  was  born  into  a  distinguished  English 
family.  His  grandfather,  Erasmus  Darwin,  was  a  renowned  physician, 
poet,  and  philosopher,  and  his  father  also  was  a  prominent  physi¬ 
cian.  Young  Darwin,  in  contrast,  seemed  headed  for  no  great  heights. 
As  his  father  once  said,  "You  care  for  nothing  but  shooting,  dogs,  and 
rat-catching,  and  you  will  be  a  disgrace  to  yourself  and  your  family" 
(Darwin,  1887,  p.  28). 

Darwin  studied  medicine  for  a  while,  and  then  began  studying  for 
the  Anglican  clergy  at  Cambridge,  but  he  was  generally  bored  and  his 
grades  were  uneven.  Still,  he  made  a  favorable  impression  on  some  of 
his  professors  at  Cambridge,  especially  those  who  shared  his  fascina¬ 
tion  with  nature  and  wildlife.  One  professor,  John  Henslow,  recom¬ 
mended  Darwin  for  the  position  of  naturalist  on  the  worldwide  voyage 
of  the  H.M.S.  Beagle,  the  voyage  on  which  Darwin  made  observations 
that  eventually  led  to  his  theory  of  evolution. 


From  Theories  of  Development:  Concepts  and  Applications,  Sixth  Edition.  William 
Crain.  Copyright  ©  2011  by  Pearson  Education,  Inc.  Published  by  Pearson 
Prentice  Hall.  All  rights  reserved. 


35 


Ethological  Theories 


of  speed  and  strength  will  become  increasingly  prevalent  in  the  population 
of  the  species. 

Evolution  usually  seems  to  occur  extremely  slowly  revealing  noticeable 
changes  only  after  numerous  generations.  Consequently  we  do  not  usually 
get  a  chance  to  see  evolution  at  work  in  any  simple  way.  However,  biologists 
did  have  such  an  opportunity  in  England  in  the  mid-1800s.  In  Manchester, 
there  were  numerous  white  moths  that  blended  in  well  with  the  white  trees 
in  the  area,  making  it  difficult  for  birds  to  spot  and  kill  them.  Among  the 
moths,  there  were  a  small  number  of  dark  ones  (the  products  of  mutations), 
who  were  easily  detected  by  the  predators.  Consequently,  only  a  few  dark 
moths  lived  and  reproduced.  But  when  industrialization  took  place,  coal 
smoke  darkened  the  trees,  making  the  white  moths  easy  prey.  Now  the  dark 
ones  had  the  best  chance  of  surviving  long  enough  to  reproduce,  and  over 
the  next  50  years  their  number  increased  from  less  than  1%  to  99%  (Ehrlich 
&  Holm,  1963,  pp.  126-130). 


The  Case  of  Humans 

In  The  Origin  of  Species  (1859),  Darwin  discussed  evolution  but  barely  men¬ 
tioned  the  evolution  of  humans.  The  topic  was  too  incendiary.  He  waited  to 
address  it  in  a  book  he  published  12  years  later.  The  Descent  of  Man  (the  first 
edition  was  published  in  1871;  the  second  edition  in  1874).  In  that  book  he 
firmly  argued  that  our  species  is  not  separate  from  others — not  the  act  of  a  spe¬ 
cial  creation,  as  almost  everyone  believed.  Rather,  humans  and  other  species 
descended  from  common  ancestors.  Long  ago,  Darwin  speculated,  humans 
and  apes  branched  off  from  a  common  ape-like  animal.  At  an  even  more  dis¬ 
tant  time,  humans  and  other  mammals  probably  evolved  from  an  amphib¬ 
ian,  and  before  that,  from  aquatic  life  forms.  Sharing  common  ancestors,  we 
and  other  living  species  are  all  related.  We  are  part  of  one  extended  family. 
There  are,  of  course,  differences  among  species.  But  if  we  look  with  an  open 
mind,  we  see  similarities  between  ourselves  and  other  species — similarities 
that  bear  the  stamp  of  our  common  heritage  (1874,  pp.  160,  629-632). 

We  see,  for  example,  that  we  are  like  other  animals  on  the  physical 
level.  Our  bones  are  similar  to  those  of  animals  as  diverse  as  monkeys,  bats, 
and  seals,  and  "so  it  is  with  our  muscles,  nerves,  blood  vesicles,  and  inter¬ 
nal  viscera"  (p.  6). 

Darwin  also  observed  that  early  human  embryos  are  highly  similar  to 
the  embryos  of  other  animals.  This  fact,  too,  suggests  common  ancestry  (p.  25). 
The  strongest  argument  of  this  kind  was  made  by  Ernst  Haeckel,  who,  in  the 
late  1860s,  proposed  that  ontogeny  recapitulates  phytogeny.  That  is,  the  develop¬ 
ment  of  an  individual  organism  (ontogeny)  repeats  in  an  abbreviated  way  the 
evolutionary  history  of  its  species  (phylogeny).  The  human  embryo  goes 
through  phases  when  it  looks  like  a  fish,  then  an  amphibian,  and  so  on,  reca¬ 
pitulating  the  ancient  evolutionary  history  of  our  species.  This  proposition  has 


37 


Ethological  Theories 


As  Darwin  examined  fossils  and  variations  among  living  species,  he 
concluded  that  the  various  species  had  a  common  ancestor,  and  newer  species 
either  had  died  out  or  had  changed  to  meet  the  requirements  of  their  chang¬ 
ing  environments.  If  this  conclusion  were  correct,  then  the  common  theolog¬ 
ical  view  on  the  origin  of  the  species  must  be  wrong;  the  species  had  not  been 
created  in  a  fixed  and  perfect  form,  but  had  evolved.  Although  the  idea  of 
evolution  had  been  expressed  before,  its  plausibility  deeply  distressed  Darwin. 
It  caused  religious  doubts  in  his  mind  and  he  knew  it  would  shock  others 
(Gruber,  1981).  He  wrote  to  a  friend  that  it  was  "like  confessing  a  murder" 
(Murphy,  2007). 

Darwin  wanted  to  make  sure  the  evidence  supported  his  theory,  and  he 
didn't  publish  it  until  17  years  after  he  first  sketched  it  out  on  paper  (Carroll, 
2009,  p.  43).  In  fact,  he  wouldn't  have  published  it  then  had  he  not  learned  that 
Alfred  Wallace  was  going  to  publish  a  similar  theory.  Since  the  theory  was 
going  to  be  made  public  anyway,  Darwin  wanted  partial  credit  for  it.  Upon  the 
recommendation  of  their  colleagues,  Darwin  and  Wallace  presented  their  the¬ 
ory  in  1858  under  joint  authorship.  A  year  later,  Darwin  published  his  great 
work.  The  Origin  of  Species.  Darwin  continued  developing  his  theory  the  rest 
of  his  life,  and,  despite  the  bitter  reactions  it  produced,  he  became  widely  rec¬ 
ognized  for  his  monumental  achievements.  When  Darwin  died,  he  was  buried 
in  Westminster  Abbey,  next  to  Isaac  Newton. 


The  Theory  of  Natural  Selection 

As  mentioned,  Darwin  was  not  the  first  to  propose  a  theory  of  evolution. 
In  Darwin's  day,  biologists  had  been  debating  the  views  of  Jean  Baptiste 
Lamarck,  who  proposed  that  evolution  occurred  through  the  inheritance  of 
acquired  characteristics.  For  example,  giraffes  stretched  their  necks  to  reach 
the  leaves  on  high  trees  and  then  passed  along  their  lengthened  necks  to  the 
next  generation.  Lamarck's  theory,  however,  turned  out  to  be  wrong. 

In  the  Darwin- Wallace  theory,  no  new  characteristics  need  be  acquired 
during  an  individual's  lifetime.  In  essence,  Darwin's  theory  is  as  follows. 
Among  the  members  of  a  species,  there  is  endless  variation;  and  among  the 
various  members,  only  a  fraction  of  those  who  are  born  survive  to  reproduce. 
There  is  a  "struggle  for  existence"  during  which  the  fittest  members  of  a 
species  live  long  enough  to  transmit  their  characteristics  to  the  next  genera¬ 
tion.  Over  countless  generations,  then,  nature  "selects"  those  who  can  best 
adapt  to  their  surroundings — hence  the  term  natural  selection  (Darwin,  1859, 
chaps.  3  and  4). 

Darwin  asked  us  to  consider,  for  example,  the  situation  of  wolves  (p.  70). 
During  seasons  when  prey  is  scarce,  the  swiftest  and  strongest  wolves  have 
the  best  chances  for  survival.  They  are  therefore  more  likely  than  the  others 
to  live  long  enough  to  reproduce  and  pass  on  their  traits — today  we  would 
say  their  genes — to  the  next  generation.  After  many  such  seasons,  the  traits 


36 


Ethological  Theories 


raised  considerable  skepticism,  and  it  would  be  wrong  to  say  that  the  human 
embryo  ever  resembles  the  adult  forms  of  other  species.  However,  it  does  re¬ 
semble  the  early  forms  (Thain  &  Hickman,  1994,  p.  67). 

Darwin  also  discussed  how  some  physical  structures  he  called  "rudi¬ 
ments,"  such  as  our  tailbone,  reveal  our  descent  from  earlier  forms  (1874, 
p.  23).  But  Darwin's  most  innovative  proposal  was  that  evolutionary  conti¬ 
nuity  is  seen  in  the  behavioral  realm,  in  the  areas  of  reason  and  emotion.  He 
challenged  the  long-held  Western  view  that  reason  and  emotion  are  exclusive 
to  our  species. 

Darwin  recognized  that  humans  developed  rational  thought  to  a  higher 
degree  than  other  species.  Because  our  species  is  physically  weaker  and 
slower  than  many  others,  we  had  to  rely  on  intelligence  and  inventions 
(including  tools)  to  survive  (1874,  p.  65).  But  humans  didn't  develop  intel¬ 
lectual  powers  out  of  the  blue.  These  capacities  emerged  gradually,  in  the 
course  of  our  evolutionary  past,  and  intelligence  is  evident  in  the  many  ani¬ 
mals  who  share  our  ancestry. 

Darwin  told,  for  example,  about  a  bear  in  captivity  who  could  not  reach  a 
piece  of  bread  floating  in  some  water.  So  the  bear  dug  a  ditch  to  the  water,  which 
resulted  in  the  bread  sailing  down  the  ditch  to  him  (p.  79).  This  certainly  required 
creative  thinking.  Darwin  said  the  more  that  naturalists  study  the  behavior  of  any 
particular  animal,  the  more  intelligent  they  find  the  animal  to  be  (p.  77). 

Other  species  also  share  our  capacity  for  rich  emotional  lives.  Many  ani¬ 
mals,  for  example,  express  joy,  which  is  most  apparent  when  the  young  mem¬ 
bers  of  other  species,  such  as  puppies,  kittens,  and  lambs,  are  at  play.  Like 
human  children,  they  happily  frolic  about  (1874,  p.  70). 

Darwin  was  especially  interested  in  the  moral  emotions,  the  concern  for 
others.  He  recognized  that  human  morality  differs  from  that  of  other  animals.  We 
bring  greater  intellect  to  moral  issues  and  reflect  more  on  them  (1874,  p.  115). 
But  Darwin  suggested  that  many  animals  have  developed  the  fundamentals  of 
morality,  the  building  blocks  on  which  human  morality  was  built. 

The  members  of  many  species  want  their  companions  near  them,  send 
out  warning  calls  in  times  of  danger,  and  sometimes  come  to  one  another's  aid. 
To  illustrate,  Darwin  (1874,  p.  104)  told  the  story  of  a  troop  of  baboons  mov¬ 
ing  through  a  valley  and  up  a  hill.  While  some  of  the  baboons  were  still  in 
the  valley,  a  pack  of  dogs  attacked.  Hearing  the  attack,  some  of  the  older  males 
came  down  from  the  hill  and  roared  so  ferociously  that  the  dogs  drew  back. 
By  the  time  the  dogs  resumed  their  attack,  all  the  baboons  had  climbed  out  of 
danger — except  for  one.  This  6-month-old  baboon  was  still  below  and  called 
loudly  for  help.  He  was  surrounded  by  the  dogs.  "Now  one  of  the  largest 
males,  a  true  hero,  came  down  again  from  the  mountain,  slowly  went  to  the 
young  one,  coaxed  him,  and  triumphantly  led  him  away — the  dogs  being  too 
much  astonished  to  make  an  attack"  (Darwin,  1874,  p.  104). 

Darwin's  emphasis  on  mutual  aid  and  altruism  has  puzzled  scholars 
because  he  also  wrote  about  the  "struggle  for  existence"  which  includes 


38 


Ethological  Theories 


competition  among  individuals  within  a  species  (1859,  chap.  3).  For  example, 
male  deer  engage  in  combat  in  the  spring  (1874,  p.  531).  These  battles  ensure 
that  the  strongest  males,  rather  than  the  frail  ones,  transmit  their  characteris¬ 
tics  to  the  next  generation.  But  Darwin  also  believed  in  the  importance  of 
helpful  behavior  for  group  survival.  Those  groups  of  animals  (including 
humans)  who  banded  together  and  looked  out  for  one  another  must  have  had 
a  better  chance  of  surviving  (1874,  pp.  124, 137). 

In  summary,  Darwin  emphasized  the  continuities  between  our  species 
and  other  species,  in  both  physical  characteristics  as  well  as  cognitive  and  emo¬ 
tional  characteristics.  He  did  not  suggest  that  animals  share  all  our  emotions,  and 
certainly  not  all  our  cognitive  powers,  but  he  did  say  that  no  sharp  line  sepa¬ 
rates  the  minds  of  humans  from  other  animals.  After  two  lengthy  chapters  on 
this  topic  in  The  Descent  of  Man  (1874),  Darwin  concluded  that  the  "various  emo¬ 
tions  and  faculties  ...  of  which  man  boasts  may  be  found  in  incipient,  or  even 
sometimes  in  well-developed  form  in  the  lower  animals"  (p.  130). 


Evaluation 

Contemporary  biologists  generally  consider  Darwin's  theory  to  be  correct  in  its 
broad  outline.  Biologists  agree  with  Darwin  that  there  is  enormous  variation 
within  species,  and  that  species  change  because  only  some  members  survive 
long  enough  to  reproduce  and  pass  their  traits  on.  But  Darwin  didn't  under¬ 
stand  the  mechanisms  underlying  variation  and  the  transmission  of  traits.  It  was 
only  after  the  work  of  Gregor  Mendel  and  others  that  we  began  to  understand 
how  these  activities  are  performed  by  the  genes.  In  other  ways,  Darwin  was  far 
ahead  of  his  time.  His  thoughts  on  group  selection,  for  example,  have  only 
recently  received  serious  consideration  from  eminent  biologists  (Wade,  2009). 

Darwin  believed,  as  we  have  seen,  that  natural  selection  applies  not  only 
to  physical  characteristics  (such  as  coloring)  but  also  to  various  kinds  of 
behavior.  Thus  Darwin  opened  the  way  to  ethology — the  field  in  biology 
that  studies  animal  behavior  from  an  evolutionary  perspective.  We  will  now 
review  some  of  the  ideas  of  modern  ethologists  and  then  look  at  the  applica¬ 
tions  of  these  ideas  to  the  study  of  human  development. 


MODERN  ETHOLOGY:  LORENZ 
AND  TINBERGEN 

Biographical  Introduction 

Konrad  Lorenz  (1903-1989)  is  often  called  the  father  of  modern  ethology.  He 
did  not  necessarily  make  more  discoveries  than  other  ethologists,  but  his 
bold,  vivid,  and  often  humorous  writing  style  did  much  to  call  attention  to 
this  new  field. 


39 


Ethological  Theories 


Lorenz  was  born  and  raised  in  Austria.  His  father  was  a  prominent 
physician  who  wanted  Lorenz  to  become  a  doctor  too,  so  Lorenz  dutifully 
earned  a  medical  degree.  However,  he  never  lost  his  boyhood  enthusiasm  for 
the  study  of  nature  and  wildlife,  and  he  next  studied  zoology  at  the  Univer¬ 
sity  of  Vienna,  earning  a  Ph.D.  in  this  field.  Lorenz  began  his  studies  in  ethol¬ 
ogy  in  the  early  1930s,  when  he  became  convinced  that  one  can  see  the 
landmarks  of  evolution  in  the  innate  behavior  patterns  of  animals  just  as  surely 
as  in  their  physical  characteristics  (Lorenz,  1981,  p.  101).  He  made  many  of  his 
observations  on  his  own  large  Austrian  estate,  where  numerous  species  of 
wild  animals  freely  roamed. 

Niko  Tinbergen  (1907-1988)  worked  quietly  in  Lorenz's  shadow. 
Despite  this,  ethologists  consider  his  work  equally  substantial.  Tinbergen 
was  born  in  the  Hague,  the  Netherlands,  and  like  Lorenz  was  fascinated  by 
animals  and  wildlife  as  a  boy.  In  school,  Tinbergen's  work  was  erratic;  he  did 
well  only  in  subjects  that  interested  him,  and  he  struck  many  of  his  teach¬ 
ers  as  a  lazy  youngster  whose  primary  enthusiasm  was  for  sports.  Never¬ 
theless,  Tinbergen  went  on  to  earn  a  Ph.D.  in  biology  at  the  University  of 
Leiden  in  1932  and  began  doing  brilliant  ethological  studies.  His  research 
was  interrupted  during  World  War  II  when  the  Germans  put  him  in  a  prison 
camp  for  protesting  the  dismissal  of  Jewish  professors  at  the  university. 
During  his  imprisonment,  Tinbergen  wrote  on  ethology  as  well  as  writing 
stories  for  children.  After  the  war  he  became  a  professor  at  Oxford.  In  1973 
Tinbergen  and  Lorenz,  along  with  a  third  eminent  ethologist,  Karl  Von 
Frisch,  won  the  Nobel  Prize  in  physiology  and  medicine  (Baerends,  Beer,  & 
Manning,  1975). 


Methodological  Approach 

Ethologists  are  convinced  that  we  can  understand  an  animal's  behavior 
only  if  we  study  the  animal  in  his  or  her  natural  setting.  Only  in  this  way 
can  we  watch  an  animal's  behavior  patterns  unfold  and  see  how  they  serve 
in  the  adaptation  of  the  species.  We  cannot,  for  example,  understand  why 
birds  build  nests  where  they  do  unless  we  see  how  such  behavior  protects 
the  species  from  predators  in  the  natural  environment.  Psychologists  who 
only  study  animals  in  their  laboratories  miss  out  on  a  great  deal.  In  such 
captive  situations,  many  species  do  not  even  reproduce,  and  one  frequently 
has  no  opportunity  to  observe  their  nesting,  mating,  territorial,  or  parental 
behavior. 

When  ethologists  study  a  new  species,  their  first  step  is  simply  to  get  to 
know  the  species  as  well  as  possible.  That  is,  the  ethologist  engages  in 
naturalistic  observation;  the  ethologist  observes  an  animal's  characteristic  behav¬ 
ior  and  then  compares  the  behavior  with  that  of  other  species.  Only  after  ethol¬ 
ogists  have  gathered  a  great  deal  of  descriptive  material  do  they  attempt 
experiments  to  test  their  ideas  or  try  to  formulate  general  laws. 


40 


Ethological  Theories 


Instinctive  Behavior 

Ethologists  are  interested  in  instincts.  In  everyday  language,  we  casually  refer 
to  any  unlearned  behavior  as  "instinctive"  or  as  an  "instinct,"  but  ethologists 
consider  instincts  as  a  special  class  of  unlearned  behavior. 

An  instinct,  in  the  first  place,  is  released  by  a  specific  external  stimulus.  This 
is  the  case,  for  example,  in  the  rescuing  behavior  of  the  chicken.  The  hen 
appears  to  respond  any  time  her  chicks  are  in  danger,  but  a  closer  examina¬ 
tion  reveals  that  she  is  actually  reacting  to  a  very  specific  stimulus — the  chicks' 
distress  call.  This  point  has  been  demonstrated  in  an  experiment  by  Bruckner 
(cited  in  Tinbergen,  1951,  p.  34).  When  chicks  were  tied  to  a  post  and  hidden 
behind  a  screen,  the  mother  still  rescued  them  because  she  heard  the  distress 
calls.  When,  however,  the  screen  was  removed  and  the  struggling  chicks  were 
covered  by  a  glass  enclosure — so  the  hen  could  see  her  chicks  in  trouble  but 
could  not  hear  them  call — she  ignored  them.  She  needed  to  hear  the  specific 
distress  call. 

Similarly,  a  specific  stimulus  releases  the  tendency  to  fight  in  the  male 
three-pronged  stickleback  fish  (Tinbergen,  1951,  p.  48).  In  the  spring  the  adult 
male  establishes  a  territory,  builds  a  nest,  and  courts  females.  He  also  devel¬ 
ops  a  bright  red  spot  on  his  belly.  When  other  sticklebacks  enter  his  territory, 
he  may  or  may  not  fight — depending  on  the  sight  of  a  specific  stimulus,  the 
red  spot  on  the  invader's  belly. 

If  a  pregnant  female  enters  his  territory,  his  behavior  is  different.  When 
he  moves  toward  her,  she  tilts  her  body  upward,  exposing  her  full  belly,  and 
this  stimulus  causes  him  to  go  into  a  zigzag  dance.  This  dance  is  a  signal  for 
her  to  approach,  and  when  she  does,  he  returns  to  the  nest.  Once  there,  his 
behavior  signals  her  to  enter.  This  intricate  ritual  continues  until  the  eggs  are 
fertilized,  with  each  component  of  the  ritual  governed  by  a  specific  releasing 
stimulus  (pp.  48-50). 

Specific  releasing  stimuli  also  determine  the  reactions  of  the  young  to 
their  parents.  For  example,  a  young  jackdaw  bird  will  follow  its  parent  into 
the  air  only  when  the  parent  takes  off  at  a  certain  angle  and  speed  (Lorenz, 
1935,  pp.  157-161). 

Instincts  also  are  species-specific,  which  means  particular  behavior  pat¬ 
terns  are  found  only  in  members  of  a  specific  species.  There  may  be  some 
overlap;  for  example,  we  may  see  young  birds  in  several  species  following  a 
mother  in  single  file.  But  on  close  inspection,  there  are  distinctive  differences 
in  the  following  or  in  the  way  the  parent's  behavior  releases  following  in  each 
species  (Lorenz,  1935,  p.  157). 

In  addition,  instinctive  behaviors  always  include  some  fixed  action  pattern, 
some  stereotyped  motor  component.  Fighting  gestures,  courtship  behavior, 
and  modes  of  following  always  contain  some  fixed  aspect. 

Not  every  part  of  an  instinct,  however,  must  be  of  a  fixed  nature.  For 
example,  peregrine  falcons  engage  in  free  flight  when  searching  for  prey. 
There  is  no  rigid  pattern  to  their  search;  they  glide  around  in  various  areas 


41 


Ethological  Theories 


where  past  experience  has  taught  them  to  look.  But  once  they  spot  their  prey 
(e.g.,  a  starling  bird),  their  actions  do  become  stereotyped.  Their  swoop  and 
their  manner  of  catching  their  prey  constitute  a  fixed  action  pattern  (Lorenz, 
1952a,  p.  306). 

The  fixed  action  pattern  also  has  an  underlying  drive  component,  an  inner 
urge  to  engage  in  the  instinctive  behavior.  Consequently,  if  the  behavior  has 
not  been  released  for  a  long  time,  the  drive  behind  it  can  build  up  to  the  point 
that  less  specific  stimuli  will  suffice,  as  when  males  court  females  who  lack  the 
specific  releasing  stimuli.  In  some  cases,  the  internal  pressure  for  release  builds 
up  to  such  a  high  pitch  that  the  fixed  action  pattern  goes  off  "in  a  vacuum" 
(Lorenz,  1963,  pp.  52-53). 

Finally,  instincts,  as  the  products  of  evolution,  have  some  survival  value. 
However,  as  Freedman  (1971)  observes,  it  is  often  all  too  easy  to  create  plausible- 
sounding  explanations  of  a  behavior's  adaptive  value.  What  is  really  needed  is 
research  on  the  question.  For  example,  Tinbergen  (1965)  wondered  why  herring 
gulls  remove  their  young's  egg  shells  after  hatching.  After  all,  this  requires  them 
to  spend  time  away  from  the  nest,  endangering  their  young.  He  hypothesized 
that  the  glistening  of  the  shells  in  the  sun  attracts  predators,  and  he  conducted 
an  experiment  to  see  if  this  were  so.  He  scattered  some  egg  shells  in  one  area 
and  found  that,  in  fact,  predators  investigated  this  area  much  more  than  a  com¬ 
parable  area  lacking  the  shells. 

As  mentioned  earlier,  ethologists  distinguish  instincts  from  other  kinds 
of  unlearned  behavior.  Ethologists  have  given  the  most  attention  to  the  differ¬ 
ences  between  instincts  and  reflexes  (Hess,  1962).  Instincts  may  contain 
reflexes,  but  instincts  also  may  be  more  complex.  For  example,  the  stickle¬ 
back's  zigzag  dance  must  involve  many  reflexes.  Also,  a  reflex,  such  as  an 
eyeblink,  can  be  released  by  many  stimuli — wind,  noise,  dust,  bright  lights, 
and  so  on.  There  does  not  seem  to  be  a  specific  external  releaser. 


Imprinting 

In  many  instances,  an  animal's  responsiveness  to  specific  releasers  is  innate 
or  inborn.  But  in  many  other  instances,  the  animal  is  born  with  a  gap  in  his  or 
her  knowledge.  The  animal  is  innately  equipped  with  all  the  patterns  of  an 
instinct  but  lacks  some  information  about  the  releasing  stimulus.  When  this 
information  is  filled  in  during  an  early  critical  period,  the  process  is  called 
imprinting. 

Many  species  of  young  birds  and  mammals  enter  the  world  with  incomplete 
knowledge  about  the  stimuli  that  will  release  their  following  response.  It's  as  if  a 
gosling,  for  example,  were  to  say,  "I  know  I  have  an  instinct  to  follow,  I  know  I'm 
supposed  to  get  into  single  file,  and  I  know  something  about  the  releaser — it's  my 
mother  when  she  departs.  But  what  does  she  look  like?"  This  is  the  information 
the  gosling  acquires  when  she  follows  the  first  moving  object  she  sees  during  an 
early  critical  period.  Ordinarily,  this  object  is  the  real  mother,  but  when  orphan 


42 


Ethological  Theories 


Greylag  goslings  were  raised  by  Lorenz,  they  took  him  for  their  "mother."  They 
energetically  followed  him  about  in  single  file  wherever  he  went,  ignoring  other 
geese  (see  Figure  1).  They  had  imprinted  on  him  (Lorenz,  1935,  p.  124). 


Figure  1 

These  goslings  have  imprinted  on  Lorenz. 

(Jhomas  D.  McAvoy/Time  &  Life  Pictures/Getty  Images.) 


43 


Ethological  Theories 


Although  Lorenz  was  not  the  first  to  observe  imprinting,  he  was  the  first 
to  state  that  it  occurs  during  a  critical  period.  This  means  the  young  animal 
will  form  an  attachment  to  an  object  only  if  she  is  exposed  to  and  follows  that 
object  during  a  specific  time  early  in  life.  If  the  young  animal  is  exposed  to  an 
object  before  or  after  the  critical  period,  no  attachment  is  formed.  And  once  the 
critical  period  has  passed,  it  may  be  impossible  to  induce  the  animal  to  attach 
itself  to  another  kind  of  object  (p.  127). 

Lorenz  found  that  species  differ  with  respect  to  the  range  of  objects  on 
which  they  will  imprint.  Greylag  goslings  seem  to  imprint  on  almost  any¬ 
thing  that  moves  (some  even  have  imprinted  on  boats).  Mallard  ducklings,  in 
contrast,  are  more  finicky.  Lorenz  found  that  they  would  imprint  on  him  only 
if  he  stooped  below  a  certain  height  and  made  a  quacking  sound  as  he  moved 
about.  Mallards,  then,  have  an  innate  schema  of  certain  aspects  of  the  proper 
parent — the  parent  must  move,  be  of  a  certain  height,  and  make  a  certain 
sound.  Imprinting  only  fills  in  the  rest  of  the  visual  pattern  (Lorenz,  1935, 
p.  135;  1952b,  pp.  42-43). 

Once  imprinted  on  a  mother-figure,  goslings,  ducklings,  and  other  young 
birds  follow  the  mother  the  best  they  can,  but  they  occasionally  become  sep¬ 
arated  or  fall  behind.  They  then  search  for  the  mother  while  uttering  "lost 
piping"  calls  (which  vary  somewhat  from  species  to  species).  When  a  mal¬ 
lard  mother  hears  the  piping,  she  sounds  a  loud  guiding  call,  and  if  the  duck¬ 
ling  still  cannot  reach  her,  she  turns  back  and  fetches  the  straggler.  When  she 
reaches  the  duckling  she  utters  a  greeting,  and  she  and  her  duckling  exchange 
joyful  sounds  (Lorenz,  1935,  pp.  176-177;  1981,  p.  276). 

Imprinting  can  determine  not  only  the  following  response  in  the 
young  but  later  social  behavior  as  well.  In  particular,  early  imprinting  can 
affect  later  sexual  preferences,  as  Lorenz  also  learned  from  personal  expe¬ 
rience.  One  of  his  neighbors  hand-raised  an  orphan  jackdaw  bird  that 
imprinted  on  humans,  and  when  this  bird  reached  sexual  maturity  he 
courted  Lorenz.  He  attempted  to  seduce  Lorenz  in  typical  jackdaw  fash¬ 
ion,  by  inserting  crushed  worms  into  Lorenz's  mouth.  When  Lorenz  shut 
his  mouth,  the  bird  put  the  worms  into  his  ear.  This  bird,  then,  having  been 
exposed  only  to  humans  during  his  early  life,  focused  on  humans  as  the 
objects  of  his  later  sexual  advances.  The  critical  period  for  sexual  imprint¬ 
ing  may  differ  from  that  for  parental  imprinting,  but  it  too  occurs  very  early, 
long  before  sexual  behavior  actually  emerges  (Lorenz,  1935,  p.  132;  1937 
p.  280;  1952b,  pp.  135-136). 

Lorenz  found  that  among  Greylag  geese,  the  attachment  of  adult 
"lovers"  is  as  strong  as  young  ones'  attachment  to  their  parents.  When  adult 
geese  lose  sight  of  a  partner,  they  search  frantically.  "The  goose  moves  about 
restless  by  day  and  night,  flying  great  distances  and  visiting  all  places  where 
the  partner  might  be  found,  uttering  all  the  time  the  penetrating  trisyllabic 
long-distance  call"  (1963,  p.  208).  If  the  goose's  partner  is  lost  forever,  the 
goose  appears  grief-stricken  and  loses  all  confidence. 


44 


Ethological  Theories 


So  far,  we  have  been  discussing  the  formation  of  social  attachments, 
parental  as  well  as  sexual.  Imprinting-like  processes  also  can  govern  other 
kinds  of  learning,  including  the  learning  of  territorial  maps,  food  preferences, 
and  songs.  In  pioneering  research  Marler  and  Tamura  (1964)  found  that 
white-crowned  sparrows  in  the  San  Francisco  area  learn  aspects  of  their  songs 
during  an  early  critical  period.  The  birds  don't  learn  the  entire  song — the 
basic  structure  is  inborn — but  they  pick  up  "regional  dialects"  during  the 
critical  period  (so,  for  example,  the  birds  sing  differently  if  they  grew  up  in 
Berkeley  instead  of  Sunset  Beach).  Other  researchers  have  uncovered  similar 
findings  with  respect  to  numerous  species  of  songbirds  around  the  world 
(Ball  &  Hulse,  1998). 

Nevertheless,  most  research  on  imprinting  has  focused  on  the  forma¬ 
tion  of  social  attachments,  especially  on  the  early  following  response.  Some  of 
this  research  has  raised  questions  about  some  of  Lorenz's  initial  formulations. 
For  instance,  Lorenz  (1935)  initially  proposed  that  parental  imprinting  is 
always  supraindividual.  That  is,  he  believed  the  young  imprint  on  a  particu¬ 
lar  species  of  parent  but  not  on  an  individual  parent.  But  other  ethologists 
observed  that  young  animals  do  imprint  on  individual  parents  (Bateson,  1990), 
and  Lorenz  modified  his  position  (Lorenz,  1965,  p.  57). 1 

Other  research,  especially  that  conducted  in  laboratories,  has  questioned 
Lorenz's  view  of  the  critical  period  as  completely  fixed.  If,  in  particular,  one 
initially  rears  a  bird  in  conditions  of  sensory  deprivation,  one  can  slow  neural 
development  and  extend  the  critical  period  (Bateson,  1991).  Some  researchers 
therefore  prefer  the  term  sensitive  period  to  critical  period,  suggesting  greater 
flexibility  in  the  boundaries  (Maestripieri,  2001). 

Several  ethologists  have  looked  for  the  conditions  associated  with  the 
boundaries  of  the  critical  or  sensitive  period.  In  large  part,  the  beginning  seems 
to  be  ushered  in  by  inner,  maturational  promptings;  the  young  animal  spon¬ 
taneously  searches  for  a  parent  on  which  to  imprint.  This  search  has  an  urgent 
quality  (Bateson,  1991).  Lorenz  said  the  Greylag  gosling  behaves  as  if  she  feels 
very  lonely;  the  gosling  utters  her  lost  piping  call  and  looks  for  somebody  to 
follow  (1981,  p.  280). 

Hess  (1962, 1973)  gathered  evidence  that  the  critical  period  ends  with  the 
onset  of  the  fear  response.  Once  the  young  animal  starts  showing  fear,  she 
avoids  any  new  or  strange  object  and  wants  to  stay  near  her  imprinted  par¬ 
ent.  Even  laboratory  researchers  who  look  for  ways  of  extending  the  critical 
period  (e.g.,  Bateson,  1991)  recognize  the  importance  of  fear  in  bringing  the 
period  to  a  close. 

Imprinting  occurs  in  many  birds  and  mammals  (including  sheep, 
deer,  and  buffalo)  that  live  in  groups,  move  about  soon  after  birth,  and  are 


'Sexual  imprinting,  in  contrast,  usually  seems  to  determine  only  the  species  that  the  young 
will  later  court,  not  the  particular  member  of  the  species.  One  can  only  be  sure  that  the  young  will 
not  court  its  imprinted  parent;  this  is  somehow  excluded  (Lorenz,  1935  p.  132). 


45 


Ethological  Theories 


under  strong  predator  pressure.  In  these  species,  imprinting  ensures  that 
the  animal  will  follow  an  escaping  parent  in  times  of  danger  (Freedman, 
1974,  p.  19).  It  also  enables  the  young  to  form  a  special  bond  with  a  particular 
parent. 

But  imprinting  may  also  occur,  if  more  slowly,  in  other  species,  includ¬ 
ing  primates  such  as  chimpanzees.  Young  chimpanzees  do  not  show  much 
concern  over  whom  they  are  with  until  they  are  about  3  or  4  months  old. 
Then  they  develop  a  marked  preference  for  their  mother  (or  foster  parent) 
and  become  distinctly  wary  of  other  adults.  After  this,  they  stay  fairly  near 
her,  returning  to  her  from  time  to  time,  and  if  she  should  signal  that  she  is 
about  to  depart,  they  rush  over  and  climb  aboard.  Thus  chimps  clearly  attach 
themselves  to  a  particular  adult  during  a  certain  period  in  life  (Bowlby,  1982, 
pp.  190, 196).  A  similar  process  may  occur  in  human  children,  as  we  shall  dis¬ 
cuss  momentarily. 


Evaluation 

Ethology  was  primarily  developed  in  continental  Europe,  and  it  took  some 
time  for  it  to  be  accepted  in  the  United  States.  During  the  1950s,  1960s,  and 
1970s,  U.S.  psychologists  widely  criticized  it  for  ignoring  the  role  of  the  envi¬ 
ronment  and  experience. 

In  a  prominent  study,  Bernard  Riess  (1954)  showed  that  rats  deprived 
of  experiences  with  sticks  failed  to  show  the  nest-building  instinct.  Such 
experiments,  however,  miss  the  ethologists'  point.  Ethologists  recognize  that 
instincts  have  evolved  because  they  have  been  adaptive  within  certain  envi¬ 
ronments  and  that  instincts  need  the  right  environment  to  develop  properly. 
The  environment  is  important.  All  that  ethologists  claim  is  that  instinctive 
behaviors  have  a  large  innate  component  and  that,  given  the  environment  to 
which  the  instinct  is  preadapted,  the  instinct  will  emerge  without  elaborate 
conditioning  or  learning. 

Ethologists  have  produced  many  insights  with  respect  to  nonhuman 
species,  but  they  generally  have  been  slow  to  apply  these  insights  to  humans. 
I  suspect  that  they  fear  intense  resistance  if  they  talk  about  humans  and  other 
animals  in  the  same  breath.  They  would  be  told  that  humans  are  different 
from  other  species,  that  human  behavior  is  more  determined  by  culture  and 
learning.  There  is  a  degree  of  truth  to  this,  but  I  believe  the  resistance  more 
fundamentally  stems  from  the  centuries-old  belief  that  our  species  is  simply 
too  magnificent  to  be  associated  with  "lowly"  animals  (Balcombe,  2006, 
pp.  25-27).  In  any  case,  let  us  now  consider  a  great,  pioneering  effort  to  apply 
ethological  insights  to  human  development — the  work  of  Bowlby  and 
Ainsworth. 


46 


Ethological  Theories 


BOWLBY  AND  AINSWORTH  ON  HUMAN 
ATTACHMENT 

Boivlby 

Biographical  Introduction 

John  Bowlby  (1907-1990)  was  born  in  London,  the  son  of  an  upper-class 
English  family.  In  his  interpersonal  relations,  Bowlby  maintained  an  old- 
fashioned  British  reserve,  but  his  career  was  hardly  traditional.  He  taught  in 
two  progressive  schools  for  children,  received  psychoanalytic  training  when 
it  was  still  new,  and  in  1936  became  one  of  the  first  British  psychiatrists  to 
work  in  the  area  of  child  guidance. 

Early  on,  Bowlby  became  concerned  about  the  disturbances  of  children 
growing  up  in  understaffed  orphanages  and  nurseries,  where  the  caretakers 
couldn't  provide  the  children  with  much  emotional  interaction.  The  children 
frequently  showed  an  inability  to  form  intimate  and  lasting  relationships  with 
others.  It  seemed  to  Bowlby  that  the  children  were  unable  to  love  because 
they  missed  an  opportunity  to  form  a  solid  attachment  to  a  mother  figure 
early  in  life.  In  1948  the  World  Health  Organization  commissioned  Bowlby  to 
pull  together  the  research  evidence  on  such  institutional  deprivation,  which 
he  summarized  in  his  1951  report.  Maternal  Care  and  Mental  Health.  The  report 
produced  widespread  interest  in  the  effects  of  institutional  upbringing. 

But  Bowlby's  greater  interest  was  in  another  group  of  children — toddlers 
who  had  formed  firm  attachments  to  their  parents  and  then  went  into  the  hos¬ 
pital  for  a  period  of  one  to  several  weeks.  Bowlby  and  his  coworkers  began 
gathering  information  on  these  toddlers'  experiences  in  the  late  1940s  and 
early  1950s.  At  the  time,  most  hospitals  kept  parents  off  the  children's  wards. 
Hospital  staff  believed  that  parents  would  disrupt  routines  and  spread  infec¬ 
tions.  But  when  parents  dropped  off  their  children  at  the  hospitals,  the  chil¬ 
dren  became  extremely  upset.  For  days,  the  toddlers  cried  loudly  and  searched 
for  their  parents.  They  kept  asking,  "Where's  my  Mummy?"  After  a  while 
they  became  more  subdued,  as  if  in  a  state  of  mourning,  but  they  continued 
to  yearn  for  their  parents.  With  Bowlby's  support,  a  young  coworker,  James 
Robertson,  worked  feverishly  to  convince  hospitals  to  allow  parents  to  stay 
with  their  children.  In  1952,  Robertson  produced  a  film,  A  Two-Year-Old  Goes  to 
Hospital,  to  show  the  suffering  of  a  little  girl  named  Laura.  She  was  a  very 
pretty  girl  who  was  exceptionally  self-controlled,  but  her  emotions  broke 
through.  She  tried  in  vain  to  escape  the  hospital  and  get  back  home,  and  she 
became  increasingly  miserable,  sobbing  to  herself  when  alone.  She  kept  cry- 
ing,"I  want  my  Mummy.  Where  has  my  Mummy  gone?" 

For  a  long  time  most  medical  professionals  refused  to  take  such  obser¬ 
vations  seriously.  They  came  up  with  alternative  explanations  for  the  children's 


47 


Ethological  Theories 


behavior,  such  as  the  possibility  that  Laura  wasn't  properly  brought  up. 
People  tended  to  believe  that  children  should  act  more  maturely.  But  Bowlby, 
feeling  that  the  toddlers'  distress  was  natural,  searched  for  a  theoretical 
perspective  that  could  shed  light  on  his  impression.  His  answers  came  from 
ethology  (Bowlby,  1980,  chap.  1;  1982,  pp.  25-28;  Karen,  1994,  chap.  6). 

Theory  of  Attachment:  Overview 

Earlier,  we  saw  how  young  birds  imprint  on  their  parents  and  then  follow 
them  about.  If  the  babies  should  lose  contact,  they  utter  distress  calls.  Bowlby 
pointed  out  that  such  behavior  is  common  in  a  wide  variety  of  animals.  Of 
course,  not  all  species  are  physically  capable  of  following  their  parents  soon 
after  birth.  But  they  initially  have  other  ways  of  maintaining  contact  with 
the  parent.  A  young  infant  chimpanzee,  for  example,  clings  to  the  adult. 
Bowlby  called  actions  such  as  following,  crying  out,  and  clinging — actions 
that  maintain  proximity  to  a  parent — attachment  behaviors.  He  said  attach¬ 
ment  behaviors  became  part  of  an  animal's  instinctive  nature  because  they 
proved  highly  adaptive.  A  young  animal  who  lacked  the  urge  to  maintain 
proximity  to  the  mother — a  youngster  who  was  content  to  remain  apart  from 
her — would  have  become  relatively  easy  prey  (Bowlby,  1982,  pp.  180-190; 
1973,  pp.  57-59). 

Bowlby  stated  that  similar  attachment  behaviors  occur  in  human 
babies.  Human  babies,  too,  want  to  be  close  to  their  mothers.  As  soon  as 
they  can  crawl,  babies  try  to  follow  their  mothers,  and  they  become  upset 
when  separated.  They  cry  out  and  redouble  their  efforts  to  regain  contact. 
Bowlby  said  we  should  consider  attachment  behaviors  in  humans  to  be  in 
the  same  category  as  those  in  other  species.  In  our  species,  like  others, 
attachment  behaviors  became  part  of  our  biological  equipment  because 
they  helped  the  young  survive,  providing  protection  from  predators 
(1982,  p.  183). 

Today,  the  mention  of  predators  might  sound  odd.  Greater  dangers  are 
posed  by  automobiles  and  industrial  chemicals,  but  Bowlby  asked  us  to  con¬ 
sider  our  environment  of  adaptedness,  the  basic  environment  in  which  we 
evolved.  He  believed  that  anthropological  data  provide  a  pretty  good  picture 
of  human  life  beginning  about  2  million  years  ago,  when  our  ancestor  Homo 
habilis  began  using  crude  stone  tools.  Throughout  nearly  all  of  the  subsequent 
2  million  years,  our  ancestors  probably  moved  about  in  small  groups,  search¬ 
ing  for  food  and  risking  attacks  by  large  predators.  When  threatened,  humans 
cooperated  to  drive  off  the  predators  and  to  protect  the  sick  and  young.  The 
largest  humans  fended  off  the  predators  while  the  young  followed  their  moth¬ 
ers  to  a  safer  position  behind  them  (1982,  pp.  58-64).  If  a  toddler  lacked  the 
urge  to  follow  the  mother,  he  or  she  became  "a  more  or  less  easy  meal  for  a 
lurking  leopard  or  a  pack  of  hunting  dogs"  (Bowlby,  1973,  p.  143). 

During  this  huge  span  of  time,  attachment  behavior  undoubtedly 
acquired  some  of  the  characteristics  we  see  today.  But  Bowlby  also  believed 


48 


Ethological  Theories 


that  human  attachment  behavior  began  evolving  earlier,  in  ancestors  we 
shared  with  other  animals  (Bowlby,  1982,  pp.  59, 183). 

As  we  saw  earlier,  Lorenz  and  others  advanced  the  concept  of  imprint¬ 
ing  to  describe  a  process  by  which  attachment  to  a  parent  can  develop.  Bowlby 
suggested  that  a  kind  of  imprinting  also  occurs  in  human  children,  although 
it  develops  more  slowly  than  in  other  animals.  It  certainly  develops  more 
slowly  than  in  birds,  and  even  more  slowly  than  in  chimpanzees  and  gorillas. 

Briefly,  human  imprinting  develops  along  the  following  lines.  In  the  first 
months  of  life,  babies  cannot  actively  crawl  after  a  departing  parent,  but  they 
have  other  signals  and  gestures  for  keeping  the  parent  close.  One  way  is  to  cry. 
The  cry  is  a  distress  call;  when  the  infant  is  in  pain  or  is  frightened,  she  cries 
and  the  parent  is  impelled  to  rush  over  to  see  what  is  wrong.  Another  attach¬ 
ment  behavior  is  the  baby's  smile;  when  a  baby  smiles  into  a  parent's  eyes,  the 
parent  feels  love  for  the  baby  and  enjoys  being  close. 

Initially,  babies'  social  gestures  are  largely  indiscriminate.  For  example, 
they  will  smile  at  any  face  or  cry  for  any  person  who  leaves  their  sight.  But 
between  about  3  and  6  months  of  age,  babies  narrow  their  responsiveness  to 
a  few  familiar  people,  develop  a  clear-cut  preference  for  one  person  in  par¬ 
ticular,  and  then  become  wary  of  strangers.  Soon  after  this,  they  become  more 
mobile,  crawling  about,  and  they  take  a  more  active  role  in  keeping  their  prin¬ 
cipal  attachment  figure  nearby.  They  monitor  this  parent's  whereabouts,  and 
any  sign  that  the  parent  might  suddenly  depart  releases  following  on  their 
part.  The  whole  process — focusing  on  a  principal  attachment  figure  whose 
departure  then  releases  following — parallels  imprinting  in  other  species.  This 
attachment  figure,  usually  a  parent,  is  incredibly  important  to  the  young  child, 
and  the  child  wants  to  stay  in  proximity  to  the  parent. 

In  his  writings,  Bowlby  used  the  ethological  terms  instinct  and  imprinting 
in  a  purposely  loose  sense.  He  wanted  to  show  that  these  concepts  apply  to 
human  behavior  in  a  general  way,  not  as  extremely  precise,  detailed  definitions 
(1982,  pp.  136, 220).  Nevertheless,  Bowlby  felt  that  these  ethological  concepts 
provided  the  powerful  explanations  he  had  been  looking  for.  He  said  that 
when  he  first  learned  about  them,  in  the  1950s,  it  was  a  "eureka"  experience 
(Karen,  1994,  p.  90).  In  particular,  he  understood  why  toddlers  like  Laura  (in 
James  Robertson's  film)  become  so  shaken  when  separated  from  their  par¬ 
ents.  As  a  product  of  evolution,  the  human  child  has  an  instinctual  need  to  stay 
close  to  the  parent  on  whom  she  has  imprinted.  This  need  is  built  into  the 
very  fiber  of  the  child's  being.  So  when  the  toddler  loses  contact  with  the  par¬ 
ent,  the  toddler  tries  to  find  the  parent  and  cries  out  with  distress  calls.  The 
child  isn't  being  "babyish";  she  is  simply  engaging  in  natural  behaviors  that 
have  brought  safety  to  young  humans  for  millions  of  years.  Without  these 
behaviors,  it's  unlikely  that  human  populations  would  have  survived.  If, 
despite  the  child's  efforts,  she  cannot  regain  contact  with  the  parent,  the  child's 
anxiety  becomes  intense.  On  some  level,  the  child  may  feel  she  will  die. 

Let  us  now  look  at  the  phases  through  which  babies  normally  develop 
their  attachment  to  caretakers. 


49 


Ethological  Theories 


Phases  of  Attachment 

Phase  1  (birth  to  3  months): Social  Gestures  with  Limited  Selectivity. 

Within  a  few  days  after  birth,  infants  have  some  capacity  to  discriminate 
among  people.  They  prefer  their  mothers'  voices,  odors,  and  faces  to  those  of 
other  people  (Fogel,  2009,  pp.  121, 240-241, 244).  But  during  the  first  3  months 
babies'  selectivity  is  often  limited.  Much  of  the  time,  they  respond  to  every¬ 
one  in  the  same  ways,  as  we  shall  see  as  we  review  their  social  gestures. 

The  most  endearing  early  gesture  is  the  social  smile.  Social  smiles  begin 
at  3  or  4  weeks  of  age  and  are  usually  directed  at  a  high-pitched  human  voice. 
Beginning  at  6  to  8  weeks  of  age,  babies'  smiles  become  brighter  and  more 
energetic  and  are  primarily  directed  at  a  visual  stimulus — the  face  (Bowlby, 
1982,  pp.  283-286;  Fogel,  2009,  p.  286). 2  One  can  tell  when  visual  smiles  are 
about  to  start.  About  a  week  beforehand,  the  baby  starts  to  gaze  intently  at 
faces,  as  if  studying  them.  Then  the  baby  breaks  into  open  smiles  (Figure  2). 
This  is  often  an  electrifying  moment  in  a  parent's  life;  the  parent  now  has 


Figure  2 

The  sight  of  a  baby  smiling  into 
one's  eyes  stirs  love  and  fosters 
attachment. 


2Actually,  babies  begin  smiling  right  after  birth.  They  emit  eyes-closed  smiles,  usually 
as  they  fall  off  to  sleep.  But  these  smiles  are  not  yet  social;  they  are  not  yet  directed  at  people 
(Freedman,  1974,  p.  178). 


50 


Ethological  Theories 


"proof"  of  the  baby's  love.  The  sight  of  one's  baby  looking  deeply  into  one's 
eyes  and  smiling  causes  a  feeling  of  love  to  well  up  from  within.  (Even  if  you 
are  not  a  parent,  you  might  have  had  a  similar  feeling  when  any  baby  smiled 
at  you.  You  cannot  help  but  smile  back,  and  you  think  that  you  and  the  baby 
share  a  special  bond.) 

Actually,  until  3  months  or  so,  these  smiles  aren't  selective.  Babies  will 
smile  at  any  face,  even  a  cardboard  model  of  one.  The  main  stipulation  is 
that  the  face  be  presented  in  the  full  or  frontal  position.  A  profile  is  far  less 
effective.  Also,  a  voice  or  a  caress  is  a  relatively  weak  elicitor  of  smiling 
during  this  stage.  It  seems,  then,  that  the  baby's  social  smile  is  released  by 
a  fairly  specific  visual  stimulus  (Bowlby,  1982,  pp.  282-286;  Freedman,  1974, 
pp.  179-181, 187;  Fogel,  2009,  p.  286). 

In  Bowlby's  view,  smiling  promotes  attachment  because  it  maintains  the 
proximity  of  the  caretaker.  When  the  baby  smiles,  the  caretaker  enjoys  being 
with  the  baby;  the  caretaker  "smiles  back,  'talks'  to  him,  strokes  and  pats  him, 
and  perhaps  picks  him  up"  (Bowlby,  1982,  p.  246).  The  smile  itself  is  a  releaser 
that  promotes  loving  and  caring  interaction — behavior  that  increases  the 
baby's  chances  for  health  and  survival. 

At  about  the  time  that  babies  begin  smiling  at  faces,  they  also  begin 
babbling  (and  cooing  and  gurgling).  They  babble  primarily  at  the  sound  of  a 
human  voice  and,  especially,  at  the  sight  of  a  human  face.  As  with  smiling,  bab¬ 
bling  is  initially  unselective;  babies  will  babble  when  almost  any  person  is 
around.  The  baby's  babbling  delights  the  caretaker,  prompting  the  caretaker 
to  talk  back.  "Babbling,  like  smiling,  is  a  social  releaser  [that]  has  the  function 
of  maintaining  a  mother-figure  in  proximity  to  an  infant  by  promoting  social 
interaction  between  them"  (p.  289). 

Crying  also  results  in  proximity  between  caretaker  and  child.  It  is  like  a 
distress  call;  it  signals  the  baby  needs  help.  Babies  cry  when  they  are  in  pain, 
hungry,  cold,  or  experience  discomfort.  They  even  cry  when  a  person  at  whom 
they  had  been  looking  leaves  their  field  of  vision,  although  during  the  first 
weeks  the  particular  person  in  question  matters  little.  Babies  also  will  permit 
almost  any  person  to  quiet  them  through  rocking  or  by  attending  to  their 
needs  (pp.  289-296). 

Proximity  also  is  maintained  by  the  baby's  holding  on.  The  newborn  is 
equipped  with  two  holding  responses.  One  is  the  grasp  reflex;  when  any  object 
touches  the  baby's  open  palm,  the  hand  automatically  closes  around  it.  The 
other  is  the  Moro  reflex,  which  occurs  either  when  babies  are  startled  by  a 
loud  noise  or  when  they  suddenly  lose  support  (as  when  one  holds  their  head 
from  underneath  and  then  suddenly  lets  it  drop).  Their  response  is  to  spread 
their  arms  and  then  to  bring  them  back  around  the  chest.  The  action  looks  as 
if  the  baby  were  embracing  something  (see  Figure  3).  In  earlier  times,  Bowlby 
thought,  these  reflexes  served  the  purpose  of  keeping  hold  of  the  parent  who 
carried  them  about.  If,  for  example,  a  mother  saw  a  predator  and  suddenly  ran, 
the  chances  were  that  the  baby  had  a  grasp  of  some  part  of  her  with  the  hand 


51 


Ethological  Theories 


(see  Figure  4).  And  if  the  baby  lost  hold,  he  or  she  would  embrace  the  mother 
again  (p.  278). 

Babies  also  are  equipped  with  rooting  and  sucking  reflexes.  When  their 
cheek  is  touched,  they  automatically  turn  their  head  to  the  side  from  which 
the  stimulation  came  and  then  "root"  or  grope  until  their  mouth  touches  some¬ 
thing,  which  they  then  suck.  The  rooting  and  sucking  reflexes  obviously  aid 
breast-feeding,  but  Bowlby  also  regarded  them  as  attachment  patterns  because 
they  bring  the  baby  into  interaction  with  the  mother  (p.  275). 

Phase  2  (3  to  6  months): Focusing  on  Familiar  People.  Beginning  at 
about  3  months,  the  baby's  behavior  changes.  For  one  thing,  many  reflexes — 
including  the  Moro,  grasp,  and  rooting  reflexes — drop  out.  But  more  impor¬ 
tantly  for  Bowlby,  the  baby's  social  responses  begin  to  become  much  more 
selective.  Between  3  and  6  months,  babies  gradually  restrict  their  smiles  to 
familiar  people;  when  they  see  a  stranger,  they  simply  stare  (Bowlby,  1982, 


52 


Ethological  Theories 


Figure  4 

With  her  grasp  reflex,  this  month-old  baby  has  a  hold  on 
her  mother's  shirt. 


pp.  287, 325).  Babies  also  become  more  selective  in  their  cooing  and  babbling; 
by  the  age  of  4  or  5  months,  they  make  these  sounds  only  in  the  presence  of 
people  they  recognize  (p.  289).  Also,  by  this  age  (and  perhaps  long  before), 
their  crying  is  most  readily  quieted  by  a  preferred  figure.  By  age  5  months, 
finally,  babies  begin  to  reach  for  and  grasp  parts  of  our  anatomy,  particularly 
our  hair,  but  they  do  so  only  if  they  know  us  (pp.  279, 300). 

During  this  phase,  then,  babies  narrow  their  responsiveness  to  familiar 
people.  They  usually  prefer  two  or  three  people — and  one  in  particular.  They 
most  readily  smile  or  babble,  for  example,  when  this  person  is  near.  This 
principal  attachment  figure  is  usually  the  mother,  but  it  doesn't  have  to  be. 
It  can  be  the  father  or  some  other  caretaker.  Babies  seem  to  develop  the 
strongest  attachment  to  the  one  person  who  has  most  alertly  responded  to 
their  signals  and  who  has  engaged  in  the  most  pleasurable  interactions  with 
them  (pp.  306-316). 


53 


Ethological  Theories 


Phase  3  (6  months  to  3  years):  Intense  Attachment  and  Active 
Proximity-Seeking.  Beginning  at  about  6  months  of  age,  the  infant's  attach¬ 
ment  to  a  particular  person  becomes  increasingly  intense  and  exclusive.  Most 
notably,  infants  cry  out  when  the  mother  figure  leaves  the  room,  demonstrat¬ 
ing  separation  anxiety. 

Observers  have  also  noted  the  intensity  with  which  the  baby  greets  the 
mother  after  she  has  been  away  for  a  brief  time.  When  she  returns,  the  baby 
typically  smiles,  reaches  to  be  picked  up,  and  when  in  the  mother's  arms, 
hugs  her  and  crows  with  delight.  The  mother,  too,  displays  her  happiness  at 
the  reunion  (1982,  pp.  295,  300). 

The  new  exclusiveness  of  the  baby's  attachment  to  a  parent  is  also  evi¬ 
dent  at  about  7  or  8  months  when  the  baby  exhibits  a  fear  of  strangers.  This 
reaction  ranges  from  a  slight  vigilance  to  outright  cries  at  the  sight  of  a 
stranger,  with  the  stronger  reactions  usually  occurring  when  the  baby  feels 
ill  or  is  in  an  unfamiliar  setting  (pp.  321-326). 

But  babies  are  not  restricted  to  the  expression  of  strong  emotions.  By 
8  months,  they  can  usually  crawl  and  therefore  can  begin  to  actively  follow  a 
departing  parent.  Babies  will  make  the  most  concerted  efforts  to  regain  con¬ 
tact  when  a  parent  departs  suddenly  rather  than  slowly,  or  when  they  are  in 
unfamiliar  surroundings  (pp.  256-259).  (See  Figure  5.) 

Once  infants  can  actively  follow  a  parent,  their  behavior  begins  to  con¬ 
solidate  into  a  goal-corrected  system.  That  is,  babies  monitor  the  parent's  where¬ 
abouts,  and  if  the  parent  starts  to  leave,  they  urgently  follow,  "correcting"  or 
adjusting  their  movements  until  they  regain  proximity.  When  they  get  near  the 
parent,  they  typically  reach  up  with  their  arms,  gesturing  to  be  picked  up. 
When  held,  they  calm  down  again  (p.  252). 

Babies,  of  course,  often  move  away  from  attachment  figures  as  well  as 
toward  them.  This  is  particularly  evident  when  they  use  the  caretaker  as  a 
secure  base  from  which  to  explore.  If  a  mother  and  her  1-  or  2-year-old  child  enter 
a  park  or  playground,  the  child  will  typically  remain  close  for  a  moment  or  two 
and  then  venture  off  to  explore.  However,  the  child  will  periodically  look 
back,  exchange  glances  or  smiles  with  her,  and  even  return  to  her  from  time 
to  time  before  venturing  forth  once  again.  The  child  initiates  brief  contacts 
"as  though  to  assure  himself  that  she  is  still  there"  (p.  209). 

Using  the  mother  as  a  secure  base,  babies  and  toddlers  are  happy  explor¬ 
ers.  Although  they  periodically  monitor  the  mother's  presence,  they  are  com¬ 
fortable  investigating  things  at  some  distance  from  her.  But  this  situation  can 
quickly  change.  If,  when  a  child  glances  back  at  the  mother,  she  seems  inac¬ 
cessible  (or,  more  threatening  yet,  seems  ready  to  depart)  the  child  will  hurry 
back  to  her.  The  child  also  will  rush  back  if  he  or  she  is  frightened  by  some 
event,  such  as  a  loud  noise.  In  these  circumstances  the  child  will  want  close 
physical  contact  and  may  require  a  good  deal  of  comforting  before  he  or  she 
will  venture  away  from  the  mother  once  again  (Bowlby,  1988,  p.  62;  1982, 
pp.  257-259, 373). 


54 


Ethological  Theories 


Figure  5 

An  8-month-old  baby  struggles  to  follow  her  mother. 


By  the  end  of  the  first  year,  an  important  variable  is  the  child's  general 
working  model  of  the  attachment  figure.  That  is,  the  child  has  begun  to  build 
up,  on  the  basis  of  day-to-day  interactions,  a  general  idea  of  the  caretaker's 
accessibility  and  responsiveness.  So,  for  example,  a  1-year-old  girl  who  has 
developed  some  general  doubts  about  her  mother's  availability  will  tend  to 
be  anxious  about  exploring  new  situations  at  any  distance  from  her.  If,  in  con¬ 
trast,  the  girl  has  basically  concluded  that  "my  mother  loves  me  and  will 
always  be  there  when  I  really  need  her,"  she  will  explore  the  world  with  more 
courage  and  enthusiasm.  Even  so,  she  will  occasionally  monitor  her  mother's 
presence,  for  her  need  for  her  mother  is  vital  (Bowlby,  1973,  pp.  203-206;  1982, 
pp.  354,  373). 

Phase  4  (3  years  to  the  end  of  childhood)  .-Partnership  Behavior.  Prior 
to  the  age  of  2  or  3  years,  children  are  concerned  only  with  their  own  need  to 
maintain  a  certain  proximity  to  the  caretaker;  they  do  not  yet  consider  the  care¬ 
taker's  plans  or  goals.  For  the  2-year-old,  the  knowledge  that  mother  or  father 
is  "going  next  door  for  a  moment  to  borrow  some  milk"  is  meaningless;  the 


55 


Ethological  Theories 


child  simply  wants  to  go,  too.  The  3-year-old,  in  contrast,  has  some  under¬ 
standing  of  such  plans  and  can  visualize  the  parent's  behavior  while  he  or 
she  is  away.  Consequently,  the  child  is  more  willing  to  let  the  parent  go.  The 
child  begins  acting  more  like  a  partner  in  the  relationship.  Still,  there  are  limits 
on  the  amount  of  physical  separation  3-year-olds  can  tolerate,  for  they  still 
have  a  great  need  for  the  parent's  care. 


Attachment  as  Imprinting 

Now  that  we  have  examined  the  child's  attachment  in  some  detail,  we  are  in 
a  position  to  appreciate  Bowlby's  thesis  that  attachment  follows  a  course  sim¬ 
ilar  to  imprinting  in  animals.  Imprinting,  you  will  recall,  is  the  process  by 
which  animals  learn  the  releasing  stimuli  for  their  social  instincts.  In  particu¬ 
lar,  young  animals  learn  which  moving  objects  to  follow.  They  begin  with  a 
willingness  to  follow  a  wide  range  of  objects,  but  this  range  quickly  narrows, 
and  at  the  end  of  the  imprinting  period  they  usually  will  follow  only  the 
mother.  At  this  point  the  fear  response  limits  the  ability  to  form  new  attach¬ 
ments.  The  sensitive  period  for  imprinting  has  ended. 

In  humans,  we  can  observe  a  similar  process,  although  it  develops  much 
more  slowly.  During  the  first  weeks  of  life,  babies  cannot  actively  follow 
objects  through  locomotion,  but  they  do  direct  social  responses  toward  people. 
They  smile,  babble,  hold  on,  cry,  and  so  on — all  of  which  keep  people  close. 
At  first,  babies  direct  these  responses  toward  anyone.  However,  by 
6  months  of  age  they  have  narrowed  their  attachment  to  a  few  people  and 
one  in  particular.  They  primarily  want  this  person  near.  At  this  point  they 
become  afraid  of  strangers,  and,  as  they  learn  to  crawl,  they  follow  their  prin¬ 
cipal  attachment  figure  whenever  she  departs.  They  have  imprinted  on  a 
particular  person;  it  is  she  who  releases  following. 


Institutional  Deprivation 

Early  in  his  career,  Bowlby  was  struck  by  the  inability  of  many  institution¬ 
ally  reared  children  to  form  deep  attachments  later  in  life.  He  called  these 
individuals  "affectionless  characters'';  such  individuals  use  people  solely 
for  their  own  ends  and  seem  incapable  of  forming  loving,  lasting  ties  to  others. 
In  his  1951  World  Health  Organization  report,  Bowlby  speculated  that  they 
lacked  the  opportunity  to  form  an  early  relationship  with  a  mother-figure 
(Bowlby,  1965). 

The  conditions  in  many  institutions  do  seem  unfavorable  for  the  for¬ 
mation  of  intimate  human  ties.  In  many  institutions,  babies  receive  care  from 
several  nurses  who  can  meet  their  physical  needs  but  who  have  little  time  to 
interact  with  them.  Frequently,  no  one  is  around  to  heed  the  babies'  cries,  to 


56 


Ethological  Theories 


return  their  smiles,  to  talk  to  them  when  they  babble,  or  to  pick  them  up  when 
they  desire.  Consequently,  it  is  difficult  for  the  baby  to  establish  a  strong  bond 
with  any  particular  person. 

When  writing  his  report,  Bowlby  had  not  yet  read  about  imprinting,  but 
he  intuitively  felt  that  there  is  a  sensitive  period  for  forming  the  first,  vital 
attachment.  Bowlby  never  seemed  perfectly  confident  about  the  age  when 
the  sensitive  period  ends,  but  his  writings  suggest  it  ends  with  the  appearance 
of  fear  responses,  as  in  other  species  (1982,  pp.  222-223).  If  so,  the  sensitive 
period  might  end  at  8  or  9  months,  the  age  by  which  babies  ordinarily  have 
shown  a  fear  of  separation  (6  months)  as  well  as  a  fear  of  strangers  (8  or  9 
months).  If  the  baby  hasn't  formed  an  attachment  by  this  age,  the  baby  may 
have  missed  the  sensitive  period  for  developing  bonds  in  general. 

The  most  relevant  recent  research  has  looked  at  institutionalized  chil¬ 
dren  in  Romania.  In  1989,  political  turmoil  forced  many  babies  into  extremely 
understaffed  orphanages.  Many  caring  families  in  the  United  Kingdom 
adopted  children  in  the  orphanages,  and  researchers  have  followed  the  chil¬ 
dren's  progress  up  to  the  age  of  11  years.  It  appears  that  babies  adopted  prior 
to  the  age  of  6  months  escaped  social  deficits.  In  contrast,  about  a  quarter  of 
the  children  who  were  adopted  between  the  ages  of  6  and  42  months  exhib¬ 
ited  social  deficits,  such  as  shallow  relationships  with  others.  Thus  the  water¬ 
shed  appears  to  be  6  months,  when  the  initial  fear  response  (separation 
anxiety)  ordinarily  emerges  (Dozier  &  Rutter,  2008). 

On  the  basis  of  this  finding,  Mary  Dozier  and  Michael  Rutter  (2008,  pp. 
707-708)  suggest  there  may  be  a  genetically  programmed  period,  ending  at  6 
months,  for  the  normal  attachment  to  a  parental  figure.  If  the  baby  does  not 
form  a  bond  with  a  parental  figure  by  this  age,  subsequent  relationship  prob¬ 
lems  can  occur.  But  Dozier  and  Rutter  acknowledge  that  more  research  is 
needed  on  this  topic. 


Separations 

Although  Bowlby  was  interested  in  early  institutional  deprivation,  he  was 
much  more  interested  in  cases  where  the  child  forms  a  normal  attachment 
and  then  suffers  a  separation.  This  was  the  kind  of  separation  illustrated  by 
James  Robertson's  1952  film,  A  Two-Year-Old  Goes  to  Hospital.  Bowlby  and 
Robertson  (Bowlby,  1980,  chap.  1;  1982,  chap.  2)  proposed  that  when  separa¬ 
tions  are  forced  on  1-  to  3-year-olds,  and  last  from  one  to  several  weeks,  the 
child's  behavior  typically  goes  through  three  stages. 

First,  children  protest.  They  cry  and  scream  for  their  mother.  They 
search  for  her  and  are  alert  to  any  sight  or  sound  indicating  she  is  present 
after  all.  Sometimes  they  insist  their  mother  is  coming  soon,  ignoring  what 
they've  been  told.  During  this  phase,  the  children  usually  reject  all  forms  of 
substitute  care. 


57 


Ethological  Theories 


Second,  they  go  through  a  period  of  despair.  They  become  quieter  and 
less  active,  and  appear  to  be  in  a  deep  state  of  mourning.  But  although  their 
hopelessness  deepens,  they  continue  to  look  for  their  mother. 

Finally,  a  stage  of  detachment  sets  in.  During  this  period,  the  child  is  live¬ 
lier  and  may  accept  the  care  of  nurses  and  others.  The  hospital  staff  may  think 
the  child  has  recovered.  However,  all  is  not  well.  When  the  mother  returns,  the 
child  seems  not  to  know  her;  the  child  turns  away  from  her  and  acts  as  if  he 
has  lost  all  interest  in  her.  The  reactions  are  probably  a  defense  against  further 
disappointment. 

Fortunately,  most  children  do  reestablish  their  tie  to  the  mother  after  a 
while.  But  this  is  not  always  the  case.  If  the  separation  has  been  prolonged  or 
is  repeated,  the  child  may  give  up  on  people  altogether.  The  result  here,  too, 
is  an  "affectionless  character,"  a  person  who  no  longer  cares  for  others  in  any 
deep  way. 


Attachment  and  Separation  through 
the  Life  Cycle 

Although  Bowlby  wrote  primarily  about  attachment  in  childhood,  he 
believed  that  attachment  is  important  throughout  the  life  cycle.  Adolescents 
break  away  from  parental  dominance,  but  their  attachment  to  parents  per¬ 
sists;  adults  consider  themselves  independent,  but  they  seek  proximity  to 
loved  ones  in  times  of  crisis;  and  older  people  find  that  they  must  increas¬ 
ingly  depend  on  the  younger  generation.  In  general,  Bowlby  said,  being 
alone  is  one  of  the  great  fears  in  human  life.  We  might  consider  such  a  fear 
silly,  neurotic,  or  immature,  but  there  are  good  biological  reasons  behind  it. 
Throughout  human  history,  humans  have  best  been  able  to  withstand  crises 
and  face  danger  with  the  help  of  companions  (Bowlby,  1982,  p.  207;  1973, 
pp.  84,  143, 165). 

In  his  writings  on  adult  attachment,  Bowlby  emphasized  how  people 
provide  each  other  with  a  secure  base  of  support.  You  will  recall  that  such 
behavior  begins  early.  When,  for  example,  a  1-  or  2-year-old  goes  to  a  new 
park  with  a  caretaker,  the  child  uses  the  caretaker  as  a  base  from  which  to 
explore.  Knowing  that  the  caretaker  is  available  if  needed,  the  child  enthusi¬ 
astically  explores  the  surroundings.  Bowlby  suggested  that  similar  behavior 
characterizes  the  healthiest  adult  partnerships  (1979,  pp.  204-205).  Each  part¬ 
ner  knows  he  or  she  has  an  unwavering  backup,  someone  who  can  be  trusted 
to  provide  emotional  support  and  assistance  when  needed.  Knowing  that 
support  will  be  there,  individuals  have  the  courage  to  venture  forth  and  meet 
life's  challenges.  Secure  bases  of  support  also  are  provided  by  relatives  and 
friends.  Bowlby  said,  "All  of  us,  from  the  cradle  to  the  grave,  are  happiest 
when  life  is  organized  as  a  series  of  excursions,  long  or  short,  from  a  secure 
base  provided  by  our  attachment  figure(s)"  (1988,  p.  62). 


58 


Ethological  Theories 


Because  attachments  are  vital  throughout  life,  separations  and  losses 
can  cause  personal  upheaval.  This  is  evident,  for  example,  when  a  person 
loses  a  parent,  goes  through  a  divorce,  or  becomes  a  widow.  Attachment 
researchers  have  most  thoroughly  studied  cases  of  widowhood,  and  they  have 
found  that  the  reactions  of  the  bereaved  display  many  similarities  to  those  of 
children  who  suffer  separations.  Most  dramatically,  the  bereaved  also  search 
for  the  lost  person. 

"I  walk  around  searching,"  said  one  widow.  "I  go  to  the  grave  . . .  but  he's 
not  there."  Others  feel  drawn  to  the  old  haunts  they  and  their  loved  ones  used 
to  frequent,  as  if  they  might  find  their  loved  ones  there.  Sometimes  they  call 
out  for  the  deceased.  "Oh  Fred,  I  do  need  you,"  shouted  one  widow  during  a 
research  interview,  before  bursting  into  tears  (Bowlby,  1980,  p.  90).  A  1993 
study  found  that  a  full  year  after  a  spouse's  death,  63%  of  the  respondents 
sensed  that  their  spouse  was  with  them  at  times  (Shaver  &  Fraley,  2008, 
p.  51).  Sometimes  the  bereaved  think  they  see  their  deceased  partner  on  the 
street  or  hear  the  partner  moving  about  the  house  at  night  (Bowlby,  1980, 
p.  89).  This  desperate  searching  reminds  one  of  the  adult  geese  described  by 
Lorenz  (1963,  p.  208). 

Many  friends  and  professionals  see  the  behavior  of  bereaved  adults  as 
irrational.  They  tell  them  to  pull  themselves  together,  to  face  reality,  and  to 
focus  on  the  future  instead  of  dwelling  on  the  past.  Bowlby's  view  was  differ¬ 
ent.  He  suggested  that  in  the  course  of  evolution,  an  urge  to  find  missing  loved 
ones  became  a  powerful  part  of  our  biological  makeup.  Underlying  the  urge 
is  the  assumption  that  "all  losses  are  retrievable";  hoping  for  the  impossible, 
we  keep  searching  (Bowlby,  1979,  p.  86).  And  because  the  drive  to  reunite  with 
loved  ones  is  natural,  it  should  be  respected,  even  when  it  might  strike  us  as 
unrealistic.  To  be  helpful,  we  should  give  bereaved  individuals  a  chance  to  talk 
freely  about  their  feelings  and  wishes.  Research  indicates  that  this  opportu¬ 
nity  facilitates  a  healthy  readjustment  (Bowlby,  1979,  pp.  86,  97, 100-101). 

Bowlby  gave  attachment  theory  its  start,  but  much  of  its  progress — as  well 
as  its  current  popularity — owes  to  the  work  of  his  colleague  Mary  Ainsworth. 

Ainsworth 

Biographical  Introduction 

Mary  D.  S.  Ainsworth  (1913-1999)  grew  up  in  Toronto  and  at  the  age  of  16 
entered  the  University  of  Toronto.  There,  she  was  impressed  by  the  psycho¬ 
logical  theory  of  William  Blatz,  who  emphasized  how  parents  may  or  may 
not  provide  children  with  security.  Ainsworth  felt  Blatz's  ideas  helped  her 
understand  why  she  was  a  bit  retiring  in  social  settings.  She  stayed  on  at  the 
university  to  earn  a  doctorate  and  taught  psychology  for  a  few  years.  In  1950 
she  married  Len  Ainsworth,  and  the  couple  went  to  England,  where  she 


59 


Ethological  Theories 


answered  a  newspaper  ad  for  a  research  assistant  to  John  Bowlby.  Thus  began 
a  40-year  collaboration.  In  1954  Len  accepted  a  position  teaching  in  Uganda, 
and  Ainsworth  used  her  two  years  there  to  go  to  the  villages  near  Kampala 
to  make  careful,  naturalistic  observations  of  how  babies  become  attached  to 
their  mothers  (Karen,  1994).  This  research,  later  published  in  her  1967  book. 
Infancy  in  Uganda,  sketched  out  the  phases  of  attachment  that  Bowlby  out¬ 
lined  in  his  writings.  Ainsworth's  Uganda  research  also  described  how  babies 
use  the  mother  as  a  secure  base  from  which  to  explore.  Indeed,  Bowlby  (1988) 
credited  Ainsworth  with  discovering  infants'  secure-base  behavior.  And,  tak¬ 
ing  a  first  stab  at  a  groundbreaking  formulation,  she  described  three  patterns 
of  attachment — three  different  forms  the  attachment  process  may  take  among 
individual  babies. 

After  arriving  in  the  United  States  from  Africa,  Ainsworth  began  a  study 
of  23  middle-class  babies  and  their  mothers  in  Baltimore.  The  Baltimore  study, 
which  was  more  elaborate  than  the  Uganda  study,  replicated  and  expanded 
the  Uganda  findings  on  the  patterns  of  attachment  and  stimulated  a  tremen¬ 
dous  amount  of  research  on  the  topic. 


Patterns  of  Attachment 

In  the  Baltimore  study,  Ainsworth  and  her  students  observed  the  babies 
and  their  mothers  in  their  homes  for  the  first  year  of  the  babies'  lives,  vis¬ 
iting  them  for  about  4  hours  every  3  weeks.  When  the  infants  were  12  months 
old,  Ainsworth  wanted  to  see  how  they  would  behave  in  a  new  setting,  so 
she  brought  them  and  their  mothers  to  a  playroom  at  Johns  Hopkins  Uni¬ 
versity.  She  was  particularly  interested  in  how  the  babies  would  use  the 
mother  as  a  base  from  which  to  explore  and  how  they  would  react  to  two 
brief  separations.  In  the  first  separation,  the  mother  left  the  baby  with  a 
stranger  (a  friendly  female  graduate  student);  in  the  second,  the  baby  was 
left  alone.  Each  separation  lasted  3  minutes,  but  was  shortened  if  the  baby 
showed  too  much  distress.  The  entire  procedure,  which  lasts  20  minutes,  is 
called  the  Strange  Situation.  Ainsworth  and  coworkers  (Ainsworth,  Bell, 
&  Stanton,  1971;  Ainsworth,  Blehar,  Waters,  &  Wall,  1978)  observed  three 
patterns. 

1 .  Securely  Attached  Infants.  Soon  after  entering  the  playroom  with 
the  mother,  these  babies  used  her  as  a  base  from  which  to  explore.  When  the 
mother  left  the  room,  however,  their  exploratory  play  diminished  and  they 
sometimes  became  visibly  upset.  When  the  mother  returned,  they  actively 
greeted  her  and  remained  close  to  her  for  a  moment  or  two.  Once  reassured, 
they  eagerly  ventured  forth  to  explore  the  environment  once  again. 

When  Ainsworth  examined  the  earlier  home  observations  of  these  chil¬ 
dren,  she  found  the  mothers  had  typically  been  rated  as  sensitive  and 


60 


Ethological  Theories 


promptly  responsive  to  their  babies'  cries  and  other  signals.  The  mothers  had 
been  lovingly  available  when  the  babies  needed  comforting.  For  their  part, 
the  babies  cried  very  little  at  home  and  used  the  mother  as  a  base  from  which 
to  explore  in  the  home  as  well. 

Ainsworth  believed  these  infants  demonstrated  the  healthy  pattern  of 
attachment  behavior.  The  mother's  day-in  and  day-out  responsiveness  had 
given  the  baby  faith  in  the  mother  as  a  protector;  her  simple  presence  in  the 
Strange  Situation  gave  the  child  the  courage  to  actively  explore  the  sur¬ 
roundings.  At  the  same  time,  the  child's  responses  to  the  mother's  departure 
and  return  in  this  new  environment  revealed  the  baby's  strong  need  for  prox¬ 
imity  to  her — a  need  that  has  had  enormous  survival  value  throughout  human 
evolution.  This  pattern  has  been  found  to  characterize  about  65%  of  the 
1-year-olds  evaluated  in  the  Strange  Situation  in  U.S.  samples  (Goldberg,  1995; 
van  IJzendoorn  &  Sagi-Schwartz,  2008). 

2.  Insecure-Avoidant  Infants.  These  infants  appeared  quite  inde¬ 
pendent  throughout  the  Strange  Situation.  As  soon  as  they  entered  the  room, 
they  rushed  off  to  inspect  the  toys.  Although  they  explored,  they  didn't  use 
the  mother  as  a  secure  base,  in  the  sense  of  checking  in  with  her  from  time 
to  time.  They  simply  ignored  her.  When  the  mother  left  the  room,  they  didn't 
become  upset,  and  they  didn't  seek  proximity  to  her  when  she  returned. 
If  she  tried  to  pick  them  up,  they  tried  to  avoid  her,  turning  their  bodies 
away  or  averting  their  gaze.  This  avoidant  pattern  has  been  found  in  about 
20%  of  the  infants  in  U.S.  samples  (Goldberg,  1995;  van  IJzendoorn  &  Sagi- 
Schwartz,  2008) 

Because  these  infants  display  such  independence  in  the  Strange  Situa¬ 
tion,  they  have  struck  many  people  as  exceptionally  healthy.  But  when 
Ainsworth  saw  their  avoidant  behavior,  she  guessed  they  were  suffering  from 
some  degree  of  emotional  difficulty.  Their  detachment  reminded  her  of  chil¬ 
dren  who  had  experienced  painful  separations. 

The  home  observations  supported  Ainsworth's  guess  that  something 
was  wrong.  The  mothers  had  been  rated  as  relatively  insensitive,  interfer¬ 
ing,  and  rejecting.  And  the  babies  often  seemed  insecure.  Although  some 
were  very  independent  in  the  home,  many  were  anxious  about  the  mother's 
whereabouts. 

Ainsworth's  overall  interpretation,  then,  was  that  when  these  babies 
entered  the  Strange  Situation,  they  suspected  they  couldn't  count  on  their 
mother  for  support  and  they  therefore  reacted  in  a  defensive  way.  They 
adopted  an  indifferent,  self-contained  posture  to  protect  themselves.  Hav¬ 
ing  suffered  so  many  rejections  in  the  past,  they  attempted  to  block  out 
their  need  for  their  mother  to  avoid  further  disappointment.  And  when  the 
mother  returned  from  the  separation  episodes,  they  refused  to  look  at  her, 
as  if  denying  any  feelings  for  her.  They  behaved  as  if  they  were  saying, 
"Who  are  you?  Am  I  supposed  to  know  you? — you  who  won't  help  me 


61 


Ethological  Theories 


when  I  need  it"  (Ainsworth,  Bell,  &  Stanton,  1971,  p.  47;  Ainsworth  et  al., 
1978,  pp.  241-242,  316). 

Bowlby  (1988,  pp.  124-125)  speculated  that  this  defensive  behavior  can 
become  a  fixed  and  pervasive  part  of  the  personality.  The  child  becomes  an 
adult  who  is  overly  self-reliant  and  detached,  a  person  who  can  never  let 
down  his  or  her  guard  and  trust  others  sufficiently  to  form  close  relationships. 

3.  Insecure-Ambivalent  Infants.  In  the  Strange  Situation,  these  infants 
were  so  clingy  and  preoccupied  with  the  mother's  whereabouts  that  they 
hardly  explored  at  all.  They  became  extremely  upset  when  the  mother  left  the 
room,  and  they  were  markedly  ambivalent  toward  her  when  she  returned. 
At  one  moment  they  reached  out  for  her;  at  the  next  moment  they  angrily 
pushed  her  away. 

In  their  homes,  these  mothers  had  typically  treated  their  babies  in  an 
inconsistent  manner.  The  mothers  had  been  warm  and  responsive  on  some 
occasions  but  not  on  others.  This  inconsistency  had  apparently  left  the  babies 
uncertain  whether  the  mothers  would  be  there  for  them  when  called  on.  As  a 
result,  they  usually  wanted  to  keep  the  mother  close  at  hand — a  desire  that 
intensified  greatly  in  the  Strange  Situation.  These  babies  became  very  dis¬ 
tressed  when  the  mother  left  the  playroom,  and  they  urgently  tried  to  regain 
contact  with  her  when  she  returned,  although  they  also  vented  their  anger 
toward  her.  The  ambivalent  pattern  is  sometimes  called  "resistance"  because 
the  children  not  only  desperately  seek  contact  but  resist  it.  This  pattern  usu¬ 
ally  characterizes  10  to  15%  of  the  1-year-olds  in  U.S.  samples  (Goldberg,  1995; 
van  IJzendoorn  &  Sagi-Schwartz,  2008). 

Disorganized/Disoriented  Infants.  For  some  time,  researchers  found 
that  some  children's  Strange  Situation  behavior  didn't  fit  perfectly  into  the 
three  types.  In  the  late  1980s,  Mary  Main  and  Judith  Solomon  examined  200 
anomalous  cases  and  saw  that  many  of  the  children  exhibited  peculiar  behav¬ 
ior,  especially  when  the  mother  returned  to  the  room.  For  example,  they 
walked  toward  the  mother,  but  with  their  faces  averted,  or  they  froze  in  a 
trance-like  state.  It  seemed  that  the  children  were  at  a  loss  as  to  how  to  act 
because  they  wanted  to  approach  their  mother  but  were  afraid  to  do  so.  To 
classify  such  behavior,  Main  and  Solomon  proposed  a  fourth  category, 
Disorganized/Disoriented,  and  subsequent  research  sometimes  includes  it.  The 
category  generally  captures  about  14  to  24%  of  children  in  the  samples. 
Research  on  the  causes  of  such  fearful  behavior  points  to  the  possibility  of 
physical  abuse  (Lyons-Ruth  &  Jacobvitz,  2008). 

Follow-Up  Studies.  If  the  Strange  Situation  taps  fundamental  differ¬ 
ences  among  children,  it  should  predict  differences  in  their  later  behavior. 
A  number  of  studies  have  found  that  the  infants  classified  as  securely  attached 
in  the  Strange  Situation  have  continued  to  behave  differently  from  the  others 


62 


Ethological  Theories 


in  childhood  and  adolescence.  On  cognitive  tasks,  the  securely  attached  chil¬ 
dren  have  scored  higher  on  measures  of  persistence  and  self-reliance.  In  social 
settings,  such  as  summer  camps,  they  have  received  higher  ratings  on  friend¬ 
liness  and  leadership.  Infant  attachment  alone  doesn't  determine  all  later 
behavior,  of  course.  Other  factors,  such  as  ongoing  family  support,  have  an 
effect.  But  a  secure  attachment  in  infancy  gets  the  child  off  to  a  good  start 
(Weinfield  et  al.,  2008). 

Ainsworth  reported  that  secure  attachment  was  the  product  of  maternal 
sensitivity  to  children's  signals  and  needs.  This  finding  is  theoretically  impor¬ 
tant  because  ethologists  believe  children  have  built-in  gestures  that  must  be 
heeded  for  development  to  unfold  properly.  Ainsworth's  finding  has  been 
replicated  by  other  investigators  with  great  consistency.  In  addition,  interven¬ 
tion  programs  that  increase  mothers'  sensitivity  to  their  children's  cues  do  pro¬ 
mote  more  secure  attachments.  At  the  same  time,  the  estimated  relationship 
between  maternal  sensitivity  and  secure  attachment  is  often  more  modest  than 
attachment  theorists  would  like  to  see.  So  there  is  a  need  for  more  exploration 
of  the  variables  that  foster  secure  attachment  (Belsky  &  Fearon,  2008).  There  also 
is  a  need  to  clarify  the  role  of  fathers  in  the  attachment  process. 

Marinus  van  IJzendoorn  and  Abraham  Sagi-Schwartz  (2008)  have  led 
efforts  to  test  the  cultural  universality  of  Ainsworth's  first  three  patterns.  They 
report  that  the  Strange  Situation  produces  the  same  three  patterns  in  various 
parts  of  the  world,  including  Israel,  Africa,  Japan,  China,  Western  Europe, 
and  the  United  States.  In  all  the  samples,  secure  attachment  is  the  dominant 
type,  but  there  also  are  differences.  The  U.S  and  Western  European  samples 
contain  the  highest  percentages  of  avoidant  children.  Perhaps  the  West's  cul¬ 
tural  emphasis  on  independence  leads  parents  to  rebuff  babies'  needs,  and 
the  babies  defend  themselves  with  avoidant  behavior. 

Working  Models  in  Children  and  Adults.  Attachment  research  has 
been  moving  forward  at  a  rapid  pace,  and  one  of  the  most  popular  topics  is 
that  of  internal  working  models.  Bowlby,  you  will  recall,  conceived  of  the 
working  model  as  the  child's  expectations  and  feelings  about  the  attachment 
figure's  responsiveness.  Because  the  working  model  involves  internal  mental 
events,  it  is  difficult  to  investigate  in  infancy;  we  cannot  interview  babies  about 
their  thoughts  and  feelings.  But  after  the  age  of  3  years  or  so,  research  becomes 
feasible.  Bretherton,  Ridgeway,  and  Cassidy  (1990)  found  that  3-year-olds 
could  complete  stories  about  an  attachment  situation.  They  could  provide 
endings,  for  instance,  to  a  story  about  a  child  who  fell  and  hurt  her  knee  while 
taking  a  walk  with  her  family.  As  predicted,  the  securely  attached  children, 
compared  to  the  others,  most  frequently  depicted  the  parents  in  their  story 
endings  as  responsive  and  helpful  (saying,  for  example,  that  a  parent  will  put 
a  bandage  on  the  child's  knee). 

Adults,  too,  have  developed  thoughts  and  feelings  about  attachment, 
and  their  attitudes  undoubtedly  influence  the  way  they  treat  their  children. 


63 


Ethological  Theories 


Mary  Main  and  her  colleagues  (Main  et  al.,  1985;  Main  &  Goldwyn,  1987) 
interviewed  mothers  and  fathers  about  their  own  early  memories  in  an  Adult 
Attachment  Interview.  Focusing  on  the  openness  and  flexibility  of  the  par¬ 
ents'  responses.  Main  developed  a  typology  that  has  proven  to  correlate  quite 
well  with  children's  classifications  in  the  Strange  Situation  (Hesse,  2008). 
Main's  types  include: 

Secure/autonomous  speakers,  who  talk  openly  and  freely  about  their  own 
early  experiences.  These  parents  tend  to  have  securely  attached  chil¬ 
dren.  Apparently  the  parents'  acceptance  of  their  own  feelings  goes 
hand-in-hand  with  an  acceptance  of  their  infants'  signals  and  needs. 
Dismissing  of  attachment  speakers,  who  talk  as  if  their  own  attachment 
experiences  are  unimportant.  These  parents  tend  to  have  insecure- 
avoidant  children;  the  parents  reject  their  own  experiences  in  much  the 
same  way  that  they  reject  their  infants'  proximity-seeking. 

Preoccupied  speakers,  whose  interviews  suggest  that  they  are  still  strug¬ 
gling,  inwardly  or  outwardly,  to  win  their  own  parents'  love  and 
approval.  It  may  be  their  own  neediness  that  makes  it  difficult  for  them 
to  respond  consistently  to  their  infants'  needs.  (Main  &  Goldwyn,  1987) 

Following  the  introduction  of  the  Disorganized /Disoriented  category 
of  infant  attachment,  researchers  have  looked  for  a  corresponding  pattern  in 
the  Adult  Attachment  Interview.  Investigators  have  found  that  parents  of 
Disorganized /Disoriented  children  sometimes  exhibit  lapses  in  conscious¬ 
ness  and  logical  thinking  (Lyons-Ruth  &  Jacobvitz,  2008).  These  lapses  might 
be  associated  with  outbursts  that  generate  fear  in  their  babies,  but  this  is 
merely  conjecture  at  this  time. 

Several  studies  have  found  that  when  parents  are  interviewed  prior  to 
the  birth  of  their  babies,  their  interview  classifications  correlate  with  their 
babies'  attachment  behavior  in  the  Strange  Situation  at  1  year  of  age.  Gener¬ 
ally,  the  overlap  is  about  70%.  However,  it  has  been  more  difficult  to  find  an 
adult  interview  classification  that  predicts  the  Disorganized /Disorganized 
infant  category  (Main,  1995,  p.  446). 


Practical  Applications  of  the 
Bowlby /Ainsworth  Endeavor 

Institutional  Care.  Bowlby  and  his  colleagues  have  had  a  tremen¬ 
dous  impact  on  child  care  issues. 

Bowlby's  1951  World  Health  Organization  report  significantly  raised 
awareness  with  respect  to  emotional  deprivation  in  orphanages.  This  does 
not  mean  that  countries  have  consistently  taken  steps  to  provide  more  loving 
care,  but  Bowlby  did  a  lot  to  bring  attention  to  the  problem. 


64 


Ethological  Theories 


Bo  w  I  by,  together  with  James  Robertson,  also  battled  against  the  hos¬ 
pital  practice  of  separating  toddlers  and  young  children  from  their  parents. 
On  this  front,  Bowlby  and  Robertson  had  great  success.  True,  health  care 
professionals  initially  resisted  his  recommendations  to  allow  parents  to 
room-in  with  their  children.  But  in  the  1970s  rooming-in  did  become  a  com¬ 
mon  hospital  practice.  Most  hospitals  now  allow  parents  to  stay  with  their 
children  (Karen,  1994,  chap.  6). 

Day  Care.  As  increasing  numbers  of  U.S.  mothers  work  outside  the 
home,  families  are  turning  to  day  care  for  assistance,  and  they  are  placing 
their  children  in  day  care  settings  at  younger  and  younger  ages.  Indeed, 
day  care  for  infants  (children  under  12  months  of  age)  is  already  quite 
common. 

To  some  extent,  day  care  has  become  a  political  issue.  Some  people  argue 
that  day  care  supports  a  woman's  right  to  pursue  a  career.  Others  lobby  for  day 
care  because  it  enables  economically  disadvantaged  parents  to  work  and  make 
more  money.  Nevertheless,  Bowlby  (Karen,  1994,  chap.  22)  and  Ainsworth  (1973, 
p.  70)  have  raised  questions  about  it.  Does  early  day  care  prevent  a  baby  from 
forming  a  bond  with  her  parents?  What  are  the  emotional  effects  of  daily  sep¬ 
arations  from  the  parents  in  the  first  few  years  of  life? 

The  research  on  such  questions  is  still  ongoing  but  it  is  clear  that  even 
young  infants  who  attend  day  care  for  several  hours  a  day  become  pri¬ 
marily  attached  to  their  parents,  not  to  their  day  care  providers  (Clarke- 
Stewart,  1989). 

But  research  does  raise  the  possibility  that  children  who  spend  a  great 
deal  of  time  in  day  care  can  suffer  some  ill  effects.  A  major  study  by  the 
National  Institute  of  Child  Health  and  Human  Development  (NICHD) 
found  that  the  more  time  young  children  spend  in  day  care  up  to  the  age 
of  4  1/2  years,  the  more  likely  the  children  are  to  display  aggressive  and  dis¬ 
obedient  behavior  (2003).  The  NICHD  generally  found  these  effects  to  occur 
regardless  of  the  quality  of  the  day  care  (whether  or  not  the  settings  pro¬ 
vided  lots  of  nurturance  and  individual  attention).  However,  a  more  recent 
study  found  the  relationship  between  time  in  day  care  and  aggressive 
behavior  to  be  modest,  and  high-quality  day  care  diminished  the  adverse 
effects  (McCartney  et  al.,  2010).  Still,  taken  as  a  whole,  the  research  evi¬ 
dence  is  sufficient  to  raise  concerns. 

In  a  sense,  the  search  for  quality  day  care  really  reflects  wider  problems 
in  contemporary  societies,  as  Bowlby  (1988,  pp.  1-3)  and  Ainsworth  (Karen, 
1994,  p.  415)  tried  to  indicate.  In  earlier  village  societies,  parents  could  take 
their  children  to  work  with  them  in  the  fields  or  in  the  shops,  and  parents 
received  a  good  deal  of  child  care  assistance  from  grandparents,  aunts  and 
uncles,  teenagers,  and  friends.  There  was  also  time  for  games  and  socializ¬ 
ing  with  the  children.  In  today's  hectic  world,  the  situation  is  different.  Par¬ 
ents  usually  live  apart  from  their  relatives  and  must  raise  their  children 


65 


Ethological  Theories 


alone,  and  parents  often  come  home  from  work  too  exhausted  to  be  very 
responsive  to  their  children.  Although  quality  day  care  may  seem  desirable, 
what  parents  really  need  are  new  occupational  and  social  arrangements  that 
permit  them  to  spend  considerably  more  relaxed  and  enjoyable  time  with 
their  children. 


A  Child-Centered  Approach  to  Child  Rearing.  Bowlby  (1982,  p.  356) 
said  that  parents  as  well  as  professionals  repeatedly  asked  one  basic  question: 
Should  a  mother  always  meet  her  baby's  demands  for  her  presence  and  atten¬ 
tion?  The  fear  is  that  too  much  attention  will  lead  to  spoiling. 

The  Bowlby/ Ainsworth  position  is  the  same  as  Gesell's.  Evolution  has 
provided  infants  with  signals  and  gestures  that  promote  healthy  development, 
and  it  is  wisest  to  respond  to  them.  As  parents,  we  should  follow  our  impulse 
to  go  to  our  babies  when  they  cry,  to  return  their  smiles,  to  talk  back  when  they 
babble,  and  so  on.  Infants  are  biologically  prepared  to  guide  us  with  respect 
to  the  experiences  they  need,  and  our  relationships  with  them  will  develop 
most  happily  when  we  follow  their  cues. 

As  indicated,  this  position  is  buttressed  by  the  research  of  Ainsworth 
and  others.  Parents  who  respond  sensitively  and  promptly  to  their  infants' 
signals  tend  to  produce  babies  who,  at  1  year  of  age,  are  securely  attached.  In 
home  settings,  these  babies  cry  less  than  other  babies  and  are  relatively  inde¬ 
pendent.  They  seem  to  have  developed  the  feeling  that  they  can  always  get  the 
parents'  attention  when  necessary,  so  they  can  relax  and  explore  the  world. 
Such  infants  do,  to  be  sure,  monitor  the  parents'  whereabouts;  the  attachment 
system  is  too  strong  to  ever  completely  shut  down.  But  even  in  new  settings, 
they  do  not  worry  excessively  about  the  mother's  presence.  Instead,  they  use 
her  as  a  secure  base  from  which  to  explore.  They  venture  away  from  her  to 
investigate  the  surroundings,  and  even  though  they  glance  back  at  her  and 
perhaps  return  to  her  from  time  to  time,  it  is  not  long  before  they  venture  forth 
once  again.  "The  picture,"  Bowlby  said,  is  "that  of  a  happy  balance  between 
exploration  and  attachment"  (1982,  p.  338). 

Parents,  Bowlby  said,  can  in  fact  produce  a  spoiled  or  overmothered 
child.  But  they  do  not  accomplish  this  by  being  too  sensitive  and  responsive 
to  the  baby's  signals.  If  we  look  closely,  we  see  that  the  parent  is  taking  all 
the  initiative.  A  parent  might  insist  on  being  close  to  a  child,  or  showering  the 
child  with  love,  whether  the  child  wants  it  or  not.  The  parent  is  not  taking  his 
or  her  cues  from  the  child  (p.  375). 

In  recent  years,  many  parents  have  found  a  new  way  to  be  intrusive. 
They  provide  their  infants  and  toddlers  with  all  kinds  of  early  stimulation, 
from  flash  cards  to  computers,  in  an  effort  to  accelerate  their  children's  intel¬ 
lectual  development.  Ainsworth  believed  that  such  parental  behavior  is 
unhealthy  because  it  takes  too  much  control  away  from  the  child  (Karen, 
1994,  p.  416). 


66 


Ethological  Theories 


Parents  can  be  more  helpful,  Ainsworth  and  Bowlby  say,  by  giving 
children  opportunities  to  pursue  their  own  interests.  Parents  can  frequently 
do  this  simply  by  being  available  to  the  child,  by  providing  the  child  with 
a  secure  base  from  which  to  explore.  When,  for  example,  a  young  girl  wants 
to  climb  some  large  rocks,  or  wade  into  the  ocean  surf,  the  parent's  pres¬ 
ence  is  necessary  for  the  sake  of  the  child's  safety  and  to  help  out  if  called 
on.  But  the  child  doesn't  want  or  need  the  parent's  supervision  or  instruc¬ 
tions.  All  she  needs  is  the  parent's  patient  availability.  This  alone  gives  her 
the  assurance  she  needs  to  boldly  try  out  new  activities  and  explore  the 
world  on  her  own. 


EVALUATION 

Darwin  argued  that  humans  share  many  emotions  and  cognitive  capaci¬ 
ties  with  other  species,  reflecting  our  common  ancestry.  Darwin's  position 
was  revolutionary  at  the  time,  and  it  still  meets  with  resistance  today.  Many 
scientists  believe  that  our  species  is  vastly  different  from  and  superior  to 
other  animals  (Balcombe,  2006,  pp.  25-27).  Despite  this  sentiment,  Bowlby 
emphasized  the  similarities  between  attachment  behavior  in  humans  and 
other  animals.  When  a  human  child  follows  her  mother  and  cries  out  when 
separated,  the  child  is  engaging  in  behavior  similar  to  that  of  ducklings, 
goslings,  fawns,  young  monkeys  and  chimpanzees,  and  numerous  other 
young  animals. 

Adopting  this  perspective,  Bowlby  cast  children's  behavior  in  a  new 
light.  Prior  to  Bowlby,  people  often  saw  the  child's  need  to  stay  close  to  a  par¬ 
ent  as  merely  babyish  and  immature.  But  Bowlby  suggested  that  it  became 
part  of  our  species'  innate  make-up  because  it  served  the  same  adaptive  func¬ 
tion  as  in  other  species:  It  provided  children  with  protection.  If  human  chil¬ 
dren  had  lacked  the  need  to  maintain  proximity  to  their  parents,  many  of 
them  would  have  died. 

If  a  need  is  part  of  an  organism's  biological  nature,  it  is  important  that 
the  need  be  met.  If  we  meet  a  child's  need  for  nutritious  food,  the  child  grows 
up  healthier  than  if  the  need  is  frustrated.  Bowlby,  Ainsworth,  and  their  col¬ 
leagues  have  tried  to  show  that  the  same  principle  applies  to  attachment. 
When  caregivers  are  available  in  case  their  children  need  them,  and  are  respon¬ 
sive  to  their  children's  cries  and  other  attachment  gestures,  the  children 
develop  well.  They  are  relatively  independent  at  1  year  of  age  and  generally 
approach  life  with  courage  and  initiative  in  the  years  that  follow.  To  be  sure, 
all  the  evidence  isn't  overpowering,  but  it's  largely  consistent  with  the 
Bowlby/ Ainsworth  position. 

This  does  not  mean  that  everyone  agrees  with  the  Bowlby/ Ainsworth 
viewpoint.  Jerome  Kagan  (1984)  has  argued  that  Ainsworth  ignores  the  role 
of  innate  temperament.  Kagan  says  that  the  avoidant  infants,  for  example. 


67 


Ethological  Theories 


ignore  the  mother  in  the  Strange  Situation  not  because  they  are  defending 
themselves  against  rebuffs  but  because  they  are  innately  fearless.  However, 
attachment  theorists  have  mounted  a  good  deal  of  evidence  suggesting  the 
patterns  of  attachment  cannot  be  reduced  to  innate  temperament  (Vaughn, 
Bost,  &  van  IJzendorn,  2008). 

As  attachment  theory  moves  forward,  I  hope  writers  will  clarify  the  rela¬ 
tionship  between  attachment  and  love.  Bowlby  (1979,  p.  130)  and  others  (see 
Feeney,  2008)  sometimes  write  as  if  all  the  nuances  of  love  can  be  reduced  to 
the  attachment  model.  This  is  doubtful.  Love  can  include  sexual  desire,  per¬ 
ceptions  of  beauty,  and  a  host  of  feelings  and  fantasies  that  extend  beyond 
attachment,  which  is  more  limited  to  one's  faith  in  another's  support.  True, 
attachment  and  love  can  overlap,  but  we  need  clear  discussions  of  when  this 
overlap  occurs  and  when  it  does  not. 

Nevertheless,  attachment  theory  has  produced  great  insights.  More¬ 
over,  Bowlby's  general  approach,  which  centers  on  the  continuity  of  human 
behavior  with  that  of  other  animals,  can  be  applied  to  other  areas.  I  will  con¬ 
clude  by  suggesting  how  this  approach  can  deepen  our  understanding  of 
children's  play. 


Extending  Bowlby’s  Approach: 

The  Case  of  Play 

Play,  especially  free,  physically  active  play,  is  endangered  today.  Educational 
policymakers  believe  children  should  be  doing  more  important  things — 
namely,  mastering  academic  skills.  Schools  have  therefore  largely  eliminated 
play  from  kindergartens  (Miller  &  Almon,  2009).  Many  schools  also  have 
eliminated  or  reduced  recess  in  the  elementary  grades.  Parents,  too,  are  often 
willing  to  sacrifice  play  for  early  academic  instruction,  which  they  believe 
will  give  their  children  a  jump-start  on  future  success. 

But  is  children's  play  expendable?  Or  is  it  an  innate  need  that  must  be 
respected  for  children  to  develop  fully? 

First,  let  us  consider  play  in  nonhuman  species.  One  of  the  remarkable 
facts  about  play  is  that  it  is  ubiquitous  in  mammals,  especially  young  mam¬ 
mals.  We  see  it  in  young  chimps,  monkeys,  cats,  dogs,  wolves,  sheep,  goats, 
rats — every  mammal  one  can  think  of.  Play  also  is  common  in  birds.  Even 
octopuses  have  been  seen  at  play  (Balcombe,  2006). 

What's  more,  the  animals  appear  to  be  innately  driven  to  play.  If  you 
have  observed  kittens  or  puppies,  I  bet  this  has  been  your  impression. 
I  was  recently  struck  by  the  play  of  a  baby  goat.  Boomer,  who  was  born  on 
the  farm  animal  sanctuary  my  wife  Ellen  and  I  founded.  Within  10  days 
after  birth,  Boomer  scampered  about  and  performed  jumping  stunts.  He 
climbed  on  rocks  and  tried  jumping  down,  forward  and  backward,  spinning 
in  different  directions  before  he  landed.  When  he  ran  about,  he  periodically 


68 


Ethological  Theories 


leapt  into  the  air  and  threw  his  legs  out  in  new  ways.  All  the  while,  his 
mother  kept  an  eye  on  him  but  she  never  intervened.  I  had  never  seen  the 
other  goats  (all  adults)  engage  in  such  antics.  Boomer  clearly  hadn't  learned 
his  maneuvers  from  the  others.  He  was  inwardly  motivated  to  perform 
them. 

Scholars  have  entertained  various  hypotheses  on  the  adaptive  value  of 
play.  One  key  possibility  is  that  play  develops  the  capacity  to  improvise  and 
therefore  enables  animals  to  handle  unexpected  events.  If  Boomer  had  to  jump 
from  a  rock  to  escape  a  predator,  he  would  have  a  number  of  acrobatic  alter¬ 
natives  at  his  disposal  (Spinka,  Newberry,  &  Bekoff,  2001). 

What,  then,  are  the  implications  for  humans?  In  evolutionary  theory,  the 
fact  that  play  is  found  in  all  other  mammals  is  highly  significant.  It  suggests 
that  the  human  need  to  play  didn't  just  develop  in  our  species'  unique  cultural 
or  evolutionary  history,  after  we  branched  off  from  other  species.  Rather,  the 
need  to  play,  like  much  of  our  physical  structure,  is  rooted  in  the  ancestry  we 
share  with  other  mammals. 

Moreover,  play  in  human  children  probably  has  served  a  similar  adap¬ 
tive  function — the  development  of  the  capacity  to  improvise.  To  be  sure, 
human  children  don't  just  run,  jump,  and  engage  in  physical  play  like  other 
young  animals  do.  Human  children  also  make  use  of  symbolic  fantasy,  as 
when  they  use  sticks  to  represent  people  and  create  imaginary  scenarios.  But 
the  urge  to  improvise — and  to  create  and  to  imagine — has  undoubtedly  helped 
our  species  survive,  and  the  urge  may  be  an  evolutionary  continuation  of  a 
similar  drive  in  other  young  animals. 

If  the  human  child's  play  expresses  an  innate  urge  or  need,  we  should 
see  consequences  of  permitting,  rather  than  frustrating,  it.  Several  studies  sug¬ 
gest  that  preschool  play  enhances  cognitive  capacities  such  as  problem  solv¬ 
ing  and  creativity,  as  well  as  the  ability  to  see  things  from  others'  perspectives 
(Hirsh-Pasek  et  al.,  2009;  Taylor  &  Carlson,  1997).  When  children  are  deprived 
of  play,  they  seem  to  become  depressed  and  stressed  out,  but  more  research 
is  needed  to  document  this  possibility  (Ginsburg,  2007). 

Additional  evidence  that  play  is  an  innate  drive  comes  from  George 
Eisen's  (1990)  little-known  account  of  children  in  the  ghettos  and  in  the  con¬ 
centration  camps  of  the  Holocaust.  One  might  suppose  that  hunger,  anguish, 
and  terror  would  have  completely  suppressed  their  desire  to  play,  but  this 
did  not  happen.  Summarizing  the  diaries  and  reports  of  victims,  Eisen  says, 
"Play  burst  forth  spontaneously  and  uncontrollably  without  regard  to  the 
external  situation"  (1988,  p.  66).  Lacking  manufactured  toys,  the  children  made 
their  own — out  of  mud,  snow,  rags,  and  bits  of  wood.  When  a  skeptical  inter¬ 
viewer  asked  a  little  girl  how  she  could  have  played  in  Auschwitz,  her  face  lit 
up  and  she  said,  "But  I  played!  I  played  with  nothing!  With  the  snow!  With 
the  balls  of  snow!"  (p.  72). 

In  the  Lodz  ghetto,  children  played  games  with  cigarette  boxes,  which 
became  treasures.  One  observer  wrote,  "Children's  eyes  beg  for  those  boxes. 


69 


Ethological  Theories 


children's  hands  reach  out  for  them"  (Eisen,  1988,  p.  69).  Hanna  Levy- Haas, 
an  inmate  of  the  Bergen  Belsen  concentration  camp,  concluded  that  children's 
yearning  for  play  is  an  "instinctual  impulse."  "I  feel,"  she  wrote,  "it  is  an  urge 
that  springs  from  the  soul  of  the  children  themselves"  (pp.  60-61). 

It  seems  quite  possible,  then,  that  the  child's  urge  to  play  is  just  as  innate 
in  the  human  child  as  in  other  animals.  If  so,  educational  policymakers  who 
ignore  it  ignore  a  fundamental  and  creative  aspect  of  our  species. 


70 


Montessori’s 
Educational  Philosophy 


BIOGRAPHICAL  INTRODUCTION 

Most  of  the  developmentalists  we  discuss  in  this  book  had  ideas  on 
education,  but  only  Maria  Montessori  dedicated  herself  to  the  actual 
teaching  of  children.  Montessori  (1870-1952)  was  born  in  the 
province  of  Ancona,  Italy.  Her  father  was  a  successful  civil  servant 
with  traditional  ideas  on  the  role  of  women  in  society.  Her  mother, 
in  contrast,  hoped  that  Montessori  would  go  as  far  as  she  could  in 
life.  It  was  this  hope  that  took  hold.  It  is  said  that  when  Montessori 
was  seriously  ill  as  a  10-year-old,  she  told  her  anxious  mother,  "Don't 
worry.  Mother,  I  cannot  die;  I  have  too  much  to  do"  (Kramer,  1976, 
p.  28).  At  the  age  of  26,  Montessori  became  the  first  woman  physician 
in  Italy's  history. 

Montessori's  first  professional  interest  was  in  mental  retardation. 
She  was  impressed  by  the  extent  to  which  institutionalized  children 
with  this  diagnosis  hungered  for  experience;  she  felt  they  might  be 
teachable  if  the  right  methods  were  used.  She  read  as  much  as  she  could 
find  on  mental  retardation  and  education  in  general  and  found  that 
her  own  intuitions  had  guided  an  earlier  line  of  educators,  including 
Johann  Heinrich  Pestalozzi,  Edouard  Seguin,  and  Friedrich  Froebel — 
educators  who  had  worked  in  the  spirit  of  Rousseau.  Their  writings 
helped  convince  Montessori  that  we  cannot  simply  begin  teaching  chil¬ 
dren  with  developmental  delays  the  things  we  think  they  ought  to 
know,  such  as  reading  and  writing.  This  will  lead  only  to  frustration. 
Instead,  we  must  first  simply  observe  the  children  and  take  note  of 
their  natural  tendencies  and  spontaneous  interests.  Then  we  will  be  in 
a  position  to  take  advantage  of  the  children's  own  natural  inclinations 
and  ways  of  learning.  For  example,  Seguin  found  that  children  with 
developmental  delay,  like  typically  developing  children  at  younger 
ages,  are  most  interested  in  objects  that  stimulate  their  senses  and 


From  Theories  of  Development:  Concepts  and  Applications,  Sixth  Edition.  William 
Crain.  Copyright  ©  2011  by  Pearson  Education,  Inc.  Published  by  Pearson 
Prentice  Hall.  All  rights  reserved. 


71 


Montessori's  Educational  Philosophy 


permit  physical  activity.  Accordingly,  he  gave  them  objects  to  place  in  different¬ 
sized  holes,  beads  to  thread,  pieces  of  cloth  to  button  and  lace,  and  other 
concrete  and  useful  tasks  (Kramer,  1976,  p.  61). 

Montessori  followed  Seguin's  approach,  using  many  of  his  materials 
and  trying  out  new  materials  of  her  own.  To  her  delight,  this  new  approach 
worked,  and  she  ventured  to  teach  more  difficult  matters,  including  reading 
and  writing,  in  the  same  way.  Since  the  children  with  developmental  delay 
seemed  to  learn  best  by  touching  and  feeling  objects,  she  gave  them  wooden 
script  letters  that  they  liked  to  run  their  hands  over  again  and  again.  By  such 
methods,  she  taught  many  of  the  children  to  read  and  write  as  skillfully  as 
typical  school  children  of  the  same  age. 

During  her  work  with  the  children  with  developmental  delay,  Montessori 
worked  closely  with  another  physician.  Dr.  Giuseppe  Montessano,  with  whom 
she  had  a  love  affair.  The  result  was  a  son,  Mario.  Montessori  and  Montessano 
never  married,  apparently  because  his  parents  objected  (Kramer,  1976,  p.  92).  At 
that  time  in  Italy,  news  of  an  illegitimate  child  would  have  ruined  her  career,  so 
she  followed  the  advice  of  her  friends  and  secretly  sent  Mario  to  a  wet  nurse  in 
the  country.  She  did  continue  to  visit  her  son,  who  later  became  an  important  edu¬ 
cator  in  the  Montessori  movement.  Nevertheless,  the  episode  threw  Montessori 
into  a  crisis,  which  she  weathered  by  deepening  her  Catholic  faith. 

In  1907  Montessori  took  over  responsibility  for  educating  children  who 
lived  in  a  tenement  in  the  slums  of  San  Lorenzo,  a  section  of  Rome.  There,  she 
established  a  school  for  over  50  extremely  poor  children — the  sons  and  daugh¬ 
ters  of  unemployed  laborers,  beggars,  prostitutes,  and  criminals.  In  this 
school — called  the  Casa  dei  Bambini,  or  Children's  House — Montessori  con¬ 
tinued  to  develop  her  ideas  and  techniques,  and  she  was  so  successful  that  by 
1913  she  was  one  of  the  most  famous  women  in  the  news.  It  seemed  that  her 
ideas  were  about  to  change  the  course  of  education  throughout  the  world. 
However,  her  ideas  apparently  turned  out  to  be  too  radical  for  the  educational 
mainstream,  and  within  5  years  she  was  all  but  forgotten  except  by  a  small 
band  of  followers.  It  was  not  until  the  1960s  that  her  work  once  again  began 
to  catch  the  attention  of  psychologists,  educators,  and  the  general  public 
(Kramer,  1976;  Lillard,  1972). 


THEORY  OF  DEVELOPMENT 

Although  Montessori's  interests  were  more  practical  than  theoretical,  she  did 
develop  a  definite  theoretical  position,  one  that  owed  much  to  Rousseau.  She 
argued  that  we  are  wrong  to  assume  that  children  are  whatever  we  make 
them,  for  children  also  learn  on  their  own,  from  their  own  maturational 
promptings  (Montessori,  1936a,  p.  22;  1949,  pp.  17,  223).  And,  like  Rousseau, 
she  argued  that  children  often  think  and  learn  quite  differently  from  adults 
(Montessori,  1936b,  p.  69). 


72 


Montessori's  Educational  Philosophy 


A  central  component  of  Montessori's  theory  is  the  concept  of  sensitive 
; periods .  Sensitive  periods  are  similar  to  critical  periods;  they  are  genetically 
programmed  blocks  of  time  during  which  the  child  is  especially  eager  and 
able  to  master  certain  tasks.  For  example,  there  are  sensitive  periods  for  the 
acquisition  of  language  and  for  the  beginning  use  of  the  hand.  During  these 
periods,  the  child  works  with  all  her  might  at  perfecting  these  abilities.  And, 
"if  the  child  is  prevented  from  enjoying  these  experiences  at  the  very  time 
when  nature  has  planned  for  him  to  do  so,  the  special  sensitivity  which 
draws  him  to  them  will  vanish,  with  a  disturbing  effect  on  development" 
(Montessori,  1949,  p.  95). 


The  Sensitive  Period  for  Order 

During  the  first  sensitive  period,  which  takes  place  primarily  during  the  first 
3  years,  the  child  has  a  strong  need  for  order.1  As  soon  as  children  can  move 
about,  they  like  to  put  objects  where  they  belong;  if  a  book  or  a  pen  is  out  of 
place,  they  resolutely  put  it  back.  And  even  before  this,  they  often  become 
upset  at  the  sight  of  something  out  of  order.  Montessori  told,  for  example,  of 
a  6-month-old  girl  who  cried  when  a  visitor  put  an  umbrella  on  the  table.  The 
girl  looked  at  the  table  and  cried  for  some  time.  She  became  calm  only  when 
the  mother,  with  a  flash  of  insight,  put  the  umbrella  on  the  rack  where  it 
belonged  (Montessori,  1936b,  p.  50). 

To  us,  such  reactions,  which  are  quite  common,  seem  silly.  This  is  because 
the  adult  need  for  order  is  on  a  different  plane.  For  the  adult,  order  provides 
a  certain  measure  of  external  pleasure,  but  for  the  young  child,  it  is  essential. 
"It  is  like  the  land  upon  which  animals  walk  or  the  water  in  which  fish  swim. 
In  their  first  year  [infants]  derive  their  principles  of  orientation  from  their 
environment  which  they  must  later  master"  (p.  53). 


The  Sensitive  Period  for  Details 

Between  1  and  2  years  of  age,  children  fix  their  attention  on  minute  details.  For 
example,  they  detect  small  insects  that  escape  our  notice.  Or,  if  we  show  them 
pictures,  they  seem  to  disregard  the  main  objects,  which  we  consider  impor¬ 
tant,  and  focus  instead  on  tiny  objects  in  the  background.  This  concern  for 
details  signals  a  change  in  children's  psychic  development.  Whereas  they 
were  at  first  attracted  to  gaudy  objects  and  brilliant  lights  and  colors,  they  are 
now  trying  to  fill  in  their  experience  as  completely  as  possible.  To  adults,  the 
small  child's  concern  for  the  minutest  details  is  perplexing.  It  is  further  evi¬ 
dence  that  a  child's  "psychic  personality  is  far  different  from  our  own,  and  it 
is  different  in  kind  and  not  simply  in  degree"  (Montessori,  1936b,  p.  69). 

'Montessori  was  rather  vague  about  the  ages  of  her  sensitive  periods,  so  the  ages  listed  in 
this  chapter  are  not  definite. 


73 


Montessori's  Educational  Philosophy 


The  Sensitive  Period  for  the  Use  of  Hands 

A  third  sensitive  period  involves  the  use  of  the  hands.  Between  about  18  months 
and  3  years  of  age,  children  are  constantly  grasping  objects.  They  particularly 
enjoy  opening  and  shutting  things,  putting  objects  into  containers  and  pour¬ 
ing  them  out,  and  piling  objects  up  (Montessori,  1936b,  p.  83).  During  the  next 
2  years  or  so,  they  refine  their  movements  and  their  sense  of  touch.  For  ex¬ 
ample,  4-year-olds  enjoy  identifying  objects  by  touching  them  with  their  eyes 
closed — a  game  that  has  far  greater  interest  for  the  child  than  the  adult 
(Montessori,  1948a,  pp.  127,  229). 


The  Sensitive  Period  for  Walking 

The  most  readily  visible  sensitive  period  is  for  walking.  Learning  to  walk, 
Montessori  said,  is  a  kind  of  second  birth;  the  child  passes  from  a  helpless  to 
an  active  being  (Montessori,  1936b,  p.  77).  Children  are  driven  by  an  irre¬ 
sistible  impulse  in  their  attempts  to  walk,  and  they  walk  about  with  the  great¬ 
est  pride  as  they  learn  how. 

We  frequently  fail  to  realize  that  walking,  like  other  behaviors,  means 
something  different  to  the  child  than  it  does  to  us.  When  we  walk,  we  have  a 
destination  in  mind;  we  wish  to  get  somewhere.  The  toddler,  in  contrast,  walks 
for  the  sake  of  walking.  For  example,  the  child  may  walk  up  and  down  the 
staircase,  over  and  over.  The  child  does  not  walk  to  get  somewhere,  but  to 
"perfect  his  own  functions,  and  consequently  his  goal  is  something  creative 
within  himself"  (p.  78). 


The  Sensitive  Period  for  Language 

A  fifth  sensitive  period — and  perhaps  the  most  remarkable  one  of  all — 
involves  the  acquisition  of  language.  What  is  remarkable  is  the  speed  with 
which  children  learn  such  a  complex  process.  To  learn  a  language,  children 
must  learn  not  just  words  and  their  meanings,  but  a  grammar,  a  system  of 
rules  that  tells  them  where  to  place  the  various  parts  of  speech.  If,  for  ex¬ 
ample,  we  say,  "The  tumbler  is  on  the  table,"  the  meaning  we  give  those  words 
derives  from  the  order  in  which  we  say  them.  If  we  had  said,  "On  tumbler  the 
is  table  the,"  our  meaning  would  have  been  hard  to  grasp  (Montessori,  1949, 
p.  25).  The  rules  underlying  grammars  are  so  elusive  and  abstract  that  lin¬ 
guistic  scholars  are  still  trying  to  understand  them  in  a  formal  way.  Yet  chil¬ 
dren  master  them  without  much  thinking  about  it.  If  a  child  is  exposed  to  two 
languages,  the  child  masters  them  both  (p.  111). 

Because  the  child's  ability  to  grasp  language  is  so  great,  Montessori  con¬ 
cluded  that  the  child  must  be  endowed  with  a  special  kind  of  language  recep¬ 
tivity  or  "mechanism"  (p.  113).  This  mechanism  is  very  different  from  anything 
in  the  mental  life  of  the  older  child  or  the  adult.  Whereas  we  learn  a  second 


74 


Montessori's  Educational  Philosophy 


language  with  great  deliberation,  consciously  struggling  to  memorize  rules 
regarding  tenses,  prefixes,  modifiers,  and  so  on,  the  child  absorbs  language 
unconsciously. 

From  Montessori's  descriptions,  the  child's  language  acquisition  sounds 
very  much  like  a  kind  of  imprinting.  At  a  certain  critical  time — from  the  first 
few  months  of  life  until  2  72  or  3  years — children  are  innately  prepared  to 
absorb  sounds,  words,  and  grammar  from  the  environment.  "The  child  absorbs 
these  impressions  not  with  his  mind,  but  with  his  life  itself"  (p.  24).  Sounds 
create  impressions  of  incredible  intensity  and  emotion;  they  must  set  in  motion 
invisible  fibers  in  the  child's  body,  fibers  that  start  vibrating  in  the  effort  to 
reproduce  those  sounds  (p.  24).  We  adults  can  hardly  imagine  what  this  expe¬ 
rience  is  like,  except  perhaps  by  recalling  the  feeling  we  get  when  we  are  pro¬ 
foundly  moved  by  a  symphony,  and  then  imagining  a  similar  feeling  that  is 
several  times  stronger.  This  particular  sensitivity  for  language  comes  into  play 
during  the  first  3  years  or  so,  and  then  is  gone. 

Montessori  suggested  that  because  language  acquisition  is  governed  by 
innate,  maturational  factors,  children  develop  language  in  the  same  stages  no 
matter  where  they  grow  up  (p.  111).  For  example,  they  all  proceed  from  a  stage 
of  babbling  to  a  stage  where  they  begin  speaking  words.  Next,  they  enter  a  stage 
in  which  they  put  two-word  sentences  together  (e.g.,  "Boy  go"),  and  there  fol¬ 
lows  a  period  in  which  they  master  increasingly  complex  sentence  structures. 

These  stages,  Montessori  emphasized,  do  not  emerge  in  a  gradual,  con¬ 
tinuous  manner.  Instead,  there  are  several  times  during  which  the  child  seems 
to  be  making  no  progress,  and  then  new  achievements  come  in  explosions.  For 
example,  the  child  bursts  out  with  a  number  of  new  words,  or  suddenly  mas¬ 
ters  a  set  of  rules  for  forming  parts  of  speech,  such  as  suffixes  and  prefixes,  in 
a  sudden  explosion  (p.  114). 

Between  the  ages  of  about  3  and  6  years,  children  no  longer  absorb  words 
and  grammar  unconsciously,  but  they  still  are  in  the  general  sensitive  period 
for  language.  During  this  time  they  are  more  conscious  of  learning  new  gram¬ 
matical  forms  and  take  great  delight  in  doing  so  (see  Figure  1). 


Figure  1 

Some  early  sensitive  periods. 


0 

1  yr  2  yrs  3  yrs 

Walking 

Concern  for  details 

Need  for  order 

4  yrs  5  yrs  6  yrs 

Unconscious  grasp  of  language 

Conscious  grasp  of  language 

Use  of  hand;  Refinement  of  hand  movements  and  touch 

75 


Montessori’s  Educational  Philosophy 


By  the  time  the  child  is  5  or  6,  then,  and  is  ready  for  the  traditional  school, 
the  child  has  already  learned  to  talk.  "And  all  this  happens  without  a  teacher. 
It  is  a  spontaneous  acquisition.  And  we,  after  he  has  done  all  this  by  himself, 
send  him  to  school  and  offer  as  a  great  treat,  to  teach  him  the  alphabet!"  (p.  115). 
We  are  also  so  presumptuous  as  to  focus  on  the  child's  defects,  which  are 
trivial  in  comparison  to  the  child's  remarkable  achievements.  We  see  how 
adults  assume  that  what  they  teach  the  child  amounts  to  everything  and  how 
they  grossly  underestimate  the  child's  capacity  to  learn  on  her  own. 


EARLY  EDUCATION  IN  THE  HOME 

At  various  sensitive  periods,  then,  children  are  driven  by  an  inner  impulse  to 
independently  master  certain  experiences.  The  goal  of  education  is  to  assist 
this  process.  Since  children  do  not  ordinarily  enter  nursery  or  Montessori 
schools  until  they  are  2  or  3  years  old,  parents  and  caretakers  are  really  the  first 
educators. 

To  be  of  help,  we  do  not  necessarily  need  a  formal  knowledge  of  child 
psychology.  What  we  need  is  a  certain  attitude.  We  need  to  realize  that  it  is  not 
our  job  to  direct  our  children's  learning,  for  we  must,  above  all,  respect  their 
efforts  at  independent  mastery.  We  must  have  faith  in  their  powers  of  inner 
construction.  At  the  same  time,  we  do  not  have  to  simply  ignore  or  neglect  our 
children.  What  we  can  do  is  give  them  the  opportunities  to  learn  what  is  most 
vital  to  them.  We  can  watch  for  their  spontaneous  interests  and  give  them  the 
chance  to  pursue  them. 

For  example,  Montessori  (1936b,  p.  49)  told  about  a  nurse  who  pushed  her 
5-month-old  girl  in  the  carriage  through  the  garden.  Each  day,  the  girl  was 
delighted  to  see  a  white  marble  stone  cemented  to  an  old  gray  wall.  Apparently 
the  girl  took  pleasure  in  her  discovery  that  the  stone  was  in  the  same  place;  she 
was  developing  her  sense  of  order  in  the  world.  In  any  case,  the  nurse,  noting 
the  girl's  interest,  stopped  each  day  to  permit  the  child  to  look  at  the  sight.  The 
nurse  did  not  just  push  the  girl  along  at  her  own  pace,  but  let  the  infant's  spon¬ 
taneous  interest  guide  her.  She  was  not  teaching  the  child  in  the  ordinary  sense, 
but  she  was  behaving  like  the  ideal  teacher.  She  was  giving  the  baby  the  oppor¬ 
tunity  to  make  whatever  spontaneous  connection  she  was  working  on. 

To  take  another  example,  parents  can  help  their  children  during  the  sen¬ 
sitive  period  for  walking.  Some  parents  enjoy  following  their  child  about  as  he 
or  she  masters  this  new  skill.  These  parents  follow  their  children  as  they  walk 
and  stop  with  them  when  they  stop  to  examine  new  sights.  They  also  give 
their  children  time  to  master  new  aspects  of  walking,  such  as  stair-climbing. 
They  follow  their  children's  own  rhythms  and  enjoy  watching  the  pride 
children  take  in  mastering  new  skills  (chap.  11). 

Other  parents,  however,  fail  to  give  their  children  full  opportunities  to 
master  walking  on  their  own  and  in  their  own  way.  Some  try  to  teach  the  child 


76 


Montessori's  Educational  Philosophy 


to  walk — a  practice  that  probably  gives  the  child  the  sense  that  his  or  her  own 
efforts  are  inadequate.  Or  parents  fail  to  realize  what  walking  means  to  the 
child;  they  assume  the  child,  like  themselves,  wants  to  get  somewhere.  So 
they  pick  up  their  children  and  carry  them,  or  push  them  in  strollers,  so  as  to 
reach  their  destination  more  rapidly.  Or  parents  become  afraid  of  where  the 
child's  walking  may  lead,  so  they  surround  the  child  with  safeguards,  such  as 
playpens  (chap.  11). 

Children,  of  course,  do  eventually  learn  to  walk,  but  the  parental  reac¬ 
tions  affect  the  children's  feelings  about  their  inner  rhythms  and  indepen¬ 
dence.  In  one  case,  they  gain  the  feelings  of  freedom  and  pride  that  come  from 
mastering  an  important  skill  on  one's  own.  In  the  other  case,  they  find  that 
their  own  efforts  at  mastery  produce  negative  reactions.  The  result  may  be  a 
lingering  inhibition  with  respect  to  one's  inner  promptings.  It  is  possible  that 
later  athletic  ability  and  physical  grace  are  related  to  the  manner  in  which 
children  first  learn  to  walk. 

Once  the  child  can  walk  easily,  she  can  venture  outdoors  and  explore  the 
natural  settings  around  her.  Montessori  was  deeply  impressed  by  the  extent  to 
which  nature  invigorates  the  child.  Hiking  with  parents  through  parks  or  mea¬ 
dows  or  climbing  hills,  2-year-olds  show  amazing  energy  and  stamina;  they 
happily  cover  distances  the  adults  wouldn't  have  imagined  possible.  Natural 
settings  also  stimulate  the  young  child's  powers  of  observation.  While  on  a 
walk,  the  child  will  frequently  stop  to  examine  a  brook,  an  animal,  or  a  fallen 
branch  for  long  stretches  of  time,  completely  absorbed  in  quiet  contemplation. 
When  young  children  are  given  opportunities  to  freely  explore  and  study 
nature,  they  become  happy  and  serene.  Contact  with  nature  seems  to  fulfill  a 
vital  emotional  need  (Montessori,  1948a,  chap.  4). 


THE  MONTESSORI  SCHOOL 

When  children  are  about  2  1  2  years  old,  they  can  enter  a  Montessori  school.  There, 
they  learn  in  the  same  class  with  children  up  to  age  6  or  so — approximately  the 
same  age  range  as  in  Montessori's  Children's  House.  Increasingly,  Montesso- 
rians  are  opening  schools  so  that  children  can  continue  with  Montessori's  more 
advanced  methods — sometimes  even  through  high  school.  But  the  ages  are 
still  mixed  (e.g.,  6  to  9)  because  Montessori  found  that  children  enjoy  this 
arrangement. 


Independence  and  Concentration 

The  goal  of  education  in  the  Montessori  school  is  the  same  as  that  in  the  home. 
The  teacher  does  not  try  to  direct,  instruct,  drill,  or  otherwise  take  charge  of  the 
child;  instead,  the  teacher  tries  to  give  the  child  opportunities  for  independent 
mastery.  The  assumption  is  that  if  the  school  environment  contains  the  right 


77 


Montessori’s  Educational  Philosophy 


materials — those  that  correspond  to  the  children's  inner  needs  at  various 
sensitive  periods — the  children  will  enthusiastically  work  on  them  on  their 
own,  without  adult  supervision. 

To  create  the  right  environment,  Montessori  first  spent  considerable  time 
simply  observing  children's  behavior  with  respect  to  various  materials.  She 
then  retained  those  that  the  children  themselves  told  her  were  the  most  valu¬ 
able  to  them.  They  told  her  this  in  a  rather  dramatic  way;  when  they  came 
across  materials  that  met  deep,  inner  needs,  they  worked  on  them  with  amaz¬ 
ing  concentration. 

Montessori  first  became  aware  of  the  child's  capacity  for  concentrated 
effort  when  she  saw  a  4-year-old  girl  in  the  Children's  House  working  on 
cylinders.  That  is,  the  girl  was  placing  different-sized  cylinders  in  the  holes 
of  a  wooden  frame  until  she  had  them  all  in  place  (see  Figure  2).  Then  she 
would  take  them  out  again,  mix  them  up,  and  start  over.  All  the  while  she 
was  oblivious  to  the  world  around  her.  After  she  had  repeated  this  exercise  14 


Figure  2 

A  boy  works  on  wooden  cylinders. 

(St.  Michael's  Montessori  School,  New  York  City,  Haledjian 
photo.) 


78 


Montessori's  Educational  Philosophy 


times,  Montessori  decided  to  test  her  concentration.  She  had  the  rest  of  the 
class  sing  and  march  loudly,  but  the  girl  simply  continued  with  her  work. 
Montessori  then  lifted  the  girl's  chair — with  the  child  in  it — onto  a  table.  But 
the  girl  merely  gathered  up  her  cylinders  in  her  lap  and  kept  on  working, 
hardly  aware  of  the  disturbance.  Finally,  after  42  repetitions,  the  child  stopped 
on  her  own,  as  if  coming  out  of  a  dream,  and  smiled  happily  (Montessori, 
1936b,  p.  119). 

After  that,  Montessori  observed  the  same  phenomenon  on  countless 
occasions.  When  given  tasks  that  met  inner  needs  at  sensitive  periods,  the 
children  worked  on  them  over  and  over.  And  when  they  finished,  they  were 
rested  and  joyful;  they  seemed  to  possess  an  inner  peace.  It  seemed  that  chil¬ 
dren  were  achieving,  through  intense  work,  their  true  or  normal  state;  Montes¬ 
sori  therefore  called  this  process  normalization  (Montessori,  1949,  p.  206).  She 
then  made  it  her  goal  to  create  the  most  favorable  environment  for  this  kind 
of  concerted  effort. 


Free  Choice 

In  preparing  her  environment,  Montessori  tried  to  suspend  her  own  ideas 
about  what  children  should  learn  and  to  see  what  they  selected  when  given 
a  free  choice.  Their  free  choices,  she  learned,  usually  led  to  work  on  the  tasks 
that  most  deeply  engrossed  them.  For  example,  she  noticed  that  the  2-year-olds, 
when  free  to  move  around  in  the  room,  were  constantly  straightening  things 
up  and  putting  them  in  order.  If,  for  example,  a  glass  of  water  slipped  from  a 
child's  hands,  the  others  would  run  up  to  collect  the  broken  pieces  and  wipe 
the  floor  (Montessori,  1936b,  p.  121).  What  she  observed  was  their  need  for 
order.  Accordingly,  she  altered  the  environment  so  they  could  fulfill  this  need. 
She  made  small  washbasins  so  the  children  could  wash  their  hands  and 
brushes;  she  made  small  tables  and  chairs  so  they  could  arrange  them  just 
right;  and  she  lowered  the  cupboards  so  they  could  put  their  materials  away 
where  they  belonged.  In  this  way,  activities  of  daily  living  became  part  of  the 
curriculum.  All  the  children  enjoyed  these  activities,  but  the  2-year-olds  took 
them  the  most  seriously.  They  constantly  inspected  the  room  to  see  if  any¬ 
thing  was  out  of  place.  For  them,  ordering  the  environment  met  the  deepest 
inner  need  (Montessori,  1948a,  p.  48). 

Today,  the  core  Montessori  materials  are  largely  set,  but  the  teacher  still 
relies  heavily  on  the  principle  of  free  choice.  Each  child  goes  to  the  cupboard 
and  selects  the  apparatus  that  she  wants  to  work  on.  The  teacher  has  faith 
that  the  children  will  freely  choose  the  tasks  that  meet  their  inner  needs  at  the 
moment. 

Although  the  teacher  permits  free  choice,  the  teacher  will  from  time  to 
time  introduce  a  new  task  to  a  child  who  seems  ready  for  it.  This  is  done  most 
delicately.  The  teacher  presents  the  material  clearly  and  simply  and  then  steps 
back  to  observe  the  child's  behavior.  The  teacher  watches  for  concentration  and 


79 


Montessori's  Educational  Philosophy 


repetition.  If  the  child  does  not  seem  ready  for  the  new  task,  it  is  put  aside  for 
another  day.  The  teacher  must  be  careful  to  avoid  giving  the  impression  that 
the  child  "ought"  to  learn  a  particular  task;  this  would  undermine  the  child's 
ability  to  follow  her  own  tendencies.  If  the  child  does  begin  to  work  actively 
on  the  material,  the  teacher  moves  away  and  lets  the  child  work  indepen¬ 
dently  (Lillard,  1972,  pp.  65-68). 

The  teacher's  attitude,  Montessori  said,  is  essentially  a  passive  one — 
that  of  an  observer  (Montessori,  1936a,  p.  39).  He  or  she  spends  most  of  the 
time  simply  watching  the  children,  trying  to  guess  each  one's  particular  needs 
and  state  of  readiness. 


Rewards  and  Punishments 

The  Montessori  teacher,  then,  is  not  so  much  a  director  but  a  follower.  It  is  the 
child  who  leads  the  way,  revealing  what  she  most  needs  to  work  on.  In  this, 
the  Montessori  teacher  behaves  very  differently  from  the  typical  teacher,  who 
has  set  goals  for  the  children  and  tries  to  take  charge  of  their  education. 

The  typical  teacher  often  finds  that  children  lack  enthusiasm  for  the 
things  they  are  asked  to  learn.  The  teacher  therefore  relies  heavily  on  external 
rewards  and  punishments — praise,  grades,  threats,  and  criticism.  Yet  these 
external  inducements  often  seem  to  backfire.  Quite  often,  children  become  so 
concerned  with  external  evaluations — so  afraid  of  getting  wrong  answers  and 
looking  stupid — that  they  cannot  concentrate  deeply  on  their  work.  Driven  by 
such  pressure,  they  will  learn  a  certain  amount  of  material,  but  they  can  eas¬ 
ily  come  to  dislike  school  and  the  learning  process  (Holt,  1964;  Montessori, 
1948a,  p.  14). 

Equally  damaging,  external  evaluations  rob  children  of  their  indepen¬ 
dence.  Children  soon  begin  looking  to  external  authorities,  such  as  the  teacher, 
to  know  what  they  should  do  and  say.  Montessori  felt  that  authorities  use 
rewards  and  punishments  primarily  to  make  the  child  submissive  to  their 
will.  Like  Rousseau,  she  wondered  how  a  child  who  becomes  anxious  about 
external  approval  will  ever  learn  to  think  independently  or  will  ever  dare  to 
criticize  the  conventional  social  order  (Montessori,  1948a,  pp.  14-18). 

Thus  rewards  and  punishments  have  no  place  in  the  Montessori  class¬ 
room.  Montessori  teachers  trust  that  if  they  pay  attention  to  children's  spon¬ 
taneous  tendencies,  they  can  find  the  materials  on  which  children  will  work 
intently  on  their  own.  The  children  will  do  so  out  of  an  inherent  drive  to  per¬ 
fect  their  capacities,  and  external  inducements  will  become  superfluous. 

The  traditional  teacher  often  justifies  reward  and  criticism  as  necessary 
because  children  need  to  know  when  they  are  right  or  wrong.  Montessori 
agreed  that  children  need  to  learn  from  their  errors,  but  she  did  not  want  the 
children  to  have  to  turn  to  adults  for  this  information.  Accordingly,  she  devel¬ 
oped  many  materials  with  a  built-in  control  of  error.  For  example,  the  cylin¬ 
ders,  which  teach  spatial  dimensions,  have  this  control.  If  a  child  has  not  put 


80 


Montessori's  Educational  Philosophy 


each  cylinder  in  the  proper  hole,  there  will  be  one  cylinder  left  over.  When 
children  see  this,  their  interest  is  heightened.  They  then  figure  out  how  to 
correct  the  matter  on  their  own. 


Gradual  Preparation 

Montessori  found  that  children  cannot  learn  many  skills  all  at  once.  For  ex¬ 
ample,  4-year-olds  often  desperately  want  to  learn  to  button  their  coats  and 
tie  their  own  shoes,  as  a  consequence  of  their  natural  urge  toward  indepen¬ 
dence,  but  these  tasks  are  too  difficult  for  them.  They  lack  the  fine  motor  skills. 

To  deal  with  such  problems,  Montessori  developed  materials  that  would 
enable  the  children  to  learn  skills  in  steps,  at  levels  they  could  master.  In  the 
case  of  shoe-tying,  she  developed  a  large  tying  frame  (see  Figure  3)  so  the 
children  could  practice  the  correct  tying  pattern  with  grosser  muscle  move¬ 
ments  (Montessori,  1948a,  p.  93).  She  also  utilized  the  principle  of  indirect 
preparation  (p.  224).  That  is,  she  gave  them  unrelated  tasks,  such  as  cutting 
vegetables  (see  Figure  3)  and  holding  a  pencil,  through  which  they  could 
simultaneously  perfect  their  dexterity.  Then,  when  the  children  decided  to 
attempt  to  tie  their  own  shoes,  they  could  readily  do  so,  for  they  had  gradu¬ 
ally  mastered  all  the  necessary  subskills. 


Reading  and  Writing 

I  have  mentioned,  by  way  of  illustration,  some  of  the  tasks  that  are  part  of  the 
Montessori  method  (e.g.,  the  cylinders  and  the  exercises  of  daily  living).  We 
cannot  review  every  component  of  the  Montessori  curriculum  in  this  book,  but 
I  will  indicate  how  Montessori  approached  one  important  area:  reading  and 
writing.2 

Montessori  found  that  if  one  begins  at  the  age  of  about  4  years,  children 
will  learn  to  read  and  write  with  great  enthusiasm.  This  is  because  they  are  still 
in  the  general  sensitive  period  for  language.  They  have  just  mastered  lan¬ 
guage  unconsciously  and  are  now  eager  to  learn  all  about  it  on  a  more  con¬ 
scious  level,  which  reading  and  writing  permit  them  to  do.  If,  in  contrast,  one 
waits  until  the  age  of  6  or  7  years  to  teach  written  language,  the  task  is  more 
difficult  because  the  sensitive  period  for  language  has  already  passed  (p.  276). 

Four-year-olds  usually  master  writing  before  reading.  This  is  because 
writing  is  the  more  concrete  and  sensory  activity  and  therefore  better  suits 
the  young  child's  style  of  learning  (p.  233).  Still,  one  cannot  teach  writing  all 
at  once.  If  one  asks  4-year-olds  to  make  a  sound  and  write  it,  they  will  be 
unable  to  do  so;  one  must  introduce  writing  through  a  series  of  separate 
preparatory  exercises. 

2For  a  summary  of  the  method  for  teaching  arithmetic,  see  Montessori,  1948a,  chaps. 
18  and  19. 


81 


Montessori’s  Educational  Philosophy 


Figure  3 

Children  at  work  on  a  tying  frame  and  an  exercise  of  daily  living. 
(St.  Michael's  Montessori  School,  New  York  City,  Haledjian  photo.) 


82 


Montessori's  Educational  Philosophy 


First,  the  child  is  shown  how  to  hold  a  pencil  and  then  practices  draw¬ 
ing  by  staying  within  outlines.  Children  love  to  practice  drawing  as  precisely 
as  possible,  for  they  are  in  the  sensitive  period  for  precise  hand  movements. 
They  also  have  been  mastering  hand-eye  coordination  through  exercises  of 
daily  living,  such  as  cutting  vegetables,  pouring  water,  and  polishing  silver. 

In  another  exercise,  children  trace  their  fingers  over  sandpaper  letters 
that  are  pasted  onto  blocks  of  wood  (see  Figure  4).  For  example,  they  make  the 
"m"  sound  and  trace  it  as  they  do  so.  The  letters  are  written  in  script,  rather 
than  print,  because  children  find  the  movements  of  script  freer  and  more  nat¬ 
ural.  Through  this  exercise,  then,  they  learn  to  make  the  movements  of  the 
letters.  They  love  repeating  this  exercise,  for  they  are  still  in  the  sensitive  peri¬ 
ods  for  learning  about  sounds  and  refining  their  sense  of  touch.  Frequently 
they  like  to  close  their  eyes  and  trace  the  letters  with  their  fingers  alone.  Six- 


Figure  4 

A  girl  works  on  sandpaper  letters. 

(St.  Michael's  Montessori  School,  New  York  City,  Haledjian 
photo.) 


83 


Montessori’s  Educational  Philosophy 


year-olds,  in  contrast,  derive  no  particular  pleasure  from  the  sandpaper  letters, 
for  they  have  already  moved  out  of  the  sensitive  period  for  touch.  The  letters, 
incidentally,  have  a  built-in  control  of  error,  since  the  child  can  tell  when  her 
finger  has  strayed  off  the  letter  and  onto  the  wood  because  the  wood  feels 
different  (p.  229). 

In  a  third  exercise,  children  are  given  a  moveable  alphabet  that  permits 
them  to  form  the  letters  of  words.  For  example,  they  look  at  a  picture  of  a  cat, 
sound  out  the  letters,  and  then  make  the  word  with  the  letters.  This,  too,  they 
repeat  endlessly,  out  of  their  spontaneous  interest  in  the  elements  of  spoken 
language  (pp.  234-237). 

Through  these  and  other  separate  exercises,  then,  children  learn  the  var¬ 
ious  skills  involved  in  writing.  When  they  finally  put  these  skills  together  and 
begin  to  write  letters,  there  usually  follows  an  "explosion  of  writing."  They 
will  write  all  day  long  (p.  239). 

Writing  paves  the  way  for  reading.  Through  writing,  children  form  a  mus¬ 
cular  and  visual  memory  of  the  letters  and  words  and  therefore  can  recognize 
them.  Consequently,  the  5-  or  6-year-old  who  has  learned  to  write  can  usually 
learn  to  read  with  very  little  help  from  the  teacher  (Lillard,  1972,  p.  122).  Children 
often  say  that  nobody  taught  them  to  read  at  all.  Montessori  did  aid  the  process, 
though.  Her  essential  method  was  to  show  a  word  printed  on  a  card,  ask  the 
child  to  sound  it  out,  and  then  ask  the  child  to  sound  it  out  more  quickly.  In  most 
cases,  children  rapidly  catch  on  and  begin  reading  words  on  their  own. 

During  the  entire  preparatory  period  for  writing  and  reading,  the  chil¬ 
dren  do  not  even  look  at  a  book.  Then,  when  they  first  pick  a  book  up,  they 
can  usually  begin  reading  it  immediately.  Consequently,  they  avoid  all  the 
frustrating  experiences  that  children  so  often  associate  with  books.  There  fol¬ 
lows  an  "explosion  of  reading."  Children  delight  in  reading  everything  they 
see  (Montessori,  1948a,  p.  253). 

The  sensitive  care  with  which  Montessori  prepared  each  small  step  is 
impressive.  The  exercises  are  arranged  so  that  each  comes  easily  to  the  child, 
for  each  corresponds  to  the  child's  natural  way  of  learning.  Montessori  noted 
that  her  method  contrasts  sharply  with  that  of  most  teachers,  who  simply  give 
children  lessons  and  then  spend  most  of  their  time  criticizing  them  for  their 
mistakes.  Criticism,  Montessori  felt,  is  humiliating  and  pointless.  Instead  of 
criticizing,  which  only  tears  down,  the  teacher  should  figure  out  ways  of  help¬ 
ing  children  build  their  skills  (Montessori,  1949,  p.  245). 


Misbehavior 

We  have  emphasized  how  Montessori  teachers  prize  the  child's  independence — 
how  they  avoid  imposing  expectations  on  the  child,  or  even  praising  or  criti¬ 
cizing  the  child.  This  is  true  with  respect  to  intellectual  work.  Moral  misconduct 
is  another  matter.  Children  are  not  permitted  to  abuse  the  materials  or  their 
classmates. 


84 


Montessori's  Educational  Philosophy 


In  the  Montessori  school,  respect  for  the  materials  and  for  others  usually 
develops  quite  naturally.  The  children  know  how  important  the  work  is  for 
themselves,  so  they  respect  the  work  of  the  other  children.  If  they  do  bother 
a  child  who  is  in  deep  concentration,  the  child  usually  insists  on  being  left 
alone  in  such  a  way  that  they  automatically  respect  this  wish.  Sometimes, 
though,  the  teacher  must  intervene.  Montessori  (1948a,  p.  62)  recommended 
isolating  the  child  for  a  moment.  In  this  way,  the  child  has  a  chance  to  see  the 
value  of  the  work  for  others  and  to  sense  what  he  or  she  is  missing.  The  child 
will  then  begin  constructive  work  without  any  further  prompting. 

In  general,  the  Montessori  view  of  discipline  is  different  from  that  of 
most  teachers,  who  think  that  it  is  their  job  to  gain  control  over  the  class. 
They  shout:  "I  want  everyone  in  their  seats!"  "Didn't  you  hear  what  I  just 
told  you?"  "If  you  don't  behave  this  instant  you  won't  go  out  for  recess!" 
The  Montessori  teacher  is  not  interested  in  such  obedience.  Real  discipline 
is  not  something  imposed  from  without,  from  threats  or  rewards,  but  some¬ 
thing  that  comes  from  within,  from  the  children  themselves  as  they  "pass 
from  their  first  disordered  movements  to  those  that  are  spontaneously 
regulated"  (p.  56). 

Misbehavior,  in  Montessori's  view,  usually  indicates  that  the  children 
are  unfulfilled  in  their  work.  Accordingly,  one's  task  is  not  to  impose  one's 
authority  on  the  children  but  to  observe  each  child  more  closely,  so  one  will 
be  in  a  better  position  to  introduce  materials  that  will  meet  his  or  her  inner 
developmental  needs.  The  teacher  expects  a  certain  amount  of  restlessness 
and  distracted  behavior  during  the  first  days  of  the  year,  but  once  the  chil¬ 
dren  settle  into  their  work  they  become  so  absorbed  in  it  that  discipline  is 
rarely  a  problem. 


Nature  in  Education 

So  far  I  have  described  Montessori  education  as  if  it  occurs  completely  indoors. 
Actually,  Montessori  believed  that  even  though  children  go  to  school,  they 
still  need  rich  contact  with  nature  outdoors.  In  making  this  point,  she  believed 
she  was  bucking  a  modern  trend.  Modem  societies  devalue  nature.  They  have 
built  artificial  indoor  environments  that  make  us  feel  so  safe  and  comfortable, 
we  don't  realize  the  extent  to  which  we  have  lost  our  connection  to  the  soil, 
plants,  wildlife,  and  the  elements.  We  do  not  realize  how  much  our  lives  have 
become  impoverished  because  of  this  loss,  and,  more  tragically,  we  overlook 
the  importance  of  nature  for  children  (chap.  4). 

The  child,  Montessori  said,  has  a  stronger  affinity  for  nature  than  we  do 
and  benefits  more  fully  from  rich  contact  with  it.  In  natural  settings,  children 
spontaneously  become  quiet  and  watchful,  developing  strong  powers  of 
patient  observation.  They  also  benefit  emotionally.  The  sight  of  a  flower,  an 
insect,  or  an  animal  fills  the  child  with  joy  and  wonder,  and  as  the  child 
contemplates  such  things,  she  develops  a  love  of  life  (pp.  70-71). 


85 


Montessori’s  Educational  Philosophy 


Box  1  Two  6-Year-Old  Boys' Views  on  School  Matters 


Note  the  differences  in  the  role  of  the  teacher  in  the  minds  of  these  two  children. 

1.  Who  taught  you  to  read? 

Regular  School  Child:  "My  teacher." 

Montessori  Child:  "Nobody,  I  just  read  the  book,  and  to  see  if 

I  could  read  it." 

2.  Do  you  get  to  work  on  anything  you  want? 

Regular  School  Child:  "No.  But  we  can  go  to  the  bathroom  any¬ 

time  we  want.  But  we're  not  allowed  to  go 
to  the  bathroom  more  than  four  times." 

Montessori  Child:  "You  can  work  on  anything  you  want." 

3.  What  would  happen  if  you  bothered  another  kid  who  was  working? 

Regular  School  Child:  "I'd  get  in  trouble  from  the  teacher." 

Montessori  Child:  "He'll  just  say,  'Please  go  away.  I'm  busy.'" 

(What  would  you  do?)  "I'd  just  go  away, 
'cause  I  don't  want  to  bother  someone 
working." 


Montessori  didn't  commit  herself  to  the  precise  ages  at  which  the  child 
is  especially  attuned  to  nature,  but  she  suggested  that  this  special  sensitivity 
lasts  at  least  until  adolescence  (Montessori,  1948b,  p.  35).  In  any  case,  she 
believed  it  is  terrible  that  modern  life  separates  children  from  nature  so  thor¬ 
oughly  that  their  powers  of  observation  and  feelings  of  love  for  the  world  just 
wither  away. 

In  cities,  it  is  particularly  difficult  to  bring  children  into  contact  with 
untamed  nature,  so  Montessori  relied  on  gardening  and  animal  husbandry, 
which  she  introduced  in  the  Children's  House  (ages  3  to  6)  and  continued  to  pro¬ 
vide  in  the  elementary  school  years  (Montessori,  1909,  chap.  10;  1948a,  p.  75). 
These  activities  help  children  develop  several  important  virtues.  One  is  respon¬ 
sibility.  Without  any  prodding,  children  diligently  and  lovingly  water  seedlings 
and  care  for  animals.  Children  also  learn  patient  foresight.  They  see  how  plants 
grow  in  their  season  and  learn  to  wait  for  life  to  unfold  according  to  its  own  tim¬ 
ing.  Finally,  children  strengthen  their  feeling  for  nature.  As  they  help  things  live 
and  grow,  they  develop  the  sense  that  they  are  a  part  of  living  creation,  a  part 
of  something  much  larger  than  themselves.  They  grow  spiritually. 

Fantasy  and  Creativity 

Montessori  was  critical  of  attempts  to  enrich  children's  fantasy  lives  through 
fairy  tales,  fables,  and  other  fanciful  stories.  She  saw  fantasy  as  the  product 
of  a  mind  that  has  lost  its  tie  to  reality  (Montessori,  1917,  p.  255). 


86 


Montessori's  Educational  Philosophy 


Montessori's  position  on  fantasy  would  appear  to  contradict  one  of  her 
most  basic  tenets — namely,  that  we  should  follow  children's  natural  inclina¬ 
tions.  She  acknowledged  that  children  have  a  natural  bent  toward  fantasy.  As 
she  put  it,  the  child's  "mentality  differs  from  ours;  he  escapes  from  our 
strongly  marked  and  restricted  limits,  and  loves  to  wander  in  the  fascinating 
worlds  of  unreality''  (p.  255).  But  she  wanted  to  help  the  child  overcome  these 
tendencies.  When  we  read  children  fairy  tales  or  tell  them  about  Santa  Claus, 
we  only  encourage  their  credulity.  When  they  hear  these  stories,  furthermore, 
their  basic  attitude  is  passive;  they  simply  take  in  the  impressions  we  give 
them.  They  believe  fantastic  things  because  they  have  not  yet  developed  their 
powers  of  discrimination  and  judgment.  And  it  is  just  these  powers  that  they 
need  to  build. 

Montessori  did  recognize  the  uses  of  a  creative  imagination,  such  as  that 
possessed  by  the  artist.  But  the  artist's  creativity,  she  maintained,  is  always  tied 
to  reality.  The  artist  is  more  aware  of  forms,  colors,  harmonies,  and  contrasts 
than  we  are.  If  we  wish  children  to  become  creative,  then,  we  must  help  them 
refine  such  powers  of  discrimination  (pp.  250-251). 

When  it  came  to  drawing,  for  example,  Montessori  recognized  that  chil¬ 
dren  have  a  strong  inner  urge  to  draw,  but  she  didn't  encourage  their  "free 
drawing."  Instead,  she  tried  to  help  them  discriminate  among  forms  and  col¬ 
ors  through  activities  such  as  filling  in  insets  and  cutting  colored  paper. 
Montessori  didn't  actually  suppress  children's  free  drawing,  but  her  own 
goal  was  to  enhance  children's  powers  of  observation  and  discrimination 
(Montessori,  1948a,  chap.  20)T 


Elementary  and  Secondary  Education 

Montessori  is  best  known  for  the  methods  she  developed  for  the  Children's 
House,  for  children  3  to  6  years  of  age.  These  are  the  ages  of  the  sensitive  peri¬ 
ods  and  the  unique  power  to  absorb  impressions  in  such  a  powerful  way.  But 
Montessori  also  developed  fairly  detailed  programs  for  the  elementary  school 
years  (ages  6  to  12)  and  outlined  general  ideas  for  education  in  the  adoles¬ 
cent  and  young  adult  years.  In  recent  decades,  increasing  numbers  of  ele¬ 
mentary  schools,  middle  schools,  and  even  some  high  schools  have  developed 
Montessori  programs. 

Montessori's  philosophical  approach  to  elementary  and  later  education 
was  the  same  as  that  with  respect  to  young  children.  She  didn't  believe  that 
education  should  begin  with  adults'  ideas  about  what  children  should  learn 
(Lillard,  1996,  p.  75).  When  adult  goals  dominate,  too  many  lessons  have  noth¬ 
ing  to  do  with  children's  own  developing  needs  and  interests:  "We  make  them 
listen  when  they  have  no  desire  to  hear,  write  when  they  have  nothing  to  say. 


3For  a  discussion  of  instruction  in  music,  see  Montessori,  1948a,  chap.  21. 


87 


Montessori’s  Educational  Philosophy 


observe  when  they  have  no  curiosity"  (Montessori,  1917,  p.  269).  Instead,  edu¬ 
cation  should  continue  to  nourish  the  vital  growth  forces  at  work  within  the 
child.  The  growing  child  has  an  inner  need — indeed  a  yearning — for  certain 
activities  to  develop  herself,  and  we  should  make  these  activities  available. 

Elementary  Education  (ages  6  to  12).  At  the  age  of  6  or  7  years,  chil¬ 
dren's  developing  needs  do  undergo  a  major  shift.  Before  this,  their  deepest 
needs  were  to  develop  personal  capacities  such  as  walking,  language,  and  the 
senses.  Now,  they  become  more  intellectual  and  their  focuses  turn  outward. 
Children  want  to  learn  all  there  is  to  know  about  the  world,  including  the 
social  world  and  what  is  right  and  wrong.  They  want  to  understand  why 
things  are  as  they  are  and  gain  some  mastery  over  the  world.  In  this,  they  are 
quite  ambitious.  They  aren't  interested  in  isolated  skills  and  information,  as 
taught  in  textbooks  and  workbooks;  rather,  they  want  to  understand  the  world 
in  a  full  way — to  grasp  the  big  picture. 

Montessori  therefore  introduced  a  series  of  stories,  under  the  heading  of 
the  "cosmic  plan,"  which  tells  about  the  beginning  of  the  earth,  the  origins  of 
life,  early  humans,  the  growth  of  technology,  and  so  on.  These  stories  aren't 
meant  to  hand  down  the  ultimate  truth,  but  to  excite  the  child's  imagination 
and  stimulate  the  child  to  ask  questions  and  do  research  to  find  answers.  For 
example,  the  child  might  want  to  know  how  early  peoples  made  their  clothes 
and  what  food  they  ate.  As  with  younger  children,  the  Montessori  school 
respects  the  child's  inner  urge  to  find  answers  and  figure  things  out  for  her¬ 
self  (Lillard,  1996,  chap.  4;  Montessori,  1948a,  pp.  4, 15). 

Six-  to  12-year-olds  also  wish  to  explore  the  world  by  physically  mov¬ 
ing  away  from  family  and  school.  To  meet  this  need,  Montessori  proposed 
activities  she  called  "going  out"  expeditions.  The  child,  usually  with  two  or 
three  others,  carries  out  research  in  the  community.  The  children  might  visit 
museums,  zoos,  a  planetarium,  ponds,  libraries,  artists'  studios,  or  botanical 
gardens.  The  range  is  wide.  Typically,  the  children  go  on  their  own — without 
the  teacher — although  the  teacher  lets  relevant  people  in  the  community  know 
the  children  may  be  coming.  She  also  may  give  the  children  safety  instruc¬ 
tions  and  perhaps  a  letter  of  introduction.  The  teacher  creates  a  safe  and  favor¬ 
able  environment  for  exploration,  but  the  children  choose  the  expeditions  and 
conduct  their  investigations  on  their  own  (Lillard,  1996,  chap.  7). 

Secondary  School.  Montessori  didn't  fully  develop  educational  meth¬ 
ods  for  the  secondary  school  years,  but  she  did  offer  some  thoughts  (e.g., 
Montessori,  1948b).  She  believed  that  the  adolescent  has  a  deep,  personal  need 
to  improve  society,  but  the  young  person  also  is  plagued  by  the  self-doubts  that 
characterize  this  stage.  Perhaps  the  single-best  means  of  gaining  confidence, 
Montessori  said,  is  through  real,  meaningful  work — work  in  which  students 
engage  in  cooperative  business  ventures.  Because  adolescents  still  have  a  feel¬ 
ing  for  nature,  an  ideal  kind  of  work  is  farming,  and  young  people  should 


88 


Montessori's  Educational  Philosophy 


take  as  much  responsibility  for  running  a  farm  as  possible.  As  an  alternative, 
teenagers  might  run  a  hotel  in  the  countryside.  They  could  figure  out  expenses, 
fees,  guest  schedules,  publicity,  and  so  forth.  Students  can  learn  a  considerable 
amount  of  academic  material  through  such  economic  ventures  (e.g.,  math 
through  hotel  accounting),  and  real  work  gives  adolescents  a  feeling  of  worth. 
In  today's  Montessori  secondary  schools,  educators  make  room  for  business 
activities  such  as  running  salad  bars  and  shops  (Coe,  1996). 

Montessori  definitely  favored  rustic  settings,  where  young  people  can 
breathe  pure  air,  get  good  exercise,  and  maintain  their  feelings  for  nature.  But 
she  also  valued  technological  innovation  and  wanted  teenagers  to  understand 
how  modern  farming  techniques  and  other  machinery  contribute  to  civiliza¬ 
tions.  Indeed,  she  thought  that  teenagers  can  gain  feelings  of  self-esteem  by 
identifying  with  the  technological  progress  of  the  human  race  (Montessori, 
1948b,  pp.  117-118). 


EVALUATION 

A  cornerstone  of  developmental  or  child-centered  education  is  a  faith  in  the 
child — or,  better  put,  a  faith  in  nature's  laws  guiding  the  child  from  within. 
Rousseau,  Pestalozzi,  Gesell,  and  others  made  this  point.  Adults  shouldn't 
constantly  set  goals  and  try  to  influence  children;  they  should  try  to  provide 
tasks  that  give  children  opportunities  to  pursue  their  naturally  emerging  inter¬ 
ests.  Before  Montessori,  however,  no  one  knew  how  much  children  seem  to 
need  such  tasks,  or  how  much  energy  they  will  pour  into  them.  In  the  Chil¬ 
dren's  House,  3-  to  6-year-olds  freely  chose  certain  tasks  and  worked  on  them 
with  the  deepest  concentration.  And  when  they  finished,  they  emerged  happy, 
refreshed,  and  serene.  They  seemed  at  peace  because  they  had  been  able  to 
develop  themselves.  This  intensity  of  concentration  seems  to  be  especially 
great  in  the  first  6  years  of  life,  but  Montessori  believed  all  education  should 
consider  what  children  themselves  are  most  eager  to  learn. 

How  effective  is  Montessori  education?  In  my  experience,  people  who 
have  visited  Montessori  schools,  or  have  children  in  them,  are  impressed.  At 
the  early  level  (ages  3  to  6  years),  people  are  typically  struck  by  the  quiet  dig¬ 
nity  of  the  classroom.  The  atmosphere  is  often  like  that  of  a  monastery,  with 
everyone  so  seriously  at  work.  No  teacher  is  shouting,  and  the  children  are 
respectful  of  one  another.  Parents  see  their  children  becoming  increasingly 
independent  and  loving  school.  With  respect  to  elementary  school  classes, 
parents  and  visitors  are  again  impressed  by  children's  purposefulness. 

Psychologists  want  to  know,  however,  about  the  empirical  research  on 
the  effectiveness  of  Montessori  education.  Good  studies  are  scarce,  and  they 
are  not  terribly  conclusive,  but  they  generally  indicate  that  Montessori 
preschools  advance  children's  test  scores  about  as  well  or  better  than  other 
preschool  programs.  Montessori  children  may  read  and  spell  particularly  well. 


89 


Montessori's  Educational  Philosophy 


But  researchers  have  generally  been  more  impressed  by  the  attitudes  that 
Montessori  schools  foster — concentration,  confidence,  and  independence 
(Chattin-McNichols,  1992;  Evans,  1975,  pp.  270-275;  Kahn,  1993,  p.  18;  Miller 
&  Dyer,  1975).  One  study  that  included  both  5-  and  12-year-olds  found  that 
Montessori  schools  fostered  greater  creativity  as  well  as  greater  respect  for 
peers  (Lillard  &  Else-Quest,  2006). 

If  Montessori  were  to  hear  of  this  pattern  of  results,  she  probably  would 
be  pleased.  Her  primary  goal  was  not  high  scores  on  achievement  tests  but 
positive  attitudes.  If  children  in  Montessori  schools  typically  learn  to  read  and 
write  at  an  early  age,  this  is  fine,  but  in  terms  of  her  overall  philosophy,  it  is 
just  a  fortunate  happenstance.  Montessori  chose  to  teach  writing  and  reading 
to  4-year-olds  only  because  they  revealed  an  inner  urge  to  write  at  this  young 
age.  If  she  had  found  no  such  urge  until,  say,  age  10,  she  would  not  have 
taught  it  until  then.  She  did  not  want  to  impose  tasks  on  children  just  because 
adults  are  anxious  that  they  learn  them  as  soon  as  possible.  She  cared  little 
about  how  rapidly  children  learn  standard  skills  or  about  advancing  them 
along  the  ladder  of  achievement  tests.  Rather,  she  was  concerned  with  chil¬ 
dren's  attitudes  toward  learning.  She  wanted  to  unharness  their  natural  love 
for  learning  and  their  capacities  for  concerted  and  independent  work,  which 
unfold  according  to  an  inner  timetable.  As  she  once  said. 

My  vision  of  the  future  is  no  longer  of  people  taking  exams  and  pro¬ 
ceeding  on  that  certificate  from  the  secondary  school  to  the  University, 
but  of  individuals  passing  from  one  stage  of  independence  to  a  higher, 
by  means  of  their  own  activity,  through  their  own  effort  of  will,  which 
constitutes  the  inner  evolution  of  the  individual.  (Montessori,  1936,  cited 
in  Montessori,  1970,  p.  42) 

Although  Montessori  is  well  known  as  a  teacher,  she  is  underestimated  as  an 
innovative  theoretician.  She  anticipated  much  that  is  current  in  developmen¬ 
tal  thinking.  For  one  thing,  she  was  among  the  first  to  argue  for  the  possibil¬ 
ity  of  sensitive  or  critical  periods  in  intellectual  development.  Even  more 
impressive  were  her  insights  into  language  acquisition.  Early  on,  she  sug¬ 
gested  that  children  unconsciously  master  complex  grammatical  rules  and 
must  possess  an  innate  mechanism  that  enables  them  to  do  so — ideas  that 
anticipated  the  work  of  Chomsky. 

Montessori  also  was  among  the  first  to  call  attention  to  the  child's  need 
for  contact  with  nature.  She  said  children  are  especially  attuned  to  nature  and 
benefit  from  rich  exposure  to  it.  She  didn't  specify  a  precise  sensitive  period 
when  this  is  so,  but  she  believed  children  need  experience  with  nature  to 
develop  their  powers  of  observation  and  other  qualities,  such  as  a  feeling  of 
connection  to  the  living  world.  Today,  we  find  such  thoughts  among 
researchers  advancing  the  "biophilia  hypothesis"  (Wilson,  1993).  These  schol¬ 
ars  speculate  that  if  by  some  age  children  don't  develop  a  feeling  for  nature. 


90 


Montessori's  Educational  Philosophy 


this  feeling  will  never  take  hold.  I  should  add,  though,  that  the  number  of 
scholars  and  researchers  investigating  such  possibilities  is  still  very  small. 
Most  research  seems  guided  by  our  modern  society's  general  assumption  that 
a  feeling  for  nature  isn't  terribly  important.  What  counts  is  the  child's  social 
development  and  the  intellectual  skills  she  will  need  for  the  indoor  high-tech 
workplace.  Montessori  was  among  the  few  scholars  ever  to  take  the  child's  tie 
to  nature  seriously  (Crain,  1997). 

What  are  the  criticisms  of  Montessori?  Dewey  (Dewey  &  Dewey,  1915) 
thought  the  Montessori  teacher  sometimes  limits  the  child's  freedom  and  cre¬ 
ativity.  When,  in  particular,  a  child  finds  an  apparatus  too  difficult  and  there¬ 
fore  plays  with  it  in  some  new  way  (e.g.,  rolling  cylinders),  the  teacher  will 
suggest  working  on  something  else.  The  child  is  not  allowed  to  innovate. 
Montessori  teachers  respond  that  children  inwardly  feel  inadequate  with 
respect  to  such  tasks  and  will  feel  far  more  creative  working  on  tasks  for  which 
they  are  ready.  Still,  the  teachers  hope  the  times  they  must  intervene  are  few. 

More  generally,  Montessori  had  little  patience  for  many  of  the  more 
expressive,  emotional  aspects  of  childhood.  She  not  only  discouraged  free 
play  in  the  classroom,  but  fantasy  and  free  drawing  as  well.  Until  the  ele¬ 
mentary  years,  even  social  interactions  aren't  particularly  prominent  in  the 
classroom.  Early  Montessori  education  has  an  impersonal,  matter-of-fact  qual¬ 
ity.  Children  become  deeply  absorbed  in  their  work,  which  is  extremely  mean¬ 
ingful  to  them,  but  Montessori  might  have  given  more  recognition  to  young 
children's  social,  imaginative,  and  artistic  development. 

In  the  case  of  drawing,  Montessori  overlooked  the  remarkable  qualities 
of  children's  works.  Young  children's  spontaneous  drawing  goes  through 
phases  when  it  is  fresh,  lively,  and  beautifully  organized  (Gardner,  1980). 
Montessori  recognized  the  natural  impulse  to  draw  in  the  young  child  and 
didn't  want  to  hinder  it,  but  she  overlooked  its  natural  blossoming. 

I  believe  Montessori  also  was  wrong  about  fairy  tales.  Montessori  said 
that  fairy  tales  and  imaginary  stories  encourage  the  child  to  depart  from  real¬ 
ity.  She  also  believed  fairy  tales  force  children  into  passive  listening,  a  state  in 
which  they  merely  receive  impressions  from  adults.  But  Bettelheim's  (1976) 
book  on  fairy  tales  makes  a  strong  case  for  a  different  view.  Bettelheim  argued 
that  the  fairy  tales  do  not  really  teach  children  to  believe  in  imaginary  hap¬ 
penings  because  children  know  the  fairy  tale  is  make-believe.  The  stories 
themselves  make  this  point  with  their  opening  lines — "Once  upon  a  time," 
"In  days  of  yore  and  times  and  tides  long  ago,"  and  so  on  (p.  117).  Children 
intuitively  understand  that  the  story  addresses  itself  not  to  real,  external 
events,  but  to  the  inner  realm  of  secret  hopes  and  anxieties.  For  example, 
"Hansel  and  Gretel"  deals  with  the  child's  fear  of  separation  and  does  so  in  a 
way  that  points  to  a  solution.  It  indirectly  encourages  children  to  become  inde¬ 
pendent  and  use  their  own  intelligence. 

Furthermore,  the  process  of  listening  to  a  fairy  tale  may  be  much  more 
active  than  Montessori  realized.  When  children  listen  to  a  story,  they  interpret 


91 


Montessori’s  Educational  Philosophy 


it  in  their  own  way  and  fill  in  the  scenes  with  their  own  images.  When  a  story 
speaks  to  an  issue  with  which  the  child  is  inwardly  struggling,  the  child  wants 
to  hear  it  over  and  over,  much  as  Montessori  children  work  repeatedly  on 
external  exercises.  And,  finally,  children  often  emerge  from  the  story  in  a  state 
of  calm  and  peace,  as  if  they  have  resolved  some  issue.4 

Montessori,  then,  may  have  undervalued  some  components  of  the 
childhood  years,  such  as  play,  drawing,  and  fairy  tales.  But  whatever 
Montessori  may  have  overlooked,  her  oversights  are  minor  in  comparison 
to  her  contributions.  Montessori,  as  much  or  more  than  anyone,  demon¬ 
strated  how  the  developmental  philosophies  of  Rousseau,  Gesell,  and  oth¬ 
ers  can  be  put  into  practice.  She  showed  how  it  is  possible  to  follow 
children's  spontaneous  tendencies  and  to  provide  materials  that  will  per¬ 
mit  them  to  learn  independently  and  with  great  enthusiasm.  Montessori 
was  one  of  history's  great  educators. 


4The  process  of  listening  to  a  fairy  tale  seems  much  more  active,  for  example,  than  most 
television  watching.  Television  itself  usually  supplies  the  child  with  all  the  images. 


92 


Werner’s  Organismic 
and  Comparative  Theory 


BIOGRAPHICAL  INTRODUCTION 

Heinz  Werner  (1890-1964)  was  born  and  grew  up  in  Vienna,  Austria. 
He  was  a  studious  boy  who  also  loved  music,  taking  up  the  violin  when 
he  was  7  years  old.  After  completing  the  Gymnasium  (roughly  the 
equivalent  to  our  high  school),  Werner  thought  briefly  about  becoming 
an  engineer,  but  he  changed  his  mind  and  entered  the  University  of 
Vienna,  hoping  to  become  a  composer  and  a  music  historian.  At  the 
university,  however,  his  interests  quickly  broadened  to  include  phi¬ 
losophy  and  psychology.  This  change  began  one  day  when  he  mis¬ 
takenly  went  to  the  wrong  lecture  hall.  He  had  thought  he  was 
attending  a  music  class  but  found  himself  listening  to  a  lecture  on  the 
philosophy  of  Immanuel  Kant.  Since  he  thought  it  would  be  too 
embarrassing  to  walk  out,  he  stayed,  and  he  became  so  engrossed  in 
the  topic  that  he  soon  decided  to  major  in  philosophy  and  psychology 
(the  two  fields  were  still  combined).  Still,  Werner's  interest  in  music 
remained,  and  he  wrote  his  doctoral  dissertation  on  the  psychology  of 
aesthetic  enjoyment. 

In  1917  Werner  joined  the  Psychological  Institute  at  Hamburg, 
where  he  participated  in  lively  discussions  about  a  new  psycholo¬ 
gical  movement:  Gestalt  psychology.  Gestalt  psychologists  argued 
that  when  we  perceive  things,  we  perceive  whole  forms,  gestalts, 
which  cannot  be  analyzed  in  terms  of  their  separate  elements.  In 
Figure  1,  for  example,  we  directly  perceive  circles,  and  it  does  not 
matter  whether  the  circles  are  comprised  of  dots  or  dashes.  There  is 
a  sense  in  which  the  circle  is  a  whole  pattern  that  is  more  than  its 
parts. 

Gestalt  psychologists  went  on  to  assert  that  our  experience  of 
forms  is  governed  by  organizing  forces  in  the  central  nervous  sys¬ 
tem,  and  they  tried  to  show  the  principles  by  which  these  forces  work. 


From  Theories  of  Development:  Concepts  and  Applications,  Sixth  Edition.  William 
Crain.  Copyright  ©  2011  by  Pearson  Education,  Inc.  Published  by  Pearson 
Prentice  Hall.  All  rights  reserved. 


93 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


Figure  1 

An  example  of  Gestalt  perception:  We  perceive  both  forms  as  circles 
despite  their  different  elements. 


One  principle  is  closure,  a  tendency  to  complete  patterns.  Figure  2,  for  exam¬ 
ple,  is  not  perceived  merely  as  two  lines  but  as  a  triangle  with  pieces  miss¬ 
ing.  We  tend  to  perceive  it  as  a  whole,  meaningful  pattern. 

Although  Werner  was  strongly  influenced  by  Gestalt  psychology,  it  was 
not  the  Gestalt  psychology  with  which  we  are  familiar.  That  form  was  brought 
here  by  Max  Wertheimer,  Kurt  Koffka,  and  Wolfgang  Kohler,  who  gave  us 
examples  like  those  just  mentioned.  These  psychologists  were  sometimes 
called  the  Berlin  School.  Werner  identified  more  closely  with  the  Leipzig 
School  of  Felix  Krueger,  Friedrich  Sander,  and  others — people  who  are  still 
hardly  known  in  the  United  States.  The  Leipzig  School  agreed  with  the  gen¬ 
eral  Gestalt  principles,  but  it  believed  the  Berlin  orientation  was  not  genuinely 
holistic  because  it  focused  too  narrowly  on  perception  instead  of  on  the  whole, 
acting,  feeling  organism.  The  Leipzig  School  was  also  more  developmentally 
oriented.  As  we  shall  see,  the  Leipzig  viewpoint  had  a  strong  influence  on 
Werner's  organismic-developmental  writings. 

Werner's  years  at  Hamburg  were  extremely  productive,  and  it  was  there 
that  he  published  the  first  edition  (1926)  of  his  famous  book.  Comparative 
Psychology  of  Mental  Development  (2nd  edition,  1948).  This  book  was  a  bold. 


Figure  2 

The  Gestalt  principle  of  closure:  We  tend  to 
close  or  complete  figures  into  whole  patterns. 


94 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


sweeping  venture.  In  it,  Werner  tried  to  show  how  the  concept  of  develop¬ 
ment,  properly  defined,  could  be  used  to  compare  patterns  found  in  humans 
across  various  cultures  and  even  between  humans  and  other  species. 

In  1933  Werner  was  dismissed  from  Hamburg  by  the  Nazis  because  he 
was  Jewish.  He  spent  a  few  months  in  Holland  and  then  came  to  the  United 
States,  where  he  held  a  number  of  positions,  including  that  of  research  psy¬ 
chologist  at  the  Wayne  County  Training  School  in  Michigan.  There,  between 
1936  and  1943,  he  did  a  great  deal  of  research  on  developmentally  delayed 
and  brain- injured  children.  In  1943  Brooklyn  College  gave  him  his  first  full¬ 
time  teaching  position  in  the  United  States,  assigning  him  to  what  we  would 
now  consider  the  ridiculously  low  rank  of  instructor.  Werner  was  simply  not 
recognized  here  as  the  great  theorist  he  was. 

But  he  continued  with  his  work,  and  in  1947  Clark  University  hired  him 
as  a  professor  of  psychology  and  education.  At  Clark  he  found  a  true  intel¬ 
lectual  home,  working  with  sympathetic  colleagues  and  inspired  students. 
Former  students  remember  Werner  as  a  formal  but  kindly  man  who  was 
extremely  open-minded  and  had  a  rare  ability  to  draw  out  the  best  in  his  stu¬ 
dents  (Franklin,  2004;  Witkin,  1965). 1 


WERNER’S  VIEW  OF  DEVELOPMENT 

Werner  wanted  to  tie  development  to  both  an  organismic  and  a  comparative 
orientation.  We  first  review  his  conception  of  development  and  then  relate  it 
to  these  two  orientations. 

Psychologists  usually  talk  about  development  in  loose  ways,  but  Werner 
believed  the  concept  needed  a  precise  definition.  Development,  he  argued, 
refers  to  more  than  the  passage  of  time;  we  may  grow  older  but  without  devel¬ 
oping.  Furthermore,  development  refers  to  more  than  increases  in  size;  we 
may  grow  taller  or  fatter,  but  such  growth  is  not  necessarily  developmental. 
Development  involves  changes  in  structure,  which  may  be  defined  according 
to  the  orthogenic  principle: 

Whenever  development  occurs,  it  proceeds  from  a  state  of  relative  lack 
of  differentiation  to  a  state  of  increasing  differentiation  and  hierarchic 
integration.  (Werner  &  Kaplan,  1956,  p.  866) 

Let  us  look  at  these  two  concepts — differentiation  and  hierarchic 
integration — more  closely.  Differentiation  occurs  when  a  global  whole  separates 
into  parts  with  different  forms  or  functions.  For  example,  the  embryo  begins 
as  a  global  unit  that  separates  into  different  organs,  such  as  the  brain,  heart. 


'Margery  Franklin  and  Joseph  Glick  provided  helpful  comments  and  recollections  for  this 
biographical  introduction. 


95 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


liver,  and  kidney.  Similarly,  the  fetus's  motor  activity  becomes  more  differen¬ 
tiated  when  its  limbs  and  trunk  no  longer  all  move  together  in  one  "mass 
action"  but  move  separately. 

As  behavior  becomes  differentiated,  it  also  becomes  hierarchically  inte¬ 
grated.  That  is,  behaviors  come  under  the  control  of  higher  regulating  centers. 
In  the  fetus,  for  example,  limb  and  trunk  movements  become  not  only  more 
differentiated  but  also  more  fluid  and  coordinated  as  they  come  under  the 
control  of  higher  organizing  circuits  in  the  central  nervous  system  (Hofer, 
1981,  pp.  97-100). 

The  orthogenic  principle  describes  behavior  in  many  realms.  For  example, 
when  children  begin  to  draw,  they  first  make  the  same  kinds  of  back-and-forth 
movements,  producing  circular  scribbles.  Their  drawing  becomes  more  dif¬ 
ferentiated  as  they  experiment  with  different  kinds  of  strokes.  We  also  see 
hierarchic  organization  when  their  drawing  comes  under  the  control  of  their 
plans.  Instead  of  drawing  away  and  deciding  what  it  looks  like  afterward, 
they  start  off  with  a  plan  or  image  that  guides  their  strokes. 

The  orthogenic  principle  applies  to  personality  development,  too.  For 
example,  adolescents  differentiate  between  the  goals  they  want  to  pursue  in 
life  and  those  they  do  not.  The  goals  they  select  then  assume  hierarchical  con¬ 
trol  over  much  of  their  daily  behavior.  A  girl  who  decides  to  become  a  doctor, 
for  instance,  will  organize  many  of  her  daily  activities  with  this  goal  in  mind. 
Until  young  people  do  settle  on  their  goals,  they  often  feel  their  lives  lack 
coherence  and  structure.  They  complain  they  cannot  find  themselves.  They 
need  a  purpose  to  guide  them. 


A  Major  Theme:  Self-Object  Differentiation 

Werner  wrote  extensively  on  the  many  applications  of  the  orthogenic  prin¬ 
ciple.  However,  he  was  particularly  interested  in  the  process  of  self-object  dif¬ 
ferentiation,  the  gradual  process  by  which  children  separate  themselves  from 
the  environment.  This  process  often  seems  to  progress  through  three  levels. 
These  levels  roughly  correspond  to  infancy,  childhood,  and  adolescence,  but 
Werner  was  not  concerned  with  ages;  he  was  interested  only  in  differing  devel¬ 
opmental  patterns. 

Initially,  at  the  sensorimotor-affective  level,  infants  hardly  experience  an 
outside  world  apart  from  (differentiated  from)  their  own  immediate  actions, 
sensations,  and  feelings.  They  know  objects  only  insofar  as  they  are  sucking 
them,  touching  them,  grasping  them,  and  so  on.  If,  as  Piaget  (1936b)  showed, 
a  young  baby  loses  hold  of  a  toy,  the  baby  will  act  as  if  the  toy  no  longer  exists. 
There  is  little  sense  of  objects  existing  apart  from  oneself. 

Gradually,  children  come  to  function  on  a  more  purely  -perceptual  level, 
perceiving  things  "out  there,"  apart  from  themselves.  They  stand  back  and 
look  at  objects,  point  to  them,  ask  their  names,  and  describe  them.  They  gain 
a  measure  of  objectivity.  Still,  their  perceptions  remain  strongly  bound  up 


96 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


with  their  actions  and  feelings.  For  example,  Katz  and  Katz  (cited  in  Werner, 
1948,  p.  383)  observed  that  preschool  children  take  a  great  interest  in  furniture 
that  can  be  used  for  climbing  and  jumping,  as  well  as  houses  in  which  acquain¬ 
tances  live,  whereas  other  furniture  and  houses  hardly  seem  to  enter  into  their 
awareness. 

The  extent  to  which  children's  perceptions  are  colored  by  their  per¬ 
sonal  needs  and  actions  is  sometimes  revealed  by  the  words  they  use.  For 
example,  4-year-old  Laura  called  a  certain  tree  the  "resting  tree"  because  she 
often  sat  under  its  cool  branches  on  the  way  home  from  school.  She  called 
the  yard  where  the  "resting  tree"  was  located  the  "resting  place,"  and  the 
family  who  lived  there  "the  resting  people."  Her  perceptions  were  still 
bound  up  with  her  personal  needs  and  activities  (Smart  &  Smart, 
1978,  p.  89). 

To  gain  the  most  detached,  objective  view  of  the  world,  we  must  rise  to  a 
conceptual  level  of  thought.  That  is,  we  must  begin  to  think  in  very  general  and 
abstract  dimensions,  such  as  height,  volume,  and  velocity,  which  lend  them¬ 
selves  to  precise  measurement.  For  example,  the  rule  "area  =  height  X  width" 
enables  us  to  quantify  space  objectively,  without  any  reference  to  our  personal 
feelings  about  it.  Such  detached,  impersonal  analysis  has  long  been  the  goal  of 
Western  science. 


Returning  to  Primitive  Levels 

Werner  believed  development  is  teleological,  which  means  that  it  directs 
itself  toward  mature  end-states.  Humans,  therefore,  naturally  progress 
toward  abstract,  conceptual  modes  of  thought.  This  does  not  mean,  however, 
that  once  we  develop  these  intellectual  operations,  we  must  rely  on  them 
alone.  If  we  did,  our  lives  would  become  empty,  abstract,  and  barren.  The 
world  would  become,  in  Whitehead's  words,  "a  dull  affair,  soundless,  scent¬ 
less,  colorless"  (1929,  p.  88).  We  would  long  for  the  kinds  of  thinking  that 
characterized  earlier  levels,  in  which  images  were  tied  to  feelings,  sensations, 
and  actions. 

Sometimes,  Werner  said,  adults  preserve  the  rich,  earlier  kinds  of  expe¬ 
rience  to  a  greater  extent  than  it  might  initially  seem.  A  biologist  might 
write  up  her  research  results  in  a  highly  abstract  manner,  but  her  research 
is  actually  based  on  direct  perceptions  of  living  organisms.  Her  abstract 
formulations  bring  order  to  her  sensory  impressions,  which  remain  in  the 
background  (Werner,  1948,  p.  52). 

Werner  also  said  we  return  to  earlier,  richer  modes  of  experience  in 
dreams  or  in  states  induced  by  hallucinogenic  drugs  (1948,  p.  82).  In  his  later 
writings,  however,  Werner  (1957;  Werner  &  Kaplan,  1963)  increasingly  empha¬ 
sized  a  new  concept — microgenesis. 

Microgenesis  refers  to  the  developmental  process  that  occurs  each  time 
we  confront  a  task,  such  as  perceiving  an  object  or  figuring  out  a  problem. 


97 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


In  each  instance,  our  mental  process  goes  through  the  same  sequences  that 
characterize  development  during  the  life  span.  That  is,  we  begin  with  vague, 
global  impressions  that  are  fused  with  feelings  and  bodily  sensations.  These 
impressions  give  way  to  more  differentiated  perceptions,  which  finally  become 
integrated  into  a  coherent  whole.  Microgenesis,  then,  is  a  self-renewing  process 
in  which  we  continually  begin  at  undifferentiated  levels. 

Microgenesis  often  occurs  so  rapidly  that  we  are  unaware  of  the  process, 
but  we  may  become  aware  of  it  at  times,  as  when  we  find  ourselves  in  new, 
unfamiliar  settings.  Imagine,  for  example,  that  we  enter  a  foreign  city.  At  first 
our  perception  is  likely  to  be  global,  diffuse,  and  heavily  colored  by  feelings. 
We  are  struck  by  the  strange  sounds,  lights,  odors,  shapes,  and  colors.  We  feel 
disoriented,  vaguely  wondering  if  we  are  safe  and  how  we  are  going  to  find 
anything.  Soon,  however,  our  picture  of  the  city  becomes  more  differentiated; 
we  identify  a  hotel,  a  restaurant,  a  bus  route.  And  finally  we  may  begin  to  see 
how  the  various  parts  of  the  city  are  interrelated;  we  form  a  more  conceptual 
map  of  the  city.  Thus,  within  a  fairly  short  time,  our  knowledge  of  the  city 
goes  through  a  developmental  process  similar  to  that  which  characterizes 
development  during  childhood. 

Werner  suggested  that  people  differ  in  the  extent  to  which  they  engage 
in  the  microgenetic  process.  Some  people  have  greater  microgenetic  mobility; 
they  can  regress  farther  back  and  fully  utilize  both  primitive  and  advanced 
forms  of  thinking.  Above  all,  this  ability  to  regress  characterizes  the  creative 
person,  the  person  who  is  willing  to  start  anew.  Many  creative  scientists,  for 
example,  have  admitted  that  they  begin  thinking  about  problems  on  a  pre- 
conceptual  level,  starting  out  with  vague  intuitions,  hunches,  dreamlike 
images,  and  gut-level  feelings  (Dubos,  1961).  As  a  group,  the  ethologists  make 
a  special  point  of  forming  rich  perceptions  of  animals  with  whom  they  feel  a 
certain  empathy  before  detaching  themselves  and  moving  on  to  a  formal,  con¬ 
ceptual  plane  (Lorenz,  1981;  Tinbergen,  1977). 

Some  thinking,  in  contrast,  is  distinctly  lacking  in  microgenetic  mobil¬ 
ity.  Schizophrenic  patients  regress  to  primitive  forms  of  thought,  but  they  get 
stuck  there  and  their  thinking  remains  disorganized.  Conversely,  many  of  us 
seem  to  shift  too  quickly  to  conventional,  rational  modalities,  so  our  thinking 
lacks  richness  and  creativity.  In  general,  Werner  said,  "[T]he  more  creative  the 
person,  the  wider  his  range  of  operations  in  terms  of  developmental  level,  or 
in  other  words,  the  greater  his  capacity  to  utilize  primitive  as  well  as  advanced 
operations"  (1957,  p.  145). 

The  Organismic  Orientation 

We  have  seen  how  mental  processes  such  as  perception  and  cognition  emerge 
from  contexts  in  which  they  are  fused  with  actions,  sensations,  and  feelings. 
This  occurs  in  the  development  of  the  child,  and  it  keeps  recurring,  microge- 
netically,  in  us  as  adults.  For  Werner,  this  conception  of  development  coincided 


98 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


with  a  position  to  which  he  was  deeply  committed — the  holistic  or  organis¬ 
mic  position.  Essentially,  this  position  maintains  that  we  should,  as  far  as 
possible,  study  psychological  processes  as  they  occur  within  the  whole  acting, 
feeling,  striving  organism.  We  should  not,  for  example,  study  perceptual  activ¬ 
ities  in  isolation,  but  as  they  emerge  from  the  more  primitive  matrices  of  action 
and  feeling  in  which  they  are  embedded. 

Despite  Werner's  appeals,  the  organismic  orientation  has  been  more  the 
exception  than  the  rule  in  psychology.  Researchers  usually  study  processes 
such  as  perception,  cognition,  language,  and  memory  as  if  they  were  self- 
contained  activities.  This  compartmentalized  approach,  Werner  noted  (1948, 
p.  49),  is  convenient,  and  it  does  not  strike  us  as  too  inappropriate  when  study¬ 
ing  adults  because  adult  functioning  has  become  fairly  differentiated.  For 
example,  as  adults  we  can  usually  distinguish  between  our  thoughts  and  our 
feelings,  so  we  believe  it  is  all  right  to  study  thinking  as  an  isolated  activity. 
But  even  adults  do  not  become  disembodied  minds.  We  still  need  to  know 
how  cognitive  processes  are  related  to  the  rest  of  the  organism.  Here,  the  con¬ 
cept  of  microgenesis  is  helpful.  Microgenesis  indicates  how  cognitive 
processes,  even  in  adults,  continually  emerge  from  physical,  emotional,  and 
sensory  experiences. 

Compartmentalized  research  becomes  most  problematic  when  we  turn 
to  children,  for  whom  the  various  psychological  processes  are  far  less  dif¬ 
ferentiated.  The  child's  perception,  for  example,  is  strongly  fused  with 
motor  action  and  emotion.  A  child,  upon  seeing  a  wooden  triangle,  does 
not  see  it  as  we  do,  as  simply  a  geometric  form.  Because  it  looks  sharp,  it 
is  something  one  might  dig  with,  or  something  that  is  threatening.  When 
we  examine  and  measure  the  child's  "form  perception"  as  an  isolated  activ¬ 
ity,  as  is  usually  done,  we  miss  out  on  the  chance  to  see  how  it  is  distinc¬ 
tive  in  the  child's  experience.  We  examine  form  perception  as  if  it  were 
already  differentiated  from  action  and  emotion,  which  it  is  not  (see  Wapner, 
Kaplan,  &  Cohen,  1973). 

The  Comparative  Approach 

Werner  wanted  to  study  development  not  only  from  an  organismic  viewpoint 
but  also  from  a  comparative  viewpoint.  That  is,  he  wanted  to  show  how  the 
orthogenic  principle  enables  us  to  compare  developmental  patterns  across 
many  diverse  areas,  including  various  cultures,  species,  and  pathological 
states. 

Werner  was  particularly  interested  in  parallels  between  humans  and 
cultures  in  their  early  phases  of  development.  In  many  ways,  he  argued,  the 
mental  lives  of  children  and  indigenous  peoples  have  underlying  similarities. 
Werner  said,  for  example,  that  the  thought  of  both  is  often  characterized  by  a 
lack  of  differentiation  between  the  self  and  the  external  world.  Both  children 
and  indigeneous  peoples  may  perceive  trees,  clouds,  and  wind  expressing 


99 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


emotions  that  they  themselves  experience.  We  will  discuss  such  parallels,  but 
as  Baldwin  (1980)  has  demonstrated,  it  is  first  useful  to  point  to  some  misun¬ 
derstandings  concerning  Werner's  purpose. 

First,  Werner  was  not  trying  to  show  that  children  and  indigenous  peoples 
think  in  completely  identical  ways.  The  thinking  of  children  in  industrialized 
cultures,  for  example,  is  not  nearly  as  rich,  complex,  and  fully  formed  as  that 
of  adults  in  small  tribal  cultures.  Children  may  have  some  impressions  of  the 
emotions  and  forces  expressed  by  the  natural  elements,  but  they  have  noth¬ 
ing  resembling  the  complex  mythologies  of  early  peoples. 

Second,  Werner  was  not  advancing  a  theory  of  recapitulation  (such  as 
that  proposed  by  Rousseau  or  Haeckel).  That  is,  he  did  not  believe  that  chil¬ 
dren  resemble  indigenous  peoples  because  children  are  repeating  the  evolu¬ 
tionary  history  of  the  species.  He  believed  that  the  recapitulation  theory  takes 
the  similarities  between  children  and  people  in  early  tribal  societies  too  liter¬ 
ally,  ignoring  the  differences  between  them. 

Werner,  moreover,  was  not  interested  in  evolutionary  history  itself.  That 
is,  he  was  not  interested  in  when  behavior  appeared,  but  in  its  developmental 
status  in  a  formal  sense,  as  defined  by  the  orthogenic  principle.  In  some 
instances,  the  thinking  of  extinct  cultures  may  have  been  more  differentiated 
than  that  found  in  some  contemporary  cultures.  In  any  event,  when  Werner 
used  terms  such  as  primitive,  early,  or  advanced,  he  was  referring  to  develop¬ 
mental  status  in  terms  of  a  formal,  theoretical  model. 

The  greatest  problem  with  Werner's  comparative  theory  is  that  it  seems 
to  have  political  overtones.  When  Werner  described  indigenous  peoples  as 
primitive  and  compared  them  to  children,  he  seemed  to  be  implying  they  are 
inferior. 

Werner  wanted  to  avoid  such  value  judgments.  He  noted  (1948,  p.  34) 
that  in  earlier  stable  environments,  primitive  modes  of  thought  were  highly 
adaptive.  And,  as  we  saw  in  our  discussion  of  microgenesis,  even  Western 
adults  may  need  to  return  to  primitive  levels  to  think  in  creative  ways.  Fur¬ 
thermore,  as  we  shall  later  see,  artists  still  develop  primitive  forms  of  experi¬ 
ence  and  thereby  enrich  our  lives.  For  Werner,  the  term  "primitive"  hardly 
need  carry  any  negative  connotations. 


SOME  COMPARATIVE  STUDIES 
Pictorial  Imagery 

Werner  said  that  children,  compared  to  Western  adults,  often  think  in  pictures. 
We  can  sometimes  see  this  when  we  ask  them  to  define  words.  If  a  5-year-old 
is  asked  to  define  the  word  girl,  he  might  say,  "She  has  long  hair  and  a  dress. 
She's  pretty."  The  boy's  definition  is  based  on  a  specific  pictorial  image. 


100 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


The  boy  does  not  yet  define  the  term  in  broad,  conceptual  categories  ("a  young 
female  member  of  the  human  species"). 

Werner  observed  that  pictorial  imagery  is  so  dominant  in  young  chil¬ 
dren  that  many  possess  eidetic  imagery,  or  what  we  commonly  call  photo¬ 
graphic  memory  Children  can  describe  a  scene  in  such  vivid  detail  that  we  are 
amazed  to  find  they  are  no  longer  looking  at  it.  Strong  forms  of  eidetic  imagery 
seem  to  be  present  in  only  a  minority  of  children,  but  many  children  possess 
some  form  of  it,  and  it  is  very  rare  in  Western  adults  (Haber,  1969;  Werner, 
1948,  p.  143). 

Werner  believed  that  indigenous  peoples  commonly  have  had  eidetic 
imagery,  but  this  is  difficult  to  document.  In  any  case,  their  languages  indi¬ 
cate  a  preference  for  pictorial  images  over  general  categories.  There  are  often 
few  general  terms,  but  many  words,  that  evoke  specific  images.  In  one  Bantu 
language,  for  example,  there  is  no  general  term  "to  go,"  but  many  special¬ 
ized  words  for  different  kinds  of  walking.  There  is  a  word  that  means  "to 
walk  along  slowly  and  carefully  with  a  convalescent  man"  and  another  one 
that  means  "to  hop  across  earth  seared  by  great  heat"  (Werner,  1948,  p.  267). 
One  anthropologist  observed  that  the  Solomon  Islanders  would  never  say 
anything  so  general  and  abstract  as,  "Five  people  arrived."  They  might  say, 
"A  man  with  a  large  nose,  an  old  man,  a  child,  a  man  with  a  skin  disease,  and 
a  little  fellow  are  waiting  outside"  (p.  288). 

Social  scientists  have  long  debated  the  capacity  of  indigenous  peoples  to 
think  in  abstract  terms.  I  believe  that  whenever  we  look  closely  at  the  matter, 
we  find  the  tribe  or  society  has  the  capacity  to  use  abstract  categories  but 
doesn't  always  see  the  point  to  it.  To  indigenous  peoples,  it  is  frequently  much 
more  important  to  describe  objects  and  events  in  precise  detail.  They  use 
words  in  the  way  many  Western  poets  and  writers  do — to  depict  the  world  in 
vivid,  picturelike  images. 


Physiognomic  Perception 

If  there  was  a  single  topic  on  which  Werner  wrote  with  the  deepest  feeling,  it 
was  physiognomic  perception.  We  perceive  stimuli  physiognomically  when 
we  react  to  their  dynamic,  emotional,  expressive  qualities.  For  example,  we 
might  perceive  a  person  as  happy  and  energetic  or  sad  and  tired.  Werner 
called  this  perceptual  mode  physiognomic  because  it  is  the  physiognomy — 
the  face — that  most  directly  conveys  emotion  to  us,  although  we  may  also 
perceive  emotion  in  other  ways — for  instance,  through  a  person's  posture. 

Physiognomic  perception  is  contrasted  with  geometric-technical  percep¬ 
tion.  Here,  we  perceive  objects  in  terms  of  shape,  length,  hue,  width,  and 
other  objective,  measurable  properties.  Geometric-technical  perception  is 
more  realistic  and  matter-of-fact.  It  is  the  perceptual  modality  of  the  scientist 
and  technician. 


101 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


As  rational  adults,  we  believe  physiognomic  perception  is  appropriate 
only  when  stimuli  are  animate.  We  feel  it  is  silly  to  perceive  emotions  in  rocks, 
sticks,  cups,  and  other  inanimate  objects.  Occasionally,  of  course,  we  wax 
poetic  and  respond  to  the  physical  environment  physiognomically,  as  when 
we  say  a  landscape  is  majestic  or  subdued.  Usually,  however,  we  perceive 
the  physical  environment  in  a  more  impersonal,  matter-of-fact  manner 
(Werner,  1956). 

For  children  the  situation  is  very  different.  Children,  lacking  clear 
self/ environment  boundaries,  perceive  the  whole  world  as  full  of  life  and 
emotion.  A  child,  seeing  a  cup  lying  on  its  side,  might  say  the  cup  is  tired. 
Watching  a  stick  being  broken  in  two,  the  child  might  feel  that  the  stick  is 
being  hurt.  Or,  looking  at  the  number  5,  the  child  might  say  the  number  is 
angry  or  mean,  finding  a  facial  expression  in  it.  Children,  Werner  (1948) 
argued,  quite  naturally  experience  the  inanimate  world  in  terms  of  the  same 
forces  and  emotions  they  feel  within  themselves  (pp.  67-82;  see  Figure  3). 


Figure  3 

A  5-year-old's  drawing  reveals  physiognomic  perception  (the  sun  is  smiling). 


102 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


Like  children,  indigenous  peoples  have  felt  a  strong  unity  with  the  rest 
of  the  world,  and  they  too  have  displayed  a  greater  degree  of  physiognomic 
perception  than  adults  in  modern  society.  Native  Americans,  for  example, 
typically  grew  up  feeling  that  they  were  one  with  nature  and  that  everything 
around  them — the  wind,  the  trees,  even  the  stones — possessed  life  and  feel¬ 
ing  (Lee,  1959,  p.  61).  Consequently,  they  were  often  shocked  at  the  white 
people's  indifference  toward  the  environment.  As  an  old  Wintu  woman  said. 

We  don't  chop  down  the  trees.  We  only  use  dead  wood.  But  the  White 
people  plow  up  the  ground,  pull  up  the  trees,  kill  everything.  The  tree 
says,  "Don't.  I  am  sore.  Don't  hurt  me."  But  they  chop  it  down  and  cut 
it  up.  The  spirit  of  the  land  hates  them.  .  .  .  The  White  people  destroy 
all.  They  blast  rocks  and  scatter  them  on  the  ground.  The  rock  says, 
"Don't.  You  are  hurting  me."  But  White  people  pay  no  attention.  .  .  . 
Everywhere  the  White  man  has  touched  it,  the  earth  is  sore.  (Lee,  1959, 
pp. 163-164) 

This  old  woman's  attitude  is  completely  different  from  the  geometric-technical 
approach  of  the  engineer  or  surveyor.  She  perceives  the  environment  physiog- 
nomically,  as  teeming  with  life  and  emotion. 

In  advanced  cultures,  dramatic  examples  of  physiognomic  perception 
may  be  found  in  the  reports  of  schizophrenic  patients  who  regress  to  primi¬ 
tive  mental  states.  These  patients  may  lose  their  sense  of  detachment  from 
physical  objects  and  experience  them  as  dangerously  alive.  One  patient  looked 
fearfully  at  some  swinging  doors  and  exclaimed,  "The  door  is  devouring  me!" 
(Werner,  1948,  p.  81). 

So  far  I  have  probably  managed  to  convey  the  impression  that  phys¬ 
iognomic  perception  is  something  fairly  strange  and  unusual — something 
that  most  of  us  have  long  overcome.  And  to  an  extent  this  is  true.  As  we 
develop,  Werner  (1956)  said,  physiognomic  perception  is  superseded  by  a 
geometric-technical  outlook.  We  increasingly  come  to  view  the  world  through 
the  eyes  of  the  engineer  or  technician.  We  evaluate  things  in  terms  of  their 
measurable  properties  and  practical  uses.  Even  people  become  categorized 
in  terms  of  impersonal,  quantifiable  dimensions.  We  define  them  in  terms  of 
their  IQ,  age,  income,  property  holdings,  number  of  dependents,  and  so  on. 

Nevertheless,  we  never  lose  our  capacity  for  physiognomic  perception, 
and  it  too  develops  within  us,  if  at  a  slower  rate  than  geometric-technical  per¬ 
ception.  Werner  and  others  have  devised  some  simple  demonstrations  to  show 
that  we  can  still  perceive  physiognomic  properties  in  supposedly  impersonal 
forms.  Figure  4  shows  two  lines:  Which  is  happy  and  which  is  sad?  Most 
adults  immediately  report  that  the  upwardly  moving  line  expresses  gaiety 
and  the  downward  sloping  line  conveys  sadness.  We  can  see  that  simple 
lines — which,  of  course,  are  merely  inanimate  figures — do  express  feelings 
through  their  dynamic  patterns. 


103 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


Figure  4 

Lines  express  feelings.  Which  is  happy  and  which  is  sad? 


Most  of  all,  we  are  aware  of  physiognomic  qualities  when  we  perceive 
them  aesthetically,  through  the  eyes  of  the  artist.  For  in  modern  industrial  cul¬ 
tures,  it  is  primarily  painters,  poets,  musicians,  and  others  who  alert  us  to  the 
expressive  features  of  forms,  colors,  sounds,  and  movements.  They  help  us 
experience  the  sad  posture  of  a  willow  tree,  the  anger  of  thunder,  the  caress 
of  a  tonal  pattern,  the  smile  of  a  sunny  sky,  and  the  upward  striving  of  a  geo¬ 
metric  column  (Arnheim,  1954;  Werner,  1956). 

The  extent  to  which  artists  develop  physiognomic  sensitivities  is  suggested 
by  the  painter  Wassily  Kandinsky: 

On  my  palette  sit  high,  round  rain-drops,  puckishly  flirting  with  each 
other,  swaying  and  trembling.  Unexpectedly  they  unite  and  suddenly 
become  thin,  sly  threads  which  disappear  in  amongst  the  colors,  and 
roguishly  slip  about  and  creep  up  the  sleeves  of  my  coat.  ...  It  is  not 
only  the  stars  which  show  me  faces.  The  stub  of  a  cigarette  lying  in  an 
ash-tray,  a  patient,  staring  white  button  lying  amidst  the  litter  of  the 
street,  a  willing,  pliable  bit  of  bark — all  these  have  physiognomies  for  me. 
(Werner,  1948,  p.  71) 

Because  artists  like  Kandinsky  have  developed  physiognomic  capacities,  our 
world  is  a  richer  place. 


The  Unity  of  the  Senses 

Physiognomic  perception,  as  we  have  noted,  is  based  on  a  unity  between  one¬ 
self  and  objects.  That  is,  we  perceive  objects  as  full  of  the  same  dynamic  forces 
we  feel  within  ourselves.  Physiognomic  perception  is  also  based  on  synesthesia, 


104 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


the  syncretic  unity  of  the  senses.  Sounds,  for  example,  may  simultaneously 
involve  several  of  our  senses.  A  sad  tone  may  seem  dark  and  heavy.  A  cheer¬ 
ful  tone  may  strike  us  as  bright,  clear,  and  light  in  weight. 

Werner  believed  that  intersensory  experiences  are  developmentally  prim¬ 
itive;  they  exist  prior  to  the  differentiation  of  the  senses  into  separate  modal¬ 
ities.  If  this  is  so,  synesthesia  might  be  especially  prominent  in  children,  and 
Werner  offered  several  anecdotes  to  this  effect.  For  example,  a  4-year-old  girl 
says,  "Father  talks  . . .  boom  boom  boom!  As  dark  as  night . . . !  But  we  talk  light, 
like  the  daytime  .  .  .  him  him  him!"  (Werner,  1948,  p.  262).  There  is  also  some 
experimental  evidence  that  synesthesia,  especially  color  hearing,  is  more  com¬ 
mon  in  children  than  in  adults  (Marks,  1975;  Werner,  1948,  pp.  89-91). 

Intersensory  modes  of  experience  are  often  well  developed  among 
indigenous  peoples.  In  West  African  languages,  for  example,  a  high  pitch 
may  express  something  that  is  fine,  pointed,  alert,  fresh,  energetic,  loud  of 
color,  sharp  of  taste,  quick,  or  agile.  A  low  pitch  may  express  something  big, 
plump,  awkward,  muggy,  dull,  colorless,  stupid,  or  slow  (Werner,  1948, 
pp.  259-260). 

Intersensory  experiences  also  become  prominent  in  contemporary  West¬ 
ern  adults  who  regress  to  primitive  states  in  psychosis  or  under  the  influence 
of  hallucinogens.  One  subject  experimenting  with  mescaline  said,  "I  think 
that  I  hear  noises  and  see  faces,  and  yet  everything  is  one  and  the  same.  I  can¬ 
not  tell  whether  I  am  seeing  or  hearing.  I  feel,  taste,  and  smell  the  sound.  It's 
all  one.  I,  myself,  am  the  tone"  (p.  92). 

Intersensory  experiences,  finally,  are  the  special  domain  of  the  artist. 
The  painter  Kandinsky,  for  example,  wrote  that  for  him  even  geometric 
shapes  have  "inner  tones"  and  "their  own  inimitable  fragrances"  (Werner, 
1956,  p.  4).  And  through  his  great  paintings,  colors  affect  us  as  warm  or  cold, 
sharp  or  soft,  and  so  on.  Fine  music,  too,  affects  us  through  many  senses,  as 
when  tones  seem  golden  or  pale,  bright  or  dull,  sweet  or  harsh,  sharp  or  soft, 
light  or  heavy. 

When  we  have  truly  intersensory  experiences,  Werner  added,  we  do  not 
experience  colors  or  sounds  objectively,  as  "out  there,"  but  feel  them  within 
our  bodies.  Colors  and  sounds  invade  us  or  envelop  us  or  fill  us  up.  Werner 
believed  the  various  senses  influence  one  another  through  general  bodily 
feelings  because  "they  develop  out  of  a  common  primitive  level  .  .  .  that  is 
bodily,  motoric,  and  affective"  (Werner,  1934,  p.  164). 


SYMBOL  FORMATION:  AN  ORGANISMIC  VIEW 

Although  Werner  wrote  many  articles,  he  published  only  two  books.  The  first 
was  the  Comparative  Psychology  of  Mental  Development  (1948),  which  I  have 
been  summarizing.  The  other,  Symbol  Formation  (Werner  &  Kaplan,  1963),  was 
on  language. 


105 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


The  study  of  language  has  mushroomed  in  recent  years,  but  from 
Werner's  perspective  the  general  approach  has  been  nonorganismic.  That  is, 
researchers  have  focused  on  the  elements  of  speech  and  grammar  as  if  these 
developed  in  a  vacuum,  unrelated  to  a  living,  acting,  feeling  organism.  Werner 
believed,  in  contrast,  that  language  initially  emerges  out  of  an  undifferentiated 
matrix  that  includes  bodily,  gestural,  and  affective  (emotional)  processes. 
Language  does  eventually  become  a  relatively  separate  activity,  but  it  never 
completely  loses  touch  with  its  rich  organismic  grounding. 

As  the  title  Symbol  Formation  suggests,  Werner's  focus  was  on  the  for¬ 
mation  of  symbols.  A  symbol  is  a  word,  image,  or  action  that  represents 
something  else — some  other  object,  concept,  or  event.  For  example,  the  word 
tree  symbolizes  a  tree.  When  we  use  symbols,  we  implicitly  recognize  that 
the  symbol  is  different  from  its  referent  (e.g.,  the  word  tree  is  different  from 
the  tree  itself). 

How  are  symbols  formed?  Probably  the  most  common  view  is  what 
might  be  called  the  label  theory.  We  simply  learn  our  culture's  labels  for  things. 
We  learn  the  word  tree  goes  with  trees,  cup  with  cups,  and  so  on.  In  this  view, 
the  connections  between  symbols  and  things  are  purely  arbitrary.  They  are 
mere  conventions  handed  down  to  us  by  our  culture. 

Werner  viewed  the  process  quite  differently.  He  acknowledged,  of 
course,  that  children  do  learn  the  culture's  labels,  but  he  argued  that  symbolic 
activities  initially  emerge  out  of  bodily-organismic  activities — motoric  actions, 
physical  and  vocal  gestures,  and  feelings.  The  process  of  referring  to  things, 
for  example,  begins  with  the  physical  act  of  pointing.  The  child  points  to  an 
object  of  interest  and  says  something  like  "da,"  inviting  the  mother  to  look  at 
it  too  (Werner  &  Kaplan,  1963,  pp.  70-71). 

Many  of  the  child's  first  "natural"  symbols  are  motoric  imitations.  Chil¬ 
dren  might  flutter  their  eyelids  to  depict  the  flickering  of  lights,  or  they 
might  tremble  their  hands  to  portray  the  agitation  of  water  stirred  by  a 
boat  (p.  89). 

Most  of  the  child's  early  symbols,  like  ours,  are  sounds  they  make.  These, 
too,  initially  emerge  out  of  bodily-emotional  actions,  such  as  expressions  of 
pleasure,  cries,  and  calls.  For  example,  a  baby  in  a  high  chair  might  call  out  for 
a  doll  that  has  dropped  to  the  floor.  At  first  she  might  just  cry  out,  but  on  later 
occasions  she  might  say  her  word  for  the  doll,  too  (e.g.,  "Bappa"!). 

Babies'  first  names  for  objects  often  center  on  their  actions  toward  the 
objects.  For  example,  an  11-month-old  girl  used  the  same  word  for  a  pin,  a 
breadcrumb,  and  a  caterpillar — apparently  because  they  are  all  things  to  be 
picked  up  gingerly  with  one's  fingers  (p.  118). 

Among  the  most  active,  dynamic  aspects  of  the  world  are  the  sounds 
animals  and  things  make.  It's  no  surprise,  then,  that  many  of  the  child's 
own  "baby  talk"  words  are  onomatopoeic — imitations  of  the  sounds.  A  child 
might  refer  to  a  dog  as  "wfff,"  a  coffee  grinder  as  "rrrr,"  and  a  hammer  as 
"boom"  (p.  46). 


106 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


A  bit  later,  children  use  expressive  intonation  to  capture  other  qualities 
of  objects.  A  girl  might  speak  of  tiny  objects  in  a  high,  peeping  voice  and  large 
objects  in  a  deep,  gruff  voice.  Or  she  might  say  something  rapidly  or  slowly 
to  indicate  how  fast  an  object  is  moving.  Werner  called  such  speech 
physio gncntric  because  it  depicts  the  active,  expressive  aspects  of  things. 

Underlying  the  child's  symbolic  activities — her  pointing,  naming,  imi¬ 
tating,  and  expressing — is  a  supporting  emotional  context.  This  is  the  pres¬ 
ence  or  availability  of  the  mother  (or  other  loving  adult).  Without  this,  the 
child  wouldn't  feel  safe  in  the  world  and  could  not  take  a  lively  interest  in 
describing  it  (p.  71). 

It  is  clear  that  children  do  not  feel  that  their  natural  symbols  are  related 
to  objects  in  an  arbitrary  manner.  The  symbol  "wfff,"  for  instance,  conveys 
the  most  striking  property  of  a  dog. 

When,  however,  children  begin  using  conventional  language,  the  con¬ 
nection  between  symbols  and  referents  would  seem  to  dissolve.  What,  after 
all,  is  the  inner  relationship  between  the  word  hammer  and  a  hammer?  For  a 
while,  children  may  preserve  the  tie  by  using  combinations  of  their  own  nat¬ 
ural  symbols  and  conventional  words,  as  when  they  say  "boom-hammer"  or 
"bah-sheep."  But  with  the  shift  to  purely  conventional  speech,  any  felt  simi¬ 
larity  between  symbol  and  referent  would  seem  to  disappear. 

But  Werner  believed  the  tie  is  never  completely  broken.  In  his  studies, 
he  found  that  adults  can  still  respond  to  words  as  physiognomic  forms  that 
directly  express  the  dynamic,  expressive  qualities  of  objects.  One  man  reported 
that  when  he  said  the  word  hammer,  the  short  "ha"  seemed  to  come  down 
sharply  on  the  "mmm,"  evoking  the  sensation  of  hammering  (p.  130).  Another 
subject,  looking  at  the  German  word  wolle  (wool),  spoke  of  the  dull,  stringy 
quality  of  the  "11"  (p.  209). 

Readers  might  wonder  if  these  subjects  weren't  simply  giving  Werner  the 
responses  he  wanted  to  hear.  However,  writers  and  poets  have  also  tried  to  get 
us  to  see  that  words  have  physiognomic  properties.  Balzac,  for  instance,  asked 
us  to  consider  how  the  sound  of  an  abstract  word  like  vrai  (true)  expresses 
the  feeling-tone  of  truth  itself.  Is  there  not,  he  asked,  in  the  word 

a  fantastic  strength  of  honesty?  Does  one  not  find  in  the  short  sound 
which  it  commands  a  vague  image  of  modest  nakedness,  of  the  inherence 
of  the  truth  in  everything?  This  syllable  breathes  forth  an  indefinable 
freshness.  (Werner,  1948,  pp.  257-258) 

According  to  Werner,  we  may  perceive  words  physiognomically  more 
frequently  than  we  realize.  We  may  do  so  whenever  we  first  try  to  recognize 
them  (during  the  early  microgenetic  phases  of  word  perception).  To  investi¬ 
gate  this  possibility,  Werner  presented  words  for  a  very  short  time,  without 
giving  subjects  a  chance  to  recognize  them  fully,  and  he  found  that  their 
impressions  were  dominated  by  feelings  and  bodily  reactions.  Subjects  said 


107 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


that  although  they  couldn't  make  out  a  word,  it  felt  "warm,"  "heavy,"  "dis¬ 
tressing,"  and  so  on — qualities  they  later  said  corresponded  to  the  word's 
meaning  for  them  (Werner  &  Kaplan,  1963,  p.  215). 

In  summary,  then,  Werner  argued  that  even  conventional  words  are  not 
merely  empty,  arbitrary  labels.  They  seem  to  be  such  only  when  we  examine 
their  external  structure  in  a  purely  objective  manner.  Inwardly,  we  may  per¬ 
ceive  words  as  expressive  forms  that  resonate  with  life  and  feeling,  evoking 
the  same  emotional  and  bodily  reactions  as  their  referents.  An  inner,  organis¬ 
mic  tie  between  symbol  and  referent  is  maintained. 


THEORETICAL  ISSUES 

We  have  now  reviewed  Werner's  writing  on  several  topics,  including  phys¬ 
iognomic  perception  and  the  development  of  language.  But  Werner  was  never 
just  interested  in  particular  topics;  he  was  also  concerned  with  the  larger 
theoretical  issues  that  the  topics  addressed. 


The  Multilinear  Nature  of  Development 

One  of  Werner's  theoretical  concerns  was  whether  development  is  unilinear 
or  multilinear,  whether  it  proceeds  along  a  single  line  or  along  many  sepa¬ 
rate  lines  (Werner,  1957).  A  consideration  of  physiognomic  perception  helped 
him  answer  this  question. 

Physiognomic  perception,  as  we  have  seen,  is  attuned  to  the  dynamic 
and  expressive  qualities  of  things.  It  is  an  early  form  of  perception,  dominant 
in  children,  and  in  our  culture  is  superseded  by  a  more  geometric-technical 
outlook.  We  may  sometimes  revert  to  physiognomic  modes,  as  in  moments  of 
creative  regression,  but  we  generally  rely  on  more  logical,  rational  modes  of 
thought. 

If  this  were  the  whole  story,  we  could  conclude  that  development  is  uni¬ 
linear;  one  cognitive  mode  follows  another.  Yet  physiognomic  perception  itself 
develops.  In  most  of  us,  to  be  sure,  it  develops  only  modestly,  since  we  do  not 
nurture  it,  but  in  artists  it  becomes  quite  advanced.  So  we  must  conceive  of 
development  as  a  multilinear  branching-out  process,  with  separate  lines  fol¬ 
lowing  their  own  course.  Figure  5  attempts  to  diagram  this  conception  of 
development. 


The  Discontinuity  Issue 

An  even  more  fundamental  issue  is  whether  development  is  continuous  or  dis¬ 
continuous.  Basically,  when  we  say  change  is  continuous,  we  are  proposing 
that  we  can  measure  it  along  a  single  quantitative  dimension.  Just  as  we  can 


108 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


Figure  5 

Werner  thought  that  different  lines 
of  development  branch  out, 
(Adapted  from  J.  Longer,  Theories 
of  Development.  New  York:  Holt, 
Rinehart  &  Winston,  1 969,  p.  1 53.) 


measure  a  child's  height  with  a  tape  measure,  we  can  measure  a  child's  vocab¬ 
ulary,  attention  span,  memory  capacity,  and  a  host  of  other  psychological 
variables  along  one  quantitative  scale.  A  vast  amount  of  research  in  develop¬ 
mental  psychology  has  assumed  that  change  is  measurable  in  this  manner. 
To  many,  the  concept  of  continuous,  quantifiable  measurement  seems  to  be  the 
essence  of  science. 

Actually,  biologists  in  particular  have  long  recognized  that  many  changes 
are  discontinuous,  involving  qualitative  transformations.  Early  forms  emerge 
into  new  forms  that  are  different  in  kind;  they  have  different  patterns  and 
modes  of  functioning.  Particularly  dramatic  examples  of  qualitative  changes 
are  metamorphoses,  such  as  the  emergence  of  a  caterpillar  into  a  butterfly.  In 
such  cases,  many  quantitative  comparisons  become  meaningless.  It  makes  no 
sense,  for  instance,  to  measure  the  speed  with  which  caterpillars  can  fly.  They 
have  their  own  mode  of  locomotion. 

Since  Rousseau,  developmentalists  have  been  more  like  the  biologists 
who  emphasize  qualitative  change.  The  transformations  from  childhood  to 
adulthood  may  not  be  as  dramatic  as  the  metamorphoses,  but,  as  Rousseau 
argued,  "Childhood  has  its  own  way  of  seeing,  thinking,  and  feeling''  (1762b, 
p.  54).  If  this  position  is  correct,  we  cannot  measure  children  in  terms  of  an 
adult  yardstick  without  missing  what  is  unique  to  the  child. 

Werner,  taking  the  broadest  possible  perspective,  noted  that  both  quan¬ 
titative  and  qualitative  changes  occur.  Like  Rousseau,  however,  he  really 
believed  that  the  most  important  changes  are  qualitative.  The  adult's  abstract 
thought,  for  example,  differs  in  kind  from  the  child's  perceptual-motor-affective 
thinking. 


109 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


In  many  respects,  comparing  the  child  to  the  adult  is  like  comparing  the 
artist  to  the  scientist.  The  child,  like  the  artist,  approaches  the  world  through 
a  physiognomic,  intersensory,  vividly  pictorial  style.  Especially  between  the 
ages  of  about  2  and  7  years,  children  love  to  draw,  sing,  and  engage  in  make- 
believe  (theatric)  play,  and  their  activities  are  energetic  and  imaginative. 
Howard  Gardner  (1980)  has  shown  how  children's  drawings  reach  a  special 
kind  of  perfection.  Between  the  ages  of  about  5  and  7,  they  routinely  produce 
drawings  that  are  fresh,  lively,  and  beautifully  balanced;  the  drawings  express 
gaiety,  playfulness,  and  a  strong  sense  of  life.  Indeed,  many  great  artists  have 
said  that  they  have  tried  to  recapture  the  artistic  qualities  of  the  young  child 
(Gardner,  1973,  p.  20).  Gardner  (1980,  p.  99)  has  called  this  the  "golden  period" 
of  artistic  development.  Then,  at  about  the  age  of  8  years  or  so,  children's 
drawings  undergo  a  major  change;  they  become  more  precise  and  geometric 
(Gardner,  1980,  chap.  6).  It  seems  that  geometric-technical  thinking  is  taking 
over.  The  fresh  liveliness  of  the  young  child  is  lost  (see  Figures  6  and  7). 

Young  children,  to  be  sure,  do  not  just  demonstrate  artistic  exuberance; 
they  reveal  the  beginnings  of  scientific  skills  as  well.  There  is  continuity  with 
later  orientations.  But  young  children's  dominant  outlook  seems  more  naturally 

Figure  6 

A  6-year-old  boy's  drawing  of  a  girl  jumping  rope  (left)  expresses  liveliness  and  bal¬ 
ance.  Howard  Gardner  (1980)  compares  it  to  a  work  by  the  master  Paul  Klee  (right), 
although  the  child's  work  is  livelier. 

(From  Artful  Scribbles  by  Howard  Gardner.  Copyright  ©  1 980  by  Howard  Gardner. 
Reprinted  by  permission  of  Basic  Books,  a  Division  of  HarperCollins  Publishers,  Inc.  The 
Klee  work  is  reprinted  by  permission  of  the  Artists  Rights  Society.) 


110 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


Figure  7 

Andy's  drawings  illustrate  the  shift  from  a  livelier  to  a  more 
geometric  style. 

artistic,  and  it  seems  almost  beside  the  point  to  persist  in  evaluating  them  in 
terms  of  the  rational,  logical  skills  of  adults,  although  this  is  what  researchers 
usually  do. 

Developmentalists,  then,  emphasize  that  development  is  often 
discontinuous — that  it  involves  a  qualitative  change.  Such  changes  need  not 
be  sudden.  Abstract  thinking,  for  example,  may  differ  in  quality  from  ear¬ 
lier  thinking  but  emerge  gradually.  Discontinuity  only  means  the  change 
involves  a  qualitative  shift;  the  suddenness  of  the  change  is  another  matter 
(Werner,  1957). 


Phenomenology 

A  school  of  thought  with  which  Werner  was  very  familiar  was  phenomenol¬ 
ogy.  Phenomenologists  believe  the  first  thing  we  should  do  when  studying 
children  (or  anyone  else)  is  to  abandon  our  preconceptions  about  them.  We 
cannot  assume  children  think  as  we  do;  we  need  to  take  a  fresh  look  at  chil¬ 
dren  themselves.  Above  all,  we  need  to  learn  about  children's  subjective  expe¬ 
riences  of  things.  We  need  to  explore  their  phenomenal  world — how  it  appears 
to  them. 

Most  developmentalists  have  been  phenomenological  only  up  to  a  point. 
They  have  believed  we  should  suspend  any  preconceptions  that  the  child 
thinks  as  we  do,  but  they  have  generally  analyzed  the  child's  thinking  from 


111 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


the  outside  instead  of  trying  to  see  things  through  the  child's  eyes.  Werner,  too, 
usually  described  thinking  from  an  external  viewpoint  (e.g.,  as  differentiated). 
Still,  he  provided  some  fine  insights  into  children's  subjective  experiences, 
suggesting,  for  instance,  that  they  tend  to  perceive  objects  physiognomically. 

Werner  (1948,  chap.  12)  also  wrote  enthusiastically  about  the  phenom¬ 
enological  research  of  his  colleagues  Jacob  von  Uexkiill  and  Martha 
Muchow.  Von  Uexkiill  was  an  ethologist  who  tried  to  show  how  different 
the  environment  looks  to  different  species.  By  analyzing  the  reactions  of  a 
fly,  for  example,  he  indicated  how  a  room  must  look  very  different  to  her 
than  it  does  to  us.  Muchow,  following  von  Uexkiill's  lead,  thought  everyday 
scenes  might  appear  different  to  children  from  the  way  they  do  to  adults. 
She  therefore  observed  children  and  adults  in  some  everyday  settings,  includ¬ 
ing  a  canal  dock  in  Hamburg,  and  inferred  how  these  settings  might  appear 
to  them  (Wohlwill,  1984). 

The  dock  was  at  the  bottom  of  a  steep  slope,  and  to  get  to  it  one  could 
walk  down  a  narrow  path  that  was  fenced  in.  This  is  what  adults  did.  Chil¬ 
dren,  however,  ignored  the  path.  Instead,  they  spent  their  time  climbing  and 
swinging  on  the  fence  and  rolling  and  sliding  down  the  grassy  slopes  beside 
it.  Because  the  children  were  so  much  more  motorically  inclined,  they  seemed 
to  perceive  the  entire  scene  very  differently  from  the  adults.  To  them,  the  fence 
and  the  slopes — mere  background  elements  for  the  adults — were  the  main 
features. 

A  second  setting  was  a  large  new  department  store  in  the  city.  The 
youngest  children  (ages  6  to  9)  did  not  approach  the  store  as  we  do.  They  paid 
little  attention  to  the  merchandise,  rushing  instead  to  areas  that  provided 
opportunities  for  action  and  games.  They  were  particularly  attracted  to  the 
stairs,  elevators,  and  escalators,  on  which  they  liked  to  run  up  and  down  in 
the  wrong  direction.  Here  again,  Muchow  inferred,  young  children  experi¬ 
enced  the  setting  very  differently  from  adults. 

Muchow,  who  died  at  an  early  age,  did  not  develop  her  research  as  fully 
as  we  might  have  wished.  She  inferred  children's  perceptions  from  their 
behavior  alone;  we  would  like  other  evidence,  such  as  drawings,  to  show  how 
they  viewed  the  scenes.  Still,  she  made  a  beginning  effort  to  depict  the  child's 
phenomenal  world. 


PRACTICAL  APPLICATIONS 

Werner  was  first  and  foremost  a  theoretician,  and  he  wrote  very  little  on  the 
practical  applications  of  his  work.  He  offered  scant  advice  on  child  rearing, 
education,  or  therapy.  Nevertheless,  his  writing  has  practical  relevance  in  a 
number  of  settings. 


112 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


Clinical  Settings 

In  the  treatment  of  schizophrenia,  psychoanalysts  such  as  Searles  (1965)  have 
found  Werner's  concepts  to  be  of  great  value.  Searles  believes  we  cannot 
understand  most  schizophrenic  patients  without  appreciating  the  undiffer¬ 
entiated  quality  of  their  experience.  These  patients  have  little  sense  of  them¬ 
selves  as  separate  from  inanimate  objects  or  other  people.  They  may  feel  they 
are  actually  part  of  a  room  or  the  therapist.  The  therapist's  recognition  of  this 
can  in  itself  be  beneficial,  because  one  thing  that  helps  patients  is  their  sense 
that  someone  else  understands  what  life  is  like  for  them.  Searles  discusses 
such  points  and  many  specific  ways  in  which  Werner's  concepts  guide  his 
therapeutic  interventions. 

Werner's  own  work  with  patients  was  pioneering  diagnostic  research 
on  children  suffering  from  brain  injuries.  Between  1937  and  1945,  he  and 
Alfred  Strauss  carried  out  a  number  of  studies  comparing  the  cognitive 
behavior  of  these  children  to  that  of  children  with  a  diagnosis  of  mental 
retardation  (Barten  &  Franklin,  1978,  part  3).  They  found  that  whereas  chil¬ 
dren  diagnosed  with  mental  retardation  often  thought  in  ways  that  seemed 
simple,  vague,  and  global,  children  diagnosed  with  brain  injuries  exhibited 
special  kinds  of  disorganization.  When  copying  designs,  for  example,  they 
were  often  unable  to  concentrate  on  the  main  figure  because  they  were  so 
distracted  by  background  details.  They  were,  in  Werner's  terms,  stimulus- 
bound;  everything  jumped  out  at  them.  They  could  not  stand  back  from  a 
design  and  differentiate  between  the  main  figure  and  the  background  details. 
Today  many  children  Werner  called  "brain  injured"  would  receive  different 
labels  (e.g.,  "attention  deficit/hyperactivity  disorder").  But  Werner's  insights 
into  figure /background  problems  are  still  fundamental,  and  educators  often 
try  to  keep  rooms  and  backgrounds  simple  and  uncluttered  so  distractible 
children  can  focus  on  the  tasks  at  hand. 


The  Push  for  Early  Literacy 

Werner  composed  no  treatises  on  mainstream  education,  but  his  general  ori¬ 
entation  has  become  quite  relevant  today.  Our  nations'  educational  policy¬ 
makers  are  pressing  for  formal  academic  instruction  at  younger  and  younger 
ages.  They  are  calling  for  instruction  in  literacy — in  reading  and  writing — 
even  in  preschool.  But  from  Werner's  holistic  perspective,  we  shouldn't  focus 
on  any  specific  intellectual  process,  such  as  literacy,  without  considering  the 
broader  context  out  of  which  it  develops.  In  this  case,  we  need  to  consider 
how  literacy  can  develop  out  of  rich  experiences  with  oral  language  and  other 
symbolic  activities. 

Werner  described  how  children's  oral  language  develops  out  of  actions 
and  feelings.  Before  children  learn  many  conventional  words,  they  create  their 
own  words  that  resonate  with  the  sounds  and  actions  of  life  around  them,  as 


113 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


when  they  refer  to  a  dog  as  "rfff"  and  a  hammer  as  "boom."  Additional 
research  reveals  that  much  early  language  is  also  melodic;  babies  like  to  play 
with  the  rhythms  and  rhymes  of  sounds,  and  parents  join  them  in  their 
melodic  cooing,  babbling,  and  baby  talk.  As  children  grow,  they  continue  to 
engage  in  wordplay  as  they  run,  climb,  jump,  and  play,  saying  things  such 
as,  "Up  a  lup  a  dup,  up  a  dup  I  go."  They  also  create  lovely  poems.  In  the 
preschool  and  early  elementary  school  years,  they  are  eager  to  hear  and  tell 
stories,  and  they  engage  in  a  good  deal  of  make-believe  play,  using  dolls, 
sticks,  and  other  objects  to  symbolize  the  people  and  things  in  their  dramas. 
They  also  love  to  draw,  which  involves  further  symbols,  and  when  they 
become  absorbed  in  drawing  they  often  make  up  songs  and  stories  (Crain, 
2003).  Through  all  such  experiences,  children  develop  a  love  of  language — of 
its  rhythms  and  beauty  and  its  power  to  convey  excitement  and  adventure. 
These  experiences  with  oral  language,  in  turn,  enrich  and  energize  their  writ¬ 
ing  and  reading.  They  want  to  read  books  to  gain  access  to  the  riches  that 
books  contain,  and  they  are  eager  to  write  their  own  stories,  jokes,  poems, 
and  important  messages. 

However,  early  academic  instruction  is  crowding  out  these  rich  early 
experiences.  Today's  kindergartens  (and  even  many  preschools)  are  so  dom¬ 
inated  by  formal  academic  instruction  that  there's  little  time  for  children  to 
make  up  rhymes  or  engage  in  make-believe  play,  or  to  draw,  sing,  or  swap  sto¬ 
ries.  Instead,  adults  rush  in  and  teach  them  literacy  skills  in  an  abstract,  mech¬ 
anistic  manner.  The  children  do  not  look  forward  to  books  and  writing  to 
further  the  joys  and  adventures  of  oral  language,  for  they  haven't  had  a  chance 
to  experience  these  joys  and  adventures.  Werner  did  not  specifically  address 
such  literacy  instruction,  but  his  holistic  and  organismic  orientation  asks  us 
to  pay  much  more  attention  to  the  variety  of  experiences  out  of  which  liter¬ 
acy  more  naturally  emerges. 


Adult  Education 

Werner  also  offered  a  concept  that  may  prove  of  considerable  importance  for 
the  education  of  adults.  This  is  the  concept  of  microgenetic  mobility.  Werner, 
you  will  recall,  proposed  that  the  most  creative  thinking  does  not  restrict  itself 
to  advanced,  rational  analysis,  but  it  begins  with  the  full  use  of  preconcep- 
tual  processes — global  impressions  fused  with  bodily  sensations,  intuitions, 
and  so  on.  If  so,  educators  in  many  fields,  including  the  arts  and  sciences, 
medicine,  and  architecture,  may  wish  to  broaden  the  range  of  the  thinking 
they  try  to  nurture  and  enhance  in  their  students. 

A  case  in  point  is  the  education  of  physicians,  where  there  is  a  growing 
effort  to  teach  strictly  rational  problem-solving  skills.  Young  doctors  are 
encouraged  to  make  diagnostic  evaluations  in  a  purely  logical,  step-by-step 
fashion,  often  employing  decision  trees,  flow  charts,  and  other  devices  derived 
from  computer-based  theories  of  cognition.  Werner's  concept  of  microgenetic 


114 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


mobility,  however,  suggests  that  doctors  make  fuller  clinical  judgments  when 
they  begin  at  preconceptual  levels,  with  the  impressions,  sensations,  and  feel¬ 
ings  that  patients  arouse  in  them. 

Following  Werner's  lead,  my  wife  (a  pediatrician)  and  I  (Crain  &  Crain, 
1987)  asked  pediatricians  at  different  levels  of  competence  to  report  their 
thoughts  and  impressions  as  they  examined  infants  with  fevers  who  had  come 
to  the  emergency  room  of  a  large  urban  hospital.  Analyses  of  the  tape  record¬ 
ings  revealed  that  the  beginning  doctors  tried  to  think  about  the  patients  in  a 
purely  objective,  logical  manner  throughout  the  examination.  In  contrast,  the 
most  experienced  and  esteemed  pediatricians  initially  engaged  the  babies  in 
informal  interactions,  trying  to  get  a  global  sense  of  the  baby's  health  through 
the  sensations  and  feelings  the  baby  evoked  in  them.  Their  approach  demon¬ 
strated  greater  microgenetic  mobility;  they  initially  engaged  in  more  primitive, 
intuitive  processes  before  advancing  to  a  conceptual  approach.  Thus  educa¬ 
tors  who  stress  a  purely  rational  approach  to  medical  decision  making  may  be 
overlooking  the  rich  preconceptual  ground  from  which  the  most  mature  clini¬ 
cal  judgments  emerge. 


EVALUATION 

Today  many  consider  Werner  a  historical  relic.  People  vaguely  remember  him 
as  someone  who  constructed  a  theory  similar  to  Piaget's — both  began  writing 
in  the  1920s — but  it  was  Piaget,  not  Werner,  who  became  the  dominant  figure 
in  developmental  psychology.  Werner,  to  be  sure,  did  contribute  his  well- 
known  definition  of  development  (the  orthogenic  principle),  and  he  did  influ¬ 
ence  some  important  people.  But  by  and  large,  he  has  receded  into  the 
background. 

Let  us  look  first  at  some  possible  reasons  for  this  neglect  and  then  consider 
the  need  to  take  him  seriously  once  again. 

Werner  has  been  overlooked  partly  because  his  theory  is  so  abstract 
and  difficult.  Moreover,  on  major  issues  he  was  often  vague  and  noncom¬ 
mittal.  One  thing  we  would  like  to  know  of  any  developmental  theorist  is 
his  or  her  view  of  developmental  change.  To  what  extent  does  the  writer  see 
change  as  an  innate  maturational  process?  Or  as  a  product  of  environmental 
influences?  Werner's  biological  model  is  that  of  a  maturationist  (Baldwin, 
1980),  but  if  we  look  to  Werner  for  a  clear  statement,  we  look  in  vain.  Instead, 
we  find  statements  such  as,  "Developmental  psychology  directs  its  efforts 
not  toward  the  solution  of  the  tricky  problems  of  innate  versus  acquired  func¬ 
tion,  but  only  the  establishment  and  description  of  .  .  .  types  of  mental  activ¬ 
ity"  (Werner,  1948,  p.  18).  He  simply  skirted  a  basic  issue. 

In  a  similar  vein,  we  might  like  to  know  the  extent  to  which  Werner 
believed  that  the  child  spontaneously  creates  his  or  her  ideas,  as  opposed  to 
absorbing  the  ideas  of  adults.  Again,  Werner  was  surprisingly  noncommittal. 


115 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


Symbol  Formation  (1963),  for  example,  extensively  describes  early  symbols  that 
are  so  different  from  ours  that  they  must  be  spontaneous  creations,  yet  Werner 
and  Kaplan  said,  "In  our  opinion  the  problem  of  free  'inventions'  has  been 
unduly  stressed  in  the  literature"  (p.  102).  Here  again,  Werner  took  no  stand, 
saying  he  was  only  interested  in  the  pattern  of  the  child's  thought. 

Werner  may  seem  noncommittal  partly  because  he  was  a  tolerant  man 
who  tried  to  see  the  value  in  all  points  of  view.  He  also  believed  a  degree  of 
theoretical  looseness  was  a  good  thing.  He  wanted  to  keep  his  concepts  gen¬ 
eral  and  tentative  so  others  would  feel  free  to  specify  the  details  in  their  par¬ 
ticular  areas  of  investigation  (Glick,  1983).  So,  for  example,  he  never  committed 
himself  to  any  single  set  of  levels  or  stages.  He  proposed  some  levels  (senso¬ 
rimotor,  perceptual,  and  conceptual),  but  he  hoped  others  would  feel  at  lib¬ 
erty  to  find  their  own. 

Complaints  about  Werner 's  vagueness,  then,  may  be  unfair  because  they 
ignore  his  purpose.  But  the  fact  remains  that  Werner  has  been  generally 
neglected,  and  a  major  reason  is  that  he  failed  to  give  us  much  we  can  sink  our 
teeth  into.  If  he  had  proposed  a  set  of  clear-cut  stages,  as  Piaget  did,  researchers 
could  test  them  and  try  to  prove  him  right  or  wrong.  This  he  didn't  do. 

But  no  matter  how  vague  and  difficult,  Werner's  theory  is  becoming 
increasingly  important.  The  reason  has  to  do  with  broad  trends  in  our  culture, 
of  which  psychology  is  a  part. 

If  social  critics  such  as  Theodore  Roszak  (1972)  are  correct,  our  culture 
has  steadily  become  dominated  by  science  and  technology.  That  is,  we  have 
come  to  view  the  world  almost  exclusively  through  the  mental  categories  of 
logic,  number,  and  mechanistic  connection.  Taking  the  computer  as  our  model, 
we  have  translated  mental  life  into  flow  charts  and  decision  trees,  and  we 
have  made  precision,  objectivity,  and  rationality  our  ultimate  goals.  In  the 
process,  Roszak  says,  we  have  lost  touch  with  nonrational  modes  of  experi¬ 
ence.  We  have  cut  ourselves  off  from  the  fluid  world  of  dreams,  emotions, 
and  intuitions  and  the  organic  rhythms  of  the  body.  Simultaneously,  we  have 
lost  our  feeling  for  nature,  reducing  her  to  mere  physical  matter  to  be  exploited 
and  controlled.  Employing  our  great  technological  powers,  we  have  turned  the 
organic  world  into  an  artificial  environment  "as  lifeless  and  gleamingly  ster¬ 
ile  as  the  glass  and  aluminum,  stainless  steel  and  plastic  of  the  high-rise  archi¬ 
tecture  and  its  interiors  that  now  fill  the  urban-industrial  world"  (p.  89).  We 
have,  Roszak  says,  pressed  technology  forward  against  the  natural  world  to 
such  an  extent  that  we  are  startled  when  anxious  ecologists  remind  us  that 
our  survival  still  depends  on  air,  water,  soil,  plants,  and  animals  (p.  10). 

Developing  this  theme,  David  Abram's  book  The  Spell  of  the  Sensuous 
(1996)  calls  attention  to  how  we  have  lost  connection  to  nature  through  our 
language.  The  oral  languages  of  the  indigenous  peoples,  Abram  says,  res¬ 
onate  with  the  sounds  and  forms  of  the  animate  landscape.  The  Kaluli  of 
New  Guinea  still  sing  along  with  the  birds,  insects,  frogs,  and  tumbling  water¬ 
falls.  Like  other  indigenous  peoples,  the  Kaluli's  names  for  animals  are  often 


116 


Werner's  Organismic  and  Comparative  Theory 


onomatopoeic,  imitating  the  animals'  sounds  and  activities.  But  modern 
industrial  societies,  which  are  driving  indigenous  peoples  out  of  existence, 
emphasize  literacy.  And  literacy  insulates  us  from  nature.  To  learn  to  read,  we 
must  shut  out  the  sights  and  sounds  of  the  out-of-doors  and  concentrate  on 
the  printed  page.  As  literate  individuals,  we  no  longer  see  language  as  some¬ 
thing  we  share  with  animals,  trees,  and  the  wind,  but  as  a  distinctly  human 
form  of  communication.  Written  language  is  abstract  and  cerebral.  And  so  we 
encase  ourselves  in  buildings,  using  computer  technology  to  send  written 
messages  to  anywhere  in  the  world,  insulated  from  the  breezes  and  bird¬ 
songs  just  outside. 

Still,  Abram  argues,  linguistic  connections  to  the  natural  world  cannot 
be  entirely  severed.  In  its  depths,  language  remains  a  physical  process  that 
has  been  nourished  by  nature's  sounds,  and  we  still  use  words  that  echo 
nature.  "It  is  not  by  chance,"  Abram  says,  "that  when  hiking  in  the  moun¬ 
tains,  the  English  terms  we  spontaneously  use  to  describe  the  surging  waters 
of  the  nearby  river  are  words  like  'rush,'  'splash,'  'gush,'  'wash'"  (p.  82).  Abram 
hopes  we  can  recover  our  connections  to  the  "varied  contours  and  rhythms  of 
a  more-than-human  earth"  (p.  272). 

Abram  covers  much  of  the  same  theoretical  ground  as  Werner  did. 
Werner,  too,  wrote  about  how  speech,  at  its  foundations,  resonates  with  the 
expressive  and  dynamic  features  of  the  world.  Like  Abram,  Werner  saw  this 
expressive  speech  as  being  stronger  among  indigenous  peoples  than  among 
us  in  technological,  literacy-based  societies. 

Werner,  in  addition,  indicated  that  this  speech  is  strong  in  children.  He 
observed  how  children's  initial  symbols  are  often  onomatopoeic,  imitating 
the  sounds  of  animals  and  objects.  He  also  described  how  children  physiog- 
nomically  perceive  the  expressive  qualities  in  the  outer  world  and  how  this 
perception  is  developed  by  artists.  Poets,  painters,  and  other  artists  convey  the 
joy  of  a  flower  at  sunrise,  the  whisper  of  the  wind  in  the  trees,  and  the  explo¬ 
siveness  of  thunder. 

Whether  flowers,  wind,  and  thunder  really  possess  these  qualities  is 
open  to  debate.  But  in  our  technologically  advanced  society,  in  which  so  many 
of  us  have  lost  our  sensitivity  to  the  natural  world,  Werner  showed  where 
this  sensitivity  is  to  be  found. 


117 


This  page  intentionally  left  blank 


Piaget’s 
Cognitive- 
Developmental  Theory 


From  Theories  of  Development:  Concepts  and  Applications,  Sixth  Edition.  William 
Crain.  Copyright  ©  2011  by  Pearson  Education,  Inc.  Published  by  Pearson 
Prentice  Hall.  All  rights  reserved. 


119 


Piaget’s 

Cognitive-Developmental 

Theory 


BIOGRAPHICAL  INTRODUCTION 

In  all  psychology,  few  theorists  are  as  important  as  Jean  Piaget 
(1896-1980),  who  forged  the  single-most  comprehensive  and  com¬ 
pelling  theory  of  intellectual  development. 

Piaget  was  born  in  Neuchatel,  a  small  college  town  in  Switzer¬ 
land  where  his  father  was  a  medieval  historian  at  the  university.  Piaget 
(1952)  described  his  father  as  a  careful  and  systematic  thinker.  His 
mother,  in  contrast,  was  highly  emotional,  and  her  behavior  created 
tensions  within  the  family.  Piaget  adopted  his  father's  studious  ways 
and  found  refuge  from  the  family's  conflicts  in  solitary  research. 

Piaget  showed  promise  as  a  scientist  from  the  start.  At  the  age  of 
10  he  published  an  article  on  an  albino  sparrow  he  had  seen  in  the 
park.  While  he  was  still  in  high  school,  his  research  on  mollusks 
brought  invitations  to  meet  with  foreign  colleagues  and  a  job  offer  to 
become  the  curator  of  a  museum — all  of  which  he  turned  down 
because  of  his  age. 

At  15  years  of  age,  Piaget  experienced  an  intellectual  crisis  when 
he  realized  his  religious  and  philosophical  convictions  lacked  a  scien¬ 
tific  foundation.  He  therefore  set  out  to  find  some  way  of  bridging  phi¬ 
losophy  with  science.  He  read  widely  and  worked  out  his  new  ideas  in 
writing,  even  though  the  writing  was  intended  for  no  one  but  himself. 
This  search  did  not  occupy  all  his  time — he  still  managed  to  earn  his 
doctorate  in  the  natural  sciences  at  the  age  of  21 — but  Piaget's  broader 
quest  did  at  times  leave  him  confused  and  exhausted.  Finally,  at  the 
age  of  23,  he  settled  on  a  plan.  He  would  first  do  scientific  research  in 
child  psychology,  studying  the  development  of  the  mind.  He  then 
would  use  his  findings  to  answer  broader  questions  in  epistemology, 
philosophical  questions  concerning  the  origin  of  knowledge.  He  called 


120 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


this  new  enterprise  "genetic  epistemology"  (Ginsburg  &  Opper,  1988,  pp.  2-3; 
Piaget,  1952). 

Piaget  decided  to  study  children  in  1920  while  working  in  the  Binet 
Laboratory  in  Paris.  There,  his  assignment  was  to  construct  an  intelligence  test 
for  children.  At  first  he  found  this  work  very  boring — he  had  little  interest  in 
scoring  children's  answers  right  and  wrong,  as  intelligence  testing  requires. 
However,  Piaget  soon  became  interested  in  the  younger  children's  responses, 
especially  their  wrong  answers.  Their  mistakes,  he  found,  fit  a  consistent  pat¬ 
tern  that  suggested  their  thinking  might  have  a  character  all  its  own.  Young 
children,  Piaget  speculated,  might  not  simply  be  "dumber"  than  older  chil¬ 
dren  or  adults,  but  might  think  in  an  entirely  different  way  (Ginsburg  & 
Opper,  1988,  p.  3). 

In  order  to  learn  about  children's  potentially  unique  ideas,  Piaget  aban¬ 
doned  the  standardized  tests,  which  forced  children's  responses  into  "artifi¬ 
cial  channels  of  set  question  and  answer,"  and  devised  a  more  open-ended 
clinical  interview  that  "encourages  the  flow  of  spontaneous  tendencies" 
(Piaget,  1926,  p.  4).  He  also  spent  many  hours  observing  children's  sponta¬ 
neous  activities.  The  point  was  to  suspend  his  own  adult  preconceptions  about 
children's  thinking  and  to  learn  from  the  children  themselves. 

While  in  Paris,  Piaget  published  two  studies  based  on  his  new  approach, 
but  he  did  most  of  this  new  research  at  the  Rousseau  Institute  in  Geneva, 
where  he  settled  in  1921.  He  primarily  interviewed  children  between  the  ages 
of  4  and  12  years,  and  he  found  that  the  younger  children,  before  the  age  of 
7  or  so,  do  indeed  think  in  a  qualitatively  different  way  about  dreams,  morals, 
and  many  other  topics. 

In  1925  Piaget's  first  child,  Jacqueline,  was  born — an  event  that  initiated 
an  important  series  of  studies  on  the  cognitive  behavior  of  infants.  Piaget  and 
his  wife,  Valentine  Chatenay,  made  very  careful  observations  of  Jacqueline's 
behavior,  as  they  also  did  of  their  next  two  babies,  Lucienne  and  Laurent. 

Beginning  about  1940  Piaget  returned  to  the  study  of  children,  and  ado¬ 
lescents  as  well,  but  he  changed  his  research  focus.  Whereas  his  earlier  inves¬ 
tigations  covered  such  topics  as  dreams,  morality,  and  other  matters  of 
everyday  interest  to  the  child,  his  new  studies  focused  on  the  child's  under¬ 
standing  of  mathematical  and  scientific  concepts — a  focus  that  dominated  his 
work  until  the  end  of  his  life  (Ginsburg  &  Opper,  1988,  pp.  15-16). 

In  the  1950s  Piaget  finally  turned  to  philosophical  questions  in  episte¬ 
mology,  although  he  continued  to  study  children's  cognitive  development. 
In  this  book  I  will  say  little  about  Piaget's  epistemological  theory;  rather,  our 
task  is  to  gain  some  understanding  of  his  developmental  theory. 

Piaget's  research  has  evoked  different  responses  from  psychologists  at 
different  times.  His  first  work  caught  the  attention  of  psychologists  in  many 
parts  of  the  world.  After  this  initial  enthusiasm,  however,  interest  in  Piaget 
declined,  especially  in  the  United  States.  For  one  thing,  psychologists  had  dif¬ 
ficulty  understanding  his  orientation.  They  also  objected  to  his  methodology. 


121 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


Piaget  sometimes  changed  his  questions  during  an  interview  if  he  thought 
this  might  help  him  understand  a  particular  child's  thinking;  this,  many  psy¬ 
chologists  pointed  out,  violates  the  canon  of  standardized  interviewing.  Piaget 
also  ignored  such  matters  as  reports  on  his  sample  sizes  and  statistical  sum¬ 
maries  of  his  results.  He  seemed  to  regard  such  matters  as  less  important  than 
rich,  detailed  examples  of  children's  thinking  (Flavell,  1963,  pp.  10-11,  431; 
Ginsburg  &  Opper,  1988,  p.  6). 

By  and  large,  Piaget's  research  suffered  from  the  same  methodologi¬ 
cal  shortcomings  throughout  his  career,  but  the  1960s  saw  a  remarkable 
revival  of  interest  in  his  work.  In  the  decades  that  followed,  growing  num¬ 
bers  of  psychologists  recognized  the  stature  and  importance  of  his  theory. 
Many  have  been  skeptical  of  his  claims,  and  many  have  tried  to  prove  him 
wrong,  but  they  have  recognized  Piaget's  theory  as  something  to  be  reck¬ 
oned  with.  Today  there  is  hardly  a  study  of  children's  thinking  that  does  not 
refer  to  Piaget. 


OVERVIEW  OF  THE  THEORY 

Although  Piaget's  research  changed  over  the  years,  each  part  of  it  contributes 
to  a  single,  integrated  stage  theory.  The  most  general  stages,  or  periods,  are 
listed  in  Table  1. 

Before  we  examine  these  stages  in  detail,  it  is  important  to  note  two  the¬ 
oretical  points.  First,  Piaget  recognized  that  children  pass  through  his  stages 
at  different  rates,  and  he  therefore  attached  little  importance  to  the  ages  asso¬ 
ciated  with  them.  He  did  maintain,  however,  that  children  move  through  the 
stages  in  an  invariant  sequence — in  the  same  order. 

Second,  as  we  discuss  the  stages,  it  is  important  to  bear  in  mind 
Piaget's  general  view  of  the  nature  of  developmental  change.  Because  he  proposed 

Table  1  The  General  Periods  of  Development 


Period  I. 


Period  II. 


Period  III. 


Period  IV. 


Sensorimotor  Intelligence  (birth  to  2  years).  Babies  organize 
their  physical  action  schemes,  such  as  sucking,  grasping, 
and  hitting,  for  dealing  with  the  immediate  world. 
Preoperational  Thought  (2  to  7  years).  Children  learn  to 
think— to  use  symbols  and  internal  images— but  their  thinking 
is  unsystematic  and  illogical.  It  is  very  different  from  that  of 
adults. 

Concrete  Operations  (7  to  1 1  years).  Children  develop  the 
capacity  to  think  systematically,  but  only  when  they  can 
refer  to  concrete  objects  and  activities. 

Formal  Operations  (1 1  to  adulthood).  Young  people  develop 
the  capacity  to  think  systematically  on  a  purely  abstract  and 
hypothetical  plane. 


122 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


an  invariant  stage  sequence,  some  scholars  (e.g.,  Bandura  &  McDonald, 
1963)  have  assumed  he  was  a  maturationist.  He  was  not.  Maturationists 
believe  stage  sequences  are  wired  into  the  genes,  and  stages  unfold  accord¬ 
ing  to  an  inner  timetable.  Piaget,  however,  did  not  think  his  stages  are 
genetically  determined.  They  simply  represent  increasingly  comprehensive 
ways  of  thinking.  Children  are  constantly  exploring,  manipulating,  and 
trying  to  make  sense  out  of  the  environment,  and  in  this  process  they 
actively  construct  new  and  more  elaborate  structures  for  dealing  with  it 
(Kohlberg,  1968). 

Piaget  did  make  use  of  biological  concepts,  but  only  in  a  limited  way.  He 
observed  that  infants  inherit  reflexes,  such  as  the  sucking  reflex.  Reflexes  are 
important  in  the  first  month  of  life  but  have  much  less  bearing  on  development 
after  this. 

In  addition,  Piaget  sometimes  characterized  children's  activities  in  terms 
of  biological  tendencies  that  are  found  in  all  organisms.  These  tendencies  are 
assimilation,  accommodation,  and  organization.  Assimilation  means  taking 
in,  as  in  eating  or  digestion.  In  the  intellectual  sphere,  we  have  a  need  to 
assimilate  objects  or  information  into  our  cognitive  structures.  For  example, 
adults  assimilate  information  by  reading  books.  Much  earlier,  a  baby  might 
try  to  assimilate  an  object  by  grasping  it,  trying  to  take  it  into  her  grasping 
scheme. 

Some  objects  do  not  quite  fit  into  existing  structures,  so  we  must  make 
accommodations,  or  changes  in  our  structures.  For  example,  a  baby  girl  might 
find  that  she  can  grasp  a  block  only  by  first  removing  an  obstacle.  Through 
such  accommodations,  infants  begin  constructing  increasingly  efficient  and 
elaborate  means  for  dealing  with  the  world. 

The  third  tendency  is  organization.  For  example,  a  4-month-old  boy  might 
have  the  capacity  to  look  at  objects  and  to  grasp  them.  Soon  he  will  try  to 
combine  these  two  actions  by  grasping  the  same  objects  he  looks  at.  On  a  more 
mental  plane,  we  build  theories.  We  seem  to  be  constantly  trying  to  organize 
our  ideas  into  coherent  systems. 

So,  even  though  Piaget  did  not  believe  that  stages  are  wired  into  the 
genetic  code,  but  constructed  by  children  themselves,  he  did  discuss  the 
construction  process  in  terms  of  biological  tendencies  (Ginsburg  &  Opper, 
1988,  pp.  16-19). 

If  Piaget  was  not  a  maturationist,  he  was  even  less  a  learning  theorist. 
He  did  not  believe  children's  thinking  is  shaped  by  adult  teachings  or  other 
environmental  influences.  Children  must  interact  with  the  environment  to 
develop,  but  it  is  they,  not  the  external  environment,  who  build  new  cogni¬ 
tive  structures. 

Development,  then,  is  not  governed  by  internal  maturation  or  external 
teachings.  It  is  an  active  construction  process,  in  which  children,  through  their 
own  activities,  build  increasingly  differentiated  and  comprehensive  cognitive 
structures. 


123 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


PERIOD  I.  SENSORIMOTOR  INTELLIGENCE 
(BIRTH  TO  2  YEARS) 

Piaget's  first  developmental  period  consists  of  six  stages. 


Stage  1  (birth  to  1  month)1: 

The  Use  of  Reflexes 

When  Piaget  talked  about  the  infant's  action-structures,  he  used  the  term 
scheme  or  schema  (e.g.,  Piaget,  1936a,  p.  34).  A  scheme  can  be  any  action  pat¬ 
tern  for  dealing  with  the  environment,  such  as  looking,  grasping,  hitting,  or 
kicking.  As  mentioned,  although  infants  construct  their  schemes  and  later 
structures  through  their  own  activities,  their  first  schemes  consist  primarily  of 
inborn  reflexes.  The  most  prominent  reflex  is  the  sucking  reflex;  babies  auto¬ 
matically  suck  whenever  their  lips  are  touched. 

Reflexes  imply  a  certain  passivity.  The  organism  lies  inactive  until  some¬ 
thing  comes  along  to  stimulate  it.  Piaget,  however,  showed  that  even  a  reflex 
like  sucking  quickly  becomes  part  of  the  human  infant's  self-initiated  activ¬ 
ity.  For  example,  when  his  son  Laurent  was  only  2  days  old,  he  began  mak¬ 
ing  sucking  movements  when  nothing  elicited  them.  Since  he  did  this  between 
meals,  when  he  wasn't  hungry,  he  seemed  to  suck  simply  for  the  sake  of  suck¬ 
ing.  Piaget  said  that  once  we  have  a  scheme,  we  also  have  a  need  to  put  it  to 
active  use  (pp.  25-26, 35). 

Furthermore,  when  babies  are  hungry,  they  do  not  just  passively  wait  for 
the  mother  to  put  the  nipple  into  their  mouth.  When  Laurent  was  3  days  old, 
he  searched  for  the  nipple  as  soon  as  his  lips  touched  part  of  the  breast.  He 
groped,  mouth  open,  across  the  breast  until  he  found  it  (p.  26). 

Babies  do  not  confine  themselves  to  sucking  on  nipples.  Piaget's  chil¬ 
dren  sucked  on  clothes,  pillows,  blankets,  their  own  fingers — on  anything 
they  chanced  upon.  In  Piaget's  terms,  they  assimilated  all  kinds  of  objects  into 
the  sucking  scheme  (pp.  26,  32,  34). 

Although  assimilation  is  the  most  prominent  activity  during  stage  1,  we 
also  can  detect  the  beginnings  of  accommodation.  For  example,  babies  must 
learn  to  adjust  their  head  and  lip  movements  to  find  the  breast  and  nurse. 
Such  adjustments  also  demonstrate  the  beginnings  of  organization;  babies 
organize  their  movements  so  that  nursing  becomes  increasingly  smooth,  rapid, 
and  efficient  (pp.  29-31,  39). 


'The  age  norms  for  this  period  follow  those  suggested  by  Flavell  (1963).  I  use  the  stage 
headings  suggested  by  Ginsburg  and  Opper  (1988). 


124 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


Stage  2  (1  to  4  months): 

Primary  Circular  Reactions 

A  circular  reaction  occurs  when  the  baby  chances  upon  a  new  experience  and 
tries  to  repeat  it  (Piaget,  1936a,  p.  55).  A  prime  example  is  thumb-sucking. 
By  chance,  the  hand  comes  into  contact  with  the  mouth,  and  when  the  hand 
falls  the  baby  tries  to  bring  it  back.  For  some  time,  however,  babies  cannot  do 
this.  They  hit  the  face  with  the  hand  but  cannot  catch  it,  or  they  fling  their 
arms  wildly,  or  they  chase  the  hand  with  the  mouth  but  cannot  catch  it 
because  the  whole  body,  including  the  arms  and  hands,  moves  as  a  unit  in  the 
same  direction.  In  Piaget's  language,  they  are  unable  to  make  the  accommo¬ 
dations  necessary  to  assimilate  the  hand  to  the  sucking  scheme.  After 
repeated  failures,  they  organize  sucking  and  hand  movements  and  master  the 
art  of  thumb-sucking. 

As  with  thumb-sucking,  most  of  the  primary  circular  reactions  involve 
the  organization  of  two  previously  separate  body  schemes  or  movements.  For 
example,  when  we  see  a  baby  girl  repeatedly  bring  her  hand  next  to  her  face 
and  look  at  it,  she  is  exercising  a  primary  circular  reaction.  She  is  coordinat¬ 
ing  looking  with  hand  movements  (pp.  96-97). 

These  circular  reactions  provide  a  good  illustration  of  what  Piaget  means 
by  intellectual  development  as  a  "construction  process."  The  baby  actively 
"puts  together"  different  movements  and  schemes.  It  is  important  to  empha¬ 
size  the  amount  of  work  involved;  the  baby  manages  to  coordinate  separate 
movements  only  after  repeated  failures. 


Stage  3  (4  to  8  months): 

Secondary  Circular  Reactions 

The  developments  of  the  second  stage  are  called  primary  circular  reactions 
because  they  involve  the  coordination  of  parts  of  the  baby's  own  body. 
Secondary  circular  reactions  occur  when  the  baby  discovers  and  reproduces 
an  interesting  event  outside  herself  (Piaget,  1936a,  p.  154).  For  example,  one  day 
when  Piaget's  daughter  Lucienne  was  lying  in  her  bassinet,  she  made  a  move¬ 
ment  with  her  legs  that  stirred  the  dolls  hanging  overhead.  She  stared  at  the 
dolls  a  moment  and  then  moved  her  legs  again,  watching  the  dolls  move 
again.  In  the  next  few  days,  she  repeated  this  scene  many  times,  kicking  her 
legs  and  watching  the  dolls  shake,  and  she  often  would  squeal  with  laughter 
at  the  sight  of  the  moving  dolls  (pp.  157-159). 

Piaget  sometimes  referred  to  secondary  circular  reactions  as  "making 
interesting  sights  last"  (p.  153).  He  speculated  that  infants  smile  and  laugh  at 
the  recognition  of  a  moderately  novel  event.  At  the  same  time,  it  seems  they 
are  enjoying  their  own  power,  their  ability  to  make  an  event  happen  again 
and  again. 


125 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


Stage  4  (8  to  12  months): 

The  Coordination  of  Secondary  Schemes 

In  stage  3,  the  infant  performs  a  single  action  to  get  a  result — for  example,  kick¬ 
ing  to  move  some  dangling  dolls.  In  stage  4,  the  infant's  actions  become  more 
differentiated;  he  or  she  learns  to  coordinate  two  separate  schemes  to  get  a 
result.  This  new  accomplishment  is  most  apparent  when  infants  deal  with 
obstacles.  For  example,  one  day  Laurent  wanted  to  grab  a  matchbox,  but  Piaget 
put  his  hand  in  the  way.  At  first,  Laurent  tried  to  ignore  the  hand;  he  tried  to 
pass  over  it  or  around  it,  but  he  did  not  attempt  to  displace  it.  When  Piaget  kept 
his  hand  in  the  way,  Laurent  resorted  to  "storming  the  box  while  waving  his 
hand,  shaking  himself,  [and]  wagging  his  head  from  side  to  side" — various 
"magical"  gestures  (1936a,  p.  217).  Finally,  several  days  later,  Laurent  suc¬ 
ceeded  in  removing  the  obstacle  by  striking  the  hand  out  of  the  way  before  he 
grabbed  the  box.  Thus  Laurent  coordinated  two  separate  schemes — striking 
and  grabbing — to  obtain  the  goal.  One  scheme,  striking,  became  a  means  to 
an  end,  grabbing  the  box. 

Such  simple  observations  are  very  important  for  our  understanding  of 
how  children  develop  the  basic  categories  of  experience,  of  space  and  time.  We 
cannot  talk  to  babies  and  ask  them  about  their  experiences  of  space  and  time, 
but  we  can  see  how  these  categories  are  developing  through  their  actions. 
When  Laurent  learned  to  move  the  hand  to  get  the  box,  he  showed  a  sense  that 
some  objects  are  in  front  of  others  in  space,  and  that  some  events  must  precede 
others  in  time  (Ginsburg  &  Opper,  1988,  p.  52). 

Stage  5  (12  to  18  months): 

Tertiary  Circular  Reactions 

At  stage  3,  infants  perform  a  single  action  to  obtain  a  single  result — to  make 
an  interesting  sight  last.  At  stage  4,  they  perform  two  separate  actions  to  obtain 
a  single  result.  Now,  at  stage  5,  they  experiment  with  different  actions  to 
observe  the  different  outcomes. 

For  example,  one  day  Laurent  became  interested  in  a  new  table.  He  hit 
it  with  his  fist  several  times,  sometimes  harder,  sometimes  more  gently,  in 
order  to  hear  the  different  sounds  his  actions  produced  (Piaget,  1936a,  p.  270). 

Similarly,  one  day  when  our  son  Tom  was  12  months  old,  he  was  sitting 
in  the  bathtub,  watching  the  water  pour  down  from  the  faucet.  He  put  his 
hand  under  the  faucet  and  noticed  how  the  water  sprayed  outward.  He 
repeated  this  action  twice,  making  the  interesting  sight  last  (stage  3).  But  he 
then  shifted  the  position  of  his  hand,  sometimes  nearer,  sometimes  farther 
away  from  the  faucet,  observing  how  the  water  sprayed  out  at  different  angles. 
He  varied  his  actions  to  see  what  new,  different  results  would  follow. 

It  is  worth  pausing  to  note  that  the  infants  were  learning  entirely  on  their 
own,  without  any  adult  teaching.  They  were  developing  their  schemes  solely 
out  of  an  intrinsic  curiosity  about  the  world. 


126 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


Stage  6  (18  months  to  2  years): 

The  Beginnings  of  Thought 

At  stage  5,  children  are  little  scientists,  varying  their  actions  and  observing 
the  results.  However,  their  discoveries  all  occur  through  direct  physical 
actions.  At  stage  6,  children  seem  to  think  out  situations  more  internally,  before 
they  act. 

The  most  widely  known  example  of  stage  6  behavior  involves  Luci- 
enne  and  a  matchbox.  Piaget  placed  a  chain  in  the  box,  which  Lucienne 
immediately  tried  to  recover.  She  possessed  two  schemes  for  getting  the 
chain:  turning  the  box  over  and  sticking  her  finger  in  the  box's  slit.  But  nei¬ 
ther  scheme  worked.  She  then  did  something  curious.  She  stopped  her 
actions  and  looked  at  the  slit  with  great  attention.  Then,  several  times  in 
succession,  she  opened  and  shut  her  mouth,  wider  and  wider  (Piaget,  1936a, 
p.  338).  After  this,  she  promptly  opened  the  box  and  obtained  the  chain. 

Piaget  (p.  344)  noted  that  at  stage  5  the  child  probably  would  have 
obtained  the  chain  through  a  slow  trial-and-error  process  of  experimenting 
with  different  actions.  Because  Lucienne  stopped  acting  and  thought  out  the 
situation,  she  was  able  to  achieve  the  result  much  more  quickly.  She  did  not 
yet  have  a  good  grasp  of  language,  so  she  used  motor  movements  (her  mouth) 
to  symbolize  the  action  she  needed  to  perform. 

Children's  progress  at  stage  6  can  also  be  seen  in  their  efforts  at  imita¬ 
tion.  Piaget  observed  that  for  some  time  children  cannot  imitate  new  mod¬ 
els  at  all;  they  can  only  reproduce  actions  that  already  exist  in  their  behavioral 
repertoires.  By  stage  5,  though,  they  can  make  the  necessary  accommoda¬ 
tions  to  imitate  new  behavior  through  experimental  trial  and  error.  But  it  is 
only  at  stage  6  that  children  are  capable  of  deferred  imitation — the  imitation  of 
models  hours  or  days  after  observing  them.  For  example,  at  16  months  of 
age  Jacqueline 

had  a  visit  from  a  little  boy  . .  .  whom  she  used  to  see  from  time  to  time, 
and  who,  in  the  course  of  the  afternoon,  got  into  a  terrible  temper.  He 
screamed  as  he  tried  to  get  out  of  a  play-pen  and  pushed  it  backwards, 
stamping  his  feet.  J.  stood  watching  him  in  amazement,  never  having 
witnessed  such  a  scene  before.  The  next  day,  she  herself  screamed  in  her 
play-pen  and  tried  to  move  it,  stamping  her  foot  lightly  several  times  in 
succession.  The  imitation  of  the  whole  scene  was  most  striking.  (Piaget, 
1946,  p.  63) 

Piaget  argued  that  because  Jacqueline's  imitation  came  an  entire  day  later,  she 
must  have  carried  within  her  some  internal  representation  of  the  model.  Since 
she  lacked  the  vocabulary  to  represent  his  actions  in  words,  she  probably  used 
some  form  of  motoric  representation.  She  may  have  imitated  his  behavior  with 
very  brief  muscle  movements  when  she  saw  it,  and  these  movements  served 
as  the  basis  for  her  later  imitation. 


127 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


The  Development  of  Object  Permanence 

We  have  so  far  described  only  some  of  the  main  features  of  the  six  sensori¬ 
motor  stages.  Piaget  studied  other  developments  during  this  period;  he 
showed  how  infants  construct  concepts  of  permanent  objects,  time,  space,  and 
causality.  Because  of  space  limitations,  we  will  briefly  review  only  one  impor¬ 
tant  development — that  of  object  permanence. 

During  stages  1  and  2,  babies  have  no  conception  of  objects  existing  out¬ 
side  themselves.  If  a  person  or  an  object  leaves  their  field  of  vision,  the  most 
babies  do  is  to  continue  to  look  for  a  moment  to  where  they  last  saw  it.  If  the 
object  does  not  reappear,  they  go  on  to  something  else.  They  make  no  attempt 
to  search  for  it.  For  the  baby,  out  of  sight  is  out  of  mind  (Piaget,  1936b). 

At  stage  3,  new  progress  is  made.  As  babies  increasingly  explore  and 
interact  with  the  outer  world,  they  gain  a  better  sense  of  the  permanence  of 
external  things.  If  objects  are  dropped  from  their  line  of  vision,  they  now  look 
to  the  place  where  the  object  has  fallen.  They  also  can  find  partly  hidden 
objects  (if,  for  example,  a  blanket  covers  only  part  of  a  toy).  Also,  if  they 
momentarily  put  an  object  aside  and  look  elsewhere,  they  can  return  their 
attention  to  the  object  and  recover  it.  But  they  only  recover  the  object  when  it 
was  related  to  their  own  actions.  At  this  stage  they  cannot  find  objects  that  are 
completely  hidden  by  others. 

Stage  4  marks  the  beginning  of  a  genuine  sense  of  object  permanence. 
Babies  can  now  find  completely  hidden  objects.  If  we  completely  cover  a  toy 
with  a  blanket,  the  baby  will  lift  the  blanket  and  find  it. 

However,  Piaget  found  an  interesting  limitation  at  this  stage.  When  he 
hid  an  object  at  point  A,  his  children  could  find  it,  but  when  he  then  hid  the 
same  object  at  point  B,  they  again  tried  to  find  it  at  point  A — the  place  of  their 
prior  success.  In  Piaget's  terms,  they  could  not  follow  a  series  of  displace¬ 
ments  (movements  from  hiding  place  to  hiding  place). 

At  stage  5,  children  can  follow  a  series  of  displacements,  so  long  as  they 
can  see  us  making  them.  It  is  only  at  stage  6  that  infants  can  follow  invisible 
displacements.  For  example,  it  was  only  at  the  sixth  stage  that  Jacqueline  could 
recover  a  ball  that  rolled  under  the  sofa  by  making  a  detour  around  the  sofa. 
She  could  do  this  because  she  now  had  the  ability  to  visualize  to  herself, 
internally,  the  ball's  trajectory  path  even  when  it  was  invisible. 

For  Piaget,  such  detour  behavior  is  very  important.  It  shows  that  the 
child  has  constructed  a  sense  of  space  that  has  the  characteristics  of  a  mathe¬ 
matical  model  called  a  group.  For  example,  Jacqueline's  detours  demonstrate 
the  principle  of  associativity,  that  one  can  reach  a  point  through  different 
interconnected  paths.  She  also  demonstrates  the  group  principle  of 
reversibility  by  bringing  the  ball  back.  Similarly,  detour  behavior  reveals  the 
other  principles  that  define  a  coherent  group  structure  (Piaget  &  Inhelder, 
1966,  pp.  15-17). 

Less  technically,  we  can  note  the  tremendous  progress  that  infants  make. 
At  the  beginning  of  life,  they  have  no  sense  of  objects  existing  apart  from 


128 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


themselves — from  their  vision  and  actions.  By  the  end  of  the  sensorimotor 
period,  objects  are  separate  and  permanent.  Children  have  developed  a  uni¬ 
verse  containing  independent  objects,  in  which  they  are  only  one  object  among 
many.  Along  with  object  permanence,  then,  they  have  a  clear  sense  of  them¬ 
selves  as  independent  beings  (Piaget,  1936b,  pp.  108-109). 


PERIODS  II  AND  III.  PREOPERATIONAL 
THOUGHT  (2  TO  Z  YEARS)  AND  CONCRETE 
OPERATIONS  (Z  TO  1 1  YEARS) 

By  the  end  of  the  sensorimotor  period,  the  child  has  developed  efficient  and 
well-organized  actions  for  dealing  with  the  immediate  environment.  The  child 
continues  to  use  sensorimotor  skills  throughout  life,  but  the  next  period,  that 
of  preoperational  thought,  is  marked  by  a  major  change.  The  child's  mind 
rapidly  advances  to  a  new  plane,  that  of  symbols  (including  images  and 
words).  As  a  result,  the  child  must  organize  her  thinking  all  over  again.  This 
cannot  be  done  at  once.  For  some  time,  during  the  entire  preoperational 
period,  the  child's  thinking  is  basically  unsystematic  and  illogical.  It  is  not 
until  the  age  of  7  or  so,  the  beginning  of  concrete  operations,  that  thinking 
becomes  organized  on  a  mental  plane  (Piaget,  1964a,  p.  22). 


The  Growth  of  Symbolic  Activity 

Children  begin  to  use  symbols  when  they  use  one  object  or  action  to  represent 
an  absent  one  (Ginsburg  &  Opper,  1988,  p.  70).  Actually,  as  we  have  seen,  chil¬ 
dren  begin  to  do  this  during  the  sixth  stage  of  sensorimotor  development.  For 
example,  when  Lucienne  opened  her  mouth  before  opening  the  matchbox, 
she  used  her  mouth  to  represent  an  action  she  had  not  yet  performed.  Piaget 
emphasized  that  the  first  symbols  are  motoric,  not  linguistic. 

We  also  see  nonlinguistic  symbols  in  children's  make-believe  play,  which 
also  begins  toward  the  end  of  the  sensorimotor  period.  One  day  Jacqueline 
pretended  that  a  piece  of  cloth  was  her  pillow.  She  put  her  head  on  the  cloth 
and,  laughing,  pretended  to  go  to  sleep.  Her  play  was  symbolic  because  she 
used  one  object,  a  piece  of  cloth,  to  represent  an  absent  one,  the  pillow  (Piaget, 
1946,  p.  96). 

As  their  make-believe  play  develops,  children  start  adding  words.  When 
Jacqueline  had  just  turned  2  years  old,  she  moved  her  finger  along  a  table  and 
said,  "Horse  trotting."  A  few  days  later,  she  slid  a  postcard  along  the  table 
and  said,  "Car."  Her  words,  like  her  finger  and  the  postcard,  symbolized 
objects  not  present  in  the  immediate  situation  (Piaget,  1946,  p.  124). 

Language  develops  rapidly  during  the  early  preoperational  years  (from 
about  age  2  to  4),  and  it  vastly  widens  the  child's  horizons.  Through  language. 


129 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


the  child  can  relive  the  past,  anticipate  the  future,  and  communicate  events  to 
others.  But  precisely  because  the  young  child's  mind  is  so  rapidly  expanding, 
it  initially  lacks  the  properties  of  a  coherent  logic.  This  is  apparent  in  the  young 
child's  use  of  words.  He  or  she  does  not  use  words  to  stand  for  true  classes  of 
objects,  but  merely  as  preconcepts.  For  example,  when  Jacqueline  was  3  years 
old,  she  said  that  a  daddy  is  a  man  who  "has  lots  of  Luciennes  and  lots  of 
Jacquelines"  (p.  255).  She  did  not  yet  possess  the  concept  of  a  general  class, 
children,  within  which  those  with  the  names  Lucienne  and  Jacqueline  com¬ 
prise  only  a  small  subset. 

Because  children  lack  general  classes,  their  reasoning  is  frequently 
transductive,  shifting  from  the  particular  to  the  particular.  At  4  !  2  years  Luci¬ 
enne  said,  "I  haven't  had  my  nap  yet  so  it  isn't  afternoon"  (p.  232).  She  did  not 
yet  understand  that  afternoons  are  general  time  periods  that  contain  many 
particular  events,  of  which  her  nap  was  only  one. 

Some  psychologists  believe  that  children  learn  to  think  more  logically  as 
they  master  language.  In  this  view,  language  provides  us  with  our  concep¬ 
tual  categories  (see  Brown,  1965).  Piaget,  however,  disagreed.  Although  lan¬ 
guage  is  tremendously  important — it  provides  us  with  a  source  of  shared 
symbols  for  communicating  with  others — it  does  not  itself  provide  the  struc¬ 
ture  of  logical  thinking.  Logic,  instead,  stems  from  actions.  Infants  develop 
logically  coherent  action  systems  during  the  sensorimotor  period,  before  they 
talk,  and  later  logic  is  simply  organized  actions  of  a  more  internal  kind  (Piaget 
&  Inhelder,  1966,  pp.  86-90).  To  study  how  internal  actions  form  logical  sys¬ 
tems,  Piaget  gave  children  various  scientific  tasks.  He  usually  began  such 
experiments  with  children  at  age  4  years,  because  they  could  now  sit  down, 
focus  on  the  tasks,  and  communicate  with  the  examiner. 


Scientific  Reasoning 

Conservation  of  Continuous  Quantities  (Liquids).  This  is  Piaget's 
most  famous  experiment.  In  one  version  (Piaget  &  Szeminska,  1941,  p.  17), 
the  child  is  shown  two  glasses,  A1  and  A2,  that  are  filled  to  the  same  height 
(see  Figure  1).  The  child  is  asked  if  the  two  glasses  contain  the  same  amount 
of  liquid,  and  the  child  almost  always  agrees  that  they  do.  Next,  the  experi¬ 
menter  (or  the  child)  pours  the  liquid  from  A2  to  glass  P,  which  is  lower  and 
wider.  The  child  is  asked  if  the  amount  of  liquid  is  still  the  same.  At  the 
preoperationcd  level,  the  responses  fall  into  two  substages. 

At  the  first  substage,  the  children  clearly  fail  to  conserve — that  is,  they 
fail  to  realize  that  the  quantity  is  the  same.  Usually,  they  say  that  A1  now  has 
more  because  it  is  taller.  Occasionally,  the  child  says  that  P  now  has  more 
because  it  is  wider.  In  either  case,  the  child  "centers"  on  only  one  dimen¬ 
sion,  the  height  or  the  width.  The  child  is  so  struck  by  a  single  perceptual 
dimension — the  way  it  looks — that  he  or  she  fails  to  understand  that  logically 
the  liquid  must  remain  the  same. 


130 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


Figure  1 

Conservation-of-liquid  experi¬ 
ment.  A  child  sees  that 
beakers  A1  and  A2  contain 
the  same  amount  of  liquid. 

He  then  pours  A2  into  P 
and  claims  that  now  A1  has 
more  because  it  is  taller. 


131 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


At  the  second  substage,  the  child  takes  steps  toward  conservation  but 
does  not  achieve  it.  A  boy  might  at  one  moment  say  that  A1  has  more  because 
it  is  taller,  then  change  his  mind  and  say  that  P  has  more  because  it  is  wider, 
and  then  become  confused.  The  boy  is  showing  "intuitive  regulations";  he  is 
beginning  to  consider  two  perceptual  dimensions,  but  he  does  not  yet  rea¬ 
son  about  the  two  dimensions  simultaneously  and  recognize  that  a  change 
in  one  dimension  cancels  out  a  change  in  the  other.  His  confusion,  however, 
means  he  is  becoming  aware  that  he  is  contradicting  himself,  and  it  is  a  good 
bet  that  he  will  soon  resolve  the  contradiction  and  move  on  to  the  stage  of 
conservation. 

Children  generally  achieve  conservation  of  liquids  at  about  7  years. 
When  they  do  so,  they  are  entering  the  stage  of  concrete  operations.  Basically, 
children  demonstrate  conservation  by  using  three  arguments.  First,  the  child 
might  say,  "You  haven't  added  any  or  taken  any  away,  so  it  has  to  be  the 
same."  This  is  the  identity  argument.  Second,  the  child  might  say,  "This  glass 
is  taller  here,  but  the  other  one  is  wider  here,  so  they're  still  the  same."  This 
is  the  argument  of  compensation — that  the  changes  cancel  each  other  out.  The 
child  assumes  that  the  changes  are  part  of  an  organized  system — that  a  change 
in  one  dimension  is  necessarily  related  to  a  compensating  change  in  another 
dimension.  Third,  the  child  might  say,  "They  are  still  the  same  because  you  can 
pour  this  one  back  to  what  it  was  before."  This  is  the  argument  of  inversion 
(Piaget  &  Inhelder,  1966,  p.  98).  Piaget  believed  the  concrete  operational  child 
can  use  all  three  arguments,  although  the  child  might  not  spontaneously  do 
so  on  any  given  task. 

Underlying  these  arguments  are  logical  operations — mental  actions  that 
are  reversible  (p.  96).  When  the  child  argues  that  a  change  in  height  is  canceled 
out  by  a  change  in  width,  the  child  understands  that  the  end  result  is  a  return, 
or  reversal,  to  the  original  amount.  The  principle  of  reversibility  is  obvious,  of 
course,  when  the  child  uses  the  inversion  argument,  pointing  out  that  "You 
can  pour  it  back." 

Operations,  it  is  important  to  note,  are  mental  actions.  The  child  has  not 
actually  performed  or  seen  the  transformations  she  is  talking  about.  She  is 
only  thinking,  for  example,  about  pouring  water  back.  Operations  are  similar 
to  the  actions  of  the  infant  (as  when  an  infant  places  a  toy  under  a  blanket 
and  pulls  it  back  out),  but  operations  are  on  a  more  mental  plane. 

People  sometimes  wonder  if  young  children  might  fail  to  conserve 
simply  because  of  their  difficulties  with  language.  They  might  think  that 
what  the  experimenter  means  by  "more"  is  "taller,"  and  therefore  they  point 
to  the  taller  glass.  One  can  get  around  such  difficulties  by  changing  one's 
wording — for  example,  by  asking,  "Which  one  would  give  you  more  to 
drink?"  Usually  we  find  that  the  young  child  still  fails  to  conserve  (Peill,  1975, 
p.  7,  chap.  2). 

How  does  the  child  learn  conservation?  The  most  ready  answer  is  that 
conservation  is  taught.  However,  as  we  shall  see,  the  teaching  of  conservation 


132 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


frequently  meets  with  unexpected  resistance.  The  preoperational  child  does 
not  genuinely  believe  the  adult's  explanations. 

Piaget  argued  that  children  master  conservation  spontaneously.  The  cru¬ 
cial  moment  comes  at  the  second  substage,  when  the  child  first  says  that  one 
glass  has  more  because  it  is  taller,  then  says  the  other  has  more  because  it  is 
wider,  and  then  becomes  confused.  The  child  is  in  a  state  of  internal  contra¬ 
diction,  which  she  resolves  by  moving  on  to  a  higher  stage.  Sometimes  we  can 
see  this  change  happen  before  our  very  eyes.  The  child  says,  "This  has 
more  .  .  .  no,  that  one  is  wider,  no,  wait.  They're  both  the  same.  This  looks 
taller,  but  you've  poured  it  into  a  wider  glass." 

Conservation  of  Number.  In  one  of  his  experiments  Piaget  gave 
children  a  row  of  egg  cups  and  a  bunch  of  eggs  (Piaget  &  Szeminska,  1941, 
pp.  49-56;  Inhelder,  1971).  Piaget  then  asked  the  children  to  take  just  enough 
eggs  to  fill  the  cups.  Again,  the  responses  at  the  preoperational  period  fell 
into  two  substages. 

At  the  first  substage,  the  children  simply  made  the  rows  equal  in  length, 
ignoring  the  number  of  eggs  in  the  row.  When  Piaget  then  asked  them  to  actu¬ 
ally  put  the  eggs  in  the  cups,  they  were  surprised  to  find  they  had  too  many 
or  too  few  eggs. 

At  the  second  preoperational  stage,  the  children  spontaneously  created  a 
one-to-one  correspondence,  placing  one  egg  beneath  each  cup  (see  Figure  2). 
According  to  Piaget,  they  used  an  intuitive  approach  to  achieve  a  precise  per¬ 
ceptual  order.  However,  their  success  was  limited  to  this  simple  perceptual 
arrangement.  When  Piaget  then  bunched  up  (or  sometimes  spread  out)  one  of 
the  rows,  the  children  claimed  that  now  one  had  more.  As  with  conservation  of 
liquids,  the  children  failed  to  conserve  because  they  were  more  influenced  by 
their  immediate  perceptions  than  by  logic.  Because  one  row  now  looked  so 
much  longer,  they  failed  to  reason  that  the  number  must  remain  the  same. 

At  this  stage,  in  addition,  children  sometimes  begin  to  waver  in  their 
answers.  One  moment  they  say  that  one  row  has  more  because  it  is  longer,  but 
the  next  moment  they  think  the  other  row  has  more  because  it  is  denser.  This 
state  of  conflict  marks  the  transition  to  concrete  operations. 

At  the  stage  of  concrete  operations,  children  realize  that  the  number  in 
each  row  is  the  same  despite  the  different  appearances  in  length.  They  reason 
that  the  two  rows  are  the  same  because  "you  haven't  taken  any  away  or  added 
any"  (identity),  because  "one  row  is  longer  here  but  this  one  is  more  bunched 
in"  (compensation),  or  because  "you  could  make  this  row  long  again  and 
make  them  equal"  (inversion). 

Other  Conservation  Experiments.  Piaget  has  studied  several  other 
kinds  of  conservation,  such  as  the  conservation  of  substance,  weight,  volume, 
and  length.  For  example,  in  a  conservation-of-substance  experiment,  the  child 
is  shown  two  equal  balls  of  plasticine  or  play  dough  and  then  watches  as  one 


133 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


°o^o 

o°o 


Figure  2 

Conservation  of  number  experiment.  Young  children  can  often  create  two  rows  of 
equal  number,  but  if  we  shorten  or  bunch  up  one  row  they  think  that  the  number  has 
changed. 


ball  is  rolled  into  a  longer,  thinner  shape,  like  that  of  a  hot  dog.  At  the  pre- 
operational  level,  the  child  thinks  the  two  balls  now  have  different  amounts 
of  play  dough. 

We  will  not  describe  the  various  kinds  of  conservation  here,  but  simply 
note  that  they  all  are  thought  to  involve  the  mastery  of  the  same  logical 
concepts — identity,  inversion,  and  compensation.  Nevertheless,  some  kinds  of 
conservation  appear  more  difficult  than  others  and  are  mastered  later.2  Thus 
the  attainment  of  conservation  is  a  gradual  process  within  the  concrete  oper¬ 
ational  period. 

Classification.  In  a  typical  classification  experiment,  Piaget  (Piaget 
&  Szeminska,  1941,  pp.  161-181)  presented  children  with  20  wooden  beads — 
18  brown  and  2  white.  Piaget  made  sure  the  children  understood  that 
although  most  beads  were  brown  and  two  were  white,  they  all  were  made 
of  wood.  He  then  asked  the  children,  "Are  there  more  brown  beads  or  more 
wooden  beads?"  At  the  preoperational  level,  the  children  said  there  were 
more  brown  beads.  Apparently  they  were  so  struck  by  the  many  brown 
beads  in  comparison  to  the  two  white  ones  that  they  failed  to  realize  that 


2In  fact,  the  mastery  of  one  series — conservation  of  substance,  weight,  and  volume — 
may  always  occur  in  the  same  invariant  sequence  (Ginsburg  &  Opper,  1988,  pp.  151-153;  Piaget 
&  Inhelder,  1966,  p.  99). 


134 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


both  brown  and  white  beads  are  parts  of  a  larger  whole — the  class  of  wooden 
beads.  As  with  conservation,  children  master  such  classification  tasks  dur¬ 
ing  the  period  of  concrete  operations,  and  the  same  logical  operations  appear 
to  be  involved  (p.  178). 


Social  Thinking 

Egocentrism.  Piaget  believed  that  at  each  period  there  is  a  general 
correspondence  between  scientific  and  social  thinking.  For  example,  just  as 
preoperational  children  fail  to  consider  two  dimensions  on  conservation  tasks, 
they  also  fail  to  consider  more  than  one  perspective  in  their  interactions  with 
others.  Preoperational  children  are  frequently  egocentric,  considering  every¬ 
thing  from  their  own  single  viewpoint.  This  is  apparent  from  young  children's 
conversations  (Piaget,  1923).  A  little  girl  might  tell  her  friend,  "I'm  putting 
this  here,"  oblivious  to  the  fact  that  the  place  to  which  she  is  pointing  is 
blocked  from  her  friend's  vision. 

One  of  Piaget's  most  widely  quoted  studies  on  egocentrism  dealt  with 
the  child's  perception  of  space.  In  this  study  (Piaget  &  Inhelder,  1948)  the 
child  was  taken  for  a  walk  around  a  model  of  three  mountains  so  he  or  she 
could  see  how  the  model  looked  from  different  angles.  After  the  walk,  the 
child  was  seated  on  one  side  of  the  model,  facing  a  doll  that  looked  at  the 
model  from  the  opposite  side.  The  child  was  then  asked  to  select  from  among 
several  photographs  the  picture  that  best  showed  what  he  or  she  saw  and 
the  picture  that  showed  what  the  doll  saw.  All  the  children  could  pick  the 
picture  that  represented  their  own  view,  but  the  youngest  children  (from 
about  4  to  6  years)  frequently  chose  the  same  picture  to  show  the  doll's  view. 
Apparently,  they  did  not  understand  that  the  doll's  perspective  differed  from 
their  own. 

Egocentrism,  then,  refers  to  the  inability  to  distinguish  one's  own  per¬ 
spective  from  that  of  others.  Egocentrism  does  not,  however,  necessarily  imply 
selfishness  or  conceit.  This  point  can  be  clarified  by  an  example.  One  day  two 
boys  went  shopping  with  their  aunt  for  a  birthday  present  for  their  mother. 
The  older  boy,  who  was  7,  picked  out  a  piece  of  jewelry.  The  younger  boy, 
who  was  3  l/  2,  selected  a  model  car.  The  younger  child's  behavior  was  not  self¬ 
ish  or  greedy;  he  carefully  wrapped  the  present  and  gave  it  to  his  mother  with 
an  expression  that  clearly  showed  that  he  expected  her  to  love  it.  However,  his 
behavior  was  egocentric;  he  did  not  consider  the  fact  that  his  mother's  inter¬ 
ests  were  different  from  his  own. 

As  long  as  children  are  egocentric,  they  tend  simply  to  play  alongside 
one  another.  For  example,  two  children  in  the  sandbox  will  build  their  own 
structures.  As  they  overcome  egocentrism,  they  learn  to  coordinate  their  actions 
in  joint  endeavors.  Each  might  dig  a  tunnel  so  that  the  tunnels  eventually  con¬ 
nect.  This  requires  considering  each  other's  perspective.  Such  cooperative  play 
occurs  at  the  stage  of  concrete  operations. 


135 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


or  so — believed  the  rules  were  fixed  and  unchangeable.  They  said  the  rules 
came  from  some  prestigious  authority,  from  the  government,  or  from  God. 
The  rules  could  not  be  changed,  they  asserted,  because  then  it  wouldn't  be 
the  real  game. 

After  the  age  of  10  or  so,  the  children  were  more  relativistic.  Rules  were 
seen  simply  as  mutually  agreed-upon  ways  of  playing  the  game.  Children 
no  longer  considered  the  rules  as  fixed  or  absolute;  they  said  the  rules  prob¬ 
ably  had  changed  over  the  years,  as  children  invented  new  rules.  And  they 
added  that  they  too  could  change  them,  as  long  as  everyone  in  the  game 
agreed  (pp.  50-76). 

These  different  conceptions  of  rules,  Piaget  said,  reveal  two  basic  moral 
attitudes.  The  first,  characteristic  of  the  younger  children,  is  moral  heteronomy, 
a  blind  obedience  to  rules  imposed  by  adults.  Children  assume  there  is  one 
powerful  law  that  they  must  always  follow.  The  second  morality — that  of  the 
older  children — is  autonomy.  This  morality  considers  rules  as  human  devices 
produced  by  equals  for  the  sake  of  cooperation  (pp.  401-406). 

Piaget  believed  that  moral  heteronomy  is  tied  to  egocentrism;  children 
view  rules  from  a  single  perspective,  seeing  only  what  powerful  adults 
impose.  As  a  form  of  egocentrism,  moral  heteronomy  is  overcome  quite  late, 
at  the  age  of  10  or  so,  compared  to  egocentric  play,  which  is  usually  overcome 
by  age  7.  Here,  Piaget  reminded  us  that  heteronomy  is  a  form  of  egocentric 
thought  and  said  that  thought  often  lags  behind  action.  Children  may  need  to 
engage  in  a  good  deal  of  genuinely  cooperative  play  with  peers,  in  which  they 
actually  change  rules  to  meet  everyone's  satisfaction,  before  they  can  discuss 
the  relativity  of  rules  on  a  conscious  plane  (pp.  94-95). 

In  their  informal  play,  older  children's  interest  in  the  formulation  of  rules 
can  become  quite  keen.  Piaget  (1932,  p.  50)  described  how  a  group  of  10-  and 
11-year-olds,  preparing  for  a  snowball  fight,  spent  considerable  time  debating 
the  rules  for  voting  on  a  "president"  for  the  game,  dividing  themselves  into 
teams,  deciding  the  distances  of  the  shots,  and  discussing  the  appropriate 
sanctions  for  violations  of  the  rules.  According  to  one  account  of  the  episode, 
the  boys  were  called  home  before  they  got  a  chance  to  begin  the  actual  snow¬ 
ball  fight,  but  all  seemed  content  with  their  afternoon  (Ginsburg  &  Opper, 
1988,  p.  98).  What  really  interested  them  was  the  discussion  of  rules.  Children 
at  this  age  are  like  little  lawyers,  discussing  what  is  fair  and  right.  In  the 
process,  they  develop  their  conceptions  of  justice. 

Animism.  Piaget  described  other  ways  in  which  young  children's 
thinking  differs  from  that  of  older  children  and  adults.  Like  Werner,  Piaget 
observed  that  young  children  do  not  make  the  same  distinctions  between  liv¬ 
ing  and  nonliving  things  that  adults  do.  As  Werner  said,  they  perceive  every¬ 
thing,  including  physical  objects,  physiognomically,  as  full  of  life  and  feeling. 
A  loud  truck  may  seem  angry  and  a  single  cloud  lonely.  Piaget  called  this 
view  of  the  physical  world  animistic. 


137 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


Egocentrism  also  may  influence  young  children's  speech,  as  when  they 
engage  in  "collective  monologues."  Two  little  girls  may  appear  to  be  holding 
a  conversation  while  they  play,  but  each  girl  is  actually  just  talking  about  what 
is  on  her  own  mind.  One  girl  might  talk  about  a  toy  house  she  is  building 
while  the  other  talks  about  a  trip  she  took,  and  no  connection  is  ever  made. 
As  children  overcome  egocentrism,  they  consider  the  reactions  and  view¬ 
points  of  their  listeners. 

Much  peer  interaction,  then,  is  initially  egocentric.  Nevertheless,  Piaget 
(1923,  p.  101;  1932,  p.  94)  speculated,  children  overcome  egocentrism  as  they 
interact  less  exclusively  with  adults  and  more  with  other  children.  They  dis¬ 
cover  that  whereas  grownups  seem  to  understand  whatever  is  on  their  minds, 
their  peers  do  not.  Consequently,  they  learn  to  consider  others'  viewpoints  in 
order  to  make  themselves  understood. 

Furthermore,  children  are  less  impressed  by  the  authority  of  other  chil¬ 
dren  and  feel  freer  to  engage  in  conflicts  with  them.  They  argue  with  their 
peers  and  sometimes  reach  compromises  and  cooperate  with  them.  They  begin 
to  coordinate  alternative  viewpoints  and  interests  (Piaget,  1924,  p.  205). 

Whether  children  overcome  egocentrism  primarily  through  peer  inter¬ 
action  or  not,  the  most  crucial  point  for  Piaget's  theory  is  that  children  them¬ 
selves  play  an  active  role  in  grasping  the  fact  of  alternative  viewpoints.  On 
this  point,  I  recall  an  instance  in  which  our  son  Adam,  then  5  years  old, 
seemed  actually  to  make  this  discovery.  He  was  riding  alone  in  the  car  with 
me  when,  after  a  few  minutes  of  silence,  he  said,  "You  know,  Dad,  you're  not 
remembering  what  I'm  remembering."  I  asked  him  what  he  meant,  and  he 
replied,  "Like  I  was  remembering  about  my  shoes,  but  you  can't  see  what 
I'm  remembering;  you  can't  be  remembering  what  I'm  remembering."  At 
that  moment  he  seemed  actually  to  discover,  by  himself,  that  others'  per¬ 
spectives  differ  from  his  own.  He  might  not  have  completely  surmounted 
his  egocentrism  at  that  instant,  but  the  point  is  that  whatever  step  he  took,  he 
took  on  his  own. 

Moral  Judgment.  Piaget  investigated  children's  social  thought  in 
many  areas,  including  morals.  In  his  classic  work.  The  Moral  Judgment  of  the 
Child  (1932),  he  paid  particular  attention  to  how  children  understood  the  rules 
of  the  game  of  marbles. 

Piaget  first  observed  how  children  actually  played  the  game,  and  he 
found  that  between  the  ages  of  4  and  7  children  typically  played  in  an  ego¬ 
centric  manner.  If  two  boys  were  playing,  each  would  play  in  his  own  way. 
They  had  little  sense  of  winning — one  might  exclaim,  "I  won  and  you  won 
too!"  After  the  age  of  about  7  years,  children  tried  to  follow  common  rules 
and  win  according  to  them  (pp.  29-46). 

Piaget  next  investigated  children's  thinking  about  the  rules.  He  was 
particularly  interested  in  whether  children  thought  the  rules  could  be 
changed.  Here,  he  found  that  children  for  several  years — up  to  the  age  of  10 


136 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


Although  Piaget  and  Werner  were  struck  by  a  similar  attitude  in  young 
children,  they  studied  it  somewhat  differently.  Werner  was  concerned  with 
children's  direct  perceptions  of  objects;  Piaget  was  more  interested  in  their 
concepts  and  definitions  of  life. 

At  first,  Piaget  found  that  children  equate  life  with  any  kind  of  activity. 
For  example,  one  boy  was  asked, 

Is  the  sun  alive? — Yes. — Why? — It  gives  light. — Is  a  candle  alive? — Yes 
because  it  gives  light.  It  is  alive  when  it  is  giving  light,  but  it  isn't  alive  when 
it  is  not  giving  light. ...  Is  the  play-bell  alive? — Yes,  it  rings.  (Piaget,  1926, 
p.  196) 

Such  thinking  is  common  between  the  ages  of  4  and  6  years. 

A  bit  later,  between  the  ages  of  about  6  and  8,  children  restrict  life  to 
things  that  move.  For  example. 

Is  a  stone  alive? — Yes. — Why? — It  moves,  .  .  .  How  does  it  move? — By 
rolling. — Is  the  table  alive? — No,  it  can't  move.  ...  Is  a  bicycle  alive? — 
Yes. — Why? — It  goes.  (p.  196) 

Only  after  8  years  or  so  do  children  restrict  life  to  objects  that  move  on  their 
own  and,  later,  to  plants  and  animals. 

Piaget  found  roughly  similar  stages  in  thinking  about  the  kinds  of  objects 
that  have  feelings  and  consciousness.  At  first,  children  believe  that  an  object 
has  feelings  if  it  reacts  in  any  way.  For  example,  a  stick  feels  fire  because  it 
gets  burnt.  A  bit  later,  children  restrict  feelings  and  consciousness  to  objects 
that  move,  then  to  objects  that  move  on  their  own,  and  finally  to  animals. 

Thus  children  gradually  abandon  their  animism  and  come  to  make  the 
distinctions  characteristic  of  most  adults.  The  fate  of  animism  in  Piaget's  the¬ 
ory,  we  might  note,  differs  from  that  of  physiognomic  perception  in  Werner's. 
For  Werner,  physiognomic  perception,  while  less  dominant  in  most  adults 
than  in  young  children,  nevertheless  remains  with  us  and  contributes  to  our 
artistic  and  poetic  outlooks.  For  Piaget,  animism  is  simply  overcome. 

Dreams.  One  of  Piaget's  earliest  studies  examined  children's  concep¬ 
tions  of  dreams  (1926,  chap.  3).  As  with  conceptions  of  life,  young  children's 
understanding  of  dreams  seems  to  follow  a  specific  stage  sequence.  Since 
Piaget's  first  study,  others  (especially  the  American  psychologist  Lawrence 
Kohlberg,  1966a)  have  refined  Piaget's  dream  sequence. 

At  first,  children  seem  to  believe  that  dreams  are  real.  For  example, 
when  a  4-year-old  girl  was  asked  if  the  giant  in  her  dream  was  really  there, 
she  answered,  "It  was  really  there  but  it  left  when  I  woke  up.  I  saw  its  foot¬ 
print  on  the  floor''  (Kohlberg,  1966a,  p.  6).  Soon  afterward,  children  discover 
that  dreams  are  not  real,  but  they  still  view  dreams  quite  differently  from  the 


138 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


way  older  children  or  adults  view  them.  They  think  their  dreams  are  visible 
to  others  and  that  dreams  come  from  the  outside  (from  the  night  or  the  sky, 
or  through  the  window  from  the  lights  outside).  They  also  think  dreams 
remain  outside  themselves  while  they  are  dreaming.  It  is  as  if  they  were 
watching  a  movie,  with  the  action  taking  place  in  their  rooms  in  front  of  their 
eyes.  Gradually,  stage  by  stage,  children  realize  that  dreams  not  only  are 
unreal  but  are  also  invisible,  of  internal  origin,  of  internal  location,  and  pos¬ 
sess  the  other  characteristics  that  adults  assign  to  them.  Children  usually 
complete  their  discoveries  by  the  age  of  6  or  7  years,  at  the  beginning  of  con¬ 
crete  operations. 

How  do  children  learn  about  dreams?  Our  first  assumption  probably  is 
that  they  learn  about  them  from  adults.  When  children  have  nightmares, 
parents  reassure  them,  saying,  "Don't  worry,  it  was  only  a  dream.  It  wasn't 
real;  it  was  only  in  your  mind."  Piagetians,  however,  maintain  that  children 
actually  discover  the  various  properties  of  dreams  on  their  own.  Kohlberg 
(1966a),  for  example,  argued  that  because  children  master  the  dream  sequence 
in  an  invariant  six-stage  sequence,  it  is  unlikely  that  their  thinking  is  the  prod¬ 
uct  of  adult  teachings;  adults  do  not  take  the  trouble  to  teach  children  about 
dreams  in  such  a  detailed,  precise  order.  Instead,  children  arrive  at  different 
conceptualizations  on  their  own,  in  an  order  of  increasing  difficulty. 

To  gather  additional  information  on  the  role  of  adult  teaching,  Kohlberg 
(1966a)  administered  the  dream  interview  to  children  in  an  aboriginal  society 
in  which  the  adults  believe  dreams  are  real  (the  Atayal  on  Formosa).  Despite 
the  adults'  beliefs,  these  children  seem  to  progress  through  the  stages  in  the 
same  order  as  American  or  Swiss  children.  That  is,  they  first  discover  that 
dreams  are  unreal,  then  that  they  are  invisible,  and  so  on.  Finally,  when  they 
reach  the  last  stage,  they  feel  the  impact  of  the  adult  views  and  change  their 
minds,  adopting  the  view  that  dreams  are  real  after  all.  Still,  they  initially 
progress  through  the  dream  sequence  in  opposition  to  any  adult  beliefs,  so 
adult  views  cannot  be  the  sole  determinants  of  their  learnings. 


Summary  and  Conclusion 

Piaget  argued  that  children's  thinking  during  the  preoperational  period  is 
very  different  from  that  of  older  children  and  adults.  Preoperational  thinking 
is  characterized  by  egocentrism,  animism,  moral  heteronomy,  a  view  of 
dreams  as  external  events,  a  lack  of  classification,  a  lack  of  conservation,  as  well 
as  other  attributes  we  have  not  had  the  space  to  cover. 

The  list  is  a  long  one,  and  you  might  ask,  "What  do  all  these  characteris¬ 
tics  have  in  common?"  The  question  is  central  to  Piaget's  theory,  for  it  maintains 
that  each  developmental  stage  has  a  basic  unity.  Unfortunately,  Piaget  did  not 
give  as  much  attention  to  this  question  as  we  would  like,  but  most  often 
(e.g.,  1964a,  pp.  41-60),  he  tried  to  link  the  various  preoperational  characteristics 
to  the  concept  of  egocentrism. 


139 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


In  speech,  children  are  egocentric  when  they  consider  matters  only  from 
their  own  perspective.  Animism — the  attribution  of  life  to  physical  objects — 
also  stems  from  egocentrism;  children  assume  that  everything  functions  just 
as  they  do.  Similarly,  Piaget  tried  to  show  that  young  children's  conceptions 
of  dreams  are  related  to  egocentrism.  As  long  as  children  are  egocentric,  they 
fail  to  realize  the  extent  to  which  each  person  has  private,  subjective  experi¬ 
ences  such  as  dreams.  In  the  realm  of  morals,  furthermore,  egocentrism  goes 
hand  in  hand  with  moral  heteronomy.  Young  children  regard  rules  from  only 
one  perspective,  as  absolutes  handed  down  from  above.  They  do  not  yet  see 
how  rules  are  based  on  the  mutual  agreements  of  two  or  more  actors  attempt¬ 
ing  to  coordinate  their  different  objectives  in  a  cooperative  way. 

There  is  also  a  link  between  egocentrism  and  children's  performances  on 
scientific  tasks,  such  as  the  experiments  on  conservation.  Just  as  the  egocen¬ 
tric  child  views  things  from  a  single  perspective,  the  child  who  fails  to  conserve 
focuses  on  only  one  aspect  of  the  problem.  For  example,  when  water  is  poured 
from  one  glass  into  a  shorter,  broader  one,  the  child  "centers"  on  a  single  strik¬ 
ing  dimension — the  difference  in  height.  The  child  cannot  "decenter"  and  con¬ 
sider  two  aspects  of  the  situation  at  once. 

Children  at  the  level  of  concrete  operations  are  able  to  consider  two 
aspects  of  a  problem  simultaneously.  In  their  social  interactions,  they  consider 
not  only  what  they  are  saying  but  also  the  needs  of  the  listener.  When  they 
perform  conservation  experiments,  they  consider  not  only  the  most  visible 
change  but  also  a  compensating  change.  The  coordination  of  two  perspectives 
forms  the  basis  of  both  their  social  and  their  scientific  thinking  (Piaget,  1947, 
pp.  156-166). 


PERIOD  IV.  FORMAL  OPERATIONS 
(1 1  YEARS  TO  ADULTHOOD) 

At  concrete  operations,  children  can  think  systematically  in  terms  of  "mental 
actions."  For  example,  when  water  is  poured  into  a  new  glass,  they  can  tell  us 
about  the  implications  of  reversing  the  process,  without  actually  performing 
the  activity.  However,  there  is  a  limit  to  such  abilities.  They  can  think  logi¬ 
cally  and  systematically  only  as  long  as  they  refer  to  tangible  objects  that  can 
be  subjected  to  real  activity  (Piaget,  1964a,  p.  62). 

During  formal  operations,  in  contrast,  thinking  soars  into  the  realm  of 
the  purely  abstract  and  hypothetical.  The  capacity  for  abstract  reasoning  can 
be  seen  in  responses  to  questions  such  as  the  following:  If  Joe  is  shorter  than 
Bob,  and  Joe  is  taller  than  Alex,  who  is  the  tallest?  At  the  level  of  concrete 
operations,  children  can  handle  this  problem  only  if  they  actually  place 
people  in  order  and  compare  their  heights;  beyond  this,  they  simply  guess.  At 
the  level  of  formal  operations,  however,  adolescents  can  order  their  thoughts 
in  their  minds  alone  (p.  62). 


140 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


Piaget  was  most  concerned  with  the  capacity  to  reason  with  respect  to 
hypothetical  possibilities.  In  one  experiment  (Inhelder  &  Piaget,  1955, 
pp.  107-122),  children  were  given  four  flasks  containing  colorless  liquids,  labeled 
1, 2, 3,  and  4.  They  also  were  given  a  small  container  of  colorless  liquid,  labeled 
g.  Their  task  was  to  mix  these  liquids  to  make  the  color  yellow. 

At  the  level  of  preoperational  intelligence,  children  typically  made  a 
mess.  They  poured  the  liquids  in  and  out  of  the  bottles  in  a  haphazard  way. 

At  the  level  of  concrete  operations,  children's  actions  showed  more 
organization.  A  typical  strategy  was  to  pour  g  into  each  flask:  g  into  1,  g  into 
2,  g  into  3,  and  g  into  4.  However,  they  then  gave  up.  When  questioned, 
these  children  usually  said  there  wasn't  anything  more  they  could  do.  Thus 
their  actions  revealed  some  organization,  as  we  could  have  expected  from 
their  systematic  behavior  on  conservation  tasks,  on  which  they  can  think  in 
terms  of  two  dimensions  at  once.  But  they  entertained  only  a  limited  range 
of  possibilities. 

At  the  level  of  formal  operations,  the  adolescents  worked  systematically 
in  terms  of  nil  possibilities.  Some  started  out  by  trying  various  combinations  and 
then  realized  they  had  better  make  sure  that  they  would  include  all  possible 
combinations,  so  they  wrote  them  down  before  acting  any  further. 

When  adolescents  think  about  the  various  possibilities  inherent  in  a  situ¬ 
ation  beforehand  and  then  systematically  test  them,  they  are  working  like  true 
scientists.  For  example,  a  teenage  girl  might  test  the  effects  of  a  new  soil  for 
plants.  At  the  level  of  formal  operations,  she  does  not  just  put  new  soil  into  one 
pot  and  old  soil  into  the  other  and  watch  the  plants  grow;  she  considers  other 
possibilities.  Perhaps  these  two  plants  would  have  grown  to  different  heights 
anyway,  because  of  individual  differences,  so  she  obtains  several  plants  and 
examines  the  average  effects  of  the  different  soils.  Perhaps  the  sunlight  also  has 
an  effect,  so  she  makes  sure  that  all  the  plants  are  exposed  to  the  same  sunlight. 
Perhaps  the  amount  of  water  is  also  important,  so  she  controls  for  this  variable 
too.  The  essence  of  such  reasoning  is  that  one  is  systematically  thinking  about 
hypotheses.  One  is  not  just  entertaining  a  new  possibility  but  is  isolating  one 
hypothesis  by  controlling  for  the  effects  of  other  possible  variables. 

As  with  the  other  periods,  Piaget  introduced  logico-mathematical  mod¬ 
els  to  describe  formal  operational  thinking.  These  models  are  in  some  respects 
similar  to  those  that  apply  to  earlier  developmental  levels,  but  they  also  go 
beyond  them.  The  models  are  very  complex,  and  we  will  not  attempt  to  cover 
them  here.  It  is  important  to  note,  however,  that  at  the  level  of  formal  opera¬ 
tions,  thinking  reaches  its  highest  degree  of  equilibrium.  This  means,  among 
other  things,  that  the  various  operations  are  more  tightly  interrelated  and 
apply  to  the  widest  possible  field  of  application — the  realm  of  hypothetical 
possibilities. 

Although  Piaget  limited  most  of  his  research  on  adolescents  to  mathe¬ 
matical  and  scientific  reasoning,  he  did  speculate  on  the  role  of  formal  oper¬ 
ations  in  the  adolescent's  social  life  (Inhelder  &  Piaget,  1955,  chap.  18).  Unlike 


141 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


the  concrete-operational  child,  who  lives  primarily  in  the  here  and  now,  ado¬ 
lescents  begin  to  think  about  more  far-reaching  problems — about  their  futures 
and  the  nature  of  the  society  they  will  enter.  In  this  process,  their  new  cogni¬ 
tive  powers  can  lead  to  a  striking  idealism  and  utopianism.  They  can  now 
grasp  abstract  principles  and  ideals,  such  as  liberty,  justice,  and  love,  and  they 
envision  hypothetical  societies  very  different  from  any  that  presently  exist. 
The  adolescent  becomes  a  dreamer,  constructing  theories  about  a  better  world. 

Piaget  believed  that  such  idealistic  and  utopian  thinking  carries  with  it 
a  new  kind  of  egocentrism.  To  fully  appreciate  this  new  egocentrism,  we  must 
review  how  egocentrism  appears  whenever  the  child  enters  a  new  realm  of 
intellectual  life.  At  first,  infants  are  egocentric  in  the  sense  that  they  have  no 
conception  of  the  world  apart  from  their  own  actions.  External  objects  have 
no  permanent  existence  of  their  own.  Only  at  the  end  of  the  sensorimotor 
period  do  children  situate  themselves  in  a  world  of  permanent  objects,  of 
which  they  are  only  one. 

At  the  next  level — that  of  preoperational  thought — children  enter  a  new, 
vastly  enlarged  world — one  that  includes  language,  symbolic  representation, 
and  communication  with  others.  Children  once  again  become  egocentric  and 
have  difficulty  considering  more  than  their  own  immediate  perspective.  Grad¬ 
ually,  they  learn  to  consider  alternative  perspectives — as  long  as  they  are  think¬ 
ing  about  concrete  objects  immediately  before  them. 

Finally,  adolescents  enter  a  broader  world  yet — the  world  of  possibilities — 
and  egocentrism  reappears.  This  time  egocentrism  is  seen  when  adolescents 
attribute  unlimited  power  to  their  own  thoughts.  They  dream  of  "a  glorious 
future  or  of  transforming  the  world  through  Ideas"  (p.  346),  without  attempt¬ 
ing  to  test  out  their  thoughts  in  reality.  Young  people  overcome  this  final  form 
of  egocenrism,  in  Piaget's  view,  when  they  actually  take  up  adult  roles.  They 
then  learn  the  limits  and  resistances  to  their  own  thoughts.  They  learn  that  a 
theoretical  construction  or  a  utopian  vision  has  value  only  in  relation  to  how 
it  works  out  in  reality. 


THEORETICAL  ISSUES 
The  Stage  Concept 

Many  psychologists  use  the  term  stage  loosely,  as  merely  a  convenient  device 
for  summarizing  their  findings.  This,  however,  is  not  the  case  with  Piaget.  As 
Kohlberg  (1968)  stressed,  the  Piagetian  stage  concept  implies  several  strong 
positions  on  the  nature  of  development. 

First,  in  a  rigorous  stage  theory,  the  stage  sequence  should  be  invariant. 
People  proceed  through  the  stages  at  different  rates,  and  some  may  not  reach 
the  highest  of  Piaget's  stages;  but  to  the  extent  that  they  move  through  them, 
they  proceed  in  order. 


142 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


Second,  stages  imply  that  growth  is  divided  into  qualitatively  different 
periods.  If  intellectual  development  were  a  continuous,  quantitative  process, 
any  division  into  separate  stages  would  be  arbitrary  (Flavell,  1963,  p.  19).  For 
example,  if  knowledge  can  be  scored  from  0  to  100,  then  any  division  into 
stages  at  40,  50,  and  70  makes  no  more  sense  than  any  other  series  of  cutoff 
points.  Piaget,  however,  believed  that  thinking  at  different  times  is  organized 
along  qualitatively  different  lines.  Thinking  at  concrete  operations,  for 
instance,  is  qualitatively  different  from  that  at  formal  operations.  (It  is  logical 
insofar  as  it  refers  to  concrete  objects  and  activities,  but  it  is  not  yet  truly 
abstract  and  hypothetical.)  Consequently,  there  is  a  natural,  valid  distinction 
between  the  two  periods. 

Third,  stages  refer  to  general  characteristics.  Kohlberg  liked  to  discuss 
this  point  by  asking  the  following  question:  At  the  age  of  4  years,  a  child 
cannot  copy  a  diamond.  At  the  age  of  5,  the  child  can.  Has  the  child  reached 
the  diamond  copying  stage?  Kohlberg  explained  that  this  proposal  sounds 
somewhat  silly  because  diamond  copying  is  too  specific  to  be  called  a  stage. 
If  we  were  to  call  each  particular  achievement  a  stage,  we  would  have  thou¬ 
sands  of  stages.  It  is  more  appropriate  to  say  that  the  child  has  reached  a 
new  general  stage  of  perceptual-motor  coordination  that  permits  him  or  her 
to  do  many  new  things.  Similarly,  Piaget's  stages  refer  to  general  patterns  of 
thought,  and  if  we  know  a  child  is  in  a  particular  stage,  we  should  be  able 
to  predict  behavior  across  a  wide  variety  of  tasks.  This  is  not  completely 
true,  for  children  may  be  at  somewhat  different  stages  in  different  areas  (e.g., 
in  scientific  versus  social  reasoning).  Piaget  called  such  irregularities 
decalages.  However,  there  should  be  a  substantial  unity  in  performances  at 
each  general  period. 

Fourth,  Piaget  (Inhelder  &  Piaget,  1955)  believed  his  own  stages  repre¬ 
sent  hierarchic  integrations.  That  is,  the  lower  stages  do  not  disappear  but 
become  integrated  into,  and  in  a  sense  dominated  by,  new  broader  frame¬ 
works.  For  example,  a  teenage  boy  who  begins  using  formal  operations  can 
still  use  concrete  operations — he  can  still  reason  systematically  about  con¬ 
crete,  visible  events.  However,  he  now  realizes  these  events  are  only  a  part  of 
a  wider  range  of  theoretical  possibilities,  and  he  will  prefer  to  approach  dif¬ 
ficult  problems  with  this  wider  range  in  mind.3 

Fifth,  Piaget,  like  other  rigorous  stage  theorists,  claimed  his  stages  unfold 
in  the  same  sequence  in  all  cultures.  This  proposal  frequently  puzzles  readers. 
Don't  different  cultures  teach  different  beliefs,  particularly  with  regard  to 
morals?  In  general  the  Piagetian  answer  is  that  the  theory  is  not  concerned 
with  specific  beliefs  but  with  underlying  cognitive  capacities.  So  young 


3Piagetians  imply  that  successive  hierarchic  integrations  characterize  development  for 
all  the  periods  except  for  preoperational  thought.  The  illogical  features  of  this  period  do  not 
seem  to  be  retained  and  integrated  into  any  higher  structures;  they  are  simply  overcome 
(see  Inhelder,  1971). 


143 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


children,  regardless  of  their  cultural  beliefs  on  matters  such  as  sex  or  fighting, 
will  base  their  views  on  what  they  think  authority  condones  or  punishes.  It  is 
not  until  adolescence,  when  young  people  acquire  formal  operations,  that 
they  will  give  abstract,  theoretical  treatises  on  moral  matters,  whatever  their 
specific  beliefs. 

In  summary,  then,  Piaget  advanced  a  rigorous  stage  theory,  which 
means  he  believed  his  stages  (1)  unfold  in  an  invariant  sequence,  (2)  describe 
qualitatively  different  patterns,  (3)  refer  to  general  properties  of  thought, 
(4)  represent  hierarchic  integrations,  and  (5)  are  culturally  universal. 


Movement  from  Stage  to  Stage 

Piaget  devoted  a  great  deal  of  attention  to  the  structures  of  his  stages  and  far 
less  attention  to  the  problem  of  movement  through  them.  Nevertheless,  he 
had  definite  views  on  this  topic. 

He  acknowledged  (1964b)  that  biological  maturation  plays  some  role  in 
development.  For  example,  children  probably  cannot  attain  concrete  opera¬ 
tions  without  some  minimal  maturation  of  the  nervous  system.  However, 
Piaget  said  that  maturation  alone  cannot  play  the  dominant  role  because  rates 
of  development  depend  so  much  on  where  children  live.  Children  who  grow 
up  in  impoverished  rural  areas  frequently  develop  at  slow  rates,  apparently 
because  they  lack  intellectual  stimulation.  The  environment  is  also  important. 

However,  it  is  easy  to  exaggerate  the  role  of  the  environment,  as  learn¬ 
ing  theorists  do.  Generally  speaking,  learning  theorists  believe  the  child's 
mind  is  primarily  a  product  of  external  reinforcements  and  teaching.  Piaget- 
ian  concepts,  they  assume,  must  be  taught  by  parents,  teachers,  and  others. 
However,  it  is  not  at  all  clear  that  this  is  the  case. 

In  Piaget's  view,  the  environment  is  important,  but  only  partly  so.  The 
environment  nourishes,  stimulates,  and  challenges  the  child,  but  children 
themselves  build  cognitive  structures.  As  children  seek  out  the  environment, 
they  encounter  events  that  capture  their  interest.  They  are  particularly 
intrigued  by  events  that  are  moderately  novel — events  that  do  not  quite  cor¬ 
respond  to  their  past  experience.  Children  then  adjust  their  actions  to  learn 
about  these  events,  and  in  the  process  they  build  new  ways  for  dealing  with 
the  world.  For  example,  I  mentioned  earlier  how  our  son  Tom,  at  the  age  of 
12  months,  was  struck  by  the  way  water  sprayed  outward  when  he  placed 
his  hand  under  it.  He  then  adjusted  his  hand  up  and  down  to  learn  more 
about  it,  and  as  he  did  so,  he  probably  learned  a  little  about  the  efficacy  of 
actively  experimenting  with  different  actions  to  see  different  results  (stage  5 
of  sensorimotor  development).  In  such  behavior,  it  is  not  the  environment 
that  structures  the  child's  mind,  but  the  child  who  develops  new  schemes. 

Experiences  that  promote  cognitive  development,  in  addition,  are  not  only 
interesting,  but  usually  place  the  child  in  a  state  of  conflict.  For  example,  an 


144 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


infant  might  be  unable  to  grasp  an  object  because  an  obstacle  is  in  the  way.  The 
child  needs  to  invent  a  new  structure — a  means-ends  relationship — to  obtain  the 
object.  The  child  assimilates  new  objects  by  making  accommodations  that  build 
new  cognitive  structures. 

The  concept  of  conflict  is  involved  in  a  formal  model  of  developmental 
change  that  Piaget  called  equilibration  (1964b).  We  already  have  discussed  the 
essence  of  this  model,  without  using  its  name,  when  we  discussed  how  chil¬ 
dren  achieve  conservation.  For  example,  a  little  girl  sees  a  ball  of  clay  elongated 
and  initially  thinks  the  amount  has  increased.  After  a  while,  however,  she 
considers  the  clay's  narrow  width  and  thinks  the  clay  has  shrunk;  she  per¬ 
ceives  something  that  contradicts  her  initial  view.  When  she  thinks  about  both 
the  length  and  the  width,  she  becomes  confused.  This  conflict  motivates  the 
child  to  realize  that  one  change  cancels  out  the  other,  leading  to  the  discovery 
of  conservation.  Piaget's  equilibration  model  tries  to  assign  numerical  prob¬ 
abilities  to  the  chances  that  the  child  will  consider  one  dimension,  then  the 
other,  and  finally  both. 

In  philosophy,  Piaget's  equilibration  model  would  be  called  a  dialecti¬ 
cal  theory.  Dialectical  theory  holds  that  change  occurs  when  our  ideas  meet 
with  counterevidence  that  motivates  us  to  formulate  new  and  better  ideas. 

Another  source  of  new,  conflicting  information  is  the  social  environ¬ 
ment.  For  example,  preoperational  children  overcome  egocentrism  when  they 
interact  with  peers,  with  whom  they  get  into  arguments  and  conflicts.  In  such 
interchanges,  they  learn  that  others  have  views  different  from  their  own,  and 
they  also  learn  to  coordinate  different  interests  to  behave  in  a  cooperative 
fashion.  This  ability  to  coordinate  viewpoints  also  contributes  to  the  growth 
of  scientific  thinking,  where  the  coordination  of  dimensions  is  also  important 
(Piaget,  1947,  pp.  156-166). 

Piaget,  then,  tried  to  indicate  different  ways  in  which  interesting  and 
conflicting  pieces  of  information  lead  children  to  develop  new  cognitive  struc¬ 
tures.  It  is  important  to  emphasize  that  development  is  always  a  spontaneous 
process.  It  is  the  children  themselves  who  assimilate  new  information,  resolve 
contradictions,  and  construct  new  cognitive  structures. 


IMPLICATIONS  FOR  EDUCATION 

Piaget  did  not  write  extensively  on  education,  but  he  did  have  some  recom¬ 
mendations.  Essentially,  his  overall  educational  philosophy  is  similar  to  that 
of  Rousseau  and  Montessori.  For  Piaget,  too,  true  learning  is  not  something 
handed  down  by  the  teacher,  but  something  that  comes  from  the  child.  It  is 
a  process  of  spontaneous  invention  and  discovery.  This  is  clearly  true  of 
infants,  who  make  incredible  intellectual  progress  simply  by  exploring  and 
manipulating  the  environment  on  their  own,  and  it  can  be  true  of  older  chil¬ 
dren  as  well.  Accordingly,  the  teacher  should  not  try  to  impose  knowledge 


145 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


on  the  child  but  should  find  materials  that  will  interest  and  challenge  the 
child  and  then  permit  the  child  to  solve  problems  on  her  own  (Piaget,  1969, 
pp.  151-153, 160). 

Like  Rousseau  and  Montessori,  Piaget  also  stressed  the  importance  of 
gearing  instruction  to  the  child's  particular  level.  He  did  not  agree  with 
Montessori's  maturational  view  of  stages,  but  the  general  principle  still  holds: 
The  educator  must  appreciate  the  extent  to  which  children's  interests  and 
modes  of  learning  are  different  at  different  times. 

Say,  for  example,  a  boy  is  just  entering  the  stage  of  concrete  opera¬ 
tions.  He  is  beginning  to  think  logically,  but  his  thinking  is  still  partly  tied 
to  concrete  objects  and  activities.  Accordingly,  lessons  should  give  him 
opportunities  to  deal  actively  with  real  things.  If,  for  example,  we  wish  to 
teach  him  about  fractions,  we  should  not  draw  diagrams,  give  him  lectures, 
or  engage  him  in  verbal  discussions.  We  should  allow  him  to  divide  concrete 
objects  into  parts  (Flavell,  1963,  p.  368).  When  we  assume  he  will  learn  on 
a  verbal  plane,  we  are  being  egocentric;  we  are  assuming  he  learns  just  as 
we  do.  The  result  will  be  a  lesson  that  sails  over  his  head  and  seems  unnat¬ 
ural  to  him. 

It  might  appear  that  this  principle — tailoring  education  to  the  child's 
own  stage — is  self-evident.  Unfortunately,  this  is  not  always  so.  A  case  in  point 
was  the  wave  of  curricular  reforms  that  the  United  States  initiated  in  the  late 
1950s  and  1960s  in  response  to  the  Soviet  Union's  launching  of  Sputnik.  To  try 
to  catch  up  with  the  Russians,  educators  introduced  the  "new  math,"  "new 
science,"  and  other  studies  designed  to  teach  children  abstract,  theoretical 
reasoning  at  very  young  ages.  Initially,  this  seemed  to  be  a  great  idea,  but  the 
new  curriculum  was  not  very  successful.  The  reason,  according  to  Kohlberg 
and  Gilligan  (1971),  was  that  it  attempted  to  teach  young  children,  largely  at 
the  level  of  concrete  operations  and  lower,  ideas  that  assume  capacities  only 
attained  at  formal  operations.  The  curricular  reforms  began  with  an  adult  con¬ 
ception  of  what  children  should  learn  and  ignored  children's  own  cognitive 
levels. 

Beginning  in  the  late  1970s  and  early  1980s,  we  witnessed  a  similar 
trend — a  trend  that  continues  today.  U.S.  leaders,  worried  that  the  country 
was  losing  its  technological  leadership  to  the  Japanese,  began  calling  for  a 
new  excellence  in  education.  Parents,  too,  became  anxious  about  their  chil¬ 
dren's  future  and  wanted  to  give  them  an  early  academic  start.  One  result  has 
been  more  and  more  academic  instruction  at  younger  and  younger  ages — all 
the  way  down  to  kindergarten  and  even  earlier.  David  Elkind  (1981, 1986),  a 
Piagetian,  was  one  of  the  first  to  protest  this  trend.  Five-year-olds,  Elkind 
pointed  out,  learn  primarily  through  play  and  direct  sensory  contact  with  the 
environment;  formal  instruction,  including  workbooks  and  worksheets,  does 
not  coincide  with  the  young  child's  natural  modes  of  learning.  Early  formal 
instruction  primarily  teaches  young  children  that  learning  is  stressful  and 
unnatural. 


146 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


It  is  not  always  easy  to  find  the  educational  experiences  that  are  most  nat¬ 
ural  for  a  given  child.  A  knowledge  of  cognitive  stages  can  help,  but  children 
are  sometimes  at  different  stages  in  different  areas  (Piaget,  1969).  What  is 
needed  is  sensitivity  and  flexibility  on  the  teacher's  part — a  willingness  to 
look  closely  at  the  child's  actions,  to  learn  from  the  child,  and  to  be  guided  by 
the  child's  spontaneous  interests  (Ginsburg  &  Opper,  1988,  p.  239).  For  active 
learning  always  presupposes  interest  (Piaget,  1969,  p.  152). 

Like  Rousseau  and  Montessori,  then,  Piaget  believed  learning  should  be 
a  process  of  active  discovery  and  should  be  geared  to  the  child's  stage.  But 
Piaget  disagreed  with  Rousseau  and  Montessori  on  one  point.  Piaget  saw 
much  greater  educational  value  in  social  interactions.  Children  begin  to  think 
logically — to  coordinate  two  dimensions  simultaneously — partly  by  learn¬ 
ing  to  consider  two  or  more  perspectives  in  their  dealings  with  others.  So 
interactions  should  be  encouraged,  and  the  most  beneficial  ones  are  those  in 
which  children  feel  a  basic  equality,  as  they  most  often  do  with  peers.  As  long 
as  children  feel  dominated  by  an  authority  who  knows  the  "right"  answer, 
they  will  have  difficulty  appreciating  differences  in  perspectives.  In  group  dis¬ 
cussions  with  other  children,  in  contrast,  they  have  a  better  opportunity  to 
deal  with  different  viewpoints  as  stimulating  challenges  to  their  own  think¬ 
ing  (pp.  173-180). 

Kamii’s  Constructivism 

Several  attempts  have  been  made  to  bring  Piaget's  ideas  into  the  classroom, 
particularly  the  preschool  and  the  early  grades  (DeVries  &  Kohlberg,  1987, 
chap.  3).  Some  educators  have  focused  on  Piaget's  tasks,  attempting  to  teach 
conservation,  classification,  and  so  on.  Others  have  been  more  concerned  with 
the  spirit  of  Piaget's  theory.  An  inspired  proponent  of  this  approach  is  Con¬ 
stance  Kamii. 

Kamii  begins  with  the  Piagetian  premise  that  real  cognitive  growth 
occurs  only  when  children  construct  their  own  knowledge.  Children  need 
opportunities  to  figure  things  out  on  their  own.  They  will  not  do  this,  Kamii 
has  found,  if  teachers  use  worksheets  and  tests.  These  practices  make  chil¬ 
dren  so  worried  about  getting  the  "right  answers,"  the  answers  that  the  teacher 
will  mark  as  correct,  that  they  don't  think  problems  out  for  themselves.  Instead 
of  worksheets  and  tests,  then,  teachers  need  to  provide  experiences  that  chil¬ 
dren  will  find  so  interesting  and  meaningful  that  they  will  work  on  them  for 
their  own  sake.  Such  problems,  Kamii  says,  can  be  found  throughout  chil¬ 
dren's  daily  lives.  For  example,  first-graders  will  enthusiastically  work  on 
arithmetic  problems  as  they  come  up  during  card  games,  keeping  score  dur¬ 
ing  outdoor  games,  voting  on  class  decisions,  and  taking  attendance.  During 
such  activities,  the  teacher  can  ask  questions  that  further  stimulate  the  child's 
interest  in  arithmetic.  If  children  are  playing  softball,  the  teacher  might  ask. 
Flow  many  points  do  you  need  to  reach  11?  If  a  child  brings  pudding  for  the 


147 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


class,  the  teacher  might  ask,  Are  there  just  enough  cups  for  all  the  children? 
The  teacher's  questions  set  the  children's  minds  in  motion,  but  the  teacher 
always  leaves  the  problem  solving  to  the  children  themselves.  The  teacher 
should  even  respect  the  children's  "wrong  answers."  For  it  is  better  for  chil¬ 
dren  to  come  up  with  a  wrong  answer  that  is  their  own  than  to  feel  that  they 
must  turn  to  an  adult  to  know  what  is  correct  (Kamii,  1985,  pp.  119-121, 
161-165;  Kamii  &  DeVries,  1977). 

As  children  move  into  the  second  and  third  grades,  Kamii  adds  many 
dice,  card,  and  board  games  that  stimulate  mathematical  thinking.  She  also 
presents  children  with  standard  problems  in  addition,  subtraction,  and  so  on, 
but  she  always  encourages  the  children  to  invent  their  own  solutions.  Kamii 
vehemently  opposes  the  conventional  practice  of  teaching  algorithms  (e.g.,  a 
teacher  tells  a  child  to  add  18  +  17  by  adding  the  8  and  the  7,  carrying  the  1, 
and  so  on).  Algorithms,  she  points  out,  teach  children  to  follow  mechanical 
procedures  without  the  slightest  understanding  of  why  they  are  performing 
them.  Children  in  a  constructivist  class  invent  methods  that  make  sense  to 
them  (such  as,  "I'll  make  this  two  10s,  with  a  7  and  an  8  left  over.").  They  cre¬ 
ate  methods  for  surprisingly  difficult  problems,  and  their  methods  are  often 
quite  original  (Kamii,  1994,  2004). 

Kamii  applies  her  approach  to  nearly  every  aspect  of  school  life,  includ¬ 
ing  "discipline  problems."  If  some  children  get  into  an  argument  during  a 
card  game,  the  teacher  should  resist  the  impulse  to  step  in  and  solve  the  prob¬ 
lem  for  them.  Instead,  the  teacher  might  ask,  "Can  you  think  of  a  way  that 
would  be  fair  to  everybody?"  (Kamii,  1985,  p.  48)  In  this  way,  the  teacher 
prompts  the  children  themselves  to  work  on  a  question  of  justice. 

Piagetian  teaching,  Kamii  (1973)  says,  often  means  giving  children 
more  time  to  work  on  problems  than  schools  usually  do.  Kamii  tells,  for 
example,  about  lessons  in  specific  gravity.  Children  in  the  elementary  grades 
are  usually  surprised  to  see  that  a  pin  sinks  in  water,  whereas  a  block  of 
wood  (which  is  larger)  floats.  And  it  usually  takes  children  some  time  to 
figure  out  why  this  is  so.  Teachers  are  therefore  tempted  to  explain  the 
answer  to  their  pupils,  especially  when  the  teacher  wants  to  move  on  to  a 
new  lesson.  But  Kamii  urges  the  teacher  to  wait.  It  is  far  better,  she  says,  for 
the  children  to  keep  thinking  and  wondering  about  the  matter  than  "to  be 
told  the  answer  and  to  learn  incidentally  that  the  answer  always  comes  from 
the  teacher's  head"  (p.  225). 

Kamii  (1985,  1994,  2004)  has  conducted  evaluation  research  on  her 
method  of  teaching  arithmetic  in  the  early  elementary  grades.  She  has  found 
that  on  traditional  standardized  tests,  her  children  do  almost  as  well  as  those 
taught  by  conventional  methods.  But  her  children  demonstrate  a  far  greater 
understanding  of  the  logic  behind  their  work.  They  also  are  much  more  inde¬ 
pendently  minded.  When  a  teacher  tried  to  help  one  first-grade  girl  with  a 
hint,  the  girl  said,  "Wait,  I  have  to  think  it  in  my  own  head"  (Kamii,  1985, 
p.  235).  To  Kamii,  such  responses  are  very  important.  Like  Rousseau  and 


148 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


Montessori,  Kamii  is  less  interested  in  the  amount  of  knowledge  children  gain 
than  in  their  desire  to  think  for  themselves. 


EVALUATION 

Since  about  1960  Piaget  has  stimulated  a  vast  amount  of  research  and  the¬ 
oretical  discussion.  We  cannot  summarize  all  of  it  here,  but  we  can  look  at 
some  trends  and  issues.  I  will  organize  this  section  around  some  basic 
questions. 


Has  Research  Supported  Piaget 
on  His  Tasks? 

As  mentioned  in  the  introduction,  Piaget's  own  research  has  been  criticized 
for  its  scientific  shortcomings.  For  example,  he  based  some  conclusions  only 
on  observations  of  his  own  three  children — hardly  a  representative  sample. 
Consequently,  when  Piaget  was  rediscovered  in  the  early  1960s,  many  people 
wanted  to  see  if  they  could  replicate  his  findings. 

Stage  Sequences.  On  the  whole,  the  replication  research  using 
Piaget's  own  tasks  has  supported  his  stage  sequence.  That  is,  children  do 
seem  to  move  through  the  substages,  stages,  and  periods  in  the  order  in  which 
Piaget  initially  found.  His  stages  have  held  up  particularly  well  for  the  sen¬ 
sorimotor  period  and  for  scientific  and  mathematical  reasoning  with  respect 
to  the  later  stages  (E.  Evans,  1975;  Harris,  1983;  Lovell,  1968;  Neimark,  1975). 
The  results  have  been  somewhat  less  clear  cut  for  Piaget's  stages  of  social 
thought,  such  as  animism  (Looft  &  Bartz,  1969),  moral  judgment  (Kohlberg, 
1964),  and  egocentrism  (Damon,  1983,  pp.  120-121),  but  in  general  younger 
children  do  differ  from  older  children  as  Piaget  found.  This  replication 
research,  it  should  be  noted,  has  typically  used  Piaget's  own  tasks.  A  bit  later 
we  will  mention  some  studies  that  have  questioned  Piaget's  conclusions  by 
modifying  his  tasks. 

Stage  Generality.  Although  Piaget's  sequences  have  received  sup¬ 
port,  his  position  that  stages  are  general  modes  of  thought  has  fared  less  well. 
That  is,  researchers  have  found  rather  low  correlations  among  tasks  that 
should  tap  the  same  general  stages  of  thinking  (Flavell,  1977,  p.  248;  Gelman 
&  Baillargeon,  1983,  pp.  169-172).  For  example,  a  child  who  demonstrates 
conservation  of  liquid  might  not  exhibit  the  grasp  of  class  inclusion  that  would 
seem  to  go  along  with  it.  Piaget  himself  recognized  that  children  will  master 
different  tasks  at  different  rates — he  called  such  unevenness  decalage — but  he 
implied  more  consistency  than  has  been  found. 


149 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


These  largely  negative  findings  have  prompted  many  psychologists 
(e.g.,  Bandura,  1986,  pp.  484-485)  to  recommend  abandoning  Piaget's  stages 
altogether.  Children,  many  say,  do  not  go  through  general  periods  when  their 
thinking  reflects  broad  mental  structures.  Instead,  they  simply  learn  numer¬ 
ous  task-specific  skills.  Children  learn  arithmetic  skills,  reading  skills, 
communication  skills,  and  so  on,  and  there  are  no  general  mental  structures 
underlying  them.  Even  psychologists  who  are  sympathetic  to  Piaget,  such  as 
John  Flavell,  have  at  times  questioned  the  existence  of  general  stages  (Fla veil, 
1985,  p.  295). 

An  abandonment  of  Piaget's  stages,  however,  would  be  premature.  Con¬ 
sider  the  child  from  5  to  7  years  of  age.  Sheldon  White  (1965, 1970)  and  others 
(e.g.,  Kegan,  1985;  Sameroff  &  Haith,  1996)  have  accumulated  a  wealth  of  evi¬ 
dence  that  suggests  children  undergo  important  psychological  changes  dur¬ 
ing  this  period.  The  changes  involved  in  this  5-  to  7-year  shift  go  far  beyond 
responses  to  Piagetian  tasks.  They  include  behavior  in  a  variety  of  learning 
contexts.  Prior  to  this  shift,  children  are  generally  impulsive,  distractible,  and 
full  of  fantasy.  Afterward,  they  are  more  logical,  rational,  and  reasonable. 
Throughout  the  world,  cultures  have  chosen  this  time  to  begin  entrusting  chil¬ 
dren  with  important  responsibilities,  including  care  for  the  younger  ones 
(Weisner,  1996). 

In  many  ways,  the  5-  to  7-year  shift  marks  a  loss  of  creativity.  Before 
the  age  of  7  or  8,  children's  drawings  are  full  of  life  and  harmony;  afterward, 
their  drawings  become  more  geometric  and  precise.  Before  the  age  of  7,  chil¬ 
dren  engage  in  elaborate  make-believe  play.  Many  children  even  create  imag¬ 
inary  companions.  By  the  age  of  7  or  so,  this  world  of  make-believe  has 
declined.  As  in  the  song  Puff  the  Magic  Dragon,  the  imaginary  friend  must  go 
away  because  the  little  boy  is  growing  up  and  no  longer  believes  in  magic.  He 
is  becoming  logical  and  realistic  (Crain,  2003). 

Thus  there  is  strong  evidence  for  a  broad  stagelike  transition  occurring 
at  this  time.  And,  as  White  (1965,  1996)  observes,  Piaget's  theory  is  one  that 
can  help  explain  it.  Children  approach  life  in  a  more  logical,  rational  way 
because  they  are  developing  concrete  operational  thought. 

There  is  still  the  problem,  to  be  sure,  of  inconsistency  across  Piaget's 
tasks.  Some  researchers  believe  that  higher  levels  of  generality  are  to  be 
found  at  certain  points  within  general  periods  (Siegler  &  Alibali,  2005, 
p.  59;  Uzgiris,  1964).  I  think  it  is  more  promising  to  pursue  White's  (1996) 
thought  that  the  ultimate  validity  of  the  stage  theory  is  to  be  found  in  daily 
life,  outside  the  tabletop  universe  of  tests  and  tasks.  As  scholars  study 
Piaget's  stages  and  consider  revisions,  they  might  look  for  the  features  of  his 
stages  that  throw  the  most  light  on  the  child's  spontaneous  activities  and 
thinking  in  everyday  life.  What  features  of  concrete  operations  are  related 
to  the  decline  in  make-believe  play?  What  cognitive  processes  develop  when 
a  child  questions  Santa  Claus  and  magic?  What  cognitive  capacities  enable 


150 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


a  boy  to  look  competently  after  his  baby  sister,  rationing  her  juice  for  the 
day  and  anticipating  her  unique  needs?  Piaget's  stage  theory  has  the  poten¬ 
tial  to  help  us  understand  such  broad  dimensions  of  life.  It  would  be  fool¬ 
ish  to  dismiss  his  stages. 


Do  People  Reach  the  Highest  Stages? 

A  rather  surprising  finding  is  that  most  adults  do  not  regularly  demonstrate  the 
highest  stages  of  formal  operations  on  Piaget's  standard  tasks.  Most  middle- 
class  adults  employ  formal  operations  only  some  of  the  time  (Kuhn  et  al.,  1977; 
Neimark,  1975),  and  in  many  small  village  and  tribal  communities,  many  adults 
barely  use  any  formal  operations  at  all  (Berk,  2009,  p.  256;  Dasen,  1972).  These 
findings  do  not  necessarily  contradict  Piaget.  There  is  no  theoretical  reason 
why  all  people  must  reach  Piaget's  highest  stages;  thinking  only  moves  forward 
when  it  is  sufficiently  challenged  and  stimulated.  Nevertheless,  the  findings  are 
puzzling. 

Piaget  (1972)  attempted  to  account  for  these  findings.  It  is  likely,  he  said, 
that  most  people  attain  some  degree  of  formal  operational  thinking,  but  pri¬ 
marily  in  areas  of  special  interest  or  ability.  An  automobile  mechanic  may  not 
think  in  a  formal,  theoretical  manner  about  philosophy  or  physics  but  does  use 
formal  operations  when  trouble-shooting  a  car.  An  eager  young  law  student 
might  not  employ  formal  operations  when  faced  with  a  problem  in  chemistry 
but  does  so  when  discussing  constitutional  issues. 

Similarly,  Tulkin  and  Konner  (1973)  suggest  that  adults  in  small  tribal 
societies  might  fail  to  demonstrate  formal  operations  on  Piagetian  tasks  of 
mathematical  and  scientific  reasoning,  but  they  employ  them  when  working 
on  problems  of  vital  importance  to  them.  For  example,  when  the  indigenous 
people  of  the  Kalahari  discuss  animal  tracking,  they  advance  and  weigh 
hypotheses  in  ways  "that  tax  the  best  inferential  and  analytic  capacities  of  the 
human  mind''  (p.  35). 

Piaget  conceded,  then,  that  at  the  highest  stages  people  will  not  demon¬ 
strate  a  great  deal  of  consistency  across  intellectual  tasks — certainly  not  the  same 
degree  of  consistency  that  we  expect  at  the  earlier  stages.  Instead,  people  employ 
the  highest  stages  of  thinking  primarily  in  their  areas  of  strongest  interest. 


Do  Children  Really  Learn  on  Their  Own? 

Perhaps  Piaget's  most  controversial  claim  is  that  cognitive  development  is  a 
spontaneous  process.  Children,  he  said,  develop  cognitive  structures  on  their 
own,  without  direct  teaching  from  adults.  The  most  incontestable  evidence 
for  spontaneous  learning  comes  from  Piaget's  observations  on  infants,  who 
make  enormous  intellectual  progress  simply  by  exploring  the  environment. 


151 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


before  anyone  takes  the  trouble  to  educate  them.  Once  we  begin  teaching,  in 
fact,  we  often  seem  to  stifle  the  child's  natural  curiosity.  In  school,  children 
become  disinterested,  lazy,  rebellious,  and  frightened  of  failure.  The  major 
task  of  education,  it  would  seem,  would  be  to  liberate  the  bold  curiosity  with 
which  children  enter  life. 

When  Piaget  said  children  learn  on  their  own,  he  did  not  mean  they 
learn  in  a  vacuum.  Other  children  can  stimulate  and  challenge  the  child's 
thinking,  and  it  would  seem  that  adults  can  do  the  same.  As  we  have  seen, 
Kamii  asks  children  stimulating  questions  that  start  them  thinking.  But 
Piaget  did  not  believe  it  is  productive  to  try  to  teach  children  right  answers 
or  procedures.  Instead,  real  learning  comes  from  experiences  that  arouse 
children's  curiosity  and  give  them  opportunities  to  work  out  their  solutions 
on  their  own. 

But  many  psychologists,  particularly  American  psychologists  in  the 
learning-theory  tradition,  believe  adult  teaching  is  more  important  than  Piaget 
thought.  To  demonstrate  this,  they  have  devised  a  number  of  "training  studies," 
most  of  which  have  tried  to  teach  conservation  to  4-  and  5-year-olds. 

A  major  finding  is  that  conservation  is  surprisingly  difficult  to  teach 
(E.  Evans,  1975;  Halford  &  Andrews,  2006,  p.  579;  Liebert,  Poulos,  &  Marmor, 
1977,  pp.  176-179).  It  is  difficult,  for  example,  to  teach  conservation  by  simply 
explaining  and  reinforcing  the  right  answers.  And  if  one  does  succeed  on  one 
task,  the  ability  does  not  always  generalize  to  new  tasks.  Further,  the  teach¬ 
ing  does  not  always  cut  very  deep.  People  have  told  me  how  they  had  appar¬ 
ently  taught  a  child  to  conserve  liquids;  however,  when  they  then  offered  the 
child  a  choice  between  liquids  he  or  she  liked  to  drink  (e.g.,  a  soft  drink),  the 
child  insisted  on  taking  the  larger  glass. 

Nevertheless,  conservation  can  be  taught.  In  the  first  quite  successful 
experiment,  Rochel  Gelman  (1969)  taught  children  to  conserve  number  and 
length  by  reinforcing  them  for  attending  to  the  most  relevant  stimuli — for 
example,  the  number  of  objects  in  a  row  rather  than  the  row's  length.  The 
training  worked,  and,  furthermore,  60%  of  the  children  showed  an  immedi¬ 
ate  new  ability  to  conserve  substance  and  liquid.  Gelman's  training  was  labo¬ 
rious  (it  lasted  two  days  and  consisted  of  192  trials),  but  others  have 
successfully  used  similar  methods  in  briefer  training  (Brainerd,  2003). 

Still,  we  may  wonder  how  accurately  the  training  methods  reflect  the 
ways  in  which  children  master  conservation  in  their  ordinary  lives.  We  also 
may  wonder  about  the  effects  of  the  training  methods  on  children's  feelings. 
When  children  solve  problems  on  their  own,  they  gain  confidence  in  their 
abilities  to  make  discoveries.  When  they  undergo  the  training  programs,  in 
which  they  are  consistently  told  whether  they  are  correct  or  what  to  think, 
they  can  easily  learn  to  mistrust  their  own  powers  of  thought. 

Piaget  (1970)  added  some  additional  thoughts  that  are  relevant  here.  We 
frequently  assume  that  spontaneous  development  is  undesirable  because  it  is 
slow;  direct  teaching  seems  good  because  it  can  speed  things  up.  But  Piaget 


152 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


pointed  out  that  when  Howard  Gruber  examined  the  development  of  object 
permanence  in  kittens,  Gruber  found  that  they  progressed  through  the 
sequences  at  a  much  faster  rate  than  human  infants  do.  Yet  kittens,  Piaget  noted, 
"do  not  progress  any  further  and  one  may  wonder  whether  the  slower  rate  of 
progress  does  not . . .  make  for  greater  progress  ultimately"  (1970,  p.  111).  Piaget 
also  observed  that  it  took  Darwin  a  remarkably  long  time  to  formulate  his  basic 
ideas  (in  addition  to  the  years  he  withheld  it  from  publication  because  it  was  so 
controversial),  and  Piaget  speculated  that  slowness  may  sometimes  be  one  of 
the  conditions  of  fruitful  invention. 


Did  Piaget  Underestimate 
the  Child’s  Abilities? 

In  recent  years,  dozens  of  researchers  (some  of  whom  have  conducted  training 
studies)  have  tried  to  show  that  Piaget  underestimated  children's  capacities — 
that  children  are  a  lot  smarter  than  he  gave  them  credit  for. 

Sensorimotor  Period  Capacities.  Some  researchers  have  examined 
deferred  imitation,  the  imitation  of  events  several  hours  or  days  after  observing 
them.  I  mentioned  one  of  Piaget's  observations  earlier.  One  day  his  daughter 
Jacqueline  watched  in  amazement  when  a  little  boy  threw  a  temper  tantrum 
in  his  playpen.  The  boy  screamed,  pushed  his  playpen  backward,  and  stomped 
his  foot  several  times.  The  next  day,  when  Jacqueline  was  in  her  playpen,  she 
imitated  the  little  boy  precisely,  even  lightly  stomping  her  foot.  Deferred  imi¬ 
tation  begins  in  Piaget's  sixth  stage  of  sensorimotor  development,  at  about 
18  months  of  age.  Piaget  said  it  illustrates  the  new  capacity  for  symbolic  rep¬ 
resentation;  the  child  must  have  some  way  of  representing  the  events  inter¬ 
nally  and  carrying  the  representation  over  time. 

Questioning  Piaget's  observations,  Andrew  Meltzoff  (1988)  found  that 
babies  as  young  as  9  months  imitate  events  after  a  24-hour  delay.  In  Meltzoff 's 
experiments,  babies  saw  an  adult  do  things  such  as  shake  a  small  plastic  egg 
to  make  a  rattle  sound.  Then,  24  hours  later,  when  the  babies  were  presented 
with  the  egg,  about  half  the  babies  imitated  the  adult's  actions. 

Meltzoff 's  study  is  widely  cited  as  convincing  evidence  that  infants  have 
the  capacity  for  representation  at  a  younger  age  than  Piaget  believed.  But  the 
infants  in  Meltzoff 's  study  reproduced  very  simple  actions  that  were  proba¬ 
bly  familiar  to  them.  The  egg,  for  example,  was  really  another  rattle — to  be 
shaken.  The  infants  didn't  seem  to  need  to  hold  many  images  of  new  behav¬ 
ior  in  their  minds.  Jacqueline,  in  contrast,  behaved  like  an  actor  who  memo¬ 
rized  a  detailed  action  scene.  Some  of  the  actions,  especially  stomping  a  foot 
several  times,  were  probably  entirely  new  to  her.  She  carried  an  internal  image 
of  the  scene  in  her  mind  from  one  day  to  the  next,  and  she  referred  to  this 
image  to  guide  her  performance. 


153 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


More  recently,  researchers  have  begun  to  examine  the  deferred  imita¬ 
tion  of  more  complex  events  (more  like  those  Jacqueline  imitated).  The  find¬ 
ings  suggest  that  although  infants  as  young  as  6  months  have  some  capacity 
for  deferred  imitation,  they  must  initially  see  an  action  performed  many  times, 
and  even  then  they  don't  reproduce  it  very  fully  Deferred  imitation  becomes 
increasingly  robust  between  about  13  and  24  months  of  age — about  the  time 
Piaget  saw  it  emerging  (Barr,  Dowden,  &  Hayne,  1996;  Bauer,  2006). 

Other  investigators  have  tried  to  show  that  infants  have  object  perma¬ 
nence  at  younger  ages  than  Piaget  observed.  Piaget,  you  will  recall,  found  that 
babies  don't  search  for  completely  hidden  objects  until  stage  4  of  the  sensori¬ 
motor  period,  when  they  are  8  or  9  months  old.  If  we  cover  a  toy  with  a  blan¬ 
ket,  the  baby  won't  continue  to  search  for  it.  But  Renee  Baillargeon  (1987) 
speculated  that  the  problem  might  be  that  the  baby  is  required  to  physically 
reach  for  hidden  objects.  If  only  looking  were  involved,  the  baby  might 
demonstrate  object  permanence  earlier. 

In  Baillargeon's  best-known  study  (1987),  babies  saw  a  screen  move 
toward  a  block.  When  the  screen  got  near  the  block,  the  screen  impeded  the 
babies'  view  of  the  block.  The  block  was  now  hidden  from  their  view.  The 
experiment  was  arranged  so  that  two  groups  of  babies  now  saw  different 
things.  One  group  saw  the  screen  appear  to  stop  when  it  made  contact  with 
the  block.  But  a  second  group  of  babies  saw  the  screen  appear  to  go  right 
through  the  block — as  if  the  block  no  longer  existed!  Baillargeon  found  that 
babies  as  young  as  3  ’/2  arid  4  V2  months  of  age  looked  longer,  as  if  surprised, 
at  the  sight  of  the  screen  going  through  the  hidden  block.  This  longer  "look¬ 
ing  time,"  Baillargeon  says,  suggests  that  infants  know  that  hidden  objects 
continue  to  exist  at  much  earlier  ages  than  Piaget  indicated. 

Reviewing  this  and  similar  experiments,  several  notable  psychologists 
(e.g.,  Flavell,  Miller,  &  Miller,  2002;  Mandler,  1998)  conclude  that  Piaget  under¬ 
estimated  infants'  knowledge  about  objects  because  his  tests  relied  too  heav¬ 
ily  on  their  immature  motor  systems.  When  infants  need  only  look  at 
objects — not  physically  interact  with  them — they  demonstrate  knowledge 
much  earlier  than  Piaget  thought  possible. 

But  these  critiques  of  Piaget  tend  to  overlook  the  essence  of  his  theory. 
The  criticisms  often  assume  that  an  infant's  "motor  system"  is  some  trivial 
matter  and  distracts  us  from  what  really  counts — the  infant's  knowledge.  The 
criticisms  overlook  Piaget's  powerful  insight  that  motor  action  is  the  foun¬ 
dation  of  logic  and  scientific  thinking. 

Consider  the  baby's  ability  to  find  a  completely  hidden  object.  At  the 
time  babies  can  do  this,  Piaget  showed,  they  are  constantly  hiding  and  find¬ 
ing  objects  in  their  everyday  life.  On  one  occasion,  Piaget's  daughter  Lucienne 
hid  her  feet  under  a  blanket,  pulled  the  blanket  off,  put  it  on  again,  and  so 
on.  A  few  days  later,  she  endlessly  repeated  hiding  a  rattle  under  a  rug  and 
retrieving  it  (Piaget,  1936b,  p.  172).  Piaget  said  these  physical  actions  contain 
the  elements  of  the  logical  operation  of  reversal  that  the  child  will  later  carry 


154 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


out  on  a  more  mental  plane  (as  in  the  thought,  "I  lost  five  cards  so  I  have  to 
get  five  new  cards  to  get  back  to  what  I  had").  For  Piaget,  all  math  and  logic, 
even  at  its  most  advanced  levels,  involves  action — adding,  subtracting,  com¬ 
bining,  canceling,  deducing,  and  so  forth.  At  an  advanced  level,  the  indi¬ 
vidual  carries  out  these  actions  more  quickly  and  briefly  in  her  mind,  but 
they  are  actions  nonetheless,  and  their  precursors  are  found  in  sensorimotor 
activity. 

Although  Piaget  didn't  prove  that  logic  and  advanced  reasoning  grow 
out  of  action,  he  has  a  particularly  strong  case  with  respect  to  the  "active 
experimenting"  of  stage  5.  At  this  stage  children  begin  to  vary  actions  to  see 
the  different  outcomes.  For  instance,  they  drop  objects  from  different  heights 
to  see  the  different  effects.  Many  years  later,  individuals  carry  out  such  exper¬ 
iments  on  a  purely  mental  plane,  as  when  a  medical  scientist  thinks  to  her¬ 
self,  "I  wonder  what  would  happen  if  I  doubled  or  tripled  the  dose."  It  seems 
very  likely  that  the  scientist's  experimental  approach  had  its  beginnings  in  her 
active  physical  experiments  in  infancy. 

The  experiments  by  Baillargeon  and  others  are  widely  accepted  as 
demonstrating  that  infants  are  "more  competent"  than  Piaget  said,  provid¬ 
ing  us  with  a  "more  positive"  view  of  them  (Flavell  et  al.,  2002,  pp.  75,  330). 
Although  most  psychologists  don't  intend  their  comments  to  be  value  judg¬ 
ments,  it's  easy  to  conclude  that  Piaget  gave  us  a  negative  view  of  infants.  But 
what  could  be  more  inspiring  than  the  sight  of  infants  spontaneously  engaged 
in  the  intense  explorations  Piaget  described?  The  baby  engrossed  in  hiding 
and  retrieving  objects,  or  trying  out  different  actions  to  see  the  results,  is  quite 
an  investigator!  Piaget  suggested,  moreover,  that  these  sensorimotor  inves¬ 
tigations  lead  to  advanced  thought.  If  these  investigations  take  some  time, 
why  should  we  consider  this  to  be  negative?  As  Piaget  said,  the  develop¬ 
ment  of  logical  and  scientific  thinking  is  a  monumental  enterprise. 

The  new  experiments,  to  be  sure,  do  indicate  that  infants  have  some 
knowledge  at  younger  ages  than  Piaget  observed.  These  experiments,  in  which 
babies  merely  sit  and  look  at  events,  qualify  Piaget  to  some  extent.  Perhaps 
there  is  an  innate  component  to  babies'  early  perceptual  knowledge.  But  the 
experimenters  have  only  offered  speculations  on  how  any  such  knowledge 
is  related  to  advanced  thought.  They  have  hardly  replaced  Piaget's  richly  doc¬ 
umented  account  of  the  long  journey  from  sensorimotor  action  to  advanced 
logical  operations. 

Preoperational  Capacities.  Many  psychologists  have  tried  to  show 
that  Piaget  also  underestimated  the  intellectual  capacities  of  the  preopera¬ 
tional  child.  They  have  looked  for  ways  of  altering  or  simplifying  Piaget's 
tasks  with  respect  to  conservation,  egocentrism,  classification,  and  other  top¬ 
ics  to  show  that  3-,  4-,  and  5-year-olds  can  actually  think  like  older  children 
and  adults.  Such  findings,  they  say,  correct  Piaget's  picture  of  the  young  child 
as  cognitively  inept. 


155 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


In  an  early  study,  Borke  (1975)  suggests  that  young  children  are  not  as 
egocentric  as  Piaget  implied.  Her  research  indicates  that  although  3-  and 
4-year-olds  have  difficulty  on  Piaget's  mountain  task,  they  can  perform  less 
egocentrically  on  simpler  versions  of  the  task.  Other  researchers  have  pro¬ 
duced  similar  findings.  It  seems,  for  example,  that  even  many  2-year-olds 
know  that  the  side  of  a  cube  they  see  is  different  from  the  side  a  person  facing 
them  sees.  (See  Gelman  &  Baillargeon,  1983,  and  Siegler  &  Alibali,  2005, 
pp.  60-61,  for  summaries  of  this  research.) 

In  recent  years,  a  popular  topic  is  the  child's  "theory  of  mind" — the 
child's  theory  of  how  people  think — and  many  of  the  findings  are  relevant  to 
egocentrism.  For  example,  a  child  is  shown  a  box  with  pictures  of  candy  on 
it,  guesses  that  candy  is  inside,  but  sees  that  the  box  actually  contains  crayons. 
Then  the  child  is  asked  to  guess  what  another  person,  who  hasn't  looked 
inside  the  box,  will  believe.  Three-year-olds  often  guess  the  other  person  will 
think  the  box  contains  crayons.  The  3-year-olds  egocentrically  assume  others 
will  know  what  they  now  know.  On  such  tasks,  children  generally  overcome 
this  egocentrism  by  4  or  5  years  of  age,  which  is  sooner  than  Piaget  indicated 
(Flavell  et  al.,  2002). 

Investigators  have  also  tried  to  demonstrate  that  young  children  can 
think  rationally  on  mathematical  and  scientific  tasks.  Gelman  (1972),  for  ex¬ 
ample,  suggests  that  young  children  have  some  capacity  to  conserve  number. 
Piaget,  you  will  recall,  showed  that  when  we  shorten  or  lengthen  a  row  of 
objects,  preoperational  children  believe  the  number  is  changed.  They  seem 
more  influenced  by  the  perceptual  configuration — the  way  the  row  looks — 
than  by  logic  or  number.  In  Piaget's  studies,  however,  the  rows  often  con¬ 
tained  as  many  as  eight  objects.  Gelman,  in  contrast,  presented  3-  to  5-year-olds 
with  smaller  sets  of  objects — two,  three,  or  four  objects — and  found  that  chil¬ 
dren  ignored  changes  in  length  and  continued  to  base  their  judgments  on 
number  alone.  They  displayed  conservation  with  these  small  sets. 

Gelman's  findings,  we  might  note,  do  not  necessarily  contradict  Piaget. 
It  may  be  that  changing  such  small  rows  produces  very  little  perceptual 
change,  so  we  do  not  know  if  young  children  can  ignore  perceptual  changes 
in  favor  of  logic  or  number.  More  broadly,  Graeme  Halford  and  Glenda 
Andrews  (2006)  have  questioned  the  extent  to  which  several  studies  actu¬ 
ally  refute  Piaget  with  respect  to  young  children's  scientific  and  mathematical 
reasoning.  Rebuttals  of  Piaget  seem  stronger  with  respect  to  egocentrism. 
Nevertheless,  there  is  a  general  consensus  among  major  psychologists  that 
Piaget  gave  an  overly  pessimistic  and  negative  picture  of  children's  thinking 
on  scientific  and  mathematical  tasks  as  well  (see,  for  example,  Berk,  2009, 
p.  243-246;  Flavell  et  al.,  2002,  p.  174;  Miller,  2011,  pp.  82-84;  Siegler  & 
Alibali,  2005,  p.  57). 

In  the  following  paragraphs  I  will  reply  to  this  criticism  from  a  strongly 
developmental  perspective,  as  I  imagine  Rousseau  might  have  done. 


156 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


First  of  all,  we  may  note  that  Piaget's  critics  seem  to  equate  a  positive  and 
optimistic  view  of  childhood  with  early  and  rapid  development.  We  might 
ask,  as  Rousseau  did,  why  it  is  pessimistic  to  observe  that  the  development  of 
logical  structures  takes  time.  Piaget  himself  made  this  point  with  respect  to 
sensorimotor  development,  and  it  applies  here  as  well. 

Furthermore,  Piaget's  critics  judge  young  children's  thinking  to  be  com¬ 
petent  insofar  as  it  is  as  rational  and  logical  as  ours.  But  this  may  be  an 
inappropriate  yardstick  because  young  children's  thinking  may  be  qualitatively 
different  from  ours.  The  young  child's  orientation,  compared  to  that  of  the 
older  child  and  adult,  seems  more  akin  to  that  of  an  artist.  In  fact,  two  key 
features  of  the  preoperational  period  contribute  to  an  artistic  orientation.  First, 
on  many  tasks  the  preoperational  child  bases  her  judgments  on  her  percep¬ 
tions.  Artists,  too,  place  a  premium  on  perception,  as  when  they  help  us  see 
the  beauty  of  a  landscape  or  a  bird  in  flight.  Second,  the  preoperational  child's 
animistic  or  physiognomic  attitude  is  one  that  artists  utililze.  It  helps  them 
capture  the  dynamic,  emotional,  expressive  qualities  of  the  world  (such  as  the 
sadness  of  the  sky  or  the  gentleness  of  a  breeze). 

Young  children  reveal  their  artistic  orientation  in  many  ways.  They 
love  activities  such  as  drawing,  singing,  and  composing  poems,  and  they 
develop  arresting  works.  For  example,  by  the  age  of  6  or  7  years  they  con¬ 
sistently  produce  drawings  that  are  fresh,  lively,  and  beautifully  organized. 
Many  great  artists  have  said  they  try  to  recapture  the  young  child's  artistic 
orientation.  After  this  age  their  work  becomes  more  geometric,  wooden,  and 
lifeless.  It  seems  that  logical  intelligence  is  taking  over  (Gardner,  1973,  p.  21; 
1980).  Moreover,  the  young  child's  rich  fantasy  life  and  theatrical  playfulness 
also  correspond  to  a  mental  organization  that  is  more  akin  to  the  arts  than 
to  logic. 

In  response  to  Piaget's  critics,  then,  I  would  say  that  each  stage  has  its 
own  distinctive  quality,  its  own  perfection.  In  early  childhood,  this  perfection 
is  more  artistic  than  logical.  We  don't  provide  a  positive  view  of  the  child  by 
showing  that  she  isn't  quite  so  illogical  after  all,  but  by  considering  how  pre¬ 
operational  thinking  contributes  to  the  child's  true  strength,  which  is  in  the 
artistic  realm. 

Unfortunately,  Piaget  worked  himself  into  a  corner  where  he  couldn't 
make  this  response.  Although  he  began  his  career  with  the  goal  of  under¬ 
standing  the  distinctive  qualities  of  each  stage,  he  was  never  open  to  the  spe¬ 
cial  strength  of  the  preoperational  stage.  He  kept  comparing  it  to  the  superior 
logic  of  older  children,  and  it  never  measured  up.  In  his  writings,  the  pre¬ 
operational  child  "fails  to  grasp"  basic  notions,  "continues  to  make  the  same 
mistake,"  and  so  on  (Piaget  &  Szeminska,  1941,  pp.  13,  142).  If  Piaget  had 
considered  preoperational  thought  on  its  own  terms,  he  might  have  seen  its 
affinity  to  that  of  the  artist. 


157 


Piaget's  Cognitive-Developmental  Theory 


Conclusion 

We  see,  then,  that  there  are  many  criticisms  of  Piaget's  theory.  Other  major  the¬ 
orists — Bandura,  Vygotsky,  and  Chomsky — have  had  debates  with  Piaget.  For 
the  present,  it  is  worth  noting  that  nearly  everyone  pits  his  or  her  ideas  against 
Piaget's.  This  in  itself  is  a  testament  to  the  stature  of  Piaget's  theory.  And  it  is 
a  good  bet  that  when  all  the  dust  clears,  Piaget's  theory  will  still  stand.  For 
whatever  its  weaknesses,  it  captures  essential  aspects  of  development. 


158 


Koh  lb  erg’s  Stages 
of  Moral  Development 


BIOGRAPHICAL  INTRODUCTION 

An  outstanding  example  of  research  in  the  Piagetian  tradition  is  the 
work  of  Lawrence  Kohlberg  (1927-1987).  Kohlberg  focused  on  moral 
development  and  provided  a  stage  theory  of  moral  thinking  that  goes 
well  beyond  Piaget's  initial  formulations. 

Kohlberg1  grew  up  in  Bronxville,  New  York,  and  attended 
Andover  Academy  in  Massachusetts,  an  academically  demanding  pri¬ 
vate  high  school.  He  did  not  go  straight  to  college  but  instead  went  to 
help  the  Israeli  cause,  serving  as  the  second  engineer  on  an  old  freighter 
carrying  European  refugees  through  British  blockades  to  Israel.  After 
this,  in  1948,  Kohlberg  enrolled  at  the  University  of  Chicago,  where  he 
scored  so  high  on  admission  tests  that  he  only  had  to  take  a  limited 
number  of  courses  to  earn  his  bachelor's  degree.  This  he  did  in  one 
year.  He  stayed  on  at  Chicago  for  graduate  work  in  psychology,  at  first 
thinking  he  would  become  a  clinical  psychologist.  But  he  soon  became 
interested  in  Piaget  and  began  interviewing  children  and  adolescents 
on  moral  issues.  The  result  was  his  doctoral  dissertation  (1958a),  the 
first  rendition  of  his  new  stage  theory.  Kohlberg  taught  at  the  Univer¬ 
sity  of  Chicago  from  1962  to  1968  and  at  Harvard  University  from  1968 
until  his  death  in  1987. 

Kohlberg  was  an  informal,  unassuming  man.  When  he  taught,  he 
frequently  came  to  class  dressed  in  a  flannel  shirt  and  baggy  pants — 
as  if  he  had  thought  it  was  his  day  off.  He  usually  began  asking  ques¬ 
tions  in  an  off-the-cuff  manner.  In  the  first  days  of  the  school  year, 
students  didn't  always  know  what  to  make  of  him.  But  they  soon  saw 
that  they  were  in  the  presence  of  a  true  scholar,  a  man  who  had 


'I  would  like  to  thank  David  F.  Ricks  for  his  help  with  this  introductory  section. 

From  Theories  of  Development:  Concepts  and  Applications,  Sixth  Edition.  William 
Crain.  Copyright  ©  2011  by  Pearson  Education,  Inc.  Published  by  Pearson 
Prentice  Hall.  All  rights  reserved. 


159 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


thought  long  and  deeply  about  critical  issues  in  philosophy  and  psychology, 
and  Kohlberg  was  inviting  them  to  ponder  these  issues  with  him.  In  his  lec¬ 
tures  and  writings,  he  did  much  to  help  others  appreciate  the  wisdom  of  the 
"old  psychologists,"  writers  such  as  Rousseau,  John  Dewey,  and  James  Mark 
Baldwin. 

Unfortunately,  Kohlberg  suffered  from  a  tropical  disease  and  bouts  of 
depression  that  caused  him  intense  pain  during  the  last  20  years  of  his  life. 
At  the  age  of  59,  he  ended  his  life  by  drowning. 


PIAGET’S  STAGES  OF  MORAL  JUDGMENT 

While  he  was  in  graduate  school,  Kohlberg  became  deeply  impressed  by 
Piaget's  studies  of  moral  judgment.  Piaget,  Kohlberg  saw,  was  talking  to  chil¬ 
dren  about  fundamental  matters  in  moral  philosophy  and  was  drawing  out 
their  real  thinking.  At  the  same  time,  Piaget's  work  seemed  incomplete. 

Essentially,  Piaget's  findings  on  moral  judgment  fit  into  a  two-stage 
theory.  Children  younger  than  10  or  11  years  think  about  moral  dilemmas  one 
way;  older  children  consider  them  differently.  As  we  have  seen,  younger  chil¬ 
dren  regard  rules  as  fixed  and  absolute.  They  believe  rules  are  handed  down 
by  adults  or  by  God  and  cannot  be  changed.  The  older  child's  view  is  more 
relativistic.  She  understands  it  is  permissible  to  change  rules  if  everyone 
agrees.  Rules  are  not  sacred  and  absolute  but  are  devices  that  humans  use  to 
get  along  cooperatively. 

At  approximately  the  same  time — age  10  or  so — children's  moral  think¬ 
ing  undergoes  other  shifts.  Younger  children  base  their  moral  judgments  more 
on  consequences,  whereas  older  children  base  their  judgments  on  intentions. 
When,  for  example,  the  young  child  hears  about  one  boy  who  made  a  large 
ink  spot  trying  to  help  his  dad  and  another  boy  who  made  only  a  small  ink 
spot  when  playing  around,  the  young  child  thinks  the  first  boy  did  worse. 
The  child  primarily  considers  the  amount  of  damage — the  consequences — 
whereas  the  older  child  is  more  likely  to  judge  wrongness  in  terms  of  the 
motives  underlying  the  act  (Piaget,  1932,  p.  130). 

There  are  many  more  details  to  Piaget's  work  on  moral  judgment,  but  he 
essentially  found  a  series  of  changes  that  occur  between  the  ages  of  10  and  12, 
just  when  the  child  begins  to  enter  the  general  stage  of  formal  operations. 
Intellectual  development,  however,  does  not  stop  at  this  point.  This  is  just  the 
beginning  of  formal  operations,  which  continue  to  develop  at  least  until  age 
16.  Accordingly,  one  might  expect  thinking  about  moral  issues  to  continue  to 
develop  throughout  adolescence.  Kohlberg  therefore  interviewed  both  chil¬ 
dren  and  adolescents  about  moral  dilemmas,  and  he  did  find  stages  that  go 
well  beyond  Piaget's.  He  uncovered  six  stages,  only  the  first  three  of  which 
share  many  features  with  Piaget's  stages. 


160 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


KOHLBERG’S  METHOD 

Kohlberg's  (1958a)  core  sample  was  comprised  of  72  boys  from  both  middle- 
and  lower-class  families  in  Chicago.  They  were  ages  10,  13,  and  16.  He  later 
added  to  his  sample  younger  children,  delinquents,  and  boys  and  girls  from 
other  U.S.  cities  and  from  other  countries  (Kohlberg,  1963, 1970). 

The  basic  interview  consists  of  a  series  of  dilemmas  such  as  the  following: 

Heinz  Steals  the  Drug 

In  Europe,  a  woman  was  near  death  from  a  special  kind  of  cancer.  There 
was  one  drug  that  the  doctors  thought  might  save  her.  It  was  a  form  of 
radium  that  a  druggist  in  the  same  town  had  recently  discovered.  The 
drug  was  expensive  to  make,  but  the  druggist  was  charging  ten  times 
what  the  drug  cost  him  to  make.  He  paid  $200  for  the  radium  and 
charged  $2,000  for  a  small  dose  of  the  drug.  The  sick  woman's  husband, 
Heinz,  went  to  everyone  he  knew  to  borrow  the  money,  but  he  could 
only  get  together  about  $1,000  which  is  half  of  what  it  cost.  He  told  the 
druggist  that  his  wife  was  dying  and  asked  him  to  sell  it  cheaper  or  let 
him  pay  later.  But  the  druggist  said:  "No,  I  discovered  the  drug  and  I'm 
going  to  make  money  from  it."  So  Heinz  got  desperate  and  broke  into 
the  man's  store  to  steal  the  drug  for  his  wife.  Should  the  husband  have 
done  that?  (Kohlberg,  1963,  p.  19) 

Kohlberg  was  not  really  interested  in  whether  the  subject  said  "yes"  or  "no"  to 
this  dilemma  but  in  the  reasoning  behind  the  answer.  The  interviewer  wants  to 
know  why  the  subject  thinks  Heinz  should  or  should  not  have  stolen  the  drug. 
The  interview  schedule  then  asks  new  questions  that  help  us  understand  the 
child's  reasoning.  For  example,  children  are  asked  if  Heinz  had  a  right  to  steal 
the  drug,  if  he  was  violating  the  druggist's  rights,  and  what  sentence  the  judge 
should  give  him  once  he  was  caught.  Once  again,  the  main  concern  is  with  the 
reasoning  behind  the  answers.  The  interview  then  goes  on  to  give  more  dilem¬ 
mas  in  order  to  get  a  good  sampling  of  a  subject's  moral  thinking. 

Once  Kohlberg  had  classified  the  various  responses  into  stages,  he 
wanted  to  know  whether  his  classification  was  reliable.  In  particular,  he  wanted 
to  know  if  others  would  score  the  protocols  in  the  same  way.  Other  judges 
independently  scored  a  sample  of  responses,  and  he  calculated  the  degree  to 
which  all  raters  agreed.  This  procedure  is  called  interrater  reliability.  Kohlberg 
found  these  agreements  to  be  high,  as  he  did  in  his  subsequent  work,  but 
whenever  investigators  use  Kohlberg's  interview,  they  should  also  check  for 
interrater  reliability  before  scoring  the  entire  sample.2 


2For  a  discussion  of  other  forms  of  reliability,  see  Colby,  Kohlberg,  Gibbs,  and  Lieberman, 

1983. 


161 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


KOHLBERG’S  SIX  STAGES 

Level  I.  Preconventional  Morality 

Stage  1.  Obedience  and  Punishment  Orientation.  Kohlberg's  stage 
1  is  similar  to  Piaget's  first  stage  of  moral  thought.  The  child  assumes  that 
powerful  authorities  hand  down  a  fixed  set  of  rules  that  she  must  unques- 
tioningly  obey.  To  the  Heinz  dilemma,  the  child  typically  says  that  Heinz  was 
wrong  to  steal  the  drug  because  "it's  against  the  law''  or  "it's  bad  to  steal,"  as 
if  this  were  all  there  were  to  it.  When  asked  to  elaborate,  the  child  usually 
responds  in  terms  of  the  consequences  involved,  explaining  that  stealing  is  bad 
"because  you'll  get  punished"  (Kohlberg,  1958b). 

Although  the  vast  majority  of  children  at  stage  1  oppose  Heinz's  theft, 
it  is  still  possible  for  a  child  to  support  the  action  and  still  employ  stage  1  rea¬ 
soning.  A  child  might  say,  "Heinz  can  steal  it  because  he  asked  first  and  it's 
not  like  he  stole  something  big;  he  won't  get  punished"  (see  Rest,  1973).  Even 
though  the  child  agrees  with  Heinz's  action,  the  reasoning  is  still  stage  1;  the 
concern  is  with  what  authorities  permit  and  punish. 

Kohlberg  calls  stage  1  thinking  preconventional  because  children  do  not 
yet  speak  as  members  of  society.  Instead,  they  see  morality  as  something  exter¬ 
nal  to  themselves — something  the  big  people  say  they  must  do  (Colby, 
Kohlberg,  &  Kauffman,  1987a,  p.  16). 

Stage  2.  Individualism  and  Exchange.  At  this  stage  children  rec¬ 
ognize  there  is  not  just  one  right  view  handed  down  by  the  authorities.  Dif¬ 
ferent  individuals  have  different  viewpoints.  "Heinz,"  they  might  point 
out,  "might  think  it's  right  to  take  the  drug,  the  druggist  would  not."  Since 
everything  is  relative,  each  person  is  free  to  pursue  his  or  her  individual  inter¬ 
ests.  One  boy  said  that  Heinz  might  steal  the  drug  if  he  wanted  his  wife  to 
live,  but  that  he  doesn't  have  to  if  he  wants  to  marry  someone  younger  and 
better  looking  (Kohlberg,  1963,  p.  24).  Another  boy  said  Heinz  might  steal 
it  because 

maybe  they  had  children  and  he  might  need  someone  at  home  to  look 
after  them.  But  maybe  he  shouldn't  steal  it  because  they  might  put  him 
in  prison  for  more  years  than  he  could  stand.  (Colby,  Kohlberg,  & 
Kauffman,  1987b,  p.  208) 

What  is  right  for  Heinz,  then,  is  what  meets  his  own  self-interests. 

You  might  have  noticed  that  children  at  both  stages  1  and  2  talk  about 
punishment.  However,  they  perceive  it  differently.  At  stage  1,  punishment  is 
tied  up  in  the  child's  mind  with  wrongness;  punishment  "proves"  that  dis¬ 
obedience  is  wrong.  At  stage  2,  in  contrast,  punishment  is  simply  a  risk  that 
one  naturally  wants  to  avoid. 


162 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


Although  stage  2  respondents  sometimes  sound  amoral,  they  do  have 
some  sense  of  right  action.  There  is  a  notion  of  fair  exchange  or  fair  deals.  The 
philosophy  is  one  of  returning  favors —  "If  you  scratch  my  back,  I'll  scratch 
yours."  To  the  Heinz  story,  subjects  often  say  Heinz  was  right  to  steal  the  drug 
because  the  druggist  was  unwilling  to  make  a  fair  deal;  he  was  "trying  to  rip 
Heinz  off."  Or  they  might  say  he  should  steal  for  his  wife  "because  she  might 
return  the  favor  some  day"  (Colby  et  al.,  1987c,  pp.  16-17). 

Respondents  at  stage  2  are  still  said  to  reason  at  the  preconventional 
level  because  they  speak  as  isolated  individuals  rather  than  as  members  of 
society.  They  see  individuals  exchanging  favors,  but  there  is  still  no  identifi¬ 
cation  with  the  values  of  the  family  or  community. 


Level  II.  Conventional  Morality 

Stage  3.  Good  Interpersonal  Relationships.  At  this  stage  children — 
who  are  by  now  usually  entering  their  teens — see  morality  as  more  than 
simple  deals.  They  believe  people  should  live  up  to  the  expectations  of  the 
family  and  community  and  behave  in  "good"  ways.  Good  behavior  means 
having  good  motives  and  interpersonal  feelings  such  as  love,  empathy,  trust, 
and  concern  for  others.  Heinz,  they  typically  argue,  was  right  to  steal  the  drug 
because  "he  was  a  good  man  for  wanting  to  save  her"  and  "his  intentions  were 
good,  that  of  saving  the  life  of  someone  he  loves."  Even  if  Heinz  doesn't  love 
his  wife,  these  subjects  often  say,  he  should  steal  the  drug  because  "I  don't 
think  any  husband  should  sit  back  and  watch  his  wife  die"  (Kohlberg,  1958b; 
Colby  et  al.,  1987c,  pp.  27-29). 

If  Heinz's  motives  were  good,  the  druggist's  were  bad.  The  druggist, 
stage  3  subjects  emphasize,  was  "selfish,"  "greedy,"  and  "only  interested  in 
himself,  not  another  life."  Sometimes  the  respondents  become  so  angry 
with  the  druggist  that  they  say  he  ought  to  be  put  in  jail  (Colby  et  al.,  1987c, 
pp.  20-33).  A  typical  stage  3  response  is  that  of  Don,  age  13: 

It  was  really  the  druggist's  fault,  he  was  unfair,  trying  to  overcharge  and 
letting  someone  die.  Heinz  loved  his  wife  and  wanted  to  save  her.  I  think 
anyone  would.  I  don't  think  they  would  put  him  in  jail.  The  judge  would 
look  at  all  sides,  and  see  that  the  druggist  was  charging  too  much. 
(Kohlberg,  1963,  p.  25) 

We  see  that  Don  defines  the  issue  in  terms  of  the  actors'  character  traits  and 
motives.  He  talks  about  the  loving  husband,  the  unfair  druggist,  and  the 
understanding  judge.  His  answer  deserves  the  label  "conventional  morality" 
because  it  assumes  that  the  attitude  expressed  would  be  shared  by  the  entire 
community — "anyone"  would  be  right  to  do  what  Heinz  did  (p.  25). 

As  mentioned  earlier,  there  are  similarities  between  Kohlberg's  first 
three  stages  and  Piaget's  two  stages.  In  both  sequences  there  is  a  shift  from 


163 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


unquestioning  obedience  to  a  relativistic  outlook  and  to  a  concern  for  good 
motives.  For  Kohlberg,  however,  these  shifts  occur  in  three  stages  rather 
than  two. 

Stage  4.  Maintaining  the  Social  Order.  Stage  3  reasoning  works  best 
in  two-person  relationships  with  family  members  or  close  friends,  where  one 
can  make  a  real  effort  to  get  to  know  the  other's  feelings  and  needs  and  try 
to  help.  At  stage  4,  in  contrast,  the  respondent  becomes  more  broadly  con¬ 
cerned  with  society  as  a  whole.  Now  the  emphasis  is  on  obeying  laws,  respect¬ 
ing  authority,  and  performing  one's  duties  so  the  social  order  is  maintained. 
In  response  to  the  Heinz  story,  many  subjects  say  they  understand  that 
Heinz's  motives  were  good,  but  they  cannot  condone  the  theft.  What  would 
happen  if  we  all  started  breaking  the  laws  whenever  we  felt  we  had  a  good 
reason?  The  result  would  be  chaos;  society  couldn't  function.  As  one  subject 
explained, 

I  don't  want  to  sound  like  Spiro  Agnew,  law  and  order  and  wave  the 
flag,  but  if  everybody  did  as  he  wanted  to  do,  set  up  his  own  beliefs  as 
to  right  and  wrong,  then  I  think  you  would  have  chaos.  The  only  thing 
I  think  we  have  in  civilization  nowadays  is  some  sort  of  legal  structure 
which  people  are  sort  of  bound  to  follow.  [Society  needs]  a  centralizing 
framework.  (Colby  et  al.,  1987c,  p.  89) 

Because  stage  4  subjects  make  moral  decisions  from  the  perspective  of  soci¬ 
ety  as  a  whole,  they  think  from  a  full-fledged  member-of-society  perspective 
(Colby  et  al.,  1987a,  p.  17). 

You  will  recall  that  stage  1  children  also  generally  oppose  stealing 
because  it  breaks  the  law.  Superficially,  stage  1  and  stage  4  subjects  are  giving 
the  same  response,  so  we  see  here  why  Kohlberg  insisted  that  we  must  probe 
into  the  reasoning  behind  the  overt  response.  Stage  1  children  say,  "It's  wrong 
to  steal"  and  "It's  against  the  law,"  but  they  cannot  elaborate  any  further, 
except  to  say  that  stealing  can  get  a  person  jailed.  Stage  4  respondents,  in  con¬ 
trast,  have  a  conception  of  the  function  of  laws  for  society  as  a  whole — a 
conception  that  far  exceeds  the  grasp  of  the  younger  child. 


Level  III.  Postconventional  Morality 

Stage  5.  Social  Contract  and  Individual  Rights.  At  stage  4,  people 
want  to  keep  society  functioning.  However,  a  smoothly  functioning  society  is 
not  necessarily  a  good  one.  A  totalitarian  society  might  be  well  organized,  but 
it  is  hardly  the  moral  ideal.  At  stage  5,  people  begin  to  ask,  "What  makes  for 
a  good  society?"  They  begin  to  think  about  society  in  a  very  theoretical  way, 
stepping  back  from  their  own  society  and  considering  the  rights  and  values 
a  society  ought  to  uphold.  They  then  evaluate  existing  societies  in  terms  of 


164 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


these  prior  considerations.  They  are  said  to  take  a  "prior-to-society"  perspec¬ 
tive  (Colby  et  al.,  1987a,  p.  20). 

Stage  5  respondents  basically  believe  that  a  good  society  is  best  con¬ 
ceived  as  a  social  contract  into  which  people  freely  enter  to  work  toward  the 
benefit  of  all.  They  recognize  that  different  social  groups  within  a  society  will 
have  different  values,  but  they  believe  all  rational  people  would  agree  on  two 
points.  First,  they  would  all  want  certain  basic  rights,  such  as  liberty  and  life, 
to  be  protected.  Second,  they  would  want  some  democratic  procedures  for 
changing  unfair  laws  and  for  improving  society. 

In  response  to  the  Heinz  dilemma,  stage  5  respondents  make  it  clear  that 
they  do  not  generally  favor  breaking  laws;  laws  are  social  contracts  that  we 
agree  to  uphold  until  we  can  change  them  by  democratic  means.  Neverthe¬ 
less,  the  wife's  right  to  live  is  a  moral  right  that  must  be  protected.  Thus 
stage  5  respondents  sometimes  defend  Heinz's  theft  in  strong  language: 

It  is  the  husband's  duty  to  save  his  wife.  The  fact  that  her  life  is  in  dan¬ 
ger  transcends  every  other  standard  you  might  use  to  judge  his  action. 

Life  is  more  important  than  property.  (Kohlberg,  1976,  p.  38) 

This  young  man  went  on  to  say  that  "from  a  moral  standpoint,"  Heinz  should 
save  the  life  of  even  a  stranger,  since,  to  be  consistent,  the  value  of  a  life  means 
any  life.  When  asked  if  the  judge  should  punish  Heinz,  he  replied. 

Usually  the  moral  and  legal  standpoints  coincide.  Here  they  conflict. 

The  judge  should  weight  the  moral  standpoint  more  heavily  but  pre¬ 
serve  the  legal  law  in  punishing  Heinz  lightly.  (Kohlberg,  1976,  p.  38) 

Stage  5  subjects,  then,  talk  about  "morality"  and  "rights"  that  take  some 
priority  over  particular  laws.  Kohlberg  insisted,  however,  that  we  do  not  judge 
people  to  be  at  stage  5  merely  from  their  verbal  labels.  We  need  to  look  at  their 
social  perspective  and  mode  of  reasoning.  At  stage  4,  too,  subjects  frequently 
talk  about  the  "right  to  life,"  but  for  them  this  right  is  legitimized  by  the 
authority  of  their  social  or  religious  group  (e.g.,  by  the  Bible).  Presumably,  if 
their  group  valued  property  over  life,  they  would  too.  At  stage  5,  in  contrast, 
people  are  making  more  of  an  independent  effort  to  think  out  what  any  soci¬ 
ety  ought  to  value.  They  often  reason,  for  example,  that  property  has  little 
meaning  without  life.  They  are  trying  to  determine  logically  what  a  society 
ought  to  be  like  (Colby  et  al.,  1987c,  pp.  53-55;  Kohlberg,  1981,  pp.  21-22). 

Stage  6.  Universal  Principles.  Stage  5  respondents  are  working 
toward  a  conception  of  the  good  society.  They  suggest  that  we  need  to  (1)  pro¬ 
tect  certain  individual  rights  and  (2)  settle  disputes  through  democratic 
processes.  However,  democratic  processes  alone  do  not  always  result  in  out¬ 
comes  that  we  intuitively  sense  are  just.  A  majority,  for  example,  may  vote  for 


165 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


a  law  that  hinders  a  minority.  Thus  Kohlberg  believed  there  must  be  a  higher 
stage — stage  6 — that  defines  the  principles  by  which  we  achieve  justice. 

Kohlberg's  conception  of  justice  followed  that  of  the  philosophers 
Immanuel  Kant  and  John  Rawls,  as  well  as  great  moral  leaders  such  as 
Mohandas  Gandhi  and  Martin  Luther  King,  Jr.  According  to  these  people, 
the  principles  of  justice  require  us  to  treat  the  claims  of  all  parties  in  an  impar¬ 
tial  manner,  respecting  the  basic  dignity  of  all  people  as  individuals.  The 
principles  of  justice  are  therefore  universal;  they  apply  to  all.  We  would  not 
vote  for  a  law  that  aids  some  people  but  hurts  others.  The  principles  of  jus¬ 
tice  require  an  equal  respect  for  every  person. 

In  actual  practice,  Kohlberg  said,  we  can  reach  just  decisions  by  looking 
at  a  situation  through  one  another's  eyes.  In  the  Heinz  dilemma,  this  would 
mean  that  all  parties — the  druggist,  Heinz,  and  his  wife — take  the  roles  of  the 
others.  To  do  this  in  an  impartial  manner,  people  can  assume  a  "veil  of  igno¬ 
rance"  (Rawls,  1971),  acting  as  if  they  do  not  know  which  role  they  would 
eventually  occupy.  If  the  druggist  did  this,  even  he  would  recognize  that  life 
must  take  priority  over  property;  for  he  wouldn't  want  to  risk  finding  himself 
in  the  wife's  shoes  with  property  valued  over  life.  Thus  they  would  all  agree 
the  wife  must  be  saved — this  would  be  the  fair  solution.  Such  a  solution,  we 
must  note,  requires  not  only  impartiality  but  also  the  principle  that  everyone 
is  given  full  and  equal  respect.  If  the  wife  were  considered  of  less  value  than 
the  others,  a  just  solution  could  not  be  reached. 

Until  1975  Kohlberg  had  been  scoring  some  of  his  subjects  at  stage  6,  but 
he  then  stopped  doing  so.  One  reason  was  that  he  and  other  researchers  had 
found  very  few  subjects  who  consistently  reasoned  at  this  stage.  Also,  Kohlberg 
concluded  that  his  interview  dilemmas  did  not  draw  out  differences  between 
stage  5  and  stage  6  thinking.  Theoretically,  stage  6  has  a  clearer  and  broader  con¬ 
ception  of  universal  principles  (including  justice  as  well  as  individual  rights), 
but  the  interview  did  not  draw  out  this  broader  understanding.  So  he  dropped 
stage  6  from  his  manual,  calling  it  a  "theoretical  stage"  and  scoring  all  post- 
conventional  responses  at  stage  5  (Colby  et  al.,  1987a,  pp.  35-40). 

One  issue  that  would  distinguish  stage  5  from  stage  6  is  civil  disobe¬ 
dience.  Stage  5  thinkers  would  be  hesitant  to  endorse  civil  disobedience 
because  of  their  commitment  to  the  social  contract  and  to  changing  laws 
through  democratic  agreements.  Only  when  an  individual  right  is  clearly 
at  stake  does  violating  the  law  seem  justified.  At  stage  6,  in  contrast,  a  com¬ 
mitment  to  justice  makes  the  rationale  for  civil  disobedience  stronger  and 
broader.  Martin  Luther  King  argued  that  laws  are  valid  only  insofar  as  they 
are  grounded  in  justice,  and  that  a  commitment  to  justice  carries  with  it  an 
obligation  to  disobey  unjust  laws.  King  also  recognized,  of  course,  the  gen¬ 
eral  need  for  laws  and  democratic  processes  (stages  4  and  5),  and  he  was 
therefore  willing  to  accept  the  penalties  for  his  actions.  Nevertheless,  he 
believed  that  the  higher  principle  of  justice  required  civil  disobedience 
(Kohlberg,  1981,  p.  43). 


166 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


Summary 

At  stage  1  children  think  of  what  is  right  as  what  authority  says  is  right.  Doing 
the  right  thing  is  obeying  authority  and  avoiding  punishment.  At  stage  2  chil¬ 
dren  are  no  longer  so  impressed  by  any  single  authority;  they  see  that  there 
are  different  sides  to  any  issue.  Since  everything  is  relative,  one  is  free  to  pur¬ 
sue  one's  own  interests,  although  it  is  often  useful  to  make  deals  and  exchange 
favors  with  others. 

At  stages  3  and  4  young  people  think  as  members  of  the  conventional 
society,  with  its  values,  norms,  and  expectations.  At  stage  3  they  emphasize 
being  a  good  person,  which  basically  means  having  helpful  motives  toward 
people  who  are  close  to  one.  At  stage  4  the  concern  shifts  toward  obeying  laws 
to  maintain  society  as  a  whole. 

At  stages  5  and  6  people  are  less  concerned  with  maintaining  society  for 
its  own  sake,  and  more  concerned  with  the  principles  and  values  that  make 
for  a  good  society.  At  stage  5  they  emphasize  basic  rights  and  the  democratic 
processes  that  give  everyone  a  say,  and  at  stage  6  they  define  the  principles  by 
which  agreements  will  be  most  just. 


A  Possible  Seventh  Stage 

Those  who  have  developed  conception  of  justice  often  work  to  bring  it  about, 
but  they  also  encounter  serious  setbacks.  They  go  through  periods  of  doubt 
and  despair.  Martin  Luther  King  and  activists  in  the  civil  rights  movement  of 
the  1950s  and  1960s  experienced  such  periods.  Any  of  us  can  go  through  them 
as  well.  We  might  ask  ourselves.  Why  should  I  act  morally  when  no  one  else 
seems  to?  Why  act  generously  when  the  world  is  governed  by  self-interest? 
Why  should  I  bother  to  live  when  those  whom  I  love  the  most  are  dying  and 
suffering  and  I  can  do  nothing  about  it? 

One  answer  to  these  kinds  of  questions  has  come  from  secular  existen¬ 
tialists  such  as  Albert  Camus  (1948, 1955).  Camus  believed  that  even  though 
our  efforts  may  be  futile,  we  gain  dignity  by  sticking  with  them.  Although 
the  world  offers  nothing  meaningful,  we  create  meaning  by  working  for  what 
we  believe  is  right. 

Kohlberg  described  an  alternative.  He  observed  that  answers  to  despair 
can  come  from  a  spiritual  attitude  he  called  stage  7. 

Stage  7  isn't  a  stage  of  moral  reasoning,  but  rather  a  stage  of  spiritual 
development  growing  out  of  personal  experiences  and  reflection.  It  needn't  be 
tied  to  organized  religion.  It  doesn't  replace  stage  6  efforts  to  rationally  con¬ 
sider  what  is  fair  or  right,  but  it  gives  some  people  emotional  support  for 
working  for  what  is  right.  Essentially,  it  is  a  sense  of  being  part  of  something 
much  larger  than  oneself — a  sense  of  oneness  with  life,  God,  or  Nature.  Feel¬ 
ing  a  part  of  a  transcendent  whole,  one  no  longer  feels  futile  or  hopeless.  One 
even  feels  courage  in  the  face  of  death  (Kohlberg  &  Power,  1981). 


167 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


Martin  Luther  King  expressed  his  personal  view  this  way:  "I  am  con¬ 
vinced  that  the  universe  is  under  the  control  of  a  loving  purpose,  and  that 
in  the  struggle  for  righteousness  man  has  cosmic  companionship"  (1963, 
p.  153).  No  matter  what  King  faced,  this  "cosmic  companionship"  kept  him 
going. 

Kohlberg  based  his  ideas  about  stage  7  on  the  lives  of  moral  leaders 
as  well  as  James  Fowler's  research  on  the  development  of  faith  in  children 
and  adults.  On  the  basis  of  very  limited  data,  Kohlberg  speculated  that 
stage  7  follows  stage  6  of  moral  reasoning.  It  comes  after  stage  6  as  an 
answer  to  the  question  of  why  one  should  act  morally  when  it  feels  point¬ 
less  to  do  so.  If  it  emerges  this  late,  stage  7  is  extremely  rare  (Kohlberg  & 
Power,  1981).  One  of  Kohlberg's  former  coworkers,  John  Gibbs  (2003),  sug¬ 
gests  that  stage  7  thinking  often  occurs  earlier  and  is  even  fairly  common 
in  adolescence.  In  any  event,  I  want  to  emphasize  that  Kohlberg  didn't  con¬ 
sider  stage  7  part  of  his  moral  stage  sequence.  Rather,  he  thought  of  it  as  a 
type  of  consciousness  through  which  some  individuals  gain  moral  strength 
(Kohlberg  &  Power,  1981). 


THEORETICAL  ISSUES 
How  Development  Occurs 

Kohlberg,  it  is  important  to  remember,  was  a  close  follower  of  Piaget.  Accord¬ 
ingly,  Kohlberg's  theoretical  positions,  including  that  on  developmental 
change,  reflected  those  of  his  mentor. 

Kohlberg  (e.g.,  1968;  1981,  chap.  3)  said  his  stages  are  not  the  product  of 
maturation — that  is,  the  stage  structures  and  sequences  do  not  simply  unfold 
according  to  a  genetic  blueprint. 

Neither,  Kohlberg  maintained,  are  his  stages  the  product  of  socializa¬ 
tion.  That  is,  socializing  agents  (e.g.,  parents  and  teachers)  do  not  directly 
teach  new  forms  of  thinking.  Indeed,  it  is  difficult  to  imagine  them  system¬ 
atically  teaching  each  new  stage  structure  in  its  particular  place  in  the 
sequence. 

The  stages  emerge,  instead,  from  our  own  thinking  about  moral  prob¬ 
lems.  Social  experiences  do  promote  development,  but  they  do  so  by  stimu¬ 
lating  our  mental  processes.  As  we  get  into  discussions  and  debates  with 
others,  we  find  our  views  questioned  and  challenged  and  are  therefore  moti¬ 
vated  to  come  up  with  new,  more  comprehensive  positions.  The  stages  reflect 
these  broader  viewpoints  (Kohlberg  et  al.,  1975). 

We  might  imagine,  for  example,  a  young  man  and  woman  discussing  a 
new  law.  The  man  says  that  everyone  should  obey  it,  like  it  or  not,  because 
laws  are  vital  to  social  organization  (stage  4).  The  woman  notes,  however,  that 
some  well-organized  societies,  such  as  Nazi  Germany,  were  not  particularly 


168 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


moral.  The  man  therefore  sees  that  some  evidence  contradicts  his  view.  He 
experiences  some  cognitive  conflict  and  is  motivated  to  think  about  the  mat¬ 
ter  more  fully,  perhaps  moving  a  bit  toward  stage  5. 

Kohlberg  also  sometimes  spoke  of  change  occurring  through  role-taking 
opportunities,  opportunities  to  consider  others'  viewpoints  (e.g.,  Kohlberg, 
1976).  As  children  interact  with  others,  they  learn  how  viewpoints  differ  and 
how  to  coordinate  them  in  cooperative  activities.  As  they  discuss  their  prob¬ 
lems  and  work  out  their  differences,  they  develop  their  conceptions  of  what 
is  fair  and  just. 

Whatever  the  interactions  are  specifically  like,  they  work  best,  Kohlberg 
said,  when  they  are  open  and  democratic.  The  less  children  feel  pressured 
simply  to  conform  to  authority,  the  freer  they  are  to  settle  their  own  differ¬ 
ences  and  formulate  their  own  ideas. 


The  Stage  Concept 

Piaget,  you  will  recall,  proposed  that  true  mental  stages  meet  several  criteria. 
They  (1)  are  qualitatively  different  ways  of  thinking,  (2)  are  structured  wholes, 
(3)  progress  in  an  invariant  sequence,  (4)  can  be  characterized  as  hierarchic 
integrations,  and  (5)  are  cross-cultural  universals.  Kohlberg  took  these  crite¬ 
ria  very  seriously,  trying  to  show  how  his  stages  meet  them  all.  Let's  consider 
these  points  one  at  a  time. 

1 .  Qualitative  Differences.  It  seems  fairly  clear  that  Kohlberg's  stages 
are  qualitatively  different  from  one  another.  For  example,  stage  1  responses, 
which  focus  on  obedience  to  authority,  sound  very  different  from  stage  2 
responses,  which  argue  that  each  person  is  free  to  behave  as  he  or  she  wishes. 
The  two  stages  do  not  seem  to  differ  along  any  quantitative  dimension;  they 
seem  qualitatively  different. 

2.  Structured  Wholes.  By  structured  wholes,  Kohlberg  meant  the  stages 
are  not  just  isolated  responses  but  are  general  patterns  of  thought  that  consis¬ 
tently  show  up  across  many  different  kinds  of  issues.  One  gets  a  sense  this  is 
true  by  reading  through  his  scoring  manual;  one  finds  the  same  kinds  of  think¬ 
ing  reappearing  on  diverse  items.  For  example,  one  item  asks,  Why  should  a 
promise  be  kept?  As  on  the  Heinz  dilemma,  children  at  stage  1  again  speak  in 
terms  of  obedience  to  rules,  whereas  those  at  stage  2  focus  on  exchanging 
favors  that  are  in  one's  self-interest  (e.g.,  "You  never  know  when  you're  going 
to  need  that  person  to  do  something  for  you").  Similarly,  as  children  proceed 
through  the  stages,  they  keep  giving  responses  that  are  similar  to  those  to  the 
Heinz  dilemma  (Colby  et  al.,  1987c,  pp.  802-854). 

In  addition,  Kohlberg  and  his  coworkers  (Colby  et  al.,  1983)  have 
obtained  quantitative  estimates  of  the  extent  to  which  subjects  respond  in 
terms  of  one  particular  stage.  Since  some  subjects  might  be  in  transition 


169 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


between  stages,  one  does  not  expect  perfect  consistency.  Nevertheless, 
Kohlberg  found  that  subjects  scored  at  their  dominant  stage  across  nine  dilem¬ 
mas  about  two  thirds  of  the  time.  This  seems  to  be  a  fair  degree  of  consistency, 
suggesting  the  stages  may  reflect  general  modes  of  thought. 

3.  Invariant  Sequence.  Kohlberg  believed  his  stages  unfold  in  an 
invariant  sequence.  Children  always  go  from  stage  1  to  stage  2  to  stage  3  and 
so  forth.  They  do  not  skip  stages  or  move  through  them  in  mixed-up  orders. 
Not  all  children  necessarily  reach  the  highest  stages;  they  might  lack  intellec¬ 
tual  stimulation.  But  to  the  extent  they  do  go  through  the  stages,  they  pro¬ 
ceed  in  order. 

Most  of  Kohlberg's  evidence  on  his  stage  sequence  came  from  cross- 
sectional  data.  That  is,  he  interviewed  different  children  at  various  ages  to  see 
if  the  younger  ones  were  at  lower  stages  than  the  older  ones.  Figure  1 

Figure  1 

Use  of  six  types  of  moral  judgments  at  four  ages. 

(From  Kohlber,  L.  Use  of  six  types  of  moral  judgments  at  four 
ages.  Human  Development  6,  p.  1 6.  Copyright  ©  1 963. 

Reprinted  by  permission  of  S.  Karger  A.G..) 


170 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


summarizes  this  data  from  his  first  studies.  As  you  can  see,  stages  1  and  2  are 
primarily  found  at  the  youngest  age,  whereas  the  higher  stages  become  more 
prevalent  as  age  increases.  The  data  support  the  stage  sequence. 

Cross-sectional  findings,  however,  are  inconclusive.  In  a  cross-sectional 
study,  different  children  are  interviewed  at  each  age,  so  there  is  no  guarantee 
that  any  individual  child  actually  moves  through  the  stages  in  order.  For  ex¬ 
ample,  there  is  no  guarantee  that  a  boy  who  is  coded  at  stage  3  at  age  13  actu¬ 
ally  passed  through  stages  1  and  2  in  order  when  he  was  younger.  More 
conclusive  evidence  must  come  from  longitudinal  studies,  in  which  the  same 
children  are  followed  over  time. 

The  first  two  major  longitudinal  studies  (Holstein,  1973;  Kohlberg  & 
Kramer,  1969)  began  with  samples  of  teenagers  and  then  tested  them  at 
3-year  intervals.  These  studies  produced  ambiguous  results.  In  both,  most 
subjects  either  remained  at  the  same  stage  or  moved  up  one  stage,  but  there 
were  also  some  who  might  have  skipped  a  stage.  Furthermore,  these  studies 
indicated  that  some  subjects  had  regressed,  and  this  finding  also  bothered 
Kohlberg  because  he  believed  that  movement  through  his  stages  should 
always  be  forward. 

Kohlberg's  response  to  these  troublesome  findings  was  to  revise  his  scor¬ 
ing  method.  He  had  already  become  uncomfortable  with  his  first  (1958b)  scor¬ 
ing  manual,  believing  it  relied  too  heavily  on  the  content  of  subjects'  answers 
rather  than  their  underlying  reasoning.  So,  in  1975,  after  these  longitudinal 
findings  showed  stage-skipping  and  regression,  he  decided  to  develop  a  more 
precise  scoring  system.  He  and  his  coworkers  created  a  manual  that  was  more 
stringent  in  assigning  high  scores;  high-stage  reasoning  had  to  be  more  clearly 
demonstrated.  It  was  during  this  work  that  Kohlberg  decided  to  drop  stage  6 
because  so  few  people  now  fit  into  it.  He  and  his  colleagues  then  carried  out 
a  new  longitudinal  analysis  of  his  original  sample  with  the  new  manual,  and 
this  time  they  found  no  stage  skipping  and  very  little  regression.  Other  lon¬ 
gitudinal  studies  obtained  similar  results  (Colby  et  al.7  1983). 

Kohlberg's  new,  longitudinal  study  changed  the  earlier  picture  of  moral 
development  in  other  ways.  If  we  look  again  at  Figure  1,  which  depicts  the  age 
changes  found  in  Kohlberg's  first  studies,  we  see  that  stage  4  had  become  the 
dominant  stage  by  age  16.  In  the  new  scoring  system,  Kohlberg  found  that 
stage  4  did  not  become  dominant  until  the  boys  were  in  their  20s  and  30s 
(Figure  2).  Stage  5,  too,  appears  only  in  the  mid-20s  and  never  becomes  very 
prevalent. 

4.  Hierarchic  Integration.  When  Kohlberg  said  his  stages  were  hier¬ 
archically  integrated,  he  meant  that  people  do  not  lose  the  insights  gained  at 
earlier  stages  but  integrate  them  into  new,  broader  frameworks.  For  example, 
people  at  stage  4  can  still  understand  stage  3  arguments,  but  they  now  sub¬ 
ordinate  them  to  wider  considerations.  They  understand  that  Heinz  had  good 
motives  for  stealing,  but  they  point  out  that  if  we  all  stole  whenever  we  had 


171 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


Age  in  years 


Figure  2 

Mean  percentage  of  moral  reasoning  at  each  stage  for  each  age  group. 

(From  Colby,  Kohlberg,  Gibbs,  &  Lieberman,  A  longitudinal  study  of  moral  judgment. 
Monographs  of  the  Society  for  Research  in  Child  Development  Serial  No.  200, 1 983, 
p.  46.  Copyright  ©  1 983.  Reprinted  by  permission  of  Wiley-Blackwell.) 


a  good  motive,  the  social  structure  would  break  down.  Thus  stage  4  subordi¬ 
nates  a  concern  for  motives  to  a  wider  concern  for  the  society  as  a  whole. 

The  concept  of  hierarchic  integration  was  very  important  for  Kohlberg 
because  it  enabled  him  to  explain  the  direction  of  his  stage  sequence.  Since  he 
was  not  a  maturationist,  he  could  not  simply  say  the  sequence  is  wired  into 
the  genes.  So  he  wanted  to  show  how  each  new  stage  provides  a  broader 
framework  for  dealing  with  moral  issues.  Stage  4,  as  mentioned,  transcends 
the  limitations  of  stage  3  and  becomes  more  broadly  concerned  with  social 
organization.  Stage  5,  in  turn,  sees  the  weakness  of  stage  4;  a  well-organized 
society  is  not  necessarily  a  moral  one.  Stage  5  therefore  considers  the  rights  and 
orderly  processes  that  make  for  a  moral  society.  Each  new  stage  retains  the 
insights  of  the  prior  stage,  but  it  recasts  them  into  a  broader  framework.  In  this 
sense,  each  new  stage  is  more  cognitively  adequate  than  the  prior  stage. 


172 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


If  Kohlberg  was  right  about  the  hierarchic  nature  of  his  stages,  we  would 
expect  that  people  would  still  be  able  to  understand  earlier  stages  but  con¬ 
sider  them  inferior.  In  fact,  when  Rest  presented  adolescents  with  arguments 
from  different  stages,  this  is  what  he  found.  They  understood  lower-stage  rea¬ 
soning,  but  they  disliked  it.  What  they  preferred  was  the  highest  stage  they 
heard,  whether  they  fully  understood  it  or  not.  This  finding  suggests,  per¬ 
haps,  that  they  had  some  intuitive  sense  of  the  greater  adequacy  of  the  higher 
stages  (Rest,  1973;  Rest,  Turiel,  &  Kohlberg,  1969). 

5.  Cross-Cultural  Universality.  Kohlberg,  like  all  stage  theorists, 
maintained  that  his  stage  sequence  is  universal;  it  is  the  same  in  all  cultures. 
At  first  glance,  this  proposal  might  be  surprising.  Don't  different  cultures 
socialize  their  children  differently,  teaching  them  very  different  moral 
beliefs? 

Kohlberg's  response  was  that  different  cultures  do  teach  different  beliefs, 
but  his  stages  refer  not  to  specific  beliefs  but  to  underlying  modes  of  reason¬ 
ing  (Kohlberg  &  Gilligan,  1971).  For  example,  one  culture  might  discourage 
physical  fighting,  while  another  encourages  it  more.  As  a  result,  children  will 
have  different  beliefs  about  fighting,  but  they  will  still  reason  about  it  in  the 
same  way  at  the  same  stage.  At  stage  1,  for  example,  one  child  might  say  it  is 
wrong  to  fight  when  insulted  "because  you  will  get  punished  for  it,"  while 
another  says  that  "it  is  all  right  to  fight;  you  won't  get  punished. "  The  beliefs 
differ,  but  both  children  reason  about  them  in  the  same  underlying  way — in 
terms  of  the  physical  consequences  (punishment).  They  do  so  because  this  is 
what  they  can  cognitively  grasp.  Later  on,  the  first  child  might  argue  that 
fighting  is  bad  "because  if  everyone  fought  all  the  time  there  would  be  anar¬ 
chy,''  while  the  second  child  argues  that  "people  must  defend  their  honor, 
because  if  they  don't  everyone  will  be  insulting  everyone,  and  the  whole  soci¬ 
ety  will  break  down."  Once  again,  the  specific  beliefs  differ,  reflecting  differ¬ 
ent  cultural  teachings,  but  the  underlying  reasoning  is  the  same — in  this  case 
it  is  stage  4,  where  people  can  consider  something  as  abstract  as  the  social 
order.  Children,  regardless  of  their  beliefs,  will  always  move  to  stage  4  think¬ 
ing  some  time  after  stage  1  thinking  because  it  is  cognitively  so  much  more 
sophisticated. 

Kohlberg,  then,  proposed  that  his  stage  sequence  is  the  same  in  all  cul¬ 
tures,  for  each  stage  is  conceptually  more  advanced  than  the  next.  He  and 
other  researchers  have  given  his  interview  to  children  and  adults  in  a  variety 
of  cultures,  including  Mexico,  Taiwan,  Turkey,  Israel,  the  Yucatan,  Kenya,  the 
Bahamas,  and  India.  Most  of  the  studies  have  been  cross-sectional,  but  a  few 
have  been  longitudinal.  The  studies  have  supported  Kohlberg's  stage 
sequence.  To  the  extent  that  children  in  different  cultures  move  through  the 
stages,  they  appear  to  move  in  order  (Edwards,  1981;  Gibbs  et  al.,  2007). 

At  the  same  time,  people  in  different  cultures  seem  to  move  through  the 
sequence  at  different  rates  and  to  reach  different  end-points.  In  the  United 


173 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


States  most  urban,  middle-class  adults  reach  stage  4,  with  a  small  percentage 
using  some  stage  5  reasoning.  The  picture  is  fairly  similar  in  urban  areas  of 
other  countries.  But  in  the  isolated  villages  and  tribal  communities  of  many 
countries,  stage  4  is  rarer  and  stage  5  is  completely  absent  (Gibbs  et  al.  2007; 
Edwards,  1981). 

Kohlberg  (Nisan  &  Kohlberg,  1982)  suggested  that  we  can  understand 
these  findings  in  terms  of  Piagetian  theory.  Cultural  factors,  in  this  theory,  do 
not  directly  shape  the  child's  moral  thought,  but  they  do  stimulate  thinking. 
Social  experiences  can  challenge  children's  ideas,  motivating  them  to  come 
up  with  new  ones.  In  traditional  villages,  there  may  be  little  to  challenge  a 
stage  3  morality;  the  norms  of  care  and  empathy  work  very  well  in  govern¬ 
ing  the  face-to-face  interactions  of  the  group.  There  is  little  to  stimulate  think¬ 
ing  beyond  this  stage. 

When,  in  contrast,  young  people  leave  the  village  and  go  off  to  the 
city,  they  witness  the  breakdown  of  interpersonal  ties.  They  see  that  group 
norms  of  care  and  empathy  have  little  impact  on  the  impersonal  interactions 
of  city  life,  and  they  see  the  need  for  a  formal  legal  structure  to  ensure  moral 
conduct.  They  also  become  aware  of  the  need  to  coordinate  a  new  variety 
of  formal  roles,  such  as  manager,  foreman,  and  worker,  to  keep  organiza¬ 
tions  functioning  smoothly.  In  the  city,  then,  it's  natural  to  think  in  terms  of 
stage  4  morality.  Keniston  (1971)  also  notes  that  if  young  people  attend  the 
universities,  they  may  take  classes  in  which  the  teachers  deliberately  ques¬ 
tion  the  unexamined  assumptions  of  their  childhoods  and  adolescences. 
They  are  stimulated  to  think  about  moral  matters  in  new,  postconventional 
ways. 

Nevertheless,  the  results  for  traditional  village  societies  are  striking  and 
raise  the  possibility  that  Kohlberg's  stages  fail  to  do  justice  to  non-Western 
philosophical  thought.  As  an  example,  Kohlberg's  former  co-author  John 
Snarey  (Gibbs  et  al.,  2007)  refers  to  a  50-year-old  man  from  India  who  said 
that  the  Heinz  dilemma  illustrates  the  need  to  become  conscious  of  the  unity 
of  all  life,  including  the  lives  of  animals.  This  man's  thinking  was  difficult  to 
score  according  to  Kohlberg's  manual,  but  it  seemed  advanced.  Similar  unity- 
of-life  thinking  also  is  found  in  indigenous  peoples  around  the  world  (Suzuki 
&  Knudston,  1992).  It  also  appears  in  Kohlberg's  stage  7,  but  Kohlberg  kept 
stage  7  out  of  his  official  six-stage  moral  sequence.  Perhaps  a  more  compre¬ 
hensive,  culturally  universal  stage  theory  would  include  this  unity-of-life  ori¬ 
entation  and  map  out  its  development. 


Moral  Thought  and  Other  Forms 
of  Cognition 

Kohlberg  also  tried  to  relate  his  moral  stages  to  other  forms  of  cognition. 
He  first  analyzed  his  stages  in  terms  of  their  underlying  cognitive  structures 
and  then  looked  for  parallels  in  purely  logical  and  social  thought.  For  this 


174 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


purpose,  he  analyzed  his  own  stages  in  terms  of  implicit  role-taking  capaci¬ 
ties,  capacities  to  consider  others'  viewpoints  (Kohlberg,  1976;  see  also  Rest, 
1983;  Selman,  1976). 

At  stage  1,  children  hardly  seem  to  recognize  that  viewpoints  differ.  They 
assume  there  is  only  one  right  view — that  of  authorities.  At  stage  2,  in  contrast, 
they  recognize  that  people  have  different  interests  and  viewpoints.  They  seem 
to  be  overcoming  egocentrism,  and  they  see  that  perspectives  are  relative  to 
the  individual.  They  also  begin  to  consider  how  individuals  might  coordinate 
their  interests  in  terms  of  mutually  beneficial  deals. 

At  stage  3,  people  conceptualize  role  taking  as  a  deeper,  more  empathic 
process — one  becomes  concerned  with  the  other's  feelings.  Stage  4,  in  turn,  has 
a  broader,  society  wide  conception  of  how  people  coordinate  their  roles 
through  the  legal  system. 

Stages  5  and  6,  finally,  take  a  more  idealized  look  at  how  people  might 
coordinate  their  interests.  Stage  5  emphasizes  democratic  processes,  and  stage 
6  considers  how  all  parties  take  one  another's  perspectives  according  to  the 
principles  of  justice. 

The  moral  stages,  then,  reflect  expanded  insights  into  how  perspectives 
differ  and  might  be  coordinated.  As  such,  the  moral  stages  might  be  related 
to  stages  of  logical  and  social  thought  that  contain  similar  insights.  So  far,  the 
empirical  evidence  suggests  that  advances  in  moral  thinking  may  rest  on  prior 
achievements  in  these  other  realms  (Colby  et  al.,  1987a,  pp.  12-15).  For  ex¬ 
ample,  children  seem  to  advance  to  stage  2,  overcoming  their  egocentrism  in 
the  moral  sphere,  only  after  they  have  made  equivalent  progress  in  their 
logical  and  social  thought.  If  this  pattern  is  correct,  we  can  expect  to  find  many 
individuals  who  are  logical  and  even  socially  insightful  but  still  underdevel¬ 
oped  in  their  moral  judgment. 


Moral  Thought  and  Moral  Behavior 

Kohlberg's  scale  has  to  do  with  moral  thinking,  not  moral  action.  In  many 
situations,  we  might  have  a  clear  idea  about  what  is  right,  but  we  might  not 
act  accordingly.  We  might  put  self-interest  first;  or  we  might  feel  our  action 
will  be  futile;  or  we  might  lack  the  courage  of  our  moral  convictions.  Con¬ 
sequently,  we  would  not  expect  perfect  correlations  between  moral  judg¬ 
ment  and  moral  action.  Still,  Kohlberg  thought  there  should  be  some 
relationship. 

As  a  general  hypothesis,  he  proposed  that  moral  behavior  is  more  con¬ 
sistent,  predictable,  and  responsible  at  the  higher  stages  (Kohlberg  et  al.,  1975) 
because  the  stages  themselves  increasingly  employ  more  stable  and  general 
standards.  For  example,  stage  3  bases  decisions  on  others'  approval,  which 
can  vary,  but  stage  4  refers  to  set  rules  and  laws.  Thus  we  can  expect  that 
moral  behavior,  too,  will  become  more  consistent  as  people  move  up  the 
sequence.  Generally  speaking,  there  is  some  research  support  for  this 


175 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


hypothesis  (e.g.,  with  respect  to  cheating),  but  the  evidence  is  not  clear  cut 
(Blasi,  1980;  Brown  &  Herrnstein,  1975;  Kohlberg  &  Candee,  1984). 

In  a  socially  relevant  study,  Haan,  Smith,  and  Block  (1968)  examined  the 
moral  reasoning  of  those  who  participated  in  the  Berkeley  Free  Speech  Move¬ 
ment  in  1964.  They  wondered  if  the  protestors  were  motivated  by  postcon- 
ventional  democratic  principles.  The  researchers  did  find  that  the  protestors' 
thinking  was  more  often  postconventional  than  that  of  a  matched  sample  of 
nonparticipants,  but  this  finding  was  not  replicated  with  some  other  protests, 
perhaps  because  moral  principles  were  not  as  clearly  at  stake  (Keniston,  1971, 

pp.  260-261). 

Overall,  then,  research  has  indicated  rather  modest  links  between  moral 
thought  and  moral  action  (Berk,  2009,  pp.  502-503).  Kohlberg's  adherents  are 
unhappy  with  the  results,  believing  there  must  be  some  stronger  relationship 
that  has  yet  to  be  found  (Walker  &  Pitts,  1998). 


GILLIGAN  ON  THE  FEMININE  VOICE 

In  1977  Carol  Gilligan,  one  of  Kohlberg's  associates  and  coauthors,  published 
an  essay  that  criticized  Kohlberg's  work  as  biased  against  girls  and  women. 
Gilligan  expanded  this  article  into  a  book.  In  a  Different  Voice  (1982),  which 
ignited  a  great  deal  of  controversy  and  stimulated  a  considerable  amount  of 
new  thinking. 

Gilligan  pointed  out  that  Kohlberg  developed  his  stages  exclusively  from 
interviews  with  boys,  and  she  argued  that  the  stages  reflect  a  decidedly  male 
orientation.  For  males,  advanced  moral  thought  revolves  around  rules,  rights, 
and  abstract  principles.  The  ideal  is  formal  justice,  in  which  one  tries  to  be 
impartial  in  evaluating  the  competing  claims  of  all  parties.  The  individual 
stands  apart  from  the  situation  and  tries  to  come  up  with  a  moral  solution 
that  is  fair  in  some  theoretical  sense.  This  conception  of  morality  leaves  out  the 
female  voice  on  moral  matters. 

For  women,  Gilligan  said,  morality  centers  not  on  rights  and  rules  but  on 
interpersonal  relationships  and  the  ethics  of  compassion  and  care.  The  ideal  is 
not  impersonal  justice  but  more  affiliative  and  connected  ways  of  living. 
Women's  morality,  in  addition,  is  more  contextualized;  it  is  tied  to  real  ongo¬ 
ing  relationships  rather  than  abstract  solutions  to  hypothetical  dilemmas. 

Gilligan  said  that  because  of  these  gender  differences,  men  and  women 
frequently  score  at  different  stages  on  Kohlberg's  scale.  Women  more  often 
score  at  stage  3,  with  its  focus  on  interpersonal  relationships,  whereas  men 
more  commonly  score  at  stages  4  and  5,  which  reflect  more  abstract  concep¬ 
tions  of  social  organization.  Thus  women  score  lower  than  men.  If,  however, 
Kohlberg's  scale  were  more  sensitive  to  women's  distinctly  interpersonal  ori¬ 
entation,  it  would  show  that  women  also  continue  to  develop  their  thinking 
beyond  stage  3. 


176 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


Several  research  studies  have  examined  the  validity  of  Gilligan's 
charge  that  Kohlberg's  stages  are  biased.  By  and  large,  gender  differences 
on  Kohlberg's  stages  appear  to  be  minimal.  Girls  often  reach  stage  3  a  bit 
earlier  than  boys  do,  but  overall,  females  and  males  perform  at  the  same  lev¬ 
els  on  Kohlberg's  sequence  (Berk,  2009,  p.  499).  The  results  do  not  support 
Gilligan's  charge  that  Kohlberg's  stage  theory  makes  females  appear 
inferior. 

At  the  same  time,  Gilligan  has  called  attention  to  an  ethic  of  care  that 
seems  distinct  from  the  abstract  justice  orientation  that  Kohlberg  emphasized. 
And  females  do  seem  more  drawn  to  the  care  orientation.  In  an  early  (1983) 
study,  Nora  Lyons  asked  men  and  women,  "What  does  morality  mean  to 
you?"  The  following  gender  differences  were  typical: 

Male.  "Morality  is  basically  having  a  reason  for  a  way  of  knowing  what 

is  right,  what  one  ought  to  do." 

Female.  "Morality  is  a  type  of  consciousness,  I  guess,  a  sensitivity  . . .  that 

you  can  affect  someone  else's  life."  (p.  125) 

The  men's  responses  were  more  abstract,  whereas  the  women,  employing  an 
ethic  of  care,  more  fequently  saw  themselves  in  relation  to  others. 

Lyons  reported  substantial  gender  differences  in  the  use  of  the  two  moral 
orientations.  Subsequent  research  has  found  more  modest  differences,  and 
both  males  and  females  usually  use  both  justice  and  care  orientations  to  at 
least  some  extent  (Pratt,  Skoe,  &  Arnold,  2004).  The  two  orientations  are  also 
subject  to  cultural  influences;  some  cultures,  such  as  Japan,  socialize  both  boys 
and  girls  to  adopt  care  orientations  (Berk  2009,  pp.  499-450).  But  all  in  all,  it 
does  appear  that  there  are  two  moral  orientations,  with  females  more  gener¬ 
ally  represented  by  the  care  orientation. 

Gilligan  also  sketched  out  the  way  women's  moral  orientation  develops. 
Because  she  believes  that  women's  conceptions  of  care  and  affiliation  are 
embedded  in  real-life  situations  (not  hypothetical  ones),  she  interviewed 
women  facing  a  personal  crisis — the  decision  to  have  an  abortion.  Through 
these  interviews,  Gilligan  described  how  women  progressed  from  pre- 
conventional  to  conventional  to  postconventional  modes  of  thinking.  At  the 
preconventional  level,  women  talked  about  the  issues  in  terms  of  what  they 
meant  to  themselves,  in  terms  of  their  self-interests.  At  the  conventional  level, 
they  adopted  the  position  of  a  caring,  maternal  person  as  defined  by  others 
and  society  at  large.  At  the  postconventional  level,  they  formed  their  own 
insights  based  on  their  cumulative  knowledge  of  human  relationships 
(Gilligan,  1982,  p.  74). 

Throughout  women's  discussions,  Gilligan  says,  we  hear  a  concern  for 
what  is  "selfish"  and  what  is  "responsible."  At  the  first  level  there  is  an  empha¬ 
sis  on  the  self,  which  at  the  conventional  level  shifts  toward  socially  defined 
responsibility  toward  others.  At  the  postconventional  level,  women  develop 


177 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


insights  into  ways  the  self  and  others  are  actually  interdependent.  As  a  woman 
called  Claire  put  it. 

By  yourself,  there  is  little  sense  to  things.  It  is  like  the  sound  of  one  hand 
clapping,  the  sound  of  one  man  or  one  woman,  there  is  something  lack¬ 
ing.  . . .  You  have  to  love  someone  else,  because  while  you  may  not  like 
them,  you  are  inseparable  from  them.  In  a  way,  it  is  like  loving  your 
right  hand.  They  are  part  of  you.  (1982,  p.  160,  emphasis  in  original) 

Eva  Skoe  and  her  colleagues  (Skoe  &  von  der  Lippe,  1998;  Pratt  et  al., 
2004)  have  begun  more  systematic  studies  of  developmental  changes  in  the 
care  orientation.  These  investigators  have  created  a  standard  interview  (which 
partly  allows  respondents  to  talk  about  real-life  dilemmas  of  their  own  choos¬ 
ing)  and  have  developed  a  formal  scoring  system.  Focusing  on  adolescents  and 
young  adults,  the  researchers  have  basically  found  developmental  changes 
similar  to  those  outlined  by  Gilligan.  There  is  sometimes  a  slight  tendency  for 
females  to  score  higher  than  males.  The  researchers  have  not,  however,  come 
across  individuals  who  articulate  human  interrelatedness  with  the  eloquence 
of  Claire  in  Gilligan's  study  (quoted  above).  Perhaps  such  insightful  responses 
appear  with  more  frequency  in  later  adulthood. 

It  would  be  interesting  to  know  if  Claire  and  those  who  think  like  her 
extend  their  view  of  interrelatedness  beyond  humans  and  include  all  life.  If 
so,  they  may  have  attained  a  wisdom  associated  with  non- Western  cultures, 
and  Gilligan's  care  orientation  may  provide  a  developmental  pathway  toward 
this  wisdom. 


IMPLICATIONS  FOR  EDUCATION 

Kohlberg  wanted  to  see  people  advance  to  the  highest  possible  stage  of  moral 
thought.  The  best  possible  society  would  contain  individuals  who  not  only 
understand  the  need  for  social  order  (stage  4)  but  can  entertain  visions  of  uni¬ 
versal  principles,  such  as  justice  and  liberty  (stage  6)  (Kohlberg,  1970). 

How,  then,  can  we  promote  moral  development?  Turiel  (1966)  found 
that  when  children  listened  to  adults'  moral  judgments,  the  resulting  change 
was  slight.  This  is  what  Kohlberg  might  have  expected,  for  he  believed  if  chil¬ 
dren  are  to  reorganize  their  thinking,  they  must  be  more  active. 

Accordingly,  Kohlberg  encouraged  another  student,  Moshe  Blatt,  to 
lead  discussion  groups  in  which  children  had  a  chance  to  grapple  actively 
with  moral  issues  (Blatt  &  Kohlberg,  1975).  Blatt  presented  moral  dilemmas 
that  engaged  sixth-graders  in  a  good  deal  of  heated  debate.  He  tried  to  leave 
much  of  the  discussions  to  the  children  themselves,  stepping  in  only  to  sum¬ 
marize,  clarify,  and  sometimes  present  a  view  himself  (p.  133).  He  encour¬ 
aged  arguments  that  were  one  stage  above  those  of  most  of  the  class.  In 


178 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


general,  he  tried  to  implement  one  of  Kohlberg's  main  ideas  on  how  children 
move  through  the  stages.  They  do  so  by  encountering  views  that  challenge 
their  thinking  and  stimulate  them  to  formulate  better  arguments  (Kohlberg 
et  al.,  1975). 

Blatt  began  a  typical  discussion  by  telling  a  story  about  a  man  named 
Mr.  Jones  who  had  a  seriously  injured  son  and  wanted  to  rush  him  to  the 
hospital.  Mr.  Jones  had  no  car,  so  he  approached  a  stranger,  told  him  about 
the  situation,  and  asked  to  borrow  his  car.  The  stranger,  however,  refused,  say¬ 
ing  he  had  an  important  appointment  to  keep.  So  Mr.  Jones  took  the  car  by 
force.  Blatt  then  asked  whether  Mr.  Jones  should  have  done  that. 

In  the  discussion  that  followed,  one  child,  Student  B,  felt  Mr.  Jones  had 
a  good  cause  for  taking  the  car  and  also  believed  the  stranger  could  be  charged 
with  murder  if  the  son  died.  Student  C  pointed  out  that  the  stranger  violated 
no  law.  Student  B  still  felt  the  stranger's  behavior  was  somehow  wrong,  even 
though  he  now  realized  it  was  not  legally  wrong.  So  Student  B  was  in  a  kind 
of  conflict.  He  had  a  sense  of  the  wrongness  of  the  stranger's  behavior,  but  he 
could  not  articulate  this  sense  in  terms  that  would  meet  the  objection.  He  was 
challenged  to  think  about  the  problem  more  deeply. 

In  the  end,  Blatt  gave  him  the  answer.  The  stranger's  behavior,  Blatt  said, 
was  not  legally  wrong,  but  morally  wrong — wrong  according  to  God's  law 
(this  was  a  Sunday  School  class).  At  this  point,  Blatt  was  an  authority  teach¬ 
ing  the  "correct"  view.  In  so  doing,  he  might  have  robbed  Student  B  of  the 
chance  to  formulate  spontaneously  his  own  position.  Blatt  would  have  done 
better  to  ask  a  question  or  to  simply  clarify  the  student's  conflict  (e.g.,  "So  it's 
not  legally  wrong,  but  you  still  have  a  sense  that  it's  somehow  wrong  .  .  ."). 
In  any  case,  it  seems  clear  that  part  of  this  discussion  was  valuable  for  this 
student. 

The  Kohlberg-Blatt  method  of  inducing  cognitive  conflict  exemplifies 
Piaget's  equilibration  model.  The  child  takes  one  view,  becomes  confused  by 
discrepant  information,  and  then  resolves  the  confusion  by  forming  a  more 
advanced  and  comprehensive  position.  The  method  is  also  the  dialectic 
process  of  Socratic  teaching.  The  students  give  a  view,  the  teacher  asks  ques¬ 
tions  that  get  them  to  see  the  inadequacies  of  their  views,  and  they  are  then 
motivated  to  formulate  better  positions. 

In  Blatt's  first  experiment,  the  students  (sixth-graders)  participated  in 
12  weekly  discussion  groups.  Blatt  found  that  over  half  the  students  moved 
up  one  full  stage  after  the  12  weeks.  Blatt  and  others  have  tried  to  replicate 
these  findings,  sometimes  using  other  age  groups  and  lengthier  series  of 
classes.  As  often  happens  with  replications,  the  results  have  not  been  quite  so 
successful;  upward  changes  have  been  smaller — usually  a  third  of  a  stage  or 
less.  Still,  it  generally  seems  that  Socratic  classroom  discussions  held  over  sev¬ 
eral  months  can  produce  changes  that,  although  small,  are  significantly  greater 
than  those  found  in  control  groups  that  do  not  receive  these  experiences 
(Rest,  1983). 


179 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


One  of  Blatt's  supplementary  findings  was  that  those  students  who 
reported  they  were  most  "interested"  in  the  discussions  made  the  greatest 
amount  of  change.  This  finding  is  in  keeping  with  Piagetian  theory.  Children 
develop  not  because  they  are  shaped  through  external  reinforcements  but 
because  their  curiosity  is  aroused.  They  become  interested  in  information  that 
does  not  quite  fit  into  their  existing  cognitive  structures  and  are  thereby  moti¬ 
vated  to  revise  their  thinking.  Other  investigators  (Berkowitz  &  Gibbs,  1985) 
have  examined  actual  dialogues  to  see  if  those  who  become  most  challenged 
and  involved  in  the  tensions  of  moral  debates  are  also  those  who  move  for¬ 
ward.  The  evidence  suggests  this  is  the  case. 

Although  Kohlberg  was  committed  to  the  cognitive-conflict  model  of 
change,  he  also  developed  another  strategy — the  just  community  approach. 
Here,  the  focus  is  not  on  individuals  but  on  groups.  Kohlberg  and  some  of 
his  colleagues  (Power  &  Reimer,  1979)  set  up  a  special  high  school  group  of 
about  180  students  and  encouraged  them  to  function  as  a  democracy  and  to 
think  of  themselves  as  a  community.  Initially,  little  community  feeling  was 
present.  The  group's  dominant  orientation  was  stage  2;  it  treated  problems 
such  as  stealing  as  purely  individual  matters.  If  a  boy  had  something  stolen, 
it  was  too  bad  for  him.  After  a  year,  however,  the  group  norms  advanced  to 
stage  3;  the  students  now  considered  stealing  to  be  a  community  issue  that 
reflected  on  the  degree  of  trust  and  care  in  the  group.  As  a  result,  stealing  and 
other  behavior  problems  sharply  declined  and  the  students  began  helping 
one  another  in  many  ways.  Similar  projects  have  produced  similar  results 
(Power,  Higgins,  &  Kohlberg,  1989). 

The  just  community  approach  has  troubled  some  of  Kohlberg's  follow¬ 
ers.  Although  the  students  are  encouraged  to  participate  in  a  good  deal  of 
democratic  decision  making,  the  adults  in  the  program  actively  state  their 
own  positions.  When  Kohlberg  participated,  he  forcefully  urged  the  students 
to  form  a  true  community.  Reimer,  Paolitto,  and  Hersh  (1983)  wondered  if  the 
adults  were  not  practicing  indoctrination.  After  discussing  the  matter  with 
Kohlberg,  they  seemed  reassured  that  Kohlberg  hadn't  abandoned  his  belief 
in  students'  need  to  think  for  themselves  (p.  251),  but  there  are  still  grounds 
for  some  uneasiness.  In  his  last  years,  Kohlberg  may  have  departed  some¬ 
what  from  his  basic  commitment  to  independent  thinking. 

Although  the  just  community  approach  focuses  on  the  moral  orienta¬ 
tions  of  groups,  researchers  have  wondered  if  the  programs  produce  changes 
in  individuals.  Power,  Higgins,  and  Kohlberg  (1989)  found  that  students  who 
participated  in  the  programs  for  2  or  3  years,  compared  to  similar  students  in 
ordinary  high  schools,  showed  greater  advances  in  their  moral  judgment 
scores,  but  their  progress  was  still  modest.  Most  advanced  from  stage  2  to 
stage  3.  The  researchers  advise  those  who  primarily  want  to  promote  moral 
development  in  individuals  to  concentrate  on  academic  discussions  of  hypo¬ 
thetical  moral  dilemmas.  This  intervention  is  easier  than  trying  to  change  an 
entire  group. 


180 


Kohlberg's  Stages  of  Moral  Development 


EVALUATION 

Kohlberg,  a  follower  of  Piaget,  offered  a  new,  more  detailed  stage  sequence  for 
moral  thinking.  Piaget  basically  found  two  stages  of  moral  thinking,  the  sec¬ 
ond  of  which  emerges  in  early  adolescence;  Kohlberg  uncovered  additional 
stages  that  develop  well  into  adolescence  and  adulthood.  He  suggested  that 
some  people  even  reach  a  postconventional  level  of  moral  thinking  where 
they  no  longer  accept  their  own  society  as  given  but  think  reflectively  and 
autonomously  about  what  a  good  society  should  be. 

The  suggestion  of  a  postconventional  morality  is  unusual  in  the  social 
sciences.  Perhaps  it  took  a  cognitive-developmentalist  to  suggest  such  a  thing. 
Whereas  most  social  scientists  have  been  impressed  by  the  ways  in  which 
societies  mold  and  shape  children's  thinking,  cognitive-developmentalists  are 
more  impressed  by  the  capacities  for  independent  thought.  If  children  engage 
in  enough  independent  thinking,  Kohlberg  suggested,  they  will  eventually 
begin  to  formulate  conceptions  of  rights,  values,  and  principles  by  which  they 
evaluate  existing  social  arrangements. 

Kohlberg's  theory  has  provoked  sharp  criticism.  We  have  reviewed  Gilli- 
gan's  view  that  it  is  male-oriented,  as  well  as  the  cultural  critique  that 
Kohlberg's  theory  contains  a  Western  bias.  Both  critiques  point  out  that 
Kohlberg  worked  in  a  Kantian  tradition  that  emphasizes  abstract  rights  and 
principles  of  justice  rather  than  interconnectedness,  a  sense  of  unity  with  oth¬ 
ers  or  with  all  of  life.  I  believe  these  critiques  have  merit. 

All  the  same,  we  shouldn't  minimize  the  Kantian  philosophical  tradi¬ 
tion  in  which  Kohlberg  worked.  As  Broughton  (1983)  argues,  this  morality  of 
justice  has  inspired  battles  against  repressive  state  power  that  other  ethical 
orientations  seem  less  equipped  to  handle.  Gilligan's  ethic  of  care  seems  to  nat¬ 
urally  focus  on  the  interpersonal  relationships  of  daily  life,  not  the  powerful 
legal  system  that  Martin  Luther  King  challenged  in  the  name  of  justice.  Sim¬ 
ilarly,  as  Albert  Schweitzer  (1929,  pp.  302-304)  observed,  the  Eastern  con¬ 
sciousness  of  the  unity  of  life  is  more  contemplative  than  action  oriented.  In 
the  pursuit  of  an  abstract  principle  of  justice,  King  acted. 

Kohlberg  gave  us  a  picture  of  how  children,  through  their  own  thinking, 
might  work  their  way  toward  such  principled  positions.  Few,  to  be  sure,  will 
grapple  with  moral  issues  so  long  and  intently  that  they  will  come  to  think 
about  them  in  the  manner  of  Kant,  Socrates,  Gandhi,  and  King.  But  Kohlberg's 
stages  provide  us  with  an  inspiring  vision  of  where  moral  development  might 
lead. 


181 


This  page  intentionally  left  blank 


Learning  Theory: 
Pavlov,  Watson, 
and  Skinner 


From  Theories  of  Development:  Concepts  and  Applications,  Sixth  Edition.  William 
Crain.  Copyright  ©  2011  by  Pearson  Education,  Inc.  Published  by  Pearson 
Prentice  Hall.  All  rights  reserved. 


183 


Learning  Theory: 
Pavlov,  Watson, 
and  Skinner 


Theorists  in  the  developmental  tradition  believe  that  key  develop¬ 
ments  are  governed  by  internal  forces — by  biological  maturation  or 
by  the  individual's  own  structuring  of  experience.  In  this  chapter,  we 
will  describe  the  work  of  some  of  the  theorists  in  the  opposing, 
Lockean  tradition — learning  theorists  who  emphasize  the  processes 
by  which  behavior  is  formed  from  the  outside,  by  the  external 
environment. 


PAVLOV  AND  CLASSICAL 
CONDITIONING 

Biographical  Introduction 

The  father  of  modern  learning  theory  is  Ivan  Petrovich  Pavlov 
(1849-1936).  Pavlov  was  bom  in  Ryazan,  Russia,  the  son  of  a  poor  village 
priest.  Pavlov  himself  planned  to  become  a  priest  until  the  age  of  21,  when 
he  decided  he  was  more  interested  in  a  scientific  career.  For  many  years 
he  devoted  his  attention  to  physiological  investigations,  and  in  1904  he 
won  the  Nobel  Prize  for  his  work  on  the  digestive  system.  It  was  just  a 
little  before  this  time,  when  Pavlov  was  50  years  old,  that  he  began  his 
famous  work  on  conditioned  reflexes.  This  new  interest  came  about 
through  an  accidental  discovery  about  the  nature  of  salivation  in  dogs. 
Ordinarily  dogs  salivate  when  food  touches  their  tongues;  this  is  an  innate 
reflex.  But  Pavlov  noticed  that  his  dogs  also  salivated  before  the  food  was 
in  their  mouths;  they  salivated  when  they  saw  the  food  coming,  or  even 
when  they  heard  approaching  footsteps.  What  had  happened  was  that  the 
reflex  had  become  conditioned  to  new,  formerly  neutral  stimuli. 

For  a  while  Pavlov  could  not  decide  whether  to  pursue  the  impli¬ 
cations  of  his  new  discovery  or  to  continue  with  his  earlier  research. 
Finally,  after  a  long  struggle  with  himself,  he  began  studying  the 


184 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


conditioning  process.  Still,  Pavlov  believed  that  he  was  working  as  a  physi¬ 
ologist,  not  a  psychologist.  In  fact,  Pavlov  required  that  everyone  in  his  labo¬ 
ratory  use  only  physiological  terms.  If  his  assistants  were  caught  using 
psychological  language — referring,  for  example,  to  a  dog's  feelings  or 
knowledge — they  were  fined  (R.  Watson,  1968,  pp.  408-412). 


Basic  Concepts 

The  Classical  Conditioning  Paradigm.  In  a  typical  experiment 
(Pavlov,  1928,  p.  104),  a  dog  was  placed  in  a  restraining  harness  in  a  dark  room 
and  a  light  was  turned  on.  After  30  seconds  some  food  was  placed  in  the  dog's 
mouth,  eliciting  the  salivation  reflex.  This  procedure  was  repeated  several 
times — each  time  the  presentation  of  food  was  paired  with  the  light.  After  a 
while  the  light,  which  initially  had  no  relationship  to  salivation,  elicited  the 
response  by  itself.  The  dog  had  been  conditioned  to  respond  to  the  light. 

In  Pavlov's  terms  (1927,  lectures  2  and  3),  the  presentation  of  food  was 
an  unconditioned  stimulus  (US);  Pavlov  did  not  need  to  condition  the  animal  to 
salivate  to  the  food.  The  light,  in  contrast,  was  a  conditioned  stimulus  (CS);  its 
effect  required  conditioning.1  Salivation  to  the  food  was  called  an  unconditioned 
reflex  (UR),  and  salivation  to  the  light  was  called  a  conditioned  reflex  (CR).  The 
process  itself  is  called  classical  conditioning. 

You  might  have  noticed  in  this  experiment  that  the  CS  appeared  before 
the  US;  Pavlov  turned  on  the  light  before  he  presented  the  food.  One  of  the 
questions  he  asked  was  whether  this  is  the  best  order  for  establishing  condi¬ 
tioning.  He  and  his  students  discovered  that  it  is.  It  is  very  difficult  to  obtain 
conditioning  when  the  CS  follows  the  US  (1927,  pp.  27-28).  Other  studies  have 
suggested  that  conditioning  often  occurs  most  rapidly  when  the  CS  is  pre¬ 
sented  about  one-half  second  prior  to  the  US  (see  Schwartz,  1989,  p.  83). 

Pavlov  discovered  several  other  principles  of  conditioning,  some  of 
which  we  will  briefly  describe. 

Extinction.  A  conditioned  stimulus,  once  established,  does  not  con¬ 
tinue  to  work  forever.  Pavlov  found  that  even  though  he  could  make  a  light 
a  CS  for  salivation,  if  he  flashed  the  light  alone  over  several  trials,  it  began  to 
lose  its  effect.  Drops  of  saliva  became  fewer  and  fewer  until  there  were  none 
at  all.  At  this  point,  extinction  had  occurred  (Pavlov,  1928,  p.  297). 

Pavlov  also  discovered  that  although  a  conditioned  reflex  appears  to  be 
extinguished,  it  usually  shows  some  spontaneous  recovery.  In  one  experiment 
(Pavlov,  1927,  p.  58),  a  dog  was  trained  to  salivate  to  the  mere  sight  of  food — 
the  CS.  (Previously,  the  dog  would  salivate  only  when  food  was  in  its  mouth.) 
Next,  the  CS  alone  was  presented  at  3-minute  intervals  for  six  trials,  and  by 


'Pavlov  actually  used  the  terms  conditional  and  unconditional:  they  were  translated 
conditioned  and  unconditioned,  the  terms  psychologists  now  generally  use. 


185 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


the  sixth  trial,  the  dog  no  longer  salivated.  The  response  appeared  to  have 
been  extinguished.  But,  after  a  2-hour  break  in  the  experiment,  the  presenta¬ 
tion  of  the  CS  alone  once  again  produced  a  moderate  amount  of  salivation. 
Thus  the  response  showed  some  spontaneous  recovery.  If  one  were  to  con¬ 
tinue  to  extinguish  the  response,  without  periodically  repairing  the  CS  to  the 
US,  the  spontaneous  recovery  effect  would  also  disappear. 

Stimulus  Generalization.  Although  a  reflex  has  been  conditioned  to 
only  one  stimulus,  it  is  not  just  that  particular  stimulus  that  elicits  it.  The 
response  seems  to  generalize  over  a  range  of  similar  stimuli  without  any  fur¬ 
ther  conditioning  (Pavlov,  1928,  p.  157).  For  example,  a  dog  that  has  been  con¬ 
ditioned  to  salivate  to  a  bell  of  a  certain  tone  will  also  salivate  to  bells  of 
differing  tones.  The  ability  of  the  neighboring  stimuli  to  produce  the  response 
varies  with  the  degree  of  similarity  to  the  original  CS.  Pavlov  believed  that  we 
observe  stimulus  generalization  because  of  an  underlying  physiological  process 
he  called  irradiation.  The  initial  stimulus  excites  a  certain  part  of  the  brain  that 
then  irradiates,  or  spreads,  over  other  regions  of  the  cerebrum  (p.  157). 

Discrimination.  Initial  generalization  gradually  gives  way  to  a  process 
of  differentiation.  If  one  continues  to  ring  bells  of  different  tones  (without  pre¬ 
senting  food),  the  dog  begins  to  respond  more  selectively,  restricting  its 
responses  to  the  tones  that  most  closely  resemble  the  original  CS.  One  can 
also  actively  produce  differentiation  by  pairing  one  tone  with  food  while  pre¬ 
senting  another  tone  without  food.  This  would  be  called  an  experiment  in 
stimulus  discrimination  (Pavlov,  1927,  pp.  118-130). 

Higher-Order  Conditioning.  Pavlov  showed,  finally,  that  once  he  had 
solidly  conditioned  a  dog  to  a  CS,  he  could  then  use  the  CS  alone  to  establish 
a  connection  to  yet  another  neutral  stimulus.  In  one  experiment,  Pavlov's  stu¬ 
dent  trained  a  dog  to  salivate  to  a  bell  and  then  paired  the  bell  alone  with  a 
black  square.  After  a  number  of  trials,  the  black  square  alone  produced  sali¬ 
vation.  This  is  called  second-order  conditioning.  Pavlov  found  that  in  some  cases 
he  could  also  establish  third-order  conditioning,  but  he  could  not  go  beyond 
this  point  (p.  34). 

Evaluation 

In  a  sense,  Pavlov's  basic  idea  was  not  new.  In  the  17th  century,  Locke  had  pro¬ 
posed  that  knowledge  is  based  on  associations.  Pavlov  went  beyond  Locke, 
however,  and  uncovered  several  principles  of  association  through  empirical 
experiments.  He  took  the  theory  of  learning  out  of  the  realm  of  pure  specu¬ 
lation.  Pavlov,  as  we  shall  see,  did  not  discover  everything  there  is  to  know 
about  conditioning;  in  particular,  his  brand  of  conditioning  seems  restricted 
to  a  certain  range  of  innate  responses.  Nevertheless,  he  was  the  first  to  put 
learning  theory  on  a  firm  scientific  footing. 


186 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


WATSON 

Biographical  Introduction 

The  man  most  responsible  for  making  Pavlovian  principles  a  part  of  the  psy¬ 
chological  mainstream  was  John  B.  Watson  (1878-1958).  Watson  was  born  on 
a  farm  near  Greenville,  South  Carolina.  He  said  that  in  school  "I  was  lazy, 
somewhat  insubordinate,  and  so  far  as  I  know,  I  never  made  above  a  passing 
grade"  (Watson,  1936,  p.  271).  Nevertheless,  he  went  to  college  at  Furman 
University  and  graduate  school  at  the  University  of  Chicago,  where  he  began 
doing  psychological  research  with  animals.  After  earning  his  doctorate,  he 
took  a  position  at  Johns  Hopkins  University  in  Baltimore,  where  he  did  his 
most  productive  work. 

In  1913  Watson  made  a  great  impact  on  psychology  by  issuing  a  mani¬ 
festo,  "Psychology  as  the  Behaviorist  Views  It."  In  this  article  he  argued  that 
the  study  of  consciousness  through  introspection  has  no  place  in  psychology 
as  a  science.  Psychology  should  abandon  "the  terms  consciousness,  mental 
states,  mind,  content,  introspectively  verifiable,  imagery  and  the  like"  (Wat¬ 
son,  1913,  p.  166).  Instead,  its  goal  should  be  "the  prediction  and  control  of 
behavior"  (p.  158).  In  particular,  it  should  study  only  stimuli,  responses,  and 
the  formation  of  habits.  In  this  way  psychology  could  become  a  science  like 
the  other  natural  sciences. 

A  year  later  he  read  the  works  of  Pavlov  and  the  Russians  on  condi¬ 
tioned  reflexes  and  made  Pavlovian  conditioning  the  cornerstone  of  his  think¬ 
ing.  Then,  in  1916,  Watson  began  research  on  young  children,  becoming  the 
first  major  psychologist  to  apply  principles  of  learning  to  the  problems  of 
development. 

In  1929  Watson's  academic  career  came  to  an  abrupt  end.  His  divorce 
from  his  wife  became  so  widely  and  sensationally  publicized  that  Johns  Hop¬ 
kins  fired  him.  Watson  remarried  (Rosalie  Raynor,  a  coworker)  and  entered  the 
business  world.  In  order  to  get  a  good  sense  of  business,  he  worked  for  a  while 
as  a  coffee  salesman  and  a  clerk  at  Macy's  department  store.  He  continued  to 
write,  but  now  for  magazines  such  as  Cosmopolitan,  Harper's,  and  McCall's,  in 
which  he  advanced  his  ideas  on  child  development. 


Basic  Concepts 

Environmentalism.  Watson  was  a  behaviorist;  he  said  we  should 
study  only  overt  behavior.  He  also  was  an  environmentalist  and  made  this 
famous  proposal: 

Give  me  a  dozen  healthy  infants,  well-formed,  and  my  own  specified 
world  to  bring  them  up  in  and  I'll  guarantee  to  take  any  one  at  random 
and  train  him  to  become  any  type  of  specialist  I  might  select — doctor. 


187 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


lawyer,  artist,  merchant,  chief,  and  yes,  even  begger-man  and  thief, 
regardless  of  his  talents,  penchants,  tendencies,  abilities,  vocations,  and 
race  of  his  ancestors.  (1924,  p.  104) 

In  the  next  sentence  Watson  added  that  "I  am  going  beyond  my  facts,  and 
I  admit  it,  but  so  have  the  advocates  of  the  contrary  and  they  have  been  doing 
it  for  many  thousands  of  years"  (p.  104). 

Study  of  Emotions.  One  of  Watson's  major  interests  was  the  condi¬ 
tioning  of  emotions.  He  claimed  that  at  birth  there  are  only  three  unlearned 
emotional  reactions — fear,  rage,  and  love.  Actually,  all  we  observe  are  three 
different  physical  responses,  but  for  the  sake  of  simplicity  we  can  call  them 
emotions. 

Fear,  Watson  said  (1924,  pp.  152-154),  is  observed  when  infants  suddenly 
jump  or  start,  breathe  rapidly,  clutch  their  hands,  close  their  eyes,  fall,  and 
cry.  There  are  only  two  unconditioned  stimuli  that  elicit  fear.  One  is  a  sudden 
noise;  the  other  is  loss  of  support  (as  when  the  baby's  head  is  dropped).  Yet 
older  children  are  afraid  of  all  kinds  of  things — strange  people,  rats,  dogs,  the 
dark,  and  so  on.  Therefore  it  must  be  that  the  stimuli  evoking  most  fear  reac¬ 
tions  are  learned.  For  example,  a  little  boy  is  afraid  of  snakes  because  he  was 
frightened  by  a  loud  scream  when  he  saw  one.  The  snake  became  a  condi¬ 
tioned  stimulus. 

Rage  is  initially  an  unlearned  response  to  the  restriction  of  body  move¬ 
ment.  If  we  grab  a  2-year-old  girl,  preventing  her  from  going  where  she 
wants,  she  begins  to  scream  and  stiffens  her  body.  She  lies  down  stiff  as  a 
rod  in  the  middle  of  the  street  and  yells  until  she  becomes  blue  in  the  face 
(p.  154).  Although  rage  is  initially  a  reaction  to  one  situation — being  forcibly 
held — it  later  is  expressed  in  a  variety  of  situations;  children  become  angry 
when  told  to  wash  their  faces,  sit  on  the  toilet,  get  undressed,  take  a  bath, 
and  so  on.  Such  commands  elicit  rage  because  they  have  been  associated 
with  physical  restraint  in  these  situations.  The  child  becomes  angry  when 
told  to  get  undressed  because  this  order  was  initially  associated  with  being 
forcibly  held. 

Love  is  initially  a  response  that  is  automatically  elicited  by  the  stroking 
of  the  skin,  tickling,  gentle  rocking,  and  patting.  The  baby  responds  by  smil¬ 
ing,  laughing,  gurgling  and  cooing,  and  other  responses  that  we  call  affec¬ 
tionate,  good  natured,  and  kindly.  Although  Watson  had  no  use  for  Freud,  he 
noted  that  such  responses  ''are  especially  easy  to  bring  about  by  the  stimula¬ 
tion  of  what,  for  lack  of  a  better  term,  we  may  call  the  erogenous  zones,  such 
as  the  nipples,  the  lips,  and  the  sex  organs"  (p.  155). 

Infants  initially  do  not  love  specific  people,  but  they  are  conditioned  to 
do  so.  The  mother's  face  frequently  appears  along  with  patting,  rocking,  and 
stroking,  so  it  becomes  a  conditioned  stimulus  that  alone  elicits  the  good  feel¬ 
ings  toward  her.  Later,  other  people  associated  with  the  mother  in  some  way 


188 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


also  elicit  the  same  responses.  Thus  tender  or  positive  feelings  toward  others 
are  learned  through  second-order  conditioning. 

Actually,  much  of  Watson's  writing  on  the  emotions  was  speculation — 
and  vague  speculation  at  that.  He  said  the  three  basic  emotions  become 
attached  to  a  variety  of  stimuli  and  "we  get  marked  additions  to  the  responses 
and  other  modifications  of  them"  (p.  165),  but  he  said  little  about  how  these 
further  developments  occur.  Where  Watson  did  become  specific  was  in  his 
experimental  work.  His  major  experiment  was  on  the  conditioning  of  fear  in 
an  11-month-old  infant  he  called  Albert  B. 

Conditioning  Fear  in  Little  Albert.  Watson  and  Raynor  (Watson,  1924, 
pp.  159-164)  wanted  to  see  if  they  could  condition  Albert  to  fear  a  white  rat. 
At  the  beginning  of  the  experiment  Albert  showed  no  such  fear.  Next,  the 
experimenter  on  four  occasions  presented  the  rat  and  simultaneously  pounded 
a  bar  behind  Albert's  head,  producing  a  startle  response.  On  the  fifth  trial 
Albert  was  shown  the  rat  alone,  and  he  puckered  his  face,  whimpered,  and 
withdrew.  He  had  been  conditioned  to  fear  the  rat.  For  good  measure,  the 
experimenter  combined  the  rat  and  the  pounding  twice  more,  and  on  the  next 
trial,  when  the  rat  was  again  presented  alone,  Albert  cried  and  tried  to  crawl 
away  as  rapidly  as  he  could. 

A  few  days  later,  Watson  and  Raynor  tested  for  stimulus  generalization. 
They  found  that  although  Albert  played  with  many  objects,  he  feared  any¬ 
thing  furry.  He  cried  or  fretted  whenever  he  saw  a  rabbit,  dog,  fur  coat,  cot¬ 
ton  wool,  or  a  Santa  Claus  mask,  even  though  he  previously  had  not  been 
afraid  of  these  things.  Albert's  fear  had  generalized  to  all  furry  objects. 

Practical  Applications.  One  of  Watson's  major  practical  innovations 
was  a  method  for  deconditioning  fears.  He  was  not  able  to  decondition  Albert 
of  his  new  fears,  because  Albert  was  an  orphan  who  was  adopted  and  taken 
out  of  town  before  this  could  be  attempted.  But  Watson  advised  one  of  his 
colleagues,  Mary  Cover  Jones,  on  procedures  for  eliminating  the  fears  of 
another  little  boy,  a  3-year-old  called  Peter. 

Peter  seemed  active  and  healthy  in  every  respect  except  for  his  fears.  He 
was  scared  of  white  rats,  rabbits,  fur  coats,  feathers,  cotton  wool,  frogs,  fish, 
and  mechanical  toys.  As  Watson  noted,  "One  might  well  think  that  Peter  was 
merely  Albert  B.  grown  up,  but  Peter  was  a  different  child  whose  fears  were 
'home  grown'"  (1924,  p.  173). 

Jones  tried  a  variety  of  methods,  including  having  Peter  watch  other 
children  play  with  a  rabbit.  But  the  procedure  that  she  and  Watson  highlighted 
was  the  following.  Peter  was  placed  in  his  highchair  and  given  a  midafter¬ 
noon  snack.  Then  a  caged  white  rabbit  was  displayed  at  a  distance  that  did  not 
disturb  him.  The  next  day,  the  rabbit  was  brought  increasingly  closer,  until 
he  showed  a  slight  disturbance.  That  ended  the  day's  treatment.  The  same 
thing  was  done  day  after  day;  the  rabbit  was  brought  closer  and  closer,  with 


189 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


the  experimenter  taking  care  never  to  disturb  Peter  very  much.  Finally,  Peter 
was  able  to  eat  with  one  hand  while  playing  with  the  rabbit  with  the  other.  By 
similar  means,  Jones  eliminated  most  of  Peter's  other  fears  as  well. 

Jones's  technique,  although  anticipated  by  Locke,  was  quite  innovative 
at  the  time.  It  is  today  known  as  a  form  of  belwvior  modification  called  systematic 
desensitization  (see  Wolpe,  1969).  The  subject  is  relaxed  and  gradually  intro¬ 
duced  to  the  feared  stimulus.  The  experimenter  makes  sure  that  the  subject  is 
at  no  time  made  to  feel  too  anxious.  Gradually,  then,  the  subject  learns  to  asso¬ 
ciate  relaxed  feelings,  rather  than  fear,  to  the  object  or  situation. 

Watson  did  not  confine  his  advice  to  therapeutic  procedures  for  elimi¬ 
nating  fears.  He  also  had  much  to  say  on  child  rearing,  which  he  wanted  to 
turn  into  a  scientific  enterprise.  Watson  recommended,  among  other  things, 
that  parents  place  babies  on  rigid  schedules,  and  he  insisted  they  refrain  from 
hugging,  kissing,  or  caressing  their  babies.  For  when  they  do  so,  their  chil¬ 
dren  soon  associate  the  very  sight  of  the  parent  with  indulgent  responses  and 
never  learn  to  turn  away  from  the  parent  and  explore  the  world  on  their  own 
(Watson,  1928,  p.  81).  Watson's  advice  was  quite  influential  in  the  1930s,  but 
it  was  too  extreme  to  last.  Under  the  influence  of  Spock,  Bowlby,  and  others, 
parents  relaxed  their  schedules  and  became  more  affectionate  with  their  chil¬ 
dren.  Nevertheless,  Watson's  more  general  goal — that  of  placing  child  train¬ 
ing  on  the  firm  foundation  of  scientific  learning  principles — remains  a  vital 
part  of  child  care  in  the  United  States. 


Evaluation 

Largely  because  of  Watson's  efforts,  the  classical  conditioning  paradigm 
became  a  cornerstone  of  psychological  theory.  It  would  seem  that  many  of 
our  reactions  to  objects  and  people  develop  through  this  conditioning  process 
(see  Liebert  et  al.,  1977). 

At  the  same  time,  we  need  to  note  that  the  model  has  certain  limitations. 
For  one  thing,  researchers  have  found  it  much  more  difficult  to  condition 
infants'  responses  than  Watson  implied.  This  seems  particularly  true  during 
the  first  month  of  life  (Lamb  &  Campos,  1982;  Sameroff  &  Cavanaugh,  1979). 
Perhaps  classical  conditioning  becomes  easier  once  infants  have  developed 
what  Piaget  calls  primary  circular  reactions.  Once  they  can  coordinate  senso¬ 
rimotor  actions  (e.g.,  look  at  what  they  hear),  they  might  more  readily  learn 
to  make  various  associations. 

There  also  seem  to  be  limitations  to  the  kinds  of  conditioned  stimuli 
humans  will  learn.  When,  for  example,  researchers  attempted  to  classically 
condition  infants  to  fear  objects  such  as  curtains  and  wooden  blocks  instead 
of  rats,  they  had  great  difficulty.  Perhaps  humans  are  innately  disposed  to 
fear  certain  stimuli.  There  may  be  biological  constraints  on  the  kinds  of 
stimuli  we  will  associate  with  different  responses  (Harris  &  Liebert,  1984, 
pp.  108-109;  Seligman,  1972). 


190 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


From  a  learning  theory  perspective,  finally,  classical  conditioning  seems 
limited  to  certain  kinds  of  responses.  It  seems  to  apply  best  to  the  conditioning 
of  reflexes  and  innate  responses  (which  may  include  many  emotional  reactions). 
It  is  questionable  whether  this  kind  of  conditioning  can  also  explain  how  we 
learn  such  active  and  complex  skills  as  talking,  using  tools,  dancing,  or  playing 
chess.  When  we  master  such  skills,  we  are  not  limited  to  inborn  reactions  to 
stimuli,  but  we  engage  in  a  great  deal  of  free,  trial-and-error  behavior,  finding 
out  what  works  best.  Accordingly,  learning  theorists  have  developed  other  mod¬ 
els  of  conditioning,  the  most  influential  of  which  is  that  of  B.  F.  Skinner. 


SKINNER  AND  OPERANT  CONDITIONING 
Biographical  Introduction 

B.  F.  Skinner  (1905-1990)  grew  up  in  the  small  town  of  Susquehanna,  Penn¬ 
sylvania.  As  a  boy,  he  liked  school  and  enjoyed  building  things  such  as  sleds, 
rafts,  and  wagons.  He  also  wrote  stories  and  poetry.  After  graduating  from 
high  school,  he  went  to  Hamilton  College  in  New  York.  There,  he  felt  some¬ 
what  out  of  place,  but  he  graduated  Phi  Beta  Kappa  with  a  major  in  English 
literature. 

Skinner  spent  the  next  two  years  trying  to  become  a  writer,  but  he  even¬ 
tually  decided  that  he  could  not  succeed  because  "I  had  nothing  important  to 
say"  (1967,  p.  395).  Because  he  was  interested  in  human  and  animal  behavior, 
he  enrolled  in  the  graduate  psychology  department  at  Harvard,  where  he 
began  doing  research  and  formulating  his  ideas  on  learning.  Skinner  taught 
at  the  University  of  Minnesota  (1936-1945),  Indiana  University  (1945-1947), 
and  Harvard  University  (1947  until  his  death  in  1990). 

Despite  his  successful  career  as  a  scientist,  Skinner  never  completely 
abandoned  his  earlier  interests.  For  one  thing,  he  continued  to  display  his 
boyhood  enthusiasm  for  building  things.  When  his  first  child  was  born,  he 
decided  to  make  a  new,  improved  crib.  This  crib,  which  is  sometimes  called 
his  "baby  box,"  is  a  pleasantly  heated  place  that  does  away  with  the  necessity 
of  excessive  clothing  and  permits  freer  movement.  It  is  not,  as  is  sometimes 
thought,  an  apparatus  for  training  babies.  It  is  simply  a  more  comfortable  crib. 
Skinner's  literary  interests  also  reemerged.  In  1948  he  published  a  novel, 
Walden  Two,  which  describes  a  utopian  community  based  on  his  principles  of 
conditioning. 


The  Operant  Model 

Like  Watson,  Skinner  was  a  strict  behaviorist.  He  believed  psychology 
should  dispense  with  any  references  to  intangible  mental  states  (such  as 
goals,  desires,  or  purposes);  instead,  it  should  confine  itself  to  the  study  of 


191 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


overt  behavior.  Like  Watson,  in  addition,  Skinner  was  an  environmentalist; 
although  Skinner  recognized  that  organisms  enter  the  world  with  genetic 
endowments,  he  was  primarily  concerned  with  how  environments  control 
behavior. 

In  contrast  to  Watson,  however,  Skinner's  primary  model  of  condition¬ 
ing  was  not  Pavlovian.  The  responses  that  Pavlov  studied,  Skinner  said,  are 
best  thought  of  as  respondents.  These  are  responses  that  are  automatically 
"elicited"  by  known  stimuli.  For  example,  the  ingestion  of  food  automatically 
elicits  salivation,  and  a  loud  noise  automatically  elicits  a  startle  response.  Most 
respondents  are  probably  simple  reflexes. 

A  second  class  of  behavior,  which  most  interested  Skinner,  is  called 
operant.  In  operant  behavior,  the  animal  is  not  harnessed  in,  like  Pavlov's 
dogs,  but  moves  freely  about  and  "operates"  on  the  environment.  For  ex¬ 
ample,  in  early  experiments  by  Thorndike  (1905),  cats  in  a  puzzle  box  would 
sniff,  claw,  and  jump  about  until  they  hit  upon  the  response — pulling  a 
latch — that  enabled  them  to  get  food.  The  successful  response  would  then 
be  more  likely  to  recur.  In  such  cases,  we  cannot  always  identify  any  prior 
stimulus  that  automatically  elicits  the  responses.  Rather,  animals  emit 
responses,  some  of  which  become  more  likely  in  the  future  because  they 
have  led  to  favorable  consequences.  Behavior,  in  Skinner's  terms,  is  con¬ 
trolled  by  the  reinforcing  stimuli  that  follow  it  (Skinner,  1938,  pp.  20-21; 
1953,  pp.  65-66).  The  two  models,  respondent  and  operant,  are  diagrammed 
in  Figure  1. 

To  study  operant  conditioning,  Skinner  constructed  an  apparatus  that 
is  commonly  referred  to  as  a  "Skinner  box."  This  is  a  fairly  small  box  in 
which  an  animal  is  free  to  roam  about  (see  Figure  2).  At  one  end  there  is  a 
bar  (lever)  that,  when  pressed,  automatically  releases  water  or  a  pellet  of 
food.  The  animal,  such  as  a  rat,  at  first  pokes  around  until  she  eventually 
presses  the  bar,  and  then  she  gets  the  reward.  As  time  goes  on,  she  presses 
the  bar  more  frequently.  The  most  important  measure  of  learning,  for  Skin¬ 
ner,  is  the  rate  of  responding;  when  responses  are  reinforced,  their  rates  of 


Figure  1 

Respondent  and  operant  conditioning.  In  respon¬ 
dent  (Pavlovian)  conditioning,  stimuli  precede 
responses  and  automatically  elicit  them.  In  oper¬ 
ant  conditioning,  the  initial  stimuli  are  not  always 
known;  the  organism  simply  emits  responses  that 
are  controlled  by  reinforcing  stimuli  (SRs)  that 
follow. 


csv 

>» 

US - £:R 

Respondent  conditioning  Operant  conditioning 


192 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


Figure  2 

A  Skinner  box.  One  side  has  been  cut  away  to  show  the  part 
occupied  by  the  animal. 

(From  Skinner,  B.  F.,  The  Behavior  of  Organisms,  p.  49. 
Copyright  1 938,  renewed  1 966.  Reprinted  by  permission 
of  Prentice-Flail,  Inc.) 


occurrence  increase.  In  Skinner's  apparatus,  the  bar  presses  are  automat¬ 
ically  registered  on  a  graph,  so  the  experimenter  need  not  be  present  much 
of  the  time.  The  data  are  presented  as  a  learning  curve,  illustrated  in 
Figure  3. 

Skinner  believed  that  operant  behavior,  in  comparison  to  respondent 
behavior,  plays  a  much  greater  role  in  human  life.  When  we  brush  our  teeth, 
drive  a  car,  or  read  a  book,  our  behavior  is  not  automatically  elicited  by  a  spe¬ 
cific  stimulus.  The  mere  sight  of  a  book,  for  instance,  does  not  elicit  reading 
in  the  same  way  a  bright  light  automatically  elicits  an  eyeblink.  We  may  or 
may  not  read  the  book,  depending  on  the  consequences  that  have  followed  in 
the  past.  If  reading  books  has  brought  us  rewards,  such  as  high  grades,  we  are 
likely  to  engage  in  this  behavior.  Behavior  is  determined  by  its  consequences 
(Munn,  Fernald,  &  Fernald,  1974,  p.  208). 


Figure  3 

A  typical  learning  curve. 

(From  Skinner,  B.  F.  The  Behavior 
of  Organisms,  Copyright  1938. 
Renewed  1 966.  Reprinted  by 
permission  of  Prentice-Hall,  Inc.) 


193 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


Principles  of  Conditioning 

Reinforcement  and  Extinction.  Skinnerians  have  performed  numer¬ 
ous  experiments  showing  that  human  behavior,  beginning  in  infancy,  can  be 
controlled  by  reinforcing  stimuli.  For  example,  infants  increase  their  rates  of 
sucking  when  sucking  results  in  sweet,  as  opposed  to  nonsweet,  liquid  (Lipsitt, 
1975).  Similarly,  infants'  rates  of  smiling  and  vocalization  can  be  increased  if 
the  behavior  leads  to  rewards  such  as  the  experimenter's  smiles,  caresses,  and 
attention  (Brackbill,  1958;  Rheingold,  Gewirtz,  &  Ross,  1959). 

In  such  experiments,  one  is  dealing  with  different  kinds  of  reinforcers. 
Some  reinforcers,  such  as  food  or  the  removal  of  pain,  are  primary  reinforcers; 
they  have  "natural"  reinforcing  properties.  Other  reinforcing  stimuli,  such  as 
an  adult's  smiles,  praise,  or  attention,  are  probably  conditioned  reinforcers;  their 
effectiveness  stems  from  their  frequent  association  with  primary  reinforcers 
(Skinner,  1953,  p.  78). 

Operant  behavior,  like  respondent  behavior,  is  also  subject  to  extinction 
(p.  69).  For  example,  because  children  do  things  "just  to  get  attention''  (p.  78), 
one  can  extinguish  undesirable  behaviors,  such  as  excessive  crying  or  tem¬ 
per  tantrums,  by  consistently  withdrawing  one's  attention  whenever  they 
occur  (Etzel  &  Gewirtz,  1967;  Williams,  1959). 

Operant  behavior  that  has  apparently  been  extinguished  may  also  show 
spontaneous  recovery.  For  example,  a  little  boy  whose  temper  tantrums  had 
been  extinguished  through  the  withdrawal  of  attention  began  having  tantrums 
once  again  when  placed  in  a  new  situation  (Williams,  1959).  The  behavior  had 
to  be  extinguished  further. 

Immediacy  of  Reinforcement.  Skinner  (1953,  p.  101;  1959,  p.  133) 
found  he  could  initially  establish  responses  at  the  highest  rates  when  he  rein¬ 
forced  them  promptly.  A  rat  will  begin  pressing  a  bar  at  a  high  rate  only  if  she 
has  promptly  received  a  food  pellet  each  time  she  has  done  so.  As  Bijou  and 
Baer  (1961,  p.  44)  point  out,  this  principle  has  importance  for  child  rearing.  If 
a  father  shows  pleasure  immediately  after  his  son  brings  him  the  newspaper, 
the  boy  is  likely  to  repeat  the  behavior  the  next  evening.  If,  however,  the  father 
is  so  engrossed  in  something  else  that  he  delays  reinforcing  his  son's  behav¬ 
ior  for  a  few  minutes,  the  boy's  behavior  will  not  be  strengthened.  In  fact, 
what  gets  strengthened  is  the  boy's  behavior  at  the  moment  of  reinforcement. 
If  he  is  building  blocks  at  that  moment,  it  is  block-building,  not  newspaper- 
fetching,  that  gets  reinforced. 

Discriminative  Stimuli.  We  have  said  that  operant  conditioning  may 
be  described  without  any  reference  to  initiating  stimuli.  This  is  true,  but  it 
does  not  mean  such  stimuli  are  unimportant.  Stimuli  that  precede  responses 
may  gain  considerable  control  over  them. 

For  example,  Skinner  (1953,  pp.  107-108)  reinforced  a  pigeon  each  time 
she  stretched  her  neck.  At  this  point  Skinner  had  no  knowledge  of  any  initial 


194 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


stimulus;  he  simply  waited  for  the  pigeon  to  emit  the  response  and  then  rein¬ 
forced  it.  Next,  however,  he  reinforced  the  response  only  when  a  signal  light 
was  on.  After  a  few  trials,  the  pigeon  stretched  her  neck  much  more  frequently 
when  the  light  was  flashing  than  when  it  was  off.  The  flashing  light  had 
become  a  discriminative  stimulus.  The  light  controlled  the  behavior  because  it 
set  the  occasion  upon  which  the  behavior  was  likely  to  be  reinforced. 

Skinner  (pp.  108-109)  listed  numerous  examples  to  show  how  everyday 
behavior  becomes  attached  to  discriminative  stimuli.  In  an  orchard  in  which 
red  apples  are  sweet  and  all  others  are  sour,  redness  becomes  a  stimulus  that 
sets  the  occasion  upon  which  picking  and  eating  will  produce  favorable  out¬ 
comes.  Similarly,  we  learn  that  a  smile  is  an  occasion  upon  which  approach¬ 
ing  another  will  meet  with  a  positive  response.  When  others  frown,  the  same 
approach  meets  with  aversive  consequences,  such  as  rebuffs.  Insofar  as  this 
is  true,  the  facial  expressions  of  others  become  discriminative  stimuli  that  con¬ 
trol  the  likelihood  that  we  will  approach  them. 

Although  discriminative  stimuli  do  exert  considerable  control,  it  must  be 
emphasized  that  this  control  is  not  automatic,  as  in  the  case  of  respondent 
conditioning.  In  Pavlov's  experiments,  prior  stimuli  automatically  elicit 
responses;  in  operant  conditioning,  such  stimuli  only  make  responses  more 
likely. 


Generalization.  In  operant  conditioning,  as  in  respondent  condition¬ 
ing,  there  is  a  process  of  stimulus  generalization  (Skinner,  1953,  p.  132).  Sup¬ 
pose  a  little  girl  has  been  reinforced  for  saying  "Da  da"  at  the  sight  of  her 
father,  but  not  when  she  is  looking  at  her  mother  or  siblings.  The  father  has 
become  a  discriminative  stimulus.  It  is  not  unusual,  however,  to  find  the  girl 
saying  "Da  da"  when  she  sees  any  man  at  all,  such  as  strangers  on  the  street. 
The  stimulus  has  generalized.  Her  parents  must  now  teach  her  to  make  a  finer 
discrimination.  They  might  say,  "That's  right,"  when  she  utters  "Da  da"  in 
the  presence  of  her  father,  but  not  when  she  looks  at  any  other  man. 

Similarly,  we  can  observe  response  generalization.  It  has  been  shown,  for 
example,  that  when  children  are  reinforced  for  using  one  part  of  speech,  such 
as  plurals,  they  begin  uttering  new  plurals — even  though  they  haven't 
received  reinforcement  for  those  particular  words.  Reinforcement  influences 
not  only  particular  responses  but  those  of  the  same  general  class  (Lovaas, 
1977,  pp.  112-113). 

Shaping.  Operant  behavior  is  not  acquired  in  all-or-nothing  packages. 
It  is  usually  learned  gradually,  little  by  little.  Even  teaching  a  pigeon  to  peck 
a  spot  on  the  wall,  Skinner  (1953,  p.  92)  showed,  must  be  gradually  shaped. 
If  we  place  a  pigeon  in  a  box  and  wait  for  her  to  peck  the  spot,  we  may  have 
to  wait  days  or  even  weeks.  Much  of  the  time,  the  pigeon  doesn't  even 
approach  the  spot.  So  we  must  shape  her  behavior.  First,  we  give  the  bird 
food  when  she  turns  in  the  direction  of  the  spot.  This  increases  the  frequency 


195 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


of  this  behavior.  Next,  we  withhold  food  until  she  makes  a  slight  movement 
in  the  right  direction.  We  then  keep  reinforcing  positions  closer  and  closer  to 
the  spot,  until  the  bird  is  facing  it.  At  this  point  we  can  reinforce  head  move¬ 
ments,  first  giving  food  for  any  forward  movement  and  finally  reinforcing 
the  bird  only  when  she  actually  pecks  the  spot.  Through  this  procedure  we 
gradually  shape  the  desired  response.  Shaping  is  also  called  the  "method  of 
approximations,"  because  reinforcement  is  made  contingent  upon  better  and 
better  approximations  of  the  desired  response. 

We  probably  teach  many  human  skills  in  this  bit-by-bit  shaping  process. 
When  we  teach  a  boy  to  swing  a  baseball  bat,  we  first  say  "Good"  when  he  gets 
his  hands  into  the  right  grip.  We  then  say  "Right"  when  he  lifts  his  bat  in  the 
correct  position  over  his  shoulder.  We  then  work  on  his  stance,  a  level  swing, 
and  so  on — gradually  shaping  the  complete  behavior. 

Behavior  Chains.  Although  behavior  may  be  shaped  bit  by  bit,  it  also 
develops  into  longer,  integrated  response  chains.  For  example,  batting  in  base¬ 
ball  involves  picking  up  the  bat,  getting  the  right  grip  and  stance,  watching 
for  the  right  pitch,  swinging,  running  the  bases,  and  so  on.  Skinnerians  attempt 
to  examine  each  step  in  terms  of  reinforcements  and  stimuli.  Reaching  for  the 
bat  is  reinforced  by  obtaining  it,  which  also  serves  as  a  stimulus  for  the  next 
act,  getting  the  right  grip.  Once  the  hands  are  placed  on  the  bat,  we  get  a  cer¬ 
tain  "feel"  that  we  recognize  as  the  proper  grip.  This  "feel"  is  a  reinforcement, 
and  it  also  signals  the  next  action,  pulling  the  bat  over  the  shoulder.  A  little 
later,  the  sensation  of  the  bat  squarely  striking  the  ball  is  a  reinforcement  for 
the  swing,  and  it  also  signals  the  next  action,  running  the  bases.  When  a  boy 
or  girl  has  become  a  good  hitter,  the  entire  sequence  is  often  performed  in  a 
smooth,  integrated  fashion  (Schwartz,  1989). 

Schedules  of  Reinforcement.  Skinner  (1953,  p.  99)  observed  that  our 
everyday  behavior  is  rarely  reinforced  continuously,  every  time;  instead,  it  is 
reinforced  intermittently.  We  do  not  find  good  snow  every  time  we  go  skiing 
or  have  fun  every  time  we  go  to  a  party.  Accordingly,  Skinner  studied  the 
effects  of  different  schedules  of  intermittent  reinforcement. 

Intermittent  reinforcement  may  be  set  up  on  a  fixed-interval  schedule, 
such  that  the  organism  receives  a  reward  for  the  first  response  after  a  speci¬ 
fied  period  of  time.  For  instance,  a  pigeon  receives  food  after  pecking  a 
disc,  but  must  wait  3  minutes  before  her  next  peck  is  rewarded,  then  3  more 
minutes,  and  so  on.  The  rate  of  responding  on  this  schedule  is  generally  low. 
Higher  rates  are  produced  by  fixed-ratio  schedules,  as  when  the  pigeon  gets 
food  after  every  fifth  peck.  On  both  schedules,  however,  there  is  a  lull  in 
responding  immediately  after  reinforcement.  It  is  as  if  the  organism  knows  it 
has  a  long  way  to  go  before  the  next  reinforcement  (p.  103).  Students  often 
experience  this  effect  immediately  after  completing  a  long  term  paper — it  is 
difficult  to  get  started  on  another  assignment. 


196 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


The  lulls  produced  by  fixed  schedules  can  be  avoided  by  varying  rein¬ 
forcement  in  unpredictable  ways.  On  variable-interval  schedules,  reinforce¬ 
ment  is  administered  after  an  average  length  of  time,  but  the  intervals  are 
mixed  up.  With  variable-ratio  schedules,  we  vary  the  number  of  responses 
needed  to  produce  a  reward.  When  put  on  these  two  schedules,  organisms 
consistently  respond  at  high  rates,  especially  on  variable-ratio  schedules.  They 
keep  responding  because  a  reward  might  come  at  any  time. 

One  of  Skinner 's  most  important  findings  is  that  intermittently  rein¬ 
forced  behavior,  in  comparison  to  that  which  is  continuously  reinforced,  is 
much  more  difficult  to  extinguish.  This  is  why  many  of  our  children's  unde¬ 
sirable  behaviors  are  so  difficult  to  stop.  We  might  be  able  to  resist  a  child's 
nagging  or  demanding  behavior  most  of  the  time,  but  if  we  yield  every  once 
in  a  while,  the  child  will  persist  with  it  (Bijou  &  Baer,  1961,  p.  62). 

If  we  wish  to  begin  teaching  a  desirable  form  of  behavior,  it  is  usually 
best  to  begin  with  continuous  reinforcement;  this  is  the  most  efficient  way  to 
get  the  behavior  started.  However,  if  we  also  wish  to  make  the  behavior  last, 
we  might  at  some  point  switch  to  an  intermittent  schedule  (Bijou  &  Baer, 
1961,  p.  62). 

Negative  Reinforcement  and  Punishment.  So  far  we  have  been 
focusing  on  positive  reinforcement.  Reinforcement  means  strengthening  a 
response  (increasing  its  rate),  and  positive  reinforcements  strengthen 
responses  by  adding  positive  consequences  such  as  food,  praise,  or  atten¬ 
tion.  Responses  may  also  be  strengthened  through  negative  reinforcement,  by 
removing  unpleasant  or  aversive  stimuli.  Basically,  what  is  strengthened  in 
this  way  is  the  tendency  to  escape,  as  when  a  girl  standing  on  a  diving  board 
learns  to  escape  the  taunts  of  her  peers  by  diving  into  the  water  (Skinner, 
1953,  pp.  73,173). 

When  we  punish,  in  contrast,  we  do  not  try  to  strengthen  behavior  but 
to  eliminate  it.  Punishment,  Skinner  said,  is  "the  commonest  technique  of  con¬ 
trol  in  modern  life.  The  pattern  is  familiar:  If  a  man  does  not  behave  as  you 
wish,  knock  him  down;  if  a  child  misbehaves,  spank  him;  if  the  people  of  a 
country  misbehave,  bomb  them"  (p.  182). 

Punishment,  however,  does  not  always  work.  In  an  early  experiment, 
Skinner  (1938)  found  that  when  he  punished  rats  for  bar  pressing  (by  having 
the  bar  swing  back  and  smack  them  on  the  legs),  he  only  temporarily  sup¬ 
pressed  the  response.  In  the  long  run,  punishment  did  not  eliminate  the 
response  any  faster  than  did  extinction.  Other  studies  (e.g.,  Estes,  1944)  have 
obtained  similar  results,  and  the  findings  conform  to  everyday  experience. 
Parents  who  hit  their  children  get  them  to  behave  for  a  while,  but  the  parents 
find  that  the  misconduct  reappears  later  on. 

Skinner  also  objected  to  punishment  because  it  produces  unwanted  side 
effects.  A  child  who  is  scolded  in  school  may  soon  appear  inhibited  and  con¬ 
flicted.  The  child  seems  torn  between  working  and  avoiding  work  because  of 


197 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


the  feared  consequences.  The  boy  or  girl  may  start  and  stop,  become  dis¬ 
tracted,  and  behave  in  other  awkward  ways  (Skinner,  1953,  pp.  190-191). 

Some  researchers  believe  Skinner  overstated  the  case  against  punish¬ 
ment.  In  some  instances  punishment  will  in  fact  completely  eliminate 
responses.  This  is  especially  true  when  the  punishment  is  extremely  painful. 
Also,  punishment  can  be  effective  when  it  is  promptly  administered,  and 
when  the  organism  can  make  alternative  responses  that  are  then  rewarded 
(Liebert  et  al.,  1977,  pp.  138-141).  Nevertheless,  the  effects  of  punishment  are 
often  puzzling  and  undesirable. 

Skinner  recommended  that  instead  of  punishing  children,  we  try  extinc¬ 
tion.  "If  the  child's  behavior  is  strong  only  because  it  has  been  reinforced  by 
'getting  a  rise  out  of'  the  parent,  it  will  disappear  when  this  consequence  is  no 
longer  forthcoming"  (1953,  p.  192).  Skinnerians  often  suggest  that  we  com¬ 
bine  extinction  for  undesirable  behavior  with  positive  reinforcement  for  desir¬ 
able  behavior.  In  one  study,  teachers  simply  ignored  nursery  school  children 
whenever  they  were  aggressive  and  gave  them  praise  and  attention  when¬ 
ever  they  were  peaceful  or  cooperative.  The  result  was  a  quieter  classroom 
(P.  Brown  &  Elliott,  1965). 


Internal  Events: 

Thoughts,  Feelings,  and  Drives 

Thoughts.  It  is  sometimes  said  that  Skinner  proposed  an  "empty 
organism"  theory.  He  examined  only  overt  responses  and  ignored  internal 
states.  This  characterization  is  accurate  but  slightly  oversimplified.  Skinner 
did  not  deny  that  an  inner  world  exists.  We  do  have  inner  sensations,  such  as 
the  pain  from  a  toothache.  We  also  can  be  said  to  think.  Thinking  is  merely  a 
weaker  or  more  covert  form  of  behavior.  For  example,  we  may  talk  to  our¬ 
selves  silently  instead  of  out  loud,  or  we  may  think  out  our  moves  silently  in 
a  chess  game.  However,  such  private  events  have  no  place  in  scientific  psy¬ 
chology  unless  we  can  find  ways  of  making  them  public  and  measuring  them 
(Skinner,  1974,  pp.  16-17,  and  chap.  7). 

Skinner  was  particularly  distressed  by  our  tendency  to  treat  thoughts 
as  the  causes  of  behavior.  We  say  we  went  to  the  store  because  "we  got  an 
idea  to  do  so"  or  that  a  pigeon  pecked  a  disc  because  she  "anticipated"  food. 
However,  we  are  in  error  when  we  speak  in  this  way.  We  go  to  stores,  and 
pigeons  peck  discs,  only  because  these  actions  have  led  to  past  reinforcements. 
Any  discussion  of  goals  or  expectations  is  superfluous.  Worse,  it  diverts  us 
from  the  true  explanation  of  behavior — the  controlling  effect  of  the  environ¬ 
ment  (Skinner,  1969,  pp.  240-241;  1974,  pp.  68-71). 

Feelings.  Skinner  acknowledged  that  we  have  emotions,  just  as  we 
have  thoughts.  However,  feelings  do  not  cause  behavior  any  more  than 
thoughts  do.  We  might  say  we  are  going  to  the  movies  because  "we  want 


198 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


to"  or  because  "we  feel  like  it,"  but  such  statements  explain  nothing.  If  we 
go  to  the  movies,  it  is  because  this  behavior  has  been  reinforced  in  the  past 
(Skinner,  1971,  p.  10). 

Emotional  responses  themselves  can  be  explained  according  to  learning- 
theory  principles.  In  our  discussion  of  Watson,  we  saw  how  emotional  reac¬ 
tions  might  be  learned  through  classical  conditioning.  Skinner  believes  an 
operant  analysis  is  also  useful.  Many  emotions  are  the  by-products  of  differ¬ 
ent  reinforcement  contingencies.  Confidence,  for  example,  is  a  by-product  of 
frequent  positive  reinforcement.  When  we  learn  to  hit  a  baseball  sharply  and 
consistently,  we  develop  a  sense  of  confidence  and  mastery  (Skinner,  1974, 
p.  58).  Conversely,  we  become  depressed  and  lethargic  when  reinforcements 
are  no  longer  forthcoming.  On  certain  fixed-ratio  or  fixed-interval  schedules 
we  find  it  difficult  to  get  going  after  receiving  a  reward  because  further 
rewards  will  not  be  coming  for  some  time  (p.  59). 

An  operant  analysis  also  helps  us  understand  why  various  patterns  of 
emotional  behavior  persist.  If  a  little  girl  persistently  behaves  in  an  aggressive 
manner,  it  is  important  to  know  the  consequences  of  this  behavior.  Do  her 
actions  succeed  in  getting  attention  or  other  children's  toys?  If  so,  her  aggres¬ 
siveness  is  likely  to  continue.  Similarly,  if  displays  of  happiness,  meekness, 
sympathy,  fearfulness,  and  other  emotional  responses  persist,  it  is  because 
they  have  produced  positive  consequences  (Bijou  &  Baer,  1961,  pp.  73-74; 
Skinner,  1969,  pp.  129-130). 

Skinner  believed,  then,  that  we  can  understand  emotions  if  we  look  at 
them  as  the  products  of  environmental  control.  It  is  useless  to  consider  emo¬ 
tions  as  intrapsychic  causes  of  behavior,  as  the  Freudians  do.  For  example, 
a  Freudian  might  talk  about  a  man  who  fears  sex  because  of  anticipated 
punishment  from  an  internal  agency,  the  superego.  To  Skinner,  such  dis¬ 
cussions  get  us  nowhere.  If  we  wish  to  understand  why  a  person  avoids  sex, 
we  must  look  at  the  past  consequences  of  his  sexual  behavior  (Skinner,  1974, 
chap.  10). 

Drives.  Skinner's  refusal  to  look  for  causes  of  behavior  within  the 
organism  led  to  certain  difficulties.  In  particular,  he  had  trouble  with  the  con¬ 
cept  of  drive.  Drives,  such  as  hunger  or  thirst,  would  seem  to  refer  to  internal 
states  that  motivate  behavior,  and  Skinner  himself  deprived  his  animals  of 
food  and  water  in  order  to  make  reinforcements  effective. 

Skinner  argued  that  we  do  not  need  to  conceive  of  drives  as  inner  states, 
either  mental  or  physiological.  We  simply  specify  the  hours  we  deprive  an 
animal  of  food  or  water  and  examine  the  effect  of  this  operation  on  response 
rates  (Skinner,  1953,  p.  149). 

Still,  the  drive  concept  has  remained  a  thorn  in  the  side  of  Skinneri¬ 
ans,  and  they  have  therefore  searched  for  ways  of  conceptualizing  rein¬ 
forcement  without  reference  to  this  concept.  One  interesting  proposal  has 
been  made  by  Premack  (1961),  who  suggests  we  think  of  reinforcement  simply 


199 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


as  the  momentary  probability  of  a  response.  Behavior  that  has  a  high  prob¬ 
ability  of  occurrence  at  the  moment  can  serve  as  a  reinforcer  for  behavior 
with  a  lower  probability.  If  children  are  supposed  to  be  eating  their  dinner 
but  are  busy  playing  instead,  playing  can  be  used  as  a  reinforcer  for  eating. 
We  simply  say,  "Eat  some  dinner  and  then  play  some  more"  (Homme  & 
Totsi,  1969).  Conceptualized  in  this  way,  eating  and  drinking  have  no  spe¬ 
cial  status  as  reinforcers.  Eating  and  drinking,  like  any  other  actions,  may  or 
may  not  be  good  reinforcers,  depending  on  their  probabilities  of  occurrence 
at  a  particular  time. 


Species-Specific  Behavior 

Skinner  argued,  then,  that  we  need  not  look  inside  the  organism  for  the  causes 
of  behavior.  Behavior  is  controlled  by  the  external  environment.  There  do 
seem  to  be,  however,  certain  limitations  to  environmental  control.  As  we 
briefly  mentioned  in  our  evaluation  of  Watson,  each  species  has  a  particular 
genetic  endowment  that  makes  it  easier  to  teach  it  some  things  rather  than 
other  things.  Operant  research  has  found,  for  example,  that  it  is  hard  to  teach 
a  rat  to  let  go  of  objects,  and  it  is  hard  to  shape  vocal  behavior  in  nonhuman 
species  (Skinner,  1969,  p.  201).  There  are,  as  learning  theorists  increasingly 
say,  biological  "constraints"  on  what  a  species  can  learn. 

In  practice,  Skinnerians  often  deal  with  species-specific  behavior  as 
the  topography  of  a  response.  That  is,  the  experimenter  maps  out  a  descrip¬ 
tion  of  the  behavior  he  or  she  can  work  with — for  example,  vocal  behavior 
in  humans.  The  topography  is  merely  a  description  and  does  not  consti¬ 
tute  the  most  important  part  of  the  analysis,  which  is  the  way  reinforce¬ 
ments  shape  and  maintain  behavior.  Nevertheless,  the  topography  is 
essential  (pp.  199-209). 

In  a  larger  sense,  Skinner  argued,  even  species-specific  behavior  is  a 
product  of  environmental  contingencies.  For  such  behavior  has  become,  in 
the  course  of  evolution,  part  of  the  species'  repertoire  because  it  has  helped  that 
species  survive  in  a  certain  environment.  Thus  environments  selectively  rein¬ 
force  all  behavior — not  only  that  in  an  animal's  lifetime  but  also  that  in  its 
species'  evolutionary  past  (pp.  199-209). 


Practical  Applications 

Behavior  Modification  with  Children  with  Autism.  Skinner 's  research 
readily  lends  itself  to  practical  applications.  We  have  seen  how  Skinnerians 
might  extinguish  temper  tantrums  or  get  an  unruly  class  to  behave.  The  use 
of  operant  techniques  to  correct  behavior  problems  is  a  branch  of  behavior 
modification.  Operant  techniques  supplement  the  systematic  desensitization 
procedures  first  employed  by  Watson  and  Jones. 


200 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


An  impressive  example  of  operant  therapy  is  Lovaas's  work  with  chil¬ 
dren  with  autism.  Autism  was  first  described  by  Kanner  in  1943.  It  is  a  severe 
disorder  in  which  children  are  extremely  isolated.  The  children  also  engage  in 
repetitive  behavior  such  as  spinning  objects  or  flapping  their  hands  over  and 
over.  Many  are  mute,  and  others  are  echolalic — they  merely  echo  what  one 
says.  Some  engage  in  self-injurious  behavior,  such  as  hitting  themselves 
(Lovaas,  2003;  Koegel  &  Koegel,  2006,  p.  34). 

Lovaas  tries  to  gain  control  over  the  children's  behavior  so  he  can  change 
it.  He  tries  to  eliminate  socially  inappropriate  behavior  and  reinforce  socially 
appropriate  behavior.  If  a  child  engages  in  echolalia,  repetitive  behavior,  or 
self-injurious  behavior,  Lovaas  withdraws  attention  or  punishes  the  child  with 
a  loud  "No!"  or  a  slap  on  the  thigh.  If  the  child  does  something  more  appro¬ 
priate,  such  as  emitting  correct  speech,  Lovaas  gives  the  child  a  reward,  per¬ 
haps  a  bit  of  tasty  cereal  and  the  word  "Good"  (Lovaas,  1987). 

Frequently,  appropriate  behavior  must  be  gradually  shaped,  as  when 
the  therapist  teaches  mute  children  to  imitate  words.  At  first,  the  therapist 
reinforces  any  vocalization  the  child  makes,  even  blowing  air  out  of  the  mouth. 
Once  the  child  is  regularly  making  sounds,  the  therapist  says  a  word  such  as 
"baby"  and  rewards  any  sound  that  comes  within  the  next  5  seconds.  After 
that,  rewards  are  made  contingent  on  better  and  better  approximations  of 
"baby"  (or  other  target  words)  (Lovaas,  1969, 1977). 

Initially,  some  children  are  so  silent  that  the  therapist  must  elicit  sounds 
by  tickling  them  or  pressing  their  lips  together  and  then  letting  the  air  out. 
These  interventions  are  called  manual  prompts.  Strictly  speaking,  these  prompts 
violate  Skinner's  operant  paradigm;  operant  conditioning  reinforces  freely 
emitted  behavior — not  behavior  forced  by  the  therapist's  actions.  Prompts  are 
faded  as  soon  as  possible  (Lovaas,  1977,  pp.  36-37). 

Lovaas's  therapy  is  intensive.  In  his  first  major  project,  begun  in  the  1960s, 
Lovaas  and  his  staff  trained  children  seven  hours  a  day,  seven  days  a  week,  for 
one  year  in  a  residential  treatment  setting  at  UCLA.  Most  of  the  children  were  5 
to  8  years  old  (Lovaas,  1973, 1977).  Many  made  significant  progress,  but  when 
they  were  discharged  to  state  hospitals,  they  lost  all  they  had  gained.  In  his  next 
major  project,  in  the  1970s  and  1980s,  Lovaas  avoided  this  discharge  problem;  he 
worked  with  children  in  their  homes  and  taught  parents  to  help  train  the  chil¬ 
dren.  He  also  worked  with  younger  children — under  the  age  of  4  years.  The  chil¬ 
dren  were  trained  at  least  40  hours  a  week.  After  2  to  3  years,  nearly  half  entered 
first  grade  as  regular  students — an  achievement  that  would  have  once  seemed 
impossible  (Lovaas,  1987).  A  6-year  follow-up  study  found  that  almost  all  of 
these  children  still  attended  a  regular  school  (McEachlin,  Smith,  &  Lovaas,  1993). 

Lovaas  and  his  colleagues  have  described  their  treatment  as  applied  behav¬ 
ior  analysis,  or  ABA,  a  term  they  apply  to  any  therapy  that  uses  principles  of 
learning  in  a  measurable,  scientific  manner.  Lovaas's  ABA  methods  are  still  the 
most  widely  used,  but  there  are  new  variations.  Robert  and  Lynn  Koegel  and 
their  colleagues  (2006)  have  developed  a  program  that  focuses  less  on  teaching 


201 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


discrete  skills  and  more  on  broad  areas  such  as  motivation.  The  Koegels  believe 
that  children  often  have  difficulty  with  Lovaas's  tasks  and  sometimes  lose  their 
enthusiasm  for  learning  because  reinforcement  is  infrequent.  The  Koegels  there¬ 
fore  offer  reinforcement  more  frequently — often  just  for  the  effort.  (They  call  this 
loose  shaping.)  They  also  let  the  child  choose  toys  and  activities.  And  instead  of 
giving  cereal  treats,  they  offer  rewards  that  are  important  to  the  child  in  his  or 
her  everyday  environment.  If  a  girl  wants  a  shovel  to  dig  in  the  sand,  the  thera¬ 
pist  asks  her  to  say  "Shovel,"  and  if  she  does,  she  receives  the  shovel.  If  she  says, 
"Swing,"  she  gets  a  push  on  the  swing.  The  Koegels  have  reported  success, 
although  their  studies  aren't  nearly  as  extensive  as  those  by  Lovaas. 

Compared  to  Lovaas,  the  Koegels  give  children  more  opportunities  to 
take  the  lead.  But  the  therapist  still  maintains  control,  as  when  the  therapist 
requires  the  child  to  name  an  object  such  as  a  shovel  before  receiving  it.  Fur¬ 
thermore,  if  a  child  engages  in  highly  repetitive  behavior,  the  therapist  actively 
intervenes  to  turn  the  child's  attention  to  other  activities.  Sometimes  the  ther¬ 
apist  actually  stands  in  front  of  the  object,  such  as  a  fan,  that  stimulates  repet¬ 
itive  behavior  (Koegel  &  Koegel,  2006,  p.  221). 

Programmed  Instruction.  Skinner  contributed  to  the  education  of 
normal  children  through  his  invention  of  teaching  machines  and  programmed 
instruction  (Skinner,  1968).  The  teaching  machine  was  a  simple  apparatus  that 
permitted  one  to  read  a  brief  passage,  answer  questions,  and  then,  by  turning 
a  knob,  see  if  one  was  correct.  Actually,  the  machine  itself  was  less  important 
than  the  programmed  material  it  contained,  and  today  the  material  is  pre¬ 
sented  in  simple  booklet  form  or  installed  in  a  computer.  To  get  an  idea  of 
how  programmed  instruction  works,  read  the  following  material2  and  pre¬ 
tend  to  fill  in  the  blanks.  As  you  do  so,  cover  the  answers  on  the  left  side  with 
a  piece  of  paper,  sliding  it  down  just  far  enough  to  check  your  answers. 

1.  Programmed  instruction  involves  several  basic 
principles  of  learning.  One  of  these,  called  the 
principle  of  small  steps,  is  based  on  the  premise  that 

small  new  information  must  be  presented  in _ steps. 

2.  The  learner  gradually  acquires  more  and  more 

small  steps  information,  but  always  in _ . 

3.  Because  active  readers  generally  acquire  more 
knowledge  than  passive  readers,  programmed 
instruction  also  is  based  on  the  principle  of  active 
participation.  Writing  key  words  as  one  is  reading 

active  involves  the  principle  of _ participation. 


2From  Munn,  N.  L.,  Fernald,  L.  D.,  and  Fernald,  P.  S.,  Introduction  to  Psychology,  3rd  ed., 
Boston:  Houghton  Mifflin  Co.,  1974,  pp.  249-250.  By  permission. 


202 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


active  participation 
small  steps 
active  participation 


knowledge 


immediate 
of  results 


immediate  knowledge 
of  results 

small  steps 
active  participation 
immediate  knowledge 
of  results 


4.  While  reading  a  book,  an  uninterested  learner  may 

slip  into  a  passive  state  and  discover  that  he  can¬ 
not  recall  what  he  has  just  "read."  In  using  pro¬ 
grammed  instruction  the  learner  is  prompted  to 
remain  alert  by  writing  the  key  words,  thus  uti¬ 
lizing  the  principle  of _ . 

5.  In  these  two  techniques  of  programmed  instruction, 

information  is  presented  in _ ,  and  occa¬ 

sionally  key  words  are  missing  thus  requiring  the 
learner's _ to  complete  the  statements. 

6.  A  third  principle,  immediate  knowledge  of  results,  is 

illustrated  when  a  professor  returns  quiz  papers 
to  his  students  at  the  end  of  the  class  in  which  they 
were  written.  These  students  receive  almost  imme¬ 
diate  _ of  results. 

7.  If  a  student  makes  an  incorrect  response  at  any 

point  in  programmed  instruction,  he  discovers  his 
mistake  because  the  correct  answer  may  be  seen 
immediately  after  the  frame,  before  the  next  one  is 
considered.  Thus,  in  programmed  instruction,  the 
learner  receives _ knowledge _ . 

8.  Notice  that  in  programmed  instruction,  unlike 

the  evaluation  of  term  papers,  "immediate"  does 
not  mean  a  week  or  even  a  day  but  rather  a  few 
seconds.  The  reader  of  the  program  is  continu¬ 
ously  informed  concerning  his  progress;  he 
receives _ . 

9.  Let  us  review  the  three  techniques  of  programmed 
instruction  already  considered.  By  means  of 

_ ,  the  reader  learns  new  material, 

which  he  acquires  through _ followed 

by _ • 


Programmed  instruction  embodies  several  Skinnerian  principles.  First, 
it  proceeds  in  small  steps,  because  Skinner  has  found  that  the  best  way  to 
establish  new  behavior  is  to  shape  it  bit  by  bit.  Second,  the  learner  is  active, 
because  this  is  the  natural  condition  of  organisms.  (Recall  how  Pavlov's  dogs, 
in  contrast,  were  harnessed  in  and  simply  reacted  to  stimuli.)  Third,  feedback 
is  immediate  because  Skinner  found  that  learning  is  most  rapid  when 
promptly  reinforced.  (Reinforcement  here  is  the  knowledge  that  one's  answer 
is  correct.) 

A  sample  of  programmed  reading  for  children  is  found  in  Figure  4.  In 
programmed  instruction,  students  work  independently  and  at  their  own  pace. 
The  instruction  units  are  constructed  so  each  student  may  begin  at  a  level  she 
can  easily  master.  One  does  not  want  the  student  making  many  errors  at  first, 
for  then  she  will  lack  positive  reinforcement  for  learning.  As  with  shaping,  one 


203 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


Mat 


Man 


I  am  a  ma 


Figure  4 

Programmed  instruction  for  children. 
(Adapted  from  Sullivan,  M.  W„  Programmed 
learning  in  reading.  In  A.  D.  Calvin,  Ed., 
Programmed  Instruction:  Bold  New  Venture. 
Bloomington:  Indiana  University  Press,  1969, 
p.  1 1 1 .  By  permission  of  the  publisher.) 


Mat 


I  am  a  ma 


begins  by  reinforcing  responses  that  are  within  the  student's  behavioral  reper¬ 
toire  and  gradually  building  up  from  there. 

On  a  technical  level,  programmed  instruction  has  run  into  some  diffi¬ 
culties.  For  example,  students  sometimes  rush  through  the  programs  with¬ 
out  fully  mastering  the  material  (Munson  &  Crosbie,  1998).  But  the 
underlying  principles  are  important  and  make  efforts  to  solve  the  problems 
worthwhile. 

Surprisingly,  the  principles  underlying  programmed  instruction  over¬ 
lap  somewhat  with  Montessori's.  Both  Skinner  and  Montessori  wanted  to 
make  learning  an  individualized,  self-paced  activity  that  begins  at  the  stu¬ 
dent's  own  level  and  builds  skills  gradually.  For  both,  the  goal  is  not  to  tear 
down,  through  criticism  or  punishment,  but  to  make  learning  a  consistently 
positive  experience. 

But  the  two  approaches  also  differ.  For  one  thing,  programmed 
instruction  involves  material  that  young  children  read  (see  Figure  4), 
whereas  Montessori  materials  are  largely  physical.  Even  when  learning  to 
read,  Montessori  children  begin  with  sandpaper  letters,  metal  insets,  and  so 
on.  Montessori  thought  young  children  find  such  physical  activities  more 
natural. 

More  fundamentally,  there  is  the  difference  in  the  extent  to  which  the 
child's  work  is  free  from  adult  direction.  Montessori  allowed  children  to 
choose  their  own  tasks  and  work  on  them  while  the  teacher  steps  into  the 
background.  She  wanted  children  to  discover  for  themselves  how  some¬ 
thing  is  out  of  place,  how  cylinders  fit,  how  water  is  poured,  and  whatever 
else  is  important  to  them.  In  programmed  instruction,  in  contrast,  adult 
direction  is  pervasive.  Although  it  might  seem  that  children  work 


204 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


independently  on  the  booklets,  in  fact  an  adult  (the  program  developer) 
has  structured  each  small  response.  The  child  follows  the  adult's  lead, 
repeatedly  checking  with  this  social  authority  to  see  if  she  is  right.  Chil¬ 
dren  probably  derive  less  sense  that  they  are  making  their  own  discoveries 
about  the  world. 

Nevertheless,  it  is  important  not  to  overlook  the  similarities  between 
the  two  methods — especially  the  way  both  try  to  make  learning  a  positive 
experience.  One  can  even  imagine  Skinner  approving  Montessori's  physical 
tasks,  albeit  in  his  own  terms.  He  would  say  they  work  not  because  they 
allow  for  spontaneous  discoveries,  but  because  they  allow  children  to  make 
responses  that  readily  result  in  positive  feedback  from  the  physical 
environment. 


EVALUATION 

Skinner  considerably  widened  the  scope  of  learning  theory.  After  noting  the 
limitations  of  classical  conditioning,  he  explored  the  nature  of  operant  behav¬ 
ior,  where  the  organism  acts  freely  and  is  controlled  by  the  consequences  of 
its  actions.  In  a  brilliant  series  of  studies,  Skinner  showed  how  such  control  is 
exerted — by  schedules  of  reinforcement,  shaping,  the  influence  of  discrimi¬ 
native  stimuli,  and  other  factors.  Furthermore,  Skinner  amply  demonstrated 
the  practical  importance  of  his  ideas. 

In  the  process,  Skinner  stirred  up  controversies  on  many  fronts.  To  some, 
his  work  lends  itself  to  authoritarian  practices — for  he  suggests  ways  to  con¬ 
trol,  manipulate,  and  program  others'  behavior.  Skinner's  (e.g.,  1974,  p.  244) 
reply  was  that  environments  do,  in  fact,  control  behavior,  and  how  we  use 
our  knowledge  of  this  fact  is  up  to  us.  We  can  create  environments  that  suit 
humane  purposes,  or  we  can  create  ones  that  do  not. 

Developmentalists,  too,  often  enter  into  heated,  value-laden  debates 
with  Skinnerians.  Developmentalists  cringe  at  talk  of  controlling  and  chang¬ 
ing  children's  behavior,  when  we  should,  instead,  try  to  understand  children 
and  give  them  opportunities  to  grow  on  their  own.  To  many  Skinnerians,  such 
sentiments  are  romantic  and  naive,  for  children  chiefly  develop  through  the 
molding  influence  of  the  external  environment. 

In  a  more  objective  vein,  there  are  essentially  three  ways  in  which 
Skinner  and  writers  in  the  developmental  tradition  disagree.  First,  devel¬ 
opmental  theorists  often  discuss  internal  events.  Piaget  described  complex 
mental  structures,  even  though  he  did  not  expect  to  find  direct  evidence 
for  all  of  them  in  any  individual  case.  Freudians  discuss  internal  events, 
such  as  unconscious  fantasies,  that  we  cannot  directly  observe  at  all.  Skin¬ 
ner  believed  such  concepts  divert  us  from  scientific  progress,  which  is  made 
when  we  confine  ourselves  to  the  measurement  of  overt  responses  and 


205 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


environmental  stimuli.  But  on  this  point,  Skinner  is  now  generally  consid¬ 
ered  too  extreme.  Since  the  1960s,  there  has  been  a  dramatic  new  interest  in 
cognition,  and  even  growing  numbers  of  learning  theorists  have  been  con¬ 
sidering  internal,  cognitive  events,  even  if  the  events  cannot  be  directly 
measured. 

Second,  developmental  theorists  and  Skinnerians  disagree  on  the  mean¬ 
ing  and  importance  of  developmental  stages — periods  when  children  orga¬ 
nize  experience  in  very  different  ways.  In  Piaget's  theory,  for  example,  a  child's 
stage  is  a  crucial  variable;  it  is  a  predictor  of  the  kind  of  experience  the  child 
can  learn  from.  A  child  at  the  sensorimotor  level  will  not  learn  tasks  that 
involve  language,  nor  will  a  child  beginning  to  master  concrete  operations 
learn  much  from  lectures  covering  abstract  theory. 

Skinnerians  doubt  the  validity  of  stages  as  general,  distinct  ways  of 
thinking  or  behaving;  they  believe  the  environment  shapes  behavior  in  a  grad¬ 
ual,  continuous  manner  (Bijou,  1976,  p.  2;  Skinner,  1953,  p.  91).  Skinner  did 
acknowledge  that  one  must  note  the  child's  age  in  any  experiment,  just  as  one 
must  note  an  animal's  species  and  characteristic  behavior  (Skinner,  1969,  p.  89). 
Age  contributes  to  the  "topography"  of  behavior;  it  helps  describe  the  behav¬ 
ior  that  the  experimenter  sets  about  to  shape  or  maintain.  However,  such  infor¬ 
mation  is  still  merely  descriptive;  it  is  secondary  to  environmental  variables 
that  control  behavior.  The  question  is  whether  the  child's  developmental  sta¬ 
tus  deserves  this  secondary  role. 

A  third  issue  dividing  Skinner  and  developmental  theorists  is  the  most 
important  of  all.  This  issue  concerns  the  source  of  behavioral  change.  Devel- 
opmentalists  contend  that  in  crucial  instances  a  child's  thoughts,  feelings,  and 
actions  develop  spontaneously,  from  within.  Behavior  is  not  exclusively  pat¬ 
terned  by  the  external  environment.  Gesell,  for  example,  believed  children 
stand,  walk,  talk,  and  so  on  from  inner  maturational  promptings.  Piaget  was 
not  a  maturationist,  but  he  also  looked  primarily  to  inner  forces  underlying 
developmental  change.  In  his  view,  children's  behavior  is  not  structured  by  the 
environment  but  by  children  themselves.  Children,  out  of  a  spontaneous  inter¬ 
est  in  moderately  novel  events,  construct  increasingly  complex  and  differen¬ 
tiated  structures  for  dealing  with  the  world. 

Consider,  for  example,  a  baby  girl  who  drops  a  block,  hears  the  sound, 
and  drops  it  again  and  again,  making  this  new  and  interesting  sound  last. 
In  Skinner's  theory,  the  sound  is  a  reinforcer  that  controls  her  behavior.  But 
this  reinforcer  will  soon  lose  its  effectiveness,  for  she  will  soon  become  inter¬ 
ested  in  more  complex  outcomes  (Kohlberg,  1969a).  She  may,  for  instance, 
begin  listening  for  different  sounds  as  she  drops  objects  from  different 
heights.  For  Piaget,  we  cannot  look  to  external  reinforcements  as  the  deter¬ 
minants  of  behavior,  for  these  often  vary  with  the  child's  developing  inter¬ 
ests.  For  him,  the  main  variable  is  the  child's  spontaneous  curiosity  about 
increasingly  complex  events. 


206 


Learning  Theory:  Pavlov,  Watson,  and  Skinner 


Developmental  theorists,  then,  try  to  conceptualize  ways  in  which  chil¬ 
dren  grow  and  learn  on  their  own,  somewhat  independent  of  others'  teach¬ 
ings  or  external  reinforcements.  At  the  same  time,  no  one  can  deny  that 
environments  also  reinforce  and  control  behavior  to  a  considerable  extent,  and 
often  in  ways  Skinner  described.  Skinner's  theory  and  research,  moreover, 
have  a  clarity  and  elegant  simplicity  that  others  would  do  well  to  emulate.  It 
is  clear  that  Skinner's  enormous  contribution  to  scientific  method  and  theory 
will  be  a  lasting  one. 


207 


This  page  intentionally  left  blank 


Bandura’s  Social 
Learning  Theory 


From  Theories  of  Development:  Concepts  and  Applications,  Sixth  Edition.  William 
Crain.  Copyright  ©  2011  by  Pearson  Education,  Inc.  Published  by  Pearson 
Prentice  Hall.  All  rights  reserved. 


209 


Bandura’s  Social 
Learning  Theory 


BIOGRAPHICAL  INTRODUCTION 

The  pioneering  learning  theorists  usually  developed  their  concepts  by 
experimenting  with  animals  in  physical  settings.  They  watched  how 
animals  ran  through  mazes,  solved  puzzle  boxes,  and  learned  to  press 
levers  in  Skinner  boxes.  These  situations  were  not  social;  there  were 
no  other  animals  present.  Skinnerians  and  others  then  showed  how 
the  same  principles  apply  to  human  learning  in  social  contexts.  Just  as 
rats  learn  to  press  levers  to  get  food,  people  learn  to  interact  with  others 
to  obtain  social  rewards. 

In  the  1960s,  however,  Albert  Bandura  argued  that  our  learning 
in  social  situations  goes  beyond  anything  Skinner  and  most  learning 
theorists  described.  In  social  settings,  Bandura  said,  we  learn  a  great 
deal  through  imitation,  and  imitation  involves  cognitive  processes.  We 
acquire  considerable  information  just  by  observing  models,  mentally 
coding  what  we  see. 

In  the  1970s  Bandura  refined  his  ideas  on  observational  learn¬ 
ing  and  demonstrated  the  powerful  effects  models  have  on  our  behav¬ 
ior.  Beginning  in  the  1980s  he  turned  more  attention  to  the  ways  our 
efforts  are  influenced  by  our  beliefs  in  our  capacities — our  self-efficacy 
beliefs.  Bandura's  lifetime  of  work  occupies  a  central  place  in  modern 
psychology. 

Bandura  was  born  in  1925  in  the  tiny  town  of  Mundare  in  the 
province  of  Alberta,  Canada.  His  parents  had  emigrated  to  Mundare 
from  Eastern  Europe  as  teenagers  and  had  converted  a  homestead  into 
a  farm,  which  they  struggled  to  maintain  against  storms  and  droughts. 
As  a  boy  Bandura  pitched  in  when  he  could.  Although  his  parents  had 
no  schooling,  they  valued  education  and  instilled  this  value  in  Bandura. 
After  attending  a  high  school  with  only  20  students,  Bandura  enrolled 
in  the  University  of  British  Columbia,  working  afternoons  in  a  wood¬ 
work  plant  to  help  pay  the  cost  (Bandura,  2006;  Evans,  1989). 


210 


Bandura's  Social  Learning  Theory 


Bandura  enrolled  in  his  first  psychology  class  almost  by  chance.  He  was 
commuting  to  the  college  with  a  group  of  engineering  and  premed  students 
who  took  early  morning  classes,  and  Bandura  had  a  gap  in  his  schedule.  So 
he  signed  up  for  the  psychology  course  and  immediately  became  fascinated 
by  the  topic.  He  majored  in  it;  and  after  earning  his  bachelor's  degree,  he 
entered  the  clinical  psychology  graduate  program  at  the  University  of  Iowa. 
While  he  was  there  he  became  impressed  by  the  work  of  Robert  Sears  and 
other  pioneers  of  social  learning  theory,  and  Bandura  began  thinking  seri¬ 
ously  about  the  role  of  models  in  shaping  our  lives  (Bandura,  2006;  Evans, 
1989;  Zimmerman  &  Schunk,  2003). 

Soon  after  graduate  school,  Bandura  joined  the  faculty  of  Stanford  Uni¬ 
versity,  where  he  has  been  ever  since.  In  1974  he  was  elected  president  of  the 
American  Psychological  Association.  Bandura  didn't  just  serve  as  a  titular 
head;  he  actively  organized  the  members  to  fight  federal  budget  cuts  to  psy¬ 
chological  services.  Over  the  years,  Bandura  has  received  numerous  honors 
and  awards.  Former  students  speak  fondly  of  his  wry  humor  and  praise  him 
for  the  demanding  but  helpful  mentorship  he  provided  (Zimmerman  & 
Schunk,  2003). 


BASIC  CONCEPTS 
Observational  Learning 

In  Skinner's  theory,  learning  often  appears  to  be  a  gradual  process  in  which 
organisms  must  act  to  learn.  Organisms  emit  responses,  which  are  gradually 
shaped  by  their  consequences.  Bandura  (1962),  however,  argues  that  in  social 
situations  we  often  learn  much  more  rapidly  simply  by  observing  the  behav¬ 
ior  of  others.  When,  for  example,  children  learn  new  songs  or  play  house  just 
like  their  parents,  they  often  reproduce  long  sequences  of  new  behavior  imme¬ 
diately.  They  appear  to  acquire  large  segments  of  new  behavior  all  at  once, 
through  observation  alone. 

The  power  of  observational  learning  is  well  documented  in  the  anthro¬ 
pological  literature  (Bandura  &  Walters,  1963,  chap.  2;  Honigmann,  1967, 
p.  180).  In  one  Guatemalan  subculture,  girls  learn  to  weave  almost  exclusively 
by  watching  models.  The  teacher  demonstrates  the  operations  of  the  textile 
machine  while  the  girl  simply  observes.  Then,  when  the  girl  feels  ready,  she 
takes  over,  and  she  usually  operates  it  skillfully  on  her  very  first  try.  She 
demonstrates,  in  Bandura's  (1965a)  term,  no-trial  learning;  she  acquires  new 
behavior  all  at  once,  entirely  through  observation.  She  does  not  need  to 
fumble  through  any  tedious  process  of  trial-and-error  learning  with  differential 
reinforcement  for  each  small  response. 

When  new  behavior  is  acquired  through  observation  alone,  the  learn¬ 
ing  appears  to  be  cognitive.  When  the  Guatemalan  girl  watches  her  teacher 


211 


Bandura's  Social  Learning  Theory 


and  then  imitates  her  perfectly  without  any  practice,  she  must  rely  on  some 
inner  representation  of  the  behavior  that  guides  her  own  performance. 
Bandura,  unlike  Skinner,  believes  learning  theory  must  include  internal  cog¬ 
nitive  variables. 

Observation  also  teaches  us  the  probable  consequences  of  new  behavior; 
we  notice  what  happens  when  others  try  it.  Bandura  calls  this  process  vicarious 
reinforcement.  Vicarious  reinforcement  is  also  a  cognitive  process;  we  formu¬ 
late  expectations  about  the  outcomes  of  our  own  behavior  without  any  direct 
action  on  our  part. 

We  learn  from  models  of  many  kinds — not  only  from  live  models  but 
also  from  symbolic  models,  such  as  those  we  see  on  television  or  read  about  in 
books.  Another  form  of  symbolic  modeling  is  verbal  instruction,  as  when  an 
instructor  describes  for  us  the  actions  for  driving  a  car.  In  this  case  the  teacher's 
verbal  descriptions,  together  with  a  demonstration,  usually  teach  us  most  of 
what  we  need  to  know.  This  is  fortunate,  for  if  we  had  to  learn  to  drive  exclu¬ 
sively  from  the  consequences  of  our  own  actions,  few  of  us  would  survive 
the  process  (Bandura,  1962,  pp.  214,  241). 

Let  us  now  look  more  closely  at  the  observational  learning  process, 
which  Bandura  divides  into  four  subprocesses. 


The  Four  Components 
of  Observational  Learning 

1.  Attentions!  Processes.  First  of  all,  we  cannot  imitate  a  model  unless 
we  pay  attention  to  the  model.  Models  often  attract  our  attention  because  they 
are  distinctive,  or  because  they  possess  the  trappings  of  success,  prestige, 
power,  and  other  winsome  qualities  (Bandura,  1971,  p.  17).  Television  is  par¬ 
ticularly  successful  at  presenting  models  with  engaging  characteristics  and 
exerts  a  powerful  influence  on  our  lives  (Bandura,  1977,  p.  25).  Attention  is  also 
governed  by  the  psychological  characteristics  of  observers,  such  as  their  inter¬ 
ests,  but  less  is  known  about  such  variables  (p.  25). 

2.  Retention  Processes.  Because  we  frequently  imitate  models  some 
time  after  we  have  observed  them,  we  must  have  some  way  of  remembering 
their  actions  in  symbolic  form.  Bandura  (1965a;  1971,  p.  17)  thinks  of  sym¬ 
bolic  processes  in  terms  of  stimulus  contiguity,  associations  among  stimuli  that 
occur  together.  Suppose,  for  example,  we  watch  a  man  use  a  new  tool,  a  drill. 
He  shows  us  how  to  fasten  the  bit,  plug  it  in,  and  so  on.  Later,  the  sight  of  the 
drill  alone  arouses  many  associated  images,  and  these  guide  our  actions. 

In  the  example,  the  stimuli  are  all  visual.  However,  we  usually  remem¬ 
ber  events,  Bandura  (1971,  p.  18)  says,  by  associating  them  with  verbal  codes. 
When  we  watch  a  motorist  take  a  new  route,  we  connect  the  route  with 
words  (e.g.,  "Route  1,  then  Exit  12  .  .  .").  Later,  when  we  try  to  drive  the 
route  ourselves,  the  verbal  codes  help  us  follow  it. 


212 


Bandura's  Social  Learning  Theory 


Young  children,  under  the  age  of  5  years  or  so,  are  not  yet  accustomed 
to  thinking  in  words  and  probably  must  rely  quite  heavily  on  visual  images. 
This  limits  their  ability  to  imitate.  We  therefore  can  improve  on  their  imitations 
by  directing  them  to  use  verbal  codes — that  is,  by  asking  them  to  give  verbal 
descriptions  of  a  model's  behavior  while  they  are  watching  it  (Bandura,  1971, 
p.  19;  Coates  &  Hartup,  1969). 

On  many  memory  tasks,  young  children  display  a  striking  disregard  for 
their  own  capacities  and  limitations.  For  example,  Vygotsky  (1931b,  p.  71) 
found  that  young  children  approach  tasks,  no  matter  how  simple  or  difficult, 
with  the  same  unbridled  enthusiasm.  They  act  as  if  they  can  remember  any¬ 
thing.  In  contemporary  terms,  they  lack  metacognitive  awareness;  they  do  not 
yet  observe  and  assess  their  own  cognitive  skills.  Between  the  ages  of  about 
5  and  10  years,  children  gradually  learn  to  evaluate  their  memory  capacities 
and  learn  when  to  use  memory  aids  such  as  verbal  rehearsals  (repeating  some¬ 
thing  to  themselves  over  and  over  to  remember  it  better).  Bandura  (1986, 
p.  89)  summarizes  experimental  evidence  that  suggests  models  can  help  chil¬ 
dren  learn  to  use  verbal  rehearsal  and  other  techniques. 

3.  Motor  Reproduction  Processes.  To  reproduce  behavior  accurately, 
the  person  must  have  the  necessary  motor  skills.  For  example,  a  boy  might 
watch  his  father  use  a  saw  but  find  he  cannot  imitate  very  well  because  he 
lacks  the  physical  strength  and  agility.  From  observation  alone,  he  picks  up  a 
new  pattern  of  responses  (e.g.,  how  to  set  up  the  wood  and  where  to  place  the 
saw)  but  no  new  physical  abilities  (e.g.,  cutting  with  power).  The  latter  come 
only  with  physical  growth  and  practice  (Bandura,  1977,  p.  27). 

4.  Reinforcement  and  Motivational  Processes.  Bandura,  like  cogni¬ 
tive  learning  theorists  before  him  (Tolman,  1948),  distinguishes  between  the 
acquisition  and  the  performance  of  new  responses.  We  can  observe  a  model,  and 
thereby  acquire  new  knowledge,  but  we  may  or  may  not  perform  the  responses. 
A  boy  might  hear  his  neighbor  use  some  profane  language,  and  thereby  learn 
some  new  words,  but  the  boy  might  not  reproduce  them  himself. 

Performances  are  governed  by  reinforcement  and  motivational  variables; 
we  will  actually  imitate  another  if  we  are  likely  to  gain  a  reward.  In  part,  it  is 
our  past  history  of  direct  reinforcements  that  matters.  If,  in  our  example,  the 
boy  has  himself  received  respect  and  admiration  for  swearing,  he  is  likely  to 
imitate  his  neighbor.  If,  however,  he  has  been  punished  for  swearing,  he  prob¬ 
ably  will  hesitate  to  imitate  his  neighbor. 

Performances  also  are  influenced  by  vicarious  reinforcements,  the  conse¬ 
quences  one  sees  accrue  to  the  model.  If  the  boy  sees  his  neighbor  admired  for 
swearing,  the  boy  is  likely  to  imitate  him.  If  he  sees  the  neighbor  punished,  he 
is  less  likely  to  do  so  (Bandura,  1971,  p.  46;  1977,  pp.  117-124). 

Performances,  finally,  are  partly  governed  by  self-reinforcements,  the  eval¬ 
uations  we  make  of  our  own  behavior.  We  will  discuss  this  process  in  a  later 
section. 


213 


Bandura's  Social  Learning  Theory 


Conclusion.  To  imitate  a  model  successfully,  then,  we  must  (1)  attend 
to  the  model,  (2)  have  some  way  of  retaining  what  we  have  seen  in  symbolic 
form,  and  (3)  have  the  necessary  motor  skills  to  reproduce  the  behavior.  If 
these  conditions  are  met,  we  probably  know  how  to  imitate  the  model.  Still, 
we  might  not  do  so.  Our  actual  performances  are  governed  by  (4)  reinforce¬ 
ment  contingencies,  many  of  which  are  of  a  vicarious  sort. 

In  reality,  these  four  components  are  not  totally  separate.  Reinforce¬ 
ment  processes,  in  particular,  influence  what  we  attend  to.  For  example,  we 
often  attend  to  powerful,  competent,  prestigious  models  because  we  have 
found  that  imitating  them,  rather  than  inferior  models,  leads  to  more  posi¬ 
tive  consequences. 


SOCIALIZATION  STUDIES 

Bandura's  four-part  model  gives  a  fine-grained  analysis  of  imitative  learning. 
On  a  broader  level,  one  of  Bandura's  primary,  if  sometimes  implicit,  concerns 
has  been  the  socialization  process — the  process  by  which  societies  induce  their 
members  to  behave  in  socially  acceptable  ways. 

Socialization  is  an  inclusive  process  that  influences  almost  every  kind  of 
behavior,  even  technical  skills.  Many  American  teenage  boys,  for  example, 
feel  they  will  not  fit  into  their  social  group  unless  they  learn  to  drive  a  car. 
Automobile  driving,  however,  is  not  something  required  by  all  cultures,  and 
there  are  classes  of  social  behavior  that  have  broader  relevance.  All  cultures 
seem  to  try  to  teach  their  members  when  it  is  acceptable  to  express  aggression. 
It  also  is  likely  that  all  cultures  try  to  teach  people  certain  modes  of  coopera¬ 
tion,  sharing,  and  helping.  Aggression  and  cooperative  behavior,  then,  are 
"targets"  of  socialization  in  all  cultures  (Hetherington  &  Parke,  1977,  p.  231). 
In  the  next  few  sections  we  sample  social  learning  analyses  of  some  of  the 
target  behaviors  in  the  socialization  process. 


Aggression 

Bandura  (1967;  Bandura  &  Walters,  1963)  believes  that  the  socialization  of 
aggression,  as  well  as  other  behavior,  is  partly  a  matter  of  operant  condition¬ 
ing.  Parents  and  other  socializing  agents  reward  children  when  they  express 
aggression  in  socially  appropriate  ways  (e.g.,  in  games  or  in  hunting)  and 
punish  children  when  they  express  aggression  in  socially  unacceptable  ways 
(e.g.,  hitting  younger  children).  But  socializing  agents  also  teach  children  a 
great  deal  by  the  kinds  of  models  they  present.  Children  observe  aggressive 
models,  notice  when  they  are  reinforced,  and  imitate  accordingly.  Bandura 
has  examined  this  process  in  several  experiments,  one  of  which  is  now 
considered  a  classic. 


214 


Bandura's  Social  Learning  Theory 


In  this  study  (Bandura,  1965b),  4-year-olds  individually  watched  a  film 
in  which  an  adult  male  model  engaged  in  some  moderately  novel  aggressive 
behavior.  The  model  laid  a  Bobo  doll1  on  its  side,  sat  on  it,  and  punched  it, 
shouting  such  things  as,  "Pow,  right  in  the  nose,"  and  "Sockeroo  .  .  .  stay 
down"  (pp.  590-591).  Each  child  was  assigned  to  one  of  three  conditions, 
which  meant  that  each  child  saw  the  same  film  but  with  different  endings. 

1.  In  the  aggression-rewarded  condition,  the  model  was  praised  and  given 
treats  at  the  end  of  the  film.  A  second  adult  called  him  a  "strong  cham¬ 
pion"  and  gave  him  chocolate  bars,  soft  drinks,  and  the  like  (p.  591). 

2.  In  the  aggression-punished  condition,  the  model  was  called  a  "big  bully," 
swatted,  and  forced  to  cower  away  at  the  end  of  the  film  (p.  591). 

3.  In  the  third,  no-consequences  condition,  the  model  received  neither 
rewards  nor  punishments  for  his  aggressive  behavior. 

Immediately  after  the  film,  each  child  was  escorted  into  a  room  with  a  Bobo 
doll  and  other  toys.  The  experimenters  observed  the  child  through  a  one-way 
mirror  to  see  how  often  he  or  she  would  imitate  the  aggressive  model. 

The  results  indicated  that  those  who  had  seen  the  model  punished  exhib¬ 
ited  significantly  fewer  imitations  than  did  those  in  the  other  two  groups.  Thus 
vicarious  punishment  reduced  the  imitation  of  aggressive  responses.  There 
was  no  difference  between  the  aggression-rewarded  and  no-consequences 
groups.  This  is  often  the  finding  with  respect  to  behavior,  such  as  aggression, 
that  is  typically  prohibited.  The  observation  that  "nothing  bad  happens  this 
time"  prompts  imitation  just  as  readily  as  does  vicarious  reward  (Bandura, 
1969,  p.  239). 

The  experiment  also  had  a  second,  equally  important  phase.  An  exper¬ 
imenter  came  back  into  the  room  and  told  each  child  that  he  or  she  would 
get  juice  and  a  pretty  sticker  picture  for  each  additional  response  he  or  she 
could  reproduce.  This  incentive  completely  eliminated  the  differences  among 
the  three  groups.  Now  all  the  children — including  those  who  had  seen  the 
model  punished — imitated  him  to  the  same  extent.  Vicarious  punishment 
had  only  blocked  the  performance  of  new  responses,  not  their  acquisition.  The 
children  in  the  aggression-punished  condition  had  learned  new  responses, 
but  had  not  felt  it  wise  to  actually  reproduce  them  until  a  new  incentive  was 
introduced. 

One  of  Bandura's  followers,  Robert  Liebert  (Liebert  et  al.,  1977,  p.  145), 
suggests  this  experiment  has  implications  for  aggression  in  television  and 
movies.  Children  are  frequently  exposed  to  actors  who  demonstrate  clever 
ways  of  committing  homicides  and  other  crimes.  The  widespread  showing 
of  such  films  is  justified  by  the  fact  that  the  criminals  are  usually  caught  in  the 


'A  large  inflated  rubber  doll. 


215 


Bandura's  Social  Learning  Theory 


end.  But  Bandura's  work  suggests  that  children  probably  learn  about  crimi¬ 
nal  behavior  nonetheless,  and  only  inhibit  such  behavior  until  a  time  when 
environmental  contingencies  clearly  favor  its  occurrence. 

In  the  above  experiment,  children  performed  newly  acquired  responses. 
Models  also  can  influence  the  performance  of  previously  learned  behavior  of  the 
same  general  class.  For  example,  a  boy  might  watch  a  violent  movie  and  then 
act  roughly  toward  his  sister.  He  does  not  actually  imitate  the  behavior  he 
saw  in  the  film,  but  he  feels  freer  to  engage  in  previously  learned  behavior  of 
the  same  kind.  In  such  cases,  we  say  the  behavior  has  been  disinhibited.  Mod¬ 
els  may  also  inhibit  previously  learned  behavior,  as  when  a  girl  sees  a  boy 
punished  in  class  and  therefore  decides  to  check  her  impulse  to  do  something 
else  of  a  mischievous  nature  (Bandura  &  Walters,  1963,  p.  72;  Liebert  et  al., 
1977,  pp.  146-147). 


Gender  Roles 

During  socialization,  children  are  taught  to  behave  in  gender-appropriate 
ways.  Societies  encourage  boys  to  develop  "masculine"  traits  and  girls  to 
develop  "feminine"  traits. 

It  is  possible,  of  course,  that  gender  traits  are  also,  in  part,  genetically 
linked.  Social  learning  theorists  do  not  deny  this  possibility.  But  they  believe 
that  more  is  to  be  gained  from  the  study  of  socialization  processes  and  the  role 
of  imitation  in  particular  (Bandura  &  Walters,  1963,  pp.  26-29;  Mischel,  1970). 

In  the  learning  of  gender  roles,  the  acquisition/ performance  distinction 
is  especially  important  (Mischel,  1970).  Children  frequently  learn,  through 
observation,  the  behavior  of  both  genders;  however,  they  usually  perform 
only  the  behavior  appropriate  to  their  own  gender  because  this  is  what  they 
have  been  reinforced  to  do.  Margaret  Mead  (1964)  told  how  Eskimo  boys  are 
encouraged  to  practice  hunting  and  building  snow  houses,  whereas  the  girls 
are  not.  So,  ordinarily  only  the  boys  engage  in  these  activities.  But  the  girls 
watch  the  boys,  and  in  emergencies  they  can  execute  many  of  the  skills.  The 
girls  pick  up  the  skills  through  observation  alone  (see  Figure  1). 

It  is  also  possible,  though,  for  children  to  become  discouraged  with  respect 
to  opposite-gender  activities.  If  they  don't  get  much  opportunity  to  practice  the 
skills,  and  aren't  reinforced  for  them,  they  might  stop  paying  as  careful  atten¬ 
tion  to  them.  Sex-typed  social  reinforcement,  then,  might  have  a  negative  effect 
on  observation  itself  (Grusec  &  Brinker,  1972;  Maccoby  &  Wilson,  1957). 


Prosocial  Behavior 

Since  the  1970s  there  has  been  considerable  interest  in  the  nature  and  roots  of 
prosocial  behavior — acts  of  sharing,  helping,  cooperation,  and  altruism.  Social 
learning  theorists  have  taken  the  lead  in  this  area,  showing  that  prosocial 


216 


Bandura's  Social  Learning  Theory 


Figure  1 

This  young  girl  is  imitating  her  father.  After  a  while 
she  probably  will  find  that  she  receives  more  rein¬ 
forcement  for  imitating  females.  However,  she  still 
may  iearn  a  good  deal  about  "masculine"  skills 
from  observation  alone. 


behavior  can  be  readily  influenced  by  exposure  to  the  appropriate  models.  In 
a  typical  study  (Rushton,  1975),  7-  to  11-year-old  children  watched  an  adult 
model  play  a  bowling  game  and  donate  some  of  his  winnings  to  a  "needy 
children's  fund."  Immediately  afterward,  these  children  played  the  game 
alone,  and  they  themselves  made  many  donations — far  more  than  did  a  con¬ 
trol  group  who  had  not  seen  the  altruistic  model.  Furthermore,  the  children 
who  had  observed  the  model  still  donated  more  2  months  later,  even  when 
placed  in  a  different  room  with  a  different  experimenter.  Evidently,  even  a 
relatively  brief  exposure  to  a  generous  model  exerts  a  fairly  permanent  effect 
on  children's  sharing. 

Numerous  other  experiments  have  shown  that  models  influence  not 
only  children's  sharing  but  also  their  helpfulness  toward  others  in  distress, 
their  cooperativeness,  and  their  concern  for  the  feelings  of  others  (Bryan,  1975; 
Mussen  &  Eisenberg-Berg,  1977,  pp.  79-90).  The  experimental  findings  in  this 


217 


Bandura's  Social  Learning  Theory 


area  also  seem  supported  by  more  naturalistic  studies,  in  which  parental 
behavior  is  linked  to  their  children's  altruism  (DeHart  et  al.,  2004,  p.  353; 
Mussen  &  Eisenberg-Berg,  1977,  pp.  86-90). 

Practicing  and  Preaching.  Socializing  agents  teach  children  not  only 
by  behavioral  example  but  also  by  preaching  virtue  and  telling  children  how 
to  behave.  Such  verbal  techniques  have  been  most  fully  explored  in  research 
on  prosocial  behavior,  so  a  brief  review  might  be  in  order. 

First  of  all,  preaching  seems  ineffective  unless  it  is  forceful.  If  an  adult 
simply  says,  "It  is  nice  to  share,"  the  child  will  be  far  more  influenced  by  what 
the  adult  actually  does.  If  the  adult  shares,  so  will  the  child — regardless  of 
whether  the  adult  preaches  altruism  or  greed  (Bryan  &  Walbek,  1970).  When, 
however,  the  preaching  becomes  stronger,  taking  the  form  of  long  emotional 
sermons  and  commands,  it  can  be  effective  (Mussen  &  Eisenberg-Berg,  1977, 
pp.  151-152). 

Commands,  however,  are  coercive  and  may  backfire,  as  found  in  a  study 
by  G.  M.  White  (1972).  In  this  experiment  some  children  took  turns  bowling 
with  an  adult  who  told  them  to  share  some  of  their  winnings  with  needy  chil¬ 
dren.  Other  children  were  simply  given  the  opportunity  to  follow  an  altruistic 
example.  The  immediate  result  was  that  the  children  who  were  ordered  to  share 
did  so  to  a  greater  extent,  even  when  playing  alone.  In  a  posttest,  however,  these 
children's  sharing  decreased  sharply,  and  they  displayed  a  greater  incidence  of 
stealing,  perhaps  reflecting  their  resentment  against  the  coercive  technique. 


Self-Regulation 

As  people  become  socialized,  they  depend  less  on  external  rewards  and  punish¬ 
ments  and  increasingly  regulate  their  own  behavior.  That  is,  they  establish  their 
own  internal  standards  and  reward  and  punish  themselves  in  accordance  with 
them.  For  example,  a  woman  might  criticize  herself  for  a  moral  transgression 
that  no  one  else  is  even  aware  of.  She  punishes  herself  because  her  behavior 
violated  her  own  standards. 

Bandura  has  been  very  interested  in  how  people  evaluate  their  own  per¬ 
formances  as  they  strive  for  success  and  achievement.  Some  people  set  exceed¬ 
ingly  high  achievement  goals  and  reward  themselves  only  when  they  meet 
them.  An  artist,  for  example,  might  approve  of  his  own  work  only  after  he 
has  corrected  flaws  that  others  would  never  detect.  Others  are  satisfied  with 
less  perfect  work. 

How  are  self-evaluative  standards  acquired?  In  part,  Bandura  believes, 
they  are  the  product  of  direct  rewards  and  punishments.  For  example,  parents 
might  give  their  daughter  approval  only  when  she  earns  very  high  grades,  and 
after  a  while  she  adopts  this  high  standard  as  her  own. 

But  Bandura's  focus,  once  again,  has  been  on  the  influence  of  models. 
In  several  experiments,  Bandura  and  his  colleagues  (Bandura  &  Kupers, 


218 


Bandura's  Social  Learning  Theory 


1964;  Bandura,  1986,  pp.  341-342)  have  shown  that  children  and  adults  adopt 
the  self-evaluative  standards  they  observe  in  others.  For  example,  if  chil¬ 
dren  watch  an  adult  model  reward  himself  with  self-praise  and  candy  treats 
only  when  he  attains  a  high  score  in  bowling,  the  children  will  adopt  high 
self-evaluative  standards  when  it's  their  turn  to  bowl.  If,  in  contrast,  the 
children  observe  a  model  who  displays  low  self-evaluative  standards  (and 
gives  himself  treats  even  when  he  scores  poorly),  the  children  will  use  low 
standards  too. 

In  ordinary  life,  the  situation  is  more  complicated  because  children  are 
exposed  to  a  variety  of  models  (e.g.,  parents,  TV  characters,  and  peers),  some 
of  whom  exemplify  high  self-evaluative  standards  and  some  of  whom  do  not. 
Which  models  will  children  follow? 

Bandura  (1986,  pp.  342-343)  says  that  children  tend  to  adopt  the  self- 
evaluative  standards  of  peers  rather  than  adults  because  children  can  more 
easily  achieve  the  lower  standards  that  peers  set.  But  Bandura  also  points 
out  that  we  can  do  things  to  get  children  to  adopt  higher  standards.  For 
example,  we  can  encourage  children  to  associate  with  high-achieving  peers 
(peers  who  meet  high  self-evaluative  standards).  We  can  also  expose  chil¬ 
dren  to  models  who  are  rewarded  for  adhering  to  high  standards.  We  might 
read  children  stories  about  scientists  and  athletes  who  settled  for  nothing 
short  of  excellence  and  who  eventually  achieved  great  success  and  public 
acclaim. 

People  who  set  high  self-evaluative  standards  are  generally  hard  work¬ 
ers,  and  hard  work  produces  real  accomplishments.  At  the  same  time,  high 
goals  are  difficult  to  achieve,  and  people  who  set  high  goals  are  prone  to  dis¬ 
appointment  and  depression.  Such  people,  Bandura  says,  can  avoid  depres¬ 
sion  by  focusing  on  subgoals.  That  is,  instead  of  measuring  their  progress  in 
terms  of  distant  aims,  they  should  set  realistically  attainable  goals  for  each 
day  and  reward  themselves  when  they  achieve  them  (pp.  354, 359-360).  Like 
Locke,  Watson,  and  Skinner  before  him,  Bandura  recommends  a  method  of 
small  steps. 


SELF-EFFICACY 

When  we  regulate  our  own  behavior,  we  engage  in  self-observation.  We  eval¬ 
uate  our  ongoing  performances  in  terms  of  our  standards  and  goals.  On  other 
occasions,  we  reflect  on  our  general  abilities,  reaching  conclusions  such  as, 
"I'm  good  at  algebra"  and  "I'm  a  poor  swimmer."  Bandura  calls  such  general 
judgments  self-efficacy  appraisals  (1986,  chap.  9).  In  recent  years,  self-efficacy  has 
been  a  central  focus  of  Bandura's  work. 

Bandura  believes  that  our  self-efficacy  appraisals  exert  powerful  effects 
on  our  levels  of  motivation.  When  we  believe  we  are  good  at  tasks,  we  work 
on  them  vigorously  and  persist  with  them  despite  temporary  setbacks.  When 


219 


Bandura's  Social  Learning  Theory 


we  doubt  our  abilities,  we  work  less  energetically  and  are  more  likely  to  give 
up  when  we  encounter  difficulties  (p.  394). 

The  importance  of  perceived  self-efficacy  was  demonstrated  in  an  experi¬ 
ment  by  Collins  (1982,  cited  in  Bandura,  1986,  p.  391).  Collins  divided  children 
into  two  groups  according  to  their  level  of  ability  in  mathematics,  and  he  also 
asked  the  children  about  their  own  opinions  of  their  abilities.  Collins  then  gave 
all  the  children  some  difficult  problems.  As  we  would  expect,  the  children  in 
the  high-ability  group  outperformed  those  in  the  low-ability  group.  But  per¬ 
ceived  self-efficacy  also  had  an  effect.  Within  each  ability  group,  the  children 
who  believed  they  were  good  at  math  solved  more  problems,  chose  to  work  on 
more  of  the  problems  they  failed,  and  displayed  a  more  positive  attitude  toward 
mathematics. 

It  is  possible,  of  course,  to  have  too  high  an  estimate  of  one's  abilities.  This 
is  especially  true  when  physical  injury  can  result.  If  we  overestimate  our  abil¬ 
ity  to  ski  down  a  steep  slope,  we  could  be  seriously  hurt.  In  general,  however, 
Bandura  believes  it's  good  to  overestimate  our  capacities  and  our  belief  we  will 
succeed.  Life  is  strewn  with  difficulties — disappointments,  setbacks,  impedi¬ 
ments,  inequities.  Optimistic  self-efficacy  is  therefore  beneficial:  "Tenacious 
strivers  believe  so  strongly  in  themselves  that  they  are  able  to  exert  extraordi¬ 
nary  effort  and  suffer  countless  reversals  in  pursuit  of  their  vision"  (Bandura, 
1998,  p.  57). 


Sources  of  Self-Efficacy  Appraisals 

Bandura  (1986,  pp.  399-408)  suggests  that  self-efficacy  appraisals  are  based  on 
four  sources  of  information. 

1.  The  most  influential  source  of  knowledge  is  actual  performance.  If  we 
repeatedly  succeed  at  tasks,  our  sense  of  efficacy  increases.  If  we  repeat¬ 
edly  fail,  our  sense  of  efficacy  drops.  Once  we  have  developed  a  robust 
sense  of  self-efficacy  in  an  area,  we  are  not  too  troubled  by  temporary  set¬ 
backs.  We  are  likely  to  attribute  failures  to  our  lack  of  effort  or  to  poor  tac¬ 
tics  and  to  try  again.  And  if  we  succeed,  our  sense  of  efficacy  goes  up  even 
higher. 

2.  Self-efficacy  appraisals  are  also  influenced  by  vicarious  experiences.  If 
we  see  others  succeed  at  a  task,  we  infer  that  we  can  do  it  too.  This  is  especially 
true  if  we  believe  others  have  roughly  the  same  abilities  as  we  do. 

3.  Another  variable  is  verbal  persuasion — pep  talks.  When  someone  con¬ 
vinces  us  we  can  perform  a  task,  we  usually  do  better  on  it.  Pep  talks  cannot, 
of  course,  enable  us  to  accomplish  tasks  that  are  far  too  difficult.  But  outside 
encouragement  can  help,  largely  because  success  usually  depends  more  on  the 
effort  we  put  into  a  task  than  on  any  inherent  ability. 


220 


Bandura's  Social  Learning  Theory 


4.  Finally,  we  judge  our  abilities  partly  on  the  basis  of  physiological  cues. 
For  example,  we  might  interpret  fatigue  or  tension  as  signs  that  a  task  is 
becoming  too  difficult  for  us.  At  the  same  time,  people  often  react  differently 
to  the  same  bodily  cues.  One  girl,  warming  up  for  the  400-meter  race,  may 
interpret  her  anxiety  as  a  sign  that  she  is  too  tense  to  do  well.  Another  girl 
may  interpret  the  same  bodily  cues  as  an  indication  that  she  is  getting  "fired 
up,"  that  her  "adrenaline  is  flowing,"  and  that  she  is  ready  to  do  her  best. 

Bandura  (1994)  has  sketched  out,  in  a  very  preliminary  way,  the  devel¬ 
opment  of  self-efficacy  over  the  life  span.  Infants  develop  a  sense  of  self- 
efficacy  as  they  explore  the  environment  and  get  the  sense  that  they  can  have 
some  control  over  it.  As  children  grow,  their  social  world  widens.  They  look 
to  peers  as  models  of  self-efficacy  and  also  as  sources  of  social  comparison. 
Teenagers  evaluate  their  efficacy  in  new  areas,  including  dating.  Young  adults 
must  evaluate  new  capacities  as  workers  and  parents,  and  older  people 
reassess  their  abilities  as  they  adjust  to  retirement  and  create  a  new  lifestyle. 
Throughout  life,  a  resilient  sense  of  self-efficacy  keeps  people  moving  for¬ 
ward  with  energy  and  vitality.  When  self-efficacy  is  low,  people  are  prone  to 
depression,  resignation,  and  painful  self-doubts. 


ABSTRACT  MODELING  AND  PIAGET’S  STAGES 

In  the  course  of  his  writing,  Bandura  has  expanded  on  the  meaning  of  imi¬ 
tation.  Ordinarily,  Bandura  (1971)  observes,  psychologists  think  of  model¬ 
ing  as  a  process  of  exact  imitation.  Exact  imitation  occurs,  for  example, 
when  a  child  tries  to  imitate  a  friend's  precise  behavior,  such  as  the  friend's 
way  of  writing  the  letter  L.  But  children  also  engage  in  abstract  modeling; 
they  induce  the  general  rules  or  principles  underlying  particular  behav¬ 
iors,  and  they  then  use  these  rules  to  generate  entirely  new  behavior  on 
their  own.  For  example,  English-speaking  children  induce,  from  all  the 
language  they  hear,  that  the  rule  for  forming  the  plural  is  to  add  the  s  sound, 
and  they  then  use  the  rule  to  generate  countless  new  sentences.  Similarly, 
Bandura  says,  children  induce  the  kinds  of  concepts  that  Piaget  has  discussed. 
By  observing  a  model,  a  child  might  induce  a  new  moral  rule  or  the  principle 
of  conservation. 

To  some  extent,  Bandura  views  abstract  modeling  in  a  Piagetian  vein. 
Like  Piaget,  Bandura  sees  the  child  as  an  active  agent;  the  child  induces  rules 
and  grasps  concepts.  But  Bandura's  emphasis  is  much  more  on  the  way  the 
external  environment — especially  models — influences  the  kinds  of  concepts 
children  learn.  Later  we  review  some  of  the  research  by  Bandura  and  his 
colleagues  on  how  models  might  influence  children's  conceptual  develop¬ 
ment.  But  first,  let  us  compare  the  theories  of  Piaget  and  Bandura  a  bit  more 
thoroughly. 


221 


Bandura's  Social  Learning  Theory 


Bandura  and  Piaget 

Piaget,  you  will  recall,  thought  that  children  learn  much  on  their  own,  from 
an  intrinsic  interest  in  the  world.  Children  are  especially  curious  about  stim¬ 
uli  that  are  moderately  novel,  that  do  not  quite  fit  into  their  existing  cognitive 
structures.  When,  for  example,  our  son  Tom  was  11  months  old,  he  could 
grasp  many  things  with  his  hands,  so  he  was  surprised  to  discover  one  day 
that  he  couldn't  grasp  water.  He  kept  trying  and  failing,  intently  studying  the 
way  the  water  responded  to  his  actions.  Tom  was  not  motivated  by  adult 
approval  or  any  other  external  reinforcement.  He  was  engrossed  in  the  prob¬ 
lem  itself.  And  because  he  was  so  interested  in  the  problem,  he  continued  to 
work  on  it,  and  over  the  next  several  months  he  invented  some  ways  of  hold¬ 
ing  water. 

In  Piaget's  view,  then,  children  construct  their  own  cognitive  structures 
as  they  work  on  intrinsically  interesting  problems.  In  the  process,  their  think¬ 
ing  undergoes  a  series  of  broad  transformations  called  stages.  These  stages, 
in  turn,  indicate  the  kinds  of  new  problems  children  will  find  most  interest¬ 
ing;  for  they  continue  to  be  most  curious  about  events  and  activities  that  are 
just  beyond  their  current  level.  This  principle  of  moderate  discrepancy  holds 
for  imitation  too;  children  are  spontaneously  interested  in  models  whose 
behavior  is  slightly  more  complex  than  their  own  (Kohlberg,  1966b;  1969a, 
p.  434;  Kuhn,  1974).  This  is  why  we  often  see  children  tagging  along  after 
somewhat  older  ones,  trying  to  do  the  same  things.  Thus  Piagetians  do  not 
spend  much  time  examining  the  modeling  influences  in  a  child's  life;  they 
study,  instead,  the  child's  cognitive  behavior  at  each  stage,  for  the  child's  stage 
determines  the  kinds  of  models  the  child  will  seek  out. 

Bandura,  in  contrast,  is  much  more  of  an  environmentalist.  It  is  appeal¬ 
ing,  he  says,  to  imagine  children  making  their  own  discoveries  and  creating 
their  own  ideas.  In  reality,  however,  children's  minds  are  structured  by  the 
environment,  by  the  models  and  the  social  training  practices  the  environment 
provides  (Bandura,  1977,  p.  183;  Bandura  &  Walters,  1963,  p.  44). 

In  some  major  works  (1977, 1986, 1997),  Bandura  has  softened  his  envi¬ 
ronmentalism  somewhat.  He  talks  about  "reciprocal  influences"  among  indi¬ 
viduals,  their  behavior,  and  the  environment.  But  Bandura  is  still  much  more 
an  environmentalist  than  Piaget,  and  Bandura  continues  to  raise  strong  objec¬ 
tions  to  Piagetian  theory.  Specifically,  he  disagrees  with  two  basic  Piagetian 
tenets. 

First,  Bandura  doubts  that  children  learn  much  on  their  own,  out  of  an 
intrinsic  interest  in  moderately  novel  events.  He  says  that  if  children  were 
motivated  to  figure  out  everything  that  is  slightly  beyond  their  grasp,  they 
would  be  learning  all  the  time.  But  this  is  not  the  case.  If  we  want  children 
to  learn,  we  must  motivate  them  and  assist  them.  We  must  teach  them  things, 
administer  rewards  and  punishments,  and  provide  them  with  appropriate 
models.  After  a  while,  to  be  sure,  children  do  become  self-motivated  learn¬ 
ers.  But  this  does  not  mean  they  now  learn  for  learning's  sake,  because  of 


222 


Bandura's  Social  Learning  Theory 


their  natural  curiosity  about  the  world.  Rather,  they  learn  to  meet  their  inter¬ 
nal  achievement  standards  (for  example,  to  master  90%  of  the  material  on  a 
test).  These  internal  standards,  moreover,  are  themselves  the  products  of 
social  teaching  and  modeling  influences  (Bandura,  1986,  pp.  340,  480-488; 
1989,  pp.  8-9,  34-35). 

Bandura  (1997,  p.  219)  acknowledges  that  intrinsic  interest  does  exist. 
But  he  says  it  occurs  after  we  meet  our  achievement  standards  and  develop 
feelings  of  self-efficacy.  For  example,  after  we  do  well  in  biology  courses,  we 
begin  to  enjoy  the  subject  matter  itself.  But  intrinsic  interest  is  not  primary. 

Second,  Bandura  questions  the  validity  of  Piagetian  stages.  At  first  the 
stages  seem  plausible  because  children  do  often  master  material  in  sequences. 
But  this  is  only  because  people  usually  solve  easier  problems  before  they  solve 
more  difficult  ones.  There  is  nothing  special  about  Piaget's  stage  sequences, 
and  they  are  not  as  absolute  as  he  claims. 

Moreover,  the  stage  concept  implies  that  thinking  becomes  organized 
and  reorganized  into  broad  unitary  structures  that  underlie  children's  think¬ 
ing  across  a  wide  range  of  tasks.  For  example,  the  child  at  the  stage  of  concrete 
operations  should  apply  the  same  logical  operations  to  a  wide  variety  of  prob¬ 
lems.  But  stages  in  this  sense,  Bandura  argues,  do  not  exist.  Thinking  actu¬ 
ally  consists  of  numerous  discrete  skills  that  vary  from  one  cognitive  domain 
to  the  next.  For  example,  reading,  writing,  and  arithmetic  all  involve  many  of 
their  own  particular  skills  and  subskills.  Piagetian  stages,  which  lump  chil¬ 
dren's  thinking  into  broad  categories,  tell  us  little  about  the  particular  think¬ 
ing  skills  in  each  area  (Bandura,  1986,  pp.  484-485). 

Bandura  argues,  then,  that  Piaget's  view  of  development  is  false.  Chil¬ 
dren  do  not  primarily  learn  on  their  own,  nor  does  their  thinking  undergo 
broad  stage  transformations. 

Bandura's  opposition  to  Piaget  is  long  standing,  and  Bandura  and  his 
colleagues  have  conducted  some  classic  studies  that  were  designed  to 
demonstrate  the  superiority  of  their  theory.  In  one,  Bandura  and  McDonald 
(1963)  tried  to  show  that  modeling  influences  can  alter  Piaget's  stages  of 
moral  reasoning. 


Moral  Reasoning.  Piaget,  you  will  recall,  proposed  a  two-stage  theory 
of  moral  judgment,  one  aspect  of  which  concerns  consequences  versus  inten¬ 
tions.  That  is,  younger  children  tend  to  judge  wrongdoing  in  terms  of  its  con¬ 
sequences,  whereas  older  children  base  their  judgments  on  the  intentions 
behind  the  act.  For  example,  a  young  child  is  likely  to  say  that  a  boy  who 
made  a  large  ink  spot  trying  to  help  his  dad  is  naughtier  than  one  who  made 
a  small  ink  spot  when  playing  around.  The  young  child  focuses  on  the  con¬ 
sequences — the  amount  of  damage.  The  older  child,  in  contrast,  usually  puts 
more  weight  on  the  underlying  motive. 

Bandura  gave  5-  to  11-year-old  children  12  such  items  and  found  the  age 
shift  that  Piaget  and  others  (Kohlberg,  1969a)  have  documented.  However, 


223 


Bandura's  Social  Learning  Theory 


Bandura  emphasized,  children  of  all  ages  evidenced  at  least  some  reasoning 
of  both  kinds,  suggesting  the  stages  are  not  rigidly  demarcated. 

Following  this  pretest,  Bandura  tried  to  show  that  the  children's  think¬ 
ing  could  be  altered  by  modeling  influences.  In  a  key  part  of  the  experiment, 
children  individually  observed  an  adult  model  who  was  praised  for  giving 
responses  contrary  to  their  own  dominant  mode.  If,  for  example,  a  child  had 
typically  judged  wrongdoing  in  terms  of  intentions,  the  model  always  based 
her  judgment  on  the  consequences.  An  experimenter  presented  the  model 
with  a  moral  dilemma,  praised  her  when  she  gave  her  answer,  and  gave  the 
child  a  turn  on  a  new  item.  Taking  turns  in  this  way,  the  model  and  child  each 
responded  to  12  new  items  (different  from  the  pretest  items). 

This  training  procedure  did  have  a  strong  effect.  Prior  to  the  training, 
children  gave  one  type  of  moral  response  only  about  20%  of  the  time;  during 
the  treatment,  this  number  increased  to  an  average  of  about  50%. 

The  experiment  also  included  an  immediate  posttest  in  which  the  chil¬ 
dren  responded  once  again  to  the  pretest  items.  The  results  indicated  that  the 
children  persisted  with  their  new  mode  of  responding  (about  38%  to  53%  of 
the  time). 

The  study,  Bandura  says,  shows  that  "the  so-called  developmental  stages 
were  readily  altered  by  the  provision  of  adult  models"  (Bandura  &  Walters, 
1963,  p.  209).  There  seems  to  be  nothing  fixed  or  invariant  about  them. 

Cognitive  developmentalists  have  viewed  the  study  suspiciously.  They 
acknowledge  that  modeling  can  influence  cognitive  stages,  but  the  influence 
should  be  small.  This  is  because  stages  represent  broad,  deeply  rooted  cogni¬ 
tive  structures.  We  cannot,  in  theory,  effortlessly  get  a  child  to  reason  in  any 
way  we  wish.  And  when  we  do  produce  change,  it  should  be  primarily  in  the 
direction  of  the  stage  sequence — one  stage  forward.  Several  experiments  have, 
in  fact,  found  that  these  are  the  kinds  of  changes  that  do  occur  when 
Kohlberg's,  rather  than  Piaget's,  stages  are  used  (Gardner,  1982,  p.  219).  This, 
Kohlberg  (1969a)  argued,  is  because  his  stages  represent  broader  cognitive 
structures  than  Piaget's  moral  stages  do,  so  his  are  harder  to  change.  However, 
as  Bandura  (1986,  pp.  494-496)  notes,  the  modeling  influences  in  these  stud¬ 
ies  were  brief  and  weak. 

We  can  see,  then,  that  Bandura's  experiment  has  stirred  up  a  good 
deal  of  controversy.  He  has  presented  a  serious  challenge  to  cognitive  stage 
theory. 

Conservation.  Social  learning  theorists  have  also  tried  to  show  that 
conservation  can  be  altered  through  modeling.  In  some  key  experiments, 
Rosenthal  and  Zimmerman  (1972;  Zimmerman  &  Rosenthal,  1974)  reported 
that  5-  and  6-year-olds  gained  significant  mastery  of  conservation  on  a  battery 
of  tasks  (including  liquid,  number,  and  weight)  after  they  observed  an  adult 
model  demonstrate  conservation  reasoning.  However,  the  investigators  found 
that  4-year-olds  gained  conservation  skills  only  to  a  modest  degree. 


224 


Bandura's  Social  Learning  Theory 


Rosenthal  and  Zimmerman's  interpretation  of  the  results  indicates  the 
way  researchers'  conclusions  reflect  their  theoretical  orientations.  The 
researchers  concluded  that  the  modeling  produced  rapid  and  substantial 
change  in  conservation  behavior.  Conservation  skills,  they  believe,  are  prob¬ 
ably  the  product  of  socialization — of  the  teachings  of  adults  in  the  child's  cul¬ 
ture.  Developmentalists  would  be  more  skeptical  and  would  point  to  the 
weaker  results  with  children  who  were  not  ready  to  benefit  from  the  model¬ 
ing  experience. 


PRACTICAL  IMPLICATIONS 

Bandura's  work  should  do  a  good  deal  to  increase  our  awareness  of  the  impor¬ 
tance  of  models  in  child  rearing  and  education.  Although  most  parents  and 
teachers  are  already  somewhat  aware  of  the  fact  that  they  teach  by  example, 
they  probably  have  also  overlooked  just  how  influential  modeling  can  be. 
A  case  in  point  is  physical  punishment.  Many  parents  try  to  prevent  their 
children  from  fighting  by  spanking  them  when  they  fight — only  to  find,  it 
seems,  that  their  children  fight  all  the  more  (Bandura  &  Walters,  1963,  p.  129). 
The  likely  explanation  is  that  the  parents,  by  spanking,  are  inadvertently  pro¬ 
viding  a  good  demonstration  of  how  to  hurt  others  (Bandura,  1967).  Similarly, 
whenever  we  find  that  we  are  unable  to  rid  a  child  of  some  distressing  bit  of 
behavior,  we  might  ask  whether  we  have  been  inadvertently  modeling  the 
behavior  ourselves. 

Modeling,  according  to  Bandura,  takes  many  forms.  The  familiar  kind 
is  behavioral  modeling;  we  exemplify  an  activity  by  performing  it.  Model¬ 
ing  may  also  be  done  verbally,  as  when  we  give  instructions  or  issue  com¬ 
mands.  Social  learning  researchers  have  evaluated  the  effectiveness  of  the 
various  kinds  of  modeling,  and  their  findings  should  be  of  importance  to 
parents  and  educators.  Of  particular  interest  are  studies  such  as  G.  M.  White's 
(1972),  which  examined  the  effects  of  commanding  children  to  share.  At  first, 
the  commands  seemed  to  work,  but  their  impact  diminished  over  time,  and 
the  commands  also  produced  resentment  and  rebelliousness.  In  the  long 
run,  we  may  do  better  simply  to  model  generosity  and  helpfulness  through 
our  own  behavior.  Then  children  can  follow  our  example  without  feeling 
forced  to  do  so. 

Social  learning  theorists  have  also  shown  that  behavior  is  influenced  not 
only  by  personal  or  live  models  but  also  by  those  presented  in  the  mass  media. 
Filmed  models,  in  particular,  seem  to  exert  a  powerful  impact,  and  one  major 
implication  is  that  television,  which  many  children  watch  for  hours  on  end, 
is  shaping  young  lives.  Social  learning  theorists  have  been  especially  con¬ 
cerned  with  the  effects  that  televised  violence  has  on  children,  and  there  is 
substantial  evidence  that  it  can,  in  fact,  increase  children's  aggressiveness  in 
their  daily  lives  (Anderson  &  Gentile,  2008;  Kirsh,  2006). 


225 


Bandura's  Social  Learning  Theory 


The  kinds  of  models  presented  in  the  mass  media  have  been  of  concern 
to  leaders  of  historically  disenfranchised  groups.  Civil  rights  leaders  and  fem¬ 
inists  have  pointed  out  that  television  and  motion  pictures  have  traditionally 
depicted  people  of  color  and  women  in  stereotyped  roles,  and,  by  doing  so, 
have  restricted  people's  sense  of  what  they  might  become  in  life.  Accordingly, 
activists  have  tried  to  get  the  media  to  present  new  kinds  of  models,  such  as 
women  and  people  of  color  as  scientists  and  environmentalists  rather  than 
housewives  and  criminals.  The  social  learning  research  suggests  that  the 
activists  have  adopted  a  good  strategy  for  social  change. 

Because  modeling  can  have  a  strong  impact  on  behavior,  it  has  signifi¬ 
cant  promise  as  a  therapeutic  device.  You  might  recall  that  in  Mary  Cover 
Jones's  (1924)  famous  experiment,  modeling  was  part  of  the  method  used  to 
eliminate  Peter's  fear  of  furry  objects.  Bandura  and  others  have  conducted  a 
number  of  studies  that  have  more  systematically  shown  how  modeling  can 
help  reduce  fears.  In  one  experiment  (Bandura,  Grusec,  &  Menlove,  1967),  for 
example,  4-year-olds  who  were  afraid  of  dogs  observed  a  child  calmly  play 
with  one,  and  then  the  children  themselves  became  less  fearful. 

Bandura  (1986)  urges  therapists  to  pay  special  attention  to  self-efficacy 
appraisals  when  they  diagnose  and  treat  their  clients.  For  example,  Bandura 
believes  that  whatever  technique  a  therapist  uses  to  treat  a  phobia — whether 
it  is  modeling  or  some  other  technique — the  treatment  will  work  best  if  it 
gives  the  client  the  sense  that  he  or  she  has  the  ability  to  deal  with  the  feared 
stimulus.  Similarly,  techniques  for  dealing  with  pain,  such  as  relaxation  or 
guided  imagery,  work  best  when  they  give  clients  the  feeling  they  are  capable 
of  influencing  the  amount  of  pain  they  feel  (pp.  425-445). 

Pediatricians  have  found  self-efficacy  theory  valuable  in  the  treatment 
of  children  with  asthma.  Too  often,  doctors  simply  tell  parents  what  to  do  at 
home,  and  then  the  doctors  complain  that  the  parents  do  not  adhere  to  the 
plan.  Doctors  have  obtained  better  results  when  they  pay  attention  to  the  par¬ 
ents'  feelings  of  self-efficacy.  Because  the  parents  often  feel  helpless  with 
respect  to  their  children's  asthma,  health-care  workers  model  the  ways  the 
parents  can  remove  allergens  from  the  home,  give  the  parents  positive  feed¬ 
back,  and  help  them  believe  they  can  be  effective  (Hussain-Rizvi,  Kunkov,  & 
Crain,  2009). 

Bandura  (1994)  also  has  called  attention  to  the  social  conditions  that 
undermine  self-efficacy.  He  observes  that  standard  school  practices  such  as 
ranking  and  competitive  grading  make  many  children  feel  inadequate.  It 
would  be  better  if  children  worked  more  cooperatively  and  could  judge  their 
work  according  to  their  own  individual  progress  (rather  than  against  that  of 
other  pupils).  Bandura  adds  that  it  is  important  for  teachers  to  feel  self-efficacy 
as  well.  When  they  believe  their  work  will  have  an  effect,  their  confidence 
serves  as  a  model  for  their  children. 

More  broadly,  Bandura  (1998)  is  worried  about  the  impersonality  of 
our  technological  society,  and  the  difficulty  any  individual  has  changing  it. 


226 


Bandura's  Social  Learning  Theory 


Self-efficacy  in  the  modern  world,  he  speculates,  must  become  collective 
self-efficacy — people  working  together  for  change. 


EVALUATION 

Bandura's  work  has  changed  over  the  years.  Initially,  he  wanted  to  show  how 
the  Skinnerian  model,  in  which  one  must  act  to  learn,  is  inadequate.  Learning 
also  includes  the  observation  of  models,  which  is  a  cognitive  process.  In  this 
early  work,  Bandura  focused  clearly  on  the  power  of  modeling  influences, 
and  he  and  his  colleagues  devised  a  series  of  brilliant  experiments  to  show  just 
how  powerful  models  can  be.  In  1977  he  wrote. 

One  can  get  people  to  behave  altruistically,  to  volunteer  their  services, 
to  delay  or  to  seek  gratification,  to  show  affection,  to  behave  punitively, 
to  prefer  certain  foods  or  apparel,  to  converse  on  particular  topics,  to  be 
inquisitive  or  passive,  and  to  engage  in  most  any  course  of  action  by 
having  such  conduct  exemplified,  (p.  88) 

In  more  recent  years,  especially  since  the  mid-1980s,  Bandura's  theory  has 
become  increasingly  eclectic  and  wide  ranging.  In  his  recent  self-efficacy  the¬ 
ory,  Bandura  considers  modeling  influences  to  be  less  powerful  than  suc¬ 
cessful  performances  (in  which  the  person  achieves  results  through  hard 
work),  and  Bandura  speculates  about  the  broad  social  context  in  which  self- 
efficacy  develops. 

Still,  the  theme  of  modeling  runs  throughout  his  work,  and  modeling, 
together  with  the  general  social  environmental  orientation,  has  presented  a  sig¬ 
nificant  challenge  to  the  developmental  position.  It  is  therefore  useful  to  more 
fully  consider  the  reaction  of  developmentalists  to  his  work. 

Develop  men  talists  recognize  that  environments  influence  behavior,  and 
often  in  the  ways  that  Bandura  has  specified.  But  developmentalists  place  a 
high  value  on  the  kinds  of  growth  that  emerge  from  within  the  child — from 
the  child's  inner  maturational  promptings  and  spontaneous  interests  in  the 
world.  Bandura  has  generally  minimized  the  importance  of  such  growth. 

Among  the  developmentalists,  it  has  been  the  Piagetians  who  have 
become  most  embroiled  in  debates  with  Bandura.  Piagetians  believe  that  chil¬ 
dren  learn  from  a  spontaneous  interest  in  moderately  novel  events.  Bandura 
(1986,  pp.  480-482)  has  dismissed  this  suggestion.  Children,  he  says,  really 
learn  in  order  to  obtain  reinforcements,  such  as  praise,  which  they  eventually 
come  to  administer  to  themselves.  But  Bandura's  own  research  may  contra¬ 
dict  his  argument.  In  several  experiments,  models  perform  what  he  calls 
"moderately  novel"  or  "relatively  unique"  behaviors  (Bandura,  1962,  pp.  250, 
252;  1965b,  p.  116).  Models  sock  Bobo  dolls,  march  about,  knock  objects  off 


227 


Bandura's  Social  Learning  Theory 


shelves,  and  engage  in  other  zany  physical  antics.  As  Kohlberg  (1969a,  p.  435) 
pointed  out,  these  behaviors  seem  intuitively  designed  to  capture  the  imagi¬ 
nation  of  4-year-olds,  and  in  several  experiments  the  children  readily  imi¬ 
tated  the  behaviors  even  though  there  were  no  reinforcements  available 
(Bandura,  1965b;  Bandura  &  Huston,  1961;  Bandura,  Ross,  &  Ross,  1963). 
Quite  possibly,  the  children  reproduced  such  behaviors  because  they  found 
them  intrinsically  interesting.  Reinforcement  variables,  to  be  sure,  can  increase 
or  alter  imitation,  but  a  spontaneous  interest  in  moderate  novelty  might  also 
be  at  work. 

Bandura  (1986,  pp.  480-482)  argues  that  the  principle  of  moderate  nov¬ 
elty  does  not  fit  with  everyday  observations.  If  people  learned  from  their 
intrinsic  interest  in  moderately  novel  events,  they  would  be  learning  all  the 
time;  for  they  are  constantly  encountering  slightly  new  information.  But, 
Bandura  says,  people  in  general  are  not  eager  learners.  They  usually  restrict 
their  learning  to  one  or  two  areas  of  life,  such  as  their  areas  of  occupational 
expertise. 

Piagetians  (e.g.,  Kamii,  1980)  and  other  developmentalists  (e.g.,  Montes- 
sori,  1936b)  would  agree  that  people  often  seem  to  be  fairly  apathetic  when  it 
comes  to  learning.  But  this  observation  does  not  prove  that  humans  have  no 
intrinsic  interest  in  the  world.  Rather,  the  observation  shows  that  the  child's 
natural  curiosity  has  been  stifled. 

Children,  in  the  developmental  view,  begin  life  full  of  enthusiasm  for 
learning,  and  during  the  first  few  years  they  learn  a  tremendous  amount  on 
their  own,  without  adult  instruction.  Then  adults  get  hold  of  them,  sending 
them  to  schools  and  taking  charge  of  their  learning.  Adults  provide  them  with 
modeling  influences  and  teach  them  what  and  how  to  think.  Children  feel  the 
pressure  to  please  grownups  and  try  to  think  in  the  ways  the  adults  prescribe. 
As  a  result,  children  stop  pursuing  their  spontaneous  interests  and  lose  the 
thrill  that  comes  from  making  their  own  discoveries. 

Bandura  says  that  he,  too,  believes  in  self-motivated  learning,  but  of  a  dif¬ 
ferent  kind.  People,  in  Bandura's  view,  do  not  learn  out  of  a  spontaneous  inter¬ 
est  in  the  world,  but  to  achieve  their  internal  goals  and  standards.  Children 
internalize  external  standards  and  make  their  own  positive  self-evaluations 
contingent  on  the  achievement  of  these  standards.  For  example,  a  college 
student,  studying  for  exams,  might  only  be  pleased  with  herself  when  she  is 
certain  she  has  mastered  enough  material  to  earn  straight  A's.  Bandura  (1997, 
p.  219)  says  that  people  enjoy  learning  for  its  own  sake  after  they  start  meet¬ 
ing  their  internal  standards  and  feeling  good  about  their  abilities. 

I  believe  Bandura  sheds  light  on  the  kind  of  learning  that  is  dominant  in 
our  society  today.  We  do  seem  to  constantly  set  standards  and  evaluate  our 
progress  and  abilities.  But  such  extensive  self-evaluation  is  confining  and 
debilitating.  We  become  so  wrapped  up  in  ourselves  that  we  lose  touch  with 
the  childlike  delight  in  the  world  itself — in  nature,  other  people,  art,  and  the 
world  as  we  find  it. 


228 


Bandura's  Social  Learning  Theory 


Piagetians  also  believe  Bandura  overlooks  the  importance  of  cognitive 
structures  or  stages.  Bandura  acknowledges  that  cognitive  skills  set  limits  on 
what  children  can  learn  and  imitate,  but  he  does  not  believe  these  skills  belong 
to  broad  stage  structures.  Instead,  he  believes  the  cognition  consists  of  a  large 
number  of  specific,  isolated  skills. 

Bandura's  position  has  its  supporters,  but  the  issue  is  still  very  unsettled. 
Piaget's  stages,  despite  certain  problems,  are  important. 

In  fact,  social  learning  research  itself  occasionally  suggests  that  the  child's 
general  stage  is  at  work.  For  example,  Liebert  and  his  colleagues  (1969)  found 
that  14-year-olds,  but  not  8-  or  6-year-olds,  could  imitate  a  new  grammatical 
rule.  The  oldest  subjects  were  able  to  figure  out  the  rule  underlying  the  model's 
behavior  because  they  had  capacities  for  abstract  thinking  that  the  younger 
children  lacked.  They  had,  it  seems,  formal  operations. 

It  might  be,  then,  that  Bandura  underestimates  the  importance  of  devel¬ 
opmental  variables.  He  certainly  seems  to  overlook  the  extent  to  which  chil¬ 
dren  learn  on  their  own,  from  an  intrinsic  interest  in  the  world.  He  might 
also  overlook  the  extent  to  which  modeling  is  influenced  by  cognitive  stages. 
Nevertheless,  Bandura  has  significantly  broadened  learning  theory  and  con¬ 
tributed  enormously  to  our  understanding  of  how  environmental  factors 
shape  behavior. 


229 


This  page  intentionally  left  blank 


Vygotsky’s 
Social-Historical 
Theory  of  Cognitive 
Development 


From  Theories  of  Development:  Concepts  and  Applications,  Sixth  Edition.  William 
Crain.  Copyright  ©  2011  by  Pearson  Education,  Inc.  Published  by  Pearson 
Prentice  Hall.  All  rights  reserved. 


231 


Vygotsky’s 
Social-Historical 
Theory  of  Cognitive 
Development 


BIOGRAPHICAL  INTRODUCTION 

This  book  focuses  on  theorists  in  the  developmental  tradition — scholars 
who  have  seen  developmental  change  primarily  in  terms  of  inner  forces. 
For  example,  Gesell  emphasized  inner  maturational  promptings  and 
Piaget  saw  children  making  their  own  discoveries.  By  way  of  contrast, 
we  have  also  examined  the  ideas  of  learning  theorists,  who  have  empha¬ 
sized  the  role  of  the  external  environment. 

Some  of  you  may  be  dissatisfied  with  this  theoretical  division. 
Why,  you  might  ask,  must  we  view  development  in  either/ or  terms? 
Can't  a  theory  assign  major  roles  to  both  inner  and  outer  forces? 

The  construction  of  such  an  integrative  theory  is  a  worthy  goal, 
but  few  people  have  made  much  progress  in  attaining  it.  Bandura,  as 
we  saw,  pronounces  behavior  to  be  multidetermined — to  be  influenced 
by  various  internal  and  external  variables — but  he  also  discredits  the 
developmental  perspective  on  how  change  comes  from  within.  Later 
we  will  discuss  the  ways  Freud  and  Erikson  weave  inner  and  outer 
forces  into  their  psychoanalytic  theories.  In  the  realm  of  cognitive  devel¬ 
opment,  the  major  theorist  who  discussed  both  developmental  and 
environmental  forces  was  the  Russian  L.  S.  Vygotsky  (1896-1934). 

Vygotsky  had  read  the  early  writings  of  Gesell,  Werner,  and 
Piaget,  and  he  recognized  the  importance  of  the  kinds  of  intrinsic 
development  they  were  addressing.  At  the  same  time,  Vygotsky  was  a 
Marxist  who  believed  that  we  can  understand  human  beings  only  in  the 
context  of  the  social-historical  environment.  So  Vygotsky  tried  to  cre¬ 
ate  a  theory  that  allowed  for  the  interplay  between  the  two  lines  of 


232 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


development — the  natural  line  that  emerges  from  within  and  the  social-historical 
line  that  influences  the  child  from  without  (Vygotsky,  1931a,  p.  17). 

Vygotsky  was  only  partly  successful.  He  had  only  sketched  out  an  inte¬ 
grative  theory  of  development  when,  at  the  age  of  38,  his  life  was  cut  short  by 
tuberculosis.  Nevertheless,  many  psychologists  believe  that  if  we  eventually  do 
construct  a  solid  integrative  theory,  it  will  build  on  the  start  Vygotsky  gave  us. 

Lev  Semenovich  Vygotsky  grew  up  in  Gomel,  a  port  city  in  western 
Russia.  His  father  was  a  banking  executive,  and  his  mother  was  a  teacher, 
although  she  spent  most  of  her  life  raising  her  eight  children.  The  family  loved 
interesting  conversation,  a  trait  that  rubbed  off  on  the  young  Vygotsky.  As  a 
teenager,  he  was  known  among  his  friends  as  the  "little  professor"  because  he 
was  constantly  leading  them  in  discussions,  mock  trials,  and  debates.  Vygot¬ 
sky  also  loved  to  read  history,  literature,  and  poetry  (Wertsch,  1985,  pp.  3-4). 

When  he  was  17,  Vygotsky  wanted  to  attend  the  University  of  Moscow, 
but  because  he  was  Jewish  he  had  to  struggle  with  the  state's  quota  system; 
the  university's  enrollment  was  only  3%  Jewish.  Initially,  Vygotsky  seemed 
assured  of  a  spot  because  he  was  so  bright.  But  before  he  completed  his  oral 
examinations,  the  educational  ministry  shifted  to  a  lottery  system  for  Jewish 
applicants.  Vygotsky  felt  he  had  lost  all  hope,  but  then  he  won  a  position  by 
chance  alone. 

At  the  university,  Vygotsky  specialized  in  law,  but  he  also  took  a  wide 
variety  of  courses  in  other  fields,  as  well  as  courses  at  Shanyavskii  People's 
University,  where  a  number  of  professors  had  gone  after  being  expelled  from 
the  University  of  Moscow  for  anti-czarist  leanings.  Vygotsky  graduated  with 
a  law  degree  from  the  University  of  Moscow  in  1917  and  returned  to  his  home 
of  Gomel  (Wertsch,  1985,  pp.  5-6). 

Between  1917  (the  year  of  the  Communist  Revolution)  and  1924,  Vygot¬ 
sky  taught  literature  in  a  secondary  school  and  psychology  at  the  local 
teacher's  college,  and  he  became  interested  in  the  education  of  the  physically 
disabled.  He  also  worked  on  his  doctoral  dissertation  on  the  psychology  of  art. 
During  this  period  he  became  ill  with  tuberculosis  (Wertsch,  1985,  pp.  7-8). 

On  January  6, 1924,  Vygotsky  traveled  to  Leningrad  to  deliver  a  lecture 
on  the  psychology  of  consciousness.  The  clarity  and  brilliance  of  his  speech — 
by  the  unknown  young  man  from  the  provinces — had  an  electrifying  effect  on 
the  young  psychologists  in  the  audience.  One,  A.  R.  Luria  (1902-1977),  rec¬ 
ommended  Vygotsky  for  a  position  at  the  Moscow  Institute  of  Psychology, 
which  Vygotsky  received.  During  his  first  year  of  work  at  the  institute,  he  fin¬ 
ished  his  dissertation  and  received  his  doctorate  (p.  8). 

In  Moscow,  Vygotsky  soon  became  a  commanding  presence.  When  he 
lectured,  students  stood  outside  the  packed  auditorium  and  listened  through 
open  windows.  When  he  traveled,  students  wrote  poems  in  honor  of  his  jour¬ 
ney.  Vygotsky  inspired  such  enthusiasm  not  only  because  his  ideas  were  excit¬ 
ing  but  also  because  he  led  a  group  of  young  Marxists  on  a  mission — to  create 
a  psychology  that  would  help  build  a  new  socialist  society  (p.  10). 


233 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


Perhaps  sensing  his  life  would  be  short,  Vygotsky  worked  at  a  break¬ 
neck  pace.  He  read,  lectured,  and  conducted  research  as  rapidly  as  he  could, 
and  he  also  traveled  extensively  to  help  clinics  working  with  children  and 
adults  with  neurological  disorders.  Vygotsky's  daily  schedule  was  often  so 
busy  that  he  did  his  writing  after  2  A.M.,  when  he  had  a  few  quiet  hours  to  him¬ 
self.  During  the  last  3  years  of  his  life,  his  coughing  spells  became  so  severe 
that  he  was  sometimes  left  exhausted  for  days  at  a  time.  Nevertheless,  he 
worked  until  he  died  at  the  age  of  38  (pp.  12-14). 

A  few  of  Vygotsky's  writings  were  published  shortly  after  his  death  in 
1934,  but  in  1936  the  Soviet  government  banned  his  work — a  ban  that  lasted 
until  1956.  The  primary  reason  for  the  ban  was  that  Vygotsky  conducted  some 
research  with  intelligence  tests,  which  the  Communist  Party  condemned. 
Actually,  Vygotsky  criticized  the  conventional  use  of  intelligence  tests  and 
employed  them  in  new  ways,  but  such  subtleties  were  lost  on  the  authorities. 
Fortunately,  Vygotsky's  colleagues  and  students  kept  his  work  alive,  and  today 
his  ideas  are  extremely  popular  among  psychologists  and  educators 
throughout  the  world  (Cole  &  Scribner,  1978;  Kozulin,  1986,  pp.  xxiv-xxv). 


MARX’S  VIEWS  ON  HUMAN  NATURE 

Because  Vygotsky  tried  to  create  a  psychology  along  Marxist  lines,  it  will  be 
helpful  to  review  briefly  some  of  the  ideas  of  Karl  Marx  (1818-1883)  on  human 
nature  before  discussing  Vygotsky  in  detail. 

Marx's  comments  on  human  nature  were  relatively  brief,  and  they  pri¬ 
marily  appeared  in  his  early  writings  (Marx,  1844, 1845;  Marx  &  Engels,  1846). 
Marx  recognized  that  humans  have  biological  needs,  but  he  emphasized  the 
human  capacity  for  tool  use  and  production.  It  is  by  inventing  and  using  tools 
that  humans  master  their  environments,  satisfy  their  needs,  and,  ideally,  ful¬ 
fill  their  deepest  creative  potentials.  Production,  Marx  also  emphasized,  is  an 
inherently  social  process.  People  join  together  to  plant  and  harvest  crops, 
exchange  goods,  assemble  machines,  and  so  on. 

Beyond  these  general  comments,  Marx  had  little  to  say  about  human 
nature.  Indeed,  he  argued  that  it  is  a  mistake  to  describe  human  nature  in  the 
abstract,  apart  from  its  social-historical  context.  Although  humans  are  distin¬ 
guished  by  their  capacity  for  tool  use  and  technological  production,  the  con¬ 
ditions  under  which  they  work  and  produce  change  throughout  history.  The 
working  conditions  of  the  medieval  artisan,  for  example,  were  quite  different 
from  those  of  the  19th-century  factory  worker.  To  understand  humans,  then, 
we  need  to  understand  history  and  the  dynamics  of  historical  change  (Marx, 
1845,  pp.  107-109;  Marx  &  Engels,  1846,  pp.  118-121, 129). 

History,  in  Marx's  view,  is  a  dialectical  process,  a  series  of  conflicts  and 
resolutions.  New  forces  of  production  (e.g.,  new  ways  of  manufacturing)  come 
into  conflict  with  the  existing  social  system,  and  a  new  social  system  is 


234 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


installed.  For  example,  in  18th-  and  19th-century  Europe,  the  creation  of  new 
factories  gave  a  rising  class  of  capitalists  the  opportunity  to  make  vast  sums 
of  money,  but  the  ancient  feudal  system  stood  in  their  way.  The  result  of  this 
conflict  was  the  overthrow  of  the  feudal  system  and  the  establishment  of  a 
new  system — the  free  enterprise  system  that  allowed  the  capitalists  to  make 
as  much  money  as  they  liked  (Marx,  1859;  Marx  &  Engels,  1872,  pp.  336-340; 
Mills,  1962,  pp.  82-83). 

Marx  believed  that  his  own  age — the  second  half  of  the  19th  century — 
was  experiencing  a  new  phase  in  the  dialectic  of  history.  Technological 
progress  was  now  being  impeded  by  the  free  enterprise  system.  The  resolu¬ 
tion  of  this  conflict  would  be  a  communist  revolution  in  which  the  workers 
would  take  over  the  industries  and  organize  them  for  the  benefit  of  all. 

Marx,  like  so  many  other  scholars,  adopted  the  concept  of  dialectic  from 
Hegel.  However,  Marx  used  the  concept  in  a  very  different  way. 

For  Hegel,  the  dialectic  of  history  occurs  in  the  realm  of  consciousness 
and  ideas;  one  viewpoint  comes  into  conflict  with  its  opposite,  leading  to  a 
new  synthesis.  Marx,  in  contrast,  believed  that  conflicts  in  ideas  are  superfi¬ 
cial.  The  conflicts  that  really  matter  are  social  and  economic.  In  fact,  most 
ideas  and  values  merely  justify  particular  social  and  economic  interests.  The 
medieval  lords  praised  loyalty  and  honor;  the  rising  capitalists  heralded  lib¬ 
erty  and  free  competition;  and  both  groups  believed  they  were  giving  expres¬ 
sion  to  the  highest  of  all  values.  In  reality,  both  groups  were  merely  spouting 
opinions  that  justified  their  own  social  and  economic  interests. 

Marx,  then,  was  highly  critical  of  those  scholars  who  analyzed  the  nature 
of  consciousness — people's  ideas,  values,  and  outlooks — as  if  these  had  an 
independent  existence.  What  people  think,  Marx  said,  depends  on  their  mate¬ 
rial  life — the  ways  in  which  they  work,  produce,  and  exchange  goods — at  a 
certain  point  in  historical  development. 

But  it  is  not  just  the  content  of  thinking  that  depends  on  historical  devel¬ 
opment.  Our  species'  cognitive  capacities,  too,  have  changed  as  a  result  of  his¬ 
torical  change,  especially  technological  development.  This,  at  least,  was  the 
position  of  Marx's  collaborator  Friedrich  Engels  (1820-1895),  who  forcefully 
argued  that  early  technology — early  tool  use — gave  rise  to  uniquely  human 
traits  such  as  advanced  intelligence  and  speech. 


Engels  on  Tool  Use  and  Human  Evolution 

According  to  Engels  (1925,  pp.  47-49, 238-246),  our  ancestors  became  capable 
of  tool  use  when  they  came  down  from  the  trees  and  began  living  on  level 
ground.  This  new  mode  of  life  enabled  them  to  develop  an  upright  posture, 
which  freed  the  hands  for  the  production  of  stone  implements.  Once  people 
began  making  tools,  their  minds  expanded.  They  discovered  new  properties 
of  natural  objects,  such  as  the  properties  of  stone  and  wood  that  facilitate 


235 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


cutting.  They  also  became  aware,  however  dimly  at  first,  of  the  scientific  prin¬ 
ciples  underlying  tool  use,  principles  such  as  leverage,  mass,  and  force. 

Tool  use  also  led  to  new  modes  of  cooperation  and  communication.  As 
technologies  advanced,  people  discovered  the  advantages  of  working  together. 
For  example,  they  found  that  they  could  more  effectively  build  a  hut  or  a  boat 
by  joining  forces.  But  they  now  needed  some  way  of  communicating  beyond 
grunts  and  gestures.  People  needed  to  give  one  another  instructions,  such  as 
"Turn  right,"  and  "Pull  harder."  "Men  in  the  making,"  Engels  said,  "arrived 
at  the  pointwhere  they  had  something  to  say  to  one  another"  (p.  232),  and  they 
developed  speech. 

More  generally,  technology  promoted  a  new  orientation  toward  the  envi¬ 
ronment.  With  tools  in  hand,  humans  no  longer  had  to  accept  the  environ¬ 
ment  as  they  found  it.  They  could  change  it.  At  a  certain  point,  they  stopped 
picking  fruit  and  vegetables  wherever  they  found  them;  they  began  clearing 
land  and  planting  their  own  crops.  This  new  orientation  promoted  planning 
and  foresight.  Successful  farming  requires  people  to  plan  months  and  years 
ahead.  Such  foresight,  Engels  observed,  has  not  always  been  a  capacity  that 
humans  have  exercised  as  well  as  they  should.  Nevertheless,  once  people  saw 
the  power  of  tools  and  technology,  they  began  transforming  the  environment 
according  to  their  own  plans  and  designs. 


VYGOTSKY’S  THEORY 
OF  PSYCHOLOGICAL  TOOLS 

Vygotsky  was  deeply  impressed  by  Engels's  writing  on  tool  use,  and  he 
attempted  to  extend  Engels's  insights.  Just  as  people  have  developed  tools  to 
master  the  environment,  Vygotsky  proposed,  they  also  have  created  "psy¬ 
chological  tools"  to  master  their  own  behavior.  For  example,  early  peoples 
used  notched  sticks  and  knotted  ropes  to  help  them  remember  events,  much 
as  a  person  might  tie  a  string  around  his  or  her  finger  today.  Later,  as  cultures 
developed,  they  created  other  mental  tools.  Voyagers  began  using  maps  to 
help  them  retrace  prior  routes  and  plan  future  expeditions.  Vygotsky  called 
the  various  psychological  tools  that  people  use  to  aid  their  thinking  and  behav¬ 
ior  signs,  and  he  argued  that  we  cannot  understand  human  thinking  without 
examining  the  signs  that  cultures  provide  (Vygotsky,  1930,  pp.  39-40;  1931). 

Undoubtedly,  the  single  most  important  sign  system  is  speech.  Speech 
serves  many  functions,  but  most  fundamentally  it  frees  our  thought  and  atten¬ 
tion  from  the  immediate  situation — from  the  stimuli  impinging  on  us  at  the 
moment.  Because  words  can  symbolize  things  and  events  that  go  beyond  the 
present  situation,  speech  enables  us  to  reflect  on  the  past  and  plan  for  the  future 
(Luria,  1976,  p.  10;  Vygotsky,  1930,  p.  26). 

For  example,  I  know  a  farming  family  whose  vegetables  were  being 
raided  by  deer.  For  a  while  the  family  members  simply  reacted  to  each  immediate 


236 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


situation  as  it  occurred.  Whenever  someone  saw  a  deer  eating  the  vegetables, 
he  or  she  chased  it  away.  After  a  while,  however,  the  family  sat  down  and  dis¬ 
cussed  long-term  solutions.  They  talked  about  building  a  new  fence,  how  high 
it  should  be,  and  whether  a  ditch  would  be  useful.  One  family  member  shared 
an  idea  she  heard  from  a  neighbor  a  few  months  earlier.  By  using  words  to 
symbolize  things  and  events  that  were  not  immediately  present — "a  fence," 
"a  ditch,"  "the  neighbor's  idea" — the  family  developed  a  plan.  (They  decided 
to  build  a  higher  fence.) 

When  humans  use  signs,  Vygotsky  said,  they  engage  in  mediated  behav¬ 
ior.  That  is,  they  do  not  just  respond  to  environmental  stimuli;  their  behavior 
is  also  influenced  or  "mediated"  by  their  own  signs.  In  the  present  example, 
the  family  members  did  not  just  respond  directly  to  the  environmental  stim¬ 
uli  (the  deer);  they  also  acted  on  the  basis  of  a  verbally  formulated  plan  ("OK, 
we've  decided  to  build  a  10-foot  fence")  (Vygotsky,  1930a,  pp.  19-40). 

The  acquisition  of  speech  is  of  major  importance  to  the  growing  child; 
it  enables  the  child  to  participate  intelligently  in  the  social  life  of  his  or  her 
group.  But  speech  does  more  than  this.  It  also  facilitates  the  child's  own, 
individual  thinking.  By  the  age  of  3  or  4  years,  Vygotsky  noted,  children 
begin  to  carry  out  the  kinds  of  dialogues  they  had  had  with  others  with 
themselves  alone.  At  first  they  do  this  aloud,  and  we  can  hear  children  at 
play  saying  things  such  as,  "I  wonder  where  this  wheel  goes?  Does  it  go 
here?"  After  a  while,  at  the  age  of  6  or  7  years,  children  begin  to  carry  out 
such  dialogues  more  inwardly  and  silently.  Vygotsky  believed  that  our  abil¬ 
ity  to  talk  to  ourselves — to  think  with  the  help  of  words — contributes  enor¬ 
mously  to  our  powers  of  thought. 

Two  other  important  sign  systems  are  writing  and  numbering  systems.  The 
invention  of  writing  was  a  great  human  achievement;  it  enabled  people  to  keep 
permanent  records  of  information.  For  most  children,  however,  learning  to 
write  (and  read)  is  a  real  struggle  because  writing  forces  children  to  detach 
themselves  from  physical,  expressive  speech,  which  comes  so  naturally  to 
them,  and  to  use  abstract  symbols  for  words.  Learning  to  write  usually  requires 
a  good  deal  of  formal  instruction  (Vygotsky,  1934,  p.  181;  1935,  p.  105). 

Numbering  systems  have  also  been  of  great  importance  in  human  evo¬ 
lution.  Vygotsky  suggested  that  early  peoples  created  numbering  systems 
because  they  found  they  were  unable  to  quantify  objects  (such  as  vegetables 
or  cattle)  by  sight  alone.  They  needed  sets  of  symbols  to  help  them  count.  For 
example,  the  Papaus  of  New  Guinea  invented  a  method  of  counting  that  used 
their  fingers  and  many  parts  of  their  bodies  to  stand  for  objects.  As  societies 
evolved,  they  developed  other  numbering  systems,  such  as  the  abacus  and 
written  notation.  They  also  increasingly  dealt  with  quantities  in  abstract  and 
theoretical  ways,  apart  from  particular  objects.  Algebra,  for  example,  deals 
with  general  quantitative  categories  without  even  specifying  particular  num¬ 
bers.  If  a  +  10  =  b,  then  a  =  b  —  10,  regardless  of  the  particular  values  of  a 
and  b.  The  mastery  of  algebra  and  other  theoretical  uses  of  number,  like  the 


237 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


mastery  of  reading  and  writing,  usually  require  formal  instruction  (John- 
Steiner  &  Souberman,  1978). 

Vygotsky  argued  that  cultural  sign  systems  have  a  major  impact  on 
cognitive  development — an  impact  overlooked  by  developmentalists  such 
as  Gesell  and  Piaget.  Gesell  and  Piaget  looked  at  development  as  if  it  comes 
from  the  child  alone,  from  the  child's  inner  maturational  promptings  or 
spontaneous  discoveries.  Vygotsky  acknowledged  that  such  intrinsic  devel¬ 
opment,  the  "natural  line"  of  development,  is  important.  It  may  even  dom¬ 
inate  cognitive  development  up  to  the  age  of  2  years  or  so  (Vygotsky,  1930, 
p.  24).  But  after  this,  the  growth  of  the  mind  is  increasingly  influenced  by  the 
"cultural  line"  of  development,  the  sign  systems  the  culture  provides.  In 
fact,  all  our  uniquely  human  powers  of  thought — those  that  distinguish  us 
from  other  species — would  be  impossible  without  speech  and  other  sign 
systems. 

Vygotsky  speculated,  in  addition,  that  the  highest  levels  of  thinking — 
the  levels  of  purely  abstract  or  theoretical  reasoning — require  instruction  in 
writing,  math,  and  other  kinds  of  abstract  concepts.  Although  children 
might  develop  some  concepts  on  their  own,  in  their  everyday  experience, 
they  will  not  develop  purely  abstract  modes  of  thought  without  instruc¬ 
tion  in  abstract  sign  systems.  And  since  this  instruction  is  only  widespread 
in  technologically  advanced  societies,  we  will  find  purely  abstract  thinking 
prevalent  only  in  these  societies  (Vygotsky,  1934,  pp.  103,  206;  1935,  p.  90; 
Luria,  1976,  pp.  8, 161). 

In  1931  Vygotsky  saw  a  unique  opportunity  to  test  this  latter  hypothesis — 
that  abstract  thinking  is  a  product  of  relatively  advanced  levels  of  social- 
historical  development.  At  this  time,  there  were  many  remote  areas  of  the 
Soviet  Union,  including  Central  Asia,  where  peasants  still  lived  a  feudal  exis¬ 
tence.  The  peasants  worked  on  small  farms  and  were  completely  dependent 
on  wealthy  landowners  and  feudal  lords.  Most  were  illiterate.  The  new  Soviet 
government,  attempting  to  develop  the  entire  nation  into  a  modern  socialist 
state,  instituted  collective  farming  practices,  in  which  peasants  met  in  groups 
to  plan  production,  measure  output,  and  so  on.  The  government  also  gave 
the  peasants  short  courses  in  writing,  reading,  and  the  theoretical  uses  of  num¬ 
ber.  Because,  in  1931,  the  government  was  still  phasing  in  the  new  programs, 
Vygotsky  saw  the  opportunity  to  compare  the  mental  processes  of  those  adults 
who  had  begun  to  participate  in  the  modem  forms  of  social  life  with  those  who 
were  still  living  in  the  old  ways. 

Actually,  Vygotsky  himself  was  too  ill  to  go  to  Central  Asia  to  conduct 
fieldwork,  but  he  encouraged  Luria  and  others  to  do  so.  In  one  aspect  of  the 
study,  the  interviewers  presented  the  subjects  with  syllogisms  such  as  the 
following: 

In  the  Far  North,  where  there  is  snow,  all  bears  are  white.  Novaya  is  in 

the  Far  North.  What  color  are  the  bears  there?  (Luria,  1976,  p.  108) 


238 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


The  nonliterate  subjects  refused  to  deal  with  the  question  in  a  purely 
theoretical  way.  They  said  things  such  as,  "I  don't  know  what  color  the 
bears  there  are,  I  never  saw  them"  (p.  111).  When  the  interviewer  pressed 
them,  asking  them  to  answer  "on  the  basis  of  my  words,"  the  peasants  still 
refused  to  speak  beyond  their  personal  experience.  As  one  said,  "Your 
words  can  be  answered  only  by  someone  who  was  there,  and  if  a  person 
wasn't  there  he  can't  say  anything  on  the  basis  of  your  words"  (p.  109). 
Those  who  had  been  participating  in  the  new  programs,  in  contrast,  were 
willing  to  deal  with  the  syllogisms  on  a  theoretical  plane  and  they  answered 
them  correctly  (p.  116). 

This  study  wasn't  perfect.  Luria  gave  the  impression  that  the  nonliter¬ 
ate  subjects  not  only  refused  to  think  in  syllogisms  but  also  were  incapable 
of  doing  so.  However  on  occasion  a  few  subjects,  when  pressed  sufficiently, 
went  against  their  deep-seated  mental  habits  and  answered  the  questions 
correctly.  They  were  capable  of  abstract  thinking — they  just  preferred  not  to 
engage  in  it. 

But  in  general  the  study  did  support  the  Marxist  contention  that  the 
mind  is  a  product  of  social-historical  change.  The  study  suggested  that  we 
cannot  meaningfully  discuss  the  "principles  of  thinking"  or  "cognitive  devel¬ 
opment"  in  the  abstract,  as  psychologists  usually  do.  We  need  to  examine  the 
culture  into  which  the  child  is  growing,  and  the  sign  systems  the  culture  pro¬ 
vides.  For,  as  Vygotsky  said,  as  these  tools  of  thinking  change,  the  mind  takes 
on  a  different  character. 

Not  all  Marxist  psychologists,  we  should  note,  have  enthusiastically 
endorsed  Vygotsky's  ideas.  Several  Marxists  have  argued  that  Vygotsky 
stretched  the  metaphor  of  tools  too  far.  Tools,  they  say,  mean  real  tools — not 
speech,  writing,  math,  and  other  "psychological  tools"  (see  Kozulin,  1986, 
pp.  xlviii-1). 

But  whatever  his  standing  as  a  Marxist,  Vygotsky  pointed  developmental 
psychology  in  a  promising  new  direction.  Vygotsky  recognized  the  role  of 
intrinsic  forces,  but  he  suggested  that  a  complete  understanding  of  cognitive 
development  requires  the  study  of  the  psychological  tools  the  culture  hands 
down  to  the  child. 

These  two  forces — intrinsic  and  cultural — generally  seem  to  be  opposed. 
Perhaps  it  is  for  this  reason  that  most  scholars  have  emphasized  one  force  or 
the  other,  but  not  both.  Vygotsky,  in  contrast,  was  schooled  in  dialectical  the¬ 
ory  and  was  therefore  primed  to  consider  the  ways  in  which  opposing  forces 
interact  and  produce  new  transformations.  The  growing  child,  trying  to  make 
sense  of  the  world  in  her  own  way,  encounters  a  culture  that  expects  her  to  use 
its  particular  psychological  tools.  These  interactions  are  complex  and  diffi¬ 
cult  to  study.  Vygotsky  himself  only  began  to  investigate  them,  and  he  gen¬ 
erally  focused  on  only  one  side  of  the  dialectic — the  impact  of  culture  on  the 
child.  In  the  following  sections,  we  will  look  at  Vygotsky's  insights  into  how 
some  of  these  psychological  tools  are  acquired. 


239 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


MEMORY  AIDS 

Vygotsky  suggested  that  some  of  humankind's  earliest  psychological  tools 
were  memory  aids,  and  these  tools  are  still  very  important  to  us  today. 
Vygotsky  and  his  colleagues  conducted  various  experiments  to  try  to  gain 
insights  into  the  ways  in  which  children  acquire  them. 

In  one  experiment,  Vygotsky  (1931a,  pp.  70-71)  instructed  children  and 
adults  to  respond  in  different  ways  when  they  saw  different  colors.  He  told 
them  to  lift  a  finger  when  they  saw  red,  to  press  a  button  when  they  saw  green, 
and  so  on.  Sometimes  he  made  the  task  simple,  sometimes  he  made  it  diffi¬ 
cult,  and  at  certain  points  he  offered  memory  aids. 

In  such  experiments,  the  youngest  children,  between  the  ages  of  4  and 
8  years,  typically  acted  as  if  they  could  remember  anything.  Whether  the  task 
was  simple  or  difficult,  they  rushed  into  it  as  soon  as  they  heard  the  instruc¬ 
tions.  When  the  experimenter  offered  them  pictures  and  cards  "to  help  you 
remember,"  they  usually  ignored  the  aids,  or  used  them  inappropriately. 
Young  children,  Vygotsky  concluded,  "do  not  yet  know  their  capacities  and 
limitations"  or  how  to  use  external  stimuli  to  help  them  remember  things 
(1931b,  p.  71). 

Older  children,  from  about  9  to  12  years,  typically  used  the  pictures 
Vygotsky  offered,  and  these  aids  did  improve  their  performance.  Interestingly, 
the  addition  of  such  aids  did  not  always  improve  the  memory  of  the  adults. 
But  this  was  not  because  they  had  become  like  young  children  and  no  longer 
used  memory  devices.  Rather,  it  was  because  they  now  rehearsed  instructions 
and  made  mental  notes  to  themselves  inwardly,  without  the  need  for  external 
cues  (Vygotsky,  1930,  pp.  41-45). 

By  today's  standards,  these  experiments  were  very  informal.  But  they 
were  pioneering  investigations  into  an  area  that  has  become  a  major  topic  in 
contemporary  psychology.  This  is  metacognition,  the  awareness  people  have  of 
their  own  thought  processes.  (People's  specific  awareness  of  their  own  mem¬ 
ory  processes  is  sometimes  called  metamemory. )  Like  Vygotsky,  contemporary 
psychologists  are  trying  to  discover  how  children  become  aware  of  their  think¬ 
ing  and  how  they  learn  to  use  psychological  tools  and  strategies  to  improve 
it  (Flavell  et  al.,  2002,  pp.  163-167,  262-263). 


SPEECH 

The  single-most  important  psychological  tool  is  speech  (Vygotsky,  1930,  p.  24; 
1934,  p.  256).  Speech  frees  our  thought  and  attention  from  the  immediate  per¬ 
ceptual  field.  This  freedom  sets  us  apart  from  other  species. 

To  illustrate  this  difference,  Vygotsky  called  attention  to  research  by 
Kohler  (1925)  on  the  problem  solving  of  apes.  Kohler  found  that  if  one  places 


240 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


a  banana  within  an  ape's  visual  field — but  behind  some  bars  so  the  ape  can¬ 
not  grab  it — the  ape's  attention  will  be  so  riveted  on  the  banana  that  it  will 
hardly  consider  anything  else.  The  ape  won't  consider  using  a  stick  lying 
nearby,  unless  the  stick  also  happens  to  lie  directly  in  front  of  the  bars.  The 
stick,  that  is,  must  also  be  part  of  the  immediate  visual  field  (Kohler,  1925, 
pp.  37-38;  Vygotsky,  1930,  pp.  35-37). 

Human  thinking,  in  contrast,  can  range  much  more  freely  beyond  the 
immediate  perceptual  field,  and  it  is  speech  that  enables  it  to  do  so.  Because 
words  frequently  refer  to  absent  objects,  we  can,  in  a  situation  like  that  of  the 
ape,  ask  ourselves.  What  object  might  reach  that  banana?  Is  there  a  stick  or  a 
pole  around  here  that  will  reach  it?  Thus,  we  use  words  to  contemplate  and 
direct  our  search  for  objects  not  in  our  visual  field. 

Vygotsky  suggested  that  the  ability  to  engage  in  such  internal  dialogues 
develops  in  three  steps. 

1 .  Initially,  references  to  absent  objects  occur  in  the  child's  interactions  with 
others.  For  example,  a  2-year-old  girl  might  ask  her  mother  to  help  her 
find  something.  Or  the  mother  might  say,  "We're  going  to  the  park  now, 
so  get  your  pail  and  shovel,"  directing  the  girl's  attention  to  objects  she 
had  not  been  looking  at. 

2.  Next,  at  the  age  of  3  years  or  so,  the  child  begins  to  direct  similar  com¬ 
ments  to  herself.  While  playing  with  her  toys,  she  might  say,  "Where's 
my  shovel?  I  need  my  shovel,"  and  begin  looking  for  an  object  that  had 
not  been  within  her  immediate  surroundings. 

For  a  time,  this  self-guiding  speech  is  said  aloud;  we  frequently  hear 
children  talking  as  they  play  or  work  on  problems.  Then,  beginning  at 
about  6  years  of  age,  children's  self-directed  speech  becomes  increas¬ 
ingly  quiet,  abbreviated,  and  less  comprehensible  to  us. 

3.  Finally,  by  age  8  or  so,  we  cannot  hear  this  talk  at  all.  But  the  child's  self- 
directed  speech  has  not  disappeared;  it  has  merely  gone  underground. 
It  has  turned  into  inner  speech,  the  silent  dialogue  that  one  has  with  one¬ 
self  (Vygotsky,  1934,  pp.  29-40). 

The  general  process,  then,  is  one  of  internalizing  social  interactions.  What 
begins  as  an  interpersonal  process,  occurring  between  the  parent  and  the  child, 
becomes  an  intrapsychic  process,  occurring  within  the  child.  Vygotsky  believed 
that  this  general  progression  characterizes  the  development  of  all  the  "higher 
mental  processes,"  all  the  forms  of  thought  and  attention  that  depend  on  cul¬ 
tural  signs.  In  fact,  he  stated  that  the  progression  is  a  general  law: 

Any  function  in  the  child's  cultural  development  appears  on  the  stage 
twice,  on  two  planes,  first  on  the  social  plane  and  then  on  the  psycho¬ 
logical.  (1931a,  pp.  44-45) 


241 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


This  law,  in  the  view  of  Vygotsky  and  his  followers,  was  a  cornerstone  of 
a  Marxist  psychology.  A  Marxist  does  not  seek  the  origins  of  thinking  within  the 
individual  child,  spontaneously  sprouting  from  the  child's  mind,  but  in  exter¬ 
nal  social  existence  (Vygotsky,  1930,  p.  45).  "The  child,"  Vygotsky  said,  "learns 
the  social  forms  of  behavior  and  applies  them  to  himself"  (1931a,  p.  40). 


Egocentric  Speech 

In  the  process  of  internalizing  social  speech,  children  go  through  a  phase 
(step  2)  in  which  they  spend  considerable  time  talking  to  themselves  aloud. 
The  first  person  to  call  attention  to  this  kind  of  speech  was  Piaget  (1923),  who 
called  it  egocentric  speech.  Piaget  observed,  for  example,  that  if  two  5-year-old 
girls  are  playing  in  a  sandbox,  each  might  talk  enthusiastically  about  topics 
without  considering  the  fact  that  the  other  couldn't  possibly  know  what  she 
was  referring  to.  Piaget  called  this  speech  "egocentric"  because  he  thought 
it  reflects  the  child's  general  egocentrism;  the  child  doesn't  adjust  her  speech 
to  the  perspective  of  the  listener  because  she  egocentrically  assumes  the  lis¬ 
tener's  perspective  is  the  same  as  her  own.  Piaget  estimated  that  between 
the  ages  of  4  and  7  years  about  45%  of  all  speech  is  egocentric  (1923,  p.  51). 

Vygotsky  agreed  that  egocentric  speech  is  very  prevalent  in  this  age 
group,  but  he  disagreed  with  Piaget  about  its  theoretical  meaning.  In 
Piaget's  view,  egocentric  speech  is  basically  useless.  It  merely  reflects  a  defi¬ 
ciency  in  the  child's  thinking.  Vygotsky,  in  contrast,  emphasized  its  positive 
function;  it  helps  the  child  solve  problems.  In  one  of  Piaget's  studies  (1923, 
p.  14),  6  y2-year-old  Lev  says  to  no  one  in  particular,  "I  want  to  do  that  draw¬ 
ing,  there.  ...  I  want  to  draw  something,  I  do.  I  shall  need  a  big  piece  of 
paper  to  do  that."  In  Vygotsky's  view,  Lev's  self-directed  talk  helps  Lev 
plan  and  direct  his  activities  (Vygotsky,  1934,  p.  29). 

Vygotsky  also  disagreed  with  Piaget  about  egocentric  speech's  ultimate 
fate.  Piaget  implied  that  as  children  overcome  their  egocentrism,  egocentric 
speech  simply  dies  out.  Vygotsky  argued  that  it  doesn't  just  fade  away,  but  it 
goes  underground  and  turns  into  inner  speech,  the  kind  of  silent  dialogue  we 
so  often  have  with  ourselves  when  we  try  to  solve  problems.  Interpreting  the 
decline  of  egocentric  speech  as  an  indication  it  is  dying,  Vygotsky  said,  "is 
like  saying  that  the  child  stops  counting  when  he  ceases  to  use  his  fingers  and 
starts  adding  in  his  head"  (1934,  p.  230). 

Vygotsky  argued,  then,  that  egocentric  speech  is  highly  useful  and  an 
important  way  station  on  the  road  to  inner  speech.  But  even  if  we  were  to 
agree  with  Vygotsky  on  these  points,  we  would  still  have  to  agree  with  Piaget 
that  there  is  something  puzzling  about  it.  The  child  seems  to  be  talking  to 
someone,  yet  doesn't  do  so  in  any  full  way.  For  example,  a  child  playing  alone 
with  Tinkertoys  while  an  adult  is  silently  seated  across  the  room  says. 

The  wheels  go  here,  the  wheels  go  here.  Oh,  we  need  to  start  it  all  over 

again.  We  need  to  close  it  up.  See,  it  closes  up.  We're  starting  it  all  over 


242 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


again.  Do  you  know  why  we  wanted  to  do  that?  Because  I  needed  it  to 
go  in  a  different  way.  (Kohlberg,  Yaeger,  &  Hjertholm,  1968,  p.  695) 

The  child  seems  to  be  talking  to  the  listener  (e.g.,  asking  him,  "Do  you  know 
why  .  .  .  ?"),  but  the  child  doesn't  wait  for  the  listener  to  respond. 

According  to  Vygotsky,  the  child's  self-directed  speech  is  puzzling  because 
it  is  not  yet  differentiated  from  social  speech.  The  child  is  trying  to  use  speech  to 
direct  her  own  activities,  but  she  still  casts  her  speech  in  the  form  of  social  com¬ 
munication.  It  takes  a  while  for  self-directed  speech  to  "differentiate  out"  and  take 
on  its  own  character.  Only  gradually  does  self-directed  speech  become  quieter 
and  more  abbreviated  and  turn  into  inner  speech  (Vygotsky,  1934,  pp.  229-232). 

Research  Bearing  on  the  Vygotsky-Piaget  Issue.  Vygotsky  tried  to 
think  of  ways  to  test  whether  his  view  of  egocentric  speech  was  more  correct 
than  that  of  Piaget.  In  his  most  prominent  study,  Vygotsky  reasoned  that  if 
egocentric  speech  serves  a  problem-solving  function,  it  should  increase  when 
tasks  become  more  difficult.  Because  Piaget  saw  no  positive  function  to  ego¬ 
centric  speech,  his  theory  makes  no  such  prediction. 

So  Vygotsky  did  various  things  to  make  children's  tasks  more  difficult.  "For 
instance,  when  a  child  was  getting  ready  to  draw,  he  would  suddenly  find  that 
there  was  no  paper,  or  no  pencil  of  the  color  he  needed.  In  other  words,  by  obstruct¬ 
ing  his  free  activity,  we  made  him  face  problems"  (Vygotsky,  1934,  pp.  29-30).  In 
these  situations,  the  proportion  of  egocentric  speech  (the  amount  of  egocentric 
speech  compared  to  all  speech)  nearly  doubled  among  5-  to  7-year-olds  (Luria, 
1961,  p.  33).  The  children  tried  to  solve  problems  by  talking  to  themselves.  For 
example,  one  child  said,  "Where's  the  pencil?  I  need  a  blue  pencil.  Never  mind.  I'll 
draw  with  the  red  one  and  wet  it  with  water;  it  will  become  dark  and  look  like  blue" 
(Vygotsky,  1934,  pp.  29-30).  This  study  suggested,  then,  that  egocentric  speech 
does  serve  a  problem-solving  function  in  young  children,  as  Vygotsky  suggested. 

This  study  has  been  widely  replicated,  and  the  results  have  largely  been 
in  agreement  with  Vygotsky's.  There  is,  however,  one  qualification.  If  tasks  are 
made  much  too  difficult  for  children,  they  do  not  engage  in  self-guiding 
speech.  They  just  give  up  and  don't  say  anything.  As  Laura  Berk  says,  tasks 
must  be  "appropriately  challenging"  (2009,  p.  265). 

Other  research  has  examined  the  contrasting  positions  of  Piaget  and 
Vygotsky,  and  most  of  it  supports  Vygotsky.  It  suggests  that  egocentric  or  self- 
directed  speech  serves  a  positive  function  and  turns  into  inner  speech,  which 
continues  to  guide  behavior  (Berk,  2009,  p.  265;  Kohlberg  et  al.,  1968). 

Nevertheless,  it  still  seems  possible  that  Piaget  was  partly  correct.  Even 
if  some  egocentric  speech  serves  the  self-guiding  function  that  Vygotsky 
emphasized,  it  also  seems  that  some  egocentric  speech  might  reflect  the  child's 
inability  to  consider  the  audience's  viewpoint.  It  may  be  that  both  Piaget  and 
Vygotsky  were  correct.1 


'In  their  research  reports,  contemporary  psychologists  often  refer  to  both  egocentric  and 
vocalized  self-directed  speech  as  private  speech. 


243 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


Self-Control 

So  far  we  have  focused  on  the  way  children  use  self-guiding  speech  to  help 
them  solve  problems,  as  when  they  work  on  tasks  such  as  drawing  and  build¬ 
ing  things  with  Tinkertoys.  But  verbal  self-regulation  also  helps  people  gain 
emotional  self-control,  in  the  sense  of  overcoming  impulses  and  temptations. 
In  everyday  conversations,  we  speak  of  this  capacity  as  willpower. 

According  to  Vygotsky,  the  basic  question  of  willpower  is:  How  is  it  pos¬ 
sible  for  us  to  take  action  in  situations  in  which  forces  pull  us  strongly  against 
it?  How,  for  instance,  do  we  stop  watching  TV  and  go  study  instead? 

Vygotsky's  (1932)  answer  was  that  we  use  words  to  create  artificial  stim¬ 
uli  to  direct  our  behavior.  If  we  are  watching  TV,  we  might  say  to  ourselves, 
"OK,  I'm  going  to  watch  it  until  8  o'clock,  then  I'll  study."  We  create  a  new,  ver¬ 
bal  signal  to  control  our  behavior. 

As  usual,  Vygotsky  argued  that  we  initially  acquire  such  signals  through 
social  interactions.  When  we  were  young,  adults  frequently  used  signals  to 
direct  our  behavior.  They  might  have  told  us,  "I  want  you  to  jump  in  the  water 
on  the  count  of  three"  or  "You  can  watch  TV  until  the  big  hand  on  the  clock 
reaches  the  12."  A  little  later,  we  began  applying  similar  signals  to  ourselves, 
at  first  aloud  and  then  silently  through  inner  speech. 

As  Berk  observes,  we  can  sometimes  hear  young  children  talking  to 
themselves  as  they  try  to  gain  self-control.  A  toddler  who  is  tempted  to  touch 
a  light  socket  says  to  herself,  "Don't  touch,"  and  pulls  her  hand  back.  A  little 
boy  who  starts  to  jump  on  a  sofa  says  to  himself,  "No,  can't,"  and  climbs  down 
(Berk,  2001,  pp.  89,  511).  Several  psychologists  are  interested  in  the  process 
by  which  children  learn  to  delay  gratification,  as  when  they  are  told  to  wait 
before  eating  a  treat.  Berk  points  out  that  this  capacity  emerges  with  the  devel¬ 
opment  of  language  and  that  one  can  often  overhear  young  children  instruct¬ 
ing  themselves  to  wait  (2001,  p.  89). 


Luria’s  Research  on  the  Verbal 
Regulation  of  Behavior 

An  especially  fine-grained  analysis  of  the  verbal  self-regulation  of  behavior 
was  provided  by  Vygotsky's  colleague  A.  R.  Luria. 

Luria  focused  on  the  internalization  of  adult  commands.  He  wanted  to 
see  how  the  child  comes  to  obey  adult  commands  and  then  applies  those 
commands  to  herself.  Vygotsky,  we  should  note,  did  not  imply  that  all  self¬ 
regulation  is  limited  to  the  internalization  of  commands.  Children  internalize 
all  kinds  of  dialogue.  But  Luria  focused  on  commands. 

Luria  found  that  a  child's  ability  to  follow  adult  commands  develops 
rather  slowly.  Suppose  a  toy  fish  is  lying  on  a  table.  If  we  tell  a  14-month-old 
child,  "Bring  me  the  fish,"  the  child  will  do  so.  But  if  we  place  a  shiny  toy  cat 
closer  to  the  child  and  again  say,  "Bring  me  the  fish,"  the  child  will  bring  us 


244 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


the  shiny  cat.  Our  verbal  instructions  cannot  overcome  the  power  of  an  attrac¬ 
tive  stimulus  (Luria,  1960,  p.  360). 

There  are  other  difficulties  as  well.  In  one  experiment,  Luria  gave  a 
2-year-old  a  rubber  balloon  and  told  him  to  press  it,  which  the  child  did.  But 
Luria  noted,  "He  does  not  stop  his  reaction,  for  he  presses  a  second,  a  third, 
and  a  fourth  time"  (p.  360).  Luria  gave  the  boy  only  one  instruction,  but  the 
boy's  action  perseverated — it  kept  going. 

What's  more,  our  commands,  which  can  so  easily  set  a  child's  behavior 
in  motion,  do  not  have  nearly  the  same  power  to  inhibit  it.  If  an  experimenter 
tells  a  2-year-old  who  is  pressing  a  balloon,  "That's  enough,"  the  command 
usually  has  little  effect.  In  fact,  in  many  cases  the  command  only  intensifies  the 
child's  reaction;  the  child  presses  even  more  energetically  (Luria,  1961,  p.  53). 

By  the  ages  of  3  or  3  %,  children  can  follow  specific  adult  commands 
fairly  well  (Luria,  1961,  p.  70;  Slobin,  1966,  p.  131).  But  can  they  follow  their 
own  verbal  instructions? 

In  one  experiment,  Luria  told  children  to  say  "Press"  and  press  a  balloon 
when  they  saw  one  light  and  to  say  "Don't  press"  and  to  refrain  from  press¬ 
ing  when  they  saw  another  light.  But  3-  and  3  /^-year-olds  pressed  at  every 
light.  They  said  "Press"  and  pressed,  and  they  said  "Don't  press"  and  pressed. 
Once  again,  words  excite  action,  but  they  have  a  weak  inhibiting  effect  (Luria, 

1960,  pp.  374-375;  1961,  pp.  90-91). 

Luria  believed  that  a  good  part  of  the  difficulty  is  that  young  children 
respond  to  the  excitatory  function  of  speech  rather  than  to  its  meaning.  The 
phrase  "Don't  press"  excites  action  simply  because  it  is  a  signal,  regardless  of 
its  meaning. 

A  number  of  Luria's  experiments  suggest  that  children  can  verbally  reg¬ 
ulate  much  of  their  own  behavior  by  the  age  of  5  or  6  years.  They  can  easily 
handle  the  kinds  of  experiments  previously  described.  In  fact,  an  experimenter 
need  only  give  them  instructions  at  the  outset,  and  they  will  perform  correctly 
without  saying  anything  to  themselves  aloud.  But  Luria  believed  they  are  still 
giving  themselves  verbal  instructions — only  now  they  are  doing  so  silently, 
through  inner  speech.  To  support  his  interpretation,  Luria  reported  that  when 
he  made  tasks  more  complicated  or  speeded  them  up,  the  5-  and  6-year-olds 
spontaneously  began  giving  themselves  instructions  aloud  once  again  (Luria, 

1961,  p.  93). 

Self-Regulation  and  Neurological  Functioning.  Luria  emphasized 
the  social  origins  of  self-regulation.  First,  children  submit  to  the  commands 
of  others;  then  they  command  themselves.  At  the  same  time,  Luria  recog¬ 
nized  that  the  child's  ability  to  regulate  her  behavior  depends  on  the  matu¬ 
ration  of  the  nervous  system.  In  fact,  Luria  devoted  a  great  portion  of  his 
life  studying  the  neurological  mechanisms  underlying  self-regulation  and 
other  mental  functioning,  and  he  is  considered  one  of  history's  great 
neurologists. 


245 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


Many  of  Luria's  insights  came  during  his  work  with  patients  who  suf¬ 
fered  brain  injuries  during  the  Second  World  War.  Luria,  like  others,  found  that 
the  kinds  of  difficulties  the  patients  experienced  depended  greatly  on  the  spe¬ 
cific  location  of  their  injuries.  The  ability  to  regulate  one's  own  behavior,  Luria 
found,  is  tied  to  the  frontal  lobes,  particularly  in  the  left  hemisphere.  Patients 
who  suffered  frontal  lobe  injuries  could  still  speak  and  perform  simple  habit¬ 
ual  tasks,  such  as  greeting  others  and  dressing  themselves.  But  in  new  situa¬ 
tions,  they  were  unable  to  regulate  their  own  behavior  and,  as  a  result,  they 
were  slaves  to  environmental  stimulation. 

For  example,  one  patient  was  supposed  to  take  a  train  to  Moscow,  but 
when  he  arrived  at  the  station  he  stepped  onto  the  first  train  he  saw  boarding 
and  traveled  in  the  opposite  direction.  Apparently  the  call  "All  aboard"  and 
the  sight  of  the  others  getting  onto  the  train  was  more  than  he  could  resist.  He 
couldn't  tell  himself,  "This  isn't  my  train,"  and  use  these  words  to  regulate  his 
own  behavior. 

Patients  with  severe  frontal  lobe  damage  also  have  problems  with  per¬ 
severation;  once  they  begin  an  activity,  they  cannot  easily  stop  it.  Luria  told 
about  a  patient  "who  began  occupational  therapy  after  the  war.  He  was 
instructed  to  plane  a  piece  of  wood.  He  planed  a  board  down  completely  and 
continued  to  plane  the  work  bench,  being  unable  to  stop"  (Luria,  1982,  p.  111). 

In  such  cases,  we  must  guess  that  the  patients  were  unable  to  use  speech 
to  control  their  behavior.  We  suppose  that  they  could  not  effectively  tell  them¬ 
selves  "Stop"  or  "Hold  it."  Some  of  Luria's  other  research  added  more  direct 
support  for  this  speculation.  In  one  study,  Luria  asked  patients  to  imitate  him 
and  raise  a  finger  or  a  fist  whenever  he  did  so.  This  they  could  do.  But  when 
Luria  reversed  the  instructions,  they  had  difficulty.  They  could  repeat  his 
instructions,  but  they  couldn't  apply  them  to  their  behavior.  A  patient  would 
say,  "Yours  is  a  fist,  so  now  I  must  raise  my  finger,"  but  he  still  imitated  Luria 
and  raised  his  fist.  He  couldn't  use  speech  to  regulate  his  actions  (p.  112). 


Inner  Speech 

Under  ordinary  circumstances,  adults  have  developed  the  capacity  to  give 
themselves  verbal  instructions  inwardly  and  silently,  through  inner  speech. 
Inner  speech,  however,  is  very  difficult  to  investigate.  Vygotsky  obtained  some 
clues  from  writers  and  poets,  but  he  relied  primarily  on  the  study  of  egocen¬ 
tric  speech  in  children.  That  is,  he  assumed  that  the  changes  we  see  in  ego¬ 
centric  speech  just  before  it  goes  underground  forecast  what  inner  speech  is 
like  (Vygotsky,  1934,  pp.  226-227). 

Inner  speech,  in  comparison  to  social  speech,  seems  more  abbreviated. 
It  omits  information  that  we  already  know  and  focuses  on  that  which  is  new. 
Sometimes  we  can  observe  the  same  phenomenon  in  social  situations.  Vygot¬ 
sky  asked  us  to  imagine  several  people  waiting  for  a  particular  bus.  "No  one 
will  say,  on  seeing  the  bus  approach,  'The  bus  for  which  we  are  waiting  is 


246 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


coming.'"  The  speaker  is  likely  to  say  merely,  "Coming,"  or  some  such  expres¬ 
sion.  She  limits  her  statement  to  the  new  information — the  bus's  arrival  (1934, 
p.  236).  When  we  talk  silently  to  ourselves,  we  abbreviate  our  statements  in  a 
similar  way. 

Another  characteristic  of  inner  speech  is  the  dominance  of  sense  over 
meaning.  The  sense  of  the  word  is  the  feeling  it  arouses  in  us.  For  example, 
the  word  lion  can  evoke  feelings  ranging  from  fear  to  tender  sympathy, 
depending  on  the  context  in  which  we  are  thinking  about  the  animal.  The 
meaning  is  the  more  precise  definition,  like  that  found  in  a  dictionary.  A  word's 
meaning  is  important  for  clear  communication,  but  when  we  use  words  to 
think  about  something  just  to  ourselves,  we  are  strongly  affected  by  the  emo¬ 
tional  sense  of  the  words  (Vygotsky,  1934,  pp.  244-245). 

To  understand  inner  speech  more  fully,  Vygotsky  (1934,  pp.  245-249) 
said  we  need  to  examine  its  role  within  a  microgenetic  process.  Microgenesis 
is  the  relatively  brief  developmental  process  that  occurs  every  time  we  form 
a  thought  or  a  perception.  The  formation  of  a  verbal  statement,  too,  unfolds 
microgenetically,  and  inner  speech  enters  this  process  at  a  critical  point. 

The  act  of  making  a  verbal  statement  begins  with  an  emotion — a  desire, 
interest,  or  need.  Next  comes  the  dim  stirring  of  a  thought,  which  always 
includes  something  of  the  original  feeling.  At  this  point,  inner  speech  comes 
into  play.  We  engage  in  inner  speech  as  we  try  to  articulate  our  thoughts.  This 
process  is  fluid  and  dynamic,  and  both  our  thoughts  and  our  words  undergo 
several  transformations  as  we  struggle  to  make  a  clear  statement  without  los¬ 
ing  feeling  behind  our  original  thought  (pp.  249-255). 

Sometimes  we  cannot  find  words  to  express  our  thoughts  at  all.  Vygot¬ 
sky  referred  to  a  novel  by  Gelb  Uspensky,  in  which  "a  poor  peasant,  who  must 
address  an  official  with  some  life-important  issue,  cannot  put  his  thoughts 
into  words"  (p.  249).  The  poor  man  asks  the  Lord  for  help,  but  to  no  avail. 

Even  great  poets,  who  are  so  good  with  words,  experience  this  difficulty. 
The  poet  Afanasey  Fet  wrote,  "If  only  soul  might  speak  without  words!" 
F.  Tiutcheve  felt  that  the  process  of  translating  thoughts  into  words  so  routinely 
distorts  the  original  thought  that  "a  thought  once  uttered  is  a  lie"  (Vygotsky, 
1934,  pp.  251,  254).  Vygotsky  recognized  this  danger.  Nevertheless,  he  argued 
that  we  need  words  to  develop  our  thoughts.  A  thought  that  fails  to  realize  itself 
in  words  remains  unfulfilled.  A  "voiceless  thought"  as  the  poet  Osip  Mandel¬ 
stam  said,  "returns  to  shadow's  chambers"  (Vygtosky,  1934,  p.  210). 


PLAY 

We  have  seen  that  speech  frees  the  child  from  the  immediate  physical  situa¬ 
tion.  Using  words,  the  child  can  talk  about  objects  and  events  beyond  the  here 
and  now.  The  young  child  also  gains  freedom  from  the  concrete  situation 


247 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


through  play.  In  make-believe  play  a  piece  of  wood  becomes  a  person,  a  stick 
becomes  a  horse.  The  child  creates  an  illusory  world  where  objects  take  on 
new  meanings.  Play  is  a  big  step  in  imaginative  thinking. 

But  Vygotsky  (1933)  emphasized  that  the  child's  play,  although  sponta¬ 
neous  and  imaginative,  is  not  completely  free.  In  the  child's  mind,  there  are 
rules  to  be  followed.  When  two  young  girls  pretend  it  is  night  and  they  have 
to  go  to  sleep,  they  follow  an  implicit  rule  that  they  do  not  engage  in  any 
imaginary  activity  whatsoever,  such  as  digging  in  the  dirt  or  riding  bikes; 
they  only  engage  in  bedtime  activities.  Vygotsky  told  about  two  girls,  ages  5 
and  7,  who  decided  to  play  sisters.  They  followed  an  implicit  rule  that  sisters 
do  things  the  same.  They  dressed  alike  and  talked  alike. 

By  adhering  to  the  rules  implicit  in  their  play,  children  exhibit  more  self- 
control  than  in  the  rest  of  their  lives.  They  behave  according  to  what  they 
think  a  role  requires,  not  their  immediate  desires.  If  three  children  pretend  to 
be  shopkeepers  and  customers,  and  let  pieces  of  candy  represent  money,  they 
don't  eat  the  candy.  They  use  the  candy  as  a  prop  and  stay  in  their  roles. 

Vygotsky  said  that  because  the  child  exhibits  so  much  greater  self  con¬ 
trol  in  play,  it's  as  if  he  were  "a  head  taller  than  himself"  (1933,  p.  102).  Yet 
the  child  doesn't  experience  the  rules  in  play  as  a  burden.  On  the  contrary, 
the  child  takes  pleasure  in  adhering  to  them.  Play,  Vygotsky  said,  is  the  proto¬ 
type  for  later  taking  pleasure  in  following  one's  guiding  idea  or  moral 
principle  (p.  99). 

After  the  age  of  7  or  so,  children  begin  playing  games  that  have  very 
set  rules.  Vygotsky  (1934,  p.  104)  observed  that  play  isn't  as  free  and  imag¬ 
inative  as  it  once  was.  But  we  should  note  that  when  Vygotsky  wrote  about 
older  children's  play,  he  was  primarily  thinking  of  structured,  competitive 
sports,  not  more  informal  children's  games,  like  snowball  battles.  In  their 
more  informal  games,  children  feel  freer  to  create  and  revise  rules,  as  Piaget 
observed. 


SCHOOLING 

Vygotsky  noted  that  children  master  language  quite  naturally  (1935,  p.  105), 
and  he  made  it  sound  as  if  early  play  springs  spontaneously  from  the  child  her¬ 
self.  One  might  ask  if  speech  and  play  are  as  much  a  part  of  the  natural  line 
of  development  as  the  cultural  line.  Unfortunately,  Vygotsky  didn't  say  much 
on  this  question.  But  he  made  it  clear  that  the  acquisition  of  cultural  sign  sys¬ 
tems  such  as  math  and  writing  don't  usually  come  naturally.  These  are  taught 
in  schools,  and  most  children  have  difficulty  with  these  subjects.  Vygotsky 
was  one  of  the  first  psychologists  to  devote  considerable  attention  to  the 
impact  of  school  instruction  on  the  developing  child.  As  was  his  custom,  he 
developed  his  ideas  by  comparing  them  to  the  ideas  of  others,  particularly 
those  of  Piaget. 


248 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


Vygotsky  versus  Piaget 

Piaget  drew  a  sharp  distinction  between  development  and  teaching.  Develop¬ 
ment,  he  said,  is  a  spontaneous  process  that  comes  from  the  child.  It  comes  from 
inner  maturational  growth  and,  more  importantly,  from  the  child's  own  efforts 
to  make  sense  of  the  world.  The  child,  in  Piaget's  view,  is  a  little  intellectual 
explorer,  making  her  own  discoveries  and  formulating  her  own  positions. 

Piaget  did  not  mean  that  the  child  develops  in  isolation,  apart  from  the 
social  world.  Other  people  do  have  an  impact  on  the  child's  thinking.  But  they 
do  not  help  the  child  by  trying  to  directly  teach  her  things.  Rather,  they  pro¬ 
mote  development  by  stimulating  and  challenging  the  child's  own  thinking. 
This  often  occurs,  for  example,  when  children  get  into  discussions  and  debates 
with  friends.  If  a  girl  finds  that  a  friend  has  pointed  out  a  flaw  in  her  argument, 
she  is  stimulated  to  come  up  with  a  better  argument,  and  her  mind  grows. 
But  the  girl's  intellectual  development  is  an  independent  process.  For  it  is  the 
girl  herself — not  an  outside  person — who  must  construct  the  new  argument. 

As  a  proponent  of  independent  thinking,  Piaget  was  highly  critical  of  the 
teacher-directed  instruction  that  occurs  in  most  schools.  Teachers  try  to  take 
charge  of  the  child's  learning,  acting  as  if  they  could  somehow  pour  material 
into  the  child's  head.  They  force  the  child  into  a  passive  position.  Moreover, 
teachers  often  present  abstract  concepts  in  math,  science,  and  other  areas  that 
are  well  beyond  the  child's  own  grasp.  Sometimes,  to  be  sure,  children  appear 
to  have  learned  something,  but  they  usually  have  acquired  mere  "verbalisms"; 
they  repeat  back  the  teacher 's  words  without  any  genuine  understanding  of  the 
concepts  behind  them.  If  adults  want  children  to  genuinely  grasp  concepts,  they 
must  give  children  opportunities  to  discover  them  on  their  own  (Piaget,  1969). 

In  Vygotsky's  view,  spontaneous  development  is  important,  but  it  is  not 
all-important,  as  Piaget  believed.  If  children's  minds  were  simply  the  products 
of  their  own  discoveries  and  inventions,  their  minds  wouldn't  advance  very 
far.  In  reality,  children  also  benefit  enormously  from  the  knowledge  and  con¬ 
ceptual  tools  handed  down  to  them  by  their  cultures.  In  modern  societies,  this 
usually  occurs  in  schools.  Teachers  do,  as  Piaget  said,  present  material  that  is 
too  difficult  for  children  to  learn  by  themselves,  but  this  is  what  good  instruc¬ 
tion  should  do.  It  should  march  ahead  of  development,  pulling  it  along,  help¬ 
ing  children  master  material  that  they  cannot  immediately  grasp  on  their  own. 
Their  initial  understanding  might  be  superficial,  but  the  instruction  is  still 
valuable,  for  it  moves  the  children's  minds  forward. 

Scientific  Concepts 

Vygotsky  saw  particular  value  in  the  kinds  of  abstract  concepts  that  are  taught  in 
schools.  He  called  them  scientific  concepts,  and  he  included  in  this  category  con¬ 
cepts  in  math  and  science  (e.g.,  Archimedes'  law)  as  well  as  concepts  in  the  social 
sciences  (e.g.,  class  conflict).  He  contrasted  these  concepts  with  the  spontaneous  con¬ 
cepts  that  children  learn  on  their  own.  Because  children  develop  most  of  their 


249 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


spontaneous  concepts  outside  of  school,  in  their  everyday  lives,  Vygotsky  also 
referred  to  spontaneous  concepts  as  everyday  cmcepts  (although  there  is  no  reason 
why  schools  cannot  also  give  children  opportunities  to  make  their  own  discov¬ 
eries,  as  Montessori,  Dewey,  and  Piagetians  such  as  Kamii  have  shown). 

In  any  case,  Vygotsky  argued  that  instruction  in  scientific  concepts  is 
very  helpful  because  it  provides  children  with  broader  frameworks  in  which 
to  place  their  spontaneous  concepts.  For  example,  a  7-year-old  boy  might  have 
developed  the  spontaneous  concept  of  grandmother,  but  his  concept  is  pri¬ 
marily  based  on  his  image  of  his  own  grandmother.  If  we  ask  him  to  define 
the  term,  he  might  reply,  "She  has  a  soft  lap."  Formal  instruction,  in  which  the 
teacher  diagrams  abstract  "family  trees"  (which  include  concepts  such  as 
grandparents,  parents,  and  children )  can  give  the  child  a  broader  framework  in 
which  to  place  his  spontaneous  concept  and  help  him  understand  what  a 
grandmother  really  is  (Vygotsky,  1930,  p.  50). 

Vygotsky  argued  that  this  kind  of  formal  instruction  brings  conscious¬ 
ness  to  the  child's  thinking.  So  long  as  the  child  thinks  of  the  concept 
grandmother  as  a  particular  person,  he  is  not  really  conscious  of  the  concept. 
His  awareness  is  directed  to  the  person,  not  the  concept.  Only  when  he  sees 
that  grandmother  is  a  category  within  a  more  general  system  of  categories  does 
he  become  aware  of  the  concept  as  such  (Vygotsky,  1934,  p.  171). 

A  similar  process  occurs  when  children  learn  to  write.  Before  we  are 
introduced  to  writing,  we  have  mastered  a  great  deal  of  spoken  language,  but 
our  mastery  is  not  at  a  very  conscious  level.  Speaking  is  a  bit  like  singing;  it 
is  physically  expressive  and  flows  rather  naturally.  Writing,  in  contrast,  uses 
more  formal  and  abstract  systems  of  symbols  and  forces  us  to  behave  much 
more  consciously  and  deliberately.  When  we  write,  we  are  constantly  making 
conscious  decisions  with  respect  to  the  proper  verb  form,  the  point  at  which 
a  sentence  should  end,  and  so  forth.  Learning  to  write  takes  great  effort,  but 
it  helps  us  see  how  language  is  structured.  Writing,  Vygotsky  said,  "brings 
awareness  to  speech"  (p.  183). 

Support  for  Vygotsky's  views  has  come  from  the  research  of  Sylvia  Scrib¬ 
ner  and  Michael  Cole  (1981,  pp.  151-156)  on  the  effects  of  literacy  among  the 
Vai  people  in  Liberia.  The  investigators  presented  both  literate  and  nonliterate 
Vai  adults  with  several  sentences,  some  of  which  were  ungrammatical.  Both 
groups  were  perfectly  able  to  say  which  sentences  were  ungrammatical.  But  the 
literate  Vai  were  better  able  to  explain  why  (for  example,  to  explain  that  the  sub¬ 
ject  and  the  verb  of  a  sentence  didn't  agree).  Apparently,  literacy  training  had 
given  them  a  greater  conceptual  awareness  of  their  speech.  In  contemporary 
terms,  they  had  gained  metacognitive  knowledge  of  their  own  speech. 

To  get  a  better  sense  of  what  it  feels  like  to  learn  on  a  newly  conceptual 
level,  we  might  recall  the  experience  of  studying  a  foreign  language  in 
school.  The  process  probably  felt  awkward  and  self-conscious.  But  we  might 
also  have  felt  we  were  becoming  aware  of  our  native  language  for  the  first 
time  because  we  were  seeing  it  within  a  broader,  abstract  framework,  as 


250 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


employing  one  set  of  rules  where  other  options  are  possible  (Vygotsky,  1934, 
p.  196).  As  Goethe  said,  "He  who  knows  no  foreign  language  does  not  really 
know  his  own"  (Vygotsky,  1934,  p.  160). 

Vygotsky,  then,  saw  much  more  value  in  scientific  concepts  than  Piaget 
did.  In  Vygotsky's  view,  both  scientific  and  spontaneous  concepts  have  their 
own  specific  virtues.  Spontaneous  concepts,  such  as  the  child's  own  concepts 
of  grandmother  and  brother,  are  "saturated  with  experience"  (p.  193);  they  are 
full  of  rich  personal  sensations  and  imagery.  Scientific  concepts,  such  as 
abstract  family  lineage  systems,  are  comparatively  dry.  But  scientific  concepts 
give  children  broader  frameworks  in  which  to  view  their  own  concepts. 

Interactions  Between  Scientific  and  Spontaneous  Concepts.  In 

school,  the  two  kinds  of  concepts  typically  influence  and  benefit  each  other  in 
the  following  way.  Scientific  concepts,  which  the  teacher  hands  down  "from 
above,"  lead  the  way.  They  give  cognitive  development  a  new  goal,  pressing 
children  to  think  more  abstractly  than  they  ordinarily  would. 

For  a  while,  however,  children  usually  have  difficulty  understanding  the 
new  concepts.  That  the  children  understand  them  at  all  must  be  credited  to 
their  spontaneous  concepts.  When,  for  example,  a  typical  Russian  class  of  third- 
graders  listens  to  the  teacher  discuss  the  concept  of  class  conflict,  it  is  only  because 
the  children  have  already  developed  spontaneous  concepts  of  rich  and  poor 
people  that  they  have  an  inkling  of  what  the  teacher  is  talking  about.  As  the 
teacher  presses  on,  the  children  are  asked  to  think  about  the  scientific  concepts 
further,  and  after  a  while  they  may  develop  some  understanding  of  how  their 
spontaneous  concepts  fit  into  a  more  abstract  scheme  (Vygotsky,  1934,  p.  194). 

Instruction,  then,  propels  the  mind  forward.  Instruction,  Vygotsky 
emphasized,  does  not  just  add  something  new  to  the  child's  development, 
like  adding  clothes  to  the  child's  body.  Rather,  it  interacts  with  development, 
awakening  it,  charting  new  paths  for  it.  Vygotsky  said  that  psychologists 
should  do  all  they  can  to  learn  about  this  interaction  (1935,  pp.  80,  91). 

Vygotsky  himself,  however,  found  that  this  interaction  is  difficult  to 
study;  the  developmental  processes  stimulated  by  instruction  are  largely  hid¬ 
den  from  view.  The  one  thing  that  is  certain,  Vygotsky  found,  is  that  devel¬ 
opment  does  not  follow  instruction  in  any  straightforward  way.  When  he 
plotted  the  two  curves — one  for  the  course  of  instruction,  the  other  for  the 
child's  subsequent  mental  development — he  found  that  the  curves  do  not 
coincide.  For  example,  it  often  happens  that  three  or  four  steps  in  instruction 
produce  no  change  in  the  child's  understanding  of  arithmetic,  and  then 

with  a  fifth  step,  something  clicks;  the  child  has  grasped  a  general  prin¬ 
ciple,  and  his  developmental  curve  rises  markedly.  For  this  child,  the 
fifth  operation  was  decisive,  but  this  cannot  be  a  general  rule.  The  turn¬ 
ing  points  at  which  a  general  principle  becomes  clear  to  the  child  can¬ 
not  be  set  in  advance  by  the  curriculum.  (Vygotsky,  1934,  p.  185) 


251 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


Thus  the  teacher  cannot  prescribe  the  manner  in  which  the  child  learns. 
The  teacher  might  create  a  curriculum  that  progresses  in  a  step-by-step  man¬ 
ner,  but  this  doesn't  mean  the  child  will  develop  according  to  the  teacher's 
plan.  Development  has  its  own  rhythms.  Still,  adult  teaching  is  necessary. 
Without  it,  the  child's  mind  wouldn't  advance  very  far  (1934,  p.  185). 


The  Zone  of  Proximal  Development 

Most  teachers  would  probably  agree  with  Vygotsky's  general  viewpoint.  They 
would  agree  that  it  is  their  job  to  move  the  child's  mind  forward,  and  to  do 
this  they  must  directly  teach  children  new  concepts,  not  wait  for  them  to  make 
their  own  discoveries.  At  the  same  time,  teachers  know  they  cannot  teach  any 
concept  to  any  child.  They  cannot,  for  example,  effectively  begin  teaching 
algebra  to  most  first-graders.  Teachers  need  ways  of  determining  the  kinds  of 
lessons  children  are  ready  for. 

Most  schools  have  made  such  decisions  with  the  help  of  standardized 
achievement  and  intelligence  tests.  A  school  might  give  a  third-grade  child 
an  achievement  test,  find  that  she  is  doing  math  at  the  third-grade  level,  and 
assign  her  to  a  middle-level  math  group.  Vygotsky  argued,  however,  that  the 
conventional  tests  are  inadequate.  They  only  measure  the  child's  actual  level 
of  development,  telling  us  how  far  she  has  developed  so  far.  They  do  not  tell 
us  about  the  child's  ability  to  learn  new  material  beyond  her  present  level. 

The  reason  for  this  shortcoming,  Vygotsky  said,  is  that  conventional  tests 
only  evaluate  what  the  child  can  accomplish  when  working  independently. 
But  before  children  can  perform  tasks  alone,  they  can  perform  them  in  col¬ 
laboration  with  others,  receiving  some  guidance  or  support.  To  determine  a 
child's  potential  for  new  learning,  then,  we  need  to  see  how  well  the  child 
can  do  when  offered  some  assistance. 

Vygotsky  asked  us  to  consider  two  boys  who  scored  at  the  8-year-old 
level  on  a  conventional  intelligence  test  (Vygotsky,  1934,  p.  187).  They  scored 
at  this  level,  that  is,  when  working  independently,  as  the  test  requires.  Then, 
however,  the  examiner  presented  some  new  problems,  too  difficult  for  the 
boys  to  solve  on  their  own,  and  offered  each  some  slight  assistance,  such  as  a 
leading  question  or  the  first  step  in  a  solution.  With  this  help,  one  boy  scored 
at  the  9-year-old  level  while  the  other  boy  scored  at  the  12-year-old  level. 
Clearly,  the  boys'  potential  for  new  learning  was  not  the  same.  Vygotsky  called 
the  distance  that  children  can  perform  beyond  their  current  level  the  zone  of 
proximal  development.  More  precisely,  he  defined  the  zone  as 

the  distance  between  the  actual  developmental  level  as  determined  by 
independent  problem  solving  and  the  level  of  potential  development  as 
determined  through  problem  solving  under  adult  guidance  or  in  col¬ 
laboration  with  more  capable  peers.  (1935,  p.  86) 


252 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


Vygotsky  hoped  the  zone  of  proximal  development  would  give  educators  a 
much  better  indication  of  each  child's  true  potential. 

Actually  Vygotsky  wrote  just  as  enthusiastically  about  the  concept's  use¬ 
fulness  to  developmental  psychology  He  discussed  the  concept  as  if  it  pro¬ 
vides  a  new,  improved  searchlight  that  illuminates  not  only  those  functions 
that  have  already  matured  but  also  those  that  are  in  the  process  of  maturing. 
By  focusing  on  the  activities  children  can  accomplish  with  assistance,  the  zone 
reveals  those  abilities  that  are  just  beginning  to  develop,  such  as  the  ability  to 
walk  in  an  infant  who  can  do  so  only  if  she  has  a  hand  to  hold.  The  zone  of 
proximal  development  casts  light  not  so  much  on  "the  ripe  as  the  ripening 
functions" — those  that  the  child  can  carry  out  only  with  assistance  today  but 
will  be  able  to  perform  alone  tomorrow  (Vygotsky,  1934,  p.  188). 

But  how  do  we  know  Vygotsky  was  correct,  that  the  zone  of  proximal 
development  does  illuminate  the  stirrings  of  inner  development?  When  a 
slight  amount  of  assistance  quickly  enables  a  child  to  succeed,  we  can  be  fairly 
certain  we  are  observing  a  spontaneously  developing  capacity.  The  rapid  suc¬ 
cess  suggests  that  the  adult  aided  a  capacity  that  had  already  been  emerging 
from  within. 

But  Vygotsky  also  suggested  that  adults  occasionally  provide  a  great  deal 
of  assistance.  He  approvingly  noted,  for  example,  that  a  child  could  use  an 
abstract  concept  "because  the  teacher,  working  with  the  child,  [had]  explained, 
supplied  information,  questioned,  corrected,  and  made  the  pupil  explain" 
(1934,  p.  191).  In  this  case,  the  teacher  appears  to  have  treated  the  child  like  a 
puppet,  and  it  isn't  clear  that  the  teacher  has  stimulated  anything  sponta¬ 
neous  within  the  child. 

Perhaps  the  only  way  to  know  if  the  child's  spontaneous  development 
is  activated  is  to  watch  the  child.  Is  the  child  enthusiastic,  curious,  and  actively 
involved?  Or  does  the  child  look  off  into  space?  In  fact,  some  research  (e.g., 
Rogoff,  Malkin,  &  Gilbride,  1984)  suggests  that  adults  who  teach  effectively 
within  the  zone  of  proximal  development  do  continually  look  for  signs  of 
spontaneous  interest  on  the  child's  part. 


PRACTICAL  APPLICATIONS 

Vygotsky  wanted  to  help  build  a  new  society,  and  he  deliberately  set  out  to 
construct  a  theory  that  addressed  practical  matters.  As  we  have  just  seen,  he 
tried  to  show  how  school  instruction  can  promote  child  development,  and 
he  offered  a  new  concept — the  zone  of  proximal  development — to  assess 
each  child's  potential  for  new  learning.  If  we  want  to  know  what  a  child  is 
ready  to  learn,  Vygotsky  said,  we  cannot  look  at  what  the  child  can  do  when 
working  alone;  we  must  see  how  far  ahead  she  can  go  when  offered  some 
assistance. 


253 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


The  zone  of  proximal  development  has  captured  the  interest  of  a  grow¬ 
ing  number  of  researchers.  Some  have  evaluated  the  extent  to  which  the  zone 
does  in  fact  diagnose  a  child's  potential  for  new  learning.  The  zone's  diag¬ 
nostic  value  seems  promising  but  in  need  of  refinement;  it  does  not  yet  pre¬ 
dict  end-of-the-year  achievement  better  than  IQ  tests  do  (Berk,  2001,  p.  205). 

The  zone  of  proximal  development  has  stimulated  much  more  interest 
in  the  teaching  process  itself — how  adults  can  help  a  child  solve  problems  or 
use  strategies  that  are  initially  beyond  the  child's  independent  abilities.  Typ¬ 
ically,  psychologists  and  educators  refer  to  this  process  as  scaffolding  (Wood, 
1998).  The  adult  (or  more  competent  peer)  at  first  provides  a  good  deal  of 
assistance,  but  reduces  it  as  the  child  gets  the  hang  of  the  activity.  The  assis¬ 
tance  is  like  a  temporary  scaffold  that  comes  down  when  construction  is  fin¬ 
ished.  For  example,  a  parent  might  initially  help  a  child  pedal  and  steer  a 
bicycle,  but  then  step  aside  as  the  child  seems  able  to  ride  it  on  her  own. 

Brown  and  Palinscar  (1989)  showed  how  teachers  might  scaffold  read¬ 
ing  skills  using  a  method  they  call  reciprocal  teaching.  Initially,  the  teacher 
shows  children  how  to  summarize  and  clarify  reading  passages.  Then  the 
children  take  turns  "being  the  teacher,"  leading  small  groups  of  classmates 
in  the  use  of  the  strategies.  The  teacher  continues  to  guide  the  process  but 
gradually  shifts  much  of  the  responsibility  to  the  children.  The  method  has 
produced  positive  results  (Berk,  2009,  p.  269). 

Elena  Bodrova  and  Deborah  Leong  have  developed  a  program  called 
Tools  of  the  Mind  to  help  preschool  and  kindergarten  children  learn  self¬ 
regulation  skills  such  as  planning  activities,  sticking  to  tasks,  and  ignoring 
distractions.  Bodrova  and  Leong  began  with  Vygtosky's  observation  that  chil¬ 
dren  frequently  demonstrate  remarkable  self-regulation  in  their  make-believe 
play.  For  example,  the  preschooler  who  has  difficulty  sitting  still  during 
circle  time  can  do  so  when  she  plays  the  role  of  a  pupil  in  a  make-believe 
scene  (Bodrova  &  Leong,  2007,  p.  132).  Using  the  Tools  of  the  Mind  program, 
the  teacher  helps  young  children  initiate  and  sustain  make-believe  play. 

Teachers  introduce  children  to  play  themes  through  videos,  field  trips, 
and  books.  Teachers  also  ask  children  to  create  play  plans.  The  children  write 
down  their  plans  (to  the  best  of  their  abilities)  and  draw  pictures  of  them¬ 
selves  engaged  in  the  activities.  Children  are  encouraged  to  make  their  play 
plans  as  specific  as  possible. 

During  the  planning,  the  teachers  suggest  how  the  children  "can  try  out 
new  roles,  add  new  twists  to  the  play  scenario,  or  think  of  a  way  to  substitute 
for  missing  props"  (Bodrova  &  Leong,  2001,  p.  19).  Initially,  children  often 
believe  props  must  be  realistic -looking  toys.  Teachers  wean  children  away 
from  this  idea;  they  brainstorm  with  children  about  the  different  things  a  simple 
object,  such  as  wooden  block,  might  represent.  If  children  have  difficulty  sus¬ 
taining  their  play,  the  teacher  intervenes.  She  helps  them  plan  and  act  out  a 
new  scenario.  If  she  intervenes  a  second  time,  she  offers  less  assistance  (as 
scaffolding  requires)  (Bodrova  &  Leong,  2007,  p.  151).  In  general,  teachers  do 


254 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


a  considerable  amount  of  coaching,  which  they  gradually  fade  out  (Tough, 
2009,  p.  35). 

The  Tools  of  the  Mind  program  values  both  the  quality  of  play — its  rich¬ 
ness  and  complexity — and  the  planning  process  itself.  Planning  helps  chil¬ 
dren  gain  cognitive  control  over  their  behavior. 

Tools  of  the  Mind  also  employs  Vygotsky's  ideas  with  respect  to  academic 
activities  such  as  writing.  For  example,  teachers  ask  children  to  use  private  or 
self-directed  speech  while  drawing  letters.  After  observing  a  class,  journalists 
Bronson  and  Merryman  report: 

When  the  kids  are  learning  the  capital  C,  they  all  say  in  unison,  "Start 
at  the  top  and  go  around"  as  they  start  to  print.  No  one  ever  stops  the 
kids  from  saying  it  out  loud,  but  after  a  few  minutes,  the  Greek  chorus 
ends.  In  its  place  is  a  low  murmur.  A  couple  of  minutes  later,  a  few  kids 
are  still  saying  it  out  loud — but  most  of  the  children  are  saying  it  in  their 
heads.  (Bronson  &  Merryman,  2009,  p.  167) 

In  kindergarten,  children  and  teachers  have  mini-conferences  to  evalu¬ 
ate  the  child's  activities  during  the  past  week  and  to  plan  for  the  next  week 
(Tough,  2009,  p.  35).  These  conferences,  too,  are  designed  to  help  children  gain 
cognitive  control  over  their  behavior.  Some  research  indicates  that  Tools  of 
the  Mind  does,  in  fact,  increase  children's  ability  to  regulate  their  behavior 
(Diamond  et  al.,  2007). 

It  is  interesting  to  note  that  Vygotsky  didn't  write  about  assisting  chil¬ 
dren's  play.  He  described  play  as  if  it's  a  spontaneous  development,  coming 
from  children  themselves.  But  Bodrova  and  Leong  are  justified  in  calling  their 
project  "Vygotskian"  (2001,  p.  17)  because  Vygotsky  generally  emphasized 
the  way  adults  or  more  competent  peers  advance  children's  skills. 

Indeed,  contemporary  Vygotskians  believe  that  adults  and  older 
peers — not  children  themselves — initiate  the  first  episodes  of  make-believe 
play  (Bodrova  &  Leong,  2007,  p.  120;  Berk,  2009,  p.  268).  If  a  toddler  is  hold¬ 
ing  a  doll,  an  adult  might  say,  "Tell  your  baby  to  chew  her  food,"  helping 
the  child  get  into  the  mother  role.  Vygotskians  (Berk,  2009,  p.  268;  Berk  & 
Winsler,  1995,  p.  64)  frequently  cite  two  studies  to  demonstrate  the  need 
for  parental  direction,  but  I  don't  believe  the  studies'  results  warrant  this 
conclusion. 

In  one  study,  Wendy  Haight  and  Peggy  Miller  (1993)  found  that  moth¬ 
ers  tried  to  get  their  1-year-olds  started  on  imaginary  play.  Then,  when  the 
children  were  studied  again  at  age  2,  the  children  initiated  41%  of  their  play 
episodes.  It  might  seem  that  the  parents  introduced  the  children  to  make- 
believe  play,  which  the  children  later  initiated  on  their  own.  But  what  is  over¬ 
looked  is  that  the  parents'  efforts  at  age  1  had  no  discernable  effect.  The 
children  rarely  played  at  that  age.  So  the  children  who  began  make-believe 
episodes  a  full  year  later  (at  age  2)  might  have  acted  spontaneously. 


255 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


In  a  second  study.  Miller  and  Catherine  Garvey  (1984)  found  that  par¬ 
ents  provided  props  such  as  dolls  for  their  2-year-olds'  imaginary  play.  The 
parents  also  allowed  their  children  to  borrow  household  objects  such  as  pots 
and  pans  for  other  props.  But  the  children  themselves  usually  began  the  play 
episodes.  Certainly,  parents  and  older  children  can  support  and  expand 
youngsters'  imaginary  play,  but  I  don't  find  evidence  that  their  teaching  or 
guidance  is  necessary  for  its  emergence. 

In  any  case,  it  will  be  good  to  see  further  research  on  this  question,  which 
highlights  a  basic  disagreement  between  the  Vygotskians  and  Piagetians.  The 
Vygotskians  believe  that  development  always  has  social  origins.  The  Piage¬ 
tians  believe  that  development  emerges  from  the  child  herself.  You  might 
remember  how  Piaget's  daughter  Jacqueline  began  make-believe  play  at  about 
the  age  of  2  years,  as  when  she  moved  her  finger  on  a  table  and  said,  "Horse 
trotting.''  From  Piaget's  accounts,  all  her  play  at  this  age  seemed  to  be  her 
own  creation. 


EVALUATION 

Vygotsky's  work  has  generated  great  excitement  because  it  suggests  impor¬ 
tant  ways  to  expand  traditional  developmental  theory.  Vygotsky  recognized 
that  intrinsic  development,  as  studied  by  Gesell,  Piaget,  and  others,  is  impor¬ 
tant;  children  do  grow  and  learn  from  their  inner  maturational  promptings  and 
inventive  spirit.  But  these  forces  alone,  Vygotsky  said,  will  not  take  children 
very  far.  To  develop  their  minds  fully,  children  also  need  the  intellectual  tools 
provided  by  their  cultures — tools  such  as  language,  memory  aids,  numerical 
systems,  writing,  and  scientific  concepts.  A  major  task  of  developmental  the¬ 
ory  is  to  understand  how  these  tools  are  acquired. 

But  Vygotsky  did  more.  He  suggested  we  should  study  how  intrinsic 
developmental  and  cultural  forces  interact  and  produce  new  transformations. 
It  is  the  interaction  between  these  conflicting  forces  that  psychology  must 
eventually  understand. 

Vygotsky's  suggestion  is  more  impressive  than  it  might  initially  sound. 
Many  psychologists  have  called  for  eclectic  approaches,  saying  we  need  to  con¬ 
sider  a  variety  of  intrinsic  and  environmental  variables  when  we  study  devel¬ 
opment.  Such  statements  sound  reasonable,  but  they  overlook  the  legitimate 
conflicts  between  theorists  who  emphasize  one  force  or  the  other.  Piagetians 
believe  the  child  grasps  a  concept  on  her  own;  environmentalists  believe  she 
learns  it  from  others;  how  can  both  be  right?  There  is  a  logical  contradiction. 

Vygotsky,  as  a  dialectical  theorist,  offered  a  new  perspective.  According 
to  dialectical  theory,  life  is  full  of  contradictions,  and  what  we  need  to  study 
is  what  happens  when  opposing  forces  meet.  We  need  to  see  what  happens 
when  the  growing  child,  trying  to  figure  things  out  for  herself,  encounters 
adults  who  try  to  teach  her  things.  These  interactions,  Vygotsky  observed,  are 


256 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


complex  and  largely  hidden  from  view.  Indeed,  Vygotsky  frequently  used  the 
metaphors  of  magnifying  glasses.  X-rays,  and  telescopes  to  convey  the  need 
to  get  a  better  view  of  them  (Cole  &  Scribner,  1978,  p.  12;  Vygotsky,  1933, 
p.  102;  1935,  p.  91).  But  although  these  interactions  are  difficult  to  study,  they 
are  very  important. 

At  the  same  time,  Vygotsky's  work  suffers  from  one-sidedness.  As  James 
Wertsch  (1985,  pp.  40-49)  points  out,  Vygotsky's  accounts  about  intrinsic  or 
natural  development — that  which  comes  from  the  children  themselves — were 
vague.  Moreover,  when  it  came  to  the  interactions  between  these  intrinsic 
forces  and  cultural  forces,  Vygotsky's  own  research  focused  largely  on  cul¬ 
tural  forces.  For  example,  he  studied  the  ways  in  which  memory  aids,  writ¬ 
ing,  and  scientific  concepts  transform  the  child's  mind,  but  he  didn't  examine 
the  ways  in  which  the  child's  inner,  spontaneous  development  might  affect 
cultural  forces.  He  gave  us  a  good  picture  of  how  children  internalize  their  cul¬ 
ture,  but  he  told  us  little  about  how  they  might  challenge  or  criticize  their  cul¬ 
ture,  as  an  idealistic  adolescent  might  do. 

It  is  easy  to  forgive  any  one-sidedness  in  Vygotsky's  own  research. 
A  person  can  only  do  so  much  in  his  or  her  research  career,  and  Vygotsky's 
career  was  cut  tragically  short.  Others  can  study  the  interactions  between 
development  and  culture  in  fuller  and  more  balanced  ways. 

The  problem  is  that  Vygotsky  did  not  restrict  himself  to  academic  mat¬ 
ters.  He  also  tried  to  shape  educational  practices,  and  his  educational  ideas  are 
rapidly  gaining  popularity.  In  this  realm,  any  one-sidedness  becomes  a  more 
urgent  matter,  and  we  need  to  take  a  close  look  at  it.  In  the  following  com¬ 
ments,  I  evaluate  Vygotsky's  educational  theory  from  a  strongly  develop¬ 
mental  perspective — that  of  writers  such  as  Rousseau,  Montessori,  and  Piaget. 

Vygotsky,  compared  to  these  developmentalists,  was  enthusiastic  about 
school  instruction.  Instruction,  he  said,  gives  development  a  forward  thrust. 
It  "does  not  preclude  development,  but  charts  new  paths  for  it"  (1934,  p.  152). 

On  a  day-to-day  basis,  the  teacher  moves  the  child  forward  by  working 
within  the  zone  of  proximal  development.  That  is,  the  teacher  does  not  just 
give  children  tasks  that  they  can  solve  by  themselves,  but  more  difficult 
tasks — tasks  they  can  solve  only  with  some  assistance.  In  this  way,  instruction 
stimulates  capacities  that  are  still  in  an  embryonic  state  and  pushes  develop¬ 
ment  forward. 

At  first  glance,  this  kind  of  forward-looking  instruction  would  seem 
desirable.  But  many  developmental  scholars  have  been  wary  of  attempts  to 
accelerate  development.  One  danger  is  that  we  can  push  children  forward 
before  we  give  them  the  chance  to  develop  their  potentials  fully  at  their  pres¬ 
ent  stage. 

As  an  example,  Vygotskians  are  attempting  to  promote  goal-directed, 
self-regulated  thinking  in  3-  to  5-year-olds.  Left  on  their  own,  children  at  this 
age  aren't  very  focused  or  deliberate  in  their  approach  to  tasks.  They  don't 
screen  out  irrelevant  information,  and  they  don't  monitor  their  progress. 


257 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


Because  these  self-regulation  skills  will  be  essential  for  future  school  success, 
Vygotskian  educators  are  trying  to  help  children  acquire  them  early  on. 

But  this  forward-looking  instruction  overlooks  a  potential  strength  of 
early  childhood — an  open-minded  receptivity  to  the  world  in  all  its  richness 
and  variety.  Young  children  love  to  wander  about  without  any  goal  in  mind, 
taking  delight  in  whatever  they  find.  They  become  enthralled  by  their 
discoveries — a  shiny  rock,  a  bird,  a  fish  in  a  shallow  brook.  The  world  is  full 
of  enchantment.  Adult  poets,  artists,  and  naturalists  try  to  recapture  this 
fresh  openness  and  sense  of  wonder.  Naturalist  Cathy  Johnson  (1990)  says 
she  tries  to  reduce  the  narrow,  goal-directed  approach  that  we  associate 
with  cognitive  maturity.  Johnson  says  that  if  she  wants  to  make  serendipi¬ 
tous  discoveries,  she  needs  to  allow  herself  to  wander  about  and  be  open 
to  whatever  she  encounters.  Thus,  the  young  child's  unfocused  approach 
to  the  world  has  its  benefits.  If  we  stress  goal-directed  behavior  too  early, 
we  curtail  a  valuable  approach  to  life.  (For  more  on  the  young  child's  open¬ 
ness  to  the  world,  see  Crain,  2003,  and  Gopnik,  2009.) 

Vygotsky's  educational  philosophy  contains  a  second  danger.  Instruc¬ 
tion,  Vygotsky  said,  propels  the  child  forward  because  teachers  and  more 
capable  peers  give  the  child  assistance.  With  the  help  of  others,  children  can 
solve  problems  that  are  beyond  them  as  individuals.  Vygotsky  was  undoubt¬ 
edly  correct  about  this,  but  he  overlooked  the  extent  to  which  outside  assis¬ 
tance  undermines  the  child's  independence.  Developmentalists  have 
repeatedly  warned  that  when  we  give  children  assistance  and  direction,  we 
encourage  them  to  depend  on  others  to  know  what  and  how  to  think,  under¬ 
mining  their  ability  to  think  for  themselves. 

Vygotsky,  to  be  sure,  usually  recommended  that  we  provide  children 
only  with  slight  amounts  of  assistance  (such  as  a  leading  question  or  the  first 
step  in  a  solution).  In  such  cases,  the  threat  to  the  child's  independence  does 
not  seem  to  be  too  great.  But  on  occasion,  Vygotsky  implied  that  we  might 
give  the  child  a  great  deal  of  assistance.  He  implied  this,  for  example,  when 
discussing  his  research  on  the  concept  of  because. 

Vygotsky  found  that  8-year-olds  frequently  use  because  correctly  when 
speaking  on  theoretical  topics  learned  in  school  before  they  do  so  with  respect 
to  their  everyday  concerns.  For  example,  a  girl  might  correctly  say,  "Planned 
economy  in  the  USSR  is  possible  because  there  is  no  private  property" 
(Vygotsky,  1934,  p.  191).  The  reason  for  the  girl's  success,  Vygotsky  said,  is 
that  "the  teacher,  working  with  the  child,  has  explained,  supplied  information, 
questioned,  corrected,  and  made  the  pupil  explain"  (p.  191).  So,  when  the  girl 
responds  alone,  she  speaks  correctly  because  the  teacher's  help  is  "invisibly 
present"  (p.  191). 

But  to  those  who  value  independent  thinking  the  girl's  correct  response 
is  no  cause  for  celebration.  When  the  teacher's  assistance  is  this  pervasive,  it 


258 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


is  difficult  to  imagine  that  the  girl  is  in  any  way  thinking  for  herself.  She  is 
more  like  a  toy  puppet  that  is  saying  what  it  has  been  programmed  to  say. 

Vygotsky  (1935)  had  little  patience  with  such  objections.  Many  devel- 
opmenta lists,  he  said,  are  so  worried  about  the  harmful  effects  of  instruction 
that  they  constantly  keep  it  at  bay.  They  introduce  instruction  only  when  the 
child  is  "ready"  for  it,  which  usually  means  waiting  for  a  capacity  to  fully 
mature  before  adding  any  relevant  instruction.  Instruction  then  becomes 
superfluous,  doing  nothing  to  move  the  child  forward. 

Actually,  developmental  educators  in  the  tradition  of  Montessori,  Dewey, 
and  Piaget  believe  that  children  sometimes  consolidate  current  capacities  and 
sometimes  move  forward.  These  educators  believe  that  children  themselves 
tell  us  which  tasks  they  need.  They  take  a  keen  interest  in  such  tasks  and  work 
on  them  with  great  energy  and  concentration.  For  example,  Montessori  found 
that  children  of  4  years  or  so  become  deeply  engrossed  in  cutting  vegetables 
and  other  practical  activities,  probably  because  these  activities  help  them 
develop  their  perceptual-motor  skills.  The  teacher's  job  is  to  observe  the  child's 
interests  and  inclinations  and  to  provide  activities  that  engage  the  child  in  a 
full  way. 

Teachers  will,  of  course,  be  tempted  to  introduce  materials  that  they 
know  the  child  will  need  in  the  future.  But  education  is  most  effective  when 
it  is  geared  to  the  child's  own  interests  and  inclinations,  not  the  teacher's  goals 
for  the  future.  And  in  no  case  should  the  teacher  present  tasks  that  are  so  far 
ahead  of  the  child  that  the  child  can  solve  them  only  with  the  teacher's  assis¬ 
tance.  The  teacher  should  introduce  activities  that  stimulate,  challenge,  and 
engage  the  child,  and  then  let  the  child  solve  them  on  his  or  her  own. 

Some  of  Vygotsky's  followers  have  narrowed  the  gap  between  Vygotsky 
and  the  strong  developmentalists.  They  point  to  instruction  that  pays  close 
attention  to  the  child's  interest  and  enthusiasm  as  it  leads  the  child  through 
tasks  (Griffin  &  Cole,  1984;  Rogoff,  1998).  These  investigators  do  not  want  to 
squash  the  child's  creativity  or  participation  in  the  learning  process.  In  fact,  in 
one  essay,  Vygotsky  (1935,  pp.  116-119)  himself  argued  that  instruction  should 
arouse  the  child's  vital  interests  and  correspond  to  the  child's  natural  way  of 
learning. 

One  Vygotskian,  Barbara  Rogoff  (2003,  chap.  8),  suggests  that  part  of  the 
problem  is  that  Vygotsky  focused  on  schools,  where  learning  is  predominantly 
adult  directed.  In  many  non-Western  communities,  children  more  frequently 
learn  through  participation  in  work-related  activities  and  take  more  initiative 
with  respect  to  the  tasks.  For  example,  young  Mayan  children  decide  on  their 
own  to  make  tortillas,  with  mothers  giving  them  any  assistance  they  need.  In 
many  communities,  children  are  expected  to  initially  learn  adult  work  through 
observation,  and  "children  take  a  leading  role  in  managing  their  own  atten¬ 
tion,  motivation,  and  involvement  in  learning,  through  their  observation  and 
participation  in  ongoing  mature  activities"  (Rogoff,  2003,  p.  301). 


259 


Vygotsky's  Social-Historical  Theory  of  Cognitive  Development 


Rogoff,  then,  shares  the  developmentalists'  emphasis  on  children  tak¬ 
ing  the  initiative  in  their  learning.  But  neither  she  nor  other  Vygotskians 
endorse  a  really  strong  developmental  position.  They  particularly  object  to 
Piaget.  As  Bruner  (1984,  p.  96)  has  said,  they  oppose  Piaget's  "image  of  human 
development  as  a  lone  venture  for  the  child,"  in  which  the  child  must  figure 
everything  out  on  her  own.  Instead,  society  has  a  responsibility  to  provide 
the  child  with  the  intellectual  tools  it  has  developed,  and  this  means  provid¬ 
ing  her  with  instruction  and  assistance.  If  this  assistance  forces  the  child  to 
lean  on  others  for  intellectual  support,  so  be  it.  Children  simply  cannot  dis¬ 
cover  everything  on  their  own.  To  develop  their  minds  they  need  the  help  of 
adults  and  more  capable  peers. 

In  the  last  analysis,  then,  Vygotsky  and  the  developmentalists  disagree 
over  the  extent  to  which  development  can  be  entrusted  to  the  child,  to  the 
child's  own  interests  and  efforts.  And  this  disagreement  is  likely  to  continue 
for  a  long  time.  But  this  may  be  a  good  thing.  For  disagreement  can  be  part 
of  an  ongoing  dialectic,  a  series  of  challenges  and  responses  that  keep  both 
sides  thinking  and  coming  up  with  new  ideas. 


260 


Freud’s  Psychoanalytic 

Theory 


BIOGRAPHICAL  INTRODUCTION 

In  this  chapter  we  will  begin  discussing  a  group  of  theorists — the  psy¬ 
choanalysts — whose  special  province  has  been  the  inner  world  of  feel¬ 
ings,  impulses,  and  fantasies.  The  principal  founder  of  psychoanalytic 
theory  was  Sigmund  Freud  (1856-1939). 

To  an  extent,  Freud's  thinking  was  similar  to  developmentalists 
such  as  Gesell;  Freud  believed  psychological  change  is  governed  by 
inner  forces,  especially  biological  maturation.  But  Freud  also  thought 
that  maturation  brings  with  it  unruly  sexual  and  aggressive  energies, 
which  societies  must  harness.  So,  social  forces  also  play  a  powerful  role 
in  Freud's  theory. 

Freud  was  bom  in  Freiberg,  Moravia  (later  part  of  Czechoslovakia). 
He  was  the  first  child  of  a  20-year-old  mother  and  a  40-year-old  father, 
although  his  father  also  had  two  grown  sons  from  a  previous  marriage. 
The  father  was  a  wool  merchant  who  never  became  very  successful  in 
business,  and  financial  troubles  forced  the  family  to  move  twice  when 
Freud  was  young — first  to  Leipzig,  and  then,  when  Freud  was  4,  to 
Vienna,  where  Freud  lived  until  the  last  year  of  his  life  (Jones,  1961, 
chap.  1). 

As  a  boy,  Freud  was  a  brilliant  student,  and  the  family  encouraged 
his  studies.  His  parents  made  sure  he  had  an  oil  lamp  to  study  by,  while 
the  other  family  members  had  only  candles  (Schultz,  1975,  p.  302). 
Freud's  intellectual  interests  covered  a  wide  variety  of  topics,  and  when 
he  was  old  enough  to  enter  the  university  he  had  difficulty  deciding  on 
an  area  of  study.  With  some  reluctance,  he  chose  medicine,  primarily 
because  it  gave  him  an  opportunity  to  do  research.  In  medical  school 
Freud  conducted  important  investigations  of  the  spinal  cord  of  the 
Petromyzon,  a  type  of  fish  (Jones,  1961,  chaps.  3  and  4). 


From  Theories  of  Development:  Concepts  and  Applications,  Sixth  Edition.  William 
Crain.  Copyright  ©  2011  by  Pearson  Education,  Inc.  Published  by  Pearson 
Prentice  Hall.  All  rights  reserved. 


261 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


Between  the  ages  of  26  and  35,  Freud  restlessly  searched  for  a  field  in 
which  he  might  make  some  important  discovery.  He  continued  to  do  research 
in  established  areas  of  neurology,  but  he  was  more  excited  by  other  possibil¬ 
ities.  For  a  while,  he  thought  he  might  find  revolutionary  uses  for  cocaine,  a 
drug  to  which  he  seemed  temporarily  addicted.  Freud  also  visited  Charcot's 
laboratory  in  Paris,  where  Charcot  was  investigating  the  mysteries  of  hyste¬ 
ria.  The  study  of  this  disorder  became  the  starting  point  of  Freud's  great  con¬ 
tributions  (Jones,  1961,  chaps.  5,  6, 10,  and  11). 

The  term  hysteria  is  applied  to  physical  ailments  as  well  as  to  losses  of 
memory  for  which  there  is  no  physiological  explanation.  A  woman  might 
complain  of  a  "glove  anesthesia,"  a  loss  of  feeling  in  the  hand  up  to  the  wrist, 
even  though  physiologically  there  is  no  way  she  could  lose  sensation  in  pre¬ 
cisely  this  part  of  the  body. 

Freud's  first  work  on  hysteria  followed  the  example  of  Josef  Breuer, 
who  had  treated  a  woman  ("Anna  O.")  by  helping  her  uncover  buried 
thoughts  and  feelings  through  hypnosis.  It  seemed  to  Breuer  and  Freud  (1895) 
that  hysteric  patients  had  somehow  blocked  off,  or  repressed,  wishes  and  emo¬ 
tions  from  awareness.  The  blocked-off  energy  had  then  become  converted 
into  physical  symptoms.  Therapy,  then,  consisted  of  uncovering  and  releas¬ 
ing  emotions  that  had  been  relegated  to  a  separate  part  of  the  mind — the 
unconscious. 

Freud's  early  work  with  hysteric  patients  can  be  illustrated  by  the  case 
of  a  woman  he  called  Elizabeth  von  R.  Elizabeth  suffered  from  hysterical  pains 
in  her  thighs,  pains  that  became  worse  after  walks  with  her  brother-in-law, 
toward  whom  she  "grew  to  feel  a  peculiar  sympathy  .  .  .  which  easily  passed 
with  her  for  family  tenderness''  (Freud,  1910,  p.  23).  The  sister  (his  wife)  then 
died,  and  Elizabeth  was  summoned  to  the  funeral.  As  Elizabeth  "stood  by  the 
bedside  of  her  dead  sister,  for  one  short  moment  there  surged  up  in  her  mind 
an  idea,  which  might  be  framed  in  these  words:  'Now  he  is  free  and  can  marry 
me'"  (p.  23).  This  wish  was  totally  unacceptable  to  her  sense  of  morality,  so  she 
immediately  repressed  it.  She  then  fell  ill  with  severe  hysterical  pains,  and 
when  Freud  came  to  treat  her,  she  had  completely  forgotten  the  scene  at  her 
sister's  bedside.  Many  hours  of  psychoanalytic  work  were  necessary  to 
uncover  this  and  other  memories,  for  Elizabeth  had  strong  reasons  for  barring 
them  from  consciousness.  Eventually,  she  was  able  to  gain  awareness  of  her 
feelings,  and,  to  the  extent  she  could  accept  them,  they  no  longer  needed  to 
be  redirected  into  bodily  symptoms. 

In  Freud's  work  with  Elizabeth  and  many  other  patients,  he  did  not  use 
hypnosis,  the  technique  Breuer  had  employed.  Freud  found  that  hypnosis, 
among  its  other  drawbacks,  could  only  be  used  with  some  patients,  and  even 
with  those  it  often  produced  only  temporary  cures.  In  its  place  Freud  devel¬ 
oped  the  method  of  free  association,  in  which  the  patient  is  instructed  to  let  his 
or  her  mind  go  and  to  report  everything  just  as  it  occurs,  making  no  effort  to 
order  or  censor  the  thoughts  in  any  way. 


262 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


Freud  found,  however,  that  although  free  association  eventually  leads  to 
buried  thoughts  and  feelings,  it  is  by  no  means  completely  free.  Patients 
strongly  resist  the  process.  They  block  on  certain  topics,  change  the  topic, 
insist  that  their  thoughts  are  too  trivial  or  embarrassing  to  mention,  and  so  on 
(Freud,  1920,  pp.  249-250).  Freud  named  these  interruptions  resistance  and 
considered  resistance  new  evidence  for  the  power  of  repression  in  the  mind 
(Breuer  &  Freud,  1895,  p.  314).  That  is,  Freud  saw  new  evidence  for  his  the¬ 
ory  that  the  patient's  mind  is  at  war  with  itself,  that  certain  wishes  are  unac¬ 
ceptable  to  the  patient's  "ethical,  aesthetic,  or  personal  pretensions,"  and  that 
the  wishes  therefore  need  to  be  repressed  (Freud,  1910,  p.  22). 

As  Freud  built  his  theory,  he  speculated  that  not  only  hysterics  and  other 
neurotic  patients  suffer  from  this  kind  of  internal  conflict.  We  all  have  thoughts 
and  desires  we  cannot  admit  to  ourselves.  In  neurosis,  repression  and  con¬ 
flict  become  particularly  intense  and  unmanageable,  and  symptoms  result. 
Nevertheless,  conflict  characterizes  the  human  condition  (Freud,  1900,  p.  294; 
1933,  p.  121). 

Breuer  and  Freud  published  a  book  together — Studies  on  Hysteria 
(1895) — which  became  the  first  classic  work  in  psychoanalytic  theory.  After¬ 
ward,  however,  Breuer  discontinued  his  work  in  the  area.  Breuer 's  decision 
was  largely  influenced  by  the  direction  the  work  was  taking.  Freud  was 
increasingly  finding  that  the  central  emotions  that  hysterics  blocked  from 
awareness  were  sexual  ones — a  finding  that  Breuer  sensed  was  true  but  which 
he  also  found  personally  distasteful  and  troubling.  Moreover,  the  sexual  the¬ 
ory  brought  ridicule  from  the  scientific  community,  and  this  hurt  Breuer 
deeply.  Consequently,  Breuer  left  it  to  Freud  to  investigate  this  new  area  by 
himself. 

As  Freud  pressed  on  with  the  work,  he  found  that  his  patients'  buried 
memories  led  farther  back  into  their  pasts — into  their  childhoods.  Freud  had 
great  trouble  understanding  what  he  was  finding.  His  patients  repeatedly 
told  stories  about  how  their  parents  had  committed  the  most  immoral  sexual 
acts  against  them  as  children — stories  that  Freud  finally  concluded  must 
mainly  be  fantasies.  For  a  while,  it  seemed  his  research  had  gone  up  in  smoke. 
It  was  not  built  on  truth,  but  on  fiction.  But  he  then  concluded  that  fantasies, 
too,  govern  our  lives.  Our  thoughts  and  feelings  can  be  as  important  as  actual 
events  (Freud,  1914a,  p.  300;  Gay,  1988,  p.  95). 

In  1897,  the  year  in  which  Freud  was  puzzling  over  the  truth  of  his 
patients'  memories,  he  began  a  second  line  of  investigation — a  self-analysis. 
Motivated  by  the  disturbance  he  felt  when  his  father  died,  he  began  examin¬ 
ing  his  own  dreams,  memories,  and  childhood  experiences.  Through  this 
analysis,  he  gained  independent  confirmation  of  his  theory  of  childhood  sex¬ 
uality  and  discovered  what  he  considered  his  greatest  insight:  the  Oedipus 
complex  in  the  child.  That  is,  he  discovered  that  he  (and  presumably  all  chil¬ 
dren  as  well)  develop  an  intense  rivalry  with  the  parent  of  the  same  sex  for  the 
affection  of  the  parent  of  the  opposite  sex.  Freud  first  published  this  theory  in 


263 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


the  Interpretation  of  Dreams  (1900).  He  called  the  interpretation  of  dreams  "the 
royal  road  to  the  unconscious"  (p.  647). 

Freud's  self-analysis  was  not  an  easy  process.  He  had  begun  delving 
into  an  area — the  unconscious — out  of  which  "God  knows  what  kind  of  beast 
will  creep"  (Jones,  1961,  p.  213).  At  times,  Freud  was  unable  to  think  or  write; 
he  experienced  "an  intellectual  paralysis  such  as  I  have  never  imagined"  (p.  213). 
And,  on  top  of  this,  what  he  was  finding — evidence  for  childhood  sexuality — 
was  unacceptable  to  most  of  the  scientific  community.  Most  of  his  colleagues 
believed,  with  everyone  else,  that  sexuality  begins  at  puberty,  not  before. 
Freud's  suggestion  that  innocent  children  experience  sexual  desires  indicated 
that  he  was  little  more  than  a  perverted  sex  maniac.  In  the  face  of  this  reaction, 
Freud  felt  "completely  isolated"  and  said  he  often  dreaded  losing  his  way 
and  his  confidence  (Freud,  1914a,  p.  302). 

About  1901  (when  Freud  was  45  years  old)  he  finally  began  to  emerge 
from  his  intellectual  isolation.  His  work  attracted  various  younger  scientists 
and  writers,  some  of  whom  began  meeting  with  him  for  weekly  discussions. 
These  discussion  groups  gradually  evolved  into  a  formal  psychoanalytic  asso¬ 
ciation.  Among  Freud's  early  disciples  were  Alfred  Adler  and  Carl  Jung,  who, 
like  several  others,  eventually  broke  with  Freud  and  established  their  own 
psychoanalytic  theories. 

Freud  continued  to  develop  and  revise  his  theory  until  the  end  of  his 
life,  the  last  16  years  of  which  he  spent  in  pain  from  cancer  of  the  jaw.  In  1933 
the  Nazis  burned  his  books  in  Berlin,  and  in  1938  he  had  to  leave  Vienna  for 
London,  where  he  lived  his  last  year  and  died  at  the  age  of  83. 


THE  STAGES  OF  PSYCHOSEXUAL 
DEVELOPMENT 

We  have  seen  how  Freud's  work  led  him  to  believe  that  sexual  feelings  must 
be  active  in  childhood.  Freud's  concept  of  sex,  however,  was  very  broad.  In 
his  view  (1905),  "sex"  includes  not  just  sexual  intercourse  but  practically 
anything  that  produces  bodily  pleasure.  In  childhood,  in  particular,  sexual 
feelings  are  very  general  and  diffuse.  Sexual  feelings  may  be  included  in 
activities  such  as  sucking  for  pleasure,  masturbation,  the  wish  to  show  off 
one's  body  or  to  look  at  the  bodies  of  others,  anal  excretion  or  retention, 
body  movements  such  as  rocking,  and  even  acts  of  cruelty,  such  as  pinching 
or  biting  (pp.  585-594). 

Freud  had  two  major  reasons  for  considering  such  diverse  activities  as 
sexual.  First,  children  seem  to  derive  pleasure  from  them.  Babies  enjoy  suck¬ 
ing  even  when  they  are  not  hungry;  they  suck  their  hands,  fingers,  and  other 
objects  because  it  produces  pleasurable  sensations  on  the  mucous  membranes 
of  the  mouth  (p.  588).  Second,  Freud  regarded  many  childhood  activities  as 
sexual  because  they  later  reemerge  in  adult  sexual  activity.  Most  adults  engage 


264 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


in  sucking  (i.e.,  kissing),  looking,  exhibitionism,  or  cuddling  immediately 
prior  to  and  during  sexual  intercourse.  Sometimes,  in  the  cases  of  so-called  per¬ 
versions,  adults  reach  orgasm  through  childhood  sexual  activities  alone  (with¬ 
out  sexual  intercourse).  A  "Peeping  Tom"  may  reach  orgasm  simply  by  looking 
at  the  bodies  of  others.  Neurotic  adults,  too,  retain  childhood  sexual  wishes, 
but  they  feel  so  much  guilt  and  shame  that  they  repress  them  (Freud,  1920, 
chaps.  20  and  21;  1905,  pp.  577-579). 

In  Freud's  theory,  the  term  for  one's  general  sexual  energy  is  libido,  and 
any  part  of  the  body  on  which  this  energy  becomes  focused  is  called  an 
erogenous  zone  (Freud,  1905,  pp.  585-594, 611).  Almost  any  part  of  the  body  can 
become  an  erogenous  zone,  but  in  childhood  the  three  most  important  zones 
are  the  mouth,  the  anus,  and  the  genital  area.  These  zones  become  the  center 
of  the  child's  sexual  interests  in  a  specific  stage  sequence.  The  child's  first  inter¬ 
ests  center  on  the  mouth  (the  oral  stage),  followed  by  the  anus  (the  anal  stage), 
and  finally  the  genital  region  (the  phallic  stage).  Freud  thought  that  this 
sequence  is  governed  by  a  maturational  process — by  innate,  biological  factors 
(pp.  587,  621).  At  the  same  time,  the  child's  social  experiences  also  play  a  deci¬ 
sive  developmental  role.  For  example,  a  child  who  experiences  a  great  deal  of 
frustration  at  the  oral  stage  may  develop  a  lasting  preoccupation  with  things 
having  to  do  with  the  mouth.  Let  us  now  look  at  Freud's  stages  in  more  detail. 


The  Oral  Stage 

The  First  Months.  Freud  said  that  "if  the  infant  could  express  itself, 
it  would  undoubtedly  acknowledge  that  the  act  of  sucking  at  its  mother's 
breast  is  far  and  away  the  most  important  thing  in  life"  (Freud,  1920,  p.  323). 
Sucking  is  vital,  of  course,  because  it  provides  nourishment;  the  baby  must 
suck  to  stay  alive.  But,  as  mentioned,  Freud  thought  that  sucking  also  pro¬ 
vides  pleasure  in  its  own  right.  This  is  why  babies  suck  on  their  thumbs  and 
other  objects  even  when  they  are  not  hungry.  Freud  called  such  pleasure¬ 
sucking  autoerotic;  when  babies  suck  their  thumbs,  they  do  not  direct  their 
impulses  toward  others  but  find  gratification  through  their  own  bodies 
(Freud,  1905,  p.  586). 

Autoerotic  activities  are  not  confined  to  the  oral  stage.  Later  on,  for 
example,  children  stimulate  their  genitals  for  pleasure,  and  this  too  is  auto¬ 
erotic.  However,  Freud  emphasized  the  autoerotic  nature  of  the  oral  stage 
because  he  wanted  to  stress  the  extent  to  which  babies  are  wrapped  up  in 
their  own  bodies.  Like  Piaget,  Freud  thought  that  during  the  first  six  months 
or  so  the  baby's  world  is  "objectless."  That  is,  the  baby  has  no  conception  of 
people  or  things  existing  in  their  own  right.  When  nursing,  for  example, 
young  infants  experience  the  comfort  of  the  mother's  hold,  but  they  do  not 
recognize  the  existence  of  the  mother  as  a  separate  person.  Similarly,  when 
cold,  wet,  or  hungry,  babies  feel  mounting  tension  and  even  panic,  but  they 
are  unaware  of  any  separate  person  who  might  relieve  the  pain.  They  simply 


265 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


long  for  a  return  of  pleasurable  feelings.  Thus,  although  babies  are  completely 
dependent  on  others,  they  are  unaware  of  this  fact  because  they  do  not  yet 
recognize  other  people's  separate  existence. 

Sometimes  Freud  described  this  initial  objectless  state  as  one  of  primary 
narcissism  (e.g.,  Freud,  1915a,  p.  79).  The  term  narcissism  means  self-love  and 
is  taken  from  the  Greek  myth  about  a  boy  called  Narcissus,  who  fell  in  love 
with  his  reflection  in  a  pond.  As  Edith  Jacobson  (1964,  chap.  1)  has  observed, 
this  term  is  somewhat  confusing  because  it  implies  that  babies  have  a  clear 
conception  of  themselves  to  love,  when  they  still  cannot  distinguish  them¬ 
selves  from  the  rest  of  the  world.  Still,  narcissism  does  convey  the  idea  that  at 
first  babies  focus  primarily  inward,  on  their  own  bodies.  The  basic  narcissis¬ 
tic  state,  Freud  (1916)  said,  is  sleep,  when  infants  feel  warm  and  content  and 
have  absolutely  no  interest  in  the  outside  world. 

The  Second  Part  of  the  Oral  Stage.  Beginning  at  about  6  months  of 
age,  babies  begin  to  develop  a  conception  of  another  being,  especially  the 
mother,  as  a  separate,  necessary  person.  They  become  anxious  when  she  leaves 
or  when  they  encounter  a  stranger  in  her  place  (Freud,  1936a,  p.  99). 

At  the  same  time,  another  important  development  is  taking  place:  the 
growth  of  teeth  and  the  urge  to  bite.  At  this  point,  Karl  Abraham  (1924a) 
pointed  out,  babies  dimly  form  the  idea  that  it  is  they,  with  their  urge  to  bite 
and  devour,  who  can  drive  their  mothers  away.  Life  at  this  stage,  then, 
becomes  increasingly  complex  and  troubling.  It  is  little  wonder  that  we  may 
often  unconsciously  wish  to  return  to  the  earlier  oral  stage,  when  things 
seemed  so  much  simpler  and  more  gratifying. 

An  Illustration:  Hansel  and  Gretel.  Freud  was  aware  of  the  difficulty 
in  reaching  conclusions  about  the  infant's  mental  life.  Babies  cannot  talk  and 
tell  us  about  their  feelings  and  fantasies.  To  some  extent,  we  are  forced  to  recon¬ 
struct  the  infant's  psychic  life  from  the  analyses  of  adults  who  seem  to  revert 
to  early  ways  of  thinking — namely,  psychotics.  But  Freudians  also  suggest  that 
many  myths  and  fairy  tales  reveal  the  child's  early  fantasies  and  concerns. 

Bruno  Bettelheim  (1976,  pp.  159-166)  wrote  about  the  oral  themes  con¬ 
tained  in  the  story  of  FFansel  and  Gretel.  Briefly,  FFansel  and  Gretel  are  two  chil¬ 
dren  who  are  sent  into  the  forest  by  their  parents,  especially  the  mother, 
because  they  are  careless  with  food  (milk)  and  there  is  no  longer  enough  to 
feed  them.  In  the  forest,  they  discover  a  gingerbread  house,  which  they  pro¬ 
ceed  to  devour.  Sensing  that  it  may  be  dangerous  to  eat  so  much  of  the  house. 
Hansel  and  Gretel  hear  a  voice  that  asks,  "Who  is  nibbling  at  my  house?''  But 
they  ignore  it,  telling  themselves,  "It  is  only  the  wind"  (The  Brothers  Grimm, 
1972,  p.  90).  The  woman  who  owns  the  house  then  appears,  and  she  is  at  first 
completely  gratifying.  She  gives  them  all  kinds  of  good  things  to  eat  and  nice 
beds  in  which  to  sleep.  But  the  next  day  she  turns  out  to  be  worse  than  their 
mother.  She  is  a  witch  who  intends  to  eat  them. 


266 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


In  Bettelheim's  analysis,  the  themes  are  largely  those  of  the  second  oral 
stage.  The  story  begins  with  the  children  experiencing  the  dreaded  separa¬ 
tion  from  their  caretakers.  There  is  some  hint  that  the  children's  own  inner 
urges  are  at  the  root  of  their  troubles;  they  have  been  reckless  with  their 
mother's  milk  and  they  greedily  devour  the  gingerbread  house.  The  children's 
wish  is  to  return  to  the  first  oral  stage,  which  seemed  so  blissful.  So  they  meet 
the  witch,  who  is  temporarily  "the  original,  all-giving  mother,  whom  every 
child  hopes  to  find  again  later  somewhere  out  in  the  world"  (Bettelheim,  1976, 
p.  161).  However,  this  proves  impossible.  Because  they  are  dimly  aware  of 
their  own  oral  destructiveness,  they  imagine  that  others  will  take  an  oral 
revenge,  which  is  what  the  witch  attempts  to  do. 

Bettelheim  says  that  fairy  tales  facilitate  growth  by  addressing  children's 
deepest  fears  while,  at  the  same  time,  showing  them  that  their  problems  have 
solutions.  In  this  story.  Hansel  and  Gretel  finally  quit  acting  solely  on  the  basis 
of  their  oral  impulses  and  use  more  rational  parts  of  the  personality.  They 
employ  reason  to  outwit  the  witch  and  kill  her,  and  they  return  home  as  more 
mature  children. 

Fixation  and  Regression.  According  to  Freud,  we  all  go  through  the 
oral  stage  as  well  as  every  other  stage  of  psychosexual  development.  However, 
we  also  can  develop  a  fixation  at  any  stage,  which  means  that  no  matter  how 
far  we  have  advanced  beyond  it,  we  maintain  a  lasting  preoccupation  with  the 
pleasures  and  issues  of  the  earlier  stage.  For  example,  if  we  are  fixated  at  the 
oral  stage,  we  might  find  ourselves  continually  preoccupied  with  food;  or  we 
find  that  we  work  most  comfortably  when  we  are  sucking  or  biting  on  objects, 
such  as  pencils;  or  we  gain  the  most  pleasure  from  oral  sexual  activities;  or  we 
find  ourselves  addicted  to  smoking  or  drinking  partly  because  of  the  oral 
pleasure  involved  (Abraham,  1924b;  Freud,  1905). 

Freud  (1920,  p.  357)  said  that  he  was  not  certain  about  the  causes  of  fix¬ 
ation,  but  psychoanalysts  generally  believe  that  fixations  are  produced  by  either 
excessive  gratification  or  excessive  frustration  at  the  stage  in  question  (Abra¬ 
ham,  1924b,  p.  357;  Fenichel,  1945,  p.  65).  The  baby  who  receives  prolonged 
and  very  satisfying  nursing  may  continue  to  seek  oral  pleasures.  Alternatively, 
the  baby  who  experiences  sharp  frustrations  and  deprivations  at  the  oral  stage 
may  act  as  if  he  or  she  is  unwilling  to  give  up  oral  satisfactions  or  as  if  there  is 
a  persistent  danger  that  oral  needs  will  not  be  met.  Such  a  person  might,  for 
instance,  become  anxious  when  meals  are  not  served  on  time  and  devour  the 
food  as  if  it  might  disappear  at  any  moment.  In  general,  it  seems  that  severe 
frustrations,  rather  than  excessive  gratifications,  produce  the  strongest  fixa¬ 
tions  (White  &  Watt,  1973,  pp.  136, 148, 189;  Whiting  &  Child,  1953). 

Sometimes  people  show  few  oral  traits  in  their  daily  lives  until  they 
experience  some  frustration,  and  then  they  regress  to  the  oral  fixation  point.  A 
little  boy  who  suddenly  finds  himself  deprived  of  parental  affections  when  his 
baby  sister  is  born  might  regress  to  oral  behavior  and  once  again  take  up 


267 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


thumb  sucking — something  he  had  previously  given  up.  Or  a  teenage  girl 
may  not  be  particularly  concerned  about  oral  matters  until  she  loses  a 
boyfriend,  and  then  she  becomes  depressed  and  finds  comfort  in  eating. 

The  tendency  to  regress  is  determined  by  both  the  strength  of  the  fixa¬ 
tion  in  childhood  and  the  magnitude  of  the  current  frustration  (Freud,  1920, 
chap.  22).  If  we  have  a  strong  oral  fixation,  a  relatively  small  frustration  in 
our  current  life  may  be  sufficient  to  cause  an  oral  regression.  Alternatively,  a 
major  frustration  might  cause  a  regression  to  an  earlier  developmental  stage 
even  if  the  fixation  was  not  particularly  strong. 

The  kinds  of  regressions  we  have  been  discussing  might  occur  in  any  of 
us — in  relatively  "normal"  people.  We  all  find  life  frustrating  at  times,  and 
now  and  then  we  regress  to  earlier,  more  infantile,  ways  of  behaving.  Such 
regressions  are  not  pathological,  because  they  are  only  partial  and  temporary. 
For  example,  the  boy  who  resumes  thumb  sucking  when  his  baby  sister  is 
born  usually  does  so  only  for  a  while;  in  any  case,  he  does  not  become  like  an 
infant  in  other  respects. 

Freud  also  believed,  however,  that  the  concepts  of  fixation  and  regression 
can  help  clarify  more  serious  emotional  disorders.  In  certain  forms  of  schizo¬ 
phrenia,  there  is  a  very  complete  regression  to  the  first  developmental  stage.  The 
schizophrenic  often  withdraws  from  interaction  with  others  and  entertains 
grandiose  ideas  concerning  his  or  her  importance.  A  patient  may  think  she  is 
God  and  her  ideas  affect  the  whole  world.  In  such  a  case,  the  person  has  under¬ 
gone  a  fairly  complete  regression  to  a  state  of  primary  narcissism,  in  which  the 
libido  is  invested  solely  in  the  self,  and  the  boundaries  between  the  self  and  the 
rest  of  the  world  have  once  again  become  unstable  (Freud,  1920,  pp.  422-424). 

According  to  Abraham  (1924a),  regression  to  the  oral  stage  is  also  evident 
in  severe  cases  of  depression.  Such  depressions  frequently  follow  the  loss  of 
a  loved  one,  and  a  common  symptom  is  the  patient's  refusal  to  eat.  Perhaps 
patients  are  punishing  themselves  because  they  unconsciously  feel  it  was  their 
own  oral  anger  that  destroyed  the  love  object. 


The  Anal  Stage 

During  the  second  and  third  years  of  the  child's  life,  the  anal  zone  becomes 
the  focus  of  the  child's  sexual  interests.  Children  become  increasingly  aware 
of  the  pleasurable  sensations  that  bowel  movements  produce  on  the  mucous 
membranes  of  the  anal  region.  As  they  gain  maturational  control  over  their 
sphincter  muscles,  they  sometimes  learn  to  hold  back  their  bowel  movements 
until  the  last  moment,  thereby  increasing  the  pressure  on  the  rectum  and 
heightening  the  pleasure  of  the  final  release  (Freud,  1905,  p.  589).  Children 
also  frequently  take  an  interest  in  the  products  of  their  labors  and  enjoy  han¬ 
dling  and  smearing  their  feces  (Freud,  1913,  pp.  88-91;  Jones,  1918,  p.  424). 

It  is  at  this  stage  that  children  are  first  asked  to  renounce  their  instinc¬ 
tual  pleasures  in  a  fairly  dramatic  way.  Few  parents  are  willing  to  permit  their 


268 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


children  to  smear  and  play  with  feces  for  very  long.  Most  parents,  as  well- 
socialized  individuals,  feel  a  certain  repugnance  over  anal  matters  and  soon 
get  children  to  feel  the  same  way.  As  soon  as  their  children  are  ready,  if  not 
sooner,  parents  toilet-train  them. 

Some  children  initially  fight  back  by  deliberately  soiling  themselves 
(Freud,  1905,  p.  591).  They  also  sometimes  rebel  by  becoming  wasteful,  dis¬ 
orderly,  and  messy — traits  that  sometimes  persist  into  adulthood  as  aspects  of 
the  "anal  expulsive"  character  (J.  F.  Brown,  1940;  Hall,  1954,  p.  108). 

Freud,  however,  was  most  interested  in  the  opposite  reaction  to  parental 
demands.  He  observed  that  some  people  develop  an  excessive  stake  in  clean¬ 
liness,  orderliness,  and  reliability  (1908a).  It  seems  as  if  they  felt,  as  children, 
that  it  was  too  risky  to  rebel  against  parental  demands,  and  so  they  anxiously 
conformed  to  parental  rules.  Instead  of  messing  and  smearing,  they  became 
models  of  self-control,  acquiring  a  disgust  for  anything  dirty  or  smelly,  and 
developing  a  compulsive  need  to  be  clean  and  orderly.  Such  people,  who  are 
sometimes  labeled  "anal  compulsive"  characters,  also  harbor  resentment  over 
submitting  to  authority,  but  they  do  not  dare  express  their  anger  openly. 
Instead,  they  frequently  develop  a  passive  obstinacy;  they  insist  on  doing 
things  according  to  their  own  schedule — often  while  others  are  forced  to  wait. 
They  may  also  be  frugal  and  stingy.  It  is  as  if  they  feel  that  although  they  were 
forced  to  give  up  their  feces  when  others  demanded  it,  they  will  hold  on  to 
other  things,  such  as  money,  and  nobody  will  take  these  things  away. 

Toilet  training  probably  arouses  sufficient  anger  and  fear  to  produce 
some  measure  of  fixation  in  most  children,  especially  in  the  United  States, 
where  we  tend  to  be  strict  about  this  matter  (Munroe,  1955,  p.  287).  Conse¬ 
quently,  most  people  probably  develop  at  least  some  tendency  toward  "anal 
expulsiveness,''  "anal  compulsiveness,"  or  some  combination  of  both.  Some¬ 
times  these  traits  have  little  serious  impact  on  one's  life  but  then  emerge  in  a 
more  pronounced  way  when  one  is  under  stress.  For  example,  writers  may  be 
prone  to  compulsive  behavior  when  they  become  anxious  about  their  work. 
A  writer  may  be  unable  to  finish  a  manuscript  because  of  a  compulsive  need 
to  check  and  recheck  it  for  mistakes.  To  a  Freudian,  such  behavior  probably 
represents  a  regression  to  the  anal  stage,  where  the  individual  learned  that 
his  or  her  natural  actions  met  with  unexpected  disapproval.  That  is,  the  writer 
might  have  learned  that  his  or  her  first  "productions"  were  considered  dirty 
and  revolting  when  done  spontaneously  but  prized  if  done  properly.  Thus,  the 
writer,  anxious  about  the  impact  of  the  manuscript,  tries  to  protect  himself  or 
herself  by  seeing  that  everything  is  done  precisely  as  it  is  supposed  to  be. 


The  Phallic  or  Oedipal  Stage 

Between  the  ages  of  about  3  and  6  years,  the  child  enters  the  phallic  or  oedi¬ 
pal  stage.  Freud  understood  this  stage  better  in  the  case  of  the  boy  than  in  the 
case  of  the  girl,  so  we  begin  our  discussion  with  the  boy. 


269 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


The  Boy’s  Oedipal  Crisis.  The  oedipal  crisis  begins  when  the  boy 
starts  to  take  an  interest  in  his  penis.  This  organ,  which  is  "so  easily  excitable 
and  changeable,  and  so  rich  in  sensations,"  fires  his  curiosity  (Freud,  1923, 
p.  246).  He  wants  to  compare  his  penis  to  those  of  other  males  and  of  animals, 
and  he  tries  to  see  the  sexual  organs  of  girls  and  women.  He  may  also  enjoy 
exhibiting  his  penis  and,  more  generally,  imagines  the  role  he  might  play  as 
an  adult,  sexual  person.  He  initiates  experiments  and  spins  fantasies  in  which 
he  is  an  aggressive,  heroic  male,  frequently  directing  his  intentions  toward 
his  primary  love  object,  his  mother.  He  may  begin  kissing  Mommy  aggres¬ 
sively,  or  want  to  sleep  with  her  at  night,  or  imagine  marrying  her.  He  prob¬ 
ably  does  not  yet  conceive  of  sexual  intercourse  per  se,  but  he  does  wonder 
what  he  might  do  with  her. 

The  boy  soon  learns,  however,  that  his  most  ambitious  experiments  and 
plans  are  considered  excessive  and  improper.  He  learns  that  he  cannot,  after 
all,  marry  Mommy  or  engage  in  any  sex  play  with  her.  He  cannot  even  touch, 
hug,  or  cuddle  with  Mommy  as  much  as  he  would  like,  since  he  is  now  a  "big 
boy."  At  the  same  time,  he  notices  that  Daddy  seems  to  be  able  to  do  whatever 
he  wants:  Daddy  seems  to  kiss  and  hug  Mommy  at  will,  and  he  sleeps  with 
her  all  night  long  (doing  with  her  whatever  grownups  do  at  night).  So  the 
lines  of  the  Oedipus  complex  are  drawn:  The  boy  sees  the  father  as  a  rival  for 
the  affections  of  the  mother. 

The  little  boy's  oedipal  wishes  are  illustrated  by  Freud's  case  of  Little 
Hans  (Freud,  1909).  When  Hans  was  about  5  years  old,  he  asked  his  mother 
to  touch  his  penis,  and  he  wanted  to  cuddle  with  her  at  night.  His  father,  how¬ 
ever,  objected.  Soon  after,  Hans  had  the  following  dream: 

In  the  night  there  was  a  big  giraffe  in  the  room  and  a  crumpled  one;  and 
the  big  one  called  out  because  I  took  the  crumpled  one  away  from  it. 
Then  it  stopped  calling  out;  and  then  I  sat  down  on  top  of  the  crumpled 
one.  (p.  179) 

According  to  Freud,  Hans's  dream  probably  represented  his  wish  to  take  his 
mother  (the  crumpled  giraffe)  from  the  father  (the  big  giraffe). 

The  little  boy,  of  course,  cannot  realistically  hope  to  carry  out  his  rivalrous 
wishes;  the  father  is  too  big.  The  youngster  could  still  entertain  rivalrous  fan¬ 
tasies,  but  these  too  become  dangerous.  For  one  thing,  he  not  only  feels  jealous 
of  his  father  but  he  also  loves  and  needs  his  father,  so  he  is  frightened  by  his 
destructive  wishes  toward  him.  But  more  important,  the  boy  begins  to  consider 
the  possibility  of  castration.  In  Freud's  day,  parents  often  made  outright  threats 
of  castration  when  a  boy  masturbated.  Today,  parents  may  discourage  mastur¬ 
bation  more  delicately,  but  the  boy  does  probably  begin  to  worry  about  castra¬ 
tion  when  he  realizes  his  sister  and  other  females  are  missing  a  penis.  He  then 
concludes  that  they  once  had  one,  but  it  was  cut  off,  and  the  same  thing  could 
happen  to  him.  The  oedipal  rivalry  takes  on  a  new,  dangerous  dimension,  and 
the  boy  must  escape  the  whole  situation  (Freud,  1924,  p.  271). 


270 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


Figure  1 

Drawings  by  a  5-year-old  boy  and  a  6-year-old  girl  suggest  sexual  interests  of  the 
phallic  stage. 


Typically,  the  boy  resolves  the  oedipal  predicament  through  a  series  of 
defensive  maneuvers  (Freud,  1923;  1924).  He  fends  off  his  incestuous  desires 
for  his  mother  through  repression;  that  is,  he  buries  any  sexual  feelings  toward 
her  deep  into  his  unconscious.  He  still  loves  his  mother,  of  course,  but  he  now 
admits  only  to  a  socially  acceptable,  "sublimated"  love — a  pure,  higher  love. 
The  boy  overcomes  his  rivalry  with  his  father  by  repressing  his  hostile  feelings 
and  by  increasing  his  identification  with  him.  Instead  of  trying  to  fight  the 
father,  he  now  becomes  more  like  him,  and  in  this  way  vicariously  enjoys  the 
feeling  of  being  a  big  man.  It  is  as  if  the  boy  were  to  say,  "If  you  can't  beat 
him,  join  him." 

To  overcome  the  oedipal  crisis,  finally,  the  boy  internalizes  a  superego. 
That  is,  he  adopts  his  parents'  moral  prohibitions  as  his  own,  and  in  this  way 


271 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


establishes  a  kind  of  internal  police  officer  who  guards  against  dangerous 
impulses  and  desires.  The  superego  is  similar  to  what  we  ordinarily  call  the 
conscience;  it  is  an  inner  voice  that  reprimands  us  and  makes  us  feel  guilty  for 
bad  thoughts  and  actions.  Before  the  child  internalizes  a  superego,  he  suffers 
only  from  external  criticism  and  punishment.  Now,  however,  he  can  criticize 
himself,  and  thus  he  possesses  an  inner  fortification  against  forbidden  impulses. 

The  foregoing  review  suggests  the  complexity  of  the  Oedipus  complex, 
but  it  actually  is  far  more  complex  than  we  have  indicated.  The  boy's  rivalry 
and  love  work  both  ways — he  also  rivals  the  mother  for  the  affection  of  the 
father  (Freud,  1923,  pp.  21-24).  The  situation  is  also  complicated  by  the  pres¬ 
ence  of  siblings,  who  also  become  the  objects  of  love  and  jealousy  (Freud, 
1920,  p.  343),  and  by  other  factors,  such  as  the  loss  of  a  parent.  We  cannot 
begin  to  go  into  the  limitless  variations  here,  but  the  interested  reader  can 
refer  to  Fenichel  (1945,  pp.  91-98). 

Typical  Outcomes.  Typically,  when  the  boy  resolves  the  Oedipus 
complex  at  the  age  of  6  years  or  so,  his  rivalrous  and  incestuous  wishes  are 
temporarily  driven  underground.  As  we  shall  see,  he  enters  the  latency  period, 
during  which  he  is  relatively  free  of  these  worries.  Nevertheless,  oedipal  feel¬ 
ings  continue  to  exist  in  the  unconscious.  They  threaten  to  break  into  con¬ 
sciousness  once  again  at  puberty  and  exert  a  strong  influence  on  the  life  of 
the  adult.  This  influence  has  many  variations,  but  it  typically  is  felt  in  two 
central  areas:  competition  and  love. 

As  the  adult  male  enters  into  competition  with  other  men,  he  carries 
with  him  the  dim  knowledge  of  his  first  forays  into  this  area.  The  first  time 
he  dared  to  rival  a  man,  his  masculinity  suffered  a  sharp  setback.  Conse¬ 
quently,  he  may  be  apprehensive  about  rivaling  men  again.  In  the  back  of 
his  mind,  he  is  still  a  little  boy,  wondering  if  he  can  really  be  a  big  man 
(Fenichel,  1945,  p.  391;  Freud,  1914b). 

The  adult  may  also  feel  a  sense  of  guilt  over  competitive  urges.  The  first 
time  he  rivaled  a  man,  he  wished  to  do  away  with  his  competitor.  He  repressed 
these  hostile  wishes  and  established  a  superego  to  help  fend  them  off,  but  he 
still  may  dimly  feel  that  the  wish  to  become  more  successful  than  others  is 
somehow  wrong  (Freud,  1936b,  p.  311). 

Oedipal  feelings  also  influence  a  man's  experiences  in  love.  Freud  (1905) 
said  that  the  man  "seeks  above  all  the  memory-image  of  the  mother"  (p.  618). 
However,  this  desire  has  its  problems.  In  the  early  years,  it  became  associated 
with  castration  anxiety  and  guilt.  Consequently,  men  are  sometimes  impo¬ 
tent  with  women  who  evoke  too  much  of  the  mother's  presence.  They  become 
sexually  inhibited  with  women  who  arouse  the  deep  and  tender  feelings  asso¬ 
ciated  with  the  mother,  and  they  are  most  potent  with  women  whom  they 
regard  as  mere  outlets  for  their  physical  needs  (Freud,  1912). 

Freud  thought  that  everyone  undergoes  an  oedipal  crisis,  so  all  men 
have  some  of  these  feelings  to  a  certain  degree.  Severe  problems  usually  stem 


272 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


from  excessive  fears  experienced  as  a  child.  Still,  oedipal  problems  are  not  as 
serious  as  those  that  develop  at  earlier  periods,  when  the  personality  is  in  a 
more  formative  stage. 

The  Girl’s  Oedipus  Complex.  Freud  thought  there  was  an  Oedipus 
complex  for  the  little  girl  too,  but  he  admitted  that  "here  our  material — for 
some  reason  we  do  not  understand — becomes  far  more  shadowy  and  incom¬ 
plete"  (1924,  p.  274).  Freud's  views  on  this  topic,  in  broad  outline,  were  as  fol¬ 
lows.  He  noted  (1933,  pp.  122-127)  that  the  girl,  by  the  age  of  5  years  or  so, 
becomes  disappointed  in  her  mother.  She  feels  deprived  because  her  mother 
no  longer  gives  her  the  constant  love  and  care  that  she  required  as  a  baby, 
and,  if  new  babies  are  born,  she  resents  the  attention  they  receive.  Further¬ 
more,  she  is  increasingly  irritated  by  the  mother's  prohibitions,  such  as  that 
on  masturbation.  Finally,  and  most  upsetting,  the  girl  discovers  that  she  does 
not  have  a  penis — a  fact  for  which  she  blames  the  mother,  "who  sent  her  into 
the  world  so  insufficiently  equipped"  (Freud,  1925a,  p.  193). 

The  little  girl's  genital  disappointment  is  illustrated  by  an  anecdote 
from  Ruth  Munroe  (1955,  pp.  217-218),  a  psychologist  who  said  she  was  skep¬ 
tical  about  Freud's  theory  until  one  day  when  she  observed  her  4-year-old 
daughter  in  a  bathtub  with  her  brother.  The  daughter  suddenly  exclaimed, 
"My  weewee  (penis)  is  all  gone," — apparently  comparing  herself  with  her 
brother  for  the  first  time.  Munroe  tried  to  reassure  her,  but  nothing  worked, 
and  for  some  weeks  she  objected  violently  even  to  being  called  a  girl.  Thus 
this  little  girl  felt  what  Freud  called  penis  envy,  the  wish  to  have  a  penis  and 
to  be  like  a  boy  (Freud,  1933,  p.  126). 

The  little  girl  does,  however,  recover  her  feminine  pride.  This  happens 
when  she  begins  to  appreciate  the  attentions  of  her  father.  The  father  may 
have  not  paid  any  special  attention  to  his  daughter  when  she  was  in  diapers, 
but  now  he  may  begin  to  admire  her  cuteness  and  growing  femininity,  call¬ 
ing  her  his  little  princess  and  flirting  with  her  in  other  ways.  Thus  inspired, 
she  begins  to  spin  romantic  fantasies  involving  herself  and  her  father.  At  first 
her  thoughts  include  a  vague  wish  for  his  penis,  but  this  soon  changes  into  a 
wish  to  have  a  baby  and  give  it  to  him  as  a  present. 

As  with  the  little  boy,  the  little  girl  discovers  that  she  lacks  sole  rights  to 
her  new  love  object.  She  realizes  that  she  cannot,  after  all,  marry  Daddy,  nor 
can  she  cuddle,  hug,  or  sleep  with  him  as  much  as  she  would  like.  However, 
the  mother  seems  to  be  able  to  do  these  things,  so  she  becomes  the  rival  for 
his  affections.  Freud  said  that  this  oedipal  situation  might  be  called  the  Electra 
complex  (1940,  p.  99). 

What  most  puzzled  Freud  about  the  girl's  Oedipus  complex  was  the 
motivation  for  its  resolution.  In  the  case  of  the  little  boy,  the  primary  motiva¬ 
tion  seemed  clear:  The  boy  is  frightened  by  the  threat  of  castration.  But  the  little 
girl  cannot  fear  castration,  for  she  has  no  penis  to  lose.  Why,  then,  does  she 
renounce  her  oedipal  wishes  at  all?  In  one  essay,  Freud  (1925a,  p.  196)  said 


273 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


that  he  simply  did  not  know  the  answer,  but  his  best  guess  was  that  the  girl 
resolves  the  oedipal  crisis  because  she  fears  the  loss  of  parental  love  (1933, 
p.  87).  So  she  does  after  all  repress  her  incestuous  desires,  identify  with  her 
mother,  and  institute  a  superego  to  check  herself  against  forbidden  impulses 
and  wishes.1  Still,  lacking  castration  anxiety,  her  motivation  to  erect  strong 
defenses  against  oedipal  feelings  must  be  weaker,  and,  as  a  result,  she  must 
develop  a  weaker  superego.  Freud  knew  that  this  last  conclusion  would  anger 
the  feminists,  but  this  was  where  his  reasoning  led  and  he  argued  that  women 
in  fact  are  less  rigid  about  moral  issues  (p.  129). 

Like  a  boy,  then,  the  little  girl  entertains  and  then  abandons  rivalrous 
and  incestuous  fantasies.  In  some  ways,  the  later  consequences  of  the  oedipal 
experience  would  seem  similar  to  those  for  the  boy.  For  example,  the  girl  too 
may  carry  within  her  the  dim  knowledge  that  her  first  attempt  at  rivaling  a 
woman  for  a  man's  love  failed,  and  she  may  therefore  doubt  her  future 
prospects.  At  the  same  time,  though,  the  girl's  oedipal  experiences  differed 
from  the  boy's,  so  the  effects  may  differ  as  well.  She  had  less  need  to  resolve 
the  Oedipus  crisis,  so  her  oedipal  desires  may  be  more  open  and  transparent 
later  in  life  (p.  129).  Furthermore,  just  before  she  entered  into  the  oedipal 
rivalry,  she  experienced  a  deep  disappointment  over  being  female.  This  feel¬ 
ing,  Freud  felt,  may  lead  to  a  "masculinity  complex,"  in  which  the  woman 
may  avoid  intimate  relationships  with  men,  since  these  only  remind  her  of 
her  inferior  state,  and,  instead,  try  to  outdo  men  by  becoming  very  aggressive 
and  assertive  (p.  126). 


The  Latency  Stage 

With  the  establishment  of  strong  defenses  against  oedipal  feelings,  the  child 
enters  the  latency  period,  which  lasts  from  about  age  6  to  11  years.  As  the 
name  suggests,  sexual  and  aggressive  fantasies  are  now  largely  latent;  they  are 
kept  firmly  down,  in  the  unconscious.  Freud  thought  that  the  repression  of  sex¬ 
uality  at  this  time  is  quite  sweeping;  it  includes  not  only  oedipal  feelings  and 
memories,  but  oral  and  anal  ones  as  well  (Freud,  1905,  pp.  580-585).  Because 
dangerous  impulses  and  fantasies  are  now  kept  underground,  the  child  is  not 
excessively  bothered  by  them,  and  the  latency  period  is  one  of  relative  calm. 
The  child  is  now  free  to  redirect  his  or  her  energies  into  concrete,  socially 
acceptable  pursuits,  such  as  sports  and  games  and  intellectual  activities. 

Some  of  Freud's  followers  have  argued  that  sexual  and  aggressive  fan¬ 
tasies  do  not  disappear  at  this  time  as  completely  as  Freud  implied  (Bios, 
1962,  pp.  53-54).  For  example,  an  8-year-old  boy  is  still  interested  in  girls' 
bodies,  and  he  typically  discovers  the  real  facts  of  life  at  about  this  age.  Never¬ 
theless,  most  Freudians  agree  that  sexual  concerns  lose  their  frightening  and 


'As  with  the  boy,  the  girl's  Oedipus  complex  is  exceedingly  complex.  Rivalries  develop 
with  both  parents  and  with  siblings  as  well. 


274 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


overwhelming  character.  In  general,  the  latency-age  child  possesses  a  new 
composure  and  self-control. 


Puberty  (The  Genital  Stage) 

The  stability  of  the  latency  period,  however,  does  not  last.  As  Erikson  said, 
"It  is  only  a  lull  before  the  storm  of  puberty"  (1959,  p.  88).  At  puberty,  which 
begins  at  about  age  11  for  girls  and  age  13  for  boys,  sexual  energy  wells  up  in 
full  adult  force  and  threatens  to  wreak  havoc  with  the  established  defenses. 
Once  again,  oedipal  feelings  threaten  to  break  into  consciousness,  and  now  the 
young  person  is  big  enough  to  carry  them  out  in  reality  (Freud,  1920,  p.  345). 

Freud  said  that  from  puberty  onward,  the  individual's  great  task  is  "free¬ 
ing  himself  from  the  parents"  (p.  345).  For  the  son,  this  means  releasing  his  tie 
to  the  mother  and  finding  a  woman  of  his  own.  The  boy  must  also  resolve  his 
rivalry  with  his  father  and  free  himself  of  his  father's  domination  of  him.  For 
the  daughter,  the  tasks  are  the  same;  she  too  must  separate  from  the  parents 
and  establish  a  life  of  her  own.  Freud  noted,  however,  that  independence 
never  comes  easily  (1905,  p.  346).  Over  the  years  we  have  built  up  strong 
dependencies  on  our  parents,  and  it  is  painful  to  separate  ourselves  emo¬ 
tionally  from  them.  For  most  of  us,  the  goal  of  genuine  independence  is  never 
completely  attained. 


Anna  Freud  on  Adolescence 

Although  Freud  sketched  the  general  tasks  of  adolescence,  he  wrote  little 
about  the  distinctive  stresses  and  behavior  patterns  of  this  stage  of  life.  It  was 
his  daughter,  Anna  Freud,  who  made  many  of  the  first  contributions  to  the 
psychoanalytic  study  of  adolescence. 

Anna  Freud's  starting  point  was  the  same  as  that  of  her  father:  The 
teenager  experiences  the  dangerous  resurgence  of  oedipal  feelings.  Typically, 
the  young  person  is  most  aware  of  a  growing  resentment  against  the  parent 
of  the  same  sex.  Incestuous  feelings  toward  the  other  parent  remain  more 
unconscious. 

Anna  Freud  said  that  when  adolescents  first  experience  the  welling  up 
of  oedipal  feelings,  their  first  impulse  is  to  take  flight.  The  teenager  feels  tense 
and  anxious  in  the  presence  of  the  parents  and  feels  safe  only  when  apart 
from  them.  Some  adolescents  actually  run  away  from  home  at  this  time;  many 
others  remain  in  the  house  "in  the  attitude  of  a  boarder"  (A.  Freud,  1958, 
p.  269).  They  shut  themselves  up  in  their  rooms  and  feel  comfortable  only 
when  they  are  with  their  peers. 

Sometimes  adolescents  try  to  escape  their  parents  by  developing  a  blan¬ 
ket  contempt  for  them.  Instead  of  admitting  any  dependence  and  love,  they 
take  an  attitude  that  is  exactly  the  opposite.  It  is  as  if  they  think  they  can 
become  free  of  parental  involvement  by  thinking  absolutely  nothing  of  them. 


275 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


Here,  again,  teenagers  may  fancy  themselves  suddenly  independent,  but  their 
parents  still  dominate  their  lives,  for  they  spend  all  their  energy  attacking  and 
deriding  their  parents  (p.  270). 

Adolescents  sometimes  attempt  to  defend  themselves  against  feelings 
and  impulses  altogether,  irrespective  of  the  individuals  to  whom  their  feelings 
are  attached.  One  strategy  is  asceticism.  That  is,  the  adolescent  tries  to  fend  off 
all  physical  pleasure.  Boys  or  girls  might  adhere  to  strict  diets;  deny  them¬ 
selves  the  pleasures  of  attractive  clothes,  dancing,  or  music,  or  anything  else 
fun  or  frivolous;  or  try  to  master  their  bodies  through  exhausting  physical 
exercise. 

Another  defense  against  impulses  is  intellectualization.  The  adolescent 
attempts  to  transfer  the  problems  of  sex  and  aggression  onto  an  abstract,  intel¬ 
lectual  plane.  He  or  she  might  construct  elaborate  theories  on  the  nature  of  love 
and  the  family,  and  on  freedom  and  authority.  While  such  theories  may  be 
brilliant  and  original,  they  are  also  thinly  disguised  efforts  to  grapple  with 
oedipal  issues  on  a  purely  intellectual  level  (A.  Freud,  1936). 

Anna  Freud  observed  that  adolescent  turmoil  and  the  desperate  strate¬ 
gies  and  defenses  of  this  period  are  actually  normal  and  to  be  expected.  She 
did  not  usually  recommend  psychotherapy;  rather,  she  believed  that  the  ado¬ 
lescent  should  be  given  time  and  scope  to  work  out  his  or  her  own  solution. 
However,  parents  may  need  guidance,  for  there  "are  few  situations  in  life 
which  are  more  difficult  to  cope  with  than  an  adolescent  son  or  daughter  dur¬ 
ing  the  attempt  to  liberate  themselves"  (A.  Freud,  1958,  p.  276). 


THE  AGENCIES  OF  THE  MIND 

We  have  now  reviewed  the  stages  of  development.  Freud's  theory  contains 
many  other  concepts,  and  we  cannot  review  them  all.  However,  an  intro¬ 
duction  to  Freud  does  require  a  look  at  one  other  cluster  of  concepts,  those 
pertaining  to  the  agencies  of  the  mind.  Freud  was  continually  revising  his 
ideas  on  this  topic,  but  his  best  known  concepts  are  those  of  the  id,  ego,  and 
superego. 


The  Id 

The  id  is  the  part  of  the  personality  that  Freud  initially  called  "the  uncon¬ 
scious"  (e.g.,  1915b).  It  is  the  most  primitive  part  of  the  personality,  contain¬ 
ing  the  basic  biological  reflexes  and  drives.  Freud  likened  the  id  to  a  pit  "full 
of  seething  excitations,"  all  pressing  for  discharge  (1933,  p.  73).  In  terms  of 
motivation,  the  id  is  dominated  by  the  pleasure  principle;  its  goal  is  to  maximize 
pleasure  and  minimize  pain.  Pleasure,  in  Freud's  view,  is  primarily  a  matter 
of  reducing  tension  (1920,  p.  365).  During  sexual  intercourse,  tension  mounts 


276 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


and  its  final  release  is  pleasurable.  Similarly,  we  find  that  the  release  of  hunger 
or  bladder  tensions  brings  pleasurable  relief.  In  general,  the  id  tries  to  remove 
all  excitation  and  to  return  to  a  quiet  state — namely,  that  of  deep,  peaceful 
sleep. 

At  first,  the  baby  is  almost  all  id.  Babies  worry  about  little  besides  bod¬ 
ily  comfort,  and  they  try  to  discharge  all  tensions  as  quickly  as  possible.  How¬ 
ever,  even  babies  must  experience  frustration.  For  example,  they  sometimes 
must  wait  to  be  fed.  What  the  id  does  then  is  to  hallucinate  an  image  of  the 
desired  object,  and  in  this  way  it  temporarily  satisfies  itself.  We  see  such  wish- 
fulfilling  fantasies  at  work  when  a  starving  person  hallucinates  an  image  of 
food,  or  when  a  thirsty  dreamer  dreams  that  a  glass  of  water  is  at  hand  and 
therefore  does  not  have  to  wake  up  and  get  one  (Freud,  1900,  pp.  158, 165). 
Such  fantasies  are  prime  examples  of  what  Freud  called  primary  process 
thinking  (p.  535). 

In  the  course  of  life,  many  impressions  and  impulses  are  repressed  into 
the  id,  where  they  exist  side  by  side  with  the  basic  drives.  In  this  "dark  and 
inaccessible"  region  of  the  mind,  there  is  nothing  that  corresponds  to  logic  or 
a  sense  of  time  (Freud,  1933,  pp.  73-74).  Impressions  and  strivings  "are  vir¬ 
tually  immortal;  after  the  passage  of  decades  they  behave  as  though  they  had 
just  occurred"  (p.  74).  Images  in  the  id,  furthermore,  are  very  fluid  and  easily 
merge  into  one  another.  The  id  is  oceanic,  chaotic,  and  illogical.  It  is  com¬ 
pletely  cut  off  from  the  external  world.  Our  best  knowledge  of  this  mysteri¬ 
ous  region  comes  from  the  study  of  dreams. 

The  id,  then,  contains  basic  drives  and  reflexes,  along  with  images  and 
sensations  that  have  been  repressed.  So  far  we  have  focused  on  the  id's  sex¬ 
ual  drives  and  those  associated  with  the  preservation  of  life,  such  as  hunger 
and  thirst.  The  id  also  contains  aggressive  and  destructive  forces.  Freud's 
views  on  aggression  are  complex  and  underwent  drastic  revisions,  but  in  a 
sense  we  can  see  how  aggression  follows  the  id's  basic  principle  of  reducing 
tension.  In  the  id,  any  image  associated  with  pain  or  tension  should  be 
instantly  destroyed.  It  does  not  matter  to  the  id  that  one  may  be  wishing  for 
the  destruction  of  someone  one  needs  and  loves;  contradictions  such  as  these 
have  no  importance  in  this  illogical  region  of  the  mind.  The  id  simply  wants 
a  reduction  in  disturbing  tensions  immediately. 


The  Ego 

If  we  were  ruled  by  the  id,  we  would  not  live  for  long.  To  survive,  we  cannot 
act  solely  on  the  basis  of  hallucinations  or  simply  follow  our  impulses.  We 
must  learn  to  deal  with  reality.  For  example,  a  little  boy  soon  learns  that  he  can¬ 
not  just  impulsively  grab  food  from  wherever  he  sees  it.  If  he  takes  it  from  a 
bigger  boy,  he  is  likely  to  get  hit.  He  must  learn  to  consider  reality  before  act¬ 
ing.  The  agency  that  delays  the  immediate  impulse  and  considers  reality  is 
called  the  ego. 


277 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


Freud  said  that  whereas  "the  id  stands  for  the  untamed  passions,"  the 
ego  "stands  for  reason  and  good  sense"  (1933,  p.  76).  Because  the  ego  con¬ 
siders  reality,  it  is  said  to  follow  the  reality  principle  (Freud,  1911).  The  ego  tries 
to  forestall  action  until  it  has  had  a  chance  to  perceive  reality  accurately,  to 
consider  what  has  happened  in  similar  situations  in  the  past,  and  to  make 
realistic  plans  for  the  future  (Freud,  1940,  p.  15).  Such  reasonable  ways  of 
thinking  are  called  secondary  process  thinking  and  include  what  we  generally 
think  of  as  perceptual  or  cognitive  processes.  When  we  work  on  a  math  prob¬ 
lem,  plan  a  trip,  or  write  an  essay,  we  are  making  good  use  of  ego  functions. 
At  first,  though,  the  ego's  functioning  is  largely  bodily  or  motoric.  For  ex¬ 
ample,  when  a  child  first  learns  to  walk,  she  inhibits  impulses  toward  ran¬ 
dom  movement,  considers  where  she  is  headed  to  avoid  collisions,  and 
otherwise  exercises  ego  controls  (p.  15). 

The  term  ego  is  one  that  we  hear  a  great  deal  in  everyday  language.  Quite 
often,  we  hear  that  someone  has  a  "big  ego,"  meaning  this  person  has  an 
inflated  self-image.  Although  Freud  himself  (e.g.,  1917)  occasionally  wrote 
about  the  ego  in  just  this  way,  many  Freudians  (e.g.,  Beres,  1971;  FFartmann, 
1956)  contend  that  we  should  distinguish  between  the  ego  and  the  self-image. 
Strictly  speaking,  they  say,  the  ego  refers  only  to  a  set  of  functions — judging 
reality  accurately,  regulating  impulses,  and  so  on.  The  self-image,  the  picture 
we  have  of  ourselves,  is  different  from  the  ego  itself. 

Freud  emphasized  that  although  the  ego  functions  somewhat  inde¬ 
pendently  from  the  id,  it  also  borrows  all  its  energy  from  the  id.  He  likened 
the  ego's  relation  to  the  id  to  that  of  a  rider  on  a  horse.  "The  horse  supplies 
the  locomotive  energy,  while  the  rider  has  the  privilege  of  deciding  on  the 
goal  and  guiding  the  powerful  animal's  movement.  But  only  too  often  there 
arises  between  the  ego  and  the  id  the  not  precisely  ideal  situation  of  the  rider 
being  obliged  to  guide  the  horse  along  the  path  by  which  it  itself  wants  to  go" 
(1933,  p.  77). 


The  Superego 

The  ego  is  sometimes  called  one  of  the  "control  systems"  of  the  personality 
(Redl  &  Wineman,  1951).  The  ego  controls  the  blind  passions  of  the  id  to  pro¬ 
tect  the  organism  from  injury.  We  mentioned  how  a  little  boy  must  learn  to 
inhibit  the  impulse  to  grab  food  until  he  can  determine  whether  it  is  realisti¬ 
cally  safe  to  do  so.  But  we  also  control  our  actions  for  other  reasons.  We  might 
also  refrain  from  taking  things  from  others  because  we  believe  such  actions  are 
morally  wrong.  Our  standards  of  right  and  wrong  constitute  the  second  con¬ 
trol  system  of  the  personality — the  superego. 

We  referred  earlier  to  Freud's  view  on  the  origin  of  the  superego:  It  is  a 
product  of  the  oedipal  crisis.  Children  introject  parental  standards  to  check 
themselves  against  the  dangerous  impulses  and  fantasies  of  this  period.  Freud 


278 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


did  note,  though,  that  the  superego  continues  to  develop  after  this  period  as 
well.  Children  continue  to  identify  with  other  people,  such  as  teachers  and 
religious  leaders,  and  to  adopt  their  moral  standards  as  their  own  (Freud, 
1923,  p.  27). 

Freud  wrote  about  the  superego  as  if  it  contained  two  parts  (pp.  24-25). 
One  part  is  sometimes  called  the  conscience  (Flail,  1954).  It  is  the  punitive,  neg¬ 
ative,  and  critical  part  of  the  superego  that  tells  us  what  not  to  do  and  punishes 
us  with  feelings  of  guilt  when  we  violate  its  demands.  The  other  part  is  called 
the  ego  ideal,  and  this  part  consists  of  positive  aspirations.  For  example,  when 
a  child  wants  to  be  just  like  a  famous  basketball  player,  the  athlete  is  the  child's 
ego  ideal.  The  ego  ideal  may  also  be  more  abstract.  It  may  include  our  posi¬ 
tive  ideals,  such  as  the  wish  to  become  more  generous,  courageous,  or  dedi¬ 
cated  to  principles  of  justice  and  freedom. 


Levels  of  Awareness  of  the  Three  Agencies 

The  id,  ego,  and  superego  function  at  differing  levels  of  awareness,  as  Freud 
tried  to  show  by  means  of  a  diagram  (1933,  p.  78),  reproduced  here  as 
Figure  2. 

The  id,  at  the  bottom  of  the  drawing,  is  completely  removed  from  the 
region  labeled  pcpt.-cs,  from  consciousness  and  the  perception  of  reality.  The 
id  is  entirely  unconscious,  which  means  that  its  workings  can  be  made  con¬ 
scious  only  with  a  great  deal  of  effort. 

The  ego  extends  into  consciousness  and  reality;  it  is  the  part  of  the  id 
that  develops  in  order  to  deal  with  the  external  world.  The  ego,  you  will  note, 
largely  inhabits  a  region  labeled  preconscious.  This  term  refers  to  functioning 
that  is  below  awareness  but  can  be  made  conscious  with  relatively  little  effort. 


pcpt.-cs. 


Figure  2 

Freud's  sketch  of  the  personality  structure. 

(Reprinted  from  New  Introductory  Lectures  on  Psycho¬ 
analysis  by  Sigmund  Freud. Translated  by  James 
Strachey.  Copyright©  1965, 1964  by  James  Strachey. 
Used  by  permission  of  W.  W.  Norton  &  Co.,  Inc.) 


279 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


The  ego  is  also  partly  unconscious;  for  example,  it  represses  forbidden 
thoughts  in  a  completely  unconscious  way. 

The  superego  is  drawn  on  top  of  the  ego,  illustrating  its  role  of  criticiz¬ 
ing  the  ego  from  above.  The  superego,  too,  is  partly  unconscious;  although 
we  are  sometimes  aware  of  our  moral  standards,  they  also  frequently  affect 
us  unconsciously.  For  example,  we  might  suddenly  become  depressed  with¬ 
out  any  idea  why,  because  our  superego  is  punishing  us  for  forbidden 
thoughts. 

The  superego  also  works  unconsciously  during  dreams.  Dreams  begin 
as  wishes  from  the  id,  but  many  wishes  violate  the  superego's  standards,  so 
the  superego  demands  that  the  wishes  undergo  distortion  or  disguise  before 
surfacing  into  consciousness  (Freud,  1940,  p.  51).  In  one  of  Freud's  examples, 
a  little  boy  was  told  it  was  wrong  for  him  to  eat  very  much  because  of  his  ill¬ 
ness;  so  one  night,  when  he  was  especially  hungry,  he  dreamt  that  someone 
else  was  enjoying  a  sumptuous  meal  (1900,  pp.  301-302).  Similarly,  many  sex¬ 
ual  and  aggressive  wishes  must  be  disguised  and  distorted  before  surfacing. 
Because  the  dream  we  remember  upon  waking  has  undergone  disguise,  we 
cannot  interpret  it  in  any  simple,  straightforward  way.  In  psychoanalysis,  the 
patient  is  asked  to  free-associate  to  the  dream,  to  say  whatever  comes  to  mind 
in  connection  with  each  aspect  of  it.  In  this  way,  the  unconscious  wishes  of  the 
id  may  eventually  come  to  light,  and  the  patient's  ego  can  make  some  con¬ 
scious  assessment  of  them. 


The  Central  Role  of  the  Ego 

In  the  last  analysis,  our  ability  to  deal  with  life — our  mental  balance — rests 
with  our  ego's  ability  to  meet  the  various  pressures  put  upon  it.  More  specif¬ 
ically,  the  ego  is  the  executive  agency  that  must  somehow  serve  three 
"tyrannical  masters'' — the  id,  reality,  and  the  superego  (Freud,  1933,  p.  78). 
The  ego  must  eventually  meet  the  biological  demands  of  the  id,  but  in  a 
way  that  also  respects  external  reality  and  does  not  violate  the  precepts  of 
the  superego.  The  task  is  difficult  because  the  ego  is  basically  weak;  as  men¬ 
tioned,  it  has  no  energy  of  its  own,  but  borrows  it  from  the  id.  Consequently, 
the  ego  is  quite  prone  to  anxiety — to  the  fear  it  might  not  satisfy  any  one  of 
its  three  dictators.  Anxiety  arises  when  we  feel  helpless  to  satisfy  a  basic  bio¬ 
logical  need  in  the  id;  when  we  anticipate  moral  punishment  from  the 
superego;  or  when  we  face  danger  in  the  external  world. 

"Thus  the  ego,  driven  by  the  id,  confined  by  the  superego,  repulsed  by 
reality,  struggles  to  master  its  economic  task  of  bringing  harmony  among  the 
forces  and  influences  working  in  and  upon  it;  and  we  can  understand  how  it 
is  that  so  often  we  cannot  suppress  a  cry:  'Life  is  not  easy!"'  (p.  78) 

In  much  of  Freud's  writing,  the  ego  seems  to  regard  the  id  and  the 
superego  as  adversaries,  as  powerful  combatants  it  must  somehow  appease 


280 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


and  control.  But  Freud  also  recognized  the  vital  necessity  of  the  id  and 
superego,  and  some  of  Freud's  closest  followers  have  elaborated  on  the 
positive  ways  the  ego  utilizes  these  agencies.  In  an  important  contribution, 
Kris  (1952)  described  how  the  ego  can  utilize  the  fluid,  sensuous,  dreamlike 
imagery  of  the  id  as  a  source  of  creative  thinking.  Artists,  for  example,  may 
temporarily  abandon  their  tight  ego  controls  and  realistic  thinking  in  order 
to  delve  into  the  unconscious  for  its  rich  imagery  and  inspirational  power. 
Kris  called  this  process  "regression  in  the  service  of  the  ego,"  and  Kris's 
concept  has  become  very  important  in  Freudian  theory.  Werner  also  empha¬ 
sized  a  similar  process  in  his  discussions  of  microgenesis.  For  both  Werner 
and  the  Freudians,  then,  primordial  thinking  is  not  just  something  to  be 
overcome  but  may  continually  serve  as  a  rich  resource  for  creative  work. 


The  Ego’s  Mechanisms  of  Defense 

Although  the  ego  is  weak,  it  can  ward  off  excessive  anxiety  by  employing 
mechanisms  of  defense.  Freud  (1926)  thought  the  central  defense  mechanism 
is  repression,  the  rejection  of  thoughts,  fantasies,  or  impulses  from  conscious 
awareness.  We  saw  earlier  how  children  repress  sexual  and  aggressive 
impulses  and  fantasies  as  they  resolve  the  Oedipus  complex.  We  also  briefly 
noted  repression  in  the  case  of  one  of  Freud's  patients,  Elizabeth  von  R.  At 
the  bedside  of  her  just-deceased  sister,  Elizabeth  had  a  romantic  thought  about 
her  brother-in-law:  "Now  he  is  free  and  can  marry  me."  This  wish  totally  vio¬ 
lated  her  moral  (superego)  standards,  and  she  immediately  repressed  it,  for¬ 
getting  the  thought  and  the  entire  scene  as  well. 

For  many  years,  Freud  considered  repression  to  be  the  only  defense 
mechanism.  Eventually  (1926)  he  came  to  include  others,  some  of  which  I  will 
review  below.  In  her  classic  work  The  Ego  and  the  Mechanisms  of  Defense  (1936), 
Anna  Freud  observed  that  repression  is  the  most  powerful  defense  mecha¬ 
nism  and  often  used  in  combination  with  others.  She  also  made  it  clear  that 
the  ego  employs  all  the  defense  mechanisms  unconsciously  (p.  52).  So,  when 
a  psychoanalytic  patient  tries  to  free-associate  but  tells  the  therapist  that  her 
mind  has  suddenly  gone  blank,  she  isn't  necessarily  concealing  something  on 
purpose.  It  is  likely  that  her  ego  is  repressing  a  thought,  and  the  repression 
occurs  unconsciously,  below  her  level  of  awareness. 

A  second  defense  mechanism  is  displacement,  the  shifting  of  impulses  or 
feelings  from  one  object  onto  another.  By  way  of  illustration,  Anna  Freud 
(1936)  described  a  young  female  patient  who  felt  intense  anger  at  her  mother. 
However,  the  girl  unconsciously  feared  it  would  result  in  the  loss  of  her 
mother's  love.  The  girl  therefore  repressed  her  anger  toward  her  mother  and 
displaced  it  onto  other  females.  For  many  years  there  was  always  some  other 
woman  she  hated  with  a  passion. 


281 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


Reaction-formation  occurs  when  we  turn  our  feelings  into  the  opposite. 
Freud  (1908a)  thought  that  anal  compulsivity  reflects  an  underlying  reaction- 
formation;  the  person  wishes  to  be  messy,  but  instead  becomes  a  stickler  for 
neatness  and  cleanliness.  Reaction-formation  also  is  involved  in  the  adoles¬ 
cent's  blanket  contempt  for  her  parents.  Instead  of  acknowledging  any  feel¬ 
ings  of  love  or  tenderness  toward  her  parents,  she  simply  cannot  stand  them 
(A.  Freud,  1936). 2 

Projection  occurs  when  we  attribute  our  own  impulses,  feelings,  and 
characteristics  onto  others.  A  man  might  believe  he  is  free  of  hostile  wishes  but 
sees  other  people  as  full  of  hostility.  He  represses  anger  in  himself  and  projects 
it  onto  others.  If  Bettelheim  (1967)  was  correct,  projection  is  implicit  in  the 
story  of  Hansel  and  Gretel.  The  children's  own  oral  greed  and  wishes  to 
devour  are  projected  onto  the  wicked  witch. 

Most  defense  mechanisms  deal  with  anxiety-producing  impulses,  fan¬ 
tasies,  and  emotions  that  emerge  from  within,  as  when  we  repress  a  forbid¬ 
den  desire.  Denial  addresses  the  outside;  it  defends  against  reality  by  denying 
the  facts  (A.  Freud,  1936).  Denial  is  often  necessary  in  severe  circumstances, 
as  when  a  child  whose  mother  has  died  says,  "My  mommy  is  coming  today." 
Elizabeth  Kubler-Ross  (1969)  found  that  terminally  ill  patients  usually  go 
through  an  initial  stage  of  denying  the  evidence  that  they  have  the  illness. 

Anna  Freud  (1936)  tentatively  suggested  that  the  defense  mechanisms 
are  also  tied  to  specific  developmental  stages.  Repression  is  characteristic  of 
the  oedipal  stage,  reaction-formation  of  the  anal  stage.  Projection  and  denial 
are  primitive  mechanisms  that  may  be  characteristic  of  the  oral  stage.  But  this 
association  between  defenses  and  stages  is  somewhat  sketchy. 

Following  Freud's  (1926)  suggestion,  many  psychoanalysts  have  exam¬ 
ined  how  different  defenses  are  at  work  in  different  emotional  disorders.  For 
example,  they  have  found  that  displacement  plays  a  major  role  in  many  pho¬ 
bias,  including  school  phobias.  A  young  child  who  starts  attending  school 
might  develop  an  extraordinary  fear  of  it,  and  the  fear  is  especially  intense 
because  the  child  displaces  her  anxiety  over  separation  from  her  mother  onto 
the  school  (White  &  Watt,  1973). 

While  not  necessarily  denying  the  value  of  such  analyses,  several  con¬ 
temporary  scholars  seek  to  cast  defense  mechanisms  in  a  more  positive  light. 
They  ask  us  to  consider  some  defenses  as  healthy  coping  strategies.  These 
scholars  are  exploring  an  important  area — constructive  coping — but  they 
often  overextend  the  concept  of  a  defense  mechanism.  For  example,  Valliant 
(2000)  calls  suppression  a  healthy  defense  mechanism.  But  suppression  is  a 
fairly  conscious  effort  to  avoid  interfering  thoughts,  whereas  the  classic 
defense  mechanisms  operate  unconsciously. 


2In  her  discussion  of  adolescence,  which  we  reviewed  earlier,  Anna  Freud  described  sev¬ 
eral  ways  young  people  try  to  ward  off  sexual  and  aggressive  impulses  welling  up  at  this  time. 
Two  of  the  strategies,  asceticism  and  intellectualization,  are  technically  considered  mechanisms 
of  defense  in  standard  psychoanalytic  texts  (e.g.,  Waelder,  1960). 


282 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


In  traditional  psychoanalytic  theory,  the  healthiest  defense  mechanism 
is  sublimation.  This  is  the  process  by  which  the  ego  redirects  impulses  into 
socially  acceptable  pursuits.  For  example,  people  might  channel  their  aggres¬ 
sive  energies  into  competitive  sports.  Or  they  might  sublimate  their  sexual 
interests  into  artistic  activities,  writing  fiction  or  painting  pictures  on  the  topic 
of  romantic  love. 


The  Ego’s  Development 

In  the  years  after  Freud's  death,  many  of  his  followers  addressed  the  process 
by  which  the  ego  develops.  Freud  wrote  little  on  this  subject.  His  main  sug¬ 
gestion  (1911)  was  that  the  ego  develops  because  the  drives  are  frustrated. 
As  long  as  babies  are  gratified,  they  have  no  reason  for  dealing  with  reality. 
But  they  do  experience  frustration.  At  first  they  try  to  reduce  tensions 
through  hallucinations,  but  these  do  not  work  for  long.  So  they  must  seek 
need-gratifying  objects  in  reality. 

The  difficulty  with  Freud's  proposal  is  that  it  implies  the  ego  acts  only 
when  the  id  activates  it.  Construed  in  this  way,  the  ego  is  weak.  It  only  serves 
the  id. 

Hartmann’s  Revision.  One  of  Freud's  most  influential  followers, 
Heinz  Hartmann,  suggested  that  Freud's  theory  might  permit  a  different  pic¬ 
ture  of  the  ego — one  that  gives  it  more  autonomy.  Hartmann  (1939,  1950) 
noted  that  Freud  wondered  whether  the  ego  might  not  have  genetic  roots  of 
its  own.  If  so,  ego  functions  such  as  motility  (body  movement),  language,  per¬ 
ception,  and  cognition  might  develop  according  to  their  own  mnturational 
timetable.  Children,  then,  might  begin  to  walk,  talk,  grasp  objects,  and  so  on, 
from  inner  promptings  that  are  biologically  governed  but  are  also  independent 
of  the  instinctual  drives.  Children  have  a  maturational  need  to  develop  ego 
functions  when  the  id  is  at  rest,  when  life  is  "conflict  free."  Thus  the  ego  might 
develop  independently  from  the  id.  Hartmann's  proposal  is  widely  considered 
a  major  breakthrough  in  the  study  of  ego  development. 

Ego  Development  and  Object  Relations.  Freudians  have  also  stud¬ 
ied  the  kind  of  environment  most  conducive  to  ego  growth.  When  Freudians 
talk  about  the  environment,  they  usually  are  speaking  not  about  the  physical 
world  but  the  world  of  other  people.  They  call  interactions  with  others  object 
relations. 

According  to  Hartmann  (Hartmann,  Kris,  &  Lowenstein,  1946),  Benedek 
(1938),  and  others,  the  optimal  interpersonal  environment  at  first  is  a  con¬ 
sistently  gratifying  one.  When  caretakers  are  consistently  loving,  babies 
become  interested  in  them  and  learn  about  the  external  world  of  people.  Con¬ 
sistent  care  seems  especially  important  for  the  development  of  one  essential 


283 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


ego  function — the  ability  to  postpone  gratification.  As  Benedek  says,  when 
the  mother  is  consistent  and  loving,  the  baby  gains  confidence  in  her.  The  baby 
does  not  grow  unduly  impatient  the  minute  his  or  her  needs  are  not  met  but 
learns  to  wait.  The  baby  knows  care  is  forthcoming. 

As  psychoanalysis  has  developed,  a  number  of  people  have  moved 
object  relations  to  the  forefront.  Some  analysts  have  given  object  relations  pri¬ 
ority  over  everything  else — over  the  instinctual  drives,  libidinal  zones,  and  ego 
functions.  What  people  really  want,  these  writers  say,  is  not  to  relieve  instinc¬ 
tual  tensions  or  to  engage  in  ego  functions  for  their  own  sake,  but  to  develop 
mature  interpersonal  relationships  (see  Greenberg  &  Mitchell,  1983,  especially 
chap.  6).  The  theories  of  Erikson  and  Mahler  have  moved  psychoanalytic  the¬ 
ory  in  the  direction  of  object  relations  while  maintaining  a  commitment  to 
classical  Freudian  concepts. 


PRACTICAL  IMPLICATIONS 

It  is  impossible  to  make  any  sharp  distinctions  between  Freudian  theory  and 
practice.  Freud's  theory  emerged  from  the  clinical  treatment  of  patients,  and 
his  followers  continue  to  use  therapy  as  a  main  source  of  data.  In  this  chap¬ 
ter  we  have  focused  on  Freud's  theory  of  normal  growth  and  development, 
rather  than  pathology  and  treatment,  but  we  still  have  found  it  necessary  to 
mention  topics  in  the  latter  areas  (e.g.,  hysteria). 

A  description  of  Freud's  therapeutic  work  is  well  beyond  our  scope. 
What  we  can  say  here  is  that  a  major  goal  of  psychoanalysis  is  to  recover 
repressed  or  blocked-off  experience.  We  saw  how  this  was  necessary  in  the 
case  of  Elizabeth  von  R.  Elizabeth  had  repressed  sexual  feelings  toward  her 
brother-in-law,  and  these  feelings,  far  from  disappearing,  became  diverted 
into  painful  bodily  symptoms.  The  only  solution,  Freud  thought,  is  for  us  to 
become  more  conscious  of  our  thoughts  and  feelings  so  that,  instead  of  their 
controlling  us,  we  can  gain  a  measure  of  control  over  them.  As  he  put  it, 
"Where  id  was,  there  ego  shall  be''  (1933,  p.  80). 

Therapy  with  children  usually  proceeds  somewhat  differently  from  that 
with  adults,  for  children  are  not  given  to  verbal  discussions  and  recollections. 
Instead,  they  learn  to  express,  accept,  and  master  feelings  and  fantasies 
through  play. 

It  is  important  to  note  that  Freud  never  believed  that  psychoanalysis 
can  completely  cure  our  problems.  Because  we  all  live  in  society,  which 
demands  some  repression  of  our  instinctual  urges,  we  all  suffer  to  some 
extent.  Further,  Freud  saw  the  therapist's  role  as  limited.  A  psychiatrist  was 
once  asked  by  Freud  if  he  was  really  able  to  cure.  The  psychiatrist  replied, 
"In  no  way,  but  one  can,  as  a  gardener  does,  remove  some  impediments  to 


284 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


personal  growth."  "Then,"  Freud  answered,  "we  will  understand  each 
other"  (Ellenberger,  1970,  p.  461). 

The  practical  implications  of  Freud's  ideas  extend  far  beyond  the  treat¬ 
ment  of  patients.  His  ideas  have  influenced  practically  every  area  of  life, 
including  the  practice  of  law,  art,  literature,  religion,  and  education.  The  area 
of  most  interest  to  us  here  is  education.  Freud's  thoughts  on  education  were 
not  as  radical  as  it  is  sometimes  supposed.  He  believed  societies  will  always 
exact  some  instinctual  renunciation,  and  he  said  it  would  be  unfair  to  send  chil¬ 
dren  into  the  world  expecting  they  can  do  just  as  they  please  (1933,  p.  149).  On 
the  other  hand,  Freud  thought  discipline  is  usually  excessive;  it  makes  children 
feel  unnecessarily  ashamed  and  guilty  about  their  bodies  and  their  natural 
functions.  Freud  was  particularly  emphatic  on  the  need  for  sex  education.  He 
recommended  that  sex  education  be  handled  by  the  schools,  where  children 
could  learn  about  reproduction  in  their  lessons  on  nature  and  animals.  They 
themselves  would  then  draw  the  necessary  conclusions  with  respect  to 
humans  (Freud,  1907). 

Freudian  ideas  have  motivated  some  more  adventurous  experiments  in 
education.  For  example,  at  Summerhill,  A.  S.  Neill  (1960)  gave  children  a  great 
deal  of  liberty  of  all  kinds,  including  sexual  freedom.  However,  such  radical 
innovations  are  rare,  and  Freud's  influence  is  more  typically  found  in  the  gen¬ 
eral  attitude  a  teacher  takes  toward  children.  This  attitude  is  particularly  evi¬ 
dent  when  a  teacher  refrains  from  automatically  disciplining  some  unwanted 
behavior  and  instead  tries  to  understand  the  emotional  reasons  behind  it  (Rus¬ 
sell,  1971).  When  a  teacher  takes  a  closer  look  at  a  child's  life,  the  teacher  may 
discover  that  the  angry  or  sullen  child  is  not  really  mad  at  the  teacher  but  is 
finding  something  at  home,  such  as  the  neglect  of  a  parent,  deeply  frustrating. 
Or  the  teacher  may  discover  that  the  seemingly  lazy  teenager  is  actually  brood¬ 
ing  endlessly  over  sex  or  social  failure  (White  &  Watt,  1973,  p.  34).  The  teacher 
may  not  always  be  able  to  correct  such  problems,  or  even  feel  it  is  prudent  to 
discuss  them  with  the  student,  for  the  student  may  need  his  or  her  privacy  in 
certain  matters.  Nevertheless,  a  measure  of  understanding  can  help.  For  the 
teacher  is  then  not  so  quick  to  criticize  or  punish  but  has  a  reason  for  being 
patient  and  encouraging — attitudes  that  have  helped  many  a  child. 


EVALUATION 

Freud  was  one  of  the  great  thinkers  of  modern  times.  Before  Freud,  some 
poets,  artists,  and  philosophers  may  have  known  about  the  unconscious 
and  early  sexual  fantasies,  but  it  was  Freud's  remarkable  work  that  made 
us  take  these  matters  seriously.  At  the  same  time,  Freud  was  more  bitterly 
attacked  than  any  other  psychological  theorist  before  or  since.  Even  today 
many  consider  his  ideas  scandalous. 


285 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


It  is  not  surprising,  then,  that  Freud  and  his  followers  have  sometimes 
reacted  dogmatically  and  defensively.  At  times  they  have  behaved  like  mem¬ 
bers  of  a  religious  sect,  isolating  themselves  from  other  scientists  and  gath¬ 
ering  in  their  own  groups  to  reaffirm  the  truth  of  their  own  beliefs.  At  other 
times,  Freudians  have  resorted  to  ad  hominem  arguments — arguments 
directed  not  against  others'  ideas,  but  against  their  personalities.  In  one 
essay  (1925b),  Freud  argued  that  his  critics  objected  to  his  ideas  because  of 
their  own  resistances  and  repressions. 

In  the  midst  of  such  emotionally  charged  debates,  several  criticisms  of 
psychoanalysis  have  been  offered  that  have  merit,  and  some  Freudians  have 
tried  to  face  them  openly  and  to  correct  the  weaknesses  in  the  theory. 

Some  of  the  most  important  criticisms  of  Freud  have  come  from  anthro¬ 
pologists  who  have  argued  that  Freud's  theory  is  culture  bound.  In  the  1920s, 
Malinowski  and  others  zeroed  in  on  Freud's  theory  of  the  Oedipus  complex, 
pointing  out  that  it  is  not  nearly  as  universal  as  Freud  imagined.  Malinowski 
noted  that  the  family  constellation  on  which  this  complex  is  based — the 
nuclear  triangle  of  mother,  father,  and  child — is  not  found  in  all  cultures. 
Among  the  Trobriand  Islanders,  Malinowski  found,  the  child's  chief  disci¬ 
plinarian  was  not  the  father  but  the  maternal  uncle.  Further,  the  strongest 
incest  taboo  was  not  between  children  and  parents  but  between  brothers  and 
sisters.  In  this  situation,  Malinowski  pointed  out,  repressed  fears  and  long¬ 
ings  were  very  different.  "We  might  say  that  in  the  Oedipus  complex  there 
is  a  repressed  desire  to  kill  the  father  and  marry  the  mother,  while  in 
the  .  .  .  Trobriands  the  wish  is  to  marry  the  sister  and  to  kill  the  maternal 
uncle"  (Malinowski,  1927,  pp.  80-81).  The  oedipal  situation  is  by  no  means 
just  as  Freud  described. 

But  Malinowski  did  not  wish  to  dispense  with  Freud  altogether.  On  the 
contrary,  he  was  indebted  to  Freud  for  the  insight  that  repressed  wishes 
emerge  in  projections  such  as  dreams,  magic,  and  folklore.  This  insight  pro¬ 
vided  him  with  an  important  theoretical  tool.  Malinowski's  argument  was 
that  such  projections  vary  with  the  cultural  setting.  Among  the  Trobriand 
Islanders,  he  found  no  oedipal  myths  or  dreams,  but  many  that  centered  on 
their  own  strongest  temptations  and  taboos — especially  brother-sister  rela¬ 
tions.  For  example,  although  they  themselves  never  admitted  to  incestuous 
wishes  toward  siblings,  they  told  stories  about  how  magic  originated  long 
ago  when  a  brother  and  sister  did  commit  incest. 

At  the  time  of  Malinowski's  writings,  Freud  and  his  followers  resisted 
anthropological  modifications  of  psychoanalytic  theory.  Flowever,  later  Freudi¬ 
ans  (e.g.,  Erikson,  1963;  Kardiner,  1945)  have  tried  to  combine  psychoanalytic 
and  anthropological  insights. 

Freud  has  also  been  sharply  criticized  for  cultural  bias  on  the  topic  of 
women.  Psychoanalytically  oriented  writers  such  as  Clara  Thompson  (1950) 
and  modern  feminists  have  charged  that  Freud's  views  on  women  reflect 
his  own  unexamined  Victorian  attitudes.  Freud's  limitations,  Thompson 


286 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


said,  are  most  evident  in  his  concept  of  penis  envy.  She  agreed  that  girls 
envy  boys,  but  not  for  the  reasons  Freud  thought.  Freud  assumed  that  penis 
envy  is  based  on  a  real  biological  inferiority — a  view  that  fit  well  with  his 
society's  prejudice.  Actually,  she  said,  penis  envy  is  much  more  of  a  cul¬ 
tural  problem;  girls  feel  inferior  to  boys  because  girls  lack  the  same  privi¬ 
leges  in  a  male-dominated  society.  That  is,  they  lack  the  opportunities  for 
adventure,  independence,  and  success.  Freud  ignored  women's  legitimate 
desire  for  social  equality. 

Writers  have  also  accused  Freud  of  cultural  bias  in  his  discussions  of 
women's  sense  of  morality.  Freud  thought  that  girls,  not  fearing  castration, 
have  less  need  to  internalize  a  strong  superego.  As  evidence  he  pointed  to 
women's  greater  emotionality  and  flexibility  in  moral  matters.  Such  observa¬ 
tions,  his  critics  contend,  simply  reflect  his  own  cultural  stereotypes. 

Empirical  evidence  does  suggest  that  Freud  would  have  done  well  to 
question  his  theory  on  superego  formation.  Most  evidence  suggests  that 
children  do  not  acquire  an  initial  sense  of  morality  because  they  fear  harm, 
whether  castration  or  some  other  physical  punishment.  The  child  who  only 
fears  physical  punishment  simply  tries  to  avoid  getting  caught  (and  per¬ 
haps  learns  to  hate  the  punisher).  A  sense  of  morality,  instead,  appears  to 
develop  when  the  child  experiences  love  and  wishes  to  keep  it.  The  child 
who  receives  love  tries  to  behave  properly  to  gain  parental  approval  (Brown, 
1965,  pp.  381-394;  White  &  Watt,  1981,  pp.  359-360.)  So,  if  a  girl  is  loved  as 
much  as  a  boy,  she  should  develop  an  equally  strong  conscience. 

Several  contemporary  feminist  psychoanalysts  say  that  Freud's  theory 
is  too  individualistic.  Nancy  Chodorow  (1978)  and  Jessica  Benjamin  (1988) 
argue  that  we  cannot  understand  people  as  isolated  individuals  with  their 
drives  and  ego  functions.  We  must  focus  on  object  relations — interactions  with 
others.  In  the  view  of  both  prominent  feminists  and  object  relations  theorists, 
humans  don't  merely  seek  gratification  of  erotic  needs;  they  seek  relation¬ 
ships  (Greenberg  &  Mitchell,  1983,  chap.  6). 

Freud  has  also  been  criticized  on  scientific  grounds.  Although  his  theory 
hinges  on  universal  childhood  developments,  his  evidence  came  primarily 
from  adults — from  the  memories  and  fantasies  of  adults  in  treatment.  Freud 
did  not  investigate  his  hypotheses  in  an  unbiased  way  with  representative 
samples  of  normal  children. 

Some  psychologists  think  Freud's  theory  is  of  little  scientific  value 
because  it  is  so  hopelessly  opaque  and  complex.  Sometimes,  in  fact,  the  the¬ 
ory  predicts  equally  probable  but  contradictory  outcomes.  For  example,  chil¬ 
dren  who  experience  frustration  at  the  anal  stage  might  develop  habits  of 
orderliness,  cleanliness,  and  obedience,  or  they  might  develop  the  opposite 
characteristics,  rebelliousness  and  messiness.  How  do  we  predict  which  set  of 
traits  any  given  child  will  develop? 

Finally,  there  is  the  unnerving  experience  of  never  seeming  able  to 
disconfirm  Freud's  hypotheses.  If,  for  instance,  we  do  a  study  that  finds  no 


287 


Freud's  Psychoanalytic  Theory 


relationship  between  weaning  and  later  oral  behavior,  we  can  be  sure  some 
Freudians  will  say  we  failed  to  understand  Freud's  thoughts  in  sufficient 
depth. 

But  despite  the  difficulties,  an  enormous  amount  of  research  on  Freud's 
ideas  has  been  done  and  will  continue,  and  investigators  will  eventually  sort 
out  the  valid  and  invalid  propositions.  Researchers  will  continue  to  struggle 
with  Freud's  theory  and  to  test  it  the  best  they  can  because  they  sense  that 
Freud  was  basically  on  the  right  track.  As  Flail,  Lindzey,  and  Campbell  (1998) 
say,  his  theory  has  a  fundamental  appeal  because  it  is  both  broad  and  deep: 

Over  and  above  all  the  other  virtues  of  his  theory  stands  this  one:  It 
tries  to  envisage  full-bodied  individuals  living  partly  in  a  world  of  real¬ 
ity  and  partly  in  a  world  of  make-believe,  beset  by  conflicts  and  inner 
contradictions,  yet  capable  of  rational  thought  and  action,  moved  by 
forces  of  which  they  have  little  knowledge  and  by  aspirations  which 
are  beyond  their  reach,  by  turn  confused  and  clear-headed,  frustrated 
and  satisfied,  hopeful  and  despairing,  selfish  and  altruistic;  in  short,  a 
complex  human  being.  For  many  people,  this  picture  of  the  individual 
has  an  essential  validity,  (p.  77) 


288 


Erikson  and  the  Eight 
Stages  of  Life 


BIOGRAPHICAL  INTRODUCTION 

Among  the  advances  in  the  psychoanalytic  theory  of  development, 
none  has  been  more  substantial  than  that  made  by  Erik  H.  Erikson 
(1902-1994).  Erikson  has  given  us  a  new,  enlarged  picture  of  the  child's 
tasks  at  each  of  Freud's  stages.  Beyond  this,  he  has  added  three  new 
stages — those  of  the  adult  years — so  the  theory  now  encompasses  the 
entire  life  cycle. 

Erikson  was  born  to  Danish  parents  in  Frankfurt,  Germany,  the 
child  of  an  extramarital  union  he  and  his  mother  kept  secret  ("Erik 
Erikson,"  1994).  Erikson  was  raised  by  his  mother  alone  until  he  was 
3  years  old,  when  she  married  again,  this  time  to  a  local  pediatrician. 
Dr.  Homburger.  His  mother  and  Dr.  Homburger  were  Jewish,  but 
Erikson  looked  different — more  like  a  tall,  blond,  blue-eyed  Dane.  He 
was  even  nicknamed  "the  goy"  (non-Jew)  by  the  Jewish  boys  (Coles, 
1970,  p.  180). 

Young  Erikson  was  not  a  particularly  good  student.  Although  he 
excelled  in  certain  subjects — especially  ancient  history  and  art — he 
disliked  the  formal  school  atmosphere.  When  he  graduated  from  high 
school,  he  felt  lost  and  uncertain  about  his  future  place  in  life.  Instead 
of  going  to  college,  he  wandered  throughout  Europe  for  a  year,  returned 
home  to  study  art  for  a  while,  and  then  set  out  on  his  travels  once  again. 
He  was  going  through  what  he  would  later  call  a  moratorium,  a  period 
during  which  young  people  take  time  out  to  try  to  find  themselves. 
Such  behavior  was  acceptable  for  many  German  youth  at  the  time.  As 
Erikson's  biographer,  Robert  Coles  (1970),  says,  Erikson  "was  not  seen 
by  his  family  or  friends  as  odd  or  'sick,'  but  as  a  wandering  artist  who 
was  trying  to  come  to  grips  with  himself"  (p.  15). 

Erikson  finally  began  to  find  his  calling  when,  at  the  age  of  25, 
he  accepted  an  invitation  to  teach  children  in  a  new  Viennese  school 
founded  by  Anna  Freud  and  Dorothy  Burlingham.  When  Erikson 

From  Theories  of  Development:  Concepts  and  Applications,  Sixth  Edition.  William 
Crain.  Copyright  ©  2011  by  Pearson  Education,  Inc.  Published  by  Pearson 
Prentice  Hall.  All  rights  reserved. 


289 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


wasn't  teaching,  he  studied  child  psychoanalysis  with  Anna  Freud  and  oth¬ 
ers,  and  he  was  himself  analyzed  by  her. 

At  the  age  of  27,  Erikson  married  Joan  Serson  and  started  a  family.  Their 
life  was  disrupted  in  1933  when  the  rise  of  Hitler  forced  them  to  leave  Europe. 
They  settled  in  Boston,  where  Erikson  became  the  city's  first  child  analyst. 

But  the  urge  to  travel  seemed  firmly  implanted  in  Erikson's  nature.  After 
3  years  in  Boston,  he  took  a  position  at  Yale  University,  and  2  years  later  he 
made  another  trip — to  the  Pine  Ridge  Reservation  in  South  Dakota,  where  he 
lived  with  and  learned  about  the  Lakota  (Sioux).  Erikson  then  moved  on  to 
San  Francisco,  where  he  resumed  his  clinical  practice  with  children  and  par¬ 
ticipated  in  a  major  longitudinal  study  of  normal  children  at  the  University 
of  California.  He  also  found  time  to  travel  up  the  California  coast  to  study 
another  Indian  tribe,  the  Yurok  fishermen.  We  can  see  that  Erikson  was  explor¬ 
ing  areas  that  Freud  had  left  uncharted — the  lives  of  normal  children  and  of 
children  growing  up  in  different  cultural  contexts. 

In  1949,  during  the  McCarthy  era,  Erikson  came  into  conflict  with  his 
employer,  the  University  of  California.  The  university  demanded  a  loyalty 
oath  of  all  its  employees,  which  Erikson  refused  to  sign.  When  some  of  his 
colleagues  were  dismissed,  he  resigned.  Erikson  took  a  new  job  at  the  Austin 
Riggs  Center  in  Stockbridge,  Massachusetts,  where  he  worked  until  1960.  He 
was  then  given  a  professorship  at  Harvard  University,  even  though  he  had 
never  earned  a  formal  college  degree,  and  he  taught  at  Harvard  until  his  death. 

Erikson's  most  important  work  is  Childhood  and  Society  (1950;  2nd  ed. 
1963).  In  this  book  he  maps  out  his  eight  stages  of  life  and  illustrates  how 
these  stages  are  played  out  in  different  ways  in  different  cultures.  Two  other 
highly  influential  books  are  Young  Man  Luther  (1958)  and  Gandhi's  Truth  (1969), 
which  bridge  psychoanalytic  insights  with  historical  material. 


ERIKSON’S  STAGE  THEORY 
General  Purpose 

Freud,  you  will  recall,  postulated  a  sequence  of  psychosexual  stages  that 
center  on  body  zones.  As  children  mature,  their  sexual  interest  shifts  from  the 
oral  to  the  anal  to  the  phallic  zone;  then,  after  a  latency  period,  the  focus  is  once 
again  on  the  genital  region.  Freud  presented  a  completely  new  way  of  look¬ 
ing  at  development. 

At  the  same  time,  Freud's  stage  theory  is  limited.  In  particular,  its  focus 
on  body  zones  is  too  specific.  A  rigorous  stage  theory  describes  general  achieve¬ 
ments  or  issues  at  different  periods  of  life.  For  example,  we  do  not  call  shoe 
tying  a  stage  because  it  is  too  specific.  Similarly,  the  focus  on  zones  also  tends 
to  be  specific,  describing  only  parts  of  the  body.  Even  though  it  is  interesting 
to  note  that  some  people  become  fixated  on  these  zones — and,  for  example. 


290 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


find  the  mouth  the  main  source  of  pleasure  in  life — there  is  more  to  person¬ 
ality  development  than  this. 

Freud's  writings,  of  course,  were  not  limited  to  descriptions  of  body 
zones.  He  also  discussed  crucial  interactions  between  children  and  significant 
others.  Erikson  tried  to  do  this  more  thoroughly.  At  each  Freudian  stage, 
Erikson  introduced  concepts  that  gradually  led  to  an  understanding  of  the 
most  decisive,  general  encounter  between  the  child  and  the  social  world. 


1 .  The  Oral  Stage 

Zones  and  Modes.  Erikson  first  tried  to  give  the  Freudian  stages 
greater  generality  by  pointing  out  that  for  each  libidinal  zone,  we  can  also 
speak  of  an  ego  mode.  At  the  first  stage,  the  primary  zone  is  the  mouth,  but  this 
zone  also  possesses  a  mode  of  activity,  incorporation,  a  passive  yet  eager  taking 
in  (Erikson,  1963,  p.  72).  Further,  incorporation  extends  beyond  the  mouth  and 
characterizes  other  senses  as  well.  Babies  not  only  take  in  through  the  mouth 
but  also  through  the  eyes;  when  they  see  something  interesting,  they  open  their 
eyes  eagerly  and  widely  and  try  to  take  the  object  in  with  all  their  might.  Also, 
they  seem  to  take  in  good  feelings  through  their  tactile  senses.  And  even  a 
basic  reflex,  the  grasp  reflex,  seems  to  follow  the  incorporative  mode;  when 
an  object  touches  the  baby's  palm,  the  fist  automatically  closes  around  it. 
Incorporation  describes  a  general  mode  through  which  the  baby's  ego  first 
deals  with  the  external  world. 

Freud's  second  oral  stage  is  marked  by  the  eruption  of  teeth  and  aggres¬ 
sive  biting.  According  to  Erikson,  the  mode  of  biting  or  grasping,  like  incor¬ 
poration,  is  a  general  one  that  extends  beyond  the  mouth.  With  maturation, 
babies  can  actively  reach  out  and  grasp  things  with  their  hands.  Similarly, 
"the  eyes,  first  part  of  a  relatively  passive  system  of  accepting  impressions  as 
they  come  along,  have  now  learned  to  focus,  to  isolate,  to  'grasp'  objects  from 
a  vaguer  background,  and  to  follow  them"  (p.  77).  Finally,  the  organs  of  hear¬ 
ing  conform  to  the  more  active  mode  of  grasping.  Babies  can  now  discern  and 
localize  significant  sounds  and  can  move  their  heads  and  bodies  so  as  to 
actively  take  them  in.  Thus  the  mode  of  biting  or  grasping — of  active  taking — 
is  a  general  one  that  describes  the  central  way  in  which  the  ego  now  deals 
with  the  world. 

The  Most  General  Stage:  Basic  Trust  versus  Mistrust.  The  most 
general  stage  at  each  period  consists  of  a  general  encounter  between  the  child's 
maturing  ego  and  the  social  world.  At  the  first  stage,  as  babies  try  to  take  in 
the  things  they  need,  they  interact  with  caretakers,  who  follow  their  own  cul¬ 
ture's  ways  of  giving  to  them.  What  is  most  important  in  these  interactions  is 
that  babies  come  to  find  some  consistency,  predictability,  and  reliability  in 
their  caretakers'  actions.  When  they  sense  that  a  parent  is  consistent  and 
dependable,  they  develop  a  sense  of  basic  trust  in  the  parent.  They  come  to 


291 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


sense  that  when  they  are  cold,  wet,  or  hungry,  they  can  count  on  others  to 
relieve  their  pain.  Some  parents  come  promptly  while  others  minister  on 
schedules,  but  in  either  case  babies  learn  the  parent  is  dependable  and  there¬ 
fore  trustworthy.  The  alternative  is  a  sense  of  mistrust,  the  feeling  that  the 
parent  is  unpredictable  and  unreliable,  and  may  not  be  there  when  needed 
(Erikson,  1963,  p.  247). 

Babies  must  also  learn  to  trust  themselves.  This  problem  becomes  par¬ 
ticularly  acute  when  babies  experience  the  rages  of  teething  and  hurt  the  nurs¬ 
ing  mother  with  their  sharp  bites  and  grasps.  When  babies  learn  to  regulate 
their  urges — to  suck  without  biting  and  to  hold  without  hurting — they  begin 
to  consider  themselves  "trustworthy  enough  so  that  the  providers  will  not 
need  to  be  on  guard  lest  they  be  nipped"  (p.  248).  For  her  part,  the  mother 
needs  to  be  careful  not  to  withdraw  too  completely  or  to  wean  too  suddenly. 
If  she  does,  the  baby  will  feel  that  her  care  is  not  dependable  after  all,  for  it  may 
be  suddenly  taken  away. 

When  babies  have  developed  a  sense  of  trust  in  their  caretakers,  they 
show  it  in  their  behavior.  Erikson  said  the  first  sign  of  trust  in  a  mother  comes 
when  the  baby  is  willing  "to  let  her  out  of  sight  without  undue  anxiety  or 
rage"  (p.  247).  The  word  undue  is  probably  important  here,  for  we  saw  in  the 
discussion  of  Bowlby  that  most  babies  experience  some  separation  anxiety. 
Nevertheless,  if  parents  are  dependable,  babies  can  learn  to  tolerate  their 
absences.  If  caretakers  are  undependable,  babies  cannot  afford  to  let  them  go 
and  panic  when  they  begin  to  do  so. 

Trust  is  similar  to  what  Benedek  called  confidence.  It  is  a  basic  faith  in 
one's  providers.  Erikson  said  he  preferred  the  term  trust  because  "there  is  more 
naivete  and  more  mutuality  in  it"  (p.  248).  But  trust  results  in  the  same  attitude 
that  Benedek  was  concerned  about — the  calm  patience  that  comes  from  the 
certainty  that  one's  providers  will  be  there  when  needed. 

Trust,  then,  is  the  sense  that  others  are  reliable  and  predictable.  At  the 
same  time,  however,  Erikson  implied  that  trust  ultimately  depends  on  some¬ 
thing  more.  Ultimately,  he  said,  trust  depends  on  the  parents'  own  confidence, 
on  their  sense  they  are  doing  things  right.  Parents  "must  be  able  to  represent 
to  the  child  a  deep,  an  almost  somatic  conviction  that  there  is  a  meaning  to 
what  they  are  doing"  (p.  249).  This  sense  of  meaning,  in  turn,  requires  cul¬ 
tural  backing — the  belief  that  the  "way  we  do  things  is  good  for  our  children." 

At  first  glance,  Erikson's  emphasis  on  the  caretaker's  own  confidence  is 
puzzling.  What  does  the  parent's  confidence  have  to  do  with  the  baby? 
Erikson  might  have  had  in  mind  thoughts  similar  to  those  of  the  psychiatrist 
H.  S.  Sullivan.  Sullivan  (1953)  believed  that  in  the  first  months  of  life  the  infant 
has  a  special  kind  of  physical  empathy  with  the  mother  figure  such  that  the 
baby  automatically  feels  the  mother's  state  of  tension.  If  the  mother  feels  anx¬ 
ious,  the  baby  feels  anxious;  if  the  mother  feels  calm,  the  baby  feels  calm.  It  is 
important  that  parents  feel  reasonably  confident  and  self-assured,  so  babies 


292 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


will  not  become  too  wary  of  interpersonal  contact.  Babies  need  to  feel  that  it 
is  basically  good  and  reassuring  to  be  close  to  others. 

Erikson  (1959,  p.  64)  observed  that  it  is  not  always  easy  for  U.S.  parents 
to  have  an  inner  confidence  in  their  child-rearing  practices.  Whereas  parents 
in  simpler,  more  stable  cultures  follow  practices  that  have  been  handed  down 
over  the  generations,  the  modern  American  parent  has  fewer  traditions  to  fall 
back  on.  Modern  parents  receive  all  kinds  of  advice  on  newer,  "better"  child- 
rearing  techniques,  and  the  advice  is  by  no  means  uniform. 

In  this  situation,  Erikson  believed  books  such  as  Spock's  (1946)  are  help¬ 
ful.  Throughout  his  book,  Spock  encourages  parents  to  trust  themselves.  He 
tells  parents  that  they  know  more  than  they  think  and  they  should  follow 
their  impulses  to  respond  to  their  babies'  needs.  It  is  almost  as  if  Spock  had 
read  Erikson  and  understood  the  importance  of  parents  possessing  an  inner 
assurance. 

Beyond  reading  Spock,  Erikson  said,  parents  can  gain  an  inner  security 
from  religion.  Their  own  faith  and  inner  assurance  will  be  transmitted  to  the 
child,  helping  the  child  feel  the  world  is  a  trustworthy  place.  If  parents  are 
without  religion,  they  must  find  faith  in  some  other  area,  perhaps  in  fellowship, 
or  the  goals  of  their  work,  or  in  their  social  ideals  (Erikson,  1959,  pp.  64-65). 

Erikson  has  sometimes  given  readers  the  impression  that  babies  should 
develop  trust  but  not  mistrust.  But  he  did  not  mean  this.  He  saw  each  stage 
as  a  vital  conflict  or  tension  in  which  the  "negative"  pole  is  also  necessary  for 
growth.  In  the  present  case,  infants  must  experience  both  trust  and  mistrust. 
If  they  only  developed  trust,  they  would  become  too  gullible.  "It  is  clear," 
Erikson  said,  "that  the  human  infant  must  experience  a  goodly  measure  of 
mistrust  in  order  to  learn  to  trust  discerningly"  (1976,  p.  23). 

At  the  same  time,  it  is  critical  that  infants  emerge  from  this  stage  with  a 
favorable  balance  of  trust  over  mistrust.  If  they  do,  they  will  have  developed 
the  core  ego  strength  of  this  period:  hope.  Hope  is  the  expectation  that  despite 
frustrations,  rages,  and  disappointments,  good  things  will  happen  in  the 
future.  Hope  enables  the  child  to  move  forward  into  the  world  and  take  up 
new  challenges  (Erikson,  1982,  p.  60). 

Conclusion.  We  see,  then,  that  Erikson  considerably  broadened 
Freud's  description  of  the  oral  stage.  Erikson  showed  that  it  is  not  just  the  oral 
zone  that  is  important,  but  the  corresponding  ego  modes  of  dealing  with  the 
world.  The  infant  incorporates  and  later  grasps  things  in  the  world  through 
the  various  senses.  The  infant's  maturing  ego,  in  turn,  meets  the  social  world — 
in  this  case,  the  caretakers — in  a  general,  decisive  encounter.  The  critical  issue 
is  that  of  trust  versus  mistrust.  The  baby  needs  to  know  that  the  caretakers  are 
predictable  and  to  sense  their  inner  assurance.  If  the  baby  can  develop  a  favor¬ 
able  balance  of  trust  over  mistrust,  the  baby  develops  the  core  ego  strength  of 
this  period:  hope.  Hope  enables  the  child  to  move  forward  and  enthusiastically 
confront  the  world  despite  current  and  past  frustrations. 


293 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


Issues  of  trust,  mistrust,  and  hope  are,  of  course,  with  us  throughout  our 
lives.  Erikson  recognized  this.  But  he  also  claimed  that  the  struggle  between 
trust  and  mistrust  reaches  its  own  particular  crisis  and  is  the  dominating  event 
in  the  first  year  of  life.  And  the  way  in  which  infants  resolve  this  first  crisis, 
with  or  without  a  firm  sense  of  hopefulness,  determines  the  energy  and  vital¬ 
ity  they  bring  to  subsequent  stages. 

2 .  The  Anal  Stage 

Zones  and  Modes.  In  Freud's  second  stage,  which  occurs  during  the 
second  and  third  years,  the  anal  zone  comes  into  prominence.  With  the  mat¬ 
uration  of  the  nervous  system,  children  gain  voluntary  control  over  their 
sphincter  muscles;  they  can  now  retain  and  eliminate  as  they  wish.  They  often 
hold  on  to  their  bowel  movements  to  maximize  the  sensations  of  the  final 
release. 

Erikson  agreed  with  Freud  that  the  basic  modes  of  this  stage  are  reten¬ 
tion  and  elimination,  of  holding  on  and  letting  go.  However,  Erikson  also 
pointed  out  that  these  modes  encompass  more  than  the  anal  zone.  For  ex¬ 
ample,  children  begin  to  use  their  hands  to  hold  stubbornly  on  to  objects  and, 
just  as  defiantly,  to  throw  them  away.  Once  they  can  sit  up  easily,  they  carefully 
pile  things  up  one  moment,  only  to  discard  them  the  next.  With  people,  too, 
they  sometimes  hold  on,  snuggling  up,  and  at  other  times  insist  on  pushing 
the  adult  away  (Erikson,  1959,  pp.  82,  86). 

The  General  Stage:  Autonomy  versus  Shame  and  Doubt.  Amidst 
these  contradictory  impulses — holding  on  one  moment  and  expelling  the 
next — the  child  is  primarily  trying  to  exercise  a  choice.  Two-year-olds  want  to 
hold  on  when  they  want  and  to  push  aside  when  they  do  not.  They  are  exer¬ 
cising  their  will,  their  sense  of  autonomy  (see  Table  1). 


Table  1  The  Stages  of  Freud  and  Erikson 


AGE 

FREUD'S  STAGE 

ERIKSON'S  GENERAL  STAGE 

Birth  to  1 

Oral 

Trust  vs.  Mistrust:  Hope 

1  to  3 

Anal 

Autonomy  vs.  Shame,  Doubt:  Will 

3  to  6 

Phallic  (Oedipal) 

Initiative  vs.  Guilt:  Purpose 

6  to  11 

Latency 

Industry  vs.  Inferiority: 

Competence 

Adolescence 

Genital 

Identity  vs.  Role  Confusion:  Fidelity 

Young  Adulthood 

Intimacy  vs.  Isolation:  Love 

Adulthood 

Generativity  vs.  Self-Absorption, 
Stagnation:  Care 

Old  Age 

Ego  Integrity  vs.  Despair:  Wisdom 

294 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


In  other  ways,  too,  maturation  ushers  in  a  sense  of  autonomy  during 
the  second  and  third  years.  Children  can  now  stand  up  on  their  own  two  feet, 
and  they  begin  to  explore  the  world  on  their  own.  They  also  insist  on  feeding 
themselves,  even  if  this  means  exercising  their  right  to  make  a  mess.  Their 
language,  too,  reveals  a  new-found  autonomy  and  sense  of  selfhood;  they 
repeatedly  use  the  words  me  and  mine.  Most  of  all,  they  express  their  auton¬ 
omy  in  a  single  word — no.  Two-year-olds  seem  unable  to  say  "Yes,"  as  if  any 
agreement  means  a  complete  forfeiture  of  their  independence.  Through  the 
strong  and  insistent  "No,"  children  defy  all  external  control. 

As  children  seem  so  much  more  in  control  of  themselves  and  reach  peaks 
of  willfulness,  societies,  through  parents,  decide  it  is  time  to  teach  them  the 
right  ways  to  behave.  As  Freud  observed,  parents  do  not  permit  their  chil¬ 
dren  to  enjoy  their  anality  in  any  way  they  please;  instead,  they  train  them  to 
behave  in  the  socially  proper  way.  Parents  quite  often  toilet-train  children  by 
making  them  feel  ashamed  of  messy  and  improper  anal  behavior.  Children 
may  resist  training  for  some  time,  but  they  eventually  submit  to  it. 

Erikson  agreed  that  the  "battles  of  the  toilet  bowl"  are  important.  But 
he  also  is  suggesting  that  the  battles  of  this  time — between  the  child's  auton¬ 
omy  and  the  society's  regulations — take  place  in  a  number  of  arenas.  For 
example,  when  children  insist  on  feeding  themselves  and  making  a  mess, 
parents  try  to  regulate  their  behavior.  Similarly,  parents  sooner  or  later  decide 
their  2-year-olds  cannot  say  "No"  to  every  single  request.  Two-year-olds,  like 
everyone  else,  must  live  in  society  and  respect  others'  wishes.  Thus  the  con¬ 
flict  at  this  stage  is  a  very  general  one. 

Erikson  defined  the  conflict  as  that  of  autonomy  versus  shame  and 
doubt.  Autonomy  comes  from  within;  biological  maturation  fosters  the  abil¬ 
ity  to  do  things  on  one's  own — to  control  one's  own  sphincter  muscles,  to 
stand  on  one's  own  feet,  to  use  one's  hands,  and  so  on.  Shame  and  doubt,  in 
contrast,  come  from  an  awareness  of  social  expectations  and  pressures.  Shame 
is  the  feeling  that  we  do  not  look  good  in  others'  eyes.  For  example,  a  little  girl 
who  wets  her  pants  becomes  self-conscious,  worried  that  others  will  see  her 
in  this  state.  Doubt  stems  from  the  realization  that  one  is  not  so  powerful  after 
all,  that  others  can  control  one  and  perform  actions  much  better. 

It  is  hoped  that  children  can  learn  to  adjust  to  social  regulations  without 
losing  too  much  of  their  initial  sense  of  autonomy.  Some  parents  try  to  assist 
the  child  with  this.  They  gently  try  to  help  the  child  learn  social  behavior  with¬ 
out  crushing  the  child's  independence.  Other  parents  are  not  so  sensitive. 
They  may  shame  children  excessively  when  they  have  a  bowel  accident;  they 
may  try  to  break  their  children  of  any  oppositional  behavior;  or  they  may 
ridicule  their  children's  efforts  to  do  things  on  their  own.  In  such  instances, 
children  can  develop  lasting  feelings  of  shame  and  doubt  that  override  their 
impulses  toward  self-determination. 

To  the  extent  that  children  resolve  this  second  crisis  in  a  positive  way, 
with  a  favorable  ratio  of  autonomy  over  shame  and  doubt,  they  develop  the 


295 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


ego  strength  of  rudimentary  will.  "Will,"  Erikson  said,  is  "the  unbroken 
determination  to  exercise  free  choice  as  well  as  self-restraint"  (1964,  p.  119). 
Erikson  includes  self-restraint  in  his  definition  because  he  believes  it  is 
important  for  children  to  learn  to  control  their  impulses  and  to  renounce 
what  is  not  worth  doing  (or  cannot  be  done).  Still,  it  is  the  child — not  exter¬ 
nal  powers — who  is  in  charge. 


3.  The  Phallic  (Oedipal)  Stage 

Zone  and  Modes.  During  Freud's  third  stage  (between  about  3  and  6 
years  of  age),  the  child's  concern  with  the  anal  zone  gives  way  to  the  primacy 
of  the  genital  zone.  Children  now  focus  their  interest  on  their  genitals  and 
become  curious  about  the  sex  organs  of  others.  They  also  begin  to  imagine 
themselves  in  adult  roles  and  even  dare  to  rival  one  parent  for  the  love  of  the 
other.  They  enter  the  oedipal  crisis. 

Erikson  called  the  primary  mode  at  this  stage  intrusion.  By  this  term,  he 
hoped  to  capture  Freud's  sense  of  the  child  as  now  exceedingly  daring,  curi¬ 
ous,  and  competitive.  The  term  intrusion  describes  the  activity  of  the  boy's 
penis,  but  as  a  general  mode  it  refers  to  much  more.  For  both  sexes,  the  mat¬ 
uration  of  physical  and  mental  abilities  impels  the  child  forward  into  a  vari¬ 
ety  of  intrusive  activities.  "These  include  the  intrusion  into  other  bodies  by 
physical  attack;  the  intrusion  into  other  people's  ears  and  minds  by  aggressive 
talking;  the  intrusion  into  space  by  vigorous  locomotion;  the  intrusion  into 
the  unknown  by  consuming  curiosity"  (Erikson,  1963,  p.  87). 


The  General  Stage:  Initiative  versus  Guilt.  Initiative,  like  intru¬ 
sion,  connotes  forward  movement.  The  child  with  a  sense  of  initiative  makes 
plans,  sets  goals,  and  perseveres  in  attaining  them.  I  noted,  for  example, 
some  of  the  activities  of  our  son  Adam  when  he  was  5  years  old.  In  a  single 
day,  he  decided  to  see  how  high  he  could  build  his  blocks,  invented  a  game 
that  consisted  of  seeing  who  could  jump  the  highest  on  his  parents'  bed, 
and  led  the  family  to  a  new  movie  containing  a  great  deal  of  action  and  vio¬ 
lence.  His  behavior  had  taken  on  a  goal-directed,  competitive,  and  imagi¬ 
native  quality. 

The  crisis  comes  when  children  realize  their  biggest  plans  and  fondest 
hopes  are  doomed  for  failure.  These  ambitions,  of  course,  are  the  oedipal 
ones — the  wish  to  possess  one  parent  and  rival  the  other.  The  child  finds 
out  that  these  wishes  violate  deep  social  taboos  and  are  far  more  dangerous 
than  imagined.  Consequently,  the  child  internalizes  social  prohibitions — 
a  guilt-producing  superego — to  keep  such  dangerous  impulses  and  fantasies 
in  check.  The  result  is  a  new  form  of  self-restriction.  Forever  after,  the  indi¬ 
vidual's  naive  exuberance  and  daring  will  be  offset  by  self-observation, 
self-control,  and  self-punishment  (see  Figure  1). 


296 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


Figure  1 

A  boy's  drawing  expresses  daring  initiative  and  disaster.  There  is  a  resemblance 
to  the  myth  of  Icarus,  about  a  boy  who  went  too  far — too  near  the  sun.  This  draw¬ 
ing,  by  a  9-year-old,  may  also  suggest  the  industry  theme  of  the  next  stage:  The 
climbers  on  the  left  are  engaged  in  skillful  cooperation. 

In  Erikson's  view,  the  creation  of  a  superego  constitutes  one  of  the  great 
tragedies  in  life.  Although  the  superego  is  necessary  for  socialized  behavior,  it 
stifles  the  bold  initiative  with  which  the  child  met  life  at  the  phallic  stage.  Still, 
Erikson  was  not  completely  pessimistic.  He  observed  that  3-  to  6-year-old  chil¬ 
dren  are,  more  than  at  any  other  time,  ready  to  learn  quickly  and  avidly,  and 
they  are  willing  to  find  ways  of  channeling  their  ambition  into  socially  useful 
pursuits  (1963,  p.  258).  Parents  can  help  this  process  by  easing  their  authority 
somewhat  and  by  permitting  children  to  participate  with  them  as  equals  on 
interesting  projects.  In  this  way,  parents  can  help  children  emerge  from  the  cri¬ 
sis  of  this  stage  with  a  strong  sense  of  purpose,  "the  courage  to  envisage  and  pur¬ 
sue  valued  goals,"  unimpaired  by  guilt  and  inhibition  (Erikson,  1964,  p.  122). 

4.  The  Latency  Stage 

In  Freud's  theory,  the  resolution  of  the  Oedipus  complex  brings  about  a  latency 
period,  lasting  from  about  age  6  to  11.  During  this  period  the  sexual  and 
aggressive  drives,  which  produced  crises  at  earlier  periods,  are  temporarily 
dormant.  There  is  no  libidinal  (sexual)  zone  for  this  stage. 


297 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


Of  course,  the  child's  life  at  this  time  may  not  be  entirely  conflict  free.  For 
example,  the  birth  of  a  sibling  may  arouse  intense  jealousy.  But  as  a  rule,  this 
is  a  period  of  calm  and  stability.  In  terms  of  the  instincts  and  drives,  nothing 
much  is  going  on. 

Erikson,  however,  showed  that  this  is  a  most  decisive  stage  for  ego 
growth.  Children  master  important  cognitive  and  social  skills.  The  crisis  is 
industry  versus  inferiority.  Children  forget  their  past  hopes  and  wishes,  which 
were  often  played  out  within  the  family,  and  eagerly  apply  themselves  to 
learning  the  useful  skills  and  tools  of  the  wider  culture.  In  indigenous  societies, 
children  learn  to  track,  find  food,  and  make  utensils.  In  these  cultures,  learn¬ 
ing  is  often  informal,  and  much  of  it  comes  from  older  children.  In  modern 
technological  societies  such  as  ours,  children  go  to  school,  where  they  are 
asked  to  master  more  cerebral  skills — reading,  writing,  and  arithmetic.  In 
either  case,  they  are  learning  to  do  meaningful  work  and  are  developing  the 
ego  strengths  of  "steady  attention  and  persevering  diligence"  (Erikson,  1963, 
p.  259).  They  also  are  learning  to  work  and  play  with  their  peers. 

The  danger  of  this  stage  is  an  excessive  feeling  of  inadequacy  and  infe¬ 
riority  (1963,  p.  260).  Most  of  us  can  probably  remember  the  hurts  of  failure 
in  the  classroom  or  on  the  playground.  A  particularly  deep  sense  of  inferior¬ 
ity  may  have  various  roots.  Sometimes  children  have  difficulty  at  this  stage 
because  they  have  not  successfully  resolved  the  conflicts  at  earlier  stages.  For 
example,  a  girl  may  have  developed  more  doubt  than  autonomy  at  the  second 
stage,  so  she  is  unsure  of  herself  as  she  tries  to  master  new  tasks.  At  other 
times,  school  and  community  attitudes  may  hinder  the  development  of  a  sense 
of  industry.  An  African  American  boy  may  learn  that  the  color  of  his  skin 
counts  for  more  than  his  wish  and  will  to  learn.  And  all  too  often  schools  fail 
to  discover  and  encourage  the  individual's  special  talents  (p.  260). 

Good  teachers  (who  often  are  those  who  feel  trusted  and  respected  by 
the  community)  can  help  children  at  this  time.  Erikson  (1959,  p.  87)  said  he  had 
repeatedly  observed  that  in  the  lives  of  inspired  and  gifted  people  just  one 
teacher  made  a  difference  by  encouraging  the  individual's  talent. 

In  any  case,  the  successful  resolution  of  this  stage  leads  to  the  ego  strength 
Erikson  called  competence,  the  free  exercise  of  intelligence  and  skill  in  the  com¬ 
pletion  of  tasks,  unimpaired  by  excessive  feelings  of  inferiority  (1964,  p.  124). 

5.  Puberty  (The  Genital  Stage) 

According  to  Sigmund  and  Anna  Freud,  adolescence  is  a  turbulent  stage 
because  of  the  dramatic  physiological  changes  occurring  at  this  time.  Sexual 
and  aggressive  drives,  which  were  dormant  during  the  latency  stage,  now 
threaten  to  overwhelm  the  ego  and  its  defenses.  The  genital  zone,  in  particu¬ 
lar,  is  infused  with  tremendous  sexual  energy,  and  the  adolescent  is  once  again 
troubled  by  oedipal  fantasies.  The  teenager  may  find  it  difficult  simply  to  be 
around  his  or  her  parents. 


298 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


Erikson  agreed  that  the  great  increase  in  drive  energy  is  disruptive  at 
adolescence,  but  he  saw  this  as  only  part  of  the  problem.  Adolescents  also 
become  disturbed  and  confused  by  new  social  conflicts  and  demands.  The 
adolescent's  primary  task,  Erikson  believed,  is  establishing  a  new  sense  of  ego 
identity — a  feeling  for  who  one  is  and  one's  place  in  the  larger  social  order. 
The  crisis  is  one  of  identity  versus  role  confusion. 

The  upsurge  of  instinctual  drives  certainly  contributes  to  the  adolescent's 
identity  problems.  Adolescents  suddenly  feel  as  if  their  impulses  have  a  will 
of  their  own,  that  they  are  no  longer  one  with  themselves.  Also,  the  rapid  phys¬ 
ical  growth  at  puberty  creates  a  sense  of  identity  confusion.  Young  people  begin 
to  grow  so  quickly  and  to  change  in  so  many  ways  that  they  barely  recognize 
themselves.  It  is  probably  for  this  reason  that  teenagers  spend  so  much  time 
looking  in  mirrors  and  pay  so  much  attention  to  their  appearance. 

But  identity  problems  are  as  much,  if  not  more,  a  social  matter.  It  is  not 
physical  growth  or  sexual  impulses  per  se  that  trouble  young  people,  but  it  is 
the  thought  that  one  might  not  look  good  to  others  or  meet  others'  expecta¬ 
tions.  And,  even  more  than  this,  young  people  begin  to  worry  about  their 
future  place  in  the  larger  social  world.  Adolescents,  with  their  rapidly  expand¬ 
ing  mental  powers,  feel  overwhelmed  by  the  countless  options  and  alterna¬ 
tives  before  them. 

Because  adolescents  are  so  uncertain  about  who  they  are,  they  anxiously 
tend  to  identify  with  in-groups.  They  can  "become  remarkably  clannish,  intol¬ 
erant,  and  cruel  in  their  exclusion  of  others  who  are  'different'"  (Erikson,  1959, 
p.  92).  In  their  hurry  to  find  some  identity,  they  stereotype  "themselves,  their 
ideals,  and  their  enemies"  (p.  92).  They  often  put  themselves  and  others  to  a 
"loyalty  test."  Some  young  people  align  themselves  to  political  or  religious  ide¬ 
ologies.  In  all  this,  we  can  detect  young  people's  search  for  values  to  which 
they  can  be  true. 

To  understand  identity  formation,  it  is  important  to  recognize  that  it  is 
a  lifelong  process.  In  part,  we  form  our  identities  through  identifications. 
Although  we  are  not  necessarily  aware  of  it,  we  identify  with  those  who  appeal 
to  us  and  therefore  become  like  them.  Each  person's  identity,  then,  is  partly  a 
synthesis  of  various  partial  identifications  (1959,  pp.  112-113). 

We  also  develop  a  sense  of  identity  through  our  accomplishments. 
The  ability  to  stand  up,  walk,  run,  play  ball,  draw,  read,  and  write  all  con¬ 
tribute  to  a  sense  of  ego  identity.  We  come  to  see  ourselves  as  "one  who 
can  do  these  things."  Such  accomplishments  become  part  of  a  positive  and 
lasting  sense  of  identity  when  they  have  importance  for  the  culture  (1959, 
pp.  89-90). 

Still,  even  though  identity  formation  is  a  lifelong  process,  the  problem 
of  identity  reaches  its  crisis  at  adolescence.  It  is  at  this  time  that  so  many  inner 
changes  are  taking  place,  and  so  much  in  terms  of  future  commitment  is  at 
stake.  During  adolescence  one's  earlier  identity  seems  inadequate  for  all  the 
choices  and  decisions  one  must  make. 


299 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


Erikson  (1959,  p.  123)  asked  us  to  consider,  for  example,  a  young  college 
girl  from  a  conservative  background.  When  she  goes  to  college  she  meets 
people  of  very  different  backgrounds,  among  whom  she  must  choose  her 
friends.  She  also  must  decide  what  her  attitude  toward  sex  will  be  and  what 
occupational  goals  she  is  willing  to  compete  for.  At  this  point,  her  previous 
identity  and  identifications  offer  little  help.  Each  decision  seems  to  affirm 
some  aspect  of  her  past  while  repudiating  others.  If  she  decides  to  become 
sexually  active,  she  may  violate  her  family's  spoken  values,  while  identifying 
with  some  of  their  hidden  wishes.  If  she  chooses  to  compete  in  a  male- 
dominated  field  such  as  politics  or  surgery,  she  ventures  beyond  certain  fam¬ 
ily  values  but  aligns  herself  with  others.  As  she  makes  decisions  and 
commitments,  she  reworks  prior  identifications  and  forms  a  new  identity.  Her 
task  is  to  forge  for  herself  some  "central  perspective  and  direction,  some  work¬ 
ing  unity,  out  of  the  effective  remnants  of  [her]  childhood  and  the  hopes  of 
[her]  anticipated  adulthood"  (Erikson,  1958,  p.  14). 

Identity  formation  is  a  largely  unconscious  process.  Still,  young  people 
are  often  painfully  aware  of  their  inability  to  make  lasting  commitments. 
They  feel  there  is  too  much  to  decide  too  soon,  and  that  every  decision 
reduces  their  future  alternatives  (Erikson,  1959,  pp.  124-126).  Because  com¬ 
mitment  is  so  difficult,  they  sometimes  enter  a  psychosocial  moratorium,  a  kind 
of  "time  out"  period  for  finding  oneself.  Some  young  people,  for  example, 
drop  out  of  college  to  travel  or  experiment  with  various  jobs  before  making 
any  final  decisions.  However,  many  young  people  have  trouble  achieving  a 
free  moratorium  state.  Until  they  know  who  they  are  and  what  they  will  do 
in  life,  they  often  experience  a  sense  of  isolation,  a  feeling  that  time  is  pass¬ 
ing  them  by,  an  inability  to  find  meaning  in  any  kind  of  activity,  and  a  feel¬ 
ing  that  life  is  simply  happening  to  them.  As  Biff  puts  it  in  Arthur  Miller's 
Death  of  a  Salesman,  "I  just  can't  take  hold.  Mom,  I  can't  take  hold  of  some  kind 
of  life"  (Erikson,  1959,  p.  91). 

Nevertheless,  the  adolescent  frequently  postpones  commitments  any¬ 
way,  because  of  an  inner  need  to  avoid  identity  foreclosure,  a  premature  accep¬ 
tance  of  compartmentalized  social  roles.  And  although  a  protracted  identity 
search  can  be  painful,  it  can  also  eventually  lead  to  a  higher  form  of  personal 
integration  and  to  genuine  social  innovations.  As  we  have  seen,  many  of  the 
theorists  in  this  book  resisted  the  temptation  to  settle  into  conventional  occu¬ 
pational  identities.  Piaget,  Freud,  and  Erikson,  among  others,  spent  some  time 
searching  for  their  true  callings.  And  their  search,  while  not  always  pleasant 
for  them,  eventually  led  to  new  ways  of  understanding  and  meaningful 
changes  in  their  professions. 

The  adolescent's  central  task,  then,  is  to  find  some  way  of  life  to  which 
he  or  she  can  make  a  permanent  commitment.  The  struggles  of  this  stage  lead 
to  the  new  ego  strength  of  fidelity,  the  ability  to  sustain  one's  freely  pledged 
loyalties  (Erikson,  1964,  p.  125). 


300 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


6. Young  Adulthood 

Erikson  is  the  first  Freudian  and  one  of  the  few  developmental  writers  of  any 
persuasion  to  propose  separate  stages  for  the  adult  years.  If,  then,  his 
thoughts  seem  sketchy,  we  should  remember  that  he  was  writing  about  an 
uncharted  area. 

Erikson's  stages  of  adult  development  describe  steps  by  which  people 
widen  and  deepen  their  capacities  to  love  and  care  for  others.  The  adolescent 
is  preeminently  self-centered.  Adolescents  are  concerned  with  who  they  are, 
how  they  appear  in  the  eyes  of  others,  and  what  they  will  become.  They  do 
become  sexually  attracted  to  others  and  even  fall  in  love,  but  such  attach¬ 
ments  most  often  are  really  efforts  at  self-definition.  In  their  interactions, 
young  people  try  to  find  out  who  they  are  by  endlessly  talking  about  their 
true  feelings,  their  views  of  each  other,  and  their  plans,  hopes,  and  expecta¬ 
tions  (Erikson,  1959,  p.  95). 

The  adolescent,  then,  is  too  preoccupied  with  who  he  or  she  is  to  take 
up  the  task  of  young  adulthood — the  attainment  of  intimacy.  Real  intimacy 
is  only  possible  once  a  reasonable  sense  of  identity  has  been  established 
(1959,  p.  95).  Only  one  who  is  secure  with  one's  identity  is  able  to  lose  one¬ 
self  in  true  mutuality  with  another.  The  young  man,  for  example,  who  is 
worried  about  his  masculinity  will  not  make  the  best  lover.  He  will  be  too 
self-conscious,  too  worried  about  how  he  is  performing,  to  abandon  himself 
freely  and  tenderly  with  his  sexual  partner.  To  the  extent  that  people  fail  to 
attain  genuine  mutuality,  they  experience  the  opposite  pole  of  this  stage — 
isolation. 

Erikson  observed  that  some  young  people  marry  before  they  have  estab¬ 
lished  a  good  sense  of  identity.  They  hope  they  will  be  able  to  find  them¬ 
selves  in  their  marriage.  Such  marriages,  however,  rarely  work  out.  The 
partners  sooner  or  later  begin  to  feel  hemmed  in  by  their  obligations  as  mates 
and  parents.  They  soon  complain  that  others  are  not  giving  them  the  oppor¬ 
tunity  to  develop  themselves.  Erikson  noted  that  a  change  in  mate  is  rarely 
the  answer.  What  the  individual  needs  is  some  "wisely  guided  insight"  into 
the  fact  that  one  cannot  expect  to  live  intimately  with  another  until  one  has 
become  oneself  (p.  95). 

In  his  discussions  of  intimacy,  Erikson,  as  a  respectable  Freudian,  spoke 
glowingly  of  the  experience  of  orgasm:  It  is  a  supreme  experience  of  mutual  reg¬ 
ulation  that  takes  the  edge  off  the  inevitable  bitterness  and  differences  between 
two  people  (1963,  p.  265).  He  added,  though,  that  the  "Utopia  of  genitality"  is  by 
no  means  a  purely  sexual  matter.  True  intimacy  means  that  two  people  are  will¬ 
ing  to  share  and  mutually  regulate  all  important  aspects  of  their  lives  (p.  266). 

As  with  the  other  stages,  no  one  develops  only  the  positive  pole  of  this 
stage.  No  couple  experiences  total  intimacy.  Because  people  are  different 
(sexually  and  otherwise),  there  is  inevitably  a  degree  of  antagonism  between 


301 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


partners  that  leads  to  periodic  isolation.  Ideally,  however,  intimacy  is 
stronger  than  isolation.  If  so,  young  adults  develop  the  ego  strength  of 
mature  love —  the  "mutuality  of  devotion  forever  subduing  the  antagonisms" 
between  them  (Erikson,  1964,  p.  129). 


7.  Adulthood 

Once  two  people  have  established  some  measure  of  intimacy,  their  interests 
begin  to  expand  beyond  just  the  two  of  them.  They  become  concerned  with 
raising  the  next  generation.  In  Erikson's  terms,  they  enter  the  stage  of 
generativity  versus  self-absorption  and  stagnation  (Erikson,  1982,  p.  67). 
Generativity  is  a  broad  term  that  refers  not  only  to  the  creation  of  children  but 
also  to  the  production  of  things  and  ideas  through  work.  But  Erikson  focused 
primarily  on  the  former — the  generation  of  children. 

The  mere  fact  of  having  children,  of  course,  does  not  guarantee  genera¬ 
tivity.  Parents  must  do  more  than  produce  offspring;  they  must  protect  and 
guide  them.  This  means  that  parents  must  often  sacrifice  their  own  needs. 
They  must  overcome  temptations  to  self-indulgence,  which  lead  to  an  unpro¬ 
ductive  stagnation.  To  the  extent  they  can  positively  cope  with  this  conflict, 
they  develop  their  ability  to  care  for  the  next  generation. 

Some  people,  Erikson  noted,  develop  generativity  and  care  without  hav¬ 
ing  children  of  their  own.  Nuns  and  priests,  for  example,  forgo  the  right  to 
raise  their  own  children,  as  do  others  who  apply  their  special  gifts  to  other 
areas.  Such  persons  can  still  teach  and  guide  the  next  generation  "by  working 
with  other  people's  children  or  helping  to  create  a  better  world  for  them" 
(Erikson  in  Evans,  1969,  p.  51).  Such  adults  must,  to  be  sure,  withstand  a  cer¬ 
tain  amount  of  frustration.  This  is  especially  true  of  women,  whose  bodies 
are  built  for  nurturing  and  nourishing  offspring.  But  a  sense  of  care  and  gen¬ 
erativity  is  still  possible. 

On  the  other  hand,  there  are  many  people  who  marry  but  lack  genera¬ 
tivity.  In  such  cases,  the  couples  often  regress  to  a  kind  of  "pseudointimacy" 
or  "begin  to  indulge  themselves  as  if  they  were  their  one  and  only  child" 
(Erikson,  1959,  p.  97).  Erikson  might  have  been  thinking  of  couples  who 
endlessly  analyze  their  relationship  in  terms  of  how  much  each  person  is  get¬ 
ting  from  the  other.  The  individuals  seem  more  concerned  with  their  own 
needs  than  those  of  their  children. 

There  are  several  possible  reasons  for  an  inability  to  develop  at  this  stage. 
Sometimes  the  parent's  own  childhood  was  so  empty  or  frustrating  that  the 
parent  cannot  see  how  it  is  possible  to  do  more  for  his  or  her  children.  In  other 
cases,  the  difficulty  seems  more  cultural.  In  the  United  States  in  particular, 
our  values  emphasize  independent  achievement  to  such  an  extent  that  people 
can  become  too  exclusively  involved  in  themselves  and  their  successes  and 
neglect  the  responsibility  of  caring  for  others  (Erikson,  1959,  p.  97). 


302 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


8.  Old  Age 

The  psychological  literature  on  old  age,  which  is  still  sparse,  typically  views 
this  period  as  one  of  decline.  The  elderly,  it  is  repeatedly  pointed  out,  must 
cope  with  a  series  of  physical  and  social  losses.  They  lose  their  physical 
strength  and  health;  they  lose  their  jobs  and  much  of  their  income  through 
retirement;  and,  as  time  goes  by,  they  lose  their  spouses,  relatives,  and  friends. 
Equally  damaging,  they  suffer  the  inevitable  loss  of  status  that  accompanies 
being  old,  inactive,  and  "useless"  in  America  (see  Gitelson,  1975;  Havighurst, 
1952, 1968).  Some  psychologists  have  tried  to  paint  a  more  optimistic  picture. 
While  acknowledging  the  many  problems  and  losses,  these  psychologists  say 
that  old  age  can  be  satisfying  and  can  provide  new  experiences — "so  long  as 
one  actively  engages  the  environment"  (Cole  &  Cole,  1993,  p.  671;  see  also 
Newman  &  Newman,  2003,  pp.  445,  470-472). 

Erikson's  insights  went  in  a  very  different  direction.  He  wasn't  pri¬ 
marily  concerned  with  the  older  person's  activity,  usefulness,  or  involvement 
in  external  affairs.  Instead,  he  focused  on  the  inner  struggle  of  this  period — 
a  struggle  that  involves  painful  feelings  but  has  potential  for  inner  growth 
and  wisdom.  He  called  this  struggle  ego  integrity  versus  despair. 

As  older  people  face  death,  Erikson  implied,  they  engage  in  what  has 
been  called  a  life  review  (Butler,  1963).  They  look  back  on  their  lives  and  won¬ 
der  whether  they  were  worthwhile.  In  this  process,  they  confront  the  ultimate 
despair — the  feeling  that  life  was  not  what  it  should  have  been,  but  now  time 
has  run  out  and  there  is  no  chance  to  try  alternative  lifestyles.  Frequently,  dis¬ 
gust  hides  despair.  Many  older  people  are  disgusted  by  every  little  thing; 
they  have  no  patience  for  the  struggles  and  failings  of  others.  Such  disgust, 
Erikson  said,  really  signifies  their  contempt  for  themselves  (1959,  p.  98). 

As  the  older  person  faces  despair,  he  or  she  is  trying  to  find  a  sense  of 
ego  integrity.  Ego  integrity,  Erikson  said,  is  difficult  to  define  but  includes  the 
sense  that  there  is  an  order  to  one's  life  and  "the  acceptance  of  one's  one  and 
only  life  cycle  as  something  that  had  to  be  and  that,  by  necessity,  permitted  of 
no  substitutions"  (1963,  p.  268).  Integrity,  it  would  seem,  expresses  the  feeling 
that,  "Yes,  I  made  mistakes,  but  given  who  I  was  at  the  time  and  the  circum¬ 
stances,  the  mistakes  were  inevitable.  I  accept  them,  along  with  the  good 
things  in  my  life."  Integrity  is  a  feeling  that  also  extends  beyond  the  self  and 
even  transcends  national  and  ideological  boundaries.  The  older  person,  on 
some  level,  has  a  feeling  of  companionship  "with  the  ordering  ways  of  distant 
times  and  different  pursuits,  so  expressed  in  the  simple  products  and  sayings 
of  such  times  and  pursuits"  (p.  268). 

Erikson  (1976)  told  us  that  the  crisis  of  old  age  is  most  admirably  illus¬ 
trated  by  Ingmar  Bergman's  film  Wild  Strawberries.  The  film,  in  Erikson's  words, 

records  an  old  Swedish  doctor's  journey  by  car  from  his  place  of  retire¬ 
ment  to  the  city  of  Lund.  There,  in  the  ancient  cathedral.  Dr.  Isak  Borg 


303 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


is  to  receive  the  highest  honor  of  his  profession,  a  Jubilee  Doctorate  mark¬ 
ing  fifty  years  of  meritorious  service.  But  this  journey  by  car  on  marked 
roads  through  familiar  territory  also  becomes  a  symbolic  pilgrimage 
back  into  childhood  and  deep  into  his  unknown  self.  (p.  1) 

The  film  begins  with  Borg  writing  in  his  diary,  in  which  he  expresses  a 
self-satisfied  view  of  what  life  has  to  offer.  The  film  then  plunges  into  a  terri¬ 
fying  dream  symbolizing  his  fear  of  death.  Upon  awakening,  Borg  decides  to 
travel  to  Lund  by  car  instead  of  by  airplane  and  to  take  along  his  daughter- 
in-law,  Marianne,  who  is  in  the  midst  of  a  marital  crisis  with  which  Borg  has 
so  far  refused  to  help.  As  soon  as  they  are  in  the  car,  they  begin  to  quarrel, 
and  Marianne  tells  him  that  "even  though  everyone  depicts  you  as  a  great 
humanitarian  . . .  you  are  an  old  egotist.  Father"  (Bergman,  1957,  p.  32).  Along 
the  journey,  Borg  engages  in  other  encounters  with  Marianne  and  others,  and 
he  is  visited  by  vivid  dreams  and  memories  about  the  past.  These  dreams  and 
memories  are  extremely  humiliating  to  him.  He  comes  to  realize  that  through¬ 
out  his  life  he  has  been  an  isolated  onlooker,  moralistically  aloof,  and  in  many 
ways  incapable  of  love.  We  see,  then,  that  Borg's  initial  sense  of  integrity  was 
superficial;  as  he  imagines  death  and  reviews  his  life,  he  confronts  its  many 
failures. 

In  the  end,  however,  Borg's  insights  do  not  lead  to  a  final  despair  but  to 
a  new  acceptance  of  the  past.  While  he  is  receiving  his  Jubilee  Doctorate,  which 
by  now  has  become  a  rather  trivial  event,  he  begins  to  see  "a  remarkable  causal¬ 
ity"  in  the  events  of  his  life — an  insight  that  sounds  remarkably  similar  to 
Erikson's  statement  that  ego  integrity  includes  a  sense  of  the  inevitable  order 
of  the  past.  Equally  impressive,  though,  is  a  change  in  character.  At  the  end  of 
the  film,  Borg  expresses  his  love  for  Marianne  and  offers  to  help  her  and  his  son. 

Through  this  film,  we  see  why  Erikson  emphasized  the  importance  of 
both  the  positive  and  negative  poles  of  his  crises.  Borg's  initial  sense  of 
integrity  was  superficial  and  unconvincing.  He  acquired  a  more  meaningful 
sense  of  integrity  only  after  confronting  his  life  thoroughly  and  answering  to 
some  existential  despair  (Erikson,  1976,  p.  23). 

Erikson  and  Bergman,  then,  are  pointing  to  an  inner  struggle  that  we 
are  apt  to  miss  when  we  look  at  older  people.  We  are  aware  of  their  many 
physical  and  social  difficulties,  and  we  may  deplore  the  fact  that  older  people 
seem  so  "useless."  We  may  then  try  to  correct  our  perceptions  by  finding 
examples  of  older  people  who  are  more  "useful,"  energetic,  and  engaged  in 
external  affairs.  But  we  are  still  evaluating  the  elderly  on  the  basis  of  external 
behavior.  We  fail  to  consider  the  inner  struggle.  We  fail  to  see  that  the  quiet 
older  person  may  be  grappling  in  some  way  with  the  most  important  of  all 
questions:  Was  my  life,  as  I  face  death,  a  meaningful  one?  What  makes  a  life 
meaningful? 

This  inner  struggle  tends  to  make  the  older  person  something  of  a  philoso¬ 
pher,  and  out  of  the  struggle  grows  the  ego  strength  of  wisdom.  Wisdom  may  be 


304 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


expressed  in  many  ways,  but  it  always  reflects  a  thoughtful,  hopeful  effort  to 
find  the  value  and  meaning  of  life  in  the  face  of  death  (Erikson,  1976,  p.  23;  1982, 

pp.  61-62). 


THEORETICAL  ISSUES 

Why  Erikson’s  Theory  Is  a  Stage  Theory 

Piaget  and  Kohlberg  believed  that  cognitive  stages  should  meet  several  cri¬ 
teria.  Erikson's  stages  deal  more  with  emotional  development,  but  they  basi¬ 
cally  meet  the  same  criteria.  That  is,  the  stages  (1)  describe  qualitatively 
different  behaviors,  (2)  refer  to  general  issues,  (3)  unfold  in  an  invariant 
sequence,  and  (4)  are  culturally  universal.  Let  us  examine  these  points  in 
turn. 


1. The  Stages  Refer  to  Qualitatively  Different  Behavior  Patterns.  If 

development  were  just  a  matter  of  gradual  quantitative  change,  any  division 
into  stages  would  be  arbitrary.  Erikson's  stages,  however,  give  us  a  good 
sense  of  how  behavior  is  qualitatively  different  at  different  points.  Chil¬ 
dren  at  the  autonomy  stage  sound  very  different  from  those  at  the  trust 
stage;  they  are  much  more  independent.  Children  at  the  initiative  stage  are 
different  again.  Whereas  children  who  are  establishing  a  sense  of  auton¬ 
omy  defy  authority  and  keep  others  out,  children  with  a  sense  of  initiative 
are  more  daring  and  imaginative,  running  vigorously  about,  making  big 
plans,  and  initiating  new  activities.  Behavior  has  a  distinctive  flavor  at  each 
stage. 

2.  The  Stages  Describe  General  Issues.  As  I  have  emphasized,  stages 
refer  to  general  characteristics  or  issues.  Erikson  went  beyond  Freud's  rela¬ 
tively  specific  focus  on  body  zones  and  attempted  to  delineate  the  general 
issues  at  each  period.  At  the  oral  stage,  for  example,  he  showed  that  it  is  not 
just  the  stimulation  of  this  zone  that  is  important  but  the  general  mode  of  tak¬ 
ing  in  and,  more  generally  still,  the  development  of  a  sense  of  trust  in  one's 
providers.  Similarly,  at  each  stage  Erikson  tried  to  isolate  the  most  general 
issue  faced  by  the  individual  in  the  social  world. 

3.  The  Stages  Unfold  in  an  Invariant  Sequence.  All  stage  theories 
imply  an  invariant  sequence,  and  Erikson's  is  no  exception.  He  said  that  each 
stage  is  present  in  some  form  throughout  life,  but  each  reaches  its  own  crisis 
at  a  specific  time  and  in  a  specific  order. 

Erikson's  claim  is  based  on  the  assumption  that  his  sequence  is  partly  the 
product  of  biological  maturation.  As  he  put  it,  the  child  obeys  "inner  laws  of 


305 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


development,  namely  those  laws  which  in  his  prenatal  period  had  formed 
one  organ  after  another  and  which  now  create  a  succession  of  potentialities  for 
significant  interaction  with  those  around  him"  (Erikson,  1963,  p.  67).  At  the  sec¬ 
ond  stage,  for  example,  biological  maturation  ushers  in  a  sense  of  autonomy. 
Because  of  maturation,  children  can  stand  on  their  own  two  feet,  control  their 
sphincter  muscles,  walk,  use  words  such  as  me,  mine,  and  no,  and  so  on.  At  the 
third  stage,  maturation  prompts  a  new  sexual  interest,  along  with  capacities 
for  imaginative  play,  curiosity,  and  vigorous  locomotion. 

At  the  same  time,  societies  have  evolved  such  that  they  invite  and  meet 
this  inner,  maturational  succession  of  potentialities.  When,  for  example,  the 
child  at  the  autonomy  stage  demonstrates  a  new  degree  of  self-control,  social¬ 
izing  agents  consider  the  child  ready  for  training.  For  example,  they  begin 
toilet  training.  The  result  is  the  battle  of  wills,  between  child  and  society,  which 
creates  the  crisis  of  this  period.  Similarly,  when  children  become  recklessly 
ambitious  with  respect  to  sexual  matters,  societies  decide  it  is  now  time  to 
introduce  their  particular  sexual  prohibitions,  creating  the  core  conflict  at  the 
third  stage.  Thus  the  succession  of  crises  is  produced  by  inner  maturation  on 
the  one  hand  and  social  forces  on  the  other. 

4.  The  Stages  Are  Cultural  Universals.  Erikson  believed  his  stages 
can  be  applied  to  all  cultures.  You  might  see  how  the  stages  would  be  uni¬ 
versal  to  the  extent  they  are  maturationally  governed,  but  you  may  still  be 
skeptical,  for  you  know  how  widely  cultures  differ. 

Erikson,  too,  was  aware  of  the  vast  differences  among  cultures.  In  fact, 
he  wanted  to  show  readers  how  cultures  handle  the  stages  differently  accord¬ 
ing  to  their  different  value  systems.  For  example,  the  Lakota  provide  their 
children  with  a  long  and  indulgent  period  of  nursing;  one  of  their  goals  is 
to  get  children  to  trust  others  and  to  become  generous  themselves  (1963, 
pp.  134-140).  Our  society,  in  contrast,  discourages  dependency.  Compared  to 
other  cultures,  we  wean  our  infants  very  early.  We  do  not  seem  to  want  our 
children  to  learn  to  depend  on  or  trust  others  too  much,  but  to  become  inde¬ 
pendent.  Independence  and  free  mobility  seem  part  of  our  cultural  ethos, 
from  the  pioneer  days  to  the  present  time  (chap.  8). 

What  Erikson  did  claim  is  that  all  cultures  address  themselves  to  the 
same  issues.  All  cultures  try  to  provide  their  children  with  consistent  care,  reg¬ 
ulate  their  extreme  wish  to  do  everything  their  own  way,  and  instill  incest 
taboos.  And,  as  children  grow,  all  cultures  ask  them  to  learn  the  tools  and 
skills  of  their  technology,  to  find  a  workable  adult  identity,  to  establish  bonds 
of  intimacy,  to  care  for  the  next  generation,  and  to  face  death  with  integrity. 
All  cultures  attempt  to  achieve  these  tasks  because  culture  itself  is  a  part  of  the 
evolutionary  process;  in  the  course  of  evolution,  those  groups  that  failed  in 
these  tasks  had  less  chance  of  surviving.  Unless,  for  example,  cultures  could 
get  their  members  to  sacrifice  some  of  their  independence  for  the  needs  of 
others  (at  the  autonomy  stage),  to  begin  to  learn  the  skills  and  tools  of  the 


306 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


society  (at  the  industry  stage),  and  to  care  for  the  next  generation  (at  the  gen- 
erativity  stage),  they  probably  did  not  endure.1 

The  Question  of  Hierarchic  Integration.  Piagetians,  you  may  recall, 
define  their  stages  in  terms  of  a  fifth  point;  they  view  them  as  hierarchic  inte¬ 
grations.  This  concept  has  been  used  somewhat  differently  by  different  writ¬ 
ers,  but  in  a  stage  theory  it  basically  means  earlier  structures  are  reintegrated 
into  new,  dominant  structures.  In  Erikson's  theory,  such  a  process  does  occur 
at  certain  stages,  such  as  adolescence.  As  young  people  achieve  a  new  sense 
of  identity,  they  reorganize  a  good  deal  of  their  personality  in  the  pursuit  of 
dominant  goals  or  life  plans.  But  the  concept  of  hierarchic  integration  does 
not  apply  to  all  the  stages.  For  example,  the  issues  at  the  stage  of  autonomy 
versus  shame  and  doubt  are  not  reorganized  or  reintegrated  into  the  next 
stage,  initiative  versus  guilt.  The  new  stage  simply  raises  new  concerns,  leav¬ 
ing  the  earlier  stage  in  the  background,  in  much  the  same  form  as  before.  Thus 
the  concept  of  hierarchic  integration  does  not  seem  to  characterize  develop¬ 
ment  at  all  of  Erikson's  stages  (see  Kohlberg,  1969a,  p.  353). 


Must  We  Go  Through  All  the  Stages? 

We  sometimes  hear  that  if  we  don't  achieve  a  good  measure  of  success  at  one 
of  Erikson's  stages,  we  may  be  unable  to  go  on  to  the  next  stage.  This  is 
wrong.  In  Erikson's  theory,  we  must,  if  we  live  long  enough,  go  through  all 
the  stages.  The  reason  has  to  do  with  the  forces  that  move  us  from  stage  to 
stage:  biological  maturation  and  social  expectations.  These  forces  push  us 
along  according  to  a  certain  timetable,  whether  we  have  been  successful  at 
earlier  stages  or  not. 

Consider,  for  example,  a  boy  who  has  been  unable  to  attain  much  of  a 
sense  of  industry.  When  he  reaches  puberty,  he  must  grapple  with  the  issues 
of  identity  even  though  he  is  not  really  ready  to  do  so.  Because  of  biological 
changes,  he  finds  himself  troubled  by  an  upsurge  of  sexual  feelings  and  by  a 
rapidly  changing  body.  At  the  same  time,  social  pressures  force  him  to  cope 
with  problems  of  dating  and  to  start  thinking  about  his  future  occupation.  It 
matters  little  to  the  larger  society  that  he  is  still  unsure  about  his  own  skills. 
His  society  has  its  own  timetable,  and  by  the  time  he  is  20  or  so,  he  will  feel 
pressure  to  decide  on  a  career.  In  the  same  way,  he  will  find  himself  con¬ 
fronting  each  new  stage  in  the  sequence. 

Each  of  us,  then,  must  go  through  all  the  stages,  whether  we  have  tra¬ 
versed  the  earlier  stages  well  or  not.  What  is  true  is  that  success  at  earlier 
stages  affects  the  chances  of  success  at  later  ones.  Children  who  developed 
a  firm  sense  of  trust  in  their  caretakers  can  afford  to  leave  them  and 


'Darwin  had  a  similar  view,  as  discussed  in  Chapter  3. 


307 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


independently  explore  the  environment.  In  contrast,  children  who  lack  trust — 
who  are  afraid  to  let  caretakers  out  of  sight — are  less  able  to  develop  a  sense 
of  autonomy.  (Conceptualized  slightly  differently,  it  is  the  child  who  has 
developed  a  favorable  balance  of  trust  over  mistrust  who  ventures  into  the 
world  full  of  hope  and  anticipation,  energetically  testing  new  powers  of  inde¬ 
pendent  action.)  In  a  similar  way,  a  favorable  outcome  at  each  stage  affects 
the  chances  of  a  positive  outcome  at  the  subsequent  stage.  But  whatever  the 
outcomes,  maturational  and  social  forces  require  the  child  to  face  the  issues 
at  each  new  stage. 

Comparison  with  Piaget 

We  have  now  reviewed  the  two  most  influential  stage  theories  in  the  devel¬ 
opmental  literature:  Piaget's  cognitive-developmental  theory  and  Erikson's 
psychoanalytic  theory.  In  many  respects,  the  theories  are  different,  as  briefly 
noted  before.  Broadly  speaking,  the  most  basic  differences  are  these. 

Erikson's  theory  describes  a  variety  of  feelings  we  bring  to  tasks;  Piaget's 
theory  focuses  on  intellectual  development.  This  development,  for  Piaget,  is  not 
motivated  by  biological  maturation  and  social  forces,  but  by  the  child's  efforts 
to  solve  cognitive  problems.  As  children  encounter  problems  they  cannot 
handle  with  their  existing  cognitive  structures,  they  become  challenged  and  curi¬ 
ous  and  construct  more  elaborate  structures.  Since  the  driving  force  is  the  child's 
curiosity,  there  is  no  reason  why  the  child  must  go  through  all  the  stages;  if  a 
child  is  not  curious  about  an  area  (e.g.,  mathematics),  he  or  she  may  never  reach 
the  highest  stages  in  that  area.  Thus,  where  maturation  and  social  pressures  drive 
us  through  all  of  Erikson's  stages,  ready  or  not,  we  only  go  through  Piaget's 
stages  to  the  extent  we  are  intellectually  motivated  to  build  new  structures. 

Such  differences  seem  large.  Nevertheless,  both  Erikson  and  Piaget  gave 
us  stage  theories,  attempting  to  describe  the  most  general  qualitative  shifts 
in  behavior.  Moreover,  they  often  seemed  to  be  presenting  different  perspec¬ 
tives  on  the  same  basic  developments.  Let  us  look  at  how  this  is  so. 

1.  Trust.  As  Erikson  (1964,  pp.  116-117)  observed,  both  Piaget  and  he 
were  concerned  with  the  infant's  development  of  a  secure  image  of  external 
objects.  Erikson  discussed  the  child's  growing  reliance  on  the  predictability 
and  dependability  of  people,  whereas  Piaget  documented  the  developing 
sense  of  permanent  things.  Thus  both  were  concerned  with  the  child's  grow¬ 
ing  faith  in  the  stability  of  the  world.2 

2.  Autonomy.  As  children  develop  a  sense  of  trust  in  their  caretakers, 
they  become  increasingly  independent.  Secure  in  their  knowledge  that  others 
will  be  there  when  needed,  they  are  free  to  explore  the  world  on  their  own. 


2For  research  exploring  these  parallels,  see  Bell,  1970;  Flavell,  1977,  p.  54;  and  Gouin-Decarie, 

1965. 


308 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


Piaget  pointed  to  a  similar  process.  As  children  gain  the  conviction  that 
objects  are  permanent,  they  can  act  increasingly  independently  of  them.  For 
example,  when  his  daughter  Jacqueline's  ball  rolled  under  the  sofa,  she  was 
no  longer  bound  to  the  spot  where  she  last  saw  it.  She  now  knew  that  the 
object  was  permanent,  even  if  hidden,  and  could  therefore  try  out  alternative 
routes  for  finding  it. 

3.  Initiative.  At  this  stage,  between  about  3  and  6  years,  Erikson  and 
the  Freudians  emphasize  the  child's  consuming  curiosity,  wealth  of  fantasy, 
and  daring  imagination.  As  Erikson  said,  "Both  language  and  locomotion  per¬ 
mit  him  to  expand  his  imagination  over  so  many  things  that  he  cannot  avoid 
frightening  himself  with  what  he  has  dreamed  and  thought  up''  (1959,  p.  75). 

Piaget's  view  of  the  thinking  at  this  period  was  remarkably  similar.  As 
Flavell  says. 

The  preoperational  child  is  the  child  of  wonder;  his  cognition  appears  to  us 
naive,  impression-bound,  and  poorly  organized.  There  is  an  essential  law¬ 
lessness  about  his  world  without,  of  course,  this  fact  in  any  way  entering 
his  awareness  to  inhibit  the  zest  and  flights  of  fancy  with  which  he 
approaches  new  situations.  Anything  is  possible  because  nothing  is  subject 
to  lawful  constraints.  (1963,  p.  211) 

For  Piaget,  then,  the  fantasy  and  imagination  of  the  phallic-age  child  owes 
much  to  the  fact  that  the  child  is  in  the  preoperational  period — a  time  in  which 
thoughts  run  free  because  they  are  not  yet  tied  to  the  systematic  logic  the  child 
will  develop  at  the  next  stage. 

4.  Industry.  For  Erikson  and  the  Freudians,  the  fantasies  and  fears  of 
the  oedipal  child  are  temporarily  buried  during  the  latency  stage,  which  lasts 
from  about  age  6  to  11  years.  Frightening  wishes  and  fantasies  are  repressed, 
and  the  child's  interests  expand  outward;  the  child  intently  tries  to  master  the 
realistic  skills  and  tools  of  the  culture.  In  general,  this  is  a  relatively  calm 
period;  children  seem  more  self-composed. 

Piaget,  too,  would  lead  us  to  believe  the  6-  to  11-year-old  is  more  stable, 
realistic,  and  organized  than  the  younger  child.  For  Piaget,  this  change  is  not 
the  result  of  the  repression  of  emotions  and  dangerous  wishes;  rather,  it  comes 
about  because,  intellectually,  the  child  has  entered  the  stage  of  concrete  oper¬ 
ations.  The  child  can  now  separate  fact  from  fancy,  can  see  different  perspec¬ 
tives  on  a  problem,  and  can  work  logically  and  systematically  on  concrete 
tasks.  Intellectually,  then,  the  child  is  in  a  stage  of  equilibrium  with  the  world, 
and  this  contributes  to  his  or  her  overall  stability  and  composure.  Erikson 
himself  seemed  to  have  concrete  operations  in  mind  when  he  described  this 
period:  He  said  that  at  this  time  the  child's  "exuberant  imagination  is  tamed 
and  harnessed  by  the  laws  of  impersonal  things"  (1963,  p.  258). 


309 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


5.  Identity.  In  Erikson's  view,  the  calm  of  the  preceding  period  gives 
way  to  the  turbulence  and  uncertainty  of  adolescence.  Adolescents  are  con¬ 
fused  by  physical  changes  and  pressures  to  make  social  commitments.  They 
wonder  who  they  are  and  what  their  place  in  society  will  be. 

Piaget  had  little  to  say  about  physical  changes  in  adolescence,  but  his 
insights  into  cognitive  development  help  us  understand  why  this  can  be  an 
identity-searching  time.  During  the  stage  of  concrete  operations,  the  child's 
thought  was  pretty  much  tied  to  the  here  and  now.  But  with  the  growth  of 
formal  operations,  the  adolescent's  thought  soars  into  the  distant  future  and 
into  the  realm  of  the  purely  hypothetical.  Consequently,  adolescents  can  now 
entertain  limitless  possibilities  about  who  they  are  and  what  they  will  become. 
Formal  operational  capacities,  then,  may  contribute  to  the  self-questioning  of 
this  period  (see  Inhelder  &  Piaget,  1955,  chap.  18). 


PRACTICAL  IMPLICATIONS 
Clinical  Work:  A  Case  Illustration 

Clinical  psychologists  and  other  mental  health  workers  have  found  Erikson's 
concepts  very  useful.  We  can  get  a  sense  of  this  from  Erikson's  own  work  with 
one  of  his  cases,  a  4-year-old  boy  he  called  Peter. 

Peter  suffered  from  a  psychogenic  megacolon,  an  enlarged  colon  that 
resulted  from  Peter's  emotionally  based  habit  of  retaining  his  fecal  matter  for 
up  to  a  week  at  a  time.  Through  conversations  with  Peter  and  his  family, 
Erikson  learned  that  Peter  developed  this  symptom  shortly  after  his  nurse, 
an  Asian  girl,  had  been  dismissed.  Peter,  it  seems,  had  begun  "attacking  the 
nurse  in  a  rough-housing  way,  and  the  girl  had  seemed  to  accept  and  quietly 
enjoy  his  decidedly  'male'  approach"  (Erikson,  1963,  p.  56).  In  her  culture, 
such  behavior  was  considered  normal.  However,  Peter's  mother,  living  in  our 
culture,  felt  there  was  something  wrong  about  Peter's  sudden  maleness  and 
the  way  the  nurse  indulged  it.  So  she  got  rid  of  the  nurse.  By  way  of  expla¬ 
nation,  the  nurse  told  Peter  she  was  going  to  have  a  baby  of  her  own,  and  that 
she  preferred  to  care  for  babies,  not  big  boys  like  Peter.  Soon  afterward,  Peter 
developed  the  megacolon. 

Erikson  learned  that  Peter  imagined  that  he  himself  was  pregnant,  a  fan¬ 
tasy  through  which  he  tried  to  keep  the  nurse  by  identifying  with  her.  But, 
more  generally,  we  can  see  how  Peter's  behavior  regressed  in  terms  of  stages. 
Initially,  he  had  begun  displaying  the  attacking,  sexual  behavior  of  the  initia¬ 
tive  stage,  but  he  found  that  it  led  to  a  tragic  loss.  So  he  regressed  to  an  anal 
mode.  He  was  expressing,  through  his  body,  his  central  need:  to  hold  on.  When 
Erikson  found  the  right  moment,  he  interpreted  Peter's  wishes  to  him,  and 
Peter's  symptom  was  greatly  alleviated. 


310 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


Sometimes  students,  when  hearing  of  Peter's  behavior,  suggest  his  symp¬ 
tom  was  a  means  of  "getting  attention."  This  interpretation  is  used  frequently 
by  the  behaviorists.  We  note,  however,  that  Erikson's  approach  was  different. 
He  was  concerned  with  the  meaning  of  the  symptom  for  Peter,  with  what 
Peter  was  trying  to  express  through  it.  Through  his  body,  Peter  was  uncon¬ 
sciously  trying  to  say,  "I  need  to  hold  on  to  what  I've  lost."  Erikson  and  other 
psychoanalysts  believe  that  instead  of  changing  a  child's  behavior  through 
external  reinforcements  such  as  attention,  it  is  best  to  speak  to  the  child's  fears 
and  to  what  the  child  may  be  unconsciously  trying  to  say. 


Thoughts  on  Child  Rearing 

Over  the  years,  Erikson  applied  clinical  insights  to  many  problems,  including 
those  in  education,  ethics,  and  politics.  He  also  had  a  special  interest  in  child 
rearing. 

As  we  briefly  mentioned  in  our  discussion  of  trust,  Erikson  was  con¬ 
cerned  with  the  problem  facing  parents  in  our  changing  society.  Modern  par¬ 
ents  are  often  unable  or  unwilling  simply  to  follow  traditional  child-rearing 
precepts;  they  would  like  to  bring  up  their  children  in  more  personal,  toler¬ 
ant  ways,  based  on  new  information  and  education  (Erikson,  1959,  p.  99). 
Unfortunately,  modern  child-rearing  advice  is  often  contradictory  and  fright¬ 
ens  the  new  parent  with  its  accounts  of  how  things  can  go  wrong.  Conse¬ 
quently,  the  new  parent  is  anxious  and  uncertain.  This  is  a  serious  problem, 
Erikson  believed,  for,  as  we  have  seen,  it  is  important  that  the  parent  convey 
to  the  child  a  basic  security,  a  feeling  the  world  is  a  calm  and  secure  place. 

Erikson  suggested  that  parents  can  derive  some  inner  security  from  reli¬ 
gious  faith.  Beyond  this,  he  suggested  parents  heed  their  fundamental  "belief 
in  the  species"  (1963,  p.  267).  By  this,  Erikson  meant  something  similar  to 
Gesell.  Parents  should  recognize  that  it  is  not  all  up  to  them  to  form  the  child; 
children  largely  grow  according  to  an  inner,  maturational  timetable.  As 
Erikson  said,  "It  is  important  to  realize  that .  .  .  the  healthy  child,  if  halfway 
properly  guided,  merely  obeys  and  on  the  whole  can  be  trusted  to  obey  inner 
laws  of  development"  (p.  67).  So  it  is  all  right  for  parents  to  follow  their  incli¬ 
nation  to  smile  when  their  baby  smiles,  make  room  for  their  child  to  walk 
when  he  or  she  tries  to,  and  so  on.  They  can  feel  secure  that  it  is  all  right  to  fol¬ 
low  the  baby's  own  biological  ground  plan. 

Erikson  also  hoped  that  parents  can  recognize  the  basic  inequality 
between  child  and  adult.  The  human  child,  in  contrast  to  the  young  of  other 
species,  undergoes  a  much  longer  period  of  dependency  and  helplessness. 
Parents,  therefore,  must  be  careful  to  resist  the  temptation  to  take  out  their 
own  frustrations  on  the  weaker  child.  They  must  resist,  for  example,  the 
impulse  to  dominate  the  child  because  they  themselves  feel  helpless  with  oth¬ 
ers.  Parents  should  also  be  careful  to  avoid  trying  to  shape  the  child  into  the 


311 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


person  they  wanted  to  become,  thereby  ignoring  the  child's  own  capacities  and 
inclinations.  Erikson  said,  in  conclusion,  "If  we  will  only  learn  to  let  live,  the 
plan  for  growth  is  all  there"  (1959,  p.  100). 


EVALUATION 

Erikson  certainly  broadened  psychoanalytic  theory.  He  delineated  the  most 
general  issues  at  each  of  Freud's  stages  and  enlarged  the  stage  sequence  so  it 
now  covers  the  entire  life  cycle.  Erikson  also  gave  us  a  new  appreciation  of 
how  social  factors  enter  into  the  various  stages.  For  example,  he  showed  that 
adolescents  are  struggling  not  just  to  master  their  impulses  but  to  find  an 
identity  in  the  larger  social  world. 

Erikson,  finally,  gave  Freudian  theory  new  insights  into  the  possibilities 
for  healthy  development.  He  did  this  primarily  by  making  wider  use  of  the 
concept  of  maturation  than  Freud  did.  In  Freud's  view,  maturation  directs  the 
course  of  the  instinctual  drives,  which  must  undergo  a  good  measure  of  repres¬ 
sion.  For  Erikson,  maturation  also  promotes  the  growth  of  the  ego  modes  and 
the  general  ego  qualities  such  as  autonomy  and  initiative.3  Erikson,  to  be  sure, 
discussed  the  difficulties  in  attaining  these  qualities,  but  he  did  give  us  a  bet¬ 
ter  picture  of  how  ego  growth  is  possible.  By  suggesting  that  healthy  devel¬ 
opment  is  tied  to  a  maturational  ground  plan,  Erikson  moved  Freudian  theory 
in  the  developmental  direction  of  Rousseau,  Gesell,  and  others. 

Erikson's  theory  has  also  met  with  various  criticisms.  Robert  White 
(1960)  argued  that  Erikson  tried  too  hard  to  link  the  various  aspects  of  ego 
development  to  Freud's  libidinal  zones.  Erikson  said  that  for  each  zone,  there 
is  a  characteristic  ego  mode  of  interaction  with  the  world.  However,  White 
argued,  these  modes  fail  to  capture  many  of  the  child's  activities.  For  example, 
many  of  the  young  child's  efforts  to  achieve  autonomy — such  as  the  child's 
loud  "no's"  and  vigorous  walking — seem  unrelated  to  the  anal  modes  of  reten¬ 
tion  and  elimination.  White  himself  proposed  we  think  of  ego  growth  as  a 
general  tendency  toward  competence — a  tendency  that  includes  locomotion, 
exploration,  and  autonomous  action  without  any  necessary  connection  to 
Freud's  zones. 

In  a  different  vein,  we  might  fault  Erikson  for  a  degree  of  conceptual 
vagueness.  He  wrote  in  a  beautiful,  flowing  prose,  but  he  left  many  concep¬ 
tual  matters  unclear.  For  example,  he  provided  new  insights  for  the  potential 
for  growth  in  old  age,  when  people  examine  their  lives  and  search  for  wisdom, 
but  he  did  not  clearly  indicate  how  this  is  part  of  the  maturational  process.  It 
may  be  that  there  is  a  biological  tendency  to  review  one's  life  (Butler,  1963), 


3Erikson's  suggestion  that  ego  growth  has  maturational  roots  follows  the  lead  of  Hartmann. 


312 


Erikson  and  the  Eight  Stages  of  Life 


but  Erikson  was  not  explicit  on  this  matter.  Similarly,  he  failed  to  spell  out 
how  maturation  contributes  to  the  other  stages  of  adulthood. 

Erikson  was  aware  of  his  general  vagueness.  As  he  once  said,  "I  came  to 
psychology  from  art,  which  may  explain,  if  not  justify,  the  fact  that  the  reader 
will  find  me  painting  contexts  and  backgrounds  where  he  would  rather  have 
me  point  to  facts  and  concepts"  (1963,  p.  17). 

Erikson's  conceptual  vagueness  may  partly  explain  why  empirical 
research  on  his  theory  has  been  slow  to  emerge,  although  there  have  been 
some  solid  efforts.  Most  notably,  James  Marcia  (1966)  has  constructed  measures 
of  different  identity  states,  and  these  measures  are  related  to  other  variables. 
For  example,  young  people  with  foreclosed  identities — who  have  simply 
accepted  handed-down  occupational  goals  and  values  without  themselves 
struggling  with  alternatives — seem  to  be  most  often  found  at  the  level  of  con¬ 
ventional  thought  on  Kohlberg's  scale.  In  contrast,  those  who  have  achieved 
a  sense  of  identity  after  a  personal  struggle  are  more  often  represented  by 
postconventional  moral  thinking  (Podd,  1972;  Kroger  2007,  p.  105).  Those  who 
have  found  their  identity  after  a  personal  exploration  also  feel  more  inde¬ 
pendent  and  in  control  of  their  lives  (Berk,  2009,  p.  467). 

Researchers  also  have  been  examining  the  family  contexts  that  best  allow 
young  people  to  find  their  own  identities  (Kroger,  2007,  p.  77).  All  such 
research  is  encouraging.  Erikson's  work  is  so  rich  and  profound  that  it 
deserves  energetic  scientific  investigation. 


313 


This  page  intentionally  left  blank 


Mahler’s  Separation/ 
Individuation  Theory 


From  Theories  of  Development:  Concepts  and  Applications,  Sixth  Edition.  William 
Crain.  Copyright  ©  2011  by  Pearson  Education,  Inc.  Published  by  Pearson 
Prentice  Hall.  All  rights  reserved. 


315 


Mahler’s  Separation/ 
Individuation  Theory 


BIOGRAPHICAL  INTRODUCTION 

Erikson  developed  a  grand,  sweeping  theory  that  gave  Freudian 
thought  a  much  more  social  and  cultural  emphasis.  Such  broad  theo¬ 
ries  are  impressive,  but  it's  also  possible  to  advance  theory  by  focusing 
on  a  more  limited  set  of  details.  A  striking  example  of  this  is  Mahler's 
long  and  careful  study  of  mother/ infant  interactions.  She  showed  how 
babies  become  separate  people  within  a  relationship,  and  in  the  process 
Mahler  cast  light  on  universal  dimensions  of  human  life. 

Margaret  S.  Mahler  (1897-1985)  was  born  in  the  small  town  of 
Sopron,  Hungary,  a  short  distance  from  Vienna,  Austria.  In  her  memoirs, 
she  described  her  mother,  a  homemaker,  as  a  beautiful,  narcissistic,  and 
unhappy  woman  who  didn't  want  Mahler  as  a  baby.  As  a  result,  Mahler 
was  grateful  for  the  interest  her  father,  a  physician,  took  in  her.  "I  became 
very  much  my  father's  daughter,"  Mahler  said.  "It  was  to  my  father's 
world,  the  world  of  the  intellect,  of  science,  of  medicine,  that  I  turned" 
(1988,  pp.  4,  7). 

When  Mahler  was  4  years  old,  her  mother  gave  birth  to  another 
girl,  to  whom  her  mother  devoted  more  affection.  Mahler  was  com¬ 
pletely  fascinated  by  this  tender  care  and  spent  hours  silently  observ¬ 
ing  the  mother  /baby  interactions,  hr  fact,  Mahler  said,  "I  do  not  think 
it  an  exaggeration  to  say  that  my  own  mother  and  sister  represented  the 
first  mother-child  pair  that  I  investigated"  (p.  5). 

Mahler  described  herself  as  a  very  insecure  teenager  and  young 
woman.  But  she  also  showed  early  academic  promise,  and  at  the  age 
of  16  became  only  the  second  girl  from  her  town  to  seek  higher  edu¬ 
cation,  which  was  considered  the  province  of  males.  She  went  to  a 
school  in  Budapest,  where  she  became  best  friends  with  a  girl  whose 
family  was  part  of  a  group  of  pioneering  psychoanalysts.  They 
treated  Mahler  as  if  she  were  part  of  the  family,  and  after  some  inde¬ 
cision,  Mahler  decided  to  pursue  a  career  in  medicine  followed  by 


316 


Mahler’s  Sepnmtion/Individuntion  Theory 


psychoanalysis.  (Her  friend,  Alice  Balint,  also  became  a  distinguished 
psychoanalyst.) 

Mahler  received  her  medical  degree  from  the  University  of  Jena  in  1922. 
During  the  next  several  years,  she  practiced  pediatrics  and  child  psychiatry 
and  completed  psychoanalytic  training.  In  1936  she  married  Paul  Mahler, 
and  in  1938  the  couple  came  to  the  United  States  to  escape  the  Nazis.  They 
settled  in  New  York  City,  where  Mahler's  work  on  emotional  disorders  of 
childhood  resulted  in  several  appointments,  including  a  professorship  at  the 
Albert  Einstein  College  of  Medicine.  She  also  spent  years  commuting  to 
Philadelphia  to  teach  at  its  Psychoanalytic  Institute. 

On  a  personal  level,  Mahler  retained  a  considerable  amount  of  insecurity 
throughout  her  life,  and  she  sometimes  acted  in  demanding  or  mistrustful 
ways.  But  many  sensitive  and  creative  people  were  committed  to  working  with 
her  because  they  found  her  insights  so  valuable. 


OVERVIEW  OF  CONCEPTS  AND  METHODS 

During  the  1940s  and  1950s,  two  striking  advances  were  made  in  the  concep¬ 
tualization  of  childhood  psychoses — the  most  severe  emotional  disorders.  The 
first  advance  was  made  by  Leo  Kanner  (1943),  who  suggested  that  many 
strange  symptoms  fit  into  a  syndrome  he  called  early  infantile  autism.  This  is  a 
disorder  in  which  children  are  extremely  isolated  and  aloof.  They  often  avoid 
eye  contact  or  seem  to  look  right  through  you.  Children  with  autism  also  dis¬ 
play  other  symptoms,  including  problems  with  language.  Many  are  mute,  and 
those  who  do  talk  often  engage  in  echolalia,  the  meaningless  repetition  of 
sounds.  If  you  ask  the  child,  "What's  your  name?"  the  child  answers,  "What's 
your  name?"  (Lovaas,  1973).  If  health  workers  are  alert  to  the  disorder,  they  can 
often  diagnosis  it  very  early — before  the  second  year  of  life. 

A  second  diagnostic  advance  was  made  by  Mahler.  Beginning  with  a 
footnote  in  a  1949  paper,  Mahler  conceptualized  a  disorder  that  usually 
appears  in  the  third  or  fourth  year  of  life  or  a  bit  later.  In  these  cases,  the  chil¬ 
dren  have  formed  a  relationship  with  caretakers  but  are  afraid  to  separate 
themselves  out  of  it.  They  cling  to  their  mother,  afraid  to  move  out  into  the 
world.  Using  the  biological  term  symbiosis  as  a  metaphor,  Mahler  called  this 
disorder  symbiotic  psychosis  (see  Mahler,  1968,  pp.  72-75). 

In  Mahler's  view,  these  disturbances  aren't  simply  bizarre  occurrences 
but  rather  as  deviations  from  normal  development.  As  we  can  see  in  Table  1, 
Mahler  suggested  that  normal  development  begins  with  a  normal  autistic 
phase;  the  baby  is  inwardly  focused  and  wards  off  many  stimuli.  Next,  the 
baby  progresses  to  a  normal  symbiotic  phase;  the  baby  now  attends  more  fully 
to  outer  sensations,  but  with  the  illusion  of  being  at  one  with  the  mother.  Then, 
with  the  support  of  the  mother,  the  baby  becomes  increasingly  independent, 
especially  as  she  becomes  a  toddler. 


317 


Mahler’s  Sepamtion/Individmtion  Theory 


Table  1  Mahler’s  Phases 

AGE  PHASE  HIGHLIGHTS 


Birth  to  1  month 

Normal  Autism 

1  to  5  months 

Normal  Symbiosis 

5  to  9  months 

Differentiation 

9  to  1 2  months 

Early  Practicing 

12  to  15  months 

Practicing 

1 5  to  24  months 

Rapprochement 

24  to  30  months 

Beginnings  of 
Object  Constancy 

Baby  focuses  on  inner  physiological 
state 

Baby  responds  more  to  outer  stimuli 
but  is  under  the  illusion  that  she  and 
mother  are  one 

On  mother's  lap,  pulls  back  to  study 
her  and  world— has  "hatched"  look 
Uses  mother  as  base  to  explore 
Explores  world  with  bold  exhilaration 
Realizes  she  needs  mother  after  all — 
but  still  seeks  independence 

Creates  an  internal  image  of  mother 
and  can  function  apart  from  her 


In  the  case  of  autism,  Mahler  suggested,  the  child  doesn't  get  very  far  out 
of  the  normal  autistic  phase.  In  the  case  of  symbiotic  psychosis,  the  child  does 
go  through  the  symbiotic  phase;  however,  she  doesn't  derive  bedrock  feel¬ 
ings  of  comfort  and  support  from  the  relationship.  As  she  becomes  more  inde¬ 
pendent,  she  experiences  some  separations  as  so  upsetting  that  she  desperately 
tries  to  regain  the  illusion  of  symbiotic  union  with  the  mother.  Mahler  sug¬ 
gested  that  the  symbiotic  psychosis,  appearing  later  than  autism,  is  more 
varied,  and  symbiotic  psychotic  children  sometimes  regress  to  an  autistic  state 
(1968,  pp.  14-22,  71-81). 

A  special  aspect  of  Mahler's  work  was  her  continuous  effort  to  formu¬ 
late  and  revise  her  ideas  on  the  basis  of  research  on  ongoing  mother  /infant 
relationships.  She  developed  many  of  her  thoughts  on  symbiotic  psychosis 
as  a  result  of  her  work  with  Manuel  Furer  in  a  therapeutic  nursery  for  mothers 
and  disturbed  children.  Mahler's  concept  of  normal  development,  which  is  our 
focus  in  this  chapter,  also  drew  heavily  on  observations  of  mothers  and  their 
infants  in  a  nursery  setting.  Between  1959  and  1968,  Mahler  and  her  staff 
observed  and  interacted  with  38  normal  mother /infant  pairs  in  an  indoor 
play  area.  The  space  included  an  area  for  the  mothers  to  sit,  read,  sip  coffee, 
and  talk  to  one  another — and  from  which  they  had  a  full  view  and  free  access 
to  their  children  at  play.  The  babies  typically  entered  the  project  when  they 
were  between  2  and  5  months  of  age  and  left  when  they  were  3  years  old.  The 
observations  (which  included  films,  family  interviews,  and  home  visits)  were 
analyzed  somewhat  informally — largely  through  staff  discussions — rather 
than  statistically.  The  observations  also  focused  primarily  on  the  phases 
during  which  the  child  normally  moves  out  of  symbiosis  and  achieves  inde¬ 
pendence,  rather  than  symbiosis  itself.  Mahler's  thinking  about  the  earlier 
phases,  normal  autism  and  symbiosis,  drew  more  heavily  on  her  work  with 


318 


Mahler's  Sepnmtion/Individuntion  Theory 


disturbed  children  and  adults  and  the  observations  of  other  investigators 
(Bergman,  1999,  p.  6;  Mahler,  Pine,  &  Bergman,  1975,  pp.  39,  233-271). 

The  observations  of  the  normal  babies  and  mothers  were  extremely 
rich  and  were  summarized  in  her  1975  book.  The  Psychological  Birth  of  the 
Human  Infant  (coauthored  by  Fred  Pine  and  Anni  Bergman).  The  book  tells 
the  story  of  how  the  baby  naturally  emerges  out  of  symbiosis  and  becomes 
a  separate  individual.  Let  us  now  look  at  Mahler's  full  sequence  of  phases 
in  more  detail. 


PHASES  OF  NORMAL  DEVELOPMENT 

Mahler  suggested  that  the  phases  of  normal  development  overlap,  and  in 
some  ways  the  emotional  qualities  of  each  persist  throughout  the  life  cycle.  But 
the  developmental  achievement  of  each  phase  normally  occurs  at  a  certain 
time  in  infancy  and  early  childhood  (Mahler  et  al.,  1975,  pp.  3,  48). 


The  Normal  Autistic  Phase 
(birth  to  1  month) 

Mahler  said  the  newborn  (the  baby  up  to  the  age  of  1  month)  "spends  most 
of  his  day  in  a  half-sleeping,  half-waking  state";  he  wakes  primarily  when 
hunger  or  other  tensions  arouse  him  from  within  (p.  41).  During  this  time, 
the  newborn  infant  is  achieving  a  new  physiological  balance,  and  it's  the 
baby's  inner  physiological  state — not  the  outside  world — that  holds  the  most 
interest  for  him.  In  fact,  the  newborn  seems  protected  from  the  outside  by 
what  Freud  called  a  stimulus  barrier,  a  kind  of  shell  that  keeps  out  extremes  in 
stimuli.  Mahler  recognized  there  are  also  brief  periods  when  the  newborn  is 
quietly  alert  to  his  surroundings.  But  for  the  most  part,  the  newborn  acts  as  if 
his  inner  sensations,  not  outer  sensations,  matter. 

In  recent  years,  a  number  of  researchers,  using  advanced  film  tech¬ 
nology,  have  suggested  that  infants  are  more  responsive  to  their  mothers 
than  is  apparent  to  the  naked  eye.  According  to  Mahler's  coworker  Anni 
Bergman  (1999),  Mahler  was  aware  of  these  findings  and  privately  expressed 
doubts  about  the  autistic  phase.  But  it  still  may  mark  something  important 
in  development. 


The  Normal  Symbiotic  Phase  (1  to  5  months) 

At  about  1  month  of  age,  the  baby  starts  taking  more  pleasure  in  stimuli  from 
the  mother — from  certain  touches,  smells,  tones  of  voice,  and  ways  of  being 
held.  But  the  baby  doesn't  know  these  sensations  are  separate  from  him.  He 
still  lives  in  a  twilight  state  in  which  he  is  still  under  the  illusion  that  he  and 


319 


Mahler’s  Sepamtion/Individmtion  Theory 


the  mother  are  one.  Mahler  said  that  this  undifferentiated  state,  which  we  can 
only  infer,  is  what  she  meant  by  "symbiosis"  (1975,  pp.  8,  44). 

The  first  clear  sign  that  the  baby  now  takes  pleasure  in  outer  sensations — 
which  are  mainly  experiences  of  the  mother — is  the  baby's  social  smile.  Some¬ 
time  during  the  second  month,  the  baby  starts  staring  at  the  mother's  face,  and, 
after  doing  so  over  a  period  of  several  days,  the  baby  looks  into  her  eyes  and 
bursts  into  the  first  social  smile.  The  mother's  face  isn't  the  only  one  that  elic¬ 
its  a  gaze  or  smile,  but  she  is  likely  to  be  the  one  who  gazes  and  smiles  back. 
She  also  talks  to  the  baby  in  the  baby's  high-pitched  voice  and  imitates  the 
baby's  coos.  The  deep  mutual  gaze  seems  to  be  the  kind  that  is  shared  by  peo¬ 
ple  in  love.  It  is  the  kind  that  melts  down  boundaries.  The  mutual  gazing, 
together  with  the  mutual  smiles  and  the  mother's  imitations  of  the  baby's 
sounds,  all  reinforce  the  baby's  illusion  of  oneness  (L.  Kaplan,  1978,  p.  Ill; 
Mahler  et  al.,  1975,  p.  45). 

According  to  Mahler,  the  baby's  symbiotic  state  is  marked  by  a  sense  of 
omnipotence,  a  sense  that  the  world  is  in  perfect  harmony  with  his  wishes.  The 
mother  fosters  this  illusion  through  her  empathic  sensitivity  to  the  baby's 
cues.  She  senses  that  the  baby  is  hungry  and  makes  the  nipple  available;  she 
senses  his  need  to  rest  and  allows  his  body  to  mold  into  hers.  As  he  melts  into 
her  body,  he  apparently  has  a  feeling  that  the  world  is  in  complete  harmony 
with  his  needs. 

Anni  Bergman  adds  that  although  we  can't  know  what  the  baby  actu¬ 
ally  experiences,  mothers  often  report  that  they  feel  a  sense  of  union  with 
their  babies.  They  say  that  they  "lose  their  usual  way  of  being  in  the  world. 
They  have  eloquently  articulated  something  like  a  symbiotic  state  in  them¬ 
selves  that  parallels  the  state  that  has  been  postulated  in  the  baby"  (Bergman, 
1999,  p.  8). 

Mahler  recognized  that  mothers  cannot  be  perfectly  empathic;  no 
mother  can  read  her  baby's  every  need.  To  an  extent,  babies  themselves  learn 
to  help  her;  they  learn  that  certain  cues,  such  as  the  mother's  silences,  mean 
that  they  must  let  her  know  what  they  need.  But  there  are  times  when  all 
babies  must  simply  suffer  cold,  bad  tastes,  tension,  hunger,  loud  noises,  dust, 
bright  lights,  and  so  on.  Inevitably,  then,  babies  not  only  mold  comfortably 
into  their  mothers'  bodies,  but  sometimes  stiffen  as  they  react  to  noxious 
stimuli.  And  stiffening  has  its  uses.  It's  an  early  way  of  moving  apart  from 
the  mother — differentiating  from  her  (T.  Kaplan,  1978,  pp.  100-104;  Mahler 
et  al.,  1975,  p.  53). 

On  balance,  though,  the  baby  needs  a  responsive,  comforting  mother. 
Mahler  said  that  the  baby  doesn't  need  a  perfect  mother,  but,  borrowing 
phrases  from  D.  W.  Winnicott,  the  baby  needs  a  "good  enough"  mother  or  an 
"ordinarily  devoted"  mother.  Mahler  thought  good  mothering  is  a  biologically 
rooted  necessity.  The  human  infant,  in  comparison  to  other  species,  is  more 
helpless  and  dependent  for  a  much  longer  time  and  needs  a  mother  to  ward 
off  intrusive  stimuli  and  protect  the  baby's  well-being  (1975,  pp.  7,  45, 49). 


320 


Mahler's  Sepnmtion/Individuntion  Theory 


Nurturant  mothering  is  also  necessary  for  the  baby's  psychological 
development.  Mahler  said  that  the  symbiotic  phase  is  important  for  the  initial 
development  of  what  Erikson  called  a  sense  of  trust.  The  baby  needs  to  feel 
enough  consistent  comfort  and  relief  of  tensions  to  develop  faith  in  the  world 
as  a  good  place.  Moreover,  the  sense  of  pleasurable  symbiosis — of  unity  with 
the  mother — provides  the  growing  baby  with  a  sense  of  what  Mahler  called 
a  "safe  anchor."  As  the  baby  emerges  from  the  symbiotic  state  and  turns 
increasingly  outward,  she  doesn't  feel  adrift  and  alone.  The  baby  feels  there 
is  a  safe  anchor  of  goodness  and  comfort  (1975,  pp.  45,  59, 110). 

The  Separation/Individuation  Process 

The  Differentiation  Subphase  (5  to  9  months).  The  symbiotic  state 
sounds  like  it  can  be  a  period  of  blissful  unity.  Why,  then,  would  a  child  want 
to  leave  it?  Mahler  believed  the  baby  is  maturationally  driven  to  develop  inde¬ 
pendent  functioning  and  explore  the  wider  world.  Powerful  inner  forces 
prompt  the  baby  to  scan  the  surroundings,  to  try  to  roll  over,  to  sit  up  by  one¬ 
self,  to  reach  out  to  grab  things,  and  so  on. 

By  5  months,  the  baby  has  already  been  looking  at  the  surroundings 
outside  the  mother  and  knows  the  mother  is  different  from  others.  The  baby 
now  smiles  at  the  mother  and  familiar  people,  but  not  others.  But  this 
awareness  has  developed  gradually  and  almost  passively.  At  5  months,  the 
baby's  investigations  become  more  focused,  prolonged,  and  active.  Now, 
even  while  nursing,  babies  spend  considerable  time  looking  at  things 
besides  the  mother.  When  they  finish  nursing,  they  turn  away  to  look  at 
objects  in  the  environment.  At  about  6  months  of  age,  they  pull  their  bod¬ 
ies  away  from  the  mother  to  get  a  better  look  at  her.  (This  pulling  back  is 
in  sharp  contrast  to  the  earlier  molding.)  As  babies  look  at  the  mother,  they 
touch  her  face  and  body  and  grab  things  she  is  wearing,  such  as  glasses  or 
a  pin,  to  inspect  them.  They  also  start  a  "checking  back"  pattern,  actively 
comparing  the  mother  to  other  people;  first  they  look  at  the  mother,  then  at 
the  other  person,  then  back  at  the  mother  again.  All  in  all,  the  baby  is  no 
longer  merged  with  the  mother.  The  baby  is  more  of  an  independent  per¬ 
son  who  is  actively  studying  her  mother  and  the  outside  world.  Mahler 
said  the  baby  has  hatched  (pp.  53-56). 

During  this  period,  babies  also  inspect  strangers  tactilely  and  visually. 
They  usually  do  so  in  a  very  sober  mood,  which  is  different  from  the  hap¬ 
pier  way  in  which  they  examine  their  mothers.  Mahler,  borrowing  a  term 
from  Sylvia  Brody,  called  this  behavior  "customs  inspection"  (p.  56).  At  some 
point,  usually  at  about  7  months  of  age,  many  babies,  but  not  all,  exhibit 
stranger  anxiety.  In  some  babies,  stranger  anxiety  is  very  acute  and  they  cry. 
Mahler  found  this  was  most  common  in  children  whose  symbiotic  period 
had  been  most  strained.  These  babies  hadn't  developed  the  beginnings  of 
basic  trust  and  didn't  anticipate  goodness  in  interpersonal  relationships. 


321 


Mahler’s  Sepamtion/Individmtion  Theory 


The  children  who  had  enjoyed  harmonious  symbiotic  phases  typically  showed 
little  fear  of  strangers,  looking  at  them  with  wonderment  and  curiosity 
(pp.  57-58). 

Babies  at  this  time  also  show  separation  anxiety.  They  become  upset,  for 
example,  when  the  mother  leaves  them  alone.  Mahler  found  that  separation 
anxiety  at  this  time  primarily  takes  the  form  of  low-keyedness — a  general 
lowering  of  mood.  The  speculation  is  that  the  baby  turns  inward  in  an  effort 
to  hold  on  to  the  image  of  the  absent  mother  (Bergman,  1999,  p.  13). 

During  this  phase,  then,  the  baby  is  moving  out  and  away  from  the 
mother,  finding  interesting  things  in  the  world  and  experiencing  fears  as  well. 
Mahler  said  that  technically,  two  processes  are  underway.  One  is  separation, 
which  is  mainly  increased  physical  distance  from  the  mother.  The  other  is 
individuation,  which  includes  the  ego  functions  involved  in  exploring  the 
world  perceptually,  remembering  where  the  mother  and  things  are,  and  devel¬ 
oping  an  image  of  one's  powers  (Mahler  et  al.,  1975,  pp.  63-64). 

Early  Practicing  (9  to  12  months).  The  practicing  phase  is  ushered  in 
by  the  baby's  ability  to  crawl.  As  the  baby  moves  about  on  all  fours,  and  then 
stands  and  coasts  along  while  holding  things,  she  becomes  quite  enthusiastic 
about  exploring  the  wider  world.  She  often  moves  some  distance  away  from 
the  mother,  using  her  mother  as  a  home  base.  As  Ainsworth  observed,  the  baby 
explores  new  things  in  her  environment,  often  becoming  very  absorbed  in 
them,  then  checks  to  make  sure  the  mother  is  present  (or  even  returning  to  her 
for  "refueling")  before  venturing  forth  again. 

During  these  explorations,  the  mother's  attitude  is  very  important.  Many 
mothers — including  those  who  had  difficulty  with  the  constant  closeness  and 
intimacy  of  the  earlier  months — enjoy  the  baby's  new  independence.  They 
sense  that  what  the  baby  needs  as  the  baby  explores  the  world  is  just  the 
mother's  stable  presence — her  quiet  availability.  Other  mothers  become  anx¬ 
ious  or  ambivalent  about  the  child's  explorations  and  have  trouble  serving  as 
a  secure  home  base.  They  might  try  to  interrupt  the  child's  activities  or  com¬ 
municate  their  anxiety  to  the  child.  In  such  cases,  the  child's  enthusiasm  for 
moving  out  into  the  world  is  dampened. 

The  Practicing  Subphase  Proper  (12  to  15  months).  Mahler  empha¬ 
sized  the  power  of  the  innate  drive  toward  locomotion  and  exploration,  and 
babies'  pleasure  in  these  activities  becomes  intense  once  they  can  walk.  The 
baby,  who  is  now  a  real  toddler,  becomes  exhilarated  by  her  new  ability  to 
move  about  and  explore  the  world  and  takes  pure  delight  in  the  discoveries 
she  makes.  Everything  she  comes  across,  animate  or  inanimate,  is  a  source  of 
wonder.  The  toddler  acts  as  if  the  entire  world  was  made  for  her  investigations — 
that  when  it  comes  to  exploration,  "the  world  is  my  oyster''  (Mahler  et  al., 
1975,  p.  71).  Knocks  and  falls  don't  bother  her  in  the  least,  and  she  often  seems 


322 


Mahler's  Sepnmtion/Individuntion  Theory 


impervious  to  the  mother's  presence  as  well.  The  child  does,  to  be  sure,  occa¬ 
sionally  look  back  to  check  on  the  mother's  presence,  to  make  sure  the  mother 
is  still  available.  But  the  striking  feature  of  this  phase  is  the  way  the  child 
becomes  so  thrilled  and  absorbed  in  her  explorations.  This  is  a  period  when 
the  child  "has  a  love  affair  with  the  world"  (p.  74). 

Mahler  said  this  is  a  precious  time  when  the  child's  exuberance  can  over¬ 
come  emotional  fragility.  Only  in  cases  when  the  mother  is  too  intrusive  or 
unavailable  is  enthusiasm  greatly  diminished.  Ordinarily,  the  child's  pleasure 
in  vigorous  locomotion  and  exploration  is  immense. 

Rapprochement  (15  to  24  months).  Mahler  and  her  colleagues 
observed  that  at  15  or  16  months,  the  toddlers  in  the  nursery  underwent  a 
major  shift.  Whereas  they  had  been  joyfully  walking,  running,  jumping,  and 
playing  without  much  regard  to  the  mother,  they  now  became  very  aware  of 
her.  They  began  bringing  her  objects  they  had  found  in  their  explorations — 
a  piece  of  cookie,  a  toy,  a  bit  of  cellophane,  a  rock,  a  tricycle.  They  also  began 
monitoring  her  whereabouts  and  were  no  longer  so  impervious  to  knocks  and 
falls.  Now  they  felt  the  pain  and  wanted  the  mother  to  come  over  and  ease  the 
pain.  In  short,  they  became  keenly  aware  of  the  mother  and  their  need  for  her 
(Bergman,  1999,  pp.  18-20).  It's  as  if  the  toddler,  who  during  the  practicing 
phase  adventured  into  the  world  with  a  sense  of  omnipotence,  suddenly 
thinks,  "Hey,  where's  my  mother?  What  am  I  doing  out  here  all  by  myself; 
I  need  her." 

Mahler  believed  the  change  is  brought  about  by  the  kind  of  cognitive 
development  described  by  Piaget.  During  all  their  explorations  of  the  outer 
world,  as  well  as  their  quiet  play,  the  toddlers  have  been  becoming  increas¬ 
ingly  aware  of  how  objects  exist  and  function  apart  from  themselves.  It's  just 
a  matter  of  time  before  they  think  about  their  mother  as  a  separate  person 
and  all  she  does  for  them.  Thus  it  dawns  on  the  toddlers  that  the  world  is  not 
their  oyster,  that  they  are  in  fact  "relatively  helpless,  small  and  separate  indi- 
vidualjs]"  (Mahler  et  al.,  1975,  p.  78).  In  Erikson's  stage  theory,  the  child  begins 
to  experience  doubt. 

During  the  next  several  months,  the  child  enters  something  of  a  crisis. 
She  is  torn  between  conflicting  aims.  She  wants  to  maintain  and  exert  her 
autonomy,  but  she  also  wants  her  mother.  At  one  moment  she  emphatically 
says,  "No,"  to  every  parental  demand  or  request,  asserting  her  refusal  to  sub¬ 
mit  to  any  authority.  At  the  next  moment,  she  clings  to  the  mother  or  follows 
her  about,  demanding  the  mother's  constant  attention.  She  woos  her  mother 
with  gifts  and  objects  such  as  books,  knowing  the  mother  believes  in  reading 
to  her.  Many  children  enjoy  a  darting-away  game  in  which  the  parent  chases 
and  catches  them.  The  game  seems  fun  because  the  child  feels  suddenly 
autonomous,  running  away,  but  also  is  reunited  in  the  catching. 

Sometimes  the  child  is  overcome  by  indecision.  For  example,  in  the 
nursery,  children  would  sometimes  stand  on  the  threshold  of  a  new  playroom, 


323 


Mahler’s  Sepamtion/Individmtion  Theory 


uncertain  whether  or  not  to  enter  it.  Standing  on  the  threshold  seemed  to 
symbolize  their  conflict — whether  to  venture  into  a  new  room  and  leave  the 
mother,  or  to  stay  with  her  (p.  96). 

This  is  a  difficult  time  for  the  mother.  The  child's  behavior  is  often  dis¬ 
turbing  and  demanding,  and  the  child  herself  doesn't  always  seem  to  know 
what  she  wants.  Mahler  again  stressed  the  importance  of  the  mother's  quiet 
patience  and  emotional  availability  (p.  79).  If  the  mother  can  understand  that 
the  child's  behavior  is  a  natural  development  that  will  run  its  course — the 
to-be-expected  "terrible  twos" — the  mother  can  be  patient.  She  can  avoid 
getting  caught  up  in  power  struggles  or  withdrawing  in  retaliation.  Then  the 
child  will  feel  freer  to  work  out  things  for  herself,  knowing  that  her  own  will 
is  respected. 

Beginnings  of  Emotional  Object  Constancy  (24  to  30  months).  The 

child  in  the  rapprochement  crisis  seems  to  be  in  quite  a  predicament,  and 
we  might  wonder,  "Just  how  will  the  child  get  over  it?  How  can  the  child 
resolve  the  conflicting  needs  for  autonomy  and  the  mother's  care?"  In  good 
part,  the  child  does  so  by  developing  a  positive  internal  image  of  the  mother 
that  the  child  can  evoke  in  her  absence.  Then,  even  though  the  child  may 
feel  some  longing  for  her,  he  can  go  on  functioning  independently  without 
her.  This  internal  image  is  called  emotional  object  constancy  (Mahler  et  al., 
1975,  p.  109). 

Mahler  said  the  attainment  of  object  constancy  has  two  prerequisites. 
First,  the  child  must  have  developed  object  permanence  in  Piaget's  sense.  That 
is,  the  child  must  know  that  objects  (including  people)  exist  even  when  they 
are  out  of  sight. 

The  second  prerequisite  is  what  Erikson  called  basic  trust — the  sense  of 
the  mother  as  a  reliable  and  predictable  person  who  will  be  there  for  the  child 
(1975)  when  needed.  The  baby  began  developing  this  trust  as  early  as  the 
symbiotic  phase  and  developed  it  further  in  the  differentiation,  practicing, 
and  rapprochement  phases  (1975,  p.  110). 

Now,  in  the  present  phase,  the  child  needs  to  internalize  the  image  of  a 
good  mother.  The  internalization  process  is  complex,  but  the  child  carries  it 
out  largely  through  make-believe  play.  In  her  play,  the  child  lets  objects  rep¬ 
resent  parents,  other  people,  and  herself  and  consolidates  an  image  of  the 
mother  in  her  psychic  structure.  This  is  not  always  easy  to  do  because  the 
child  may  be  experiencing  some  strain  with  the  mother.  The  child  experiences 
separations  and  frustrations  (including  toilet  training  and  perhaps  early  oedi- 
pal  issues)  and  may  be  angry  at  the  mother.  It  then  becomes  difficult  for  the 
child  to  imagine  the  mother  as  a  whole  person  who  values  the  child  despite 
the  tensions  between  them.  But  if  positive  experiences  are  sufficient,  emo¬ 
tional  object  constancyemerges.  This  development  is  open  ended;  it  is  subject 
to  change  in  the  years  that  follow.  But  the  development  of  object  constancy  in 
this  phase  is  crucial. 


324 


Mahler’s  Separation/Individuation  Theory 


PRACTICAL  APPLICATIONS 

Although  our  focus  is  on  Mahler's  theory  of  normal  development,  I  would  like 
to  note  how  much  her  work  has  helped  mental  health  workers.  In  the  early 
1970s,  when  I  began  working  in  a  partial  hospitalization  program,  I  remem¬ 
ber  how  Mahler's  ideas  cast  light  on  puzzling  psychiatric  phenomena.  One 
man  told  me  that  when  his  mother  died,  he  became  confused  and  was  taken 
to  a  hospital  where  the  intake  worker  asked  him  "an  incomprehensible  ques¬ 
tion:  She  asked  me  to  tell  her  something  about  myself.  I  didn't  have  a  clue  as 
to  what  she  meant  by  'myself.'  I  could  tell  her  about  my  mother  and  me,  but 
I  had  never  thought  about  myself  as  a  separate  person."  This  man  was  describ¬ 
ing  a  symbiotic  attachment.  Numerous  stories  like  this  one  convinced  me  and 
many  others  that  significant  insights  into  the  mysterious  roots  of  psychosis  are 
to  be  found  in  Mahler's  work. 

Mahler's  work  is  most  directly  relevant  to  therapists  treating  disturbed 
children.  Prior  to  Mahler,  it  was  almost  taken  as  an  axiom  that  therapists 
should  try  to  treat  the  child  alone  in  a  playroom.  Mahler,  instead,  began  work¬ 
ing  with  infants  and  their  mothers,  trying  to  facilitate  a  more  harmonious  and 
pleasurable  symbiotic  experience.  For  autistic  children,  her  goal  was  to  move 
them  forward  into  a  symbiotic  phase.  For  symbiotic  psychotic  children,  too, 
she  wanted  to  foster  a  more  complete  and  harmonious  symbiosis.  To  many 
people,  this  seems  puzzling.  Shouldn't  the  goal  be  for  these  children  to  become 
independent?  But  Mahler  found  that  these  children  hadn't  experienced  the 
pleasurable  union  and  trust  that  enabled  them  to  move  away  from  the  mother. 
Instead,  with  the  maturation  of  motor  and  cognitive  functions,  they  found 
themselves  separating  before  they  felt  emotionally  ready.  They  felt  prema¬ 
turely  alone  and  vulnerable,  and  new  separation  experiences  (such  as  begin¬ 
ning  nursery  school  or  the  birth  of  a  sibling)  caused  them  to  fall  apart  and  to 
cling  desperately  to  their  mothers.  What  they  needed  was  not  new  encour¬ 
agement  to  separate,  but  to  build  a  sense  of  the  mother  as  a  secure  anchor  so 
they  could  more  confidently  move  out  into  the  world. 

When  it  comes  to  ordinary  child  rearing,  Mahler  repeatedly  spoke  about 
the  mother's  "emotional  availability."  The  normal  period  of  symbiosis  gives  the 
baby  a  feeling  of  being  anchored  in  a  place  of  comfort  and  safety,  but  as  the  baby 
becomes  a  separate  individual,  she  needs  to  be  reassured  of  her  mother's  con¬ 
tinued  availability.  The  most  dramatic  example  is  the  way  the  crawling  baby 
uses  her  mother  as  a  secure  base  from  which  to  explore.  The  child  ventures 
out  to  investigate  the  world,  checking  back  and  sometimes  actually  returning 
to  her  mother  before  venturing  forth  again.  The  mother's  calm,  stable  pres¬ 
ence  gives  the  child  the  courage  to  explore  the  world  on  her  own. 

There  are  numerous  other  ways  that  the  baby  uses  the  mother's  stable 
presence  to  learn  things  on  his  or  her  own.  If  a  mother  is  holding  a  6-month-old 
baby  boy,  the  mother's  quiet,  calm  presence  allows  him  to  examine  her  with 
his  eyes  and  hands.  He  gets  a  chance  to  learn  about  her  in  his  own  way. 


325 


Mahler’s  Sepamtion/Individmtion  Theory 


This  quality  of  the  caretaker,  this  unobtrusive  presence,  is  a  quality  we 
find  highlighted  by  other  theorists.  Ainsworth  emphasized  the  baby's  use  of 
the  mother  as  a  secure  base.  Montessori,  too,  spoke  on  several  occasions 
about  the  ways  the  adult's  patient  presence  gives  the  child  opportunities 
for  independent  learning.  Montessori  mentioned,  for  example,  how  this  can 
occur  when  a  parent  takes  a  child  for  a  walk.  If  a  father  is  walking  with  his 
2-year-old  daughter  in  a  park,  he  may  adjust  to  the  toddler's  own  rhythms, 
stopping  when  the  girl  stops  to  examine  things,  standing  patiently  by  while 
she  investigates  a  stick,  rock,  or  puddle  of  water.  As  he  stands  by,  he  may 
enjoy  the  delight  she  takes  in  examining  the  object.  The  father's  presence  is 
necessary  for  the  child's  security,  but  the  father  doesn't  have  to  teach  the 
child.  All  he  needs  to  do  is  be  quietly  present  and  available,  and  the  child  can 
learn  on  her  own. 


EVALUATION 

Many  contemporary  psychoanalysts,  including  feminist  psychoanalysts 
(e.g.,  Benjamin,  1988),  have  criticized  Freudians  for  focusing  too  exclusively 
on  the  internal  dynamics  of  the  isolated  individual.  Mahler  has  moved 
Freudian  theory  in  an  interpersonal  direction.1  She  has  given  us  a  vivid 
account  of  how  the  baby  achieves  a  sense  of  selfhood  within  an  interpersonal 
relationship.  The  baby  hatches  from  a  state  of  merger,  becomes  increasingly 
independent,  and  then  struggles  with  the  realization  of  how  dependent  she 
actually  is.  This  back-and-forth  process,  in  which  the  child  deals  with  needs 
for  both  relatedness  and  separateness,  seems  to  capture  universal  tensions 
and  conflicts  within  all  human  life. 

Mahler's  theory  also  has  met  with  some  strong  criticisms,  two  by  the 
highly  respected  psychoanalyst  and  infant  researcher  Daniel  Stern  (1985). 
First,  Stern  criticizes  Mahler  for  "pathologizing"  infancy.  That  is,  Mahler 
began  with  an  attempt  to  understand  pathological  states  (autism  and  sym¬ 
biosis)  and  looked  for  them  in  normal  infancy.  This  approach,  Stern  says, 
distorts  our  view  of  normal  development.  It  would  have  been  better  if  she 
had  studied  normal  infant  and  child  development  on  its  own  terms.  In  my 
view,  this  criticism  has  some  merit,  but  it  is  hardly  fatal.  The  ultimate  test  of 
her  theory  is  not  its  origins,  but  how  well  it  captures  the  essence  of  the  child's 
development. 

Stern  also  argues  that  Mahler's  early  phases,  especially  the  autistic 
phase,  are  in  error.  The  autistic  phase,  with  its  hypothesized  stimulus  barrier, 
makes  it  sound  as  if  the  newborn  primarily  shuts  herself  off  from  the  outer 


'In  psychoanalytic  terms,  Mahler  is  said  to  have  contributed  to  object  relations  theory;  see 
Greenberg  and  Mitchell  (1983). 


326 


Mahler's  Sepnmtion/Individuntion  Theory 


world.  In  fact.  Stern  points  out,  growing  laboratory  research  and  fine-grained 
film  analyses  of  mother/infant  interactions  show  that  the  newborn  has  a 
strong  interest  in  external  reality  and  an  ability  to  make  sense  out  of  it. 

This  criticism  is  a  serious  one.  It  apparently  stimulated  Mahler,  in  her 
last  years,  to  consider  modifying  her  concept  of  normal  autism  (Bergman, 
1999,  p.  5).  But  I  believe  any  major  change  is  still  premature.  For  one  thing, 
capacities  elicited  in  the  laboratory  don't  always  reflect  typical  behavior  in 
normal  life.  The  same  is  true  of  high-tech  film  analyses.  Moreover,  a  con¬ 
siderable  amount  of  research  tends  to  support  the  autistic  concept — the  view 
that  babies  are  more  focused  on  inward  stimuli  than  on  the  outer  world. 
Newborns  sleep  a  great  deal  and  defend  themselves  firmly  against  high- 
intensity  stimuli;  and  although  they  are  interested  in  the  world  for  brief 
periods  of  time,  they  respond  to  a  rather  limited  range  of  stimuli  (Fogel, 
2009,  pp.  212-213). 

It's  possible  to  raise  other  objections  to  Mahler's  work — or  point  to 
areas  where  we  need  more  information.  For  one  thing,  Mahler  often  wrote 
as  if  the  mother  is  the  only  person  in  the  infant's  life;  we  need  to  know  more 
about  the  baby's  interactions  with  fathers,  children,  and  others.  In  addi¬ 
tion,  Mahler  focused  more  on  separation  than  the  formation  of  new  capac¬ 
ities  for  love  and  mutuality,  so  more  information  is  needed  on  this  subject 
as  well. 

As  psychologists  extend  Mahler's  work  into  new  areas,  they  are  espe¬ 
cially  interested  in  how  Mahler's  concepts  might  cast  light  on  adolescence. 
Jane  Kroger  (2007,  p.  96)  refers  to  adolescence  as  "the  second  separation- 
individuation  process."  It's  a  time  when  young  people  often  feel  the  need 
to  break  away  from  parents  and  find  their  own  identities,  yet  they  are  still 
emotionally  tied  to  their  parents  and,  after  a  while,  they  may  develop  new 
and  more  mature  relationships  with  them.  It  will  be  interesting  to  see  how 
well  Mahler's  ideas  provide  a  framework  for  understanding  these 
processes. 

I  would  like  to  suggest  another  extension  of  Mahler — the  possibility 
that  children  develop  a  oneness  not  only  with  their  mothers  but  also  with 
the  natural  world.  As  I  mentioned  in  the  chapter  on  Montessori,  the  child's 
experience  of  nature  has  received  almost  no  attention  in  psychology.  But  in 
her  beautifully  written  book  on  Mahler  ( Oneness  and  Separateness,  1978), 
Louise  Kaplan  briefly  suggests  that  the  child's  attachment  to  nature  is  impor¬ 
tant.  When  the  toddler  enters  the  practicing  phase,  Kaplan  says,  the  child 
not  only  plants  his  feet  "solidly  on  the  earth,"  but,  running  through  open 
spaces,  "haughtily  ignores  his  mother  in  the  flesh,  .  .  .  having  discovered  a 
more  exciting  mother  in  the  world  of  visible  space  through  which  his  body 
glides."  He  "molds  his  body  to  its  invisible  contours,  imagining  yet  again 
that  he  is  one  with  the  universe"  (p.  169). 

The  few  studies  on  children  in  natural  settings  provide  evidence  that 
children  do  develop  feelings  of  oneness  with  nature.  In  a  rural  New  England 


327 


Mahler’s  Sepamtion/Individmtion  Theory 


town.  Hart  (1979)  observed  that  children  (between  3  and  12  years)  liked  to  sit 
or  kneel  beside  brooks  and  ponds,  staring  quietly  into  the  water  in  a  day¬ 
dreamlike  state,  seeming  to  feel  a  fluid  connection  between  themselves  and 
the  water — a  oneness  with  the  world.  In  Berkeley,  California,  where  the  com¬ 
munity  took  up  a  half  acre  of  asphalt  and  replaced  it  with  a  nature  area  of 
ponds,  wooded  areas,  and  meadows,  the  children  described  a  new  sense  of 
connection  and  belonging.  The  nature  area  made  them  "feel  at  home,"  like 
being  part  of  "one  big  happy  family."  "Being  alone  doesn't  bother  me  now" 
(Moore,  1989,  pp.  201-203). 

A  study  of  adults'  autobiographies  produced  similar  results.  Chawla 
(1990)  found  that  those  authors  who  said  they  benefited  from  childhood 
experiences  with  nature  most  commonly  referred  to  a  lasting  sense  of  root¬ 
edness  in  the  world.  The  African  American  minister  Howard  Thurman  said 
that  he  was  a  rather  lonely  boy  who  found  comfort  in  the  woods  and  the 
ocean.  Sometimes  when  he  walked  along  the  seashore  at  night  and  the  ocean 
was  still, 

I  had  the  sense  that  all  things,  the  sand,  the  sea,  the  stars,  the  night,  and 
I  were  one  lung  through  which  all  of  life  breathed.  Not  only  was  I  aware 
of  a  vast  rhythm  enveloping  all,  but  I  was  part  of  it  and  it  was  part  of  me. 
(Chawla,  1990,  p.  21) 

Such  early  feelings  with  nature,  Thurman  said, 

gave  me  a  certain  overriding  immunity  against  much  of  the  pain  with 
which  I  would  have  to  deal  in  the  years  ahead  when  the  ocean  was  only 
a  memory.  The  sense  held:  I  felt  rooted  in  life,  in  nature,  in  existence. 
(Chawla,  1990,  p.  21) 

This  sense  of  oneness  and  rootedness  is  also  expressed  in  William 
Wordsworth's  great  ode  (1807).  Lamenting  the  loss  of  the  exquisite  attune- 
ment  to  nature  we  had  as  children,  Wordsworth  said  that  we  can  nevertheless 
take  heart: 

Though  nothing  can  bring  back  the  hour 
Of  splendour  in  the  grass,  of  glory  in  the  flower; 

We  will  grieve  not,  rather  find 
Strength  in  what  remains  behind; 

In  the  primal  sympathy 
Which  having  been  must  ever  be. 

This  "primal  sympathy,"  this  feeling  of  "rootedness,"  is  what  Mahler  thought 
the  mother  provides  in  the  early  months  of  life  and  continues  to  reinforce, 
through  her  availability,  as  the  child  becomes  separate.  Thurman  and 


328 


Mahler's  Sepnmtion/Individuntion  Theory 


Wordsworth  are  suggesting  that  the  growing  child  also  can  find  a  sense  of 
belonging  in  nature.  Today,  of  course,  we  so  thoroughly  enclose  children  in  an 
artificial  world  of  computers,  TVs,  videos,  and  synthetic  materials  that  they 
may  never  develop  any  such  feelings  at  all.  This  is  a  problem  we  must  address, 
for  the  early  feelings  of  oneness  with  nature,  like  oneness  with  the  mother, 
may  fortify  the  growing  child  against  feeling  too  alone  in  the  world. 


329 


This  page  intentionally  left  blank 


A  Case  Study 
in  Psychoanalytic 
Treatment:  Bettelheim 

on  Autism 


From  Theories  of  Development:  Concepts  and  Applications,  Sixth  Edition.  William 
Crain.  Copyright  ©  2011  by  Pearson  Education,  Inc.  Published  by  Pearson 
Prentice  Hall.  All  rights  reserved. 


331 


A  Case  Study 
in  Psychoanalytic 
Treatment:  Bettelheim 

on  Autism 


BIOGRAPHICAL  INTRODUCTION 

In  this  chapter  I  will  give  a  description  of  psychoanalytic  treatment. 
Such  treatments  vary  of  course,  and  I  will  not  attempt  to  review  the 
variations  here.  I  have  selected  Bettelheim's  work  with  children  diag¬ 
nosed  with  autism  because  it  provides  an  unusually  rich  account  of 
child  therapy  that  is  within  the  Rousseauist  developmental  tradition. 

In  some  respects  Bettelheim's  work  is  more  classic  than  contem¬ 
porary.  Today,  the  most  popular  therapy  for  children  with  autism  is 
Lovaas's  adaptation  of  B.  F.  Skinner's  principles  (summarized  on  pages 
196-198  of  this  book).  Even  the  institution  that  Bettelheim  directed  until 
1973,  the  Orthogenic  School  in  Chicago,  has  since  added  a  mix  of  new 
techniques  to  his  core  principles.  But  I  believe  Bettelheim's  treatment 
exemplifies  a  philosophical  approach  that  will  always  guide  many 
thoughtful  therapists. 

Bruno  Bettelheim  (1903-1990)  grew  up  and  became  interested  in 
psychoanalysis  in  Vienna,  Austria.  In  1932  Bettelheim  and  his  wife  took 
into  their  home  and  began  caring  for  a  girl  who  later  would  have  been 
diagnosed  as  suffering  from  autism  (Kanner,  1943) — a  mysterious  con¬ 
dition  in  which  children  are  totally  unresponsive  to  people.  But  in  1938 
Hitler's  invasion  of  Austria  disrupted  this  home  treatment,  along  with 
everything  else  (Goleman,  1990).  From  1938  to  1939  Bettelheim  was  a 
prisoner  in  the  concentration  camps  of  Dachau  and  Buchenwald.  He 
wrote  detailed  accounts  of  this  experience  (e.g.,  1960)  and  drew  on  it 
in  all  of  his  work.  After  his  release,  Bettelheim  came  to  the  United  States 
and,  in  1944,  took  over  the  direction  of  the  Orthogenic  School  in 


332 


A  Case  Study  in  Psychoanalytic  Treatment 


Chicago  with  the  hope  that  if  it  was  possible  to  build  prison  camps  powerful 
enough  to  destroy  human  personalities,  perhaps  it  was  also  possible  to  create 
environments  that  can  foster  their  rebirth  (Bettelheim,  1967,  p.  8).  In  this  spe¬ 
cial  school  and  home  for  children,  Bettelheim  and  his  staff  treated  a  wide  vari¬ 
ety  of  emotional  disorders,  but  Bettelheim  always  had  a  special  interest  in 
children  with  autism  and  he  wrote  movingly  about  his  school's  treatment  of 
them  in  The  Empty  Fortress  (1967).  Bettelheim  retired  as  director  of  the  school 
in  1973,  but  he  continued  to  write  on  many  topics,  including  fairy  tales  (Bet¬ 
telheim,  1976)  and  reading  instruction  (Bettelheim  &  Zelan,  1981).  He  died  at 
the  age  of  86,  taking  his  own  life. 

Bettelheim  was  a  complex  man.  In  his  writings,  he  emphasized  the  need 
for  a  warm,  accepting  environment  in  which  even  the  most  disturbed  chil¬ 
dren  would  feel  free  to  develop  according  to  their  inner  promptings.  This  is 
the  philosophy  that  his  staff  at  the  Orthogenic  School  followed.  Yet  Bettel¬ 
heim  himself  was  an  autocratic  man  who  sometimes  insulted  his  students 
and  staff.  And  soon  after  he  died,  former  patients  from  the  school  wrote  that 
he  sometimes  lost  his  temper  and  hit  them  and  humiliated  them  (e.g.,  Jatich, 
1990).  Richard  Poliak  (1997)  published  a  best-selling  book  that  was  scathing 
in  its  criticism  of  Bettelheim.  Bettelheim  has  his  defenders  (e.g.,  Bernstein, 
1990),  but  there  was  definitely  a  contradiction  between  his  philosophy  and 
his  behavior. 

Still,  we  do  not  study  Bettelheim  because  of  his  personal  attributes.  We 
study  him  because  of  his  ideas  and  insights. 


THE  AUTISTIC  SYNDROME 

For  decades,  autism  was  considered  to  be  very  rare.  But  the  diagnosis  of 
autism  rose  dramatically  over  the  past  two  decades  (Parritz  &  Troy,  2011). 
It  isn't  clear  if  the  trend  is  due  to  greater  awareness  of  the  disorder  or  if  the 
rising  incidence  is  real.  In  any  case,  autism  is  the  earliest  of  the  severe  per¬ 
sonality  disturbances,  usually  showing  up  by  the  second  year  of  life.  Children 
with  autism  tend  to  be  physically  healthy,  but  they  are  isolated  and  aloof, 
rebuffing  human  interaction.  They  seem  to  look  through  people.  Often  they 
do  not  speak,  and  when  they  do  speak,  they  engage  in  echolalia,  simply  echo¬ 
ing  what  others  say.  They  also  show  a  variety  of  other  disturbances,  such  as 
highly  repetitive  behavior  (e.g.,  endlessly  spinning  objects  ).  In  a  minority  of 
cases,  they  engage  in  self-destructive  behavior,  such  as  hitting  their  heads, 
especially  when  they  are  physically  moved  (Koegel  &  Koegel,  2006,  p.  34; 
Lovaas,  1973, 2003,  pp.  3-7). 

The  cause  of  autism  is  still  unknown.  Because  the  onset  is  so  early,  most 
mental  health  workers  believe  it  is  a  product  of  some  inborn  defect,  perhaps  a 
brain  dysfunction.  Bettelheim  believed  it  is  the  outcome  of  early  interactions 
with  the  social  environment,  with  parents  or  caretakers.  Specifically,  he 


333 


A  Case  Study  in  Psychoanalytic  Treatment 


proposed  that  autistic  children  fail  to  develop  a  sense  of  autonomy,  a  sense 
they  can  have  an  effect  on  the  environment. 

In  normal  development,  Bettelheim  said,  babies  begin  developing  auton¬ 
omy  early  on.  When  they  nurse,  they  get  the  sense  that  it's  their  actions — 
their  search  for  the  nipple  and  their  vigorous  sucking — that  produces  the 
desired  result.  Or  when  they  cry  and  people  respond,  they  get  the  sense  that 
their  signals  make  a  difference.  But  in  the  case  of  autism,  the  babies  develop 
the  sense  that  their  actions  are  more  likely  to  result  in  indifference,  anxiety,  or 
retaliation.  As  a  result,  the  children  begin  to  give  up  autonomous  action.  But 
more  than  this,  Bettelheim  speculated,  the  children  sense,  rightly  or  wrongly, 
that  they  are  unwanted,  that  their  caretakers  would  rather  they  didn't  exist, 
and  that  any  action  might  be  the  last  straw  that  results  in  their  destruction. 
In  this  respect,  children  with  autism  may  feel  something  like  the  prisoners 
in  concentration  camps,  for  whom  any  action  risked  death.  Thus  the  children 
with  autism  give  up  assertiveness.  Through  a  monumental  act  of  will,  they 
decide  to  do  nothing  and  to  be  nothing,  or  to  limit  their  actions  to  the  small 
world  they  can  control  (for  example,  endlessly  spinning  a  saucer,  oblivious  to 
the  happenings  in  the  rest  of  the  room). 

Bettelheim  was  often  accused  of  blaming  autism  on  parents.  He  said  this 
was  not  his  intention.  Although  he  attributed  the  disorder  to  parent/ infant 
interactions,  he  believed  innate  temperamental  differences  between  parent 
and  child  also  might  play  a  large  role.  For  example,  a  fast,  hyperactive  boy 
might  be  out  of  tune  with  a  slower  mother,  and  the  boy  will  have  difficulty 
finding  appropriate  feedback  from  her  (Bettelheim,  1967,  p.  29). 


THERAPY 

For  a  long  time,  autism  was  considered  essentially  unbeatable.  Then  Bettelheim 
(1967)  and  a  few  others  (especially  Lovaas,  1969)  reported  some  success.  In  the 
Orthogenic  School,  the  beatment  for  all  children  is  on  a  residential  basis;  the 
children  live  in  the  school  full  time.  When  Bettelheim  was  its  director,  the  school 
generally  housed  45  to  50  children,  but  it  never  attempted  to  treat  more  than  6 
or  8  children  with  autism  at  a  time  (Bettelheim,  1967,  p.  90;  1974,  p.  5).  The  treat¬ 
ment  for  these  children  usually  lasted  at  least  5  years.  Bettelheim's  therapeutic 
principles  emerge  bom  his  detailed  descriptions  of  three  case  studies  (1967). 


Love  and  Care 

A  crucial  part  of  the  school's  environment,  in  Bettelheim's  day  and  today,  is  the 
provision  of  a  tremendous  amount  of  love,  care,  and  protection — a  nurturance 
that  probably  counteracts  any  feelings  by  the  children  with  autism  that  others 
wish  their  destruction.  The  school's  counselors  are  extremely  devoted  to  the 


334 


A  Case  Study  in  Psychoanalytic  Treatment 


children,  and  after  a  while  this  loving  care  seems  to  register  with  them.  For 
example,  Joey,  a  9-year-old  boy  who  had  given  up  on  people  and  had  made 
himself  into  a  machine,  seemed  to  like  being  bathed, 

though  for  a  long  time  this  too  was  a  mechanical  procedure.  In  the  tub 
he  rocked  hard,  back  and  forth,  with  the  regularity  of  an  engine  and 
without  emotion,  flooding  the  bathroom.  If  he  stopped  rocking,  he  did 
that  too,  like  a  machine.  .  .  .  Only  once,  after  months  of  being  carried 
to  bed  from  his  bath,  did  we  catch  a  slight  puzzled  pleasure  on  his  face 
and  he  said,  in  a  very  low  voice,  "They  even  carry  you  to  your  bed 
here."  This  was  the  first  time  we  heard  him  use  a  personal  pronoun. 
(Bettelheim,  1967,  p.  255) 


Autonomy 

Apart  from  this  care,  though,  there  is  a  sense  in  which  Bettelheim  believed 
the  staff  cannot  do  things  for  children  with  autism — for  the  most  important 
thing  that  the  children  must  develop  is  autonomy,  and  if  autonomy  is  to  be 
genuine,  the  children  must  gain  it  on  their  own.  All  the  staff  can  do  is  cre¬ 
ate  the  right  conditions  of  love  and  respect  for  the  children  and  then  hope 
the  children  will  begin  to  trust  them  sufficiently  to  take  the  first  steps  on 
their  own. 

The  way  in  which  love  and  care  set  the  stage  for  autonomous  action  is 
illustrated  by  an  incident  with  Laurie,  a  girl  who  came  to  the  school  at  the 
age  of  7  years.  Although  Laurie  was  pretty  and  well  dressed,  she  was  com¬ 
pletely  inert  and  withdrawn.  She  had  not  uttered  a  word  in  more  than  4  years. 
She  also  ate  and  drank  very  little  and  for  months  had  kept  her  mouth  slightly 
open,  which  parched  her  lips.  Laurie's  counselor  tried  to 

wet  her  lips  and  also  to  oil  them,  to  make  her  more  comfortable.  Her 
counselor  rubbed  her  lips  softly,  and  then  gently  put  a  finger  in  her  mouth 
and  on  her  tongue. ...  At  first  Laurie  barely  reacted,  but  later  she  seemed 
to  like  it,  and  for  an  instant  she  touched  the  finger  with  her  tongue,  may 
even  have  licked  it  for  a  moment.  (Bettelheim,  1967,  p.  100) 

Thus  the  counselor's  loving  care  seemed  to  inspire  Laurie  to  take  a  small,  but 
spontaneous,  initial  action  on  her  own. 

Usually  the  children's  first  efforts  at  self-assertion  occurred  around  the 
issue  of  elimination,  which  is  what  happened,  for  example,  in  the  case  of 
Marcia.  When  Marcia  came  to  the  school  at  the  age  of  1 0  ly  years,  she  was 
completely  unresponsive  to  people  or  objects,  and  she  spoke  only  in  single 
words  that  had  some  personal  meaning  to  her  alone.  A  central  problem  in  her 
life  was  her  constipation;  she  had  stopped  moving  her  bowels  on  her  own 
after  her  mother  had  begun  training  her  at  age  2.  Since  then,  her  parents  had 


335 


A  Case  Study  in  Psychoanalytic  Treatment 


given  her  repeated  enemas,  an  experience  which,  her  doll  play  later  revealed, 
represented  for  her  the  feeling  of  being  completely  overpowered  by  huge 
adults.  The  staff's  attitude  toward  her  constipation  illustrates  the  importance 
they  put  on  the  concept  of  autonomy.  Bettelheim  wrote. 

From  the  moment  Marcia  came  we  were  convinced  that  if  we  were  to 
force  her  to  do  anything,  to  give  anything  up,  we  could  never  help  her 
out  of  her  isolation.  Nothing  seemed  more  important  than  her  acquir¬ 
ing  the  feeling  that  she  was  at  least  in  charge  of  her  own  body.  So  from 
the  beginning  we  assured  her  that  we  would  not  force  her  to  move  her 
bowels,  that  at  the  school  she  would  never  be  given  enemas,  or  any  lax¬ 
atives,  and  that  in  regard  to  elimination  she  could  do  as  she  wished. 
(1967,  p.  70) 

She  did  not  have  to  defecate  in  the  toilet,  "but  could  do  it  wherever  and  when¬ 
ever  it  was  easiest  for  her"  (1967,  p.  172).  Soon  Marcia  began  to  soil,  and  the 
first  place  she  defecated  with  any  regularity  was  in  the  bathtub,  the  place 
where  she  seemed  to  feel  the  most  relaxed  and  comfortable.  After  defecating 
in  the  tub,  she  frequently  played  with  her  stools.  "After  about  a  year  and  again 
in  her  own  good  time — though  we  occasionally  made  tentative  suggestions — 
she  began  to  eliminate  in  the  toilet"  (1967,  p.  172). 

The  children's  progress  continued  when  they  made  initial  attempts  to 
relate  to  others.  After  a  year  at  the  school,  Marcia  invited  her  counselor  Inge 
to  play  a  chasing  game,  exclaiming,  "Chase!"  However,  Inge  always  had  to 
maintain  a  certain  distance,  and  Marcia  never  chased  Inge  in  turn.  Bettelheim 
speculated  that  through  this  game,  in  which  Marcia  was  never  caught,  she 
was  trying  to  master  her  feelings  of  being  overpowered  by  adults.  That  is, 
she  may  have  been  trying  to  establish  "through  thousands  of  repetitions  of  the 
game  that  never  again  would  anyone  get  hold  of  her  and  overpower  the  now 
barely  emerging  'me'"  (1967,  p.  179).  Thus  Bettelheim  interpreted  Marcia's 
initial  attempts  to  relate  to  others  in  terms  of  her  need  to  establish  autonomy. 
The  counselors  respected  her  wishes  and  always  played  the  game  on  her  own 
terms.  Their  attitude,  in  turn,  seemed  to  win  Marcia's  trust  to  the  point  where 
she  then  tried  new  ways  of  relating  to  them. 

The  three  cases  suggest,  finally,  that  progress  in  relating  gave  the  children 
the  courage  to  begin  a  new  phase:  Through  symbolic  play,  they  attempted  to 
reexperience  and  master  conflicts  at  the  earliest  developmental  stage,  the  oral 
stage.  For  Marcia,  it  took  some  time  before  she  could  engage  in  purely  oral 
play.  For  days,  she  repeatedly  forced  water  in  and  out  of  a  baby  doll's  mouth 
and  rectum  in  exactly  the  same  manner.  Apparently,  she  first  had  to  free  her¬ 
self  of  the  death  grip  that  enemas  had  on  her  total  experience  before  she  could 
work  on  feeding  as  a  separate  function  (1967,  p.  208).  Finally,  she  separated  the 
two  activities  by  performing  them  in  different  rooms.  When,  however,  her 
play  did  take  on  distinctively  oral  themes,  she  revealed  that  orality  was  fraught 


336 


A  Case  Study  in  Psychoanalytic  Treatment 


with  its  own  grave  dangers,  as  when,  for  example,  she  viciously  beat  a  toy 
dog  for  daring  to  drink  some  milk  (p.  224).  Marcia  seemed  to  believe  oral 
intake  was  bad  and  could  bring  about  the  severest  retaliation.  Gradually, 
though,  she  was  able  to  experiment  with  pleasurable  ways  of  drinking  in  doll 
play  and  even  to  enjoy  drinking  itself. 

The  course  of  therapy,  it  should  be  noted,  was  not  something  Bettelheim 
determined  beforehand.  The  children  took  the  lead  in  acting  and  exploring 
their  problems,  and  the  staff  supported  them  the  best  it  could.  This  was  often 
difficult.  Marcia's  water  play,  for  example,  flooded  the  floors  and  required 
enormous  work  mopping  up.  But  the  staff  members  usually  tolerated  such 
behavior,  for  the  children  were  trying  to  master  their  experience  (pp.  204, 217). 

Marcia  eventually  made  a  partial  recovery.  After  5  years  in  the  school, 
she  was  talking  to  others  and  seemed  capable  of  the  full  range  of  emotional 
expression.  Her  intellectual  abilities,  however,  lagged  behind;  she  was  only 
reading  at  the  fourth-grade  level.  Perhaps  she  had  entered  the  school  at  too 
late  an  age  (10  /2  years)  to  permit  a  full  recovery.  Still,  when  she  returned 
home,  after  7  years  in  the  school,  she  was  able  to  take  care  of  herself  and  per¬ 
form  useful  tasks.  More  importantly,  she  was  no  longer  the  frozen  child  she 
once  had  been. 


Attitude  toward  Symptoms 

One  of  the  most  radical  aspects  of  Bettelheim's  philosophy  was  his  attitude 
toward  symptoms.  For  most  mental  health  workers,  symptoms  (e.g.,  self¬ 
stimulation  and  peculiar  gestures)  are  to  be  directly  eliminated,  or,  at  best, 
tolerated.  Bettelheim,  however,  pointed  out  that  the  symptoms  are  what  the 
children  have  spontaneously  developed  to  gain  some  relief  from,  and  even 
some  mastery  over,  their  tensions.  They  represent  the  child's  greatest  spon¬ 
taneous  achievement  to  date.  Accordingly,  they  deserve  our  respect.  If, 
instead,  we  disparage  the  symptoms — if,  for  example,  we  encourage  the  child 
to  drop  them — we  cannot  convey  our  respect  for  the  child,  either  (Bettelheim, 
1967,  p.  169). 

The  staff's  attitude  toward  symptoms  is  illustrated  by  its  approach  to 
Marcia's  behavior  in  the  dining  room.  When  Marcia  first  came  to  the  school, 
she  ate  only  candy,  and  in  the  dining  room  she  plugged  her  ears  with  her  fore¬ 
fingers  and  her  nose  with  her  little  fingers,  apparently  to  protect  herself  from 
something  dangerous  in  the  situation.  This  habit  made  it  impossible  for  her 
to  eat  with  her  hands.  The  staff  thought  about  telling  her  it  was  OK  to  unplug 
her  ears  and  nose,  but  they  realized  this  communication  would  fall  woefully 
short;  for  if  it  were  OK  for  her  to  unplug  them  she  would  do  it  herself.  Simi¬ 
larly,  they  did  not  feel  that  an  offer  to  feed  her  themselves  would  convince 
her  they  understood  her  plight;  if  she  could  trust  anyone  to  feed  her,  she  would 
not  need  to  plug  herself  up. 


337 


A  Case  Study  in  Psychoanalytic  Treatment 


Our  solution  was  to  offer  to  plug  the  ears  for  her;  then  she  could  have 
some  fingers  free  to  eat  with.  Hearing  our  offer,  Marcia  promptly 
plugged  her  nose  with  her  forefingers  and  with  her  other  fingers  brought 
food  to  her  mouth  by  bending  as  close  to  the  plate  as  she  could — a  per¬ 
formance  that  astonished  both  the  other  children  and  all  adults  present. 
(1967,  pp.  169-170) 

Many  professionals  would  consider  the  staff's  approach  completely  wrong; 
what  they  did  was  reinforce  the  psychotic  behavior.  However,  they  were  try¬ 
ing  to  show  a  respect  for  the  child's  own  devices  for  handling  frightening 
feelings. 

Sometimes  the  autistic  symptoms  included  self-destructive  behavior; 
the  children  tried  to  hurt  and  damage  themselves.  In  these  cases,  the  staff  did 
step  in;  they  had  to  protect  the  children  (e.g.,  1967,  p.  268).  However,  other 
symptoms  were  respected  as  far  as  possible,  for  they  were  the  children's 
autonomous  constructions. 


Phenomenology 

Bettelheim's  work  has  a  phenomenological  orientation.  As  a  philosophy,  phe¬ 
nomenology  is  exceedingly  complex,  but  in  psychology  it  generally  means 
suspending  our  preconception  that  others  think  in  some  customary  way  and 
trying  to  enter  into  the  other's  unique  world  from  the  inside.  It  means  putting 
oneself  in  the  other's  shoes  (Ellenberger,  1958). 

The  school's  phenomenological  approach  is  illustrated  by  the  attitude 
toward  Marcia's  plugging  of  her  ears  and  nose.  Although  the  staff  members 
knew  it  was  OK  for  Marcia  to  unplug  herself,  they  guessed  this  was  not 
Marcia's  experience.  Thus  they  tried  to  see  the  world  in  terms  of  Marcia's 
unique  inner  experience  and  to  act  accordingly. 

Bettelheim  said  that  children  with  autism  will  never  leave  their  defen¬ 
sive  positions  as  long  as  adults  are  simply  interested  in  getting  them  to  see  the 
world  as  they  (adults)  see  it. 

This  is  exactly  what  the  psychotic  child  cannot  do.  Instead,  our 
task  ...  is  to  create  for  him  a  world  that  is  totally  different  from  the  one 
he  abandoned  in  despair,  and  moreover  a  world  he  can  enter  right  now, 
as  he  is.  This  means,  above  all,  that  he  must  feel  we  are  with  him  in  his 
private  world  and  not  that  he  is  once  more  repeating  the  experience 
that  "everyone  wants  me  to  come  out  of  my  world  and  enter  his." 
(1967,  p.  10) 

The  phenomenological  task  is  especially  difficult  in  the  case  of  children 
with  autism  for  two  reasons.  First,  because  we  have  become  fairly  well 
adjusted  to  the  external  world,  we  have  difficulty  understanding  the  horror 


338 


A  Case  Study  in  Psychoanalytic  Treatment 


with  which  the  autistic  child  regards  it.  Second,  these  children  in  many  ways 
have  never  transcended  the  experiential  modalities  of  the  infant — modalities 
that  are  largely  preverbal  and  foreign  to  us  as  adults. 


Summary 

In  Bettelheim's  view,  then,  therapy  should  include  (1)  a  great  deal  of  love  and 
care  for  the  children  with  autism,  which  (2)  enables  them  to  trust  others  to 
the  point  where  they  will  dare  to  take  steps  toward  autonomous  action. 
Bettelheim  also  believed  (3)  that  the  children  will  make  progress  only  if  they 
are  given  full  respect  as  human  beings,  including  respect  for  their  symptoms 
as  their  greatest  efforts  to  date  to  relieve  their  suffering.  Finally  (4),  they  will 
move  out  of  the  autistic  position  only  if  the  staff  somehow  communicates  to 
them  that  it  does  not  simply  want  them  to  enter  its  own  world,  but  that  it  is 
trying  to  understand  the  children's  own  unique  experience. 


EVALUATION 

Bettelheim  tried  to  evaluate  the  school's  success  with  40  of  the  children  with 
autism  that  the  school  treated  up  to  1967  (Bettelheim,  1967,  pp.  414-416).  He 
believed  the  school  had  good  success  with  four  fifths  of  these  children.  That 
is,  about  this  number  were  able  to  make  a  decent  adjustment  to  society,  includ¬ 
ing  meaningful  relationships  with  others.  Of  these,  about  half,  for  all  intents 
and  purposes,  were  cured;  although  they  sometimes  showed  some  personal¬ 
ity  quirks,  they  were  doing  well  in  their  studies  or  were  earning  a  living  on 
their  own.  It  is  difficult  to  evaluate  such  statistics,  however,  because  there  are 
no  reports  on  the  reliability  of  these  judgments.  We  do  not  know,  that  is,  if 
neutral  observers  would  have  agreed  with  Bettelheim's  assessments.  Never¬ 
theless,  Bettelheim's  case  reports  and  films  indicate  that  the  children  did  make 
substantial  progress,  so  we  can  have  some  confidence  in  his  impressions. 

Bettelheim's  success  is,  for  our  purposes,  important  because  his  school 
took  a  decidedly  developmental  approach.  Unlike  most  mental  health  insti¬ 
tutions,  the  school  did  not  actively  try  to  change  the  children's  behavior.  The 
staff  was,  in  a  sense,  more  passive.  It  assumed  that  if  it  established  the  right 
conditions  of  love  and  care,  the  children  would  begin  to  take  the  steps  toward 
health  on  their  own.  The  staff  allowed  the  children  to  take  the  lead.  Bettel¬ 
heim's  school,  working  in  the  developmental  tradition,  had  faith  that  even  in 
these  very  disturbed  children  there  were  inner  forces  toward  growth  and 
autonomy  that  would  emerge  in  the  right  environment. 

Rousseau,  Gesell,  and  other  developmentalists  distinguish  between 
autonomous  growth  and  socialization.  If  we  actively  try  to  change  children's 
behavior,  we  usually  become  socializers.  We  adopt  socially  appropriate 


339 


A  Case  Study  in  Psychoanalytic  Treatment 


behavior  as  our  goal  and  try  to  teach  children  accordingly.  The  behaviorist 
Lovaas  (1973, 1987),  for  example,  tries  to  reinforce  socially  appropriate  behav¬ 
ior,  such  as  language,  while  eliminating  socially  inappropriate  behavior,  such 
as  peculiar  psychotic  gestures.  Bettelheim,  in  contrast,  put  such  a  high  pre¬ 
mium  on  autonomous  development  that  he  frequently  tolerated  socially 
"deviant"  acts.  We  saw  how  he  respected  many  psychotic  symptoms,  for 
they  are  the  child's  autonomous  creations.  We  also  saw  how  the  staff  per¬ 
mitted  Marcia  to  move  her  bowels  in  the  bathtub  and  to  flood  the  floors.  It  did 
so  because  she  was  taking  steps  on  her  own  and  exploring  her  problems. 
Bettelheim  said  that  "too  often  children's  progress  is  viewed  not  in  terms  of 
a  move  toward  autonomy  but  of  the  convenience  of  a  society  that  cares  less 
about  autonomy  than  conformity,  and  of  parents  who  prefer  not  to  clean  their 
children's  underclothes,  no  matter  what"  (1967,  p.  294).  The  real  question, 
he  says,  is  "when,  and  for  what  gains,  we  ought  to  strip  away  social  adjust¬ 
ment  for  the  sake  of  personal  development"  (p.  293). 

I  have  implied  that  Bettelheim's  approach  differs  not  only  from  the 
behaviorists'  but  from  that  of  most  mental  health  workers.  At  the  same  time, 
a  number  of  child  psychoanalysts  would  substantially  agree  with  his 
approach.  Most  child  analysts,  of  course,  work  with  less  disturbed  children 
and  therefore  do  not  need  to  become  active  caretakers.  Nevertheless,  they 
often  share  Bettelheim's  developmentalist  orientation.  That  is,  they  do  not 
try  to  get  children  to  behave  in  the  "correct"  ways,  but  they  try  to  create  a 
climate  of  acceptance  and  understanding  that  will  enable  children  to  take 
the  initiative  in  exploring  their  problems. 


340 


Schachtel  on  Childhood 

Experiences 


BIOGRAPHICAL  INTRODUCTION 

Freud,  Erikson,  Mahler,  and  Bettelheim  share  the  developmentalist 
concern  for  how  growth  might  occur  from  inner  forces,  from  the  organ¬ 
ism  itself.  They  also  share  the  developmentalist  view  that  thought  and 
behavior  are  qualitatively  different  at  different  stages.  A  writer  who 
provided  special  insights  into  the  unique  qualities  of  early  experiences 
was  Ernest  Schachtel. 

Ernest  Schachtel  (1903-1975)  was  born  and  grew  up  in  Berlin.  His 
father  wanted  him  to  become  a  lawyer,  which  he  did,  even  though  he 
was  more  interested  in  philosophy,  sociology,  and  literature.  Schachtel 
practiced  law  for  8  years  until  1933,  when  the  Nazis  had  him  jailed  and 
then  sent  to  a  concentration  camp.  After  his  release  he  worked  on  fam¬ 
ily  research  in  England  and  Switzerland  and  then  in  1935  came  to 
New  York,  where  he  received  psychoanalytic  training.  Schachtel  worked 
as  a  psychoanalyst  the  rest  of  his  life,  with  a  special  interest  in  Rorschach 
(inkblot)  testing.  However,  Schachtel  was  always  something  of  a 
maverick  among  psychoanalysts,  a  man  with  his  own  ideas  on  devel¬ 
opment  (Wilner,  1975). 


BASIC  CONCEPTS 

Schachtel  was  most  specifically  interested  in  the  problem  of  infantile 
amnesia,  our  inability  to  remember  most  of  the  personal  events  of  our 
first  5  or  6  years  of  life.  We  can,  to  be  sure,  remember  words  and 
common  objects.  What's  missing  is  our  autobiographical  memory,  our 
memories  for  our  personal  experiences  (Schachtel,  1959,  p.  286).  This 
curious  memory  gap  was  first  noted  by  Freud,  who  pointed  out  that  as 


From  Theories  of  Development:  Concepts  and  Applications,  Sixth  Edition.  William 
Crain.  Copyright  ©  2011  by  Pearson  Education,  Inc.  Published  by  Pearson 
Prentice  Hall.  All  rights  reserved. 


341 


Schachtel  on  Childhood  Experiences 


infants  we  had  many  intense  experiences — loves,  fears,  angers,  jealousies — 
and  yet  our  recall  for  them  is  very  fragmentary.  Freud's  explanation  was  that 
this  amnesia  is  the  product  of  repression.  Early  sexual  and  aggressive  feel¬ 
ings  became  linked  to  shame,  disgust,  and  loathing,  and  therefore  were 
repressed  into  the  unconscious  (Freud,  1905,  pp.  581-583). 

Schachtel  believed  Freud  was  partly  right,  but  he  pointed  out  two  prob¬ 
lems  with  the  repression  hypothesis.  First,  childhood  amnesia  is  quite 
pervasive;  we  forget  not  only  the  sexual  and  hostile  feelings  that  we  might 
have  had  cause  to  repress,  but  almost  all  the  rest  of  our  personal  experiences 
as  well.  Second,  even  psychoanalytic  patients,  who  sometimes  can  get 
beneath  the  repression  barrier,  are  still  unable  to  remember  much  of  their  first 
few  years.  So  childhood  amnesia  must  have  an  additional  source  (Schachtel, 
1959,  p.  285). 

Schachtel  suggested  that  childhood  amnesia  primarily  has  to  do  with 
perceptual  modes  of  experience.  Most  adult  experience  and  memory  is  based  on 
verbal  categories.  We  look  at  a  painting  and  say  to  ourselves,  "That  is  a  picture 
by  Picasso,"  and  this  is  how  we  remember  what  we  have  seen  (see  Slobin,  1979, 
pp.  155-156).  Childhood  experience,  in  contrast,  is  largely  preverbal.  It  is,  as 
Rousseau  said,  more  directly  based  on  the  senses.  As  a  result,  it  cannot  be 
tagged,  labeled — and  later  recalled — through  verbal  codes,  and  it  is  therefore 
lost  to  us  as  we  grow  up. 

Schachtel  divided  childhood  experience  into  two  stages:  infancy  and 
early  childhood.  Let  us  look  at  the  modes  of  perception  during  these  two 
stages  and  compare  them  with  the  orientations  of  the  adult. 


Infancy  (birth  to  1  year) 

In  infancy  we  rely  on  certain  senses  in  particular.  One  vital  sense  is  taste. 
Babies,  who  take  many  things  into  their  mouths,  have  more  taste  buds  than 
adults  do  and  probably  can  make  rather  fine  discriminations  through  this 
modality  (Schachtel,  1959,  pp.  138,  300).  Babies  also  experience  objects  and 
people  by  their  smells.  Since  babies  are  often  held,  they  probably  have 
greater  exposure  to  others'  odors  than  adults  do,  and  they  frequently  rec¬ 
ognize  an  object  such  as  a  blanket  or  a  shirt  by  its  odor  (p.  138).  Infants, 
Schachtel  said,  know  what  the  mother  tastes  and  smells  like  long  before 
they  know  what  she  looks  like.  They  probably  can  tell  when  she  is  tense  or 
calm  through  these  senses  (p.  299).  Babies  are  also  very  sensitive  to  touch 
and  react,  for  example,  to  the  state  of  the  mother  as  revealed  by  her  relaxed 
or  tense  hold.  Babies,  finally,  react  sensitively  to  temperature  through  the 
thermal  sense  (p.  92). 

Schachtel  called  these  senses  autocentric — the  sensations  are  felt  in  the 
body.  When  we  taste  or  smell  food,  our  sensations  are  felt  in  the  mouth  or  in 
the  nostrils.  Similarly,  the  experiences  of  hot  and  cold,  and  of  being  held  and 
touched,  are  felt  in  or  on  the  body.  The  autocentric  senses  are  distinguished 


342 


Schachtel  on  Childhood  Experiences 


from  the  predominantly  allocentric  senses — hearing  and  especially  sight.  When 
we  use  these  sensory  modalities,  our  attention  is  directed  to  the  outside. 
When  we  look  at  a  tree,  we  usually  focus  outward,  on  the  object  itself  (1959, 
pp.  81-84,  96-115). 

The  autocentric  senses  are  intimately  bound  up  with  feelings  of  pleasure 
and  unpleasure,  of  comfort  and  discomfort.  Good  food,  for  example,  produces 
a  feeling  of  pleasure;  rancid  food  produces  disgust.  The  allocentric  senses,  in 
contrast,  are  usually  more  neutral.  We  experience  no  keen  pleasure  or  disgust, 
for  instance,  in  looking  at  a  tree.  The  baby's  predominantly  autocentric  expe¬ 
rience,  then,  is  tied  to  the  pleasure  principle,  as  Freud  said. 

Adult  memory  categories — which  are  predominantly  verbal — are  poorly 
suited  for  the  recall  of  autocentric  experience.  We  have  a  fair  number  of  words 
for  describing  what  we  see  but  very  few  for  describing  what  we  smell,  taste, 
or  feel.  "A  wine,"  for  example,  "is  said  to  be  dry,  sweet,  robust,  fine,  full,  and 
so  on,  but  none  of  these  words  enables  one  to  imagine  the  flavor  and  bouquet 
of  the  wine"  (1959,  pp.  298-299).  Poets  can  sometimes  create  vivid  images  of 
visual  scenes,  but  they  are  unable  to  do  so  with  respect  to  smells  and  tastes. 
The  world  of  the  infant,  then,  which  is  so  much  a  world  of  smells,  tastes,  and 
bodily  sensations,  is  not  subject  to  verbal  codes  and  recall. 

Schachtel  called  special  attention  to  the  sense  of  smell.  Western  cultures 
practically  outlaw  discriminations  based  on  this  sense.  If,  upon  being  intro¬ 
duced  to  a  man,  I  were  to  go  up  and  sniff  him,  I  would  be  considered 
extremely  uncouth  (although  it  is  perfectly  acceptable  to  inspect  him  visually 
at  a  distance).  In  English,  to  say  "He  smells"  is  synonymous  with  saying  "He 
smells  bad."  We  do,  of  course,  use  perfumes  and  are  aware  of  some  fra¬ 
grances,  but  on  the  whole  our  discriminations  based  on  this  sense  are  very 
limited. 

Schachtel  said  the  taboo  on  smell  is  probably  related  to  the  fact  that  odor 
is  the  primary  quality  of  fecal  matter.  Babies  seem  to  enjoy  the  smell  of  their 
feces,  but  socializing  agents  teach  them  otherwise.  The  result  is  that  children 
repress  specific  anal  experiences.  But  it  is  more  than  this.  Children  quit  mak¬ 
ing  fine  discriminations  based  on  this  sense  altogether.  Consequently,  their 
early  experiences  are  lost,  for  they  do  not  fit  into  the  accepted  categories  of 
experience  (Schachtel,  1959,  pp.  298-300). 


Early  Childhood  (1  to  5  years) 

During  infancy  we  do  not  generally  welcome  changes  in  internal  or  external 
stimulation.  Sudden  changes — such  as  sharp  hunger  pains,  shivering  cold,  or 
the  loss  of  bodily  support — can  be  quite  threatening.  The  infant  would  like  to 
remain  embedded  in  a  warm,  peaceful,  protective  environment,  much  like 
the  womb  (Schachtel,  1959,  pp.  26,  44-68). 

At  about  1  year  of  age,  however,  the  child's  basic  orientation  undergoes 
a  change.  Children  become  relatively  less  concerned  about  their  security;  under 


343 


Schachtel  on  Childhood  Experiences 


maturational  urging,  they  take  a  much  more  active  and  persistent  interest  in 
new  things.  To  some  extent  they  still  rely  on  the  autocentric  senses,  as  when 
they  put  objects  into  their  mouths.  But  they  now  increasingly  utilize  the  pure 
allocentric  senses — hearing  and  especially  sight.  They  examine  and  explore 
new  objects  by  looking  at  them. 

The  young  child's  attitude  is  one  of  openness  to  the  world.  The  child 
has  the  capacity  to  take  everything  in,  no  matter  how  small  or  insignificant 
to  us,  in  a  fresh,  naive,  and  spellbound  manner.  A  little  girl,  coming  across 
an  insect,  will  stop  and  examine  it  intently.  To  her,  the  insect  is  full  of  new 
and  fascinating  possibilities.  She  perceives  each  new  object  with  a  sense  of 
wonder  and  awe. 

This  openness  contrasts  markedly  with  the  predominant  attitude  of 
adults.  Most  adults  simply  label  objects — for  example,  "That  is  an  ant" — and 
then  go  on  to  something  else.  Adults  use  the  same  allocentric  senses — sight 
and  hearing — but  not  in  a  fully  allocentric  way,  not  with  an  openness  to  things 
themselves.  As  adults,  our  greatest  need  is  not  to  explore  the  world  in  all  its 
richness  but  to  reassure  ourselves  that  everything  is  familiar,  as  accustomed 
and  expected. 

It  is  not  easy  to  understand  why  adults  are  in  such  a  hurry  to  name, 
label,  and  classify  things,  but  the  answer  probably  has  to  do  with  the  process 
of  socialization.  As  children  grow  up,  they  find  that  grownups  and  peers 
have  standard,  conventional  ways  of  describing  the  world,  and  the  pressure 
is  great  to  adopt  them.  The  older  child  and  the  adult  become  afraid  of 
looking  at  things  in  any  way  that  might  be  different  from  others.  There  is 
always  the  threat  of  feeling  odd,  ignorant,  or  alone.  Just  as  infants  need  the 
security  of  caretakers,  adults  need  the  security  of  belonging  and  conform¬ 
ing  to  their  cultural  group.  Consequently,  they  come  to  see  what  others  see, 
to  feel  what  everyone  feels,  and  to  refer  to  all  experiences  with  the  same 
cliches  (Schachtel,  1959,  pp.  204-206, 176-177).  They  then  think  they  know 
all  the  answers,  but  they  really  only  know  their  way  around  the  conven¬ 
tional  pattern,  in  which  everything  is  familiar  and  nothing  a  cause  for 
wonder  (p.  292). 

What  the  adult  becomes  capable  of  remembering,  then,  is  that  which  fits 
into  conventional  categories.  For  example,  when  we  take  a  trip,  we  see  all  the 
sights  we  are  supposed  to  see,  so  we  can  be  sure  to  remember  exactly  what 
everybody  else  remembers,  too.  We  can  tell  our  friends  that  we  saw  the  Grand 
Canyon,  that  we  stopped  at  six  IHOP  restaurants,  and  that  the  desert  looked 
beautiful  at  sunset  (just  like  in  the  postcards).  We  cannot,  however,  give  any 
real  idea  of  what  the  country  was  like.  The  trip  has  become  a  mere  collection 
of  cliches  (p.  288). 

Similarly,  our  journey  through  life  is  remembered  in  terms  of  conven¬ 
tional  signposts.  A  man  can  tell  us  about  his  birthdays,  his  wedding  day,  his 
jobs,  the  number  of  children  he  had  and  their  positions  in  life,  and  the  recog¬ 
nitions  he  received.  But  he  will  be  unable  to  tell  us  about  the  truly  special 


344 


Schachtel  on  Childhood  Experiences 


qualities  of  his  wife,  of  his  job,  or  of  his  children,  for  to  do  so  would  mean 
opening  himself  to  experiences  that  transcend  the  conventional  categories  of 
perception  (p.  299). 

Among  adults,  Schachtel  said,  it  is  primarily  the  sensitive  poet  and 
artist  who  have  retained  the  young  child's  capacity  to  view  the  world 
freshly,  vividly,  and  openly.  Only  they  still  experience  things  with  the  young 
child's  sense  of  wonder  at  watching  an  insect  walk;  at  the  way  a  ball 
squeezes,  bounces,  and  responds  to  the  hand;  or  at  the  way  water  feels  and 
looks  as  it  is  poured.  For  most  of  us,  unfortunately,  "the  age  of  discovery, 
early  childhood,  is  buried  deep  under  the  age  of  routine  familiarity,  adult¬ 
hood"  (p.  294). 

In  summary,  then,  neither  the  autocentric  experiences  of  the  infant  nor 
the  allocentric  experiences  of  the  young  child  fit  into  the  adult's  way  of  cate¬ 
gorizing  and  remembering  events.  The  infant's  world  of  tastes,  smells,  and 
touch,  as  well  as  the  young  child's  fresh  and  open  experience  of  things  in  all 
their  fullness,  are  foreign  to  the  adult  and  not  subject  to  recall. 


IMPLICATIONS  FOR  EDUCATION 

Most  of  Schachtel's  thoughts  on  child  rearing  and  education  concerned  the 
child  as  he  or  she  begins  actively  to  explore  the  world.  Schachtel  wanted  us 
to  preserve  and  encourage  the  young  child's  bold  curiosity.  Unfortunately, 
we  usually  stifle  it. 

For  example,  when  babies  begin  to  handle  and  examine  everything  they 
see,  parents  often  become  overly  anxious.  Parents,  as  Montessori  observed,  are 
afraid  their  children  are  acting  too  rough,  that  they  might  break  things  or  hurt 
themselves.  Actually,  it  is  usually  simple  enough  to  childproof  a  house — to 
remove  all  breakable  and  dangerous  objects — and  then  permit  the  child  to 
explore.  Nevertheless,  parents  often  become  anxious  at  this  point,  and  the  result 
is  that  children  learn  it's  dangerous  to  become  too  curious  about  the  world 
(Schachtel,  1959,  p.  154). 

Adults  may  also  discourage  children's  curiosity  by  the  way  they  name, 
label,  and  explain  things  to  children.  For  example,  when  a  child  becomes 
curious  about  something,  the  adult  often  simply  tells  the  child  the  object's 
name,  implying  there  is  nothing  more  to  know  about  it  (p.  187).  If  a  little  girl 
shouts,  "Da!"  and  points  excitedly  at  a  dog,  the  father  says,  "Yes,  that's  a 
dog,"  and  then  urges  her  to  continue  on  with  their  walk.  Fie  teaches  her  that 
the  conventional  category — the  word — "explains"  the  object.  Instead,  he 
might  say,  "Yes,  that's  a  dog!"  and  stop  and  observe  it  with  her.  In  this  way, 
he  respects  and  encourages  her  active  interest  in  the  world. 

Schachtel,  on  the  whole,  told  us  more  about  how  parents,  teachers,  and 
peers  stifle  the  child's  curiosity  than  how  we  might  protect  and  encourage  it. 
Like  Rousseau,  he  implied  that  the  most  important  thing  is  to  avoid  negative 


345 


Schachtel  on  Childhood  Experiences 


influences.  If  we  can  lessen  our  tendency  to  close  off  their  world,  children 
themselves  will  take  an  open,  active  interest  in  it,  from  their  own  spontaneous 
tendencies. 


EVALUATION 

Freud  thought  that  the  great  tragedy  of  life  is  that  in  order  for  us  to  live  in 
society,  we  repress  so  much  of  ourselves.  Freud  had  in  mind  the  repression 
of  instinctual  drives.  Erikson  elaborated  on  this  theme,  suggesting  that  pos¬ 
itive  potentials  for  autonomy,  initiative,  and  other  strengths  usually  become 
somewhat  curtailed  in  the  course  of  socialization.  Schachtel's  contribution 
is  an  enlarged  conception  of  just  how  much  we  do  lose.  It  is  not  just  that  we 
repress  our  drives,  or  even  that  ego  strengths  such  as  autonomy  are  restricted, 
but  that  we  lose  touch  with  entire  modes  of  experience.  The  baby  who  is  in 
direct  contact  with  objects  through  the  senses  of  smell,  taste,  and  touch  and 
the  child  who  is  openly  curious  about  the  world  grow  into  well-socialized 
adults  who  view  the  world  through  very  narrow,  verbal,  conventional 
schemes. 

Schachtel  called  special  attention  to  infantile  amnesia,  the  adult's  inabil¬ 
ity  to  remember  personal  events  before  the  age  of  5  or  6  years.  The  primary 
reason  for  this  memory  gap,  Schachtel  said,  is  that  adults  rely  on  conventional 
verbal  categories  that  cannot  capture  the  rich  nonverbal  experiences  of  the 
early  years. 

Schachtel  didn't  cite  empirical  research  demonstrating  the  existence  of 
infantile  amnesia.  At  the  time  he  wrote,  little  such-research  existed.  But  since 
the  1980s,  many  psychologists  have  examined  the  topic. 

Investigators  have  consistently  found  that  adults  in  Western  societies 
rarely  remember  any  personal  experiences  before  the  age  of  3  years.  The  aver¬ 
age  age  of  the  earliest  memory  is  3  In  addition,  adults  recall  significantly 
fewer  experiences  before  the  age  of  5  than  one  would  expect  simply  because 
of  the  passage  of  time  (Pillemer  &  White,  1989;  Pillemer,  Picariello,  &  Pruett, 
1994).  Hayne  and  MacDonald  (2003)  recorded  early  memories  among  the 
Maori,  the  indigenous  people  of  New  Zealand,  who  place  a  great  value  on 
telling  stories  about  the  past.  The  average  age  of  the  Maori  adults'  first  mem¬ 
ories  was  slightly  earlier — just  under  3  years,  compared  to  3  V2  in  the  West.  All 
in  all,  the  evidence  indicates  that  infantile  amnesia  certainly  exists,  although 
the  ages  for  completely  forgotten  experiences  are  generally  earlier  than 
Schachtel  suggested. 

As  psychologists  discuss  explanations  of  infantile  amnesia,  they  typically 
mention  Schachtel  in  a  rather  cursory  manner.  However,  the  most  common 
explanation  is  in  agreement  with  Schachtel's  ideas.  Briefly  put,  the  expla¬ 
nation  is  this.  Very  young  children — under  the  age  of  2  years — are  capable 
of  remembering  things.  They  can  imitate  events  after  time  delays.  But  young 


346 


Schachtel  on  Childhood  Experiences 


children  are  best  at  reproducing  events  nonverbally,  through  their  physical 
actions.  Even  at  the  age  of  4  years,  their  verbal  recall  lags  behind  (Simcock 
&  Hayne,  2003).  It  appears,  then,  that  in  order  to  preserve  memories,  chil¬ 
dren  must  learn  to  put  their  experiences  into  linguistic  forms,  especially  the 
forms  their  various  cultures  value.  Then  children  can  readily  share  their 
memories  with  others,  thereby  strengthening  the  memories  in  their  minds 
and  rendering  the  memories  more  accessible  to  them  as  adults  (Flavell  et  al., 
2002;  Nelson,  2003;  Wang,  2004). 

Many  psychologists  also  believe  that  parents  help  children  put  expe¬ 
riences  into  words  by  providing  what  Vygotskians  call  scaffolding.  That  is, 
the  parents  at  first  provide  a  good  deal  of  assistance,  helping  their  children 
describe  what  happened.  This  assistance  serves  as  a  kind  of  scaffold  until 
the  child  can  engage  in  verbal  recall  on  her  own  (Flavell  et  al.,  2002; 
Nelson,  2003). 

This,  then,  is  a  prevalent  interpretation  of  childhood  amnesia,  and  it 
accords  fairly  well  with  SchachteTs  views.  He,  too,  believed  that  societies 
teach  children  to  put  their  experiences  into  verbal  categories,  which  is  why 
their  early,  nonverbal  experiences  are  not  preserved.  (Schachtel  didn't  write 
about  the  method  of  scaffolding,  but  I'm  sure  he  would  have  agreed  that  this 
is  a  way  parents  teach  children  to  use  verbal  categories.) 

But  while  there  is  broad  agreement  on  what  occurs,  there  is  sharp  dis¬ 
agreement  on  the  benefits  of  the  process. To  my  knowledge,  every  contem¬ 
porary  psychologist  who  has  written  on  the  child's  increasing  reliance  on 
verbal  recall  has  viewed  it  in  a  purely  positive  light.  Schachtel  did  not.  Fet 
us  look  at  an  example  from  the  research  of  Reese  and  Fivush  (1993),  in 


which  a  mother  helps  her  3-year-old  son,  Michael,  remember  a  visit  to  the 
aquarium. 

Parent: 

Did  we  see  any  big  fishes?  What  kind  of  big  fishes? 

Child: 

Big,  big,  big. 

Parent: 

And  what's  their  names? 

Child: 

I  don't  know. 

Parent: 

You  remember  the  names  of  the  fishes.  What  we  called  them. 
Michael's  favorite  kind  of  fish.  Big  mean  ugly  fish. 

Child: 

Yeah. 

Parent: 

What  kind  is  it? 

Child: 

Um,  ba. 

Parent: 

A  ssshark? 

Child: 

Yeah. 

Parent: 

Remember  the  sharks? 

Child: 

Yeah. 

Parent: 

Do  you?  What  else  did  we  see  in  the  big  tank  at  the  aquarium? 

Child: 

I  don't  know. 

347 


Schachtel  on  Childhood  Experiences 


Parent:  Remember  when  we  first  came  in  . . .  the  aquarium?  And  we 

looked  down  and  there  were  a  whole  bunch  of  birdies  in  the 
water?  Remember  the  names  of  the  birdies? 

Child:  Ducks! 

Parent:  Nooo!  They  weren't  ducks.  They  had  on  little  suits.  Penguins. 

Remember,  what  did  the  penguins  do? 

Child:  I  don't  know. 

Parent:  You  don't  remember? 

Child:  No. 

Parent:  Remember  them  jumping  off  the  rocks  and  swimming  in  the 

water? 

Child:  Yeah. 

Parent:  Real  fast.  You  were  watching  them  jump  in  the  water,  hm. 

Child:  Yeah.  (p.  606) 

Flavell,  Miller,  and  Miller  have  reprinted  this  dialogue  in  their  influen¬ 
tial  book  Cognitive  Development  (2002,  pp.  241-242)  to  illustrate  how  scaffold¬ 
ing  promotes  recall.  But  from  Schachtel's  perspective,  the  mother  also  is 
teaching  Michael  that  his  own  experience  matters  less  than  labels.  For 
example,  when  Michael  gives  his  enthusiastic  impression  of  the  sharks — "Big, 
big,  big" — she  replies,  "And  what's  their  names?"  Also,  because  Michael 
doesn't  himself  come  up  with  the  name  "shark,"  the  mother  even  doubts  he 
remembers  them: 

Parent:  Remember  the  sharks? 

Child:  Yeah. 

Parent:  Do  you?  .  .  . 

If  Schachtel  was  correct,  the  mother's  emphasis  on  words  and  labels  is  shared 
by  Western  society  as  a  whole — but  at  a  great  cost.  The  sensual,  nonverbal 
realm  of  experience  is  drowned  out.  Schachtel  said  that  conventional  verbal 
labels  protect  us  from  the  "precarious  and  lonely  struggle  with  the  unknown" 
(1959,  p.  192).  He  urged  us  to  dare  to  transcend  linguistic  categories  and 
encounter  the  world  in  all  its  mystery.  This  is  the  world  in  which  young 
children  reside. 

Although  Schachtel  wrote  less  than  the  other  theorists  in  this  book,  his 
work  is  especially  important  in  another  way.  He  demonstrated  the  value  of  the 
phenomenological  approach  to  childhood.  He  provided  glimpses  of  how  the 
infant's  world  might  appear  from  the  inside,  to  the  infant  herself,  and  how  her 
experience  might  differ  from  ours  because  different  senses  are  dominant.  The 
phenomenological  approach  deserves  wider  application  in  developmental 
psychology. 

At  the  same  time,  Schachtel's  work  suffered  from  oversimplification. 
In  particular,  he  gave  a  somewhat  one-sided  picture  of  language.  Although 


348 


Schachtel  on  Childhood  Experiences 


conventional  words  and  labels  restrict  experience,  language  also  can  be 
creative. 

Still,  Schachtel  did  much  to  keep  us  mindful  of  the  value  of  the  radical 
Rousseau-like  way  of  thinking.  He  pointed  out  how  very  different  the  child's 
world  is  from  ours  and  how  much  human  potential  for  fresh,  creative  expe¬ 
rience  may  be  lost  in  the  process  of  becoming  a  well-adjusted  member  of  the 
conventional  social  order. 


349 


This  page  intentionally  left  blank 


Chomsky’s  Theory  of 
Language  Development1 


BIOGRAPHICAL  INTRODUCTION 

In  1949  Montessori  tried  to  get  us  to  see  that  the  child's  mastery  of 
language  is  an  amazing  achievement.  It  was  not  the  learning  of  words 
that  impressed  her,  but  the  acquisition  of  grammar  or  syntax — a  sys¬ 
tem  of  rules  for  creating  and  understanding  correct  sentences.  Gram¬ 
matical  rules  are  so  complex  and  so  deeply  buried  within  spoken 
language  that  adults  are  hardly  aware  of  them,  yet  children  somehow 
unconsciously  master  most  of  them  by  the  age  of  6  years.  Develop¬ 
mental  psychology  must  understand  how  this  happens. 

Psychologists  might  have  agreed  with  Montessori,  but  for  a  long 
time  they  were  handicapped  by  their  own  ignorance  of  grammatical 
rules  and  structures.  They  were  largely  limited  to  counting  children's 
nouns  and  verbs.  Then,  in  1957,  Chomsky  published  Syntactic  Struc¬ 
tures,  in  which  he  described  some  of  the  operations  we  use  to  form  and 
transform  sentences.  Researchers  then  had  an  idea  of  the  kinds  of  oper¬ 
ations  to  look  for  in  children's  speech,  and  the  whole  new  field  of  devel¬ 
opmental  psycholinguistics  emerged. 

Noam  Chomsky  was  bom  in  1928  in  Philadelphia.  Growing  up,  he 
learned  a  little  about  linguistics  from  his  father,  a  respected  Hebrew 
scholar.  Chomsky  attended  a  progressive  school  run  by  Temple  Uni¬ 
versity,  which  he  describes  (2003)  as  a  wonderful  place  that  promoted 
creative  activities.  Because  the  school  eschewed  grades  and  competi¬ 
tion,  Chomsky  didn't  even  know  he  was  a  good  student  until  high 
school.  At  the  age  of  16  he  entered  the  University  of  Pennsylvania,  full 
of  anticipation,  but  found  himself  so  bored  that  he  was  ready  to  drop  out 


'This  chapter  was  written  in  collaboration  with  Stephen  Crain. 

From  Theories  of  Development:  Concepts  and  Applications,  Sixth  Edition.  William 
Crain.  Copyright  ©  2011  by  Pearson  Education,  Inc.  Published  by  Pearson 
Prentice  Hall.  All  rights  reserved. 


351 


Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 


after  two  years.  Fortunately,  the  linguist  Zellig  Harris  invited  Chomsky  to  take 
his  graduate  course  and  to  explore  other  fields.  Chomsky  earned  both  his  B.  A. 
and  Ph.D.  from  the  University  of  Pennsylvania,  although  he  spent  several  grad¬ 
uate  school  years  in  a  special  program  at  Harvard  University  that  permitted 
him  to  work  on  whatever  he  wanted.  Chomsky's  new  theory,  a  combination 
of  mathematics  and  linguistics,  was  so  different  from  anything  that  had  been 
done  before  that  the  universities  had  no  place  for  him  within  their  traditional 
departments.  His  only  job  offer  came  from  the  Massachusetts  Institute  of  Tech¬ 
nology  (MIT),  where  he  has  been  since  1955  (Chomsky,  1977,  p.  80). 

Chomsky  is  not  only  a  linguist;  he  is  also  an  expert  on  foreign  affairs.  He 
was  one  of  the  first  intellectuals  to  speak  out  against  the  U.S.  war  in  Vietnam, 
and  he  opposed  American  military  interventions  in  Afghanistan  and  Iraq. 
Many  of  his  academic  colleagues  disagree  with  his  radical  politics,  but  they 
almost  unanimously  recognize  his  accomplishments  as  a  linguist.  He  has  been 
awarded  numerous  honorary  doctorate  degrees  and  is  widely  considered  one 
of  the  great  minds  of  our  time. 


BASIC  CONCEPTS 
The  Importance  of  Rules 

Prior  to  Chomsky,  most  people  probably  believed  what  Roger  Brown  called 
the  "storage  bin"  theory  of  language  learning.  Children  imitate  others  and 
acquire  a  large  number  of  sentences  they  store  in  their  heads.  They  then 
reach  in  for  the  appropriate  sentence  when  the  occasion  arises  (Brown  & 
Herrnstein,  1975,  p.  444). 

Chomsky  has  shown  this  view  is  incorrect.  We  do  not  simply  learn  a  set 
number  of  sentences,  for  we  routinely  create  new  ones.  As  I  write  this  book, 
I  use  the  same  words  over  and  over,  but  I  create  a  novel  sentence  practically 
every  time.  We  all  do  the  same  thing  when  we  speak  or  write.  We  can  do  this 
because  we  have  internal  rules  that  enable  us  to  decide  which  sentences  are 
grammatical  and  convey  our  intended  meanings.  If  we  could  use  only  sen¬ 
tences  that  we  had  already  heard  and  memorized,  our  language  would  be 
severely  limited.  Because  we  have  a  system  of  rules — a  grammar — we  can 
invent  and  understand  sentences  we  have  never  heard  before  (Chomsky, 
1959,  p.  56). 


The  Child’s  Remarkable  Grasp  of  Rules 

Chomsky  has  focused  on  the  rules  for  making  transformations,  as  when  we 
transform  a  statement  into  a  question.  For  example,  we  might  turn  the  sen¬ 
tence  "The  dog  bit  the  lady"  into  the  question  "Did  the  dog  bite  the  lady?" 
Chomsky  has  shown  that  the  rules  for  making  transformations  can  be  quite 


352 


Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 


complex,  and  he  therefore  considers  it  remarkable  that  they  are  routinely 
mastered  by  children. 

Chomsky  himself  has  observed  children  only  informally.  However,  we 
can  illustrate  the  child's  linguistic  capacities  with  some  findings  by  Roger 
Brown  (1973),  whom  Chomsky  inspired.  Brown  unobtrusively  tape-recorded 
a  few  children's  spontaneous  speech  over  a  number  of  years  and  found, 
among  other  things,  how  they  begin  making  a  transformation  called  tag 
questions.  Here  are  some  tag  questions  produced  by  a  boy  called  Adam  (see 
Figure  1)  one  day  when  he  was  4  years  old. 

Ursula's  my  sister,  isn't  she? 

I  made  a  mistake,  didn't  I? 

Diandros  and  me  are  working,  aren't  we? 

He  can't  beat  me,  can  he? 

He  doesn't  know  what  to  do,  does  he? 

The  "tags"  are  the  little  questions  on  the  end  (Brown  &  Herrnstein,  1975, 
p.  471). 

The  first  thing  we  might  notice  is  the  creative  nature  of  Adam's  speech. 
These  do  not  seem  to  be  sentences  he  has  heard,  but  sentences  he  is  making 
up.  He  can  create  new  sentences  that  are  grammatical  because  he  is  following 
rules. 

Yet  the  rules  are  complex.  First  of  all,  to  create  the  tags,  Adam  must 
reverse  the  negative  or  affirmative  statement  in  the  first  part  of  the  sentence. 
When  Adam  says,  "I  made  a  mistake,"  an  affirmative  statement,  the  tag  must 
be  negative,  "Didn't  I?"  When  he  begins  with  a  negative  statement,  such  as 
"He  can't  beat  me/'  the  tag  must  be  positive,  "Can  he?"  Adam  does  this  cor¬ 
rectly  every  time. 

Also,  Adam  must  locate  the  subject  of  the  sentence  and  then  convert  it 
into  the  correct  pronoun  in  the  tag  question.  In  the  sentence,  "Diandros  and 
me  are  working,  aren't  we?,''  Adam  correctly  sees  that  the  subject  is  the  noun 
phrase  "Diandros  and  me,"  and  he  converts  it  into  "we." 

In  addition,  Adam  implicitly  recognizes  there  are  specific  times  when 
one  must  move  the  auxiliary  verb  to  the  front  in  the  question.  Note,  however, 
that  in  the  sentence  "I  made  a  mistake,  didn't  I?,"  the  auxiliary  "did"  is  not 

Figure  1 

Adam. 

Reprinted  by  permission  of  the  publisher  from  A  First 
Language:  The  Early  Stages  by  Roger  Brown.  Cambridge, 
Mass.:  Harvard  University  Press,  Copyright©  1973  by  the 
President  and  Fellows  of  Harvard  College. 


353 


Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 


present  in  the  statement.  So  Adam  creates  it,  following  an  abstract  rule  no  one 
was  even  aware  of  until  Chomsky  (1957)  discovered  it. 

Thus  Adam  is  simultaneously  employing  several  operations,  and  these 
are  only  some  of  them.  It  is  truly  remarkable  that  he  can  produce  correct  tag 
questions  at  age  4  [f,  yet  he  is  not  unusual  in  this  respect  (Brown  &  Hermstein, 
1975,  p.  471). 

An  interesting  aspect  of  Adam's  verbal  record  is  the  frequency  distrib¬ 
ution  of  these  sentences  over  time.  Adam  produced  no  tag  questions  at  all 
until  he  was  4  V2  and  then  he  suddenly  burst  out  with  them.  In  one  hour  he 
created  32  such  questions,  whereas  the  average  adult  frequency  is  3  to  6.  His 
behavior  is  reminiscent  of  Piaget's  circular  reactions  and  Montessori's  repe¬ 
titions.  Children  seem  to  have  an  inner  need  to  solidify  new  capacities  through 
repeated  exercise. 

In  any  case,  the  development  of  tag  questions  illustrates  Chomsky's 
point:  Children  master  complex  linguistic  rules  and  procedures  in  a  very  short 
time.  They  seem  to  master  most  of  the  intricacies  of  grammars  by  the  age  of 
6  or  so,  and  the  rest  by  puberty.  This  is  not  to  say  they  become  consciously 
aware  of  grammatical  rules;  even  Chomsky  is  still  trying  to  make  them  explicit. 
But  they  gain  a  working  knowledge  of  them  on  an  intuitive  level.  They  rapidly 
learn  the  rules  of  their  own  language — and,  if  need  be,  those  of  a  second  lan¬ 
guage  as  well.  It  is  a  common  observation,  Chomsky  says,  that  a  young  child 
of  immigrant  parents  may  learn  a  second  language  in  the  streets,  from  other 
children,  with  amazing  rapidity,  and  the  child  will  speak  the  new  language  as 
fluently  as  the  other  children  (1959,  p.  42). 

Chomsky  acknowledges  that  everyone's  speech,  including  that  of  adults, 
contains  errors,  slips,  false  starts,  and  interrupted  fragments.  These  mistakes 
are  caused  by  such  factors  as  carelessness,  fatigue,  and  memory  lapses.  These 
deficits  in  performance,  however,  are  far  outweighed  by  an  underlying 
competence,  which  is  best  revealed  by  an  ability  to  distinguish  between  poorly 
formed  and  well-formed  sentences  (Chomsky,  1962,  p.  531). 


The  Innateness  Hypothesis 

Chomsky  says  the  linguistic  accomplishments  of  the  ordinary  child  are  too 
great  to  be  explained  in  terms  of  any  kind  of  input  from  the  environment. 
Children  hear  only  a  limited  body  of  speech,  much  of  which  is  poorly  formed, 
yet  they  rapidly  and  uniformly  develop  an  intricate  system  of  rules  for  creat¬ 
ing  an  unlimited  number  of  sentences.  Their  knowledge  extends  far  beyond 
their  experience.  One  can  only  conclude,  Chomsky  says,  that  children  do  not 
build  grammars  primarily  from  the  evidence  they  hear,  but  according  to  an 
inner  design — a  genetic  program  (Chomsky,  1972,  p.  171;  1980,  pp.  232-234). 

But  there  is  a  problem.  Languages  vary  considerably  from  culture  to  cul¬ 
ture,  and  the  language  a  child  learns  depends  on  the  culture  in  which  he  or 
she  is  raised.  How,  then,  can  an  innate  language-learning  process  be  at  work? 


354 


Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 


Chomsky's  proposal  (1986,  pp.  145-150)  is  this:  When  children  master  a 
grammar,  they  are  guided  by  an  innate  knowledge  of  Universal  Grammar;  they 
automatically  know  the  general  form  any  language  must  take.  But  Universal 
Grammar  (UG)  has  holes  in  it;  it  leaves  certain  parameters  open.  For  example, 
one  principle  of  UG  is  that  all  sentences  must  contain  a  subject,  but  some  lan¬ 
guages  allow  speakers  to  routinely  leave  the  subject  implicit;  the  speakers  do 
not  have  to  voice  it.  In  Italian  one  can  simply  say  "Went"  where  in  English  one 
must  say  "She  went"  (Hyams,  1986).  So  children  need  information  from  the 
environment  to  set  this  parameter,  to  determine  which  rule  their  particular 
language  follows.2 

Usually,  Chomsky  (1986,  pp.  146-152)  speculates,  setting  parameters  is 
a  simple  matter,  like  setting  a  switch  +  or  — .  Furthermore,  the  number  of 
switches  that  a  child  must  set  might  be  fairly  small.  If  so,  grammar  acquisition 
can  be  quick  and  efficient. 

It  is  not  yet  clear  that  this  parameter-setting  model  actually  describes 
the  way  children  learn  their  particular  grammars.  Chomsky  himself  is  con¬ 
stantly  thinking  of  new  models.  But  Chomsky  is  committed  to  the  general 
theory  of  Universal  Grammar.  Regardless  of  how  children  pick  up  the 
details  of  their  particular  grammars,  they  must  have  an  innate  knowledge 
of  the  general  form  that  all  languages  must  take.  As  they  put  words 
together,  they  must  intuitively  know  certain  combinations  are  possible  and 
others  are  not.  If  children  lacked  this  knowledge,  if  they  had  to  learn  gram¬ 
mar  primarily  from  experience,  they  could  never  master  such  a  complex 
system  in  so  short  a  time. 

The  child's  capacity  to  learn  languages,  Chomsky  also  postulates,  is 
species-specific  (found  only  in  humans)  and  a  highly  specialized  faculty 
within  the  human  mind.  That  is,  it  is  quite  unlike  the  faculty  for  learning 
science,  music,  and  so  on.  It  has  its  own  genetic  design  (Chomsky,  1980, 
chap.  6;  1983,  p.  37). 


Innate  Constraints 

What,  precisely,  are  the  genetically  determined  aspects  of  language?  We  are  a 
long  way  from  knowing  for  sure.  We  cannot  have  an  innate  knowledge  of 
many  of  the  rules  for  creating  tag  questions,  for  these  are  not  universal. 

On  a  universal  level,  Chomsky  believes  we  are  probably  disposed  to 
construct  languages  out  of  certain  building  blocks,  such  as  nouns  and  verbs. 
Primarily,  however,  Chomsky  argues  that  our  minds  possess  built-in 
constraints  that  limit  the  rules  we  will  even  consider.  As  children  learn 
languages,  these  constraints  tell  them,  in  effect,  "Don't  waste  your  time 


2The  idea  of  UG  with  gaps  filled  in  by  experience  reminds  one  of  the  imprintinglike 
process  by  which  some  species  of  birds  learn  songs.  However,  Chomsky  has  not  suggested  this 
analogy. 


355 


Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 


considering  such-and-such  rules;  these  are  wrong."  Such  constraints  free  the 
child  of  the  predicament  of  the  scientific  linguist,  who  must  entertain  and  rule 
out  all  conceivable  grammatical  systems  and  rules.  Children  already  know 
that  grammars  must  be  of  a  certain  type  (Chomsky,  1972,  p.  113). 

A  major  innate  constraint  is  that  all  transformational  rules  must  be 
structure  dependent.  To  get  an  idea  of  what  this  means,  let  us  consider  trans¬ 
forming  the  following  sentences  into  yes/no  questions. 

(1)  The  man  is  tall. — Is  the  man  tall? 

The  book  is  on  the  table. — Is  the  book  on  the  table? 

I  can  go. — Can  I  go? 

What  is  the  rule  for  forming  these  questions?  Chomsky  says  that  a  neu¬ 
tral  scientist,  looking  at  these  questions  for  the  first  time,  would  doubtlessly 
infer  that  the  rule  is  to  read  from  left  to  right  until  we  come  across  the  first 
verbal  element  (is,  can,  etc.)  and  then  to  move  it  to  the  front  of  the  sentence. 
We  can  call  this  Hypothesis  1,  and  it  works  almost  every  time  with  sentences 
of  this  type.  It  is  a  simple,  straightforward  rule,  one  we  would  use  if  we  were 
programming  a  computer.  But  look  what  happens  when  we  apply  it  to  the 
following  sentence: 

(2)  The  man  who  is  tall  is  in  the  room. — Is  the  man  who  tall  is  in  the 
room? 

The  sentence  is  ungrammatical.  Hypothesis  1  is  therefore  wrong,  and  our 
scientist  would  be  surprised. 

When  we  correctly  transform  sentences,  we  first  analyze  them  into 
abstract  phrases  (e.g.,  the  noun  phrase  and  the  verb  phrase).  The  phrases  are 
called  abstract  because  nothing  marks  off  their  boundaries;  our  sense  of  them 
is  intuitive.  Then  we  locate  the  first  verbal  element  (is,  can,  etc.)  after  the  first 
noun  phrase,  and  it  is  this  verbal  element  that  we  move  to  the  front  of  the  sen¬ 
tence.  Thus  (to  use  a  diagram  suggested  by  Aitchison,  1976), 


(1) 

(2) 


1 


The  man 
The  book 

I 

The  man  who  is  tall 


is 

tall 

is  1 

on  the  table 

can 

go 

is  1 

in  the  room 

In  this  way,  then,  we  correctly  transform  Sentence  2,  creating  the  sen¬ 
tence,  "Is  the  man  who  is  tall  in  the  room?"  In  Chomsky's  terms,  we  follow  a 
structure-dependent  rule;  we  do  not  operate  on  strings  of  single  words,  but 
we  analyze  the  structure  of  the  phrases  before  making  transformations.  And 


356 


Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 


we  always  keep  the  first  noun  phrase  (in  this  case,  "the  man  who  is  tall") 
intact  (Chomsky,  1975,  pp.  30-32). 

Chomsky  claims  that  the  ordinary  child,  unlike  our  imaginary  scientist, 
will  never  even  consider  Hypothesis  1 .  This  is  because  structure  dependence 
is  an  innate  mode  of  organizing  experience,  not  something  derived  from  evi¬ 
dence.  In  fact,  Chomsky  says,  people  may  go  through  a  considerable  part  of 
their  lives  without  hearing  any  evidence  that  would  enable  them  to  choose 
between  Hypothesis  1  and  structure  dependence,  and  yet  the  very  first  time 
they  must  transform  a  sentence  like  Sentence  2  they  will  unhesitatingly  use  the 
structure-dependent  rule  (1975,  p.  32). 

Several  scholars  (e.g.,  Pullum  &  Scholz,  2002;  Tomasello,  2003,  p.  288) 
have  challenged  Chomksy's  claim.  Unlike  Chomsky,  these  scholars  speculate 
that  children  might  hear  numerous  adult  questions  that  resemble  "Is  the  man 
who  is  tall  in  the  room?"  For  example,  a  teacher  might  ask  children,  "Is  the  boy 
who  was  crying  still  here?"  Adult  questions  of  this  kind  could  inform  chil¬ 
dren  about  the  structure  that  the  questions  must  take. 

However  researchers  have  found  that  questions  of  this  kind  are  extremely 
rare  in  the  data  bases  of  speech  that  children  hear  from  adults  (S.  Crain  & 
Thornton,  2006).  It's  possible  that  some  children  never  hear  this  kind  of  ques¬ 
tion  before  the  age  of  5  years.  Yet  a  study  by  Stephen  Crain  and  Mineharu 
Nakayama  (1987)  suggests  that  3-  to  5-year  olds  consistently  know  that  ques¬ 
tions  of  this  kind  must  be  structure  dependent. 

In  this  study,  30  children  questioned  a  doll  about  various  matters,  such 
as  whether  "the  boy  who  is  watching  Mickey  Mouse  is  happy."  The  children 
sometimes  had  difficulty  framing  their  questions  to  the  doll — their  questions 
were  sometimes  awkwardly  expressed — but  the  children  always  adhered  to 
the  principle  of  structure  dependence.  They  always  kept  the  noun  phrase  ("the 
boy  who  is  watching  Mickey  Mouse")  intact.  The  children  seemed  to  know 
intuitively  that  structure  dependence  must  be  respected.1 * 3  When,  moreover, 
we  consider  the  fact  that  all  languages,  so  far  as  we  know,  employ  only  structure- 
dependent  rules,  it  begins  to  appear  that  structure  dependence  is  indeed  an 
innate  property  of  the  human  mind. 

Structure  dependence,  then,  is  submitted  as  an  innate  constraint  that 
restricts  the  kinds  of  transformational  rules  children  must  learn.  Children 
growing  up  in  different  cultures  will  learn  somewhat  different  transforma¬ 
tional  rules,  but  they  will  automatically  know  that  all  the  rules  must  be  struc¬ 
ture  dependent.  The  great  task  of  linguistics,  Chomsky  believes,  is  to  discover 
what  principles,  such  as  structure  dependence,  set  limits  on  the  kinds  of  rules 
we  automatically  follow.  Such  principles  will  tell  us  much  about  how  the 
mind  works. 


1 A  mb  ridge,  Rowland,  and  Pine  (2008)  challenged  these  results,  reporting  that  3-  to 

7-year-olds  in  their  own  study  violated  structure  dependence  5  percent  of  the  time.  But  their 

study  might  have  contributed  to  the  errors  by  tiring  the  children;  and,  in  any  case,  a  5  percent 
error  rate  is  small. 


357 


Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 


Surface  and  Deep  Structure 

To  help  understand  how  we  transform  sentences,  Chomsky  introduced  the 
concepts  of  deep  and  surface  structure.  The  deep  structure  is  the  basic  struc¬ 
ture  on  which  we  perform  various  operations  to  create  new  sentences. 
Consider  the  following  sentences: 

(3)  Susan  ate  the  apple. 

(4)  The  apple  was  eaten  by  Susan. 

(5)  Susan  did  not  eat  the  apple. 

(6)  What  did  Susan  eat? 

(7)  Susan  ate  the  apple,  didn't  she? 

Of  these  sentences,  Sentence  3  is  the  most  straightforward.  It  is  a  simple,  active, 
declarative  sentence  and  follows  a  subject-verb-object  word  order.  In  English, 
Sentence  3  contains  the  basic  form  of  the  abstract  deep  structure.  Using  Sentence 
3,  one  could  perform  certain  operations  to  generate  all  the  other  sentences.  One 
could  not  take  any  other  sentence — say  Sentence  4 — and  derive  a  clear  set  of 
operations  for  creating  the  others  (Chomsky,  1957,  pp.  45, 91;  1965,  pp.  138-141). 

When  Chomsky  introduced  the  term  deep  structure,  he  created  a  good  deal 
of  confusion.  The  word  deep  conjures  up  images  of  an  underlying  universal 
grammar.  But  deep  structure  is  not  universal,  largely  because  languages  differ 
with  respect  to  the  word  order  they  treat  as  basic.  Some  languages,  such  as  Eng¬ 
lish,  treat  the  subject-verb-object  (SVO)  word  order  as  basic  and  use  it  for  per¬ 
forming  transformations.  Other  languages  use  other  word  orders.  For  example, 
Japanese  uses  SOV.  To  avoid  confusion,  Chomsky  has  tried  replacing  deep  and 
surface  structure  with  different  terms.  He  has  even  considered  abandoning  the 
concepts  altogether.  But  many  linguists  consider  the  concepts  very  useful. 


NOTES  ON  THE  GROWTH  OF  GRAMMAR 

As  indicated,  Chomsky  has  not  himself  studied  children,  and  his  views  on 
development  are  rather  vague  and  inconsistent.  In  general,  he  suggests  we 
begin  with  the  assumption  that  development  is  "instantaneous,"  that  chil¬ 
dren  instantly  develop  the  grammatical  structures  of  the  adult.  But  this  is  just 
an  initial  working  assumption — a  way  to  get  research  started.  For  Chomsky 
also  realizes  that  grammatical  capacities,  like  any  biological  system,  do 
mature  and  may  even  undergo  qualitatively  different  stages  (Chomsky,  1972, 
pp.  88-90;  1975,  pp.  119-123). 

In  any  case,  Chomsky's  work  has  inspired  many  researchers — 
psycholinguists — to  study  children's  language  development  in  great  detail. 
The  following  notes  summarize  some  of  the  main  findings.4 

4This  summary  follows  a  phase  sequence  suggested  by  Cairns  and  Cairns,  1976,  pp.  193-197. 


358 


Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 


Early  Language 

Right  at  birth,  babies  are  tuned  in  to  language.  Careful  film  analyses  suggest 
that  they  make  very  slight  body  movements  in  response  to  speech,  and  their 
movements  vary  with  the  boundaries  of  sounds  and  words  (Condon  &  Sander, 
1974).  Newborns  are  also  very  sensitive  to  the  rhythms  and  pitches  of  speech 
(Fogel,  2009,  p.  242). 

At  about  1  month  of  age,  babies  begin  gurgling  and  cooing,  and  by 
6  months  or  so  they  are  usually  making  babbling  sounds  such  as  "ba  ba  ba" 
and  "da  da  da"  (Sachs,  1976).  They  like  to  play  with  such  sounds,  and  their 
babbling  often  has  a  musical  quality,  too  (Crain,  2003,  p.  92). 


One-Word  Utterances 

At  about  1  year,  babies  begin  producing  single  words.  Some  researchers 
believe  they  are  trying  to  use  single  words  to  express  entire  sentences.  For 
example,  "cookie"  might  mean  "I  want  a  cookie"  or  "There  is  a  cookie," 
depending  on  the  context.  There  is  a  danger,  however,  of  reading  too  much 
into  the  baby's  speech  (Sachs,  1976). 


Two-Word  Utterances 

Beginning  at  about  1  [f  years,  children  put  two  words  together,  and  their  lan¬ 
guage  takes  on  a  definite  structure.  Researchers  have  disagreed  widely,  how¬ 
ever,  about  how  best  to  characterize  this  structure.  Table  1  lists  some  typical 
two-word  utterances,  as  characterized  by  some  psycholinguists. 

In  the  table,  notice  how,  in  utterances  6  through  8,  children  are  separat¬ 
ing  out  agents,  actions,  and  objects.  Some  people  (e.g.,  McNeill,  1966)  have 
proposed  that  children  possess  an  underlying  knowledge  of  subject-verb-object 


Table  1  Some  Typical  Two-Word  Utterances 


TYPE 

EXAMPLE 

1 .  Nanning 

that  doggie 

2.  Repetition 

more  jump 

3.  Negation 

allgone  ball,  no  wet 

4.  Possession 

my  truck 

5.  Attribution 

big  boy 

6.  Agent-action 

Johnny  hit 

7.  Action-object 

hit  ball 

8.  Agent-object 

Mommy  bread  (meaning,  "Mommy  is  cutting  the 
bread") 

Adapted  from  Brown  and  Herrnstein  (1 975,  p.  478)  and  Slobin  (1 979,  pp.  86-87). 


359 


Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 


relationships.  This,  however,  is  not  certain.  When  children  employ  agents,  they 
are  not  necessarily  using  subjects.  An  agent  is  a  limited  semantic  (word¬ 
meaning)  category;  it  refers  to  something  that  takes  action.  A  subject  is  a 
broader  syntactic  category  that  refers  to  parts  of  sentences  that  may  or  may 
not  be  taking  action  (e.g.,  there  is  no  action  in  “He  is  tall").  Thus  researchers 
who  infer  adult  syntax  in  children's  speech  may  once  again  be  reading  too 
much  into  it  (Gardner,  1982,  pp.  168-170). 


Developing  Grammar 

Between  2  and  3  years  of  age,  children  typically  begin  putting  three  and 
more  words  together,  saying  things  such  as  “I  making  coffee."  Occasionally 
they  say  things  like  "Eve  is  girl"  (Brown,  1973,  p.  314),  now  apparently  using 
subjects  and  verbs  that  go  beyond  agents  and  actions  (Eve  isn't  doing  any¬ 
thing).  English-speaking  children  usually  follow  the  subject-verb-object  word 
order,  which  is  integral  to  deep  structure  in  our  language  (Brown,  Cazden,  & 
Bellugi-Klima,  1969,  p.  42). 

As  soon  as  children  begin  putting  three  or  more  words  together,  they  indi¬ 
cate  a  sense  of  structure  dependence — that  noun  phrases  are  whole  units.  They 
reveal  this,  for  example,  by  their  pauses,  as  when  a  child  says,  "Put .  . .  the  red 
hat . . .  on,"  rather  than  "Put  the  . . .  red  hat . . .  on."  The  child  knows  the  phrase 
"the  red  hat"  functions  as  a  unit  that  is  not  to  be  broken  up  (Brown  &  Bellugi, 
1964,  p.  150).  Later,  when  children  begin  making  transformations,  they  will 
respect  the  integrity  of  these  units. 

During  this  phase  children  also  begin  making  use  of  word  endings,  and 
when  they  do,  they  overregularize,  saying  things  like  "I  rurrned,"  "It  goed," 
and  "She  doed  it."  A  similar  process  occurs  with  respect  to  plurals;  children 
routinely  say  things  such  as  "foots,"  "mans,"  and  "mouses"  (Ervin,  1964; 
Slobin,  1972). 

Interestingly,  children  do  not  begin  with  overregularizations,  but  first 
use  correct  irregular  forms.  For  example,  a  child  says  "went"  before  saying 
"goed."  But  after  a  month  or  so  children  begin  to  overregularize  word  end¬ 
ings  and  continue  to  do  so  well  into  the  elementary  school  years  (Siegler  & 
Alibali,  2005,  p.  212). 

What  children  seem  to  be  doing,  most  psycholinguists  believe,  is  for¬ 
mulating  rules.  They  discover  that  the  rule  for  forming  the  past  tense  is  to 
add  the  -ed  sound,  which  they  then  apply  to  all  cases,  assuming  the  lan¬ 
guage  is  more  consistent  than  it  actually  is.  Similarly,  they  induce  that  the 
rule  for  creating  plurals  is  to  add  the  -s  sound,  which  they  then  apply  across 
the  board. 

As  mentioned  earlier,  psycholinguists  sometimes  seem  to  be  looking 
for  adult  syntax  in  children's  speech.  Developmentalists  in  the  Rousseauist 
tradition,  in  contrast,  would  be  interested  in  the  ways  children's  speech  might 
be  qualitatively  different  from  that  of  adults.  Overregularizations  do  give 


360 


Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 


children's  speech  a  unique  flavor.  However,  children  are  actually  overregu¬ 
larizing  adult  rules.  Consequently,  we  would  like  to  know  if  children 
sometimes  also  formulate  their  own  rules. 

This  possibility  struck  Klima  and  Bellugi  (1966)  when  examining  chil¬ 
dren's  negatives.  Initially  children  act  as  if  their  rule  is:  Put  the  negative  in 
front  of  the  whole  sentence  (or  after  it).  For  example,  they  say,  "No  play  that," 
"No  want  stand  head,''  and  "Car  go  no." 

A  bit  later  children  seem  to  form  a  new  rule:  Put  the  negative  after  the 
first  noun  phrase  and  before  everything  else.  They  say  things  like  "He  no  bite 
you"  and  "I  no  want  envelope." 

At  different  stages,  then,  children  structure  negatives  in  their  own  ways. 
As  Klima  and  Bellugi  (1966)  say,  "It  has  seemed  to  us  that  the  language  of 
children  has  its  own  systematicity,  and  that  the  sentences  of  children  are  not 
just  an  imperfect  copy  of  those  of  an  adult"  (p.  191). 


Transformations 

Between  about  3  and  6  years,  children's  grammar  rapidly  becomes  quite 
complex;  most  notably,  children  begin  making  transformations.  Bellugi- 
Klima  (1968)  has  studied  how  children  form  Where,  What,  and  Why  ques¬ 
tions,  which  are  transformations  of  their  deep-structure  representations. 
For  example,  "Where  can  I  put  it?"  is  essentially  a  transformation  of  "I  can 
put  it  where." 

Children  do  not  master  the  transformational  operations  all  at  once,  and 
they  seem  to  go  through  stages  somewhat  like  those  with  respect  to  nega¬ 
tives.  For  example,  they  go  through  a  period  where  they  say  things  like, 
"Where  I  can  put  it?"  and  "What  he  wants?"  They  move  the  why  or  what  to 
the  front  of  the  sentence,  but  leave  the  rest  of  the  sentence  alone  (retaining  the 
subject-verb-object  word  order).  Even  when  they  are  asked  to  imitate,  they 
commonly  stick  to  their  own  way  of  speaking.  For  example, 

Adult:  "Adam,  say  what  I  say:  Where  can  I  put  them?" 

Adam:  "Where  I  can  put  them?"  (Slobin,  1979,  p.  96) 


Near  Adult  Grammar 

Although  children  master  most  aspects  of  grammar  by  the  age  of  5  or  6  years, 
they  still  need  time  to  master  some  sentence  constructions.  For  example, 
English-speaking  children  have  difficulty  understanding  a  sentence  such 
as,  "The  doll  is  easy  to  see."  They  think  the  doll  is  the  one  who  sees,  appar¬ 
ently  because  of  their  penchant  for  subject-verb-object  word  order.  Ages  5  to 
10  may  be  important  for  the  acquisition  of  the  subtlest  and  most  complex 
grammatical  skills  (C.  Chomsky,  1969). 


361 


Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 


Universals 

As  indicated,  many  psycholinguists  believe  there  may  be  universals  in  the 
developmental  process.  So  far  the  evidence  is  strongest  for  the  earliest  phases. 
Children  everywhere  probably  proceed  from  babbling  to  one-word  to  two-word 
utterances.  Early  babbling  and  two-word  structures,  in  particular,  appear 
to  be  highly  similar  throughout  the  world  (Brown  &  Herrnstein,  1975, 
pp.  477-479;  DeHart  et  al.,  2004,  p.  239). 

The  search  for  syntactic  universals  after  the  two-word  phase  becomes 
very  difficult,  and  the  search  has  really  just  begun.  Some  evidence  suggests 
that  children  everywhere  may  initially  handle  negatives  in  the  same  man¬ 
ner,  and  they  may  overregularize  some  parts  of  speech  (Slobin,  1973, 1985). 
By  the  time  children  are  mastering  transformations,  they  are  clearly  using 
rules  that  differ  somewhat  from  language  to  language.  Still,  there  may  be 
universal  constraints,  such  as  structure  dependence,  which  limit  the  rules 
they  will  form. 


CHOMSKY  AND  LEARNING  THEORY 

Chomsky  suggests  that  language  is  something  structured  by  children  them¬ 
selves.  Hearing  only  a  fragmentary  body  of  speech,  they  nevertheless  discover 
its  rules,  guided  by  an  innate  sense  of  what  the  rules  must  be  like.  Learning  the¬ 
orists,  in  contrast,  believe  we  must  look  to  the  social  environment  for  the  source 
of  linguistic  patterning.  Language,  in  their  view,  is  shaped  primarily  by  others 
through  operant  conditioning  or  through  modeling  influences. 


Operant  Conditioning 

The  Skinnerian  view  of  early  language  learning  is  sometimes  called  the 
"babble-luck"  theory.  Babies  babble  away  until,  by  luck,  they  hit  on  a  sound 
that  resembles  a  word,  and  it  is  reinforced.  Lor  example,  they  say  "da  da"  in 
the  presence  of  Daddy,  and  the  parents  show  their  approval.  Gradually,  par¬ 
ents  make  their  approval  contingent  upon  increasingly  accurate  and  complex 
utterances. 

Skinner  (1957)  and  his  followers  (e.g.,  Lovaas,  1977)  have  recognized 
that  such  meticulous  shaping  of  each  utterance  would  be  too  slow  a  process 
to  account  for  the  rapid  development  of  language.  Accordingly,  they  have 
pointed  out  that  when  children  are  taught  specific  linguistic  behaviors,  they 
may  rapidly  generalize  their  learning  to  new  situations.  Lor  example,  a  child 
who  has  been  taught  to  pluralize  a  word  may  automatically  pluralize  new 
words  without  any  further  training.  Because  children  generalize,  they  readily 
produce  entirely  new  expressions — behavior  that  Chomsky  considers  so 
important. 


362 


Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 


The  principle  of  generalization  would  seem  to  explain  overregulariza¬ 
tions  (e.g.,  "mans").  However,  the  picture  is  complicated  because,  as  you  may 
recall,  children  initially  emit  correct  irregular  forms  (e.g.,  "men"),  which  are 
presumably  reinforced.  Clearer  demonstrations  of  operant  principles  have 
come  from  laboratory  research,  most  of  which  has  been  done  with  children 
with  developmental  delay  or  disturbed  children  who  are  behind  in  their 
speech.  Such  children  have  been  taught  plurals,  prepositions,  and  other  rela¬ 
tively  simple  grammatical  elements,  which  they  have  rapidly  generalized  to 
new  situations  (Lovaas,  1977,  pp.  110-116).  However,  it  has  not  yet  been  shown 
that  operant  techniques  can  produce  anything  like  complex  grammatical  trans¬ 
formations. 

Furthermore,  research  by  Brown  and  Hanlon  (1970)  suggests  that  typi¬ 
cally  developing  children  would  have  great  difficulty  learning  language  on  the 
basis  of  parental  conditioning,  because  parents  are  such  poor  language  teach¬ 
ers.  These  investigators  found  that  parents  correct  surprisingly  few  ungram¬ 
matical  utterances.  Instead,  they  concentrate  on  the  truthfulness  of  their 
children's  remarks.  For  example,  when  one  girl,  Sarah,  said,  "Her  curl  my 
hair,"  her  mother  said,  "That's  right,"  because  that  was  what  she  was  doing. 
The  mother  ignored  Sarah's  grammatical  error.  When,  however,  Sarah  said, 
"There's  the  animal  farmhouse,"  a  grammatically  impeccable  sentence,  her 
mother  corrected  her,  because  it  was  a  lighthouse  (p.  202).  Thus  it  is  unlikely 
that  Sarah  learned  grammar  as  a  consequence  of  her  parents'  effective  use  of 
approval  and  disapproval. 

Perhaps  it  is  not  parental  approval,  but  some  other  form  of  feedback 
that  constitutes  effective  reinforcement.  Perhaps  children  learn  to  use  increas¬ 
ingly  correct  grammar  because  parents  can  comprehend  and  respond  accu¬ 
rately  to  it.  However,  Brown  and  Hanlon  also  failed  to  find  that  well-formed 
utterances  met  with  any  better  understanding  than  poorly  formed  utterances. 
Brown  and  Hanlon's  data  were  based  on  only  three  children,  but  these  three 
seemed  to  learn  correct  grammar  despite  the  poorest  kind  of  direct  reinforce¬ 
ment  from  their  parents. 


Bandura  and  Modeling 

Bandura  emphasizes  the  influence  of  models.  He  recognizes  that  modeling 
does  not  always  work  through  a  process  of  exact  imitation,  for  children  pro¬ 
duce  novel  utterances  that  they  have  never  heard.  For  example,  children's 
overregularizations  (e.g.,  "mans")  cannot  be  exact  imitations,  for  adults  do 
not  talk  this  way.5  However,  Bandura  contends  that  modeling  is  still  at 


5It  is  conceivable  that  overregularizations  are  exact  imitations  of  the  speech  of  other  chil- 
dren,  but  it  is  unlikely.  Overregularizations  occur  in  all  children,  including  2-year-old  firstborns 
whose  primary  linguistic  models  are  their  parents  (Slobin,  1979,  p.  94). 


363 


Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 


work;  the  process  is  one  of  "abstract  modeling."  Children  imitate  the  rules 
they  hear  (e.g.,  add  the  s  sound  to  form  the  plural),  which  they  imitate  too 
well  (Bandura,  1977,  p.  175). 

Some  laboratory  research  supports  Bandura's  position.  For  example, 
Whitehurst,  Ironsmith,  and  Goldman  (1974)  showed  that  the  careful  model¬ 
ing  of  passive  sentences  produced  passives  in  children's  speech.  The  children 
did  not  just  copy  the  model's  exact  words,  but  they  picked  up  the  general 
structure  of  passive  sentences  and  created  new  sentences  of  this  type. 

Chomsky  has  not  commented  directly  on  Bandura's  proposal,  but  we 
can  imagine  what  his  response  would  be.  In  the  real  world,  models  may  some¬ 
times  exemplify  rules  with  sufficient  clarity  for  children  to  infer  them  on  this 
basis.  By  and  large,  however,  models  present  children  with  a  limited  body  of 
speech  that  is  frequently  degenerate.  Much  adult  speech  is  full  of  errors,  slips, 
false  starts,  and  so  on.  Thus,  although  children  do  pick  up  rules  from  the 
speech  they  hear,  they  can  do  so  only  because  they  are  guided  by  an  innate 
sense  of  what  the  rules  are.  Instead  of  focusing  on  the  behavior  of  models, 
then,  we  should  study  the  processing  mechanisms  of  the  child. 

A  good  deal  of  research  has  challenged  Chomsky's  view  of  the  quality 
of  speech  children  hear  (Snow,  1979;  DeHart  et  al.,  2004,  pp.  258-259). 
Although  speech  between  adults  may  be  full  of  errors,  adults  commonly  talk 
to  children  in  a  very  simple,  clear,  and  grammatical  fashion.  Such  speech  is 
called  child-directed  speech  or  motherese  and  is  illustrated  by  the  following  early 
record  of  it  (Brown  &  Bellugi,  1964,  p.  135): 


Adam: 

See  truck.  Mommy.  See  truck. 

Mother: 

Did  you  see  the  truck? 

Adam: 

No  I  see  truck. 

Mother: 

No,  you  didn't  see  it?  There  goes  one. 

Adam: 

There  go  one. 

Mother: 

Yes,  there  goes  one. 

The  mother's  speech  is  short,  and  it  is  perfectly  grammatical.  It  is  simple 
enough  for  Adam  to  imitate,  which  he  does  at  one  point,  saying,  "There  go 
one.''  The  mother  follows  with  an  expanded  imitation — "Yes,  there  goes  one." 
That  is,  she  imitates  Adam's  sentence  and  expands  a  bit  on  it.  Perhaps 
expanded  imitations  gradually  lead  the  child  toward  new  grammatical  forms. 

The  discovery  of  motherese,  then,  suggests  that  models  may  be  far  more 
effective  than  Chomsky  implies.  If  adults  model  speech  in  simple,  clear,  and 
correct  forms,  children  can  learn  it  from  them. 

However,  we  cannot  yet  draw  any  firm  conclusions  about  the  impact  of 
modeling  influences.  For  one  thing,  we  do  not  yet  know  how  important  moth¬ 
erese  is.  Current  evidence  suggests  that  motherese  can  speed  up  some  lan¬ 
guage  acquisition  a  bit,  but  children  can  certainly  learn  language  without  it. 
The  adults  in  some  cultures,  such  as  the  Kulali  in  New  Guinea,  do  not  believe 


364 


Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 


in  using  simplified  speech,  yet  their  children  learn  language  at  roughly  the 
same  rate  as  U.S.  children  (DeHart  et  al.7  2004,  pp.  258-259;  Tomasello,  2003, 
pp.  108-109). 

Furthermore,  even  if  simplified  speech  can  accelerate  language  learn¬ 
ing  slightly,  it  still  may  be  uninformative  on  key  points.  It  probably  doesn't 
provide  children  with  the  information  they  would  need  to  know  that  all  rules 
must  be  structure  dependent  by  the  age  they  know  this.  This  knowledge,  as 
Chomsky  says,  may  be  innate,  a  part  of  the  mind's  natural  way  of  organizing 
linguistic  experience. 

There  is,  finally,  another  kind  of  evidence  that  must  caution  us  against 
placing  too  much  emphasis  on  the  role  of  modeling  influences.  Children  some¬ 
times  create  grammatical  structures  that  are  quite  unlike  those  of  adults.  For 
example,  we  noted  earlier  how  children  initially  put  the  "no"  at  the  begin¬ 
ning  or  the  end  of  the  rest  of  the  sentence — something  that  adults  never  exem¬ 
plify.  Adam  does  this  in  the  preceding  excerpt,  saying,  "No  I  see  truck."  We 
also  saw  earlier  that  when  Adam  began  making  transformations,  he  said 
things  like  "Where  I  can  put  them?"  (retaining  SVO  word  order).  Adults  don't 
talk  this  way,  but  children  do.  For  some  time,  Chomsky  and  his  coworkers 
(e.g.,  Lightfoot,  1982,  p.  184)  minimized  the  significance  of  children's  unique 
structures,  emphasizing  instead  the  early  acquisition  of  adult  grammar.  But 
they  have  more  recently  begun  to  appreciate  children's  unique  structures, 
which  suggest  that  children  do  not  just  imitate  adult  rules  but  organize  speech 
in  their  own  ways  (see  Lightfoot,  1999,  p.  72). 


Pidgins  and  Creoles 

So  far  we  have  discussed  the  views  of  Chomsky  and  others  on  the  acquisition 
of  English  and  traditional  languages.  The  linguist  Derek  Bickerton  (1984, 1999), 
whose  position  is  close  to  Chomsky's,  believes  we  can  also  learn  a  great  deal 
from  the  study  of  pidgins  and  creoles. 

Sometimes  adults  from  diverse  linguistic  backgrounds  have  been  sud¬ 
denly  thrown  together,  as  happened  on  slave  plantations.  To  communicate,  the 
workers  developed  pidgins — choppy  strings  of  words  that  lack  most  of  the 
qualities  of  true  grammar.  For  example,  pidgins  lack  rules  for  making  trans¬ 
formations.  In  conversations,  the  speakers  often  become  confused. 

A  creole  comes  about  when  a  population  turns  a  native  pidgin  into  a  full, 
elegant  grammar.  But,  according  to  Bickerton,  it's  not  the  adults  who  perform 
this  feat.  It's  the  children. 

Bickerton  (1984, 1999)  has  presented  evidence  on  how  children  created 
a  creole  in  Hawaii  at  the  turn  of  the  20th  century.  By  that  time,  slave  planta¬ 
tions  no  longer  existed,  but  adults  from  various  countries  came  to  Hawaii  to 
harvest  the  crops  for  a  booming  sugar  industry.  There,  the  adults  created  a 
typically  choppy  pidgin.  Their  children  heard  the  pidgin  and  turned  it  into  an 
elegant  creole  in  a  single  generation. 


365 


Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 


Bickerton  points  out  that  creoles  are  highly  similar  throughout  the  world. 
It's  therefore  reasonable  to  hypothesize,  he  says,  that  children  create  creoles 
on  the  basis  of  a  universal  blueprint — a  universal  grammar.  Thus  linguists 
who  want  to  know  what  universal  grammar  looks  like  can  get  a  good  idea 
from  the  study  of  creoles. 

Bickerton  further  asserts  that  children  everywhere  speak  in  something 
like  creole  grammar  before  they  adjust  to  the  languages  they  hear  from  adults 
(such  as  English  or  Spanish).  For  example,  when  English-speaking  children  say 
things  such  as  "He  no  bite  you,"  they  are  uttering  sentences  that  are  gram¬ 
matical  in  creoles  and  reveal  a  universal  blueprint. 

If  Bickerton  is  right,  modeling  cannot  explain  the  development  of  creole 
grammars.  The  pidgins  with  which  children  must  work  are  too  degenerate 
to  serve  as  models.  The  Hawaiian  children,  Bickerton  says,  didn't  draw  on 
other  adult  grammars  (e.g.,  Spanish  or  Korean),  either. 

But  how  can  children  create  a  full  creole  on  the  basis  of  a  universal 
grammar  alone?  In  Chomsky's  theory.  Universal  Grammar  would  be  insuf¬ 
ficient;  children  need  some  input  from  the  adult  languages  to  discover  key 
facts,  such  as  the  language's  basic  word  order  and  the  transformational  rules. 
In  Hawaii  and  elsewhere,  the  children  couldn't  obtain  this  information  from 
the  pidgin.  In  such  situations,  Bickerton  (1999)  proposes,  the  universal  gram¬ 
mar  frequently  provides  the  children  with  default  solutions.  The  universal 
grammar  says,  in  effect,  "If  you  don't  hear  what  transformations  are  like,  use 
option  A." 

Bickerton  worked  with  historical  records  that  are  far  from  perfect  and  his 
claims  are  controversial  (Tomasello,  2003,  p.  287).  To  many,  his  account  is  sim¬ 
ply  too  amazing  to  believe.  How  can  children,  on  the  basis  of  an  impover¬ 
ished  pidgin,  create  a  full  grammar?  But  such  a  feat  need  not  come  as  a 
complete  surprise.  Chomsky  pointed  out  that  young  immigrant  children 
acquire  a  second  language  with  amazing  rapidity,  off  the  streets  and  play¬ 
grounds,  while  older  children  and  adults  struggle  with  the  task.  Normal  lan¬ 
guage  development,  too,  points  to  a  special  power  in  children,  as  we  saw  in 
our  discussion  of  tag  questions.  Children's  ability  to  create  a  creole  confirms 
this  power. 

Teaching  Language  to  Chimpanzees 

Chomsky  (1980,  p.  239)  has  claimed  that  syntax  is  a  uniquely  human  capac¬ 
ity.  However,  many  researchers  have  tried  to  teach  animals,  especially  chim¬ 
panzees,  to  speak.  Chimpanzees  do  not  have  human  vocal  chords,  so,  beginning 
in  the  1960s,  many  researchers  attempted  to  teach  them  sign  language.  When¬ 
ever  the  chimp  gave  the  correct  sign,  the  experimenter  gave  the  animal  a 
reward  such  as  a  toy  or  piece  of  fruit.  Initially,  the  results  seemed  promising. 
The  chimps  not  only  learned  individual  words,  but  spontaneously  put  them 
together  to  make  statements  such  as  "Gimme  tickle"  and  "More  eat"  (Gardner 


366 


Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 


&  Gardner,  1969,  p.  671;  Terrace,  Petito,  Sanders,  &  Bever,  1979,  p.  894).  The 
researchers  were  enthusiastic. 

However  in  1979  Herb  Terrace  and  his  coauthors  made  a  strong  case 
that  chimpanzees  couldn't  advance  farther  than  the  two-word  stage.  When  the 
chimps  put  more  than  two  words  together,  they  merely  repeated  themselves. 
Terrace's  critique  had  a  devastating  effect  on  research  in  this  field.  It  suggested 
that  chimps  cannot  learn  human  language  after  all.  But  not  everyone  aban¬ 
doned  the  effort. 

The  most  eye-opening  recent  work  is  that  of  Sue  Savage-Rumbaugh. 
Savage-Rumbaugh  explored  new  methods  with  a  different  kind  of 
chimpanzee — the  bonobo.  Bonobos,  who  were  only  recognized  as  a  separate 
species  in  1929,  are  smaller  than  the  common  chimpanzee  and  they  seem  more 
humanlike.  Their  walk  is  more  upright  and  they  have  a  high  degree  of  empa¬ 
thy  with  us  (Savage-Rumbaugh,  Shanker,  &  Taylor,  1998,  pp.  4,  8). 

Savage-Rumbaugh's  star  pupil  is  a  bonobo  named  Kanzi.  Kanzi  came  to 
Savage-Rumbaugh's  research  lab  in  Georgia  in  1980  with  his  mother,  Matata, 
when  Kanzi  was  6  months  old.  The  staff's  initial  focus  was  on  Matata,  whom 
they  tried  to  teach  symbols  on  a  keyboard  that  lit  up  when  a  symbol  was 
pressed.  The  keyboard  had  symbols  for  bananas,  juice,  and  other  objects  of 
interest  to  Matata.  During  her  training  sessions,  Kanzi  frequently  played  on 
Matata's  lap,  climbed  on  her  shoulders,  and  performed  gymnastics  on  her 
head.  Matata  tolerated  Kanzi's  antics  and  was  still  able  to  concentrate  on  her 
learning  tasks,  but  she  didn't  have  much  success  (Rumbaugh  &  Washburn, 
2003,  p.  129;  Savage-Rumbuagh  et  al.,  1998,  pp.  3, 15-18). 

Then  one  day,  when  Kanzi  was  2 1/2  years  old,  the  center  from  which 
Matata  came  decided  to  temporarily  take  her  back  for  breeding.  On  the  first 
day  of  her  absence,  Kanzi  astonished  everyone  by  his  extensive  use  of  sym¬ 
bols.  He  produced  120  different  utterances  using  12  different  symbols.  He  had 
been  watching  Matata  all  along  and  suddenly  demonstrated  what  he  had 
learned. 

Savage-Rumbaugh  was  so  impressed  that  she  decided  to  abandon 
direct  instruction  with  Kanzi.  She  asked  Kanzi's  teachers  to  simply  talk 
about  the  things  in  which  he  expressed  an  interest,  especially  on  walks  in 
the  forest  that  is  part  of  the  research  center.  The  teachers  also  carried  a  small 
keyboard  so  they  could  present  its  symbols  as  they  spoke,  and  they  let  Kanzi 
talk  back  on  the  keyboard  if  he  wished.  But  other  than  trying  to  present  a 
language-rich  environment,  they  simply  let  Kanzi  pick  up  language  on  his 
own.  Savage-Rumbaugh  believes  this  is  how  ordinary  human  children  learn 
language  (Rumbaugh  &  Washburn,  2003,  p.  131;  Savage-Rumbaugh  &  Lewin, 
1994,  p.  177). 

Kanzi's  initial  use  of  symbols  supports  Bandura's  theory  of  observational 
learning.  Kanzi  learned  a  lot  by  simply  observing  his  mother.  He  didn't 
perform  language  until  his  mother's  temporary  absence,  but  he  had 
acquired  it  (illustrating  Bandura's  acquisition /performance  distinction). 


367 


Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 


At  the  same  time,  Kanzi  didn't  just  imitate  what  he  saw  and  heard.  When  he 
began  putting  together  two-word  utterances,  he  sometimes  departed  from 
standard  English  and  created  his  own  word-order  rules  (Savage-Rumbaugh 
et  al.,  1998,  p.  64). 

But  what's  striking  about  Kanzi's  language  isn't  what  he  produces, 
but  what  he  comprehends.  In  production,  Kanzi  basically  seems  to  use  two- 
word  combinations;  his  ability  to  comprehend  what  others  say  is  much 
greater.  At  the  age  of  8  years,  he  showed  by  his  actions  that  he  understood 
spoken  requests  such  as,  "Put  the  raisins  in  the  shoe"  as  well  as  more  com¬ 
plicated  sentences  such  as,  "Show  me  the  ball  that's  on  TV"  (Savage- 
Rumbaugh  et  al.,  1998,  p.  68-71). 

Kanzi  even  understood  Savage-Rumbaugh  when  she  said,  "Kanzi,  if 
you  give  Austin  [another  chimp]  your  monster  mask,  I'll  let  you  have  some 
of  Austin's  cereal."  Kanzi  promptly  got  his  monster  mask,  gave  it  to  Austin, 
and  then  pointed  to  the  cereal  (Savage-Rumbaugh  &  Lewin,  1994,  p.  170). 

Savage-Rumbaugh  estimates  that  at  age  9  Kanzi's  comprehension  was 
equivalent  to  that  of  a  2  %  year  old  human  child  (1998,  pp. 67-69).  Since  human 
children's  comprehension  also  outpaces  their  production,  this  is  a  significant 
achievement.  When  I  showed  my  wife  Ellen  a  YouTube  video  of  Savage- 
Rumbaugh  talking  to  Kanzi  (Savage-Rumbaugh,  2007)  Ellen  exclaimed, 
"Wow!  He  understands  English!" 

Savage-Rumbaugh  acknowledges  that  Kanzi's  linguistic  achievements 
do  not  match  those  of  humans,  but  she  insists  that  it's  sufficient  to  refute 
Chomsky's  claim  that  the  capacity  for  syntax  is  unique  to  our  species.  A 
bonobo  can  learn  some  of  it — enough  to  say  that  there  is  a  continuity,  not  a 
sharp  difference,  between  bonobo  and  human  (Savage-Rumbaugh  &  Lewin, 
1994,  pp.  156, 163). 

We  might  note,  finally,  that  discussions  of  syntax  in  chimpanzees  use 
human  syntax  as  the  standard.  Perhaps  there  will  come  a  day  when  researchers 
look  into  the  possibility  that  nonhuman  species  have  their  own  forms  of 
syntax — forms  that  may  be  more  sophisticated  than  we  had  ever  imagined. 


CHOMSKY  AND  PIAGET 

Chomsky  has  primarily  pitted  his  theory  against  environmentalism,  but  he 
also  has  discussed  differences  between  his  theory  and  that  of  Piaget.  In  fact, 
he  met  with  Piaget  in  1975  for  a  series  of  debates  (Piatelli-Palmarini,  1979). 

Piaget  and  Chomsky,  to  be  sure,  have  much  in  common.  Both  argue  that 
children  are  not  molded  by  the  external  environment,  but  spontaneously 
create  mental  structures.  But  Chomsky  is  much  more  nativistic  than  Piaget. 
Chomsky  believes  that  children  will,  when  receiving  rather  minimal  input, 
automatically  create  grammatical  forms  according  to  the  genetic  design. 
Piaget,  in  contrast,  placed  much  less  emphasis  on  genetically  controlled 


368 


Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 


development.  In  his  view,  cognitive  structures  emerge  simply  from  the  child's 
own  efforts  to  deal  with  and  make  sense  of  the  world. 

Another  difference  concerns  the  specificity  or  the  autonomy  of  language 
development.  For  Chomsky,  language  is  a  highly  specialized  mental  faculty 
that  develops  fairly  independently  from  other  forms  of  cognition.  Piaget  and 
his  followers,  in  contrast,  have  viewed  language  as  more  closely  related  to 
general  cognitive  development. 

In  support  of  his  position  Piaget  (1983)  noted  that  children  begin  using 
language  as  symbols  (to  represent  absent  things  and  events)  at  about  2  years 
of  age,  when  they  also  begin  using  physical  actions  as  symbols.  In  fact,  the 
child  starts  using  physical  symbols  a  bit  earlier.  For  instance,  Jacqueline  play¬ 
fully  used  a  piece  of  cloth  to  represent  a  pillow  before  she  added  words  to 
her  make-believe  play.  Thus,  linguist  symbols  are  part  of  the  same  general 
symbolizing  process  that  has  its  origins  in  physical  activity. 

Piagetians  (e.g.,  Sinclair,  1971)  have  speculated  that  there  are  other  ways 
that  syntax  rests  on  cognitive  achievements,  but  we  can  only  take  the  Piaget- 
ian  view  so  far.  Piaget  argued  that  between  the  ages  of  about  2  and  6  years  (the 
preoperational  period),  thinking  is  basically  illogical  and  unsystematic.  Yet 
this  is  the  time  when  language  acquisition  is  so  rapid  and  impressive.  The 
development  of  language,  especially  syntax,  seems  to  have  its  own  special 
time  of  astonishing  progress.  Still,  it  seems  unlikely  that  research  will  show 
that  language  development  is  as  completely  divorced  from  other  cognitive 
activities  as  Chomsky  suggests. 


IMPLICATIONS  FOR  EDUCATION 

Chomsky  says  that  children  learn  an  intricate  grammatical  system  almost 
entirely  on  their  own.  All  they  need  is  to  hear  a  language  spoken,  and  they  will 
master  it.  Thus  Chomsky  proposes  no  special  instructional  programs.  But  this 
does  not  mean  his  work  has  no  practical  value.  It  can  help  change  our  atti¬ 
tudes  and  deepen  our  appreciation  of  the  child's  mind.  The  teacher  who 
considers  the  child's  linguistic  accomplishments  will  realize  how  ridiculous 
it  is  to  focus  on  the  child's  shortcomings.  Whatever  the  child  may  lack,  it  is 
trivial  in  comparison  to  the  complex  grammatical  system  he  or  she  has  mas¬ 
tered.  The  teacher,  upon  meeting  each  new  elementary  school  child,  will  think, 
"This  child  has  developed  a  remarkable  grasp  of  linguistic  structures.  This 
mind  deserves  my  greatest  respect."  One  can  only  wonder  about  the  effect 
such  an  attitude  would  have. 

Despite  Chomsky's  work,  many  psychologists  cannot  accept  the  possi¬ 
bility  that  children  really  learn  language  on  their  own.  Instead,  they  believe 
it  is  up  to  us  to  teach  children  a  proper  grammar.  For  example,  Bandura  (1977, 
p.  175)  implies  we  should  correct  children's  overregularizations  (e.g.,  "We 
digged  the  hole").  Chomsky's  work  suggests  otherwise.  What  children  are 


369 


Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 


doing  is  searching  for  underlying  rules,  a  search  that  will  eventually  lead  to 
the  mastery  of  an  intricate  grammar.  It  is  wrong  to  interfere  with  this  process. 
By  correcting  children's  mistakes,  we  only  confuse  them  and  undermine  their 
confidence.  Their  mistakes  will  correct  themselves  in  time. 

Nevertheless,  many  psychologists  and  educators  continue  to  explore 
ways  of  facilitating  and  accelerating  children's  speech  (Berk,  2009,  p.  388). 
Some  of  these  efforts  include  the  use  of  expanded  imitations — something 
many  parents  naturally  do.  For  example,  we  noted  how  one  of  Roger  Brown's 
subjects,  Adam,  said,  "There  go  one,"  and  his  mother  responded,  "Yes,  there 
goes  one."  Children  then  sometimes  imitate  their  parents'  expansions.  Many 
parents  seem  naturally  to  talk  to  children  in  this  way,  and  children  may  enjoy 
such  conversations.  But  it  is  not  at  all  clear  that  expanded  imitations  can  help 
the  acquisition  of  syntax  in  any  major  way  (Berk,  2009,  p.  388;  Cole  &  Cole, 
2001,  p.  326;  Dale,  1976). 

Others  are  interested  in  increasing  children's  vocabulary,  and  in  this  case 
the  results  are  clearer.  Hart  and  Risley  (2003)  have  found  that  when  parents  talk 
a  great  deal  to  their  babies  and  toddlers,  the  parents  can  boost  their  children's 
vocabularies  at  age  3  years.  These  gains,  in  turn,  are  associated  with  elevated  IQ 
and  reading  scores  in  elementary  school.  On  the  basis  of  these  findings,  many 
authorities,  including  the  American  Academy  of  Pediatrics,  encourage  parents 
to  talk  to  their  young  children  as  much  as  possible  (Camp,  2002). 

However,  this  "chatty  parent"  movement  is  worrisome.  As  Schachtel 
emphasized,  young  children  are  eager  to  explore  their  world  nonverbally, 
through  their  senses.  I  have  often  seen  a  young  child  intently  absorbed  in 
examining  an  object — a  leaf,  a  wooden  toy,  a  puddle  of  water — only  to  have 
the  parent  interrupt  the  investigation  by  getting  the  child  to  name  it.  Schachtel 
noted  that  poets  and  artists  try  to  recapture  the  young  child's  fresh,  nonver¬ 
bal  impressions.  We  should  give  children  the  chance  to  experience  them. 

Vocabulary  enthusiasts  point  out  that  increasing  the  word  power  of  low- 
income  children  can  raise  their  academic  achievement.  This  is  a  worthy  goal. 
But  it's  also  important  to  keep  vocabulary  in  perspective.  Although  the 
average  child  spontaneously  learns  many  new  words  a  day,  the  child's  vocab¬ 
ulary  growth  is  minor  in  comparison  to  her  mastery  of  a  sophisticated  and 
abstract  syntax.  The  ordinary  child,  whether  from  a  low-  or  a  high-income 
neighborhood,  is  really  a  linguistic  genius.  Indeed,  many  children  in  low- 
income  neighborhoods  are  recent  immigrants  who  master  not  one  language 
but  two.  So  while  it  might  be  good  to  increase  a  child's  vocabulary,  it  would 
be  very  wrong  to  treat  the  child  as  if  she  has  some  deficit.  When  it  comes  to 
language,  every  child  deserves  our  admiration. 

Some  educators  have  felt  it  is  important  to  teach  children  with  African 
American  dialects  the  standard  English  form.  These  educators  have  com¬ 
monly  assumed  African  American  dialects  are  inferior  to  standard  English, 
which  they  are  not  (Labov,  1970).  The  likely  outcome  is  that  the  African 
American  child  is  made  to  feel  deficient. 


370 


Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 


In  most  schools,  teachers  describe  the  parts  of  speech,  writing  the  famil¬ 
iar  tree  diagrams  on  the  blackboard.  Chomsky's  work  suggests  that  children 
already  have  an  implicit  grasp  of  almost  everything  the  teacher  is  explaining 
by  the  age  of  6  years.  Tree  diagrams,  to  be  sure,  can  make  children  more 
conscious  of  their  language,  a  point  Vygotsky  emphasized.  Since  tree  diagrams 
are  abstract,  they  probably  benefit  children  primarily  after  the  age  of  11  or  12, 
when  the  capacity  for  abstract  thinking  begins.  Before  this  age,  tree  diagrams 
just  baffle  the  child. 

In  general,  the  lesson  to  be  gained  from  Chomsky's  work  is  this:  Since 
children  independently  master  an  intricate  system  of  grammatical  rules,  we 
should  respect  their  independent  efforts.  It  is  presumptuous  of  us  to  try  to 
structure  the  child's  learning,  and  our  attempts  to  do  so  are  likely  to  lead  only 
to  their  loss  of  faith  in  their  own  intuitions.  Although  it  is  good  to  talk  to  chil¬ 
dren  in  ways  they  find  enjoyable,  it  is  not  necessary  to  do  anything  that  under¬ 
mines  their  nonverbal  explorations  or  deprecates  their  immense  linguistic 
accomplishments. 


EVALUATION 

It  is  remarkable  that  Chomsky,  who  is  more  of  a  linguist  or  even  a  philosopher 
than  a  psychologist,  has  inspired  so  much  psychological  research.  This 
research  is  a  testament  to  the  importance  of  his  ideas. 

We  have  focused  on  the  descriptive  studies  of  children's  emerging  gram¬ 
mar.  Chomsky's  nativistic  theory  also  has  stimulated  other  lines  of  investi¬ 
gation.  Some  researchers  have  been  exploring  the  possibility  that  there  is  a 
neurologically  based  sensitive  period  for  language  learning.  Once  the  brain  has 
completed  a  certain  degree  of  maturation — perhaps  at  the  onset  of  puberty — 
it  may  be  difficult  for  children  to  acquire  language  with  anything  like  the  ease 
with  which  they  do  so  before  this  time.  This  may  be  why  children  seem  bet¬ 
ter  able  to  learn  some  aspects  of  a  second  language  more  readily  when  they 
are  young.  Similarly,  children  who  are  hearing  impaired  may  more  readily 
learn  sign  language  at  a  young  age.  There  is  some  evidence  that  a  sensitive 
period  for  rapid  language  acquisition  ends  even  prior  to  puberty,  perhaps  at 
the  age  of  7  years.  There  is  much  to  be  learned  about  the  sensitive  period 
hypothesis,  but  we  can  see  how  Chomsky's  strongly  biological  theory  has 
inspired  new  research  (Johnson  &  Newport,  1989;  Newport,  1990;  Pinker,  1994; 
Siegler  &  Alibalil,  2005,  pp.  212-214). 

The  criticisms  we  might  make  of  Chomsky  are  primarily  from  a  devel¬ 
opmental  perspective.  First,  Chomsky  promoted  a  kind  of  revival  of  prefor- 
mationism.  His  comments  on  the  "instantaneous"  emergence  of  mature 
grammar  made  it  sound  as  if  children  are  miniature  adults  as  far  as  their 
language  is  concerned.  More  recently,  Chomsky's  followers  have  been  more 
sensitive  to  the  ways  that  children's  speech,  like  their  thought,  might 


371 


Chomsky's  Theory  of  Language  Development 


sometimes  possess  a  quality  of  its  own,  but  they  still  seem  determined  to 
find  adult  structures  in  children's  language  (see  Lightfoot,  1999,  p.  72; 
S.  Crain  &  Thornton,  2006). 

The  second  developmental  criticism  is  one  Werner  might  make.  Chomsky 
contends  that  grammar  can  be  studied  separately  from  other  psychological 
processes.  He  even  suggests  this  is  the  scientific  way  to  proceed,  since  biolo¬ 
gists  study  organs  such  as  the  heart  and  the  lungs  apart  from  one  another 
(Chomsky,  1983,  p.  35).  However,  biologists  recognize  that  organs  and  systems 
differentiate  out  of  more  primitive  and  global  configurations,  and  this  may  be 
true  of  language  as  well.  Early  language,  for  example,  may  be  difficult  to  clas¬ 
sify  either  in  terms  of  syntactic  or  action  categories  because  these  two  systems 
are  still  undifferentiated  (see  Hass,  1975).  Indeed,  at  the  outset,  it's  not  always 
easy  to  separate  the  baby's  speech  from  her  singing.  So  while  we  may  disagree 
with  Piagetians  over  the  extent  to  which  language  rests  on  prior  cognitive 
achievements,  we  still  need  to  consider  the  ways  in  which  language  is  initially 
bound  up  with  various  actions,  feelings,  and  perceptions. 

These  criticisms  notwithstanding,  we  can  only  marvel  at  the  excitement 
and  energy  Chomsky  has  generated.  Earlier,  a  few  writers,  such  as  Montessori, 
indicated  that  language  development  merits  special  study  because  children  are 
mastering  so  many  complex  rules  so  soon,  but  it  was  not  until  Chomsky  began 
to  specify  the  nature  of  these  rules  that  the  research  really  got  underway. 


372 


Jung’s  Theory 
of  Adulthood 


From  Theories  of  Development:  Concepts  and  Applications,  Sixth  Edition.  William 
Crain.  Copyright  ©  2011  by  Pearson  Education,  Inc.  Published  by  Pearson  Pren¬ 
tice  Hall.  All  rights  reserved. 


373 


Jung’s  Theory 
of  Adulthood 


BIOGRAPHICAL  INTRODUCTION 

We  have  noted  that  few  theorists  have  concerned  themselves  with 
development  during  the  adult  years.  Erikson  was  one  notable  excep¬ 
tion.  Another  was  C.  G.  Jung  (1875-1961),  whose  psychoanalytic  theory 
dealt  primarily  with  the  issues  of  adulthood  and  aging. 

Jung  was  born  in  Kesswil,  a  village  in  northeastern  Switzerland. 
His  childhood  was  mostly  unhappy.  He  experienced  the  tensions  of 
his  parents'  marital  difficulties  and  was  usually  quite  lonely.  School 
bored  him  and  even  precipitated  fainting  spells  when  he  was  12  years 
old  (Jung,  1961,  p.  30).  Because  his  father  was  a  pastor,  Jung  went  to 
church,  but  he  disliked  it  and  got  into  bitter  religious  arguments  with 
his  father.  Jung's  primary  enjoyments  during  childhood  and  adoles¬ 
cence  were  exploring  nature  and  reading  books  of  his  own  choosing — 
drama,  poetry,  history,  and  philosophy. 

Despite  his  problems,  Jung  did  well  in  high  school  and  went  on 
to  earn  a  medical  degree.  He  then  began  practicing  psychiatry  in 
Zurich,  where  he  quickly  developed  a  lasting  interest  in  psychotic  dis¬ 
orders.  Jung's  work — including  his  invention  of  the  word-association 
test — suggested  the  importance  of  Freud's  ideas.  His  colleagues  warned 
him  that  any  alignment  with  Freud  would  jeopardize  his  career,  but 
he  went  ahead  and  indicated  the  importance  of  Freud  anyway  (Jung, 
1961,  p.  148).  Freud,  of  course,  appreciated  Jung's  support,  and  when 
the  two  men  met  they  found  they  had  much  in  common.  For  some 
time,  Freud  treated  Jung  like  a  son  and  chosen  disciple.  Jung,  however, 
disagreed  with  aspects  of  Freud's  theory,  particularly  with  the  attempt 
to  reduce  all  unconscious  events  to  sexual  drives.  Jung  believed  the 
unconscious  contains  many  kinds  of  strivings,  including  religious  and 
spiritual  ones.  In  1912  Jung  decided  to  develop  his  own  ideas,  and  in 
1913  the  two  men  severed  ties. 


374 


Jung's  Theory  of  Adulthood 


After  parting  with  Freud,  Jung  lost  his  footing.  He  began  having 
uncanny,  deeply  symbolic  dreams  and  experienced  frightening  visions  dur¬ 
ing  his  waking  hours.  In  one  vision  he  saw  the  Alps  grow  and  then  saw 
mighty  yellow  waves  drown  thousands  of  people  and  turn  into  a  sea  of 
blood.  Since  World  War  I  broke  out  the  next  year,  he  believed  his  vision  car¬ 
ried  a  message  that  related  to  events  far  beyond  himself  (Jung,  1961, 
pp.  175-176). 

Jung  realized  he  was  on  the  brink  of  psychosis,  but  he  nevertheless 
decided  to  submit  to  the  unconscious — to  whatever  was  welling  up  and  call¬ 
ing  him  from  within.  It  was  his  only  chance  of  understanding  what  was  hap¬ 
pening  to  him.  Thus  he  embarked  on  a  terrifying  inner  journey  in  which  he 
frequently  felt  himself  descending  into  lower  and  lower  depths.  At  each 
region,  he  saw  archaic  symbols  and  images,  and  he  communicated  with 
demons,  ghosts,  and  strange  figures  from  the  distant  historical  past.  During 
this  period,  his  family  and  professional  practice  served  as  bases  of  support  in 
the  outer  world.  Otherwise,  he  was  certain,  the  images  welling  up  from  within 
would  have  driven  him  completely  out  of  his  mind  (1961,  p.  189). 

Gradually,  after  about  4  years,  he  began  to  find  the  goal  of  his  inner 
quest.  This  happened  when  he  increasingly  found  himself  drawing  geo¬ 
metrical  figures,  symbols  composed  of  circles  and  squares  that  he  would 
later  call  mandalas  (see  Figure  1).  The  drawings  represented  some  basic  unity 
or  wholeness,  a  path  to  the  center  of  his  being.  Jung  said  that  during  his 
psychotic  state 

I  had  to  let  myself  be  carried  along  by  the  current,  without  knowing 
where  it  would  lead  me.  When  I  began  drawing  mandalas,  however, 
I  saw  that  everything,  all  the  paths  I  had  been  following,  all  the  steps 
I  had  taken,  were  leading  back  to  a  single  point — namely  to  the  mid¬ 
point.  It  became  increasingly  clear  to  me  that  the  mandala  is  the  center. 
(1961,  p.  196) 

Thus  Jung  began  to  understand  his  break  as  a  necessary  inner  journey 
that  led  to  a  new  personal  integration.  Support  for  this,  however,  came  some 
8  years  later,  when  he  dreamed  of  a  curiously  Chinese-looking  mandala, 
and  the  next  year  he  received  a  book  in  Chinese  philosophy  that  discussed 
the  mandala  as  the  expression  of  the  unity  of  life.  Jung  then  believed  that  his 
own  experience  partook  of  an  unconscious  universal  quest  for  psychic 
wholeness. 

Jung  made  the  exploration  of  the  unconscious  and  its  symbols  the  center 
of  his  research  for  the  rest  of  his  life.  He  continually  explored  his  own  dreams 
and  fantasies  and  those  of  his  patients.  He  also  extensively  studied  the  myths 
and  art  of  numerous  cultures,  finding  in  these  productions  the  expression  of 
universal,  unconscious  yearnings  and  tensions. 


375 


Jung's  Theory  of  Adulthood 


Figure  1 

A  Tibetan  mandala. 

(Source:  Jung,  C.G.,  Collected  Works  ofC.  G.  Jung.©  1977 
Princeton  University  Press.  Reprinted  by  permission  of  Princeton 
University  Press.) 


376 


Jung's  Theory  of  Adulthood 


PERSONALITY  STRUCTURE 

Although  Jung  was  most  concerned  with  the  nature  of  the  unconscious,  he 
developed  a  theory  of  personality  that  encompasses  various  systems  of  per¬ 
sonality  functioning.  We  will  first  describe  Jung's  ideas  on  personality  struc¬ 
ture,  and  then  discuss  his  views  on  how  the  personality  develops. 

The  Ego.  The  ego  is  roughly  equivalent  to  consciousness.  It  includes 
our  awareness  of  the  external  world  as  well  as  our  consciousness  of  ourselves 
(Jung,  1933,  p.  98;  Whitmont  &  Kaufmann,  1973,  p.  93). 

The  Persona.  The  persona  is  the  ego's  mask,  the  image  we  present  to 
the  outer  world.  Our  personas  vary  with  our  roles.  People  present  one  image 
to  business  associates,  another  to  their  children.  Some  people  develop  their 
personas  to  the  exclusion  of  deeper  parts  of  the  personality.  At  some  point 
they,  or  others,  sense  there  is  little  of  substance  beneath  the  superficial  front 
(Jung,  1961,  p.  385).  It  also  is  true,  however,  that  we  need  this  part  of  the 
personality  to  deal  effectively  with  others.  It  is  often  necessary,  for  example, 
to  convey  an  image  of  confidence  and  decisiveness  if  we  want  others  to  listen 
to  us  (Jacobi,  1965,  p.  37).  To  the  extent  the  personality  is  balanced,  the  persona 
will  be  developed,  but  not  to  the  exclusion  of  other  parts. 

The  Shadow.  The  shadow  consists  of  those  traits  and  feelings  we  can¬ 
not  admit  to  ourselves.  It  is  the  opposite  of  our  ego  or  self-image;  it  is  the 
Mr.  Hyde  of  Dr.  Jekyll.  In  dreams,  the  shadow  is  projected  onto  people  of 
the  same  gender,  as  when  we  dream  about  evil  and  sadistic  people  who  are 
the  same  gender  as  ourselves.  In  our  daily  lives,  our  shadow  often  shows 
when  we  are  in  awkward  situations  and,  for  example,  suddenly  blurt  out  a 
hostile  remark  that  "doesn't  sound  like  me  at  all."  We  also  see  the  projections 
of  our  shadows  when  we  complain  about  "the  one  thing  I  cannot  stand  in 
people,"  for  such  vehemence  suggests  that  we  are  really  defending  against 
an  awareness  of  this  quality  in  ourselves  (Von  Franz,  1964,  p.  174). 

In  most  cases  the  shadow  is  largely  negative,  for  it  is  the  opposite  of 
our  positive  self-image.  However,  to  the  extent  that  our  conscious  self-image 
contains  negative  elements,  the  unconscious  shadow  will  be  positive  (Jung, 
1961,  p.  387).  A  young  woman  who  considers  herself  unattractive  may  dream 
about  a  beautiful  lady.  She  considers  this  lady  somebody  else,  but  it  may 
really  represent  her  own  beauty  wishing  to  emerge.  Whether  the  shadow  is 
positive  or  negative,  it  is  important  to  get  in  touch  with  it.  Insight  into  the 
nature  of  one's  shadow  is  the  first  step  toward  self-awareness  and  the  inte¬ 
gration  of  the  personality  (Jung,  1933,  p.  33). 

The  Anima  and  Animus.  Chinese  Taoists  speak  of  the  yin  and  the 
yang,  the  feminine  and  the  masculine  sides  of  our  personalities.  According 
to  Jung,  the  feminine  principle  includes  capacities  for  nurturance,  feeling,  and 


377 


Jung's  Theory  of  Adulthood 


art,  and  a  oneness  with  nature.  The  masculine  principle  includes  logical  think¬ 
ing,  heroic  assertion,  and  the  conquest  of  nature  (Jung,  1961,  pp.  379-380; 
Whitmont  &  Kaufmann,  1973,  p.  94).  We  are  all  biologically  bisexual,  and  we 
all  identify  with  people  of  both  genders,  so  we  all  possess  both  masculine  and 
feminine  traits.  However,  there  are  also  genetic  gender  differences,  which 
socialization  pressures  exaggerate,  forcing  women  to  overdevelop  their  fem¬ 
inine  side  and  men  to  overemphasize  their  masculine  nature.  The  result  is 
that  the  "other  side"  is  repressed  and  weak.  Men  tend  to  become  one-sidedly 
independent,  aggressive,  and  intellectual;  they  neglect  capacities  for  nurtur- 
ance  and  relatedness  to  others.  Women  develop  their  nurturant  and  feel¬ 
ing  sides  but  neglect  their  capacities  for  self-assertion  and  logical  thought. 
Nevertheless,  the  neglected  aspects  do  not  disappear  but  remain  active  and 
call  out  to  us  from  the  unconscious.  In  men,  the  feminine  side  emerges  in 
dreams  and  fantasies  as  "the  woman  within,"  the  anima.  In  women,  the  "man 
within"  is  called  the  animus  (Jung,  1961,  p.  380). 

The  Personal  Unconscious.  Jung  thought  that  the  unconscious  con¬ 
sists  of  two  layers.  The  first  is  the  personal  unconscious,  which  contains  all  the 
tendencies  and  feelings  we  have  repressed  during  our  lifetime  (p.  389).  Much 
of  the  shadow  is  in  the  personal  unconscious.  It  might  include,  for  example, 
a  man's  tender  feelings  toward  his  father  that,  as  a  child,  he  needed  to  repress. 
The  anima  and  animus  are  also  partly,  but  not  completely,  found  in  this  uncon¬ 
scious  region.  A  woman  may  have  repressed  her  experiences  of  her  father  as 
seductive — experiences  that  then  contribute  to  her  animus  and  reside  in  her 
personal  unconscious. 

The  Collective  Unconscious.  Each  individual's  personal  unconscious 
is  unique,  for  each  person  has  repressed  different  thoughts  and  feelings  dur¬ 
ing  his  or  her  lifetime.  However,  Jung  also  believed  there  exists,  at  the  deep¬ 
est  layer  of  the  psyche,  a  collective  unconscious  that  is  inherited  and  shared 
by  all  humankind.  The  collective  unconscious  is  made  up  of  innate  energy 
forces  and  organizing  tendencies  called  archetypes  (see  Figure  2).  We  can  never 
know  the  archetypes  directly,  but  we  can  learn  about  them  through  arche¬ 
typal  images  found  in  the  myths,  art,  dreams,  and  fantasies  of  peoples 
throughout  the  world.  Through  these  images,  people  try  to  express  their  deep¬ 
est  inner  yearnings  and  unconscious  tendencies.  They  include  the  image  of  the 
Earth  Mother,  the  wise  old  woman,  the  wise  old  man,  animals,  rebirth,  death, 
the  trickster,  the  witch,  and  God. 

The  archetypes  also  influence  the  nature  and  growth  of  the  other  parts 
of  the  personality.  For  example,  a  woman's  animus  results  not  only  from  her 
experiences  with  her  father  and  other  men  but  also  from  unconscious  male 
aggressive  energies  that  may  appear  in  dreams  as  wild  beasts. 

Different  cultures  express  archetypal  themes  in  somewhat  different  ways, 
but  humans  everywhere  have  always  been  fascinated  and  impressed  by  them. 


378 


Jung's  Theory  of  Adulthood 


Outer  World 
Persona 


Figure  2 

The  psyche  in  Jung's  theory. 


Jung  said. 

The  concept  of  the  archetype  ...  is  derived  from  the  repeated  observa¬ 
tion  that,  for  instance,  the  myths  and  fairytales  of  world  literature  con¬ 
tain  definite  motifs  which  crop  up  everywhere.  We  meet  these  same 
motifs  in  the  fantasies,  dreams,  deliria,  and  delusions  of  individuals 
living  today.  .  .  .  They  have  their  origin  in  the  archetype,  which  in  itself 
is  an  irrepresentable  unconscious,  pre-existent  form  that  seems  to  be 
part  of  the  inherited  structure  of  the  psyche  and  can  therefore  manifest 
itself  spontaneously  anywhere,  at  any  time.  (1961,  p.  380) 

Although  Jung  said  archetypes  are  essentially  unknowable,  he  also  likened 
them  to  instincts  in  animals — for  example,  a  bird's  innate  schema  of  the  parent 
(Jung,  1964,  p.  58).  Perhaps  archetypes  can  also  be  likened  to  the  innate  per¬ 
ceptual  tendencies  Gestalt  psychologists  talk  about  (Arnheim,  1954;  R.  Watson, 
1968,  chap.  19).  For  example,  we  may  have  an  inner  sense  of  what  constitutes 
a  harmonious  form.  Mandalas  probably  strike  us  as  beautiful  because  they 
correspond  to  our  senses  of  proportion,  balance,  and  good  organization. 

The  Self.  The  most  important  archetype  is  that  of  the  Self,  our  uncon¬ 
scious  striving  for  centeredness,  wholeness,  and  meaning  (Jung,  1961,  p.  386). 
The  Self  is  an  inner  urge  to  balance  and  reconcile  the  opposing  aspects  of  our 
personalities.  It  is  represented  throughout  the  world  in  drawings  of  man¬ 
dalas,  figures  in  which  all  sides  are  perfectly  balanced  around  a  center  point. 
The  Self  is  also  expressed  by  our  search  for  God,  the  symbol  of  wholeness  and 
ultimate  meaning  (p.  382). 


379 


Jung's  Theory  of  Adulthood 


Introversion  and  Extroversion.  Although  the  Self  is  the  ultimate  goal 
in  life,  no  one  ever  fully  attains  it.  We  all  develop  in  one-sided  ways.  Most  of 
us,  for  example,  develop  our  consciousness  and  neglect  our  unconscious  lives. 
Women  neglect  their  masculine  side,  and  men  neglect  their  feminine  side. 
Jung  developed  other  concepts  to  describe  opposite  tendencies,  of  which 
we  develop  one  to  the  exclusion  of  the  other.  One  such  polarity  is  introversion- 
extroversion.  The  extrovert  confidently  engages  in  direct  action;  the  introvert 
hesitates  and  reflects  on  what  may  happen.  At  a  party,  an  extroverted  young 
woman  immediately  walks  over  to  others  and  strikes  up  a  conversation  with 
them.  The  introverted  woman  hesitates;  she  is  caught  up  in  her  inner  state,  her 
fears,  hopes,  and  feelings.  The  extrovert  moves  outward,  toward  the  world; 
the  introvert  is  more  secure  in  his  or  her  inner  world  and  takes  more  pleasure 
in  activities  such  as  reading  and  art.  We  all  have  both  tendencies  but  are 
predisposed  toward  one,  leaving  the  other  underdeveloped  and  unconscious 
(Jung,  1945). 


THEORY  OF  DEVELOPMENT 
The  First  Half  of  Life 

The  personality  develops  along  different  lines  during  the  first  and  second 
halves  of  the  life  cycle.  The  first  period,  until  the  age  of  35  or  40,  is  a  time 
of  outward  expansion.  Maturational  forces  direct  the  growth  of  the  ego  and 
the  unfolding  of  capacities  for  dealing  with  the  external  world.  Young  people 
learn  to  get  along  with  others  and  try  to  win  as  many  of  society's  rewards 
as  possible.  They  establish  careers  and  families,  and  they  do  what  they  can 
to  advance  up  the  social  ladder  of  success.  To  do  so,  women  usually  expe¬ 
rience  social  pressure  to  develop  their  feminine  traits,  and  men  their  mas¬ 
culine  traits. 

During  this  phase,  Jung  thought,  a  certain  degree  of  one-sidedness  is 
necessary;  young  people  need  to  dedicate  themselves  to  the  mastery  of  the 
outer  world.  It  is  not  especially  advantageous  for  young  people  to  be  too 
preoccupied  with  their  self-doubts,  fantasies,  and  inner  natures  (Jung,  1933, 
p.  109);  their  task  is  to  meet  the  demands  of  the  external  environment  con¬ 
fidently  and  assertively.  As  we  can  imagine,  extroverts,  rather  than  introverts, 
have  an  easier  time  of  it  during  this  period  (Jacobi,  1965,  p.  42). 


The  Midlife  Crisis 

At  about  age  40  the  psyche  begins  to  undergo  a  transformation.  The  individ¬ 
ual  feels  that  the  goals  and  ambitions  that  once  seemed  so  eternal  have  lost 
their  meaning.  Quite  often  the  person  feels  depressed,  stagnant,  and  incom¬ 
plete,  as  if  something  crucial  is  missing.  Jung  observed  that  this  happens  even 


380 


Jung's  Theory  of  Adulthood 


among  people  who  have  achieved  a  good  measure  of  social  success,  for  "the 
achievements  which  society  rewards  are  won  at  the  cost  of  a  diminution  of 
personality.  Many — far  too  many — aspects  of  life  which  should  have  been 
experienced  lie  in  the  lumber-room  among  dusty  memories"  (1933,  p.  104). 

The  psyche  itself  provides  the  way  out  of  this  crisis.  It  urges  the  person 
to  turn  inward  and  examine  the  meaning  of  his  or  her  life.  This  turning  inward 
is  prompted  by  the  unconscious,  the  region  in  which  all  the  repressed  and 
unlived  aspects  of  the  self  have  grown  and  now  clamor  to  be  heard.  The 
unconscious  calls  out  for  recognition  in  order  to  bring  about  psychic  balance 
and  harmony  (1933,  pp.  17-18,  62-63). 

The  unconscious  speaks  to  us  primarily  through  dreams.  For  example, 
early  in  his  analysis,  a  man  who  was  depressed  and  felt  that  his  life  was  mean¬ 
ingless  had  the  following  dream: 

I  am  standing  totally  perplexed,  in  the  midst  of  a  Casbah-like  city  with 
serpentine  and  winding  small  streets,  not  knowing  where  to  turn.  Sud¬ 
denly  I  see  a  young,  mysterious  woman  whom  I  had  never  seen  before, 
pointing  with  her  hand  the  direction  out.  It  had  a  very  awesome  quality 
to  it.  (Whitmont  &  Kaufmann,  1973,  p.  95) 

The  dream's  message  is  that  the  man  must  pay  attention  to  his  anima  (the 
mysterious  young  woman)  for  the  direction  out  of  his  impasse.  For  it  is  this 
side  of  himself  that  he  has  so  far  failed  to  appreciate  and  develop. 

As  adults  examine  their  lives  and  listen  to  unconscious  messages,  they 
sooner  or  later  encounter  images  of  the  Self,  the  symbols  of  wholeness  and 
centeredness.  For  example,  a  middle-aged  man,  a  highly  successful  execu¬ 
tive  who  had  been  increasingly  experiencing  tension  and  a  suicidal  depres¬ 
sion,  had  a  dream  in  which  a  water  devil  attacked  him  and  maneuvered  him 
to  the  edge  of  an  abyss.  The  creature  then  rescued  him  and  gave  him  a  drill, 
which  the  dreamer  was  supposed  to  use  to  dig  to  the  center  of  the  earth.  In 
Jungian  terms,  the  dream's  key  figure,  the  water  devil,  is  initially  evil,  for  it 
represents  elements  in  the  unconscious  that  the  conscious  ego  has  considered 
inadmissible — destructive  urges.  Yet  the  devil  turns  into  a  helper,  indicating 
that  the  man  must  confront  the  negative  aspects  of  himself  if  he  is  ever  to 
become  whole  and  find  his  true  center  (Whitmont,  1969,  pp.  224-225). 

As  the  dream  continued,  the  man  found  himself  in  a  secret  chamber 
where  a  meeting  was  in  progress  around  a  square  table.  Presiding  were  a 
splendid  knight  and  a  Lord  Mayor.  However,  the  dreamer  was  led  to  the  table 
by  a  delinquent  boy  and  a  dirty,  tramp  like  man  who  looked  like  a  friar.  They 
sat  at  the  table  and  gave  him  some  repulsive  food,  which  he  ate  anyway.  He 
then  pushed  his  drill  into  the  ground,  and  flowers  grew  around  the  drill,  and 
the  drill  was  transformed  into  a  blossoming  tree. 

According  to  a  Jungian  analysis,  the  splendid  knight  and  the  Mayor  rep¬ 
resent  the  heroic  and  authoritative  aspects  of  the  personality  that  the  man  had 


381 


Jung's  Theory  of  Adulthood 


consciously  realized  as  a  business  administrator.  The  delinquent  and  the  ragged 
friar  stand  for  the  neglected,  devalued  aspects  of  the  self — elements  he  has  so 
far  repressed.  In  particular,  this  man  had  regarded  his  religious  inclinations  as 
soft  and  escapist,  as  tendencies  that  would  undermine  his  manhood.  But  it  is 
the  monk  and  the  delinquent — repressed  shadow  figures — who  lead  him  to 
the  square  table,  the  symbol  of  psychic  unity.  There  he  eats  repulsive  food — 
for  no  one  likes  looking  into  the  repressed  parts  of  the  personality — but  in  so 
doing  he  sees  that  new  growth  (the  blossoming  tree)  will  emerge  (Whitmont, 
1969,  pp.  224-227). 

You  will  notice  that  the  Jungian  approach  to  dreams  differs  from  that 
of  the  Freudians.  Freud  considered  dreams  to  be  the  end  products  of  dis¬ 
tortion  and  disguise.  Jung,  in  contrast,  believed  that  dreams  express  uncon¬ 
scious  meanings  fairly  directly  (Jung,  1933,  p.  13).  In  the  dream  just  cited, 
the  delinquent  and  the  monk  are  interpreted,  quite  literally,  as  symbols  for 
the  delinquent  and  religious  aspects  of  the  personality.  Further,  the  uncon¬ 
scious,  the  source  of  dreams,  is  not  just  a  seething  pit  of  base  impulses  and 
desires,  as  it  was  for  Freud.  Rather,  the  unconscious,  as  a  part  of  nature,  can 
be  a  creative  force,  directing  us  out  of  our  current  stalemates,  as  the  above 
dreams  illustrate.  Dreams  tell  us  which  aspects  of  the  personality  we  have 
neglected  and  must  get  in  touch  with  (Jung,  1933,  pp.  62-63).  This  does  not 
mean  we  should  actually  live  out  our  evil  tendencies.  But  it  does  mean  we 
should  learn  about  them,  so  we  can  control  them,  rather  than  the  other  way 
around  (Whitmont,  1969,  pp.  227-230). 

The  road  toward  health  and  growth — toward  the  unattainable  goal  of  the 
Self — is  called  individuation  (Jung,  1933,  p.  26).  Individuation  involves  not  only 
achieving  a  measure  of  psychic  balance  but  also  separating  ourselves  from 
our  ordinary  conformity  to  the  goals  and  values  of  the  mass  culture.  It  means 
finding  one's  individual  way.  Each  person's  true  nature  partakes  of  universal 
archetypes,  but  it  is  also  based  on  unique  experiences  and  potentials  that  must 
be  discovered  (Jung,  1961,  p.  383;  Jacobi,  1965,  pp.  83-87). 

The  middle  of  life,  then,  is  marked  by  a  transformation  in  the  psyche.  We 
are  prompted  to  begin  turning  our  energy  away  from  the  mastery  of  the  exter¬ 
nal  world  and  to  begin  focusing  on  our  inner  selves.  We  feel  inner  urgings  to 
listen  to  the  unconscious  to  learn  about  the  potentials  we  have  so  far  left  unre¬ 
alized.  We  begin  to  raise  questions  about  the  meaning  of  our  lives,  which, 
after  all,  are  now  half  over. 

Although  the  focus  from  middle  age  onward  becomes  increasingly 
inward,  the  middle-aged  adult  still  has  the  energy  and  resources  for  making 
changes  in  his  or  her  external  situation.  In  middle  age,  adults  quite  often  take 
up  long-neglected  projects  and  interests  and  even  make  seemingly  incom¬ 
prehensible  career  changes.  Men  and  women,  Jung  observed  (1933,  p.  108), 
begin  giving  expression  to  their  opposite  sexual  sides.  Men  become  less 
aggressively  ambitious  and  become  more  concerned  with  interpersonal  rela¬ 
tionships.  As  an  older  colleague  once  told  me,  "As  you  get  older  you  find  that 


382 


Jung's  Theory  of  Adulthood 


achievement  counts  for  less  and  friendship  counts  for  far  more."  Women,  in 
contrast,  become  more  aggressive  and  independent.  If,  for  example,  a  man 
loses  interest  in  the  family  business,  the  wife  may  willingly  take  it  over.  The 
woman,  like  the  man,  is  becoming  increasingly  inner  directed  as  she  ages,  but 
her  enthusiasm  for  aggressive  pursuits  may  temporarily  counterbalance  or 
stall  this  general  inner  orientation. 

The  changes  of  life  in  middle  age  can  create  marital  problems.  A  wife 
might  tire  of  her  husband's  intellectual  condescension,  for  she  will  no  longer 
restrain  her  own  thinking  side.  The  husband  may  feel  oppressed  by  his  wife's 
tendency  to  treat  him  emotionally  like  a  child.  He  no  longer  simply  wants  to 
be  calmed  and  pampered  for  his  moodiness,  but  he  wants  to  explore  the  realm 
of  feelings  and  relationships  in  a  more  mature  manner.  Changes  such  as  these 
can  disturb  the  marital  equilibrium  (Jung,  1931). 

Although  growth  during  the  second  half  of  life  creates  tensions  and  dif¬ 
ficulties,  the  greatest  failures  come  when  adults  cling  to  the  goals  and  values 
of  the  first  half  of  life  (Jung,  1933,  p.  109).  Middle-aged  people  may  try  des¬ 
perately  to  maintain  the  attractiveness  of  their  youth  or  may  talk  incessantly 
about  their  past  athletic  glories.  In  such  cases,  adults  miss  out  on  further  devel¬ 
opment,  which  can  emerge  only  when  they  risk  a  confrontation  with  the 
neglected  parts  of  themselves. 

Old  Age 

Jung  said  that  "with  increasing  age,  contemplation,  and  reflection,  the  inner 
images  naturally  play  an  ever  greater  part  in  man's  life.  ...  In  old  age  one 
begins  to  let  memories  unroll  before  the  mind's  eye''  (1961,  p.  320).  The  old 
person  tries  to  understand  the  nature  of  life  in  the  face  of  death  (p.  309). 

Jung  believed  we  cannot  face  death  in  a  healthy  way  unless  we  have 
some  image  of  the  hereafter.  If  "I  live  in  a  house  which  I  know  will  fall  about 
my  head  within  the  next  two  weeks,  all  my  vital  functions  will  be  impaired 
by  this  thought;  but  if  on  the  contrary  I  feel  myself  to  be  safe,  I  can  dwell 
there  in  a  normal  and  comfortable  way"  (Jung,  1933,  p.  112).  When  Jung  rec¬ 
ommended  that  the  aged  entertain  thoughts  of  an  afterlife,  he  did  not  feel 
that  he  was  simply  prescribing  some  artificial  tranquilizer.  He  believed  that 
the  unconscious  itself  has  an  archetype  of  eternity  that  wells  up  from  within 
as  death  nears. 

Jung  could  not  say,  of  course,  whether  our  archetypal  image  of  the  here¬ 
after  is  valid,  but  he  believed  it  is  a  vital  part  of  psychic  functioning,  and  he 
therefore  tried  to  get  some  picture  of  it.  He  based  his  picture  on  his  own  last 
dreams  and  those  of  others  near  death.  The  archetypal  image  of  eternity,  in 
Jung's  view,  is  not  of  some  hedonistic  paradise.  Instead,  he  pictured  the  souls 
of  the  dead  to  be  like  a  spellbound  audience  listening  to  a  lecture,  seeking 
information  from  the  newly  deceased  on  the  meaning  of  life.  Apparently  they 
know  only  what  they  knew  at  the  moment  of  death — "hence  their  endeavor 


383 


Jung's  Theory  of  Adulthood 


to  penetrate  into  life  in  order  to  share  in  the  knowledge  of  men.  I  frequently 
have  the  feeling  that  they  are  standing  directly  behind  us,  waiting  to  hear 
what  answer  we  will  give  them,  and  what  answer  to  destiny"  (Jung,  1961, 
p.  308).  They  continue  to  strive  to  attain  in  death  that  share  of  awareness  they 
failed  to  win  in  life. 

In  Jung's  view,  then,  life  after  death  is  a  continuation  of  life  itself.  The 
dead,  like  the  aged,  continue  to  struggle  with  the  questions  of  existence;  they 
wonder  what  it  is  that  makes  a  life  whole  and  gives  it  meaning — they  search, 
in  Erikson's  term,  for  integrity. 


PRACTICAL  IMPLICATIONS 

As  with  the  Freudians,  Jung's  theory  is  inseparable  from  its  practical  applica¬ 
tions.  Much  of  Jung's  theory  came  out  of  his  work  with  patients  who  helped  him 
understand  the  nature  of  the  unconscious  and  the  kinds  of  experiences  that 
were  necessary  to  integrate  their  lives.  Jungian  psychoanalysis  is  most  applic¬ 
able  to  adults  and  older  people.  In  fact,  over  two  thirds  of  Jung's  own  clients 
were  in  the  second  half  of  their  lives  (Whitmont  &  Kaufmann,  1973,  p.  110). 

Jung's  ideas  would  also  seem  of  value  even  to  those  who  never  find 
their  way  to  the  analyst's  office.  Most  adults,  at  one  time  or  another,  proba¬ 
bly  experience  the  special  problems  that  come  with  growing  older.  Some 
knowledge  of  the  kinds  of  changes  that  typically  occur  may  help  them  get 
their  bearings.  For  this  reason,  adults  seem  to  derive  benefits  from  a  book 
such  as  Passages  (Sheehy,  1976),  which  discusses  the  expectable  crises  of 
adulthood.  Since  this  book  popularizes  ideas  of  Fevinson  (1977, 1978),  and 
Fevinson,  in  turn,  owes  much  to  Jung,  we  ultimately  may  find  the  deepest 
rewards  from  Jung  himself. 

Jung's  relevance  for  psychology  and  psychiatry  extends  beyond  his  spe¬ 
cial  insights  into  adult  development.  Because  he  considered  religious  questions 
vital  and  meaningful  in  their  own  right,  ministers,  priests,  and  others,  who 
themselves  must  often  work  with  emotionally  distressed  people,  have  found 
that  Jung  provides  a  valuable  bridge  between  the  religious  and  psychiatric 
professions. 

Jung's  writings,  furthermore,  anticipated  bold  thinking  on  the  nature  of 
psychotic  disorders,  especially  the  thinking  of  R.  D.  Faing  (1967).  Faing  argued 
that  it  is  wrong  to  view  psychotic  experiences  as  simply  abnormal  and  bizarre. 
This  attitude  characterizes  technological  cultures  that  refuse  to  admit  the  valid¬ 
ity  of  the  inner  world  and,  instead,  make  outer  adjustment  the  sole  objective. 
Faing  contended  that  the  psychotic  experience,  for  all  its  pain,  can  be  a 
meaningful  inner  voyage  and  a  healing  process.  In  this  voyage,  the  therapist 
can  serve  as  a  guide,  helping  the  patient  understand  his  or  her  inner  symbols. 
Jung's  view  was  somewhat  similar,  and  a  knowledge  of  Jung  would  seem 
essential  for  anyone  who  wishes  to  understand  psychosis. 


384 


Jung's  Theory  of  Adulthood 


EVALUATION 

Jung  occupies  an  unusual  place  in  contemporary  psychology.  For  many 
psychologists  his  ideas  are  too  mystical.  He  not  only  posited  a  collective 
unconscious  but  he  also  believed  in  ESP  and  related  phenomena  (e.g.,  Jung, 
1961,  p.  190).  Sometimes,  in  addition,  he  seemed  unnecessarily  determined 
to  keep  his  concepts  shrouded  in  mystery.  For  example,  he  said  that  the  arche¬ 
types  are  unknowable,  yet  he  compared  them  to  instincts  in  animals — a  topic 
certainly  open  to  scientific  investigation. 

Jung  also  annoys  scholars  by  his  use  of  categories.  In  particular,  feminists — 
even  Jungian  feminists — note  that  Jung  sometimes  wrote  about  his  feminine 
and  masculine  categories  as  if  they  were  essential  truths.  It  would  have  been 
better  if  he  had  handled  the  concepts  more  tentatively,  recognizing  that  they 
are  just  ways  of  describing  tendencies.  Indeed,  Susan  Rowland  (2002,  p.  41) 
points  out  that  a  more  tentative  approach  to  gender  concepts  would  corre¬ 
spond  to  the  fluid  androgyny  of  many  archetypal  images. 

Despite  these  problems,  psychologists  in  general,  and  developmentalists 
in  particular,  increasingly  recognize  the  importance  of  Jung's  ideas.  Devel¬ 
opmentalists,  as  we  have  seen,  have  long  been  concerned  with  how  we  seem 
to  lose  so  much  of  ourselves  and  our  potentials  as  we  become  socialized,  as 
we  become  adjusted  to  the  external  world.  Jung  agreed  this  happens,  but  he 
saw  new  opportunities  for  individual  growth  in  the  adult  years. 

Moreover,  some  very  significant  empirical  research  lends  support  to 
Jung's  ideas.  In  a  major  study  of  adult  men,  Daniel  Levinson  (1977,  1978) 
interpreted  his  findings  in  a  Jungian  context.  Levinson  found  that  the  vast 
majority  of  his  subjects  underwent  a  crisis  at  about  age  40  or  45,  during 
which  they  began  to  experience  "internal  voices  that  have  been  silent  or 
muted  for  years  and  now  clamor  to  be  heard"  (1977,  p.  108).  Levinson  con¬ 
cluded  that  the  life  structure  of  the  30s  necessarily  gives  high  priority  to  cer¬ 
tain  aspects  of  the  self,  those  oriented  toward  social  adjustment  and 
achievement.  But  in  the  40s,  "the  neglected  parts  of  the  self  urgently  seek 
expression  and  stimulate  a  man  to  reappraise  his  life"  (p.  108).  In  a  follow¬ 
up  study,  Levinson  (1996)  reported  that  for  women,  too,  middle  age  is  a 
period  in  which  the  individual  becomes  dissatisfied  with  outer  roles  and 
wants  to  make  new  connections  to  the  inner  self. 

The  studies  of  Bernice  Neugarten  and  her  colleagues  at  the  University 
of  Chicago  also  lend  support  to  Jung's  insights.  Neugarten  reports  that  for  both 
genders,  the  40s  and  50s  mark  a  "movement  of  energy  away  from  an  outer- 
world  to  an  inner-world  orientation"  (1964,  p.  201).  Introspection,  contempla¬ 
tion,  and  self-evaluation  increasingly  become  characteristic  forms  of  mental 
life  (Neugarten,  1968,  p.  140).  Furthermore,  men  "become  more  receptive  to 
their  own  affiliative,  nurturant,  and  sensual  promptings;  while  women  seem 
to  become  more  responsive  toward,  and  less  guilty  about,  their  own  aggressive, 
egocentric  impulses"  (Neugarten,  1964,  p.  199).  Some  cross-cultural  research 


385 


Jung's  Theory  of  Adulthood 


suggests  these  shifts  may  become  even  more  common  and  pronounced  in  old 
age  (Gutman,  1987).  Thus  the  work  of  Neugarten  and  her  associates,  like  that 
of  Levinson,  supports  some  of  the  personality  changes  Jung  outlined. 

These  shifts,  it  is  important  to  note,  seem  to  occur  consistently  before 
external  situations  demand  them  (Havighurst,  Neugarten,  &  Tobin,  1968, 
p.  167).  Adults  seem  to  turn  inward  before  they  might  be  forced  to  do  so  by 
external  losses,  such  as  retirement,  reduced  income,  or  the  loss  of  a  spouse. 
There  seems  to  be  an  intrinsic  developmental  process  at  work.  Adults  may 
have  an  inherent  need  to  take  stock,  to  resist  the  pressures  of  conventional 
roles,  and  to  concern  themselves  with  the  neglected  and  unrealized  aspects 
of  the  personality. 


386 


Humanistic  Psychology 
and  Developmental 

Theory 


In  this  chapter,  we  will  discuss  the  emergence  of  humanistic  psychology 
and  indicate  the  extent  to  which  developmental  theorists  have  shared  the 
humanists'  concerns. 


HUMANISTIC  PSYCHOLOGY 

Psychology  and  the  Humanistic  Revolt 

For  centuries,  psychology  was  a  topic  within  philosophy.  The  term 
psychology  derives  from  the  Greek  word  psyche,  which  means  soul  or 
life  principle.  But  many  Western  philosophers,  especially  since  the  16th 
century,  were  actually  more  interested  in  what  we  would  today  call  the 
mind.  They  discussed  how  people  perceive  objects,  form  memories, 
associate  ideas,  and  make  judgments  (Gregory,  1987;  Munn  et  al.,  1974). 

Psychology  began  to  separate  from  philosophy  in  the  later  part  of 
the  19th  century,  when  Wilhelm  Wundt  tried  to  make  psychology  a 
scientific  discipline.  Wundt  and  his  colleagues  deeply  admired  the 
accomplishments  of  physics,  chemistry,  and  the  other  natural  sciences. 
They  felt  that  if  psychology  could  only  follow  in  the  example  of  these 
sciences,  it  also  could  accomplish  great  things.  Psychology,  too,  should 
strive  for  the  objective,  quantitative  measurement  of  isolated  variables 
and  the  formulation  of  abstract  laws.  Wundt  tried  to  analyze  con¬ 
sciousness  into  its  basic  elements,  just  like  physicists  and  chemists  had 
done  with  respect  to  matter,  and  he  inspired  numerous  researchers  to 
adopt  his  approach. 

After  a  few  decades,  however,  the  investigations  of  consciousness 
seemed  to  lose  their  promise.  By  the  end  of  the  1920s,  the  scientific 
banner  had  been  taken  over  by  another  group,  the  behaviorists. 

From  Theories  of  Development:  Concepts  and  Applications,  Sixth  Edition.  William 
Crain.  Copyright  ©  2011  by  Pearson  Education,  Inc.  Published  by  Pearson 
Prentice  Hall.  All  rights  reserved. 


387 


Humanistic  Psychology  and  Developmental  Theory 


The  behaviorists  argued  we  should  confine  ourselves  to  the  measure¬ 
ment  of  overt  behavior  and  the  way  it  is  controlled  by  the  observable  stimuli 
in  the  external  environment.  Mental  processes,  they  said,  cannot  be  directly 
observed  and  therefore  have  no  place  in  scientific  psychology;  to  study  them 
just  opens  psychology  back  up  to  souls  and  all  kinds  of  mysticism  (Heidbreder, 
1933,  p.  235).  What's  more,  the  behaviorists  pointed  out,  the  study  of  overt 
behavior  and  environmental  control  has  enormous  practical  value.  As  we  have 
seen,  the  behaviorists  have  introduced  a  variety  of  techniques — a  "technology 
of  behavior"  (Skinner,  1971,  p.  3) — to  improve  learning  and  to  alleviate  fears, 
temper  tantrums,  and  other  problems.  Skinner  even  wrote  a  novel,  Walden  Two 
(1948),  which  described  the  way  one  could  create  a  total  environment  to  pro¬ 
duce  greater  human  happiness. 

Early  on,  however,  some  psychologists  had  misgivings  about  the 
behavioristic  brand  of  science.  During  the  first  half  of  the  20th  century, 
Gordon  Allport,  Carl  Rogers,  Abraham  Maslow,  and  others  argued  that 
behaviorism,  whatever  its  merits,  was  producing  a  very  one-sided  picture 
of  human  nature.  Humans,  they  argued,  do  not  consist  of  only  overt 
responses,  nor  are  they  completely  controlled  by  the  external  environment. 
People  also  grow,  think,  feel,  dream,  create,  and  do  many  other  things  that 
make  up  the  human  experience.  The  behaviorists  and  others,  in  their  emu¬ 
lation  of  the  physical  sciences,  were  ignoring  most  aspects  of  life  that  make 
humans  unique  and  give  them  dignity.  These  humanists  were  not  at  all 
opposed  to  scientific  investigation,  but  they  argued  that  psychology  should 
address  itself  to  the  full  range  of  human  experience,  not  just  the  aspects  that 
are  most  readily  measurable  and  under  environmental  control.  For  some 
time,  these  writers  were  calling  out  in  the  wilderness;  their  views  were  far 
removed  from  the  mainstream  in  U.S.  psychology.  But  in  the  1950s  their 
writings  began  to  attract  increasing  attention,  and  a  humanistic  movement 
in  psychology  was  born  (Misiak  &  Sexton,  1973,  pp.  108-109). 

Modern  humanistic  psychology,  then,  developed  primarily  in  reaction 
to  behavioristically  oriented  approaches.  Humanistic  psychology's  relation¬ 
ship  to  the  second  main  branch  of  psychology,  psychoanalysis,  has  been  more 
ambivalent.  Many  humanists  have  appreciated  the  psychoanalytic  attempt  to 
explore  the  inner  world  at  its  deepest  levels.  However,  humanists  have  also 
felt  the  psychoanalysts  have  been  too  pessimistic  about  human  capacities  for 
growth  and  free  choice.  Whereas  the  behaviorists  have  seen  people  as  exclu¬ 
sively  controlled  by  the  external  environment,  psychoanalysts  have  viewed 
people  as  dominated  by  irrational  forces  in  the  unconscious.  Perhaps,  human¬ 
ists  have  suggested,  psychoanalytic  theory  has  been  too  colored  by  the  study 
of  patients  with  crippling  emotional  disorders.  Humanists  have  proposed  that 
people,  to  a  much  greater  extent  than  has  been  realized,  are  free  and  creative 
beings,  capable  of  growth  and  self-actualization  (Maslow,  1962,  pp.  189-197). 

The  humanistic  psychology  movement  that  started  gaining  momentum 
in  the  1950s,  then,  was  a  reaction  against  two  mainstream  forces:  behaviorism 


388 


Humanistic  Psychology  and  Developmental  Theory 


and  psychoanalysis.  Because  of  this,  one  of  the  movement's  leaders,  Abraham 
Maslow,  dubbed  humanistic  psychology  "The  Third  Force"  (1962,  p.  ix).  Since 
the  1970s,  however,  the  psychological  mainstream  has  increasingly  moved  in 
a  new  direction,  turning  its  attention  to  cognitive  processes. 

The  cognitive  revolution  was  largely  inspired  by  advances  in  com¬ 
puter  technology.  Psychologists,  like  people  everywhere,  were  enormously 
impressed  by  the  achievements  of  high-speed  computers,  and  they  quickly 
saw  similarities  between  computers  and  human  thinking.  Both  computers 
and  humans,  psychologists  noted,  encode,  store,  and  retrieve  information, 
and  psychologists  began  thinking  of  the  mind  itself  as  an  "information¬ 
processing  device."  Behaviorists,  too,  have  increasingly  included  cognitive 
variables  in  their  theories,  and  computer-inspired  models  of  human  intel¬ 
ligence  have  captured  the  interest  of  scholars  in  a  wide  variety  of  academic 
disciplines.  Philosophers,  mathematicians,  linguists,  computer  scientists, 
and  neurologists  have  all  joined  the  cognitive  psychologists,  working  under 
the  banner  of  "cognitive  science."  Some  scholars,  to  be  sure,  have  stuck 
more  closely  to  computer  models  than  others,  but  the  general  upshot  has 
been  a  great  emphasis  on  the  kinds  of  thinking  that  computers  facilitate — 
thinking  that  is  rational  and  task  oriented.  Many  of  today's  top  scholars 
assume  that  we  think  best  when  we  clearly  define  the  task,  select  strate¬ 
gies  for  solving  it,  avoid  distractions,  and  self-consciously  monitor  our 
progress  each  step  of  the  way  (see,  for  example,  Palinscar  &  Brown,  1989; 
Siegler  &  Alibali,  2005;  Wood,  1998). 

But  to  humanistic  psychologists,  the  new  cognitive  models  are  nearly 
as  one-sided  as  the  old  behaviorism.  Cognitive  models  describe  thinking  as  a 
highly  rational  and  cerebral  affair.  They  leave  little  room  for  the  emotional 
aspects  of  thinking — for  empathy,  wonder,  imagination,  and  inspiration.  The 
new  models  also  leave  out  the  kinds  of  experience  that  phenomenologists 
highlight — the  immediate  experience  of  the  world  just  at  it  reveals  itself  to 
us,  before  we  put  it  into  mental  categories  (including  the  categories  that  allow 
it  to  be  processed  as  data  by  a  computational  machine). 

To  recap,  psychology  means  the  study  of  the  soul,  but  most  19th-century 
scientific  psychologists  were  more  interested  in  the  workings  of  the  mind. 
Then,  in  the  early  20th  century,  behaviorism  became  the  dominant  force  and 
discouraged  the  study  of  the  mind.  This  sequence  of  events  prompted  the 
joke,  "First  psychology  lost  its  soul.  Then  it  lost  its  mind"  (Munn  et  al., 
1974,  p.  187). 

But  since  the  1970s,  psychology  has  returned  its  full  attention  to  the  study 
of  cognitive  processes;  it  has  clearly  regained  its  mind.  Now  the  challenge  for 
humanistic  psychology  is  to  somehow  stimulate  mainstream  psychology  to 
regain  its  soul,  in  the  sense  of  paying  attention  to  inner  feelings,  creative 
promptings,  and  a  sense  of  the  wonder  of  life. 

To  get  a  fuller  understanding  of  humanistic  psychology,  let's  look  briefly 
at  the  life  and  work  of  the  man  who  is  considered  its  father,  Abraham  Maslow. 


389 


Humanistic  Psychology  and  Developmental  Theory 


Maslow 

Biographical  Introduction.  Abraham  Maslow  (1908-1970)  was  born 
in  Brooklyn,  New  York,  the  son  of  poor  Russian  immigrant  parents.  He  was 
a  shy,  unhappy  boy.  Although  he  liked  high  school,  he  had  trouble  adjusting 
to  college.  He  attended  the  City  College  of  New  York,  Cornell  University,  and 
finally  the  University  of  Wisconsin,  where  he  earned  his  B.A.  and  stayed  on 
for  graduate  work  in  psychology.  Maslow  began  his  career  squarely  within  the 
scientific  mainstream.  He  received  rigorous  experimental  training  under 
E.  L.  Thorndike  and  Harry  Harlow  and  wrote  a  standard  textbook  on  abnor¬ 
mal  psychology  (Wilson,  1972,  pp.  115-134).  In  fact,  Maslow  said  that  early  in 
his  career  he  was  sold  on  behaviorism  (Goble,  1970,  p.  11)  and  in  a  sense  he 
never  repudiated  it;  he  always  realized  that  people  are  subject  to  condition¬ 
ing  from  the  external  environment.  What  increasingly  annoyed  him  was 
behaviorism's  one-sidedness;  people  also  have  an  inner  life  and  potentials 
for  growth,  creativity,  and  free  choice. 

Maslow  taught  at  Brooklyn  College  from  1937  to  1951  and  at  Brandeis 
University  from  1951  to  1969.  During  his  career,  he  also  saw  clients  as  a  clin¬ 
ical  psychologist  and  even  spent  a  summer  doing  anthropological  fieldwork 
among  the  Blackfoot  Indians  in  Alberta,  Canada  (Goble,  1970,  p.  12). 
Maslow's  colleagues  have  described  him  as  full  of  curiosity  and  wonder, 
chuckling  warmly  over  new  ideas  (Manuel,  1972).  As  his  work  developed, 
it  became  increasingly  broad  and  inclusive.  He  wanted  psychology  to  go 
beyond  rational  science  and  incorporate  various  ways  of  knowing,  includ¬ 
ing  those  of  Eastern  philosophies.  Thus,  although  Maslow  died  in  1970, 
before  the  cognitive  revolution  really  got  under  way,  he  spelled  out  alter¬ 
natives  to  the  rational,  task-oriented  model  of  thinking  that  dominates 
cognitive  theory. 

Maslow’s  Ideas.  Maslow's  first  step  in  the  direction  of  a  humanistic 
psychology  was  the  formulation  of  a  new  theory  of  motivation  (1943).  Accord¬ 
ing  to  this  theory,  there  are  six  kinds  of  needs:  physiological  needs,  safety 
needs,  belongingness  needs,  love  needs,  self-esteem  needs,  and,  at  the  high¬ 
est  level,  self-actualization  needs.  These  needs  are  arranged  in  a  hierarchical 
order  such  that  the  fulfillment  of  lower  needs  propels  the  organism  on  to  the 
next  highest  level.  For  example,  a  man  who  has  a  strong  physiological  need, 
such  as  hunger,  will  be  motivated  by  little  else,  but  when  this  need  is  fulfilled, 
he  will  move  on  to  the  next  level,  that  of  safety  needs,  and  when  these  are 
satisfied,  he  will  move  on  to  the  third  level,  and  so  on. 

In  his  major  works,  Maslow  was  most  interested  in  the  highest  need — 
the  need  for  self-actualization.  Self-actualization,  a  concept  borrowed  from 
Goldstein  (1939),  refers  to  the  actualization  of  one's  potentials,  capacities,  and 
talents.  To  study  it,  Maslow  examined  the  lives  and  experiences  of  the  most 
healthy,  creative  people  he  could  find.  His  sample  included  contemporaries 
and  acquaintances,  such  as  the  anthropologist  Ruth  Benedict,  as  well  as  public 


390 


Humanistic  Psychology  and  Developmental  Theory 


and  historical  figures,  such  as  Thomas  Jefferson  and  Eleanor  Roosevelt 
(Maslow,  1954,  pp.  202-203). 

Maslow's  key  finding  was  that  the  self-actualizers,  compared  to  most 
people,  have  maintained  a  certain  independence  from  their  society.  Most 
people  are  so  strongly  motivated  by  needs  such  as  belongingness,  love,  and 
respect  that  they  are  afraid  to  entertain  any  thought  that  others  might  dis¬ 
approve  of.  They  try  to  fit  into  their  society  and  do  whatever  brings  pres¬ 
tige  within  it.  Self-actualizers,  in  contrast,  are  less  conforming.  They  seem 
less  molded  and  flattened  by  the  social  environment  and  are  more  sponta¬ 
neous,  free,  and  natural.  Although  they  rarely  behave  in  unconventional 
ways,  they  typically  regard  conventions  with  a  good-natured  shrug  of  the 
shoulders.  Instead,  they  are  primarily  motivated  by  their  own  inner  growth, 
the  development  of  their  potentials,  and  their  personal  mission  in  life 
(Maslow,  1954,  pp.  223-228). 

Because  self-actualizers  have  attained  a  certain  independence  from  their 
culture,  they  are  not  confined  to  conventional,  abstract,  or  stereotyped  modes 
of  perception.  When,  for  example,  most  people  go  to  a  museum,  they  read 
the  name  of  the  artist  below  the  painting  and  then  judge  the  work  according 
to  the  conventional  estimate.  Self-actualizers,  in  contrast,  perceive  things  more 
freshly,  naively,  and  as  they  really  are.  They  can  look  at  any  painting — or  any 
tree,  bird,  or  baby — as  if  seeing  it  for  the  first  time;  they  can  find  miraculous 
beauty  where  others  see  nothing  but  the  common  object  (Maslow,  1966,  p.  88). 
In  fact,  they  seem  to  have  retained  the  creative,  open  approach  that  is  char¬ 
acteristic  of  the  young  child.  Like  the  child,  their  attitude  is  frequently 
"absorbed,  spellbound,  popeyed,  enchanted"  (p.  100).  Unfortunately,  most 
children  lose  this  approach  to  life  as  they  become  socialized. 

When  such  perception  is  intense,  it  can  be  called  a  "peak  experience." 
The  individual  becomes  overcome  with  awe  and  wonder  at  the  object — a  for¬ 
est,  a  lover,  a  baby — and  becomes  so  absorbed  and  poured  into  the  experience 
that  she  loses  all  self-consciousness.  She  may  even  feel  a  mystical  sense  of  com¬ 
munion  with  a  transcendent  beauty  and  perfection.  In  any  case,  there  is  no 
effort  to  name  or  categorize  the  object,  or  use  it  for  any  purpose.  There  is  pure 
delight  in  what  is  (Maslow,  1966,  chap.  6;  1971,  pp.  333-334). 1 

In  many  ways,  self-actualizers  seem  like  good  phenomenologists. 
Whether  or  not  their  perceptions  reach  the  level  of  peak  experiences,  they  can 
suspend  or  go  beyond  conventional  ways  of  ordering  experience.  They  savor 
the  concrete,  raw  experience  (Maslow,  1966,  p.  87).  Maslow  also  likened  the 
self-actualizers'  approach  to  a  "Taoistic  letting  be,"  to  a  receptive,  open  appre¬ 
ciation  of  objects  without  interfering  with  them  or  attempting  to  control  them 
(Maslow,  1962,  p.  86). 


'Peak  experiences  are  not  restricted  to  the  perception  of  beauty  but  may  occur  during  other 
activities,  such  as  athletics,  dance,  or  the  act  of  love.  During  peak  experiences,  people  lose  them¬ 
selves  in  the  moment  and  everything  seems  to  flow  naturally  (Maslow,  1968,  chaps.  6  and  7). 


391 


Humanistic  Psychology  and  Developmental  Theory 


Maslow  believed  psychologists  and  other  scientists  could  learn  much 
from  self-actualizers'  phenomenological  and  Taoistic  approaches.  It's  widely 
assumed  that  science  must  proceed  in  an  intellectual,  goal-directed  manner. 
As  scientists,  we  must  clearly  define  the  purpose  of  our  study  and  then  collect 
data  that  help  solve  the  problem  or  test  the  hypothesis.  In  the  process,  we 
filter  out  all  the  rich  experiences  of  people  and  things  that  are  outside  the 
purpose  of  our  study.  Maslow  suggested  that  before  we  get  caught  up  in 
our  purposes,  hypotheses,  and  generalizations,  we  open  ourselves  to  the 
world  on  a  sensory,  prerational,  experiential  level.  We  should  try  to  experi¬ 
ence  the  world  more  freshly  and  receptively,  surrendering  ourselves  to  what 
moves  us  and  enchants  us,  like  a  child  does.  We  will  then  come  up  with 
insights  that  can  later  inform  our  rational,  goal-directed  work  (Maslow,  1966; 
1968,  p.  184). 

Maslow  reworked  his  ideas  over  the  years  and  was  not  always  system¬ 
atic  in  the  process.  But  by  and  large,  his  overall  position  was  as  follows: 

1.  Humans  possess  an  essential  biological,  inner  nature,  which  includes 
all  the  basic  needs  and  the  impulses  toward  growth  and  self-actualization 
(1968,  p.  190;  1971,  p.  25). 

2.  This  inner  core  is  partly  specieswide  and  partly  idiosyncratic,  for  we 
all  have  special  bents,  temperaments,  and  abilities  (1968,  p.  191). 

3.  Our  inner  core  is  a  positive  force  that  presses  toward  the  realization 
of  full  humanness,  just  as  an  acorn  may  be  said  to  press  toward  becoming  an 
oak  tree.  It  is  important  to  recognize  it  is  our  inner  nature,  not  the  environment, 
that  plays  the  guiding  role.  The  environment  is  like  sun,  food,  and  water;  it 
nourishes  growth,  but  it  is  not  the  seed.  Social  and  educational  practices 
should  be  evaluated  not  in  terms  of  how  efficiently  they  control  the  child  or 
get  the  child  to  adjust,  but  according  to  how  well  they  support  and  nourish 
inner  growth  potentials  (1968,  pp.  160-161,  211-212). 

4.  Our  inner  nature  is  not  strong,  like  instincts  in  animals.  Rather,  it  is 
subtle,  delicate,  and  in  many  ways  weak.  It  is  easily  "drowned  out  by  learn¬ 
ing,  by  cultural  expectations,  by  fear,  by  disapproval,  etc."  (1968,  p.  191). 

5.  The  suppression  of  our  inner  nature  usually  takes  place  during  child¬ 
hood.  At  the  start,  babies  have  an  inner  wisdom  with  respect  to  most  matters, 
including  food  intake,  amount  of  sleep,  readiness  for  toilet  training,  and  the 
urges  to  stand  up  and  to  walk.  Babies  will  also  avidly  explore  the  environ¬ 
ment,  focusing  on  the  particular  things  in  which  they  take  delight.  Their  own 
feelings  and  inner  promptings  guide  them  toward  healthy  growth.  However, 
socializing  agents  frequently  lack  respect  for  children's  choices.  Instead,  they 
try  to  direct  children,  to  teach  them  things.  They  criticize  them,  correct  their 


392 


Humanistic  Psychology  and  Developmental  Theory 


errors,  and  try  to  get  them  to  give  the  "right"  answers.  Consequently,  children 
quit  trusting  themselves  and  their  senses  and  begin  to  rely  on  the  opinions  of 
others  (1968,  pp.  49-55, 150, 198-199). 

6.  Even  though  our  inner  core,  with  its  urge  toward  self-actualization, 
is  weak,  it  rarely  disappears  altogether — even  in  adulthood.  It  persists  under¬ 
ground,  in  the  unconscious,  and  speaks  to  us  as  an  inner  voice  waiting  to  be 
heard.  Inner  signals  can  lead  even  the  neurotic  adult  back  to  buried  capacities 
and  unfulfilled  potentials.  Our  inner  core  is  a  pressure  we  call  the  "will  to 
health,"  and  it  is  this  urge  on  which  all  successful  psychotherapy  is  based 
(1968,  pp.  192-193). 

7.  There  are  a  few  people — "self-actualizers" — who  have  remained 
deeply  responsive  to  their  inner  natures  and  urges  toward  growth.  These 
people  are  less  molded  and  flattened  by  cultural  pressures  and  have  preserved 
the  capacity  to  look  at  the  world  in  a  spontaneous,  fresh,  childlike  manner 
(1968,  pp.  207-208). 


DEVELOPMENTALISTS  AS  HUMANISTS 

If  Maslow's  ideas  sound  familiar,  they  are.  Maslow  and  the  modern  human¬ 
istic  psychologists  have,  without  making  much  note  of  it,  drawn  heavily  on 
the  developmental  tradition  that  began  with  Rousseau.  Since  Rousseau,  many 
developmental  theorists  have  been  preoccupied  with  the  same  basic  problem 
as  Maslow:  Children,  as  they  become  socialized,  quit  relying  on  their  own 
experience  and  judgments;  they  become  too  dependent  on  conventions  and 
the  opinions  of  others.  Thus  developmentalists,  like  the  humanists,  have  been 
searching  for  an  inner  force  that  will  guide  the  individual  toward  a  healthier, 
more  independent  development. 


Intrinsic  Growth  Forces 

Where  Maslow  speaks  of  a  biological  core  that  directs  healthy  growth,  devel¬ 
opmentalists  refer  to  maturation.  Maturation  is  an  internal  mechanism  that 
prompts  children  to  seek  out  certain  experiences  at  certain  times.  Under 
maturational  urging,  children  regulate  their  cycles  of  sleep  and  eating;  learn 
to  sit  up,  walk,  and  run;  develop  an  urgent  need  for  autonomy;  master  lan¬ 
guage;  explore  the  widening  environment;  and  so  on.  According  to  Gesell  and 
others,  children,  following  their  own  inner  schedule  and  timing,  are  eminently 
wise  regarding  what  they  need  and  can  do.  So,  instead  of  trying  to  make 
children  conform  to  our  own  set  schedules  and  directions,  we  can  let  them 
guide  us  and  make  their  own  choices — as  Maslow  proposed. 


393 


Humanistic  Psychology  and  Developmental  Theory 


Nevertheless,  as  Maslow  observed,  it  is  often  difficult  for  us  to  trust  chil¬ 
dren  and  the  growth  process.  We  seem  to  have  particular  difficulty  believing 
children  can  really  learn  on  their  own,  without  our  direction  and  supervision. 
But  developmentalists  have  tried  to  show  they  can.  Montessori,  in  particular, 
tried  to  show  that  if  we  will  open-mindedly  observe  children's  spontaneous 
interests,  they  will  direct  us  to  the  tasks  on  which  they  will  work  indepen¬ 
dently  and  with  the  greatest  concentration  and  sense  of  fulfillment.  They  will 
become  absorbed  in  such  tasks  because  the  tasks  meet  inner  needs  to  perfect 
certain  capacities  at  certain  points  in  development.  So  we  are  not  forced  to 
take  charge  of  children's  learning,  to  choose  tasks  for  them,  to  motivate  them 
by  our  praise,  or  to  criticize  their  mistakes — practices  that  force  them  to  turn 
to  external  authorities  for  guidance  and  evaluation.  Instead,  we  can  trust  their 
maturationally  based  urges  to  perfect  their  own  capacities  in  their  own  ways. 
Maslow  might  have  pointed  to  Montessori  as  an  educator  who  was  thor¬ 
oughly  humanistic  in  her  faith  in  children's  intrinsic  creative  powers. 

Not  all  developmentalists,  of  course,  are  as  nativistic  as  Gesell  or  Montes¬ 
sori.  As  we  have  seen,  Piaget,  Kohlberg,  and  the  cognitive-developmentalists 
doubt  that  biological  maturation  directly  governs  the  stages  of  cognitive  devel¬ 
opment.  But  these  theorists  also  look  to  children's  independent  activities, 
rather  than  to  external  teachings,  as  the  source  of  developmental  change. 
Children,  in  their  view,  are  intrinsically  curious  about  the  world  and  reach 
out  for  new  experiences  that  lead  them  to  reorganize  their  cognitive  struc¬ 
tures.  In  this  sense,  the  cognitive-developmentalists  also  share  the  humanists' 
faith  in  intrinsic  capacities  for  self-directed  learning. 

Interestingly,  Maslow's  thoughts  on  adulthood  were  also  foreshadowed 
by  earlier  developmental  theorists — especially  by  Jung.  Maslow  pointed  out 
how  the  well-socialized  adult,  whose  inner  potentials  for  self-actualization 
lie  dormant,  will  still  hear  inner  voices  calling  for  attention.  Jung  used  nearly 
identical  language  to  describe  the  crisis  of  middle  life.  Prior  to  middle  age, 
the  individual  typically  concentrates  on  adjusting  to  the  external,  social  world, 
trying  to  do  things  that  bring  social  success  and  prestige  and  developing  those 
parts  of  the  personality  that  are  suited  for  this  goal.  In  middle  life,  however, 
social  success  loses  its  importance,  and  inner  voices  from  the  unconscious 
direct  one  to  attend  to  the  previously  neglected  and  unrealized  parts  of  the  self. 
The  individual  increasingly  turns  inward  and  considers  the  discovery  and 
rounding  out  of  the  personality  more  important  than  social  conformity. 

Thus  developmental  theorists,  like  the  modern  humanistic  psycholo¬ 
gists,  have  tried  to  uncover  intrinsic  growth  factors  that  stand  apart  from 
pressures  toward  social  conformity.  At  the  same  time,  however,  some  devel¬ 
opmental  theorists  have  been  more  pessimistic  than  the  humanists  about  the 
chances  for  any  substantial  improvement  based  on  intrinsic  forces.  In  partic¬ 
ular,  the  Freudians  have  felt  that  because  maturation  brings  with  it  unruly 
sexual  and  aggressive  impulses,  a  good  measure  of  social  repression  will 
always  be  necessary.  Erikson  viewed  maturational  growth  somewhat  more 


394 


Humanistic  Psychology  and  Developmental  Theory 


positively  than  Freud,  calling  attention  to  the  maturation  of  autonomy,  ini¬ 
tiative,  industry,  and  so  on,  but  he  too  felt  that  the  other  sides  of  these  qualities — 
shame,  doubt,  guilt,  inferiority,  and  so  on — are  inevitable.  No  child,  for 
example,  can  become  completely  autonomous,  for  societies  will  always  need 
to  regulate  the  child  to  some  extent.  Still,  Erikson  hoped  we  can  raise  children 
so  they  can  gain  as  much  autonomy,  initiative,  and  as  many  other  virtues  as 
possible. 

Furthermore,  Freudian  therapy  relies  heavily  on  inner  growth  forces. 
Recall  how  Freud  once  asked  a  psychiatrist  if  he  could  really  cure.  When  the 
psychiatrist  responded  that  he  could  not — that  he  could  only  remove  some 
impediments  to  growth  as  a  gardener  removes  some  stones  or  weeds — Freud 
said  they  would  then  understand  each  other.  The  psychoanalyst's  reliance  on 
intrinsic  growth  processes  is  quite  evident  in  Bettelheim's  school.  Bettelheim 
did  not  try  to  make  disturbed  children  behave  in  normal  ways,  but  he  tried 
to  provide  certain  conditions — love,  acceptance,  empathy — that  will  enable 
children  to  feel  it  is  safe  to  take  steps  toward  growth  on  their  own.  The  physi¬ 
cian  treats  patients  in  essentially  the  same  way.  The  doctor  does  not  actually 
heal  a  cut  but  only  cleans  and  stitches  the  wound.  The  rest  is  up  to  nature. 
Any  cure,  in  psychotherapy  or  in  medicine,  partly  relies  on  forces  toward 
health  that  are  out  of  the  doctor's  control.  The  doctor  puts  his  or  her  faith  in 
innate  forces  toward  health. 

Thus  developmental  theorists,  like  the  humanists,  have  tried  to  discover 
the  nature  of  intrinsic  growth  forces  and  to  devise  educational  and  therapeutic 
methods  based  on  them.  And,  to  a  considerable  extent,  developmental  writers 
had  been  working  on  these  tasks  long  before  the  modern  humanistic  move¬ 
ment  in  psychology  even  began. 

Romanticism 

Theories  that  extol  the  virtues  of  nature  and  biological  forces,  as  opposed  to 
society,  are  often  called  Romantic.  In  this  sense,  Maslow,  as  well  as  Rousseau 
and  the  maturationists,  are  strongly  Romantic.  Rousseau,  in  fact,  is  often  cred¬ 
ited  with  the  origin  of  Romantic  thought. 

Another  aspect  of  Romanticism  is  a  fondness  for  the  past.  This  attraction 
is  quite  evident  in  Maslow;  he  looked  upon  infancy  and  childhood  as  times 
when  we  were  more  closely  in  touch  with  our  natural  urges  and  possessed  a 
more  spontaneous  and  creative  outlook.  As  children,  he  said,  we  perceived  the 
world  more  freshly,  directly,  and  imaginatively  than  we  typically  do  as  well- 
socialized  adults.  Maslow  recognized  the  value  of  mature,  adult  thought,  but 
he  also  saw  the  need  to  learn  to  regress  temporarily  to  more  childlike  modes 
of  experience. 

Rousseau,  too,  "romanticized  the  past."  He  suggested  that  we  were  hap¬ 
pier  and  more  independent  as  savages,  and  he  saw  childhood  as  a  potentially 
happy  and  innocent  time  in  which  we  live  in  close  harmony  with  nature. 


395 


Humanistic  Psychology  and  Developmental  Theory 


In  modern  developmental  theory,  perhaps  the  most  thoroughgoing  Romantic 
was  Schachtel,  who  contrasted  the  richly  sensuous  experiences  of  infancy  and 
the  open  curiosity  of  childhood  with  the  stereotyped,  conventional  thought  of 
most  adults. 

Neither  Rousseau  nor  Schachtel,  however,  clearly  specified  ways  in 
which  we,  as  adults,  might  recapture  childlike  modes  of  experience.  For  such 
a  conceptualization,  we  are  particularly  indebted  to  Werner.  Werner  sug¬ 
gested  that  we  continually  engage  in  a  process  called  microgenesis,  beginning 
each  new  thought  or  perception  at  primitive  levels  before  moving  on  to  more 
advanced  forms  of  cognition.  Thus  the  primitive  modes  of  experience  are 
continually  available  to  us.  Ordinarily,  Werner  observed,  we  do  not  engage 
in  primitive  imagery  in  a  very  full  way,  but  we  do  so  when  we  are  most  cre¬ 
ative,  when  we  truly  begin  anew.  At  these  moments  our  impressions  become 
particularly  rich  and  sensuous;  for  primitive  images  are  fused  with  emotion, 
sensation,  and  imaginative  qualities.  Creative  thinking,  of  course,  does  not 
stop  with  such  images;  it  goes  on  to  articulate  and  structure  them.  Never¬ 
theless,  Werner  emphasized,  creativity  begins  with  a  responsiveness  to  early 
forms  of  experience — a  view  shared  by  the  psychoanalysts  who  speak  of 
"regressions  in  the  service  of  the  ego." 

Not  all  writers  in  the  developmental  tradition,  we  should  note,  have 
been  Romantic.  The  cognitive-developmentalists,  in  particular,  have  gener¬ 
ally  been  unimpressed  by  the  distinctive  virtues  of  childlike  thinking.  Piaget 
observed  that  we  continue  to  use  early  sensorimotor  schemes  and  cognitive 
operations,  but  he  saw  nothing  special  in  the  imaginative,  fanciful  thinking  of 
the  preoperational  child,  and  he  never  suggested  that  creative  people  regress 
to  it.  Similarly,  Kohlberg  never  seemed  impressed  by  the  concept  of  regression. 
In  his  view,  stages  of  moral  reasoning  simply  reflected  increasing  levels  of 
cognitive  adequacy,  so  there  was  no  point  to  regressing  to  earlier  stages. 

Not  all  developmentalists,  then,  have  placed  a  special  premium  on  child¬ 
like  modes  of  thought.  Most,  to  be  sure,  have  argued  that  childhood  thinking 
has  unique  qualities,  but  not  all  have  been  so  enamored  with  these  qualities 
that  they  have  urged  us  to  recapture  them.  Still,  a  Romantic  attraction  to  child¬ 
hood  is  one  theme  that  runs  through  a  good  deal  of  humanistic  psychology 
and  developmental  theory. 

Phenomenology 

Another  central  component  of  modern  humanistic  psychology  is  a  phenom¬ 
enological  orientation.  This  orientation  or  method  includes  what  may  be  called 
a  "phenomenological  suspension."  One  tries  to  suspend  one's  theoretical  pre¬ 
conceptions  and  customary  categories  and  tries  to  see  people  and  things  as 
openly  and  freshly  as  possible — to  see  them  as  they  really  are.  This  approach, 
as  we  have  seen,  was  the  starting  point  of  Rousseau's  developmental  philos¬ 
ophy.  Rousseau  argued  that  children  have  their  own  ways  of  seeing,  thinking. 


396 


Humanistic  Psychology  and  Developmental  Theory 


and  feeling,  and  that  we  know  nothing  about  these;  we  therefore  must  refrain 
from  investing  children  with  our  own  thoughts  and  take  the  time  to  simply 
observe  them,  listen  to  them,  and  let  them  reveal  their  unique  characteristics 
to  us.  Later,  Piaget  and  Montessori  emphasized  the  same  point.  The  etholo¬ 
gists,  too,  may  be  said  to  employ  a  phenomenological  suspension.  Before  an 
ethologist  forms  any  hypothesis  or  builds  any  theory,  he  or  she  first  simply 
tries  to  learn  about  and  describe  as  much  about  a  particular  species  as  pos¬ 
sible.  To  do  this,  ethologists  believe,  we  must  observe  animals  in  their  natural 
habitats,  not  in  the  laboratory. 

In  psychology,  phenomenology  usually  implies  a  second  step.  Phe¬ 
nomenological  psychologists  usually  suspend  preconceptions  in  order  to  enter 
into  the  inner  world  of  the  other.  They  try  to  open  themselves  to  the  other's 
direct  experience,  to  see  things  through  the  other's  eyes. 

Developmental  theorists  have  been  less  consistent  in  taking  this  sec¬ 
ond  step.  Those  who  have  worked  the  hardest  to  learn  about  children's 
inner  worlds  are  Schachtel  and  the  psychoanalysts.  Schachtel  tried  to  gain 
insight  into  the  infant's  unique  modes  of  perception,  and  the  psychoanalyst 
Bettelheim,  for  example,  constantly  asked  himself,  "How  does  the  world  look 
and  feel  to  this  child?"  Other  writers,  however,  have  been  less  interested  in 
perceiving  the  world  through  the  child's  eyes.  Gesell  wanted  us  to  be  open  to 
children's  own  needs  and  interests,  but  he  primarily  observed  their  external 
motor  behavior.  Werner  gave  us  insights  into  how  the  world  might  look  to 
the  child — how,  for  instance,  it  might  appear  full  of  life  and  feeling — but  he 
mostly  discussed  the  child's  mental  life  from  the  outside,  analyzing  it  in  terms 
of  concepts  such  as  differentiation  and  integration.  Similarly,  Piaget  provided 
valuable  insights  into  the  young  child's  unique  experiences — how  objects 
change  with  momentary  perceptions,  how  dreams  seem  real,  how  morals 
seem  imposed  by  authorities,  and  so  forth — but  Piaget,  too,  primarily  exam¬ 
ined  the  young  child's  thought  from  the  outside,  analyzing  it  in  terms  of  log¬ 
ical  structures.  The  ethologists  also  primarily  look  at  behavior  from  an  external 
point  of  view. 

A  knowledge  of  how  the  world  looks  to  children  (and  adults)  at  differ¬ 
ent  stages  will  not  be  easy  to  come  by.  Young  children  are  not  sufficiently  ver¬ 
bal  to  tell  us  how  the  world  appears  to  them,  and  infants  cannot  tell  us 
anything  at  all.  One  approach  may  be  the  study  of  spontaneous  interests.  For 
example,  Montessori  showed  how  young  children  attend  to  minute  details 
and  are  concerned  about  anything  out  of  place.  These  observations  give  us 
two  clues  concerning  the  young  child's  perceptual  world.  Young  children  also 
seem  to  perceive  life  where  we  do  not,  and  they  may  be  particularly  inter¬ 
ested  in  objects,  such  as  cars,  balls,  or  balloons,  which,  with  a  little  imagina¬ 
tion,  take  on  human  qualities.  It  would  seem  important  to  record  every  aspect 
of  the  environment  that  children  find  uniquely  interesting.  To  structure  such 
studies,  we  might  follow  the  lead  of  Martha  Muchow,  who  observed  how 
children  of  different  ages  responded  to  typical  settings  in  their  everyday  envi- 


397 


Humanistic  Psychology  and  Developmental  Theory 


ron merits,  including  a  landing  dock  and  a  department  store.  By  noting  the 
things  that  children  find  particularly  interesting,  as  well  as  those  that  they 
ignore,  we  can  begin  to  form  a  picture  of  how  the  world  appears  to  the  child 
at  different  phases  of  life. 


Universals 

Those  of  you  who  have  already  learned  something  about  developmental  psy¬ 
chology  will  notice  this  book  neglects  or  skims  over  certain  topics.  We  have 
barely  mentioned,  for  example,  differences  among  children  or  adults  on  IQ 
tests.  Other  topics  that  have  received  only  minor  coverage  include  cultural 
differences  in  personality  development  and  gender  differences.  The  various 
differences  among  people,  which  are  partly  the  product  of  environmental  fac¬ 
tors,  are  tremendously  important. 

However,  the  differences  among  people  have  not  been  the  primary 
concern  of  writers  in  the  developmental  tradition.  Instead,  they  have 
searched  for  growth  forces  and  sequences  common  to  all  people.  This  search, 
as  Chomsky  suggests  (1975,  pp.  130-133),  probably  reflects,  as  much  as  any¬ 
thing,  an  ethical  orientation.  Developmentalists,  like  humanists,  are  trying 
to  show  how,  at  the  deepest  levels,  we  are  all  the  same.  Writers  in  the  devel¬ 
opmental  tradition  are  especially  reluctant  to  investigate  ways  in  which  one 
person  is  better  than  another.  The  writers'  focus,  instead,  is  on  our  common 
humanity  (Maslow,  1962,  p.  185).  They  want  to  show  that,  at  bottom,  we  all 
have  the  same  yearnings,  hopes,  and  fears,  as  well  as  the  same  creative  urges 
toward  health  and  personal  integration.  Hopefully,  an  appreciation  of  the 
strivings  that  we  all  share  can  help  in  the  building  of  a  universal  human 
community. 


398 


REFERENCES 


From  Theories  of  Development:  Concepts  and  Applications,  Sixth  Edition.  William 
Crain.  Copyright  ©  2011  by  Pearson  Education,  Inc.  Published  by  Pearson 
Prentice  Hall.  All  rights  reserved. 


399 


References 


Baillargeon,  R.  (1987).  Object  permanence  in  31/2-  and  41/2"year_°ld  infants.  Developmental 
Psychology ,  22,  655-664. 

Balcombe,  J.  (2006).  Pleasurable  kingdom.  London:  Macmillan. 

Baldwin,  A.  L.  (1980).  Theories  of  child  development  (2nd  ed.).  New  York:  John  Wiley. 

Balinsky,  B.  I.  (1981).  An  introduction  to  embryology  (5th  ed.).  Philadelphia:  Saunders. 

Ball,  G.  F.,  &  Hulse,  S.  H.  (1998).  Birdsong.  American  Psychologist,  53, 37-58. 

Bandura,  A.  (1962).  Social  learning  through  imitation.  In  M.  R.  Jones  (Ed.),  Nebraska  symposium 
on  motivation.  Lincoln:  University  of  Nebraska  Press. 

Bandura,  A.  (1965a).  Vicarious  processes.  A  case  of  no-trial  learning.  In  L.  Berkowitz  (Ed.), 
Advances  in  experimental  social  psychology  (Vol.  2).  New  York:  Academic  Press. 

Bandura,  A.  (1965b).  Influence  of  modePs  reinforcement  contingencies  on  the  acquisition  of 
imitative  responses.  Journal  of  Personality  and  Social  Psychology,  1,  589-595. 

Bandura,  A.  (1967).  The  role  of  modeling  processes  in  personality  development.  In  W.  W.  Hartup 
&  W.  L.  Smothergill  (Eds.),  The  young  child:  Reviews  of  research.  Washington,  DC:  National 
Association  for  the  Education  of  Young  Children. 

Bandura,  A.  (1969).  Social-learning  theory  of  identificatory  processes.  In  D.  A.  Goslin  (Ed.),  Hand¬ 
book  of  socialization  theory  and  research.  Chicago:  Rand  McNally. 

Bandura,  A.  (1971).  Analysis  of  modeling  processes.  In  A.  Bandura  (Ed.),  Psychological  modeling. 
Chicago:  Atherton,  Aldine. 

Bandura,  A.  (1977).  Social  learning  theory.  Englewood  Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Hall. 

Bandura,  A.  (1986).  Social  foundations  of  thought  and  action:  A  social  cognitive  theory.  Englewood 
Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Hall. 

Bandura,  A.  (1989).  Social  cognitive  theory.  In  R.  Vasta  (Ed.),  Annals  of  Child  Development,  6, 1-60. 

Bandura,  A.  (1994).  Self-efficacy.  In  V.  S.  Ramachadraun  (Ed.),  Encyclopedia  of  human  behavior  (Vol.  4). 
New  York:  Academic  Press. 

Bandura,  A.  (1997).  Self-efficacy.  New  York:  W.  H.  Freeman. 

Bandura,  A.  (1998).  Personal  and  collective  efficacy  in  human  adaptation  and  change.  In 
J.  G.  Adair,  D.  Belanger,  &  K.  L.  Dion  (Eds.),  Advances  in  psychological  science  (Vol.  1).  Hove, 
UK:  Psychology  Press. 

Bandura,  A.  (2006).  Autobiography.  In  M.G.  Lindzey  &  W.  M.  Runyan  (Eds.),  A  history  of  psy¬ 
chology  in  autobiography  (Vol.  IX).  Washington,  DC:  American  Psychological  Association. 

Bandura,  A.,  Grusec,  J.  E.,  &  Menlove,  F.  L.  (1967).  Vicarious  extinction  of  avoidance  behavior. 
Journal  of  Personality  and  Social  Psychology,  5, 16-23. 

Bandura,  A.,  &  Huston,  A.  C.  (1961).  Identification  as  a  process  of  incidental  learning.  Journal  of 
Abnormal  and  Social  Psychology,  63,  311-318. 

Bandura,  A.,  &  Kupers,  C.  J.  (1964).  The  transmission  of  patterns  of  self-reinforcement  through 
modeling.  Journal  of  Abnormal  and  Social  Psychology,  69, 1-9. 

Bandura,  A.,  &  McDonald,  F.  J.  (1963).  Influence  of  social  reinforcement  and  the  behavior  of 
models  in  shaping  children's  moral  judgments.  Journal  of  Abnormal  and  Social  Psychology, 
67,  274-281. 

Bandura,  A.,  Ross,  D.,  &  Ross,  S.A.  (1961).  Transmission  of  aggression  through  imitation  of 
aggressive  models.  Journal  of  Abnormal  and  Social  Psychology,  63,  575-582. 

Bandura,  A.,  &  Walters,  R.  H.  (1963).  Social  learning  and  personality  development.  New  York:  Holt, 
Rinehart  &  Winston. 

Barr,  R.,  Dowden,  A.,  &  Hayne,  H.  (1996).  Developmental  changes  in  deferred  imitation  by  6- 
to  24-month-old  infants.  Infant  Behavior  and  Development,  19, 159-170. 

Barten,  S.  S.,  &  Franklin,  M.  B.  (Eds.).  (1978).  Developmental  processes:  Heinz  Werner's  selected  writ¬ 
ings  (Vols.  1  and  2).  New  York:  International  Universities  Press. 

Bateson,  P.  (1990).  Is  imprinting  a  special  case?  Philosophical  Transactions  of  the  Royal  Society,  329, 
125-131. 

Bateson,  P.  (1991).  Principles  of  behavioral  development.  In  P.  Bateson  (Ed.),  The  development  and 
integration  of  behavior.  Cambridge,  UK:  Cambridge  University  Press. 

Bauer,  P.  J.  (2006).  Event  memory.  In  D.  Kuhn  &  R.  S.  Siegler  (Eds.),  Handbook  of  child  psychology 
(6th  ed.)  (Vol.  2),  New  York:  Wiley. 

Bauerlein,  M.  (2009).  The  dumbest  generation.  New  York:  Jeremy  P.  Tarcher/ Penguin. 

Baumrind,  D.  (1967).  Child  care  practices  anteceding  three  patterns  of  preschool  behavior.  Genetic 
Psychology  Monographs,  75,  43-88. 

Baumrind,  D.  (1989).  Rearing  competent  children.  In  W.  Damon  (Ed.),  Child  development  today 
and  tomorrow.  San  Francisco:  Jossey-Bass. 


401 


REFERENCES 


Abraham,  K.  (1924a).  A  short  study  of  the  development  of  the  libido  viewed  in  light  of 
mental  disorders.  Selected  papers  of  Karl  Abraham.  New  York:  Basic  Books,  1927. 
Abraham,  K.  (1924b).  The  influence  of  oral  eroticism  on  character  formation.  Selected 
papers  of  Karl  Abraham.  New  York:  Basic  Books,  1927. 

Abram,  D.  (1996).  The  spell  of  the  sensuous.  New  York:  Vintage. 

Ainsworth,  M.  D.  S.  (1967).  Infancy  in  Uganda:  Infant  care  and  the  growth  of  love.  Baltimore: 
Johns  Hopkins  University  Press. 

Ainsworth,  M.D.S.  (1973).  The  development  of  infant  and  mother  attachment.  In.  B.  M. 
Caldwell  &  H.  M.  Ricciuti  (Eds.),  Review  of  child  development  research  (Vol.  3). 
Chicago:  University  of  Chicago  Press. 

Ainsworth,  M.  D.  S.  (1982).  Attachment:  Retrospect  and  prospect.  In  C.  M.  Parkes  & 
J.  Stevenson-Hinde  (Eds.),  The  place  of  attachment  in  human  behavior.  New  York: 
Basic  Books. 

Ainsworth,  M.  D.  S.,  Bell,  S.  M.,  &  Stanton,  D.  S.  (1971).  Individual  differences  in 
strange-situation  behavior  of  one-year-olds.  In  H.  R.  Schaffer  (Ed.),  The  origins  of 
human  social  relations.  New  York:  Academic  Press. 

Ainsworth,  M.  D.  S.,  Blehar,  M.  C.,  Waters,  E.,  &  Wall,  S.  (1978).  Patterns  of  attachment. 
Hillsdale,  NJ:  Erlbaum. 

Ainsworth,  M.  D.  S.,  &  Bowlby,  J.  (1991).  An  ethological  approach  to  personality  devel¬ 
opment.  American  Psychologist ,  46, 333-341. 

Aitchison,  J.  (1976).  The  articulate  mammal:  An  introduction  to  psycholinguistics.  New  York: 
University  Books. 

Als,  H.  (1978).  Assessing  an  assessment:  Conceptual  considerations,  methodological 
issues,  and  a  perspective  on  the  future  of  the  Neonatal  Behavioral  Assessment 
Scale.  In  A.  J.  Sameroff  (Ed.),  Organization  and  stability  of  newborn  behavior: 
A  commentary  on  the  Brazelton  Neonatal  Behavior  Assessment  Scale.  Monographs 
of  the  Society  for  Research  in  Child  Development,  43,  Serial  No.  177. 

Ambridge,  D.,  Rowland,  C.F.,  &  Pine,  M.  (2008).  Is  structure  dependence  an  innate  con¬ 
straint?  Experimental  evidence  from  children's  complex  question  production. 
Cognitive  Science,  32,  222-255. 

Ames,  L.  B.  (1971).  Don't  push  your  preschooler.  Family  Circle  Magazine,  79,  60. 
Anderson,  C.,  &  Gentile,  D.  (2008).  Media  violence,  aggression,  and  public  policy. 
In  E.  Borgida  &  S.  Fiske  (Eds.),  Beyond  common  sense:  Psychological  science  in  the 
courtroom.  Malden,  MA:  Blackwell. 

Appleton,  T.,  Clifton,  R.,  &  Goldberg,  S.  (1975).  The  development  of  behavioral  com¬ 
petence  in  infancy.  In  F.  D.  Horowitz  (Ed.),  Review  of  child  development  research 
(Vol.  4).  Chicago:  University  of  Chicago  Press. 

Aries,  P.  (1960).  Centuries  of  childhood:  A  social  history  of  family  life  (R.  Baldick,  trans.). 
New  York:  Knopf,  1962. 

Arnheim,  R.  (1954).  Art  and  visual  perception.  Berkeley:  University  of  California  Press. 
Ausubel,  D.  P.  (1958).  Theories  and  problems  in  child  development.  New  York:  Grune  & 
Stratton. 

Baerends,  G.,  Beer,  C.,  &  Manning,  A.  (1975).  Function  and  evolution  in  behavior.  Oxford, 
UK:  Clarendon  Press. 


400 


References 


Bell,  S.  M.  (1970).  The  development  of  the  concept  of  object  as  related  to  infant-mother  attach¬ 
ment.  Child  Development,  41,  291-311. 

Bell,  S.  M.,  &  Ainsworth,  M.  D.  S.  (1972).  Infant  crying  and  maternal  responsiveness.  Child  Devel¬ 
opment,  43, 1171-1190. 

Bellugi-Klima,  U.  (1968).  Linguistic  mechanisms  underlying  child  speech.  In  E.  M.  Zale  (Ed.), 
Proceedings  of  the  conference  on  language  and  language  behavior.  Englewood  Cliffs,  NJ: 
Prentice-Hall. 

Belsky,  J.,  &  Fearon,  R.  M.  P.  (2008).  Precursors  of  attachment  security.  In  J.  Cassidy  &  P.  R.  Shaver 
(Eds.),  Handbook  of  attachment  (2nd  ed.).  New  York:  Guilford. 

Benedek,  T.  (1938).  Adaptation  to  reality  in  early  infancy.  Psychoanalytic  Quarterly,  7 ,  200-215. 
Benjamin,  J.  (1988).  The  bonds  of  love.  New  York:  Pantheon. 

Beres,  D.  (1971).  Ego  autonomy  and  ego  pathology.  Psychoanalytic  Study  of  the  Child,  26,  3-24. 
Bergman,  A.  (1999).  Ours,  yours,  mine:  Mutuality  and  the  emergence  of  the  separate  self.  Northvale, 
NJ:  Jason  Aronson. 

Bergman,  I.  (1957).  Wild  Strawberries  [filmscript]  (L.  Malmstrom  &  D.  Kushner,  trans.).  New  York: 
Simon  &  Schuster. 

Berk,  L.  E.  (2001).  Awakening  children's  minds:  How  parents  and  teachers  can  make  a  difference.  Oxford, 
UK:  Oxford  University  Press. 

Berk,  L.  E.  (2009).  Child  development  (8th  ed.).  Boston:  Pearson. 

Berk,  L.E.  &  Winsler,  A.  (1995).  Scaffolding  children's  learning:  Vygotsky  and  early  childhood  educa¬ 
tion.  Washington,  D.C.:  National  Association  for  the  Education  of  Young  Children. 
Berkowitz,  M.  W.,  &  Gibbs,  J.  C.  (1985).  The  process  of  moral  conflict  resolution  and  moral 
development.  In  M.  W.  Berkowitz  (Ed.),  Peer  conflict  and  psychological  growth.  San  Francisco: 
Jossey-Bass. 

Berman,  M.  (1970).  The  politics  of  authenticity.  New  York:  Antheum. 

Bernstein,  R.  (1990,  November  4).  Accusations  of  abuse  haunt  the  legacy  of  Dr.  Bruno  Bettelheim. 
New  York  Times,  Week  in  Review. 

Bettelheim,  B.  (1960).  The  informed  heart:  Autonomy  in  a  mass  age.  New  York:  Free  Press. 
Bettelheim,  B.  (1967).  The  empty  fortress:  Infantile  autism  and  the  birth  of  the  self.  New  York:  Free  Press. 
Bettelheim,  B.  (1974).  A  home  for  the  heart.  New  York:  Knopf. 

Bettelheim,  B.  (1976).  The  uses  of  enchantment:  The  meaning  and  importance  of  fairy  tales.  New  York: 
Knopf. 

Bettelheim,  B.,  &  Zelan,  K.  (1981).  On  learning  to  read.  New  York:  Random  House. 

Bickerton,  D.  (1984).  The  language  biogram  hypothesis.  The  Behavioral  and  Brain  Sciences,  7 , 173-221. 
Bickerton,  D.  (1999).  Creole  languages,  the  language  biogram  hypothesis,  and  language  acquisi¬ 
tion.  In  W.  C.  Ritchie  &  T.  K.  Bhatia  (Eds.),  Handbook  of  child  language  acquisition.  San  Diego: 
Academic  Press. 

Bijou,  S.  W.  (1976).  Child  development:  The  basic  stage  of  early  childhood.  Englewood  Cliffs,  NJ: 
Prentice-Hall. 

Bijou,  S.  W.,  &  Baer,  D.  M.  (1961).  Child  development  (Vol.  1).  Englewood  Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Hall. 
Blasi,  A.  (1980).  Bridging  moral  cognition  and  moral  action:  A  critical  review  of  the  literature. 
Psychological  Bulletin,  88,  593-637. 

Blatt,  M.  M.,  &  Kohlberg,  L.  (1975).  The  effects  of  classroom  moral  discussion  upon  children's 
level  of  moral  judgment.  Journal  of  Moral  Education,  4, 129-161. 

Bios,  P.  (1962).  On  adolescence.  New  York:  Free  Press. 

Bodrova,  E.,  &  Leong,  D.  J.  (2001).  Tools  of  the  mind.  UNESCO.  International  Bureau  of  Education. 

www.ibe.unesco.org/ publications /innodata/ inno07.pdf 
Bodrova,  E.  &  Leong,  D.  J.  (2007).  Tools  of  the  mind:  The  Vygotskian  approach  to  early  childhood 
education  (2nd  ed.).  Upper  Saddle  River,  NJ:  Pearson /Merrill  Prentice-Hall. 

Borke,  H.  (1975).  Piaget's  mountains  revisited:  Changes  in  the  egocentric  landscape.  Developmental 
Pyschology,  11,  240-243. 

Bower,  T.  G.  R.  (1982).  Development  in  infancy  (2nd  ed.).  San  Francisco:  W.  H.  Freeman. 

Bower,  T.  G.  R.  (1989).  The  rational  infant.  New  York:  W.  H.  Freeman. 

Bowlby,  J.  (1965).  Child  care  and  the  growth  of  love.  Baltimore:  Penguin  Books. 

Bowlby,  J.  (1973).  Attachment  and  loss  (Vol.  2).  Separation.  New  York:  Basic  Books. 

Bowlby,  J.  (1979).  The  making  and  breaking  of  affectional  bonds.  London:  Tavistock  Publications.  BowlbBB 
Bowlby,  J.  (1980).  Attachment  and  loss  (Vol.  3).  Loss.  New  York:  Basic  Books. 

Bowlby,  J.  (1982).  Attachment  and  loss  (Vol.  1).  Attachment  (2nd  ed.).  New  York:  Basic  Books. 
Bowlby,  J.  (1988).  A  secure  base.  New  York:  Basic  Books. 


402 


References 


Brackbill,  Y.  (1958).  Extinction  of  the  smiling  response  in  infants  as  a  function  of  reinforcement 
schedule.  Child  Development,  29, 115-124. 

Brainerd,  C.  J.  (2003).  Piaget,  learning  research,  and  American  education.  In  B.  J.  Zimmerman 
&  D.  H.  Schunk  (Eds.),  Educational  psychology:  A  century  of  contributions.  Mahwah,  NJ: 
Erlbaum. 

Bretherton,  I.,  Ridgeway,  D.,  &  Cassidy,  J.  (1990).  Assessing  internal  working  models  of  the 
attachment  relationship:  An  attachment  story  completion  task  for  3-year-olds.  In  M.  T. 
Greenberg,  D.  Cicchetti,  &  E.  Mark  Cummings  (Eds.),  Attachment  in  the  preschool  years. 
Chicago:  University  of  Chicago  Press. 

Breuer,  J.,  &  Freud,  S.  (1895).  Studies  on  hysteria  (A.  A.  Brill,  trans.).  New  York:  Nervous  and 
Mental  Disease  Publishing  Co.,  1936. 

Bronson,  P.,  &  Merryman,  A.  (2009)  Nurture  shock.  New  York:  Twelve. 

Broughton,  J.  M.  (1983).  Women's  rationality  and  men's  virtues:  A  critque  of  gender  dualism  in 
Gilligan's  theory  of  moral  development.  Social  Research,  50,  597-642. 

Brown,  A.  L.,  &  Palinscar,  A.  S.  (1989).  Guided  cooperative  learning  and  individual  knowledge 
acquisition.  In  L.  B.  Resnick  (Ed.),  Knowing,  learning,  and  instruction.  Hillsdale,  NJ:  Erlbaum. 

Brown,  E.  (2009,  November  21).  Debate  on  playtime's  value  grows.  Washington  Post. 

Brown,  J.  F.  (1940).  The  psychodynamics  of  abnormal  behavior.  New  York:  McGraw-Hill. 

Brown,  P.,  &  Elliott,  R.  (1965).  Control  of  aggression  in  a  nursery  school  class.  Journal  of  Experi¬ 
mental  Child  Psychology,  2, 103-107. 

Brown,  R.  (1965).  Social  psychology.  New  York:  Free  Press. 

Brown,  R.  (1973).  A  first  language:  The  early  stages.  Cambridge,  MA:  Harvard  University  Press. 

Brown,  R.,  &  Bellugi,  U.  (1964).  Three  processes  in  the  child's  acquisition  of  syntax.  Harvard 
Educational  Review,  34, 133-151. 

Brown,  R.,  Cazden,  C.,  &  Bellugi-Klima,  U.  (1969).  The  child's  grammar  from  I  to  III.  In  J.  P.  Hill 
(Ed.),  Minnesota  symposia  on  child  psychology  (Vol.  2).  Minneapolis:  University  of  Min¬ 
nesota  Press. 

Brown,  R.,  &  Hanlon,  C.  (1970).  Derivational  complexity  and  order  of  acquisition  in  child  speech. 
In  R.  Brown  (Ed.),  Psycholinguistics:  Selected  papers.  New  York:  Free  Press. 

Brown,  R.,  &  Herrnstein,  R.  J.  (1975).  Psychology.  Boston:  Little,  Brown. 

Bruner,  J.  (1984).  Vygotsky's  zone  of  proximal  development:  The  hidden  agenda.  In  B.  Rogoff  & 
J.  Wertsch  (Eds.),  Children's  learning  in  the  " zone  of  proximal  development."  San  Francisco: 
Jossey-Bass. 

Bryan,  J.  H.  (1975).  Children's  cooperation  and  helping  behaviors.  In  E.  M.  Hetherington  (Ed.), 
Review  of  child  development  research  (Vol.  5).  Chicago:  University  of  Chicago  Press. 

Bryan,  J.  H.,  &  Walbek,  N.  (1970).  Preaching  and  practicing  generosity:  Children's  action,  and 
reactions.  Child  Development,  41,  329-353. 

Bryant,  P.  E.  (1974).  Perception  and  understanding  in  young  children:  An  experimental  approach. 
New  York:  Basic  Books. 

Butler,  R.  N.  (1963).  The  life  review:  An  interpretation  of  reminiscence  in  the  aged.  Psychiatry, 
26,  65-76. 

Cairns,  H.  S.,  &  Cairns,  C.  E.  (1976).  Psycholinguistics:  A  cognitive  view  of  language.  New  York: 
Holt,  Rinehart  &  Winston. 

Caldwell,  B.  M.  (1964).  The  effects  of  infant  care.  In  M.  L.  &  L.  W.  Hoffman  (Eds.),  Review  of  child 
development  research  (Vol.  1).  New  York:  Russell  Sage  Foundation. 

Camp,  B.  (2002).  Eanguage  power:  12  to  24  months.  Denver:  Bright  Beginnings. 

Campbell,  N.  A.,  &  Reece,  J.  B.  (2005).  Biology  (7th  ed.).  San  Francisco:  Pearson /Benjamin 
Cummings. 

Camus,  A  (1948).  The  plague.  (S.  Gibert,  trans.).  New  York:  Vintage. 

Camus,  A.  (1955).  The  myth  of  Sisyphus  and  other  essays.  (J.  O'Brien,  trans.).  New  York:  Knopf. 

Carnegie  Corporation  of  New  York.  (1996).  Years  of  Promise:  A  comprehensive  learning  strategy  for 
America's  children. 

Carroll,  S.B.  (2009).  Remarkable  creatures.  Boston:  Houghton  Mifflin  Harcourt. 

Chattin-McNichols,  J.  (1992).  The  Montessori  controversy.  Albany,  NY:  Delmar. 

Chawla,  L.  (1990).  Ecstatic  places.  Children's  Environments  Quarterly,  3,  34-41. 

Chodorow,  N.  (1978).  The  reproduction  of  mothering.  Berkeley:  University  of  California  Press. 

Chomsky,  C.  (1969).  The  acquisition  of  syntax  in  children  from  5  to  10.  Cambridge,  MA:  MIT  Press. 

Chomsky,  N.  (1957).  Syntactic  structures.  The  Hague:  Moulton. 

Chomsky,  N.  (1959).  A  review  of  Verbal  behavior  by  B.  F.  Skinner.  Language,  35,  26-58. 


403 


References 


Chomsky,  N.  (1962).  Explanatory  models  in  linguistics.  In  E.  Nagel,  P.  Suppes,  &  A.  Tarshi  (Eds.), 
Logic,  methodology  and  philosophy  of  science.  Stanford:  Stanford  University  Press. 

Chomsky,  N.  (1965).  Aspects  of  the  theory  of  syntax.  Cambridge,  MA:  MIT  Press. 

Chomsky,  N.  (1968).  Recent  contribution  to  the  theory  of  innate  ideas.  In  R.  S.  Cohen  &  M.  W. 
Wartofsky  (Eds.),  Boston  studies  on  the  philosophy  of  science  (Vol.  3).  Dordrecht,  Holland: 
D.  Reidel. 

Chomsky,  N.  (1972).  Language  and  mind.  New  York:  Harcourt  Brace  Jovanovich. 

Chomsky,  N.  (1975).  Reflections  on  language.  San  Diego:  Pantheon. 

Chomsky,  N.  (1977).  Interview.  In  D.  Cohen  (Ed.),  Psychologists  on  psychology.  New  York:  Taplinger. 

Chomsky,  N.  (1980).  Rules  and  representations.  New  York:  Columbia  University  Press. 

Chomsky,  N.  (1983).  Interview.  In  R.  W.  Reiber  &  G.  Voyat  (Eds.),  Dialogues  on  the  psychology  of 
language  and  thought.  New  York:  Plenum. 

Chomsky,  N.  (1986).  Knowledge  of  language:  Its  nature,  origin,  and  use.  New  York:  Praeger. 

Chomsky,  N.  (2003,  June  1).  Interview  on  C-SPAN's  In  Depth  [Television  broadcast].  Washington, 
DC:  National  Satellite  Cable  Corporation. 

Clarke-Stewart,  K.  A.  (1989).  Infant  day  care:  Maligned  or  malignant?  American  Psychologist, 
44,  266-273. 

Coates,  B.,  &  Hartup,  W.  W.  (1969).  Age  and  verbalization  in  observational  learning.  Developmental 
Psychology,  1,  556-562. 

Coe,  B.  (1996,  Spring).  Montessori  and  middle  school.  Montessori  Life,  8,  26-29. 

Colby,  A.,  Kohlberg,  L.,  Gibbs,  J.,  &  Lieberman,  M.  (1983).  A  longitudinal  study  of  moral  judg¬ 
ment.  Monographs  of  the  Society  for  Research  in  Child  Development  (Serial  No.  200). 

Colby,  A.,  Kohlberg,  L.,  &  Kauffman,  K.  (1987a).  Theoretical  introduction  to  the  measurement 
of  moral  judgment.  In  A.  Colby  &  L.  Kohlberg  (Eds.),  The  measurement  of  moral  judgment 
(Vol.  1).  Cambridge,  UK:  Cambridge  University  Press. 

Colby,  A.,  Kohlberg,  L.,  &  Kauffman,  K.  (1987b).  Instructions  for  moral  judgment  interviewing. 
In  A.  Colby  &  L.  Kohlberg  (Eds.),  The  measurement  of  moral  judgment  (Vol.  1).  Cambridge, 
UK:  Cambridge  University  Press. 

Colby,  A.,  Kohlberg,  L.,  Speicher,  B.,  Hewer,  A.,  Candee,  D.,  Gibbs,  J.,  &  Power,  C.  (1987c).  The 
measurement  of  moral  judgment  (Vol.  2).  Cambridge,  UK:  Cambridge  University  Press. 

Cole,  M.,  &  Cole,  S.  R.  (1993).  The  development  of  children  (2nd  ed.).  New  York:  Scientific. 

Cole,  M.,  &  Cole,  S.  R.  (2001).  The  development  of  children  (4th  ed.).  New  York:  Freeman. 

Cole,  M.,  &  Scribner,  S.  (1978).  Introduction.  In  M.  Cole,  V.  John-Steiner,  S.  Scribner,  &  E.  Sou- 
berman  (Eds.),  L.  S.  Vygotsky:  Mind  in  society.  Cambridge,  MA:  Harvard  University  Press. 

Coles,  R.  (1970).  Erik  H.  Erikson:  The  growth  of  his  work.  Boston:  Little,  Brown. 

Condon,  W.  S.,  &  Sander,  L.  W.  (1974).  Neonate  movement  is  synchronized  with  adult  speech: 
Interactional  participation  and  language  acquisition.  Science,  183,  99-101. 

Crain,  S.,  &  Nakayama,  M.  (1987).  Structure  dependence  in  children's  language.  Language,  63, 
522-543. 

Crain,  S.,  &  Thornton,  R.  (2006).  Acquisition  of  syntax  and  semantics  (2nd  ed) .  In  M.  Traxler  & 
M.  Gernsbacher  (Eds.),  Handbook  of  psycholinguistics.  London,  UK:  Elsevier. 

Crain,  W.  (1993).  Technological  time  values  and  the  assault  on  healthy  development.  Holistic 
Education  Review,  6,  27-34. 

Crain,  W.  (1997,  Spring).  How  nature  helps  children  develop.  Montessori  Life,  9, 41-43. 

Crain,  W.  (2003).  Reclaiming  childhood:  Letting  children  be  children  in  our  achievement-oriented 
society.  New  York:  Holt. 

Crain,  W.,  &  Crain,  E.  E  (1987).  Can  humanistic  psychology  contribute  to  our  understanding  of 
medical  problem-solving?  Psychological  Reports,  61,  779-788. 

Cranston,  M.  (1982).  Jean-Jacques:  The  early  life  and  work  of  Jean- Jacques  Rousseau  1712-1754.  Chicago: 
University  of  Chicago  Press. 

Dale,  P.  S.  (1976).  Language  development:  Structure  and  function  (2nd  ed.).  Hinsdale,  IL:  Dryden 
Press. 

Damon,  W.  (1983).  Social  and  personality  development.  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton. 

Damon,  W.  (1995).  Greater  expectations.  New  York:  Free  Press. 

Darwin,  C.  (1859).  The  origin  of  species.  New  York:  Modern  Library. 

Darwin,  C.  (1874).  The  descent  of  man  (2nd  ed.).  Amherst,  NY:  Prometheus  Books. 

Darwin,  C.  (1887).  The  autobiography  of  Charles  Darwin.  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton. 

Dasen,  P.  R.  (1972).  Cross-cultural  Piagetian  research:  A  summary.  Journal  of  Cross-Cultural 
Psychology,  3,  23-39. 


404 


References 


Davy,  J.  (1984).  Mindstorms  in  the  lamplight.  In  D.  Sloan  (Ed.),  The  computer  in  education:  A  crit¬ 
ical  perspective.  New  York:  Teachers  College  Press. 

DeHart,  G.  B.,  Sroufe,  L.  A.,  &  Cooper,  R.  G.  (2004).  Child  development:  Its  nature  and  course 
(5th  ed.).  Boston:  McGraw  Hill. 

DeVries,  R.,  &  Kohlberg,  L.  (1987).  Constructivist  early  education:  Overview  and  comparison  with 
other  programs.  Washington,  DC:  National  Association  for  the  Education  of  Young  Children. 

Dewey,  J.,  &  Dewey,  E.  (1915).  Schools  for  tomorrow.  New  York:  Dutton. 

Diamond,  A.,  Barnett,  W.  S.,  Thomas,  J.,  &  Munro,  S.  (2007).  Preschool  program  improves  cog¬ 
nitive  control.  Science,  318, 1387-1388. 

Dillon,  S.  (2010,  Jan.  13).  Obama  proposes  sweeping  change  in  education  law.  The  New  York 
Times,  1. 

Dozier,  M.,  &  Rutter,  M.  (2008).  Challenges  to  the  development  of  attachment  relationships  faced 
by  young  children  in  foster  and  adoptive  care.  In  J.  Cassidy  &  P.  R.  Shaver  (Eds.),  Handbook 
of  attachment  (2nd  ed.).  New  York:  Guilford. 

Dubos,  R.  J.  (1961).  The  dreams  of  reason.  New  York:  Columbia  University  Press. 

Edwards,  C.  P.  (1981).  The  comparative  study  of  the  development  of  moral  judgment  and  rea¬ 
soning.  In  R.  L.  Munroe,  R.  Munroe,  &  B.  B.  Whiting  (Eds.),  Handbook  of  cross-cultural 
development.  New  York:  Garland. 

Ehrlich,  P.  R.,  &  Holm,  K.  W.  (1963).  The  process  of  evolution.  New  York:  McGraw-Hill. 

Eisen,  G.  (1990).  Children  and  play  in  the  Holocaust.  Amherst,  MA:  University  of  Massachusetts 
Press. 

Elkind,  D.  (1981).  The  hurried  child.  Reading,  MA:  Addison-Wesley. 

Elkind,  D.  (1986,  May).  Formal  education  and  early  childhood  education:  An  essential  differ¬ 
ence.  Phi  Delta  Kappan,  631-636. 

Ellenberger,  H.  F.  (1958).  A  clinical  introduction  to  psychiatric  phenomenology  and  existential 
analysis.  In  R.  May,  E.  Angel,  &  H.  F.  Ellenberger  (Eds.),  Existence:  A  new  dimension  in 
psychiatry  and  psychology.  New  York:  Basic  Books. 

Ellenberger,  H.  F.  (1970).  The  discovery  of  the  unconscious.  New  York:  Basic  Books. 

Engels,  F.  (1925).  Dialectics  of  nature  (C.  Dutt,  trans.).  Moscow:  Foreign  Languages  Publishing 
House,  1954. 

"Erik  Erikson."  (1994,  May  13).  Obituary,  New  York  Times. 

Erikson,  E.  H.  (1958).  Young  man  Luther.  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton. 

Erikson,  E.  H.  (1959).  Identity  and  the  life  cycle.  Psychological  Issues,  1, 1. 

Erikson,  E.  H.  (1963).  Childhood  and  society  (2nd  ed.).  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton. 

Erikson,  E.  H.  (1964).  Insight  and  responsibility.  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton. 

Erikson,  E.  H.  (1969).  Gandhi's  truth.  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton. 

Erikson,  E.  H.  (1976).  Reflections  on  Dr.  Borg's  life  cycle.  Daedalus,  105, 1-28. 

Erikson,  E.  H.  (1982).  The  life  cycle  completed.  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton. 

Ervin,  S.  M.  (1964).  Imitation  and  structural  change  in  children's  language.  In  E.  H.  Lenneberg 
(Ed.),  New  directions  in  the  study  of  language.  Cambridge,  MA:  MIT  Press. 

Estes,  W.  K.  (1944).  An  experimental  study  of  punishment.  Psychological  Monographs,  57,  94-107. 

Etzel,  B.  C.,  &  Gewirtz,  J.  L.  (1967).  Experimental  modification  of  care-taking  maintained  high-rate 
operant  crying  in  a  6-  and  20-week-old  infant  ( infans  tyrannotearus ):  Extinction  of  crying 
with  reinforcement  of  eye  contact  and  smiling.  Journal  of  Experimental  Child  Psychology, 
5,  303-317. 

Evans,  E.  (1975).  Contemporary  influences  in  early  childhood  education  (2nd  ed.).  New  York:  Holt, 
Rinehart  &  Winston. 

Evans,  R.  E  (1969).  Dialogue  ivith  Erik  Erikson.  New  York:  Dutton. 

Evans,  R.  E  (1989).  Albert  Bandura:  The  man  and  his  ideas — A  dialogue.  New  York:  Praeger. 

Feeney,  J.  A.  (2008).  Adult  romantic  attachment:  Developments  in  the  study  of  couple  relationships. 
In  J.  Cassidy  &  P.  R.Shaver  (Eds.),  Handbook  of  attachment  (2nd  ed.).  New  York:  Guilford. 

Fenichel,  O.  (1945).  The  psychoanalytic  theon/  of  neurosis.  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton. 

Flavell,  J.  H.  (1963).  The  developmental  psychology  of  Jean  Piaget.  New  York:  Van  Nostrand  Reinhold. 

Flavell,  J.  H.  (1977).  Cognitive  development.  Englewood  Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Hall. 

Flavell,  J.  H.  (1985).  Cognitive  development  (2nd  ed.).  Englewood  Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Hall. 

Flavell,  J.  H.,  Botkin,  P.  T.,  Fry,  C.  L.,  Wright,  J.  W.,  &  Jarvis,  P.  E.  (1968).  The  development  of 
role-taking  and  communication  skills  in  children.  New  York:  John  Wiley. 

Flavell,  J.  H.,  Miller,  P.  H.,  &  Miller,  S.  A.  (2002).  Cognitive  development  (4th  ed.).  Upper  Saddle 
River,  NJ:  Prentice-Hall. 


405 


References 


Fogel,  A.  (2009).  Infancy:  Infant,  family,  and  society  (5th  ed.).  Comwell-on-Hudson,  NY:  Sloan. 
Franklin,  M.  B.  (2004).  Prologue  to  Werner,  H.  Comparative  psychology  of  mental  development. 
Clinton  Corners,  NY:  Percheron  Press. 

Freedman,  D.  G.  (1971).  An  evolutionary  approach  to  research  on  the  life  cycle.  Human  Develop¬ 
ment,  14,  87-99. 

Freedman,  D.  G.  (1974).  Human  infancy:  An  evolutionary  perspective.  New  York:  John  Wiley. 
Freud,  A.  (1936).  The  ego  and  the  mechanisms  of  defense.  New  York:  International  Universities  Press, 
1946. 

Freud,  A.  (1958).  Adolescence.  Psychoanalytic  Study  of  the  Child,  13,  255-278. 

Freud,  S.  (1900).  The  interpretation  of  dreams  (J.  Strachey,  trans.).  New  York:  Basic  Books  (Avon), 
1965. 

Freud,  S.  (1905).  Three  contributions  to  the  theory  of  sex.  The  basic  writings  of  Sigmund  Freud 
(A.  A.  Brill,  trans.).  New  York:  Modern  Library. 

Freud,  S.  (1907).  The  sexual  enlightenment  of  children  (J.  Riviere,  trans.).  Collected  papers  (Vol.  2). 
New  York:  Basic  Books,  1959. 

Freud,  S.  (1908a).  Character  and  anal  eroticism  (J.  Riviere,  trans.).  Collected  papers  (Vol.  2).  New 
York:  Basic  Books,  1959. 

Freud,  S.  (1908b).  On  the  sexual  theories  of  children  (J.  Riviere,  trans.).  Collected  papers  (Vol.  2). 
New  York:  Basic  Books.  1959. 

Freud,  S.  (1909).  Analysis  of  a  phobia  in  a  five-year-old  boy  (A.  &  J.  Strachey,  trans.).  Collected  papers 
(Vol.  3).  New  York:  Basic  Books,  1959. 

Freud,  S.  (1910).  The  origin  and  development  of  psychoanalysis.  New  York:  Henry  Regnery  (Gate¬ 
way  Editions),  1965. 

Freud,  S.  (1911).  Formulations  regarding  the  two  principles  of  mental  functioning  (J.  Riviere, 
trans.).  Collected  papers  (Vol.  4).  New  York:  Basic  Books,  1959. 

Freud,  S.  (1912).  Contributions  to  the  psychology  of  love:  The  most  prevalent  form  of  degrada¬ 
tion  in  erotic  life  (J.  Riviere,  trans.).  Collected  papers  (Vol.  4).  New  York:  Basic  Books,  1959. 
Freud,  S.  (1913).  The  excretory  functions  in  psychoanalysis  and  folklore  (J.  Strachey,  trans.). 

Collected  papers  (Vol.  5).  New  York:  Basic  Books,  1959. 

Freud,  S.  (1914a).  On  the  history  of  the  psychoanalytic  movement  (J.  Riviere,  trans.).  Collected 
papers  (Vol.  1).  New  York:  Basic  Books,  1959. 

Freud,  S.  (1914b).  On  narcissism:  An  introduction  (J.  Riviere,  trans.).  Collected  papers  (Vol.  4). 
New  York:  Basic  Books,  1959. 

Freud,  S.  (1915a).  Instincts  and  their  vicissitudes  (J.  Riviere,  trans.).  Collected  papers  (Vol.  4). 
New  York:  Basic  Books,  1959. 

Freud,  S.  (1915b).  The  unconscious  (J.  Riviere,  trans.).  Collected  papers  (Vol.  4).  New  York:  Basic 
Books,  1959. 

Freud,  S.  (1916).  Metapsychological  supplement  to  the  theory  of  dreams  (J.  Riviere,  trans.). 

Collected  papers  (Vol.  4).  New  York:  Basic  Books,  1959. 

Freud,  S.  (1917).  Mourning  and  melancholia  (J.  Riviere,  trans.).  Collected  papers  (Vol.  4).  New  York: 
Basic  Books,  1959. 

Freud,  S.  (1920).  A  general  introduction  to  psychoanalysis  (J.  Riviere,  trans.).  New  York:  Washington 
Square  Press,  1965. 

Freud,  S.  (1922).  Medusa's  head  (J.  Strachey,  trans.).  Collected  papers  (Vol.  5).  New  York:  Basic 
Books,  1959. 

Freud,  S.  (1923).  The  ego  and  the  id  (J.  Riviere,  trans.).  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton,  1960. 

Freud,  S.  (1924).  The  passing  of  the  Oedipus  complex  (J.  Riviere,  trans.).  Collected  papers  (Vol.  2). 
New  York:  Basic  Books,  1959. 

Freud,  S.  (1925a).  Some  psychological  consequences  of  the  anatomical  distinction  between  the 
sexes  (J.  Strachey,  trans.).  Collected  papers  (Vol.  5).  New  York:  Basic  Books,  1959. 

Freud,  S.  (1925b).  The  resistance  to  psychoanalysis  (J.  Strachey,  trans.).  Collected  papers  (Vol.  5). 
New  York:  Basic  Books,  1959. 

Freud,  S.  (1926).  Inhibitions,  symptoms,  and  anxiety  (J.  Strachey,  trans.).  New  York:  Norton,  1959. 
Freud,  S.  (1931).  Female  sexuality  (J.  Strachey,  trans.).  Collected  papers  (Vol.  5).  New  York:  Basic 
Books,  1959. 

Freud,  S.  (1933).  New  introductory  lectures  on  psychoanalysis  (J.  Strachey,  trans.).  New  York: 
Norton,  1965. 

Freud,  S.  (1936a).  The  problem  of  anxiety  (H.  A.  Bunker,  trans.).  New  York:  The  Psychoanalytic 
Press  and  W.  W.  Norton. 


406 


References 


Freud,  S.  (1936b).  A  disturbance  in  memory  on  the  Acropolis  (J.  Strachey,  trans.).  Collected  papers 
(Vol.  5).  New  York:  Basic  Books,  1959. 

Freud,  S.  (1940).  An  outline  of  psychoanalysis  (J.  Strachey,  trans.).  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton,  1949. 

Gardner,  H.  (1973).  The  arts  and  human  development.  New  York:  John  Wiley. 

Gardner,  H.  (1980).  Artful  scribbles.  New  York:  Basic  Books. 

Gardner,  H.  (1982).  Developmental  psychology:  An  introduction  (2nd  ed.).  Boston:  Little,  Brown. 

Gardner,  R.  A. ,  &  Gardner,  B.  (1969,  August  15).  Teaching  sign  language  to  a  chimpanzee.  Science, 
165 , 644-672. 

Gay,  P.  (1969).  The  enlightenment.  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton. 

Gay,  P.  (1988).  Freud:  A  life  for  our  time.  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton. 

Gelman,  R.  (1969).  Conservation  acquisition:  A  problem  of  learning  to  attend  to  relevant  attributes. 
Journal  of  Experimental  Child  Psychology,  7, 167-187. 

Gelman,  R.  (1972).  The  nature  and  development  of  early  number  concepts.  In  H.  Reese  (Ed.), 
Advances  in  child  development  and  behavior  (Vol.  7).  New  York:  Academic  Press. 

Gelman,  R.  (1979).  Preschool  thought.  American  Psychologist,  34, 900-905. 

Gelman,  R.,  &  Baillargeon,  R.  (1983).  A  review  of  some  Piagetian  concepts.  In  P.  H.  Mussen  (Ed.), 
Handbook  of  child  psychology  (4th  ed.)  (Vol.  3,  Cognitive  development,  J.  H.  Flavell  &  E.  M. 
Markman,  Eds.).  New  York:  John  Wiley. 

Gesell,  A.  (1945).  The  embryology  of  behavior.  New  York:  Harper  &  Row. 

Gesell,  A.  (1946).  The  ontogenesis  of  infant  behavior.  In  L.  Carmichael  (Ed.),  Manual  of  child 
psychology  (2nd  ed.).  New  York:  John  Wiley,  1954. 

Gesell,  A.  (1952a).  Autobiography.  In  E.  G.  Boring,  H.  Werner,  R.  M.  Yerkes,  &  H.  Langfield  (Eds.), 
A  history  of  psychology  in  autobiography  (Vol.  4).  Worcester,  MA:  Clark  University  Press. 

Gesell,  A.  (1952b).  Infant  development:  The  embryology  of  early  human  behavior.  Westport,  CT:  Green¬ 
wood  Press,  1972. 

Gesell,  A.,  &  Amatruda,  C.  S.  (1941).  Developmental  diagnosis:  Normal  and  abnormal  child  develop¬ 
ment.  New  York:  Hoeber. 

Gesell,  A.,  &  Ilg,  F.  L.  (1943).  Infant  and  child  in  the  culture  of  today.  In  A.  Gesell  &  F.  L.  Ilg  (Eds.), 
Child  development.  New  York:  Harper  &  Row,  1949. 

Gesell,  A.,  &  Ilg,  F.  L.  (1946).  The  child  from  five  to  ten.  In  A.  Gesell  &  F.  L.  Ilg  (Eds.),  Child  devel¬ 
opment.  New  York:  Harper  &  Row,  1949. 

Gesell,  A.,  Ilg,  F.  L.,  &  Ames,  L.  B.  (1956).  Youth:  The  years  ten  to  sixteen.  New  York:  Harper. 

Gesell,  A.,  &  Thompson,  H.  (1929).  Learning  and  growth  in  identical  infant  twins:  An  experi¬ 
mental  study  by  the  method  of  co-twin  control.  Genetic  Psychology  Monographs,  6, 1-124. 

Gibbs,  J.  C.  (2003).  Moral  development  and  reality.  Thousand  Oaks,  CA:  Sage. 

Gibbs,  J.  C. ,  Basinger,  K.  S.,  Grime,  R.  L.,  &  Snarey,  J.  R.  (2007).  Moral  judgment  development 
across  cultures:  Revisiting  Kohlberg's  universality  claims.  Developmental  Review,  27, 
443-500. 

Gilligan,  C.  (1977).  In  a  different  voice:  Women's  conceptions  of  self  and  morality.  Harvard 
Educational  Review,  47, 481-517. 

Gilligan,  C.  (1982).  In  a  different  voice.  Cambridge,  MA:  Harvard  University  Press. 

Ginsburg,  H.,  &  Opper,  S.  (1988).  Piaget's  theory  of  intellectual  development  (3rd  ed.).  Englewood 
Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Hall. 

Ginsburg,  K.  R.  (2007).  The  importance  of  play  in  promoting  healthy  child  development  and 
maintaining  strong  parent-child  bonds.  Pediatrics,  119, 182-191. 

Gitelson,  M.  (1975).  The  emotional  problems  of  elderly  people.  In  W.  C.  Sze  (Ed.),  Human  life 
cycle.  New  York:  Jason  Aronson. 

Glick,  J.  (1983).  Piaget,  Vygotsky,  and  Werner.  In  S.  Wapner  &  B.  Kaplan  (Eds.),  Toward  a  holistic 
developmental  psychology.  Hillsdale,  NJ:  Erlbaum. 

Goble,  F.  G.  (1970).  The  third  force:  The  psychology  of  Abraham  Maslow.  New  York:  Grossman. 

Goldberg,  S.  (1995).  Introduction.  In  S.  Goldberg,  R.  Muir,  &  J.  Kerr  (Eds.),  Attachment  theory. 
Hillsdale,  NJ:  Analytic  Press. 

Goldstein,  K.  (1939).  The  organism:  A  holistic  approach  to  biology  derived  from  pathological  data  in 
man.  New  York:  American  Book. 

Goleman,  D.  (1990,  March  14).  Bruno  Bettelheim  dies  at  86;  psychoanalyst  of  vast  impact. 
New  York  Times,  p.  D25. 

Gopnik,  A.  (2009,  August  16).  Your  baby  is  smarter  than  you  think.  New  York  Times. 

Gouin-Decarie,  T.  (1965).  Intelligence  and  affectivity  in  early  childhood.  New  York:  International 
Universities  Press. 


407 


References 


Greenberg,  J.  Rv  &  Mitchell,  S.  A.  (1983).  Object  relations  in  psychoanalytic  theory.  Cambridge, 
MA:  Harvard  University  Press. 

Gregory,  R.  L.  (Ed.).  (1987).  The  Oxford  companion  to  the  mind.  Oxford,  UK:  Oxford  University 
Press. 

Griffin,  P.,  &  Cole,  M.  (1984).  Current  activity  for  the  future:  The  Zo-ped.  In  B.  Rogoff  & 
J.  Wertsch  (Eds.),  Children's  learning  in  the  zone  of  proximal  development.  San  Francisco: 
Jossey-Bass. 

Grimm,  The  Brothers  (1972).  The  complete  Grimm's  fairy  tales.  New  York:  Random  House. 

Gruber,  H.  E.  (1981).  Darwin  on  man  (2nd  ed.).  Chicago:  University  of  Chicago  Press. 

Grusec,  J.  E.,  &  Brinker,  D.  B.  (1972).  Reinforcement  for  imitation  as  a  social  learning  determinant 
with  implications  for  sex-role  development.  Journal  of  Personality  and  Social  Psychology, 
21,  149-158. 

Gutman,  D.  (1987).  Reclaimed  powers.  New  York:  Basic  Books. 

Haan,  N.,  Smith,  M.  B.,  &  Block,  J.  (1968).  Moral  reasoning  of  young  adults:  Political-social 
behavior,  family  background,  and  personality  correlates.  Journal  of  Personality  and  Social 
Psychology,  10, 183-201. 

Haber,  R.  N.  (1969,  April).  Eidetic  images.  Scientific  American,  220,  36-44. 

Hahnel,  J.  (2009,  April-June).  No  Child  Left  Behind  fails  to  close  the  achievement  gap.  National 
Center  for  Youth  and  Law.  Retrieved  January  27, 2009. 

Haight,  W.  L.,  &  Miller,  P.  J.  (1993).  Pretending  at  home.  Albany,  NY:  SUNY  Press. 

Halford,  G.  S.,  &  Andrews,  G.  (2006).  Reasoning  and  problem  solving.  In  D.  Kuhn  &  R.  Sielger 
(Eds.),  Handbook  of  child  psychology  (6th  ed.)  (Vol.  2,  Cognition,  perception,  and  language). 
Hoboken,  NJ:  Wiley. 

Hall,  C.  (1954).  A  primer  of  Freudian  psychology.  New  York:  Mentor  Books  (New  American  Library). 

Hall,  C.,  Lindzey,  G.,  &  Campbell,  J.  B.  (1998).  Theories  of  personality  (4th  ed.).  New  York:  John 
Wiley. 

Hanawalt,  B.  A.  (1986).  The  ties  that  bound:  Peasant  families  in  medieval  England.  New  York:  Oxford 
University  Press. 

Harris,  J.  R.,  &  Liebert,  R.  M.  (1984).  The  child.  Englewood  Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Hall. 

Harris,  P.  L.  (1983).  Infant  cognition.  In  M.  M.  Haith  &  J.  J.  Campos  (Eds.),  Handbook  of  child 
psychology  (Vol.  2).  New  York:  Wiley. 

Hart,  B.,  &  Risley,  T.  R.  (2003,  Spring).  The  early  catastrophe.  American  Educator,  27,  4-9. 

Hart,  R.  A.  (1979).  Children's  experience  of  place.  New  York:  Irvington. 

Hartmann,  H.  (1939).  Ego  psychology  and  the  problem  of  adaptation.  New  York:  International 
Universities  Press,  1958. 

Hartmann,  H.  (1950).  Comments  on  the  psychoanalytic  theory  of  the  ego.  In  H.  Hartman  (Ed.), 
Essays  on  ego  psychology.  New  York:  International  Universities  Press,  1964. 

Hartmann,  H.  (1956).  The  development  of  the  ego  concept  in  Freud's  work.  International  Journal 
of  Psychoanalysis,  37,  425-438. 

Hartmann,  H.,  Kris,  E.,  &  Lowenstein,  R.  M.  (1946).  Comments  on  the  formation  of  psychic 
structure.  Psychoanalytic  Study  of  the  Child,  2, 11-38. 

Hass,  W.  R.  (1975).  Pragmatic  structures  of  language:  Historical,  formal,  and  developmental 
issues.  In  K.  F.  Riegel  &  G.  C.  Rosenwald  (Eds.),  Structure  and  transformation.  New  York: 
John  Wiley. 

Havighurst,  R.  J.  (1952).  Developmental  tasks  and  education.  New  York:  David  McKay. 

Havighurst,  R.  J.  (1968).  A  social-psychological  perspective  on  aging.  The  Gerontologist,  8,  67-71. 

Havighurst,  R.  J.,  Neugarten,  B.  L.,  &  Tobin,  S.  S.  (1968).  Disengagement  and  patterns  of  aging. 
In  B.  L.  Neugarten  (Ed.),  Middle  age  and  aging.  Chicago:  University  of  Chicago  Press. 

Hayne,  H.,  &  MacDonald,  S.  (2003).  The  socialization  of  autobiographical  memory  in  children 
and  adults:  The  roles  of  culture  and  gender.  In  R.  Fivush  &  C.  A.  Haden  (Eds.), 
Autobiographical  memory  and  the  construction  of  a  narrative  self:  Developmental  and  cultural 
perspectives.  Mahwah,  NJ:  Erlbaum. 

Heidbreder,  E.  (1933).  Seven  psychologies.  New  York:  Appleton  Century  Crofts. 

Herszenhorn,  D.  (2004,  April  7).  Studies  in  Chicago  fault  policy  of  holding  back  3rd  graders. 
New  York  Times,  B  1,6. 

Hess,  E.  H.  (1962).  Ethology:  An  approach  toward  the  complete  analysis  of  behavior.  In  New 
directions  in  psychology  (Vol.  1).  New  York:  Holt,  Rinehart  &  Winston. 

Hess,  E.  H.  (1973).  Imprinting:  Early  experience  and  the  developmental  psychology  of  attachment. 
New  York:  Van  Nostrand  Reinhold. 


408 


References 


Hesse,  E.  (2008).  The  adult  attachment  interview:  Historical  and  current  perspectives.  In  J.  Cassidy 
&  P.  R.  Shaver  (Eds.),  Handbook  of  attachment  (2nd  ed).  New  York:  Guilford. 

Heubert,  J.  P.,  &  Hauser,  R.  M.  (Eds.).  1999.  High  stakes.  Testing  for  tracking,  promotion,  and  gradua¬ 
tion.  A  report  by  the  National  Research  Council.  Washington,  DC:  National  Academy  Press. 
Hetherington,  E.  M.,  &  Parke,  R.  D.  (1977).  Contemporary  readings  in  child  psychology.  New  York: 
McGraw-Hill. 

Hirsh-Pasek,  K.,  Golinkoff,  R.  M.,  Berk,  L.  E.,  &  Singer,  D.  G.  (2009).  A  mandate  for  playful  learn¬ 
ing  in  preschool.  New  York:  Oxford  University  Press. 

Hofer,  M.  A.  (1981).  The  roots  of  human  behavior:  An  introduction  to  the  psychobiology  of  early  devel¬ 
opment.  San  Francisco:  W.  H.  Freeman. 

Hoffman,  M.  L.  (1970).  Moral  development.  In  P.  H.  Mussen  (Ed.),  Carmichael's  manual  of  child 
psychology  (3rd  ed.)  (Vol.  2).  New  York:  John  Wiley. 

Holstein,  C.  B.  (1973,  March).  Irreversible,  stepwise  sequence  in  the  development  of  moral  judgment: 
A  longitudinal  evaluation.  Paper  presented  at  the  biannual  meeting  of  the  Society  for 
Research  in  Child  Development. 

Holt,  J.  (1964).  How  children  fail.  New  York:  Dell. 

Homme,  L.  E.,  &  Totsi,  D.  T.  (1969).  Contingency  management  and  motivation.  In  D.  M.  Gelfand 
(Ed.),  Social  learning  in  childhood:  Readings  in  theory  and  application.  Belmont,  CA: 
Brooks /Cole. 

Honigmann,  J.  J.  (1967).  Personality  in  culture.  New  York:  Harper  &  Row. 

Hussain-Rizvi,  A.,  Kunkov,  S.,  &  Crain,  E.  F.  (2009).  Does  parental  involvement  in  pediatric 
emergency  department  asthma  treatment  affect  home  involvement?  Journal  of  Asthma,  46, 
729-795. 

Hyams,  N.  M.  (1986).  Language  acquisition  and  the  theory  of  parameters.  Dordrecht,  Holland: 

D.  Reider. 

Inhelder,  B.  (1971).  The  criteria  of  the  stages  of  mental  development.  In  J.  M.  Tanner  &  B.  Inhelder 
(Eds.),  Discussions  on  child  development.  New  York:  International  Universities  Press. 
Inhelder,  B.,  &  Piaget,  J.  (1955).  The  growth  of  logical  thinking  from  childhood  to  adolescence  (A.  Parsons 
&  S.  Milgram,  trans.).  New  York:  Basic  Books. 

Jacobi,  J.  (1965).  The  way  of  individuation  (R.  F.  C.  Hull,  trans.).  San  Diego:  Harcourt  Brace 
Jovanovich,  1967. 

Jacobson,  E.  (1964).  The  self  and  the  object  world.  Psychoanalytic  Study  of  the  Child,  9,  75-127. 
Jatich,  A.  M.  (1990,  October).  Repudiating  Bettelheim.  University  of  Chicago  Magazine,  83. 
Johnson,  C.  (1990).  On  becoming  lost.  Salt  Lake  City,  UT:  Gibbs-Smith. 

Johnson,  J.  S.,  &  Newport,  E.  L.  (1989).  Critical  period  effects  in  second  language  learning:  The 
influence  of  maturational  state  on  the  acquisition  of  English  as  a  second  language.  Cognitive 
Psychology,  21,  60-99. 

John-Steiner,  V.,  &  Souberman,  E.  (1978).  Afterword.  In  M.  Cole,  V.  John-Steiner,  S.  Scribner,  & 

E.  Souberman  (Eds.),  L.  S.  Vygotsky:  Mind  in  society.  Cambridge,  MA:  Harvard  Univer¬ 
sity  Press. 

Jones,  E.  (1918).  Anal-erotic  character  traits.  Journal  of  Abnormal  Psychology,  13,  261-284. 

Jones,  E.  (1961).  The  life  and  work  of  Sigmund  Freud  (ed.  and  abridged  by  J.  Trilling  &  S.  Marcus). 
New  York:  Basic  Books. 

Jones,  M.  C.  (1924).  A  laboratory  study  of  fear:  The  case  of  Peter.  Pedagogical  Seminary,  31, 308-315. 
Jung,  C.  G.  (1931).  Marriage  as  a  psychological  relationship  (R.  F.  C.  Hull,  trans.).  In  C.  G.  Jung, 
The  collected  works  of  C.  G.  Jung:  Vol.  20.  The  development  of  personality.  Princeton,  NJ:  Prince¬ 
ton  University  Press,  1953. 

Jung,  C.  G.  (1933).  Modern  man  in  search  of  a  soul  (W.  S.  Dell  &  C.  F.  Baynes,  trans.).  New  York: 
Harvest  Book. 

Jung,  C.  G.  (1945).  The  relations  between  the  ego  and  the  unconscious  (R.  F.  C.  Hull,  trans.).  The 
collected  works  ofC.  G.  Jung:  Vol.  7.  Two  essays  in  analytic  psychology.  Princeton,  NJ:  Princeton 
University  Press,  1953. 

Jung,  C.  G.  (1961).  Memories,  dreams,  reflections  (A.  Jaffe,  Ed.,  R.  &  G.  Winston,  trans.).  New  York: 
Vintage  Books. 

Jung,  C.  G.  (1964).  Approaching  the  unconscious.  In  C.  G.  Jung  (Ed.),  Man  and  his  symbols. 
New  York:  Dell. 

Justor,  F.  T.,  Ono,  H.,  &  Stafford,  F.P.  (2004).  Changing  times  for  American  youth:  1981-2003. 

www.ns.umich.edu/Releases/2004/Nov04/teen_time_report.pdf 
Kagan,  J.  (1984).  The  nature  of  the  child.  New  York:  Basic  Books. 


409 


References 


Kahn,  D.  (1993).  Montessori  in  the  public  schools.  Cleveland,  OH:  Montessori  Public  School 
Consortium. 

Kamii,  C.  K.  (1973).  Piaget's  interactionism  and  the  process  of  teaching  young  children.  In 
M.  Schwebel  &  J.  Raph  (Eds.),  Piaget  in  the  classroom.  New  York:  Basic  Books. 

Kamii,  C.  K.  (1980).  Why  use  group  games?  In  C.  Kamii  &  R.  DeVries  (Eds.),  Group  games  in 
early  education.  Washington,  DC:  National  Association  for  the  Education  of  Young 
Children. 

Kamii,  C.  K.  (1985).  Young  children  reinvent  arithmetic.  New  York:  Teachers  College  Press. 

Kamii,  C.  K.  (1994).  Young  children  continue  to  reinvent  arithmetic:  3rd  grade.  New  York:  Teachers 
College  Press. 

Kamii,  C.  K.  (2004).  Young  children  continue  to  reinvent  arithmetic:  2nd  grade  (2nd  ed).  New  York: 
Teachers  College  Press. 

Kamii,  C.,  &  DeVries,  R.  (1977).  Piaget  for  education.  In  M.  C.  Day  &  R.  K.  Parker  (Eds.),  The 
preschool  in  action  (2nd  ed.).  Boston:  Allyn  &  Bacon. 

Kanner,  L.  (1943).  Autistic  disturbances  of  affective  contact.  Nervous  Child,  2,  217-250. 

Kant,  I.  (1788).  The  critique  of  practical  reason  (L.  W.  Beck,  trans.).  New  York:  Liberal  Arts  Press,  1956. 

Kaplan,  L.  J.  (1978).  Oneness  and  separateness.  New  York:  Simon  &  Schuster  (Touchstone). 

Kardiner,  A.  (1945).  The  psychological  frontiers  of  society.  New  York:  Columbia  University  Press. 

Karen,  R.  (1994).  Becoming  attached.  New  York:  Warner  Books  (Oxford  University  Press  paperback, 
1998). 

Kegan,  R.  (1985).  The  loss  of  Pete's  Dragon:  Developments  of  the  self  in  the  years  five  to  seven. 
In  R.  L.  Leahy  (Ed.),  The  development  of  the  self.  New  York:  Academic  Press. 

Keniston,  K.  (1971).  The  perils  of  principle.  In  K.  Keniston  (Ed.),  Youth  and  dissent.  San  Diego: 
Harcourt  Brace  Jovanovich. 

Kessen,  W.  (1965).  The  child.  New  York:  John  Wiley. 

King,  M.  L.,  Jr.  (1963).  Strength  to  love.  Philadelphia,  PA:  Fortress  Press. 

Kirsh,  S.  J.  (2006).  Children,  adolescents,  and  media  violence.  Thousand  Oaks,  CA:  Sage. 

Klein,  A  (2010,  March  2).  Standards,  Title  I  link  scrutinized.  Education  Week. 

Klima,  E.  S.,  &  Bellugi,  U.  (1966).  Syntactic  regularities  in  the  speech  of  children.  In  J.  Lyons  & 
R.  J.  Wales  (Eds.),  Psycholinguistics  papers.  Edinburgh:  Edinburgh  University  Press. 

Koegel.  R.  L.,  &  Koegel,  L.  K.  (2006).  Pivotal  response  treatments  for  autism.  Baltimore,  MD:  Paul 
H.  Brookes. 

Kohlberg,  L.  (1958a).  The  development  of  modes  of  thinking  and  choice  in  the  years  10  to  16.  Unpub¬ 
lished  doctoral  dissertation.  University  of  Chicago. 

Kohlberg,  L.  (1958b).  Global  Rating  Guide  with  new  materials.  School  of  Education,  Harvard 
University. 

Kohlberg,  L.  (1963).  The  development  of  children's  orientations  toward  a  moral  order:  I.  Sequence 
in  the  development  of  moral  thought.  Human  Development,  6, 11-33. 

Kohlberg,  L.  (1964).  Development  of  moral  character  and  moral  ideology.  In  M.  L.  Hoffman  & 
L.  W.  Hoffman  (Eds.),  Review  of  child  development  research  (Vol.  1).  New  York:  Russell  Sage 
Foundation. 

Kohlberg,  L.  (1966a).  Cognitive  stages  and  preschool  education.  Human  Development,  9,  5-17. 

Kohlberg,  L.  (1966b).  A  cognitive-developmental  analysis  of  children's  sex-role  concepts  and 
attitudes.  In  E.  E.  Maccoby  (Ed.),  The  development  of  sex  differences.  Stanford:  Stanford 
University  Press. 

Kohlberg,  L.  (1968).  Early  education:  A  cognitive-developmental  approach.  Child  Development,  39, 
1013-1062. 

Kohlberg,  L.  (1969a).  Stage  and  sequence.  A  cognitive-developmental  approach  to  socialization. 
In  D.  A.  Goslin  (Ed.),  Handbook  of  socialization  theory  and  research.  Chicago:  Rand  McNally. 

Kohlberg,  L.  (1969b).  The  relations  between  moral  judgment  and  moral  action.  Colloquium  presented 
at  the  Institute  of  Human  Development.  Berkeley:  University  of  California  Press. 

Kohlberg,  L.  (1970).  The  child  as  a  moral  philosopher.  Readings  in  developmental  psychology  today. 
Del  Mar,  CA:  CRM  Books. 

Kohlberg,  L.  (1976).  Moral  stages  and  moralization:  The  cognitive-developmental  approach.  In 
T.  Lickona  (Ed.),  Moral  development  and  behavior:  Theory,  research,  and  social  issues.  New  York: 
Holt,  Rinehart  &  Winston. 

Kohlberg,  L.  (1981).  Essays  on  moral  development  (Vol.  1).  New  York:  Harper  &  Row. 

Kohlberg,  L.,  &  Candee,  D.  (1984).  The  relationship  of  moral  judgment  to  moral  action.  In 
L.  Kohlberg  (Ed.),  Essays  on  moral  development  (Vol.  II).  Cambridge,  MA:  Harper  &  Row. 


410 


References 


Kohlberg,  L.,  &  Elfenbein,  D.  (1975).  The  development  of  moral  judgments  concerning  capital 
punishment.  American  Journal  of  Orthopsychiatry,  45,  614-640. 

Kohlberg,  L.,  &  Gilligan,  C.  (1971).  The  adolescent  as  philosopher.  Daedalus,  100, 1051-1086. 

Kohlberg,  L.,  Kauffman,  K.,  Scharf,  P.,  &  Hickey,  J.  (1975).  The  just  community  approach  to 
corrections:  A  theory.  Journal  of  Moral  Education,  4,  243-260. 

Kohlberg,  L.,  &  Kramer,  R.  (1969).  Continuities  and  discontinuities  in  childhood  and  adult  moral 
development.  Human  Development,  12,  93-120. 

Kohlberg,  L.,  &  Power,  C.  (1981).  Moral  development,  religious  thinking,  and  the  question  of 
a  seventh  stage.  In  L.  Kohlberg  (Ed.),  Essays  on  moral  development  (Vol.  1).  New  York: 
Harper  &  Row. 

Kohlberg,  L.,  Yaeger,  J.,  &  Hjertholm,  E.  (1968).  The  development  of  private  speech:  Four 
studies  and  a  review  of  theories.  Child  Development,  39,  691-736. 

Kohler,  W.  (1925).  The  mentality  of  apes.  London:  Routledge  &  Kegan  Paul. 

Kozol,  J.  (2005).  The  shame  of  the  nation.  New  York:  Random  House. 

Kozulin,  A.  (Ed.).  (1986).  Vygotsky  in  context.  Introductory  chapter  to  L.  S.  Vygotsky's  Thought 
and  language.  Cambridge,  MA:  MIT  Press. 

Kramer,  R.  (1976).  Maria  Montessori:  A  biography.  New  York:  Putnam's. 

Kris,  E.  (1952).  Psychoanalytic  explorations  in  art.  New  York:  International  Universities  Press. 

Kroger,  J.  (2007).  Identity  development  (2nd  ed.).  Thousand  Oaks,  CA:  Sage. 

Kubler-Ross,  E.  (1969).  On  death  and  dying.  New  York:  Macmillan. 

Kuhn,  D.  (1974).  Inducing  development  experimentally:  Comments  on  a  research  paradigm. 
Developmental  Psychology,  10,  590-600. 

Kuhn,  D.,  Langer,  J.,  Kohlberg,  L.,  &  Haan,  N.  (1977).  The  development  of  formal  operations  in 
logical  and  moral  judgment.  Genetic  Psychology  Monographs,  95,  97-188. 

Labov,  W.  (1970).  The  logic  of  nonstandard  English.  In  F.  Williams  (Ed.),  Eanguage  and  poverty: 
Perspectives  on  a  theme.  Chicago:  Markham. 

Laing,  R.  D.  (1965).  The  divided  self:  An  existential  study  in  sanity  and  madness.  Middlesex,  UK: 
Penguin. 

Laing,  R.  D.  (1967).  The  politics  of  experience.  New  York:  Ballantine  Books. 

Lamb,  M.  E.,  &  Campos,  J.  J.  (1982).  Development  in  infancy.  New  York:  Random  House. 

Lamprecht,  S.  P.  (1928).  Introduction.  In  S.  P.  Lambrecht  (Ed.),  Locke:  Selections.  New  York:  Charles 
Scribner's  Sons. 

Lee,  D.  (1959).  Freedom  and  culture.  Englewood  Cliffs,  NJ:  Spectrum  (Prentice-Hall). 

Levinson,  D.  (1977).  The  mid-life  transition.  Psychiatry,  40,  99-112. 

Levinson,  D.  (1978).  The  seasons  of  a  man's  life.  New  York:  Ballantine. 

Levinson,  D.  J.  (1996).  The  seasons  of  a  woman's  life.  New  York:  Ballantine  Books. 

Liebert,  R.  M.,  Odom,  R.  D.,  Hill,  J.  H.,  &  Huff,  R.  L.  (1969).  Effects  of  age  and  rule  familiarity 
on  the  production  of  modeled  language  constructions.  Developmental  Psychology,  1, 108-112. 

Liebert,  R.  M.,  Poulos,  R.  W.,  &  Marmor,  G.  S.  (1977).  Developmental  psychology  (2nd  ed.).  Engle¬ 
wood  Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Hall. 

Lightfoot,  D.  (1982).  The  language  lottery:  Toward  a  biology  of  grammars.  Cambridge,  MA:  MIT  Press. 

Lightfoot,  D.  (1999).  The  development  of  language.  Malden,  MA:  Blackwell. 

Lillard,  A.,  &  Else-Quest,  N.  (2006,  September  29).  Evaluating  Montessori  education.  Science, 
313, 1893-1894. 

Lillard,  P.  P.  (1972).  Montessori:  A  modern  approach.  New  York:  Schocken. 

Lillard,  P.  P.  (1996).  Montessori  today.  New  York:  Schocken. 

Lipsitt,  L.  P.  (1971,  December  5).  Babies:  They're  a  lot  smarter  than  they  look.  Psychology  Today, 
pp.  70-72,  80-89. 

Lipsitt,  L.  P.  (1975).  The  synchrony  of  respiration,  heart  rate,  and  sucking  behavior  in  the  new¬ 
born.  Biologic  and  clinical  aspects  of  brain  development,  Mead  Johnson  Symposium  on  Prenatal 
and  Developmental  Medicine,  No.  6.  Reprinted  in  R.  C.  Smart  &  M.  S.  Smart  (Eds.), 
Readings  in  child  development  and  relations  (2nd  ed.).  New  York:  Macmillan,  1977. 

Locke,  J.  (1689).  Two  treatises  on  government,  P.  Laslett  (Ed.).  Cambridge,  UK:  Cambridge  Univer¬ 
sity  Press,  1960. 

Locke,  J.  (1690).  Essay  concerning  human  understanding  (Vol.  1,  J.  W.  Yolton,  Ed.).  London:  J.  M. 
Dent  and  Sons,  1961. 

Locke,  J.  (1693).  Some  thoughts  concerning  education.  In  P.  Gay  (Ed.),  John  Locke  on  education.  New 
York:  Bureau  of  Publications,  Teacher's  College,  Columbia  University,  1964. 

Looft,  W.  R.,  &  Bartz,  W.  H.  (1969).  Animisim  revived.  Psychological  Bulletin,  71, 1-19. 


411 


References 


Lorenz,  K.  (1935).  Companions  as  factors  in  the  bird's  environment.  In  K.  Lorenz,  Studies  in  ani¬ 
mal  and  human  behavior  (Vol.  1)  (R.  Martin,  trans.).  Cambridge,  MA:  Harvard  University 
Press,  1971. 

Lorenz,  K.  (1937).  The  establishment  of  the  instinct  concept.  In  K.  Lorenz,  Studies  in  animal  and 
human  behavior  (Vol.  1)  (R.  Martin,  trans.).  Cambridge,  MA:  Harvard  University  Press, 
1971. 

Lorenz,  K.  (1952a).  The  past  twelve  years  in  the  comparative  study  of  behavior.  In  C.  H.  Schiller 
(Ed.),  Instinctive  behavior.  New  York:  International  Universities  Press,  1957. 

Lorenz,  K.  (1952b).  King  Solomon's  ring  (M.  K.  Wilson,  trans.).  New  York:  Thomas  Y.  Crowell. 

Lorenz,  K.  (1963).  On  aggression.  San  Diego:  Harcourt  Brace  Jovanovich. 

Lorenz,  K.  (1965).  Evolution  and  modification  of  behavior.  Chicago:  University  of  Chicago  Press. 

Lorenz,  K.  (1981).  The  foundations  of  ethology.  New  York:  Touchstone  Book  (Simon  &  Schuster). 

Lovaas,  O.  I.  (1969).  Behavior  modification:  Teaching  language  to  autistic  children.  [Instructional  film, 
45  min.,  16mm-sound].  New  York:  Appleton-Century-Crofts. 

Lovaas,  O.  I.  (1973).  Behavioral  treatment  of  autistic  children.  University  Programs  Modular  Studies. 
Morristown,  NJ:  General  Learning  Press. 

Lovaas,  O.  I.  (1977).  The  autistic  child.  New  York:  Halstead  Press. 

Lovaas,  O.  I.  (1987).  Behavioral  treatment  and  normal  educational  and  intellectual  functioning 
in  young  autistic  children.  Journal  of  Consulting  and  Clinical  Psychology ,  55,  3-9. 

Lovaas,  O.  I.  (2003).  Teaching  individuals  with  developmental  delays.  Austin,  TX:  PRO-ED. 

Lovell,  K.  (1968,  April  5  and  6).  Piaget  in  perspective:  The  experimental  foundations.  Paper  presented 
to  the  conference  of  the  University  of  Sussex,  Sussex,  England. 

Luria,  A.  R.  (1960).  Verbal  regulation  of  behavior.  In  M.  A.  B.  Brader  (Ed.),  The  central  nervous 
system  and  behavior.  New  York:  Josiah  Macy  Jr.  Foundation. 

Luria,  A.  R.  (1961).  The  role  of  speech  in  the  regulation  of  normal  and  abnormal  behavior.  New  York: 
Liveright. 

Luria,  A.  R.  (1976).  Cognitive  development:  Its  cultural  and  social  foundations  (M.  Lopez-Morillas  & 
L.  Solotaroff,  trans.).  Cambridge,  MA:  Harvard  University  Press. 

Luria,  A.  R.  (1981).  Language  and  cognition.  (J.  Wertsch,  ed.).  New  York:  John  Wiley. 

Lyons,  N.  P.  (1983).  Two  perspectives:  On  self,  relationships,  and  morality.  Harvard  Educational 
Review ,  53, 125-145. 

Lyons-Ruth,  K.,  &  Jacobivtz,  D.  (2008).  Attachment  disorganization:  Genetic  factors,  parenting 
contexts,  and  developmental  transformation  from  infancy  to  adulthood.  In  J.  Cassidy  & 
P.R.  Shaver  (Eds.),  Handbook  of  attachment  (2nd  ed.).  New  York:  Guilford. 

Maccoby,  E.  E.,  &  Wilson,  W.  C.  (1957).  Identification  and  observational  learning  from  films. 
Journal  of  Abnormal  and  Social  Psychology,  55,  76-87. 

Maccoby,  E.  E.,  Wilson,  W.  C.,  &  Jacklin,  C.  N.  (1974).  The  psychology  of  sex  differences.  Stanford, 
CA:  Stanford  University  Press. 

MacFarlane,  A.  (1981).  What  a  baby  knows.  In  H.  E.  Fitzgerald  (Ed.),  Human  development  81/82. 
Annual  Editions.  Guilford,  CT:  Dushkin. 

McCartney,  K.,  Clark-Stewart,  A.,  Owen,  M.  T.,  Burchinal,  M.,  Bub,  K.  L.,  &  Belsky,  J.  (2010). 
Testing  a  series  of  causal  propositions  relating  time  in  child  care  to  children's  externaliz¬ 
ing  behavior.  Developmental  Psychology,  46, 1-17. 

McEachlin,  J.  J.,  Smith,  T.,  &  Lovaas,  O.  I.  (1993).  Long-term  outcome  for  children  with  autism 
who  received  early  intensive  behavioral  treatment.  American  Journal  on  Mental  Retardation, 
97, 259-372. 

McNeill,  D.  (1966).  Developmental  psycholinguistics.  In  F.  Smith  &  G.  A.  Miller  (Eds.),  The  gen¬ 
esis  of  language:  A  psycholinguists  approach.  Cambridge,  MA:  MIT  Press. 

Maestripieri,  D.  (2001).  Is  there  mother-infant  bonding  in  primates?  Developmental  Review,  21, 
93-120. 

Mahler,  M.  S.  (1968).  On  human  symbiosis  and  the  vicissitudes  of  individuation.  Vol.  1:  Infantile  psy¬ 
chosis  (in  collaboration  with  M.  Furer).  New  York:  International  Universities  Press. 

Mahler,  M.  S.  (1988).  The  memoirs  of  Margaret  S.  Mahler  (compiled  and  edited  by  P.  E.  Stepansky). 
New  York:  Free  Press. 

Mahler,  M.  S.,  Pine,  F.,  &  Bergman,  A.  (1975).  The  psychological  birth  of  the  human  infant.  London: 
Hutchinson. 

Main,  M.  (1995).  Recent  studies  in  attachment:  Overview  with  selected  implications  for  clin¬ 
ical  work.  In  S.  Goldberg,  R.  Muir,  &  J.  Kerr  (Eds.),  Attachment  theory.  Hillsdale,  NJ: 
Analytic  Press. 


412 


References 


Main,  M.,  &  Goldwyn,  R.  (1987).  Interview-based  adult  attachment  classifications:  Related  to  infant- 
mother  and  infant-father  attachment.  Unpublished  manuscript,  Department  of  Psychology, 
University  of  California,  Berkeley 

Main,  M.,  Goldwyn,  R.,  Kaplan,  N.,  &  Cassidy,  J.  (1985).  Security  in  infancy  childhood,  and 
adulthood:  A  move  to  the  level  of  representation.  In  I.  Bretherton  &  E.  Waters  (Eds.),  Grow¬ 
ing  points  of  attachment  theory  and  research.  Monographs  of  the  Society  for  Research  in  Child 
Development,  50  (Serial  No.  209). 

Malinowski,  B.  (1927).  Sex  and  repression  in  savage  society.  San  Diego:  Harcourt  Brace  Jovanovich. 
Mandler,  J.  M.  (1998).  Representation.  In  D.  Kuhn  &  R.  S.  Siegler  (Eds.),  Handbook  of  Child  Psy¬ 
chology  (5th  ed.)  (Vol.  2).  New  York:  John  Wiley. 

Manuel,  F.  (1972).  Comments.  In  International  Study  Project,  Inc.,  Abraham  Maslow:  A  memorial 
volume.  Monterey,  CA:  Brooks/Cole. 

Marcia,  J.  E.  (1966).  Development  and  validation  of  ego  identity  status.  Journal  of  Personality  and 
Social  Psychology,  3,  551-558. 

Marks,  L.  (1975).  On  colored-hearing  synesthesia.  Psychological  Bulletin,  82,  303-331. 

Marler,  P.,  &  Tamura,  M.  (1964).  Culturally  transmitted  patterns  of  vocal  behavior  in  sparrows. 
Science,  146, 1483-1486. 

Marx,  K.  (1844).  Economic  and  philosophical  manuscripts  (M.  Milligan,  trans.).  In  R.  C.  Tucker  (Ed.), 
The  Marx-Engels  reader.  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton,  1972. 

Marx,  K.  (1845).  Theses  on  Feuerbach.  In  R.  C.  Tucker  (Ed.),  The  Marx-Engels  reader.  New  York:  W. 
W.  Norton,  1972. 

Marx,  K.  (1859).  Preface  to  A  contribution  to  the  critique  of  political  economy.  In  R.  C.  Tucker  (Ed.), 
The  Marx-Engels  reader.  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton,  1972. 

Marx,  K.,  &  Engels,  F.  (1846).  The  German  ideology  (S.  Ryazanskaya  &  W.  Lough,  trans.).  In 
R.  C.  Tucker  (Ed.),  The  Marx-Engels  reader.  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton,  1972. 

Marx,  K.,  &  Engels,  F.  (1872).  Manifesto  of  the  Communist  Party.  In  R.  C.  Tucker  (Ed.),  The  Marx- 
Engels  reader.  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton,  1972. 

Maslow,  A.  (1943).  A  dynamic  theory  of  human  motivation.  Psychological  Review,  50,  370-396. 
Maslow,  A.  (1954).  Motivation  and  personality  (2nd  ed.).  New  York:  Harper  &  Row,  1970. 

Maslow,  A.  (1966).  The  psychology  of  science:  A  reconnaissance.  Chicago:  Henry  Regnery  (Gateway), 

1969. 

Maslow,  A.  (1968).  Toward  a  psychology  of  being  (2nd  ed.).  New  York:  Van  Nostrand  Reihold. 
Maslow,  A.  (1971).  The  farther  reaches  of  human  nature.  New  York:  Viking. 

Mead,  M.  (1964).  Continuities  in  cultural  evolution.  New  Haven,  CT:  Yale  University  Press. 
Meltzoff,  A.  N.  (1988).  Infant  imitation  and  memory:  Nine-month-olds  in  immediate  and  deferred 
tests.  Child  Development,  59,  217-225. 

Miller,  E.,  &  Almon,  J.  (2009).  Crisis  in  the  kindergarten:  Why  children  need  play  in  school.  College 
Park,  MD:  Alliance  for  Childhood. 

Miller,  L.  B.,  &  Dyer,  J.  L.  (1975).  Four  preschool  programs:  Their  dimensions  and  effects. 

Monographs  of  the  Society  for  Research  in  Child  Development,  40  (Serial  No.  162). 

Miller,  P.,  &  Garvey,  C.  (1984).  Mother-baby  role  play:  Its  origins  in  social  support.  In  I.  Bretherton 
(Ed.),  Symbolic  play.  Orlando,  FL:  Academic  Press. 

Miller,  P.  H.  (2011).  Theories  of  developmental  psychology  (5th  ed.).  New  York:  W.  H.  Freeman. 
Miller,  R.  (1990).  What  are  schools  for?  Holistic  education  in  American  culture.  Brandon,  VT:  Holistic 
Education  Press. 

Mills,  C.  W.  (1962).  The  Marxists.  New  York:  Dell. 

Mischel,  W.  (1970).  Sex-typing  and  socialization.  In  P.  H.  Mussen  (Ed.),  Carmichael's  manual  of 
child  psychology  (3rd  ed.)  (Vol.  2).  New  York:  John  Wiley 
Misiak,  H.,  &  Sexton,  V.  S.  (1973).  Phenomenological,  existential,  and  humanistic  psychologies:  A  his¬ 
torical  survey.  New  York:  Grune  &  Stratton. 

Montessori,  M.  (1909).  The  Montessori  method  (A.  E.  George,  trans.).  New  York:  Schocken,  1964. 
Montessori,  M.  (1917).  The  advanced  Montessori  method:  Vol.  1.  Spontaneous  activity  in  education 
(F.  Simmonds,  trans.).  Cambridge,  MA:  Robert  Bentley,  1964. 

Montessori,  M.  (1936a).  The  child  in  the  family  (N.  R.  Cirillo,  trans.).  Chicago:  Henry  Regnery, 

1970. 

Montessori,  M.  (1936b).  The  secret  of  childhood  (M.  J.  Costelloe,  trans.).  New  York:  Ballantine  Books, 
1966. 

Montessori,  M.  (1948a).  The  discovery  of  the  child  (M.  J.  Costelloe,  trans.).  Notre  Dame,  IN:  Fides 
Publishers,  1967. 


413 


References 


Montessori,  M.  (1948b).  From  childhood  to  adolescence  (A.  M.  Joosten,  trans.).  New  York:  Schocken, 
1973. 

Montessori,  M.  (1949).  The  absorbent  mind  (C.  A.  Claremont,  trans.).  New  York:  Holt,  Rinehart  & 
Winston,  1967. 

Montessori,  M.  (1970).  Maria  Montessori:  A  centenary  anthology,  1870-1970.  Koninginneweg, 
Amsterdam:  Association  Montessori  Internationale. 

Moore,  R.  C.  (1989).  Before  and  after  asphalt.  In  M.  N.  Bloch  &  A.  D.  Pellegrini  (Eds.),  The  ecological 
context  of  children's  play.  Norwood,  NJ:  Ablex. 

Munn,  N.  L.  (1974).  The  growth  of  human  behavior  (3rd  ed.).  Boston:  Houghton  Mifflin. 

Munn,  N.  L.,  Fernald,  L.  D.,  &  Fernald,  P.  S.  (1974).  Introduction  to  psychology  (3rd  ed.).  Boston: 
Houghton  Mifflin. 

Munroe,  R.  (1955).  Schools  of  psychoanalytic  thought.  New  York:  Henry  Holt. 

Munson,  K.  J.,  &  Crosbie,  J.  (1998).  Effects  of  response  cost  in  computerized  programmed  instruc¬ 
tion.  The  Psychological  Record,  48, 233-250. 

Murphy,  M.  J.  (2007,  May  20).  My  dear  fellow  species.  New  York  Times. 

Mussen,  P.  H.,  &  Eisenberg-Berg,  N.  (1977).  Roots  of  caring,  sharing,  and  helping.  San  Francisco: 
W.  H.  Freeman. 

Muuss,  R.  E.  (1975).  Theories  of  adolescence  (3rd  ed.).  New  York:  Random  House. 

National  Institute  of  Child  Health  and  Human  Development.  (2003).  Does  the  amount  of  time 
spent  in  child  care  predict  socioemotional  adjustment  during  the  transition  to  kinder¬ 
garten?  Child  Development,  74, 976-1005. 

Needham,  J.  (1959).  A  history  of  embryology  (2nd  ed.).  Cambridge,  UK:  Cambridge  University 
Press. 

Neill,  A.  S.  (1960).  Summerhill:  A  radical  approach  to  child  rearing.  New  York:  Hart. 

Neimark,  E.  D.  (1975).  Longitudinal  development  of  formal  operations  thought.  Genetic  Psy¬ 
chology  Monographs,  91, 171-225. 

Nelson,  K.  (2003).  Narrative  and  self,  myth  and  memory:  Emergence  of  the  cultural  self.  In 
R.  Fivush  &  C.  A.  Haden  (Eds.),  Autobiographical  memory  and  the  construction  of  a  narrative 
self:  Developmental  and  cultural  perspectives.  Mahwah,  NJ:  Erlbaum 

Neugarten,  B.  L.  (1964).  A  developmental  view  of  adult  personality.  In  J.  E.  Birren  (Ed.),  Relations 
of  development  and  aging.  Springfield,  IL:  Charles  C  Thomas. 

Neugarten,  B.  L.  (1968).  Adult  personality:  Toward  a  psychology  of  the  life  cycle.  In  B.  L.  Neu¬ 
garten  (Ed.),  Middle  age  and  aging.  Chicago:  University  of  Chicago  Press. 

Newman,  B.  M.,  &  Newman,  P.  R.  (2003).  Development  through  life  (8th  ed.).  Belmont,  CA: 
Wadsworth. 

Newport,  E.  (1990).  Maturational  constraints  on  language  learning.  Cognitive  Science,  14, 11-28. 

Nisan,  M.,  &  Kohlberg,  L.  (1982).  Universality  and  variation  in  moral  judgment:  A  longitudinal 
and  cross-sectional  study  in  Turkey.  Child  Development,  52,  865-876. 

Oppenheimer,  T.  (2003).  The  flickering  mind.  New  York:  Random  House. 

Palinscar,  A.  S.,  &  Brown,  A.  L.  (1989).  Instruction  for  self-regulated  reading.  In  L.  B.  Resnick  & 
L.  E.  Klopfer  (Eds.),  Toward  the  thinking  curriculum.  Alexandria,  VA:  Association  for  Super¬ 
vision  and  Curriculum  Development. 

Papert,  S.  (1980).  Mindstorms.  New  York:  Basic  Books. 

Parritz,  R.  H.,  &  Troy,  M.  F.  (2011).  Disorders  of  childhood.  Belmont,  CA:  Wadsworth. 

Pavlov,  I.  P.  (1927).  Conditioned  reflexes  (G.  V.  Anrep,  trans.).  London:  Oxford  University  Press. 

Pavlov,  I.  P.  (1928).  Lectures  on  conditioned  reflexes  (Vol.  1,  W.  H.  Gantt,  trans.).  New  York:  Inter¬ 
national  Publishers. 

Peill,  E.  J.  (1975).  Invention  and  discovery  of  reality.  London:  John  Wiley. 

Pheardon,  T.  P.  (1952).  Introduction.  In  T.  P.  Pheardon  (Ed.),  John  Locke:  The  second  treatise  of 
government.  New  York:  Liberal  Arts  Press. 

Piaget,  J.  (1923).  The  language  and  thought  of  the  child  (M.  Gabain,  trans.).  London:  Routledge  and 
Kegan  Paul,  1959. 

Piaget,  J.  (1924).  Judgment  and  reasoning  in  the  child  (M.  Warden,  trans.).  Savage,  MD:  Littlefield, 
Adams,  1972. 

Piaget,  J.  (1926).  The  child's  conception  of  the  world  (J.  &  A.  Tomlinson,  trans.).  Savage,  MD:  Little¬ 
field,  Adams,  1963. 

Piaget,  J.  (1932).  The  moral  judgment  of  the  child  (M.  Gabain,  trans.).  New  York:  Free  Press,  1965. 

Piaget,  J.  (1936a).  The  origins  of  intelligence  in  children  (M.  Cook,  trans.).  New  York:  International 
Universities  Press,  1974. 


414 


References 


Piaget,  J.  (1936b).  The  construction  of  reality  in  the  child  (M.  Cook,  trans.).  New  York:  Ballantine 
Books,  1954. 

Piaget,  J.  (1946).  Play ,  dreams  and  imitation  in  childhood  (C.  Gattegno  &  F.  M.  Hodgson,  trans.). 
New  York:  W.  W.  Norton,  1962. 

Piaget,  J.  (1947).  The  psychology  of  intelligence  (M.  Piercy  &  D.  E.  Berlyne,  trans.).  Savage,  MD: 
Littlefield,  Adams,  1973. 

Piaget,  J.  (1952).  Autobiography.  In  E.  Boring,  H.  S.  Langfeld,  H.  Werner,  &  R.  M.  Yerkes  (Eds.), 
A  history  of  psychology  in  autobiography  (Vol.  4).  Worcester,  MA:  Clark  University  Press. 

Piaget,  J.  (1964a).  Six  psychological  studies  (A.  Tenzer  &  D.  Elkind,  trans.).  New  York:  Vintage 
Books,  1968. 

Piaget,  J.  (1964b).  Development  and  learning.  In  R.  Ripple  &  V.  Rockcastle  (Eds.),  Piaget  redis¬ 
covered.  Ithaca,  NY:  Cornell  University  Press,  1969. 

Piaget,  J.  (1969).  Science  of  education  and  the  psychology  of  the  child  (D.  Coltman,  trans.).  New  York: 
Viking,  1970. 

Piaget,  J.  (1970).  Piaget's  theory.  In  P.  H.  Mussen  (Ed.),  Handbook  of  child  psychology  (4th  ed.)  (Vol.  1, 
W.  Kessen,  Ed.).  New  York:  John  Wiley,  1983. 

Piaget,  J.  (1972).  Intellectual  evolution  from  adolescence  to  adulthood.  Human  Development 
15, 1-12. 

Piaget,  J.  (1983).  Jean  Piaget's  views  on  the  psychology  of  language  and  thought.  In  R.  W.  Rieber 
(Ed.),  Dialogues  on  the  psychology  of  language  and  thought.  New  York:  Plenum. 

Piaget,  J.,  &  Inhelder,  B.  (1948).  The  child's  conception  of  space  (F.  J.  Langdor  &  J.  L.  Lunzer,  trans.). 
London:  Routledge  &  Kegan  Paul,  1956. 

Piaget,  J.,  &  Inhelder,  B.  (1966).  The  psychology  of  the  child  (H.  Weaver,  trans.).  New  York:  Basic 
Books,  1969. 

Piaget,  J.,  &  Szeminska,  A.  (1941).  The  child's  conception  of  number  (C.  Cattegno  &  F.  M.  Hodgson, 
trans.).  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton. 

Piatelli-Palmarini,  M.  (Ed.).  (1979).  Language  and  learning:  The  debate  between  Jean  Piaget  and  Noam 
Chomsky.  Cambridge,  MA:  Harvard  University  Press,  1980. 

Pillmemer,  D.  B.,  Picariello,  M.  L.,  &  Pruett,  J.  C.  (1994).  Very  long-term  memories  of  a  salient 
preschool  event.  Applied  Cognitive  Psychology,  8,  95-106. 

Pillemer,  D.  B.,  &  White,  S.  H.  (1989).  Childhood  events  recalled  by  children  and  adults.  In  H.  W. 
Reese  (Ed.),  Advances  in  child  development  and  behavior  (Vol.  21).  San  Diego:  Academic  Press. 

Pinker,  S.  (1994).  The  language  instinct.  New  York:  HarperPerennial. 

Podd,  M.  (1972).  Ego  identity  status  and  morality.  Developmental  Psychology,  6,  497-507. 

Poliak,  R.  (1997).  The  creation  of  Dr.  B.  New  York:  Simon  &  Schuster. 

Power,  C.,  &  Reimer,  J.  (1979).  Moral  atmosphere:  An  educational  bridge  between  moral  judg¬ 
ment  and  action.  In  W.  Damon  (Ed.),  New  directions  for  child  development  (Vol.  2).  San 
Francisco:  Jossey-Bass. 

Power,  F.  C.,  Higgins,  A.,  &  Kohlberg,  L.  (1989).  Lawrence  Kohlberg's  approach  to  moral  education. 
New  York:  Columbia  University  Press. 

Pratt,  M.  W.,  Skoe,  E.  A.,  &  Arnold,  M.  L.  (2004).  Care  reasoning  development  and  family  social¬ 
ization  patterns  in  later  adolescence:  A  longitudinal  analysis.  International  Journal  of  Behav¬ 
ioral  Development,  28, 139-147. 

Premack,  D.  (1961).  Predicting  instrumental  performance  from  the  independent  rate  of  the 
contingent  response.  Journal  of  Experimental  Psychology,  61, 161-171. 

Pullum,  G.,  &  Scholz,B.  (2002).  Empirical  assessment  of  stimulus  poverty  arguments.  Linguistic 
Review,  19,  8-50. 

Quality  counts.  (2001,  January  11).  Education  Week,  20. 

Quality  counts.  (2009,  January  8).  Education  Week,  28. 

Quick,  R.  H.  (1880).  Introduction.  In  R.  H.  Quick  (Ed.),  Some  thoughts  concerning  education  by  John 
Locke.  London:  C.  J.  Clay  &  Sons. 

Ravitch,  D.  (1995).  National  standards  in  American  education.  Washington,  DC:  The  Brookings 
Institution. 

Rawls,  J.  (1971).  A  theory  of  justice.  Cambridge,  MA:  Harvard  University  Press. 

Redl,  F.,  &  Wineman,  D.  (1951).  Children  who  hate.  New  York:  Free  Press. 

Reese,  E.,  &  Fivush,  R.  (1993).  Parental  styles  of  talking  about  the  past.  Developmental  Psychology, 
29,  596-606. 

Reiber,  R.  W.,  &  Voyat,  G.  (1983).  Dialogues  on  the  psychology  of  language  and  thought.  New  York: 
Plenum. 


415 


References 


Reimer,  J.,  Paolitto,  D.  P.,  &  Hersh,  R.  H.  (1983).  Promoting  moral  growth  (2nd  ed.).  New  York: 
Longman. 

Rest,  J.  (1973).  The  hierarchical  nature  of  moral  judgment:  The  study  of  patterns  of  preference  and 
comprehension  of  moral  judgments  made  by  others.  Journal  of  Personality,  41,  86-109. 

Rest,  J.  (1983).  Morality.  In  P.  H.  Mussen  (Ed.),  Handbook  of  child  psychology  (4th  ed.)  (Vol.  3, 
J.  H.  Flavell  &  E.  M.  Markman,  Eds.).  New  York:  John  Wiley. 

Rest,  J.,  Turiel,  E.,  &  Kohlberg,  L.  (1969).  Relations  between  level  of  moral  judgments  and 
preference  and  comprehension  of  the  moral  judgment  of  others.  Journal  of  Personality, 
37,  225-252. 

Reynolds,  C.  S.  (1968).  A  primer  of  operant  conditioning.  Glenview,  IL:  Scott,  Foresman. 

Rheingold,  H.  L.,  Gewirtz,  J.  L.,  &  Ross,  H.  W.  (1959).  Social  conditioning  of  vocalizations  in  the 
infant.  Journal  of  Comparative  and  Physiological  Psychology,  52,  68-73. 

Riegel,  K.  F.  (1975).  Toward  a  dialectical  theory  of  development.  Human  Development,  18,  50-64. 

Riess,  B.  F.  (1954).  Effect  of  altered  environment  and  of  age  on  the  mother-young  relationships 
among  animals.  Annals  of  the  New  York  Academy  of  Science,  57,  606-610. 

Robertson,  J.  (1952).  A  two  year  old  goes  to  hospital  [16  mm,  B  &  W  film].  London:  Tavistock  Clinic. 
New  York:  New  York  University  Film  Library. 

Rogoff,  B.  (1998).  Cognition  as  a  collaborative  process.  In  D.  Kuh  &  R.  S.  Siegler  (Eds.),  Handbook 
of  child  psychology  (5th  ed.)  (Vol.  2,  Cognition,  perception,  and  language).  New  York:  Wiley. 

Rogoff,  B.  (2003).  The  cultural  nature  of  development.  Oxford,  UK:  Oxford  University  Press. 

Rogoff,  B.,  Malkin,  C.,  &  Gilbride,  K.  (1984).  Interaction  with  babies  as  guidance  and  develop¬ 
ment.  In  B.  Rogoff  &  J.  Wertsch  (Eds.),  Children  learning  in  the  "zone  of  proximal  development." 
San  Francisco:  Jossey-Bass. 

Rosenbaum,  J.  E.  (2004,  Spring).  It's  time  to  tell  the  kids:  If  you  don't  do  well  in  high  school,  you 
won't  do  well  in  college  (or  on  the  job).  American  Educator,  28,  8-15, 41-42. 

Rosenthal,  T.  L.,  &  Zimmerman,  B.  J.  (1972).  Modeling  by  exemplification  and  instruction  in 
training  conservation.  Developmental  Psychology,  6, 392-401. 

Roszak,  T.  (1972).  Where  the  wasteland  ends.  Garden  City,  NY:  Anchor  (Doubleday),  1973. 

Rousseau,  J.  J.  (1750).  Discourse  on  the  sciences  and  arts.  In  R.  D.  Masters  (Ed.),  The  first  and  second 
discourses  (R.  D.  &  J.  R.  Masters,  trans.).  New  York:  St.  Martin's  Press,  1964. 

Rousseau,  J.  J.  (1755).  Discourse  on  the  origin  and  foundations  of  inequality.  In  R.  D.  Masters 
(Ed.),  The  first  and  second  discourses  (R.  D.  &  J.  R.  Masters,  trans.).  New  York:  St.  Martin's 
Press,  1964. 

Rousseau,  J.  J.  (1762a).  The  social  contract  (G.  Hopkins,  trans.).  New  York:  Oxford  University  Press, 
1962. 

Rousseau,  J.  J.  (1762b).  Emile,  or  education  (B.  Foxley,  trans.).  London:  J.  M.  Dent  and  Sons,  1948. 

Rousseau,  J.  J.  (1788).  The  confessions  of  Jean  Jacques  Rousseau.  New  York:  Modern  Library,  1945. 

Rowland,  S.  (2002).  Jung:  A  feminist  revision.  Cambridge,  UK:  Polity. 

Rumbaugh,  D.  M.,  &  Washburn,  D.  A.  (2003).  Intelligence  of  apes  and  other  rational  beings.  New 
Haven,  CT:  Yale  University  Press. 

Rushton,  J.  P.  (1975).  Generosity  in  children:  Immediate  and  long  term  effects  of  modeling,  preach¬ 
ing,  and  moral  judgment.  Journal  of  Personality  and  Social  Psychology,  31, 459-466. 

Russell,  B.  (1945).  A  history  of  Western  philosophy.  New  York:  Simon  &  Schuster. 

Russell,  B.  (1971).  Education  and  the  social  order.  London:  George  Allen  and  Unwin. 

Sachs,  J.  S.  (1976).  Development  of  speech.  In  E.  C.  Carterette  &  M.  P.  Friedman  (Eds.),  Handbook 
of  perception  (Vol.  7).  New  York:  Academic  Press. 

Sahakian,  W.  S.,  &  Sahakian,  M.  L.  (1975).  John  Locke.  Boston:  Twayne. 

Savage-Rumbaugh,  S.,  &  Lewin,  R.  (1994)  Kanzi.  New  York:  Wiley. 

Savage-Rumbaugh,  S.,  Shanker,  S.  G.,  &  Taylor,  T.  J.  (1998).  Apes,  language,  and  the  human  mind. 
New  York:  Oxford  University  Press. 

Savage-Rumbaugh,  S.  (2007,  May  17).  Savage-Rumbaugh:  Apes  that  write,  start  fires,  and  play  pac  man. 
YouTube,  TED.  www.youtube.com/watch?v=a8nDJaH-fVE 

Schachtel,  E.  G.  (1959).  Metamorphosis.  New  York:  Basic  Books. 

Schultz,  D.  P.  (1975).  A  history  of  modern  psychology  (2nd  ed.).  New  York:  Academic  Press. 

Schwartz,  B.  (1989).  Psychology  of  learning  and  behavior  (3rd  ed.).  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton. 

Schweitzer,  A.  (1929).  The  philosophy  of  civilization  (T.  C.  Campion,  trans.).  Amherst,  NY: 
Prometheus,  1987. 

Scribner,  S.,  &  Cole,  M.  (1981).  The  psychology  of  literacy.  Cambridge,  MA:  Harvard  University 
Press. 


416 


References 


Searles,  H.  F.  (1965).  Collected  papers  on  schizophrenia  and  related  subjects.  New  York:  International 
Universities  Press. 

Seligman,  M.  E.  P.  (1972).  Phobias  and  preparedness.  In  M.  E.  P.  Seligman  &  J.  L.  Hager  (Eds.), 
Biological  boundaries  of  learning.  New  York:  Appleton-Century-Crofts. 

Selman,  R.  K.  (1976).  Social-cognitive  understanding:  A  guide  to  educational  and  clinical  practice. 

In  T.  Lickona  (Ed.),  Moral  development  and  behavior.  New  York:  Holt,  Rinehart  &  Winston. 
Shahar,  S.  (1990).  Childhood  in  the  middle  ages.  London:  Routledge. 

Sheehy,  G.  (1976).  Passages:  Predictable  crises  of  adult  life.  New  York:  Dutton. 

Siegler,  R.  S.  &  Alibali,  M.  W.  (2005).  Children's  thinking  (4th  ed.).  Upper  Saddle  River,  NJ: 
Prentice-Hall. 

Sigel,  I.  E.  (1968).  Reflections.  In  I.  E.  Sigel  &  F.  H.  Hooper  (Eds.),  Logical  thinking  in  children: 

Research  based  on  Piaget's  theory.  New  York:  Holt,  Rinehart  &  Winston. 

Simcock,  G.,  &  Hayne,  H.  (2003).  Age-related  changes  in  verbal  and  nonverbal  memory  during 
early  childhood.  Developmental  Psychology ,  39,  805-814. 

Sinclair,  H.  (1971).  Sensorimotor  action  patterns  as  a  condition  for  the  acquisition  of  syntax. 
In  R.  Huxley  &  E.  Ingram  (Eds.),  Language  acquisition:  Methods  and  models.  New  York: 
Academic  Press. 

Skinner,  B.  F.  (1938).  The  behavior  of  organisms.  Englewood  Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Hall. 

Skinner,  B.  F.  (1948).  Walden  two.  New  York:  Macmillan. 

Skinner,  B.  F.  (1953).  Science  and  human  behavior.  New  York:  Macmillan. 

Skinner,  B.  F.  (1957).  Verbal  behavior.  Englewood  Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Hall. 

Skinner,  B.  F.  (1959).  Cumulative  record.  Englewood  Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Hall. 

Skinner,  B.  F.  (1967).  Autobiography.  In  E.  G.  Boring  &  G.  Lindzey  (Eds.),  A  history  of  psychology 
in  autobiography  (Vol.  5).  Englewood  Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Hall. 

Skinner,  B.  F.  (1968).  The  technology  of  teaching.  Englewood  Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Hall. 

Skinner,  B.  F.  (1969).  Contingencies  of  reinforcement.  Englewood  Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Hall. 

Skinner,  B.  F.  (1971).  Beyond  freedom  and  dignity.  New  York:  Bantam. 

Skinner,  B.  F.  (1974).  About  behaviorism.  New  York:  Knopf. 

Skoke,  E.  E.  A.,  &  von  der  Lippe,  A.  L.,  (1998).  Personality  development  in  adolescence.  London: 
Routledge. 

Slobin,  D.  I.  (1966).  Soviet  psycholinguistics.  In  N.  O'Connor  (Ed.),  Present-day  Russian  psychol¬ 
ogy:  A  symposium  by  seven  authors.  Oxford:  Pergamon. 

Slobin,  D.  I.  (1972).  They  learn  the  same  way  all  around  the  world.  Psychology  Today ,  6,  71-82. 
Slobin,  D.  I.  (1973).  Cognitive  prerequisites  for  the  development  of  grammar.  In  C.  A.  Ferguson 
&  D.  I.  Slobin  (Eds.),  Studies  of  child  language  development.  New  York:  Holt,  Rinehart  & 
Winston. 

Slobin,  D.  I.  (1979).  Psycholinguistics  (2nd  ed.).  Glenview,  IL:  Scott,  Foresman. 

Slobin,  D.  I.  (1985).  Introduction.  In  D.  I.  Slobin  (Ed.),  The  crosslinguistic  study  of  language  acqui- 
sitio?i  (Vol.  1).  Hillsdale,  NJ:  Erlbaum. 

Smart,  M.  S.,  &  Smart,  R.  C.  (1978).  Preschool  children  (2nd  ed.).  New  York:  Macmillan. 

Snow,  C.  E.  (1979).  Conversations  with  children.  In  P.  Fletcher  &  M.  Garman  (Eds.),  Language 
acquisition.  Cambridge,  UK:  Cambridge  University  Press. 

Spock,  B.  (1946).  Baby  and  child  care.  New  York:  Pocket  Books,  1968. 

Spinka,  M.,  Newberry,  R.  C.,  &  Bekoff,  M.  (2001).  Mammalian  play:  Training  for  the  unexpected. 

The  Quarterly  Review  of  Biology,  76, 141-168. 

Stem,  D.  N.  (1985).  The  interpersonal  world  of  the  infant.  New  York:  Basic  Books. 

Sullivan,  H.  S.  (1953).  The  interpersonal  theory  of  psychiatry.  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton. 

Suzuki,  D.,  &  Knudtson  (1992).  Wisdom  of  the  elders.  New  York:  Bantam. 

Taylor,  M.,  &  Carlson,  S.  M.  (1997).  The  relation  between  individual  differences  in  fantasy  and 
theory  of  mind.  Child  Development,  68,  436-455. 

Terrace,  H.S.,  Petito,  L.A.,  Sanders,  R.J.,  &  Bever,  T.G.  (1979,  November  23).  Can  an  ape  create 
a  sentence?  Science,  206,  891-902. 

Thain,  M.,  &  Hickman,  M.  (1994).  The  Penguin  dictionary  of  biology  (9th  ed.).  London:  Penguin. 
Thompson,  C.  (1950).  Cultural  pressures  in  the  psychology  of  women.  In  P.  Mullahy  (Ed.),  A 
study  of  interpersonal  relations.  New  York:  Hermitage  Press. 

Thorndike,  E.  L.  (1905).  The  elements  of  psychology.  New  York:  Seiler. 

Tinbergen,  N.  (1951).  The  study  of  instinct.  Oxford:  Clarendon  Press. 

Tinbergen,  N.  (1965).  The  shell  menace.  In  T.  E.  McGill  (Ed.),  Readings  in  animal  behavior.  New  York: 
Holt,  Rinehart  &  Winston. 


417 


References 


Tinbergen,  N.  (1977).  Interview.  In  D.  Cohen  (Ed.),  Psychologists  on  psychology.  New  York: 
Taplinger. 

Tolman,  E.  C.  (1948).  Cognitive  maps  in  rats  and  man.  Psychological  Review,  55, 189-208. 
Tomasello,  M.  (2003).  Constructing  a  language.  Cambridge,  MA:  Harvard  University  Press. 
Tough,  P.  (2009,  September  27).  The  make-believe  solution.  The  New  York  Times  Magazine,  31-35. 
Tulkin,  S.  R.,  &  Konner,  M.  J.  (1973).  Alternative  conceptions  of  intellectual  functioning.  Human 
Development,  16,  33-52. 

Turiel,  E.  (1966).  An  experimental  test  of  the  sequentiality  of  developmental  stages  in  the  child's 
moral  judgments.  Journal  of  Personality  and  Social  Psychology,  3,  611-618. 

U.S.  Department  of  Education.  (1983).  National  Commission  on  Excellence  in  Education,  A  nation 
at  risk.  Washington,  DC:  Government  Printing  Office. 

Uzgiris,  I.  C.  (1964).  Situational  generality  of  conservation.  Child  Development,  35,  831-841. 
Valliant,  G.  E.  (2000).  Adaptive  mental  mechanisms:  Their  role  in  a  positive  psychology  American 
Psychologist,  55,  89-98. 

Van  IJzendoorn,  M.  H.,  &  Sagi-Schwartz,  A.  (2008).  Cross-cultural  patterns  of  attachment: 
Universal  and  contextual  dimensions.  In  J.  Cassidy  &  P.  R.  Shaver  (Eds.),  Handbook  of 
attachment  (2nd  ed.).  New  York:  Guilford. 

Vaughn,  B.  E.,  Bost,  K.  K.,  &  van  IJzendoorn,  M.  H.  (2008).  Attachment  and  temperament: 
Additive  and  interactive  influences  on  behavior,  affect,  and  cognition  during  infancy  and 
childhood.  In  J.  Cassidy  &  P.  R.  Shaver  (Eds.),  Handbook  of  attachment  (2nd  ed.).  New  York: 
Guilford. 

Von  Franz,  M.  L.  (1964).  The  process  of  individuation.  In  C.  G.  Jung  (Ed.),  Man  and  his  symbols. 
New  York:  Dell. 

Vygotsky,  L.  S.  (1930).  Tool  and  symbol  in  children's  development  (A.  R.  Luria  &  M.  Cole,  trans.). 
In  M.  Cole,  V.  John-Steiner,  S.  Scribner,  &  E.  Souberman  (Eds.),  L.  S.  Vygotsky:  Mind  in 
society.  Cambridge,  MA:  Harvard  University  Press,  1978. 

Vygotsky,  L.  S.  (1931a).  Development  of  higher  mental  functions.  In  Psychological  research  in  the 

U. S.S.R.  Moscow:  Progress  Publishers,  1966. 

Vygotsky,  L.  S.  (1931b).  The  history  of  the  development  of  the  higher  mental  functions  (M.  Cole, 
trans.).  Excerpt  in  M.  Cole,  V.  John-Steiner,  S.  Scribner,  &  E.  Souberman  (Eds.),  L.  S. 
Vygotsky:  Mind  in  society.  Cambridge,  MA:  Harvard  University  Press,  1978. 

Vygotsky,  L.  S.  (1932).  The  problem  of  will  and  its  development  in  childhood.  In  R.  W.  Rieber  & 
A.  S.  Carton  (Eds.),  The  collected  works  ofL.  S.  Vygotsky  (Vol.  1,  N.  Minick,  trans.).  New  York: 
Plenum,  1987. 

Vygotsky,  L.  S.  (1933).  The  role  of  play  in  development  (M.  Lopez-Morillas,  trans.).  In  M.  Cole, 

V.  John-Steiner,  S.  Scribner,  &  E.  Souberman  (Eds.),  L.  S.  Vygotsky:  Mind  in  society.  Cam¬ 
bridge,  MA:  Harvard  University  Press,  1978. 

Vygotsky,  L.  S.  (1934).  Thought  and  language  (A.  Kozulin,  trans.).  Cambridge,  MA:  MIT  Press, 
1986. 

Vygotsky,  L.  S.  (1935).  Mental  development  of  children  and  the  process  of  learning  (M.  Lopez 
Morillas,  trans.).  In  M.  Cole,  V.  John-Steiner,  S.  Scribner,  &  E.  Souberman  (Eds.),  L.  S.  Vygot¬ 
sky:  Mind  in  society.  Cambridge,  MA:  Harvard  University  Press,  1978,  chaps.  7-8. 

Wade,  N.  (2009,  February  10).  Darwin:  Ahead  of  his  time,  is  still  influential.  New  York  Times. 
Waelder,  R.  (1960).  Basic  theory  of  psychoanalysis.  New  York:  International  Universities  Press. 
Walker,  L.  S.,  &  Pitts,  R.  G.  (1998).  Naturalistic  conceptions  of  morality.  Developmental  Psychol¬ 
ogy,  34,  403-419. 

Wang,  Q.  (2004).  The  emergence  of  cultural  self-constructions:  Autobiographical  memory  and 
self-description  in  European  American  and  Chinese  children.  Developmental  Psychology, 
40,  3-15. 

Wapner,  S.,  Kaplan,  B.,  &  Cohen,  S.  B.  (1973).  An  organismic-developmental  perspective  for 
understanding  transactions  of  men  and  environments.  Environment  and  Behavior, 
5,  255-289. 

Watson,  J.  B.  (1913).  Psychology  as  the  behaviorist  views  it.  Psychological  Review,  20, 158-177. 
Watson,  J.  B.  (1924).  Behaviorism.  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton,  1970. 

Watson,  J.  B.  (1928).  Psychological  care  of  infant  and  child.  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton. 

Watson,  J.  B.  (1936).  Autobiography.  In  C.  Murchison  (Ed.),  A  history  of  psychology  in  autobiogra¬ 
phy  (Vol.  3).  Worcester,  MA:  Clark  University  Press. 

Watson,  R.  I.  (1968).  The  great  psychologists  from  Aristotle  to  Freud  (2nd  ed.).  Philadelphia: 
Lippincott. 


418 


References 


Weinfield,  N.  Sv  Sroufe,  L.  A.,  Egeland,  B.,  &  Carlson,  E.  (2008).  The  nature  of  individual  dif¬ 
ferences  in  infant-caregiver  attachment.  In  J.  Cassidy  &  P.  R.  Shaver  (Eds.),  Handbook  of 
attachment  (2nd  ed.).  New  York:  Guilford. 

Weisner,  T.  S.  (1996).  The  5  to  7  transition  as  an  ecocultural  project.  In  A.  J.  Sameroff  &  M.  M.  Haith 
(Eds.),  The  five  to  seven  year  shift.  Chicago:  University  of  Chicago  Press. 

Weiss,  R.  S.  (1982).  Attachment  in  adult  life.  In  C.  M.  Parkes  &  J.  Stevenson-Hinde  (Eds.),  The  place 
of  attachment  in  human  behavior.  New  York:  Basic  Books. 

Werner,  H.  (1934).  The  unity  of  the  senses.  In  S.  S.  Barten  &  M.  B.  Franklin  (Eds.),  Developmental 
processes:  Heinz  Werner's  selected  writings  (Vol.  1).  New  York:  International  Universities 
Press,  1978. 

Werner,  H.  (1948).  Comparative  psychology  of  mental  development  (2nd  ed.).  New  York:  Science  Editions. 

Werner,  H.  (1956).  On  physiognomic  perception.  In  G.  Kepes  (Ed.),  The  new  landscape.  Chicago: 
Theobald. 

Werner,  H.  (1957).  The  concept  of  development  from  a  comparative  and  organismic  point  of  view. 
In  D.  B.  Harris  (Ed.),  The  concept  of  development.  Minneapolis:  University  of  Minnesota 
Press. 

Werner,  H.,  &  Kaplan,  B.  (1956).  The  developmental  approach  to  cognition:  Its  relevance  to  the 
psychological  interpretation  of  anthropological  and  ethnolinguistic  data.  American  Anthro¬ 
pologist,  58,  866-880. 

Werner,  H.,  &  Kaplan,  B.  (1963).  Symbol  formation.  New  York:  John  Wiley. 

Wertsch,  J.  V.  (1985).  Vygotsky  and  the  social  formation  of  mind.  Cambridge,  MA:  Harvard  Uni¬ 
versity  Press. 

White,  G.  M.  (1972).  Immediate  and  deferred  effects  of  model  observation  and  guided  and 
unguided  rehearsal  on  donating  and  stealing.  Journal  of  Personality  and  Social  Psychology, 
21, 139-148. 

White,  R.  W.  (1960).  Competence  and  the  psychosexual  stages  of  development.  In  M.  Jones  (Ed.), 
Nebraska  symposium  on  motivation.  Lincoln:  University  of  Nebraska  Press. 

White,  R.  W.  (1963).  Sense  of  interpersonal  competence:  Two  case  studies  and  some  reflections 
on  origins.  In  R.  R.  White  (Ed.),  The  study  of  lives.  New  York:  Atherton  Press. 

White,  R.  W.,  &  Watt,  N.  F.  (1973).  The  abnormal  personality  (4th  ed.).  New  York:  Ronald  Press. 

White,  R.  W.,  &  Watt,  N.  F.  (1981).  The  abnormal  personality  (5th  ed.).  New  York:  Wiley. 

White,  S.  (1965).  Evidence  for  a  hierarchical  arrangement  of  learning  processes.  In  L.  P.  Lipsitt  & 
C.  C.  Spiker  (Eds.),  Advances  in  child  development  and  behavior  (Vol.  2).  New  York:  Academic 
Press. 

White,  S.  (1970).  Some  general  outlines  of  the  matrix  of  developmental  changes  between  five 
and  seven  years.  Bulletin  of  the  Orton  Society,  20,  41-57. 

White,  S.  H.  (1996).  The  child's  entry  into  the  "age  of  reason."  In  A.  J.  Sameroff  &  M.  M.  Haith 
(Eds.),  The  five  to  seven  year  shift.  Chicago:  University  of  Chicago  Press. 

Whitehead,  A.  N.  (1929).  Science  and  the  modern  world.  New  York:  Macmillan. 

Whitehurst,  G.  J.,  Ironsmith,  M.,  &  Goldman,  M.  (1974).  Selective  imitation  of  the  passive  con¬ 
struction  through  modeling.  Journal  of  Experimental  Child  Psychology,  17,  288-302. 

Whiting,  J.  W.  M.,  &  Child,  I.  L.  (1953).  Child  training  and  personality:  A  cross-cultural  study.  New 
Haven,  CT:  Yale  University  Press. 

Whitmont,  E.  C.  (1969).  The  symbolic  quest:  Basic  concepts  of  analytical  psychology.  New  York: 
Putnam's. 

Whitmont,  E.  C.,  &  Kaufmann,  Y.  (1973).  Analytic  psychotherapy.  In  R.  Corsini  (Ed.),  Current 
psychotherapies.  Itasca,  IL:  F.  E.  Peacock. 

Williams,  C.  D.  (1959).  The  elimination  of  tantrum  behavior  by  extinction  procedures.  Journal  of 
Abnormal  and  Social  Psychology,  5,  269. 

Wilner,  W.  (1975,  Winter).  Schachtel:  A  life.  William  Alanson  White  Newsletter,  pp.  3-4. 

Wilson,  C.  (1972).  New  pathways  in  psychology:  Maslozv  and  the  post-Freudian  revolution.  New  York: 
Mentor  Books. 

Wilson,  E.  O.  (1993).  Biophilia  and  the  conservation  ethic.  In  S.  R.  Kellert  &  E.  O.  Wilson  (Eds.), 
The  biophilia  hypothesis.  Washington,  DC:  Island  Press. 

Winner,  E.  (1982).  Invented  worlds.  Cambridge,  MA:  Harvard  University  Press. 

Witkin,  H.  (1965).  Heinz  Werner.  Child  Development,  30,  307-328. 

Wohlwill,  J.  F.  (1984).  Martha  Muchow  and  the  life-space  of  the  urban  child.  Paper  presented  to  the 
Society  for  Research  in  Child  Development,  Ann  Arbor,  Michigan. 

Wolpe,  J.  (1969).  The  practice  of  behavior  therapy.  New  York:  Pergamon. 


419 


References 


Wood,  D.  (1998).  How  children  think  and  learn  (2nd  ed.).  Oxford,  UK:  Blackwell. 

Wordsworth,  W.  (1807).  Ode:  Intimations  of  immortality  from  recollections  of  early  childhood. 

In  W.  E.  Williams  (Ed.),  Wordsworth.  London:  Penguin,  1985. 

Zelazo,  P.  R.,  Zelazo,  N.  A.,  &  Kolb,  S.  (1972).  "Walking"  in  the  newborn.  Science,  176,  314-315. 
Zimmerman,  B.  J.,  &  Rosenthal,  T.  L.  (1974).  Conserving  and  retaining  equalities  and  inequali¬ 
ties  through  observation  and  correction.  Developmental  Psychology,  10,  260-268. 
Zimmerman,  B.  J.,  &  Schunk,  D.  H.  (2003).  Albert  Bandura:  The  scholar  and  his  contributions  to 
educational  psychology.  In  B.  J.  Zimmerman  &  D.  H.  Schunk  (Eds.),  Educational  psychology: 
A  century  of  contributions.  Mahwah,  NJ:  Erlbaum. 


420 


Index 


Page  references  followed  by  T  indicate  illustrated 
figures  or  photographs;  followed  by  "t"  indicates  a 
table. 


A 

Abilities,  13,  31-32,  34,  73,  140,  152-153,  188,  213, 
219-221, 228,  253-254,  296,  337 
Abnormal,  33,  384,  390,  401, 403,  407,  409,  412,  419 
Abnormal  behavior,  403,  412 
Abnormal  psychology,  390,  409 
abortion,  177 

Abstract  modeling,  221,  364 
Abstract  reasoning,  140 
Abstract  thinking,  111,  229,  238-239 
Abuse,  62,  84,  402 
Academic  achievement,  370 
Accessibility,  55 
Accommodation,  123-124 
Achievement,  31,  90,  143,  201, 218,  223,  237,  252, 
254,  302,  319,  351,  368,  385,  404 
IQ  and,  370 

understanding,  351, 404 
Achievement  tests,  90 

Acquisition,  73-76,  90,  213,  215-216,  237,  248,  351, 
361,  364-365,  367,  369-371,  407,  417 
of  grammar,  351 ,  361 , 417 
of  language,  73-75,  351,  355,  361,  364-365,  367, 
369-371,403-404,417 
Action  systems,  130 

Actions,  6,  25-26,  42,  48,  96-98,  113,  123,  126-130, 
135,  140-142,  144,  147,  153-155,  198-201, 
205-206,  212,  246,  269,  272,  278,  291, 295, 
359-360,  368-369,  372 
Activities  of  daily  living,  79 
Actual  developmental  level,  252 
Actualization  needs,  390 
Adaptation,  40,  332,  401-402,  408 
Adaptive  value,  42,  69 
Adjustment,  339-340,  384-385,  414 
Adolescence,  13-15,  17,  63,  86,  96,  144,  160,  168, 

181, 275,  282,  294,  298-299,  307,  327,  406, 
409,  414-415 

and  moral  development,  402 
attachment  in,  63 
autonomy,  294,  298,  307,  402 
formal  operations,  144,  160,  310,  414 
identity,  294,  299,  307,  310,  415 
identity  formation,  299 
mental  health,  310 

moral  development,  160,  168,  181, 402,  409,  417 
personality  development  in,  417 
physical  changes  in,  310 
puberty,  14,  275,  298-299,  307 
Adolescents,  58,  88-89,  96,  121,  140-142,  159-160, 
173,  178,  275-276,  299,  301,  310,  410 
Adult  development,  301,  384 
Adulthood,  109,  122,  140,  178,  181, 269,  294, 
300-302,  313,  345,  373-386,  393-394, 
412-413 

cognitive  development,  394,  412 
crises  of,  384 
generativity,  294,  302 
midlife,  380 
stage  theory,  1 22 

Adults,  1-3,  7-10,  14-15,  18,  32,  58-59,  63,  69,  72-73, 
75-77,  80,  87,  89-91 , 97-103,  105,  107, 
111-112,  114-115,  121-123,  136-139, 
151-152,  155,  160,  173-174,  178,  180,  219, 
234,  238,  244,  246,  253-256,  260,  264-266, 
284,  287,  319,  336,  338-339,  344-347,  351, 
357,  363-366,  371,  381-384 
Affect,  44,  77,  105,  177,  257,  268,  280,  409 
Affectional  bonds,  402 
affiliation,  177 
Afghanistan,  352 
Africa,  60,  63 


African,  105,  298,  328,  370 
Age,  1-3,  8,  11-12,  14,  16-18,  22-28,  31-33,  49-50, 
53-57,  59,  63-67,  71-74,  77,  81,  87-88,  90, 
110,  120-121,  124,  127,  136-137,  139, 
143-144,  150,  153-154,  156-157,  160,  163, 
170-172,  201,  206,  223,  233-235,  237-238, 
255-257,  264,  272-275,  289-290,  296-297, 
318-319,  333,  345-347,  351,  359-361, 
368-371,  382-383,  385-386,  408,  411, 414 
and  friendship,  383 
and  health,  303 

and  personality,  28,  404,  408,  419 
concepts  of,  419 
of  mother,  316,  318 
schizophrenia  and,  417 
Age  and  aging,  408,  414 
personality  and,  408 
Age  norms,  28,  32,  124 
Age-related  changes,  417 
Aggression,  214-215,  276-277,  400-401, 403,  412 
family,  and,  276 
in  children,  403 
television  and,  215 
Aggressiveness,  199 
Aging,  374,  408,  414 
and  memory,  414 
study  of,  408 

AIDS,  166,  213,  240,  256-257 
Ainsworth,  Mary,  59 
Algebra,  219,  237,  252 
Algorithms,  148 
Allport,  Gordon,  388 
Altruism,  38,  216,  218 
American  Academy  of  Pediatrics,  370 
American  Psychological  Association,  211 
members,  211 
Americans,  103 
Amnesia,  341-342,  346-347 
childhood,  341-342,  346-347 
infantile,  341,  346 
infantile  amnesia,  341,  346 
spontaneous,  346 

Anal  stage,  265,  268-269,  282,  287,  294 
Analytic  psychology,  409 
Androgyny,  385 

Anger,  14,  62,  104,  268-269,  281-282 
Anima,  377-379,  381 

Animals,  8,  37-40,  45-46,  48-49,  56,  67-70,  73,  86,  98, 
106,  116-117,  138,  187,  192,  199,  210,  285, 
378-379,  385,  397,416 
and  language,  416 
imprinting  in,  49,  56 
intelligence  of,  416 
research  on,  45,  187 
Animism,  137-140,  149 
Animus,  377-379 

Anxiety,  8,  49,  54,  57,  221,  272,  274,  280-282,  292, 
321-322 

stranger  anxiety,  321 
Applied  behavior  analysis,  201 
Apprenticeships,  2 
Archetype,  379,  383 
Archetypes,  378-379,  382,  385 
Arguments,  132,  145,  171,  173,  178-179,  286,  374, 
415 

Arithmetic,  81,  147-148,  150,  223,  251, 298,  410 
Art,  125,  228,  233,  285,  289,  378,  380,  400,  411 
stages  of,  289,  313 
Asia,  238 

Assessment,  280,  400,  415 
history  of,  400,  415 
Assimilation,  123-124 

Attachment,  18,  44,  47-61, 63-64,  66-68,  325,  327, 
400,  402-403,  405,  407-409,  412-413, 
418-419 

differences  in,  400,  419 
establishment  of,  412 


fathers,  63-64,  327 

first,  18,  44,  47,  49-51,  55-57,  60,  63,  68,  403 
growth  of,  400,  402,  409 
separation  anxiety,  54,  57 
Strange  Situation,  60-61, 63-64,  68 
theory  of,  48,  59,  325,  403,  405,  407-409,  413,  418 
with  fathers,  327 
Attachment  behaviors,  48 
Attachment  relationships,  405 
Attachment  theory,  59,  68,  407,  412-413 
in  infancy,  413 

Attention,  1, 4,  7,  30,  39,  42,  64-66,  72-73,  90,  103, 
109,  112-114,  116,  121,  127-128,  136,  139, 
144,  177,  184,  194,  197-199,  201-202,  236, 
240-242,  259,  273,  298-299,  311,  323, 
394-395 

Attentional  processes,  212 

Attitude,  3,  30,  76,  87,  103,  138,  157,  163,  167,  220, 
275,  285,  292,  322,  336-338,  369 
Attitudes,  63,  90,  137,  285-286,  298,  410 
behavior  and,  285 
Attraction,  395-396 

romantic  attraction,  396 
Attractiveness,  383 
Attribution,  140,  359 
Attunement,  328 
Audience,  233,  243,  383 
authority,  4,  11-12,  17,  85,  136-137,  144,  147, 

164-165,  167,  169,  179,  205,  276 
influence  of,  205 
obedience  to,  137,  164,  169 
Autism,  200-201,  317-318,  326-327,  331-335, 
338-339,  402,  410,  412 
Autobiographical  memory,  341, 408,  414,  418 
Autonomy,  31,  137,  283,  294-295,  298,  305-308,  312, 
323-324,  334-336,  346,  393,  395,  402 
development  of,  283,  298,  305,  308,  369,  402 
emotional,  305,  323-324 

Autonomy  versus  shame  and  doubt,  294-295,  307 
Avoidant  infants,  61,  67 

Awareness,  64,  97,  225,  240,  250,  262-263,  279,  281, 
295,  333,  384 

B 

Babbling,  51,  53,  75,  114,  359,  362 
Baby,  22,  24,  26,  29-30,  49-55,  57,  60-61, 65-66,  68, 
106,  114-115,  123,  125,  128,  151,  154-155, 
191, 201, 206,  255,  267-268,  273,  277, 
291-293,  316-322,  324-327,  343,  372, 
412-413 

Baby  talk,  106,  114 
Bahamas,  173 
Baillargeon,  R.,  401, 407 

Balance,  27-28,  31,  66,  110,  280,  293,  319-320,  379, 
381-382 
Bandura,  A.,  401 
Bantu,  101 
Basic  emotions,  189 
Basic  orientation,  343 
Basic  trust  versus  mistrust,  291 
Beginnings  of  thought,  127 

Behavior,  6-9,  18,  22,  25-26,  30-33,  35,  38-42,  44,  46, 
48-49,  51-52,  54-68,  78-79,  85,  96,  100, 
112-113,  120-121,  127-128,  135,  141, 
143-144,  150,  153,  163,  179-180,  190-203, 
205-207,  210-219,  221-222,  225-227,  229, 
236-237,  242-246,  255,  258,  267,  269, 
295-297,  304-305,  308,  310-311, 327,  333, 
337-340,  364,  397,  400-403,  407-419 
infant,  22,  26,  30,  32,  48-49,  51,  54,  63-64,  292, 
327,  339,  397,  400-403,  407-408, 
416-419 

moral,  38,  144,  163,  175,  179-180,  218,  221, 
401-403,  407-411, 414-418 
prosocial,  216,  218 
self-regulation  of,  244 

sexual,  44,  68,  199,  267,  275,  285,  297,  310 


421 


shaping  of,  362 
strength  of,  258,  296,  304 
Behavior  analysis,  201 
Behavior  modification,  190,  200,  412 
Behavior  therapy,  419 
Behavioral  treatment,  412 
Behaviorism,  388-390,  417-418 
Behaviorists,  311,  340,  387-389 
Beliefs,  5,  11,  18,  139,  143-144,  164,  173,  210,  286 
in  God,  5 

Belongingness  needs,  390 
Best  friends,  316 
Bias,  181, 286-287 
Biological  evolution,  29 
Biological  factors,  265 
Biological  model,  115 
Biology,  39-40,  223,  403,  411, 417 
Birdsong,  401 

Birth,  3-4,  11-14,  23,  25,  27,  45,  48,  50,  64,  68,  74, 
124,  298,  316,  318-319,  359 
process  of,  27,  402 
Blank  slate,  5 
Blood,  37 

Body,  1,  6,  12-15,  17,  29,  41,  75,  116,  251,  262, 
264-265,  283,  290-291,  307,  310-311, 
320-321,  327,  354,  362,  364 
Body  movement,  13,  188,  283 
Body  proportions,  1 
Bonding,  412 
Bowlby,  John,  47,  60 

Boys,  86,  135-137,  161,  171,  176-177,  214,  216,  252, 
275-276,  287,  289 
Brain,  23,  25-26,  113,  186,  246,  411 
adolescent,  411 
autism  and,  333,  402 
behavior  and,  26,  246 
development,  23,  25-26,  246,  371, 402,  411 
frontal  lobes,  246 
hand-eye  coordination,  25-26 
hemispheres  of,  26 
regions  of,  186 
schizophrenic,  113 
self,  25-26,  333,  402,  411 
Brain  development,  411 
Breast-feeding,  52 
Brown,  Roger,  352-353,  370 

c 

Cancer,  161,  264 
Capital  punishment,  411 
Care  orientation,  177-178 

Career,  47,  56,  65,  72,  122,  157,  187,  191, 257,  307, 
382 

Careers,  380 
Caregivers,  67 
Case  studies,  334,  419 
Castration,  270,  272-274,  287 
Castration  anxiety,  272,  274 
Categories,  101,  116,  126,  130,  223,  237,  250, 
342-348,  372,  385,  389,  396 
Causality,  128,  304 
Cell,  The,  24 
Cells,  23-24 

Central  nervous  system,  23,  93,  96,  412 
Cerebrum,  186 

Challenge,  146,  152,  174,  179,  227,  257,  259,  389 
Change,  3-4,  8,  12,  14,  17,  39,  54,  72-73,  93,  108-111, 
115,  122,  129,  132-133,  137,  139-140,  145, 
156,  160,  165,  168-169,  180,  206,  234-236, 
239,  251, 263,  301,  304-305,  323-324 
discontinuous,  108-109,  111 
Child  care,  64-65,  190,  401-402,  412,  414,  417 
quality  of,  65 

Child  development,  12,  22,  172,  187,  253,  400-405, 
407,  409-411, 413-415,  417-419 
future  of,  400 
theories  of,  401, 413-414 
Child  development  research,  400,  403,  410 
Child  rearing,  22,  29,  32,  66,  112,  190,  225,  311,  325, 
345,  414 

Child-directed  speech,  364 
Childhood,  13-16,  22,  33,  55,  58,  63,  91-92,  96,  98, 
109,  157,  258,  263-265,  268,  287,  300,  302, 
304,  317,  319,  341-349,  395-396,  404-405, 
407,  409,  413-415,  417-418,  420 
Childhood  amnesia,  342,  347 
Child-rearing,  293,  311 

Children,  1-3,  5-19,  22-24,  28-34,  38,  40,  46-49, 

55-70,  71-92,  95-97,  99-103,  105-114,  117, 


121-124,  126-130,  132-153,  155-157, 
159-164,  167-171,  173-175,  178-181, 
187-190,  194-195,  197-207,  211, 213-229, 
237-238,  240-246,  248-260,  263-269, 
278-279,  281-287,  289-292,  294-298,  302, 
305-309,  311,  321-323,  325,  327-329, 
332-340,  343-348,  377,  391-398,  400-406, 
408-410,  412-418,  420 
as  miniature  adults,  2 
body  proportions  and,  1 

development  in,  95,  171,  180,  232,  256,  283,  358, 
365,  371, 402,  417-418 
media  violence,  400,  410 
temperament,  28-29,  67-68,  418 
Chimpanzees,  46,  49,  67,  366-368 
China,  63 

Chinese,  375,  377,  418 

Chomsky,  90,  158,  351-372,  398,  403-404,  415 

Chomsky,  Noam,  351, 415 

Chromosomes,  24 

Church  of  England,  4 

Circular  reaction,  125 

Circular  reactions,  125-126,  190,  354 

Civil  disobedience,  166 

Claims,  122,  131,  166,  176,  223,  357,  366,  407 
two,  122,  223 
Class  inclusion,  149 

Classical  conditioning,  184-185,  190-191,  199,  205 
extinction,  185 

Classification,  64,  134-135,  139,  147,  155,  161 

Classroom,  80,  89,  91,  147,  198,  402,  410 

Clinical  psychologists,  310 

Clinics,  234 

close  relationships,  62 

Closure,  94 

Coaching,  255 

Cocaine,  262 

Coding,  210 

Cognition,  98-99,  114,  174,  206,  229,  283,  369,  396, 
402,  412,  416,  418-419 
and  aging,  408 
and  creativity,  98 
and  education,  408 
animal,  206,  412 
infant  cognition,  408 
need  for,  1 74 
reasoning  and,  408 

Cognitive  development,  121,  144,  151, 231-260,  310, 
323,  348,  369,  405,  412 
conservation,  407 
culture,  238-239,  257,  310,  407 
early  childhood,  258,  405,  407 
infancy,  412 

intelligence,  121, 234-235,  252,  407 
memory,  240,  256-257,  407 
of  infants,  121 

Piaget,  121,  144,  151, 232,  238,  242-243,  248-249, 
251,  256-257,  259-260,  310,  323,  369, 
405,  412 

Piaget  and,  121, 243,  369 
problem  solving,  240,  252 
Vygotsky,  231-260,  407 
zone  of  proximal  development,  252-254,  257 
Cognitive  domain,  223 
Cognitive  growth,  147 
Cognitive  learning,  213 
Cognitive  maps,  418 
Cognitive  mode,  108 

Cognitive  processes,  99,  150,  210,  278,  389 
Cognitive  psychology,  409,  415 
Cognitive  revolution,  389-390 
Cognitive  stages,  147,  224,  229,  305,  410 
Cognitive  theory,  390,  401 
Cognitive  view,  403 

Cognitive-developmental  approach,  410 
Cognitive-developmental  theory,  120-158,  308 
Collective  self,  227 

College,  95,  120,  159,  187,  191,  228,  289-290,  300, 
390,  405,410-411,413,416 
Color,  105,  141,  226,  238-239,  298 
Colors,  32,  73,  87,  98,  104-105,  240 
Commitment,  166,  180,  284,  299-300 
and  loving,  284 

Communication,  117,  142,  150,  236,  243,  247,  337 
of  animals,  117 
Communist  Party,  234,  413 
Community,  88,  163,  180,  191,  263-264,  298,  328, 
398,  411 

Comparative  psychology,  94,  105,  406,  419 


comparison,  17,  33,  76,  92,  134,  193,  197,  308, 
369-370,  405 
Comparisons,  109 

Competence,  115,  294,  298,  312,  354,  400,  419 
Competition,  39,  272,  351 
Computers,  66,  329,  389 

Concept,  23,  49,  97,  99,  106,  109,  114,  130,  139,  142, 
145,  169,  250-253,  256,  258,  264,  281-282, 
307,  327,  336,  396 

Conception,  2-3,  95,  98,  108,  128,  142,  146,  164-167, 
175-176,  265-266,  414-415 
Concepts,  1,  14,  49,  95,  113,  116,  123,  128,  134,  138, 
144,  205,  209-211, 221, 238,  249-252, 
256-257,  310,  313,  351-352,  397,  407,  410 
artificial,  116,  121 
concrete,  14,  134,  144,  310 
formal,  95,  113,  144,  238,  250,  289,  310 
formation  of,  187,  327,  419 
learning,  1,  14,  123,  144,  185,  205,  209-211,  221, 
249-250,  252,  351-352,  407,  419 
Conclusion,  36,  139,  158,  214,  255,  274,  293,  312 
Concrete  operational  thought,  150 
Concrete  operations,  122,  129,  132-133,  135, 

139-141,  143-144,  146,  150,  206,  223, 
309-310 

condescension,  383 
Conditioned  reflexes,  184,  187,  414 
Conditioning,  46,  184-192,  194-195,  199,  201, 205, 
214,  390,  416 

classical,  184-185,  190-191,  199,  205 
higher-order,  186 

operant,  191-192,  194-195,  199,  201, 205,  214, 
416 

vicarious,  214 

Conflict,  133,  144-145,  165,  169,  179-180,  234-235, 
249,  251, 263,  283,  290,  293,  298,  302,  306, 
402 

Conflict  resolution,  402 

Conflicts,  120,  136,  145,  234-235,  256,  288,  298-299, 
326,  336 

theory,  120,  136,  145,  234-235,  256,  288,  326 
toddler,  326 

Conformity,  12,  19,  340,  394 

Conscience,  272,  279,  287 

Consciousness,  64,  138,  168,  177,  181,  187,  233, 

262,  272,  275,  279-280,  379-380,  387 
control  of,  168,  187 
psychology  of,  233 
Consensus,  156 

Conservation,  130-135,  139-141,  145,  147,  149,  152, 
155-156,  221,  224-225,  407,  416,  418-419 
of  liquids,  132-133 

tasks,  130,  135,  140-141,  147,  149,  152,  155-156, 
224 

Consistency,  63,  149,  151,  170,  291 
Constancy,  318,  324 
Constraint,  356-357,  400 
Constraints,  190,  200,  309,  355-356,  362,  414 
Construction,  76,  123,  125,  142,  232,  408,  414-415, 
419 

Constructivism,  147 

Contact,  11, 26,  48-49,  54,  62,  77,  85-86,  154,  293, 
317,  410 

Context,  35,  107,  113,  227,  232,  234,  247,  359,  385, 
414 

thought  and,  411 
Contiguity,  212 

Contingencies  of  reinforcement,  417 
Contingency,  409 
acquisition  and,  409 
Contingency  management,  409 
Continuity,  38,  68,  110 

Control,  6,  23,  30,  32,  34,  66,  84-85,  96,  179,  187, 

194-195,  197,  199-202,  205-207,  217,  221, 
246,  248,  255,  268-269,  284,  294-296,  388, 
391-392,  405 
perceived,  395 
Control  groups,  179 
Conventional  morality,  163 
Conventional  morality  stage,  163 
Conventions,  15,  18,  29,  106,  391,  393 
Cooing,  51,  53,  114,  188,  359 
cooperation,  137,  214,  216,  297,  403 
Cooperative  learning,  403 
Cooperative  play,  1 35,  1 37 
Coping,  282 
Coping  strategies,  282 
Cornell  University,  390,  415 
Correlations,  149,  175 


422 


couples,  302 
courtship,  41 
Crawling,  26,  49,  325 
Creative  thinking,  38,  114,  281,  396 
Creativity,  69,  86-87,  90-91, 98,  150,  259,  390,  396 
curiosity  and,  390 
tests,  90,  150 
Crimes,  215 

Crisis,  58,  72,  177,  270-272,  274,  278,  294-299, 

303-306,  323-324,  380-381,  385,  394,  413 
Critical  period,  42,  44-45,  409 
Critical  periods,  73,  90 
Cross-cultural  research,  385 
Crowding,  114 

Cues,  29,  33,  63,  66,  240,  320 
Cultural  beliefs,  144 
Cultural  bias,  286-287 
Cultural  differences,  398 
Cultural  evolution,  413 
Cultural  factors,  174 
Cultural  influences,  177 
Cultural  stereotypes,  287 
Cultural  universality,  63,  173 
Cultural  universal,  169,  306 
Culture,  29-31, 46,  106,  108,  116,  173,  225,  238-239, 
257,  286,  291, 298-299,  306,  309-310,  354, 
382,  391, 411 
and  research,  31, 413 
child  development,  407,  409,  411, 413 
child  development  and,  407,  411 
context,  411 
death  and,  411 
differences,  306 
levels  of,  238 
self  and,  407,  409 
Cumulative  record,  417 
Cytoplasm,  24 
Czechoslovakia,  261 

D 

Darwin,  Charles,  35,  404 

Data,  48,  168,  170-171,  193,  284,  357,  363,  389,  392, 
407,419 
Dating,  221, 307 

Death,  11,  59,  159,  161,  167,  234,  283,  290,  300, 
303-306,  336,  383-384,  411 
confronting,  304 
fear  of,  304 
Death  and  dying,  411 
Decenter,  140 
Decision  making,  115,  180 
Decisions,  147,  164,  166,  175,  250,  252,  299-300 
individual,  164,  166,  175 
Deep  structure,  358,  360 
Defense,  58,  276,  281-283,  406 
Deferred  imitation,  127,  153-154,  401 
Deficiency,  242 
Delusions,  379 
Denial,  282 
Dependability,  308 

Dependence,  25,  275,  357,  360,  362,  400,  404 
Depression,  160,  219,  221, 268,  381 
environment  and,  221 
Deprivation,  45,  47,  56-57,  64 
human,  47,  56 
Depth,  288,  404 
Descriptive  studies,  371 
Desensitization,  190,  200 
systematic,  190,  200 

Development,  1-2,  5-6,  10,  12-15,  18,  21-26,  28, 

30-31,  35,  37,  39,  45-46,  63,  65-66,  69, 
71-73,  90-91,  93-99,  105,  108-111,  115, 
119-123,  125,  142-145,  151-153,  155, 
157-158,  159-181,  223,  231-260,  264, 
266-267,  276,  283-284,  305-308,  310-312, 
317-319,  323-326,  351-372,  393-394,  398, 
399-419 

adult,  1-2,  10,  13-15,  18,  31, 46,  73,  99,  109-110, 
123,  142,  152-153,  157,  244-245, 
252-255,  258-259,  264,  289,  301,  311, 
357-358,  360-361,  364-366,  372,  374, 
404-405,413-414,417,419 
biological,  18,  22,  31,  115,  123,  144,  234,  261, 276, 
305-308,  311-312,  317,  358,  371, 
393-394,  417 

brain,  23,  25-26,  246,  371, 402,  411 
motor  behavior,  25 
of  brain,  411 

of  moral  thinking,  159,  181 


psychosexual,  264,  267,  290,  419 
Developmental  change,  115,  122,  145,  168,  206,  232, 
394 

Developmental  delay,  71-72,  363 
Developmental  psychology,  12,  109,  115,  239,  348, 
351, 401, 404-405,  407-408,  410-413, 
415-418,  420 
adulthood,  109,  412-413 
explained,  253 
infancy  and  childhood,  418 
Developmental  stages,  206,  224,  282,  418 
Developmental  view,  228,  414 
Developmentalists,  19,  71,  109,  181,  205-206, 

224-225,  227-228,  238,  257-260,  339,  360, 
385,  393-394,  398 
Deviations,  317 
Dewey,  John,  160 
Diagnosis,  71,  113,  317,  407 
clinical,  113 
Dialects,  45,  370 
Differential  reinforcement,  211 
Digestive  system,  184 
Direct  experience,  17,  397 
Discipline,  6-7,  9,  85,  148,  285,  387 
Discrimination,  15,  87,  186,  195 
of  stimulus,  195 

Discriminative  stimuli,  194-195,  205 
Disease,  101,  160,  403 
Disequilibrium,  28 
disgust,  269,  303,  342-343 
Disorders,  234,  268,  282,  317,  374,  384,  414 
diagnosis  of,  333 
psychological,  400,  414 
Disoriented  infants,  62 
Distress,  41, 48-49,  51,  60,  217 
Distribution,  354 
disturbances  of,  47,  410 
Division  of  labor,  14 
Divorce,  59,  187 
Dominance,  26,  58,  247 
Dream,  79,  138-139,  142,  270,  280,  304,  377, 
381-382,  388 
Dreaming,  139 

Dreams,  97,  116,  121,  138-140,  263-264,  277,  280, 
286,  304,  377-379,  381-383,  397,  405-406 
analysis  of,  406 
interpretation  of,  264,  406 
nature  of,  377,  383 
psychoanalytic  theory  of,  405 
Drive,  42,  48,  59,  69,  80,  193,  199,  212,  214,  308 
sex,  199 

Drives,  198-199,  283-284,  287,  297-299,  312,  346, 
374 

Drugs,  97 
Dualism,  403 

E 

Early  childhood,  157,  258,  319,  342-343,  402,  405, 
407,  417,  420 
education,  345,  402,  405 
Early  childhood  education,  402,  405 
Early  development,  409 
Eating,  123,  195,  200,  237,  244,  268 
regulation  of,  244 
Echo,  117,  201 
Echolalia,  201,  317 
Eclectic  approaches,  256 

Education,  1,  3-7,  10,  12,  15,  18,  71-72,  76-77,  87-89, 
91,  95,  112-114,  145-146,  152,  178,  225, 
259,  285,  311,  345,  369,  410-411, 415-416 
exercise,  6,  15,  89 
health,  6 

Ego,  276-281, 283-284,  287,  291, 293-294,  296, 

298-300,  302-304,  312,  346,  377,  379-381, 
396,  402,  408-409,  413,  415 
psychoanalysis  and,  406 
repression  of,  284,  346 
Ego  ideal,  279 
Ego  identity,  299,  413,  415 
Ego  integrity,  294,  303-304 
Ego  integrity  versus  despair,  303 
Ego  psychology,  408 
Egocentric  speech,  242-243,  246 
Egocentric  thought,  137 

Egocentrism,  3,  135-137,  139-140,  142,  145,  149, 
155-156,  175,  242 
Eidetic  imagery,  101 
Elderly,  303-304,  407 
Elderly  people,  407 


Electra  complex,  273 

Elkind,  David,  146 

Emergencies,  216 

Emitted  behavior,  201 

Emotion,  38,  75,  99,  101-103,  247,  396 

Emotional  availability,  324-325 

Emotional  development,  305 

Emotional  self,  244 

Emotions,  38-39,  47,  54,  67,  100,  102,  116,  188-189, 
198-199,  262-263,  282,  309 
Empathy,  98,  163,  174,  292,  367,  389,  395 
Empirical  evidence,  5,  34,  175,  287 
reliance  on,  5 
Empiricism,  5 
Employees,  290 
Enculturation,  31 

Environment,  5-6,  10,  14,  23-24,  31, 40,  46,  60-61,  73, 
75,  77-79,  88,  96,  102-103,  112,  116, 
144-146,  151,  184,  198,  205-206,  221-222, 
283,  303,  321-322,  339,  354-355,  367-368, 
380,  390-393 
self-efficacy  and,  221 
Environmental  contingencies,  200,  216 
Environmental  factors,  23,  25,  229,  398 
Equality,  147,  287 
Equilibration,  145,  179 
Erasmus,  35 
Erikson,  E.,  405 
Erikson,  Erik,  289,  405 

theory  of  development,  289 
Erogenous  zones,  188 
Eroticism,  400,  406 

Error,  31,  80,  84,  127,  198,  211,  326,  357,  363 
Errors,  80,  203,  354,  357,  364 
ESP,  385 

Esteem  needs,  390 
Ethic  of  care,  177,  181 
Ethics,  176,  311 

Ethologists,  18,  39-42,  45-46,  63,  98,  397 
Ethology,  35,  39-40,  46,  48,  408 
Ethos,  306 

Europe,  3,  46,  63,  210,  235,  289-290 
Evaluation,  9,  18,  31,  33,  39,  46,  67,  89,  115,  148-149, 
186,  190,  203,  227-228,  256,  285,  312,  346 
of  self,  89 

Evidence,  2-3,  5,  24,  33-34,  36,  45,  47,  65,  67-69,  73, 
112,  150-151,  153,  169-171,  175-176,  180, 
205,  225,  256,  263-264,  287,  346,  357,  362, 
364-365,  371 

Evolution,  14,  29,  35-37,  40,  42,  49,  59,  61,  66,  90, 
200,  235,  237,  400,  412-413,  415 
cultural  evolution,  413 
human  evolution,  61, 235,  237 
natural  selection,  36 
Exceptions,  13 

Exercise,  6,  14-15,  17,  32,  78,  82-84,  89,  276,  298, 
354 

Exhibitionism,  265 

Expectations,  29,  33,  63,  84,  163,  198,  212,  295,  299, 
307,  392 

influence,  63,  212 

Experience,  5,  13,  16-18,  42,  44,  46,  49,  51,  71,  73, 
89-90,  96-97,  99-100,  102-105,  113-114, 

116,  144,  184,  196-197,  204-206,  238-239, 
247-248,  250-251, 267,  283-284,  287, 
300-301,  323,  325,  336-339,  342-343, 
345-346,  370,  391-393,  395-397 
Experiment,  41-42,  96,  126,  130-131,  133-134,  141, 
152,  154,  179,  185-186,  189,  197,  206,  218, 
220,  224,  226 
control,  96,  179,  197,  206 
Experimental  psychology,  415 
Experiments,  40,  46,  133,  140,  153-155,  186,  192, 
194-195,  217-218,  224,  227-228,  285 
Expert,  352 
Expertise,  228 
Exposure,  90,  217,  342 
External  control,  295 
External  forces,  18 

Extinction,  185,  194,  197-198,  403,  405,  419 
spontaneous  recovery,  185,  194 
Extroversion,  26,  380 
extroverts,  380 
Exuberance,  110,  296,  323 
Eye,  9,  23,  25-27,  69,  83,  319,  367,  383,  405 
movements  of,  83 

F 

Faces,  50-51, 62,  104-105,  188,  303 


423 


Facial  expressions,  195 
Failure,  152,  285,  296,  298 
Families,  3,  57,  65,  380,  408 
Family,  35,  37,  47,  63,  88,  97,  120,  163-164,  236-237, 
250-251, 261-262,  276,  286,  296,  298,  300, 
310,  313,  318,  328,  383,  413,  415 
blended,  37 
nuclear,  286 
systems,  237,  250-251 
Family  constellation,  286 
Family  values,  300 

Farming,  1,  3,  14,  16,  88-89,  236,  238 
Father,  1,4-5,  11-12,  39-40,  53,  55,  105,  120, 

194-195,  213,  217,  233,  270-273,  275,  286, 
304,  326,  378 
Fathers,  63-64,  327 

Fear,  8,  33,  45-46,  54,  56-58,  64,  66,  91,  188-190, 
226,  247,  269,  282,  287,  304,  392,  409 
Fear  of  strangers,  54,  57,  322 
Feedback,  203,  205,  226,  334,  363 
Feelings,  6,  12,  14,  59,  61,  63-64,  68,  77,  86,  89, 
96-99,  103-107,  113,  115,  138,  163-164, 
175,  185,  188-190,  206,  217,  223,  226, 
261-264,  271-272,  274-276,  281-282,  298, 
301,  307-308,  318,  327-329,  338,  342-343, 
372,  383 

Females,  41-42,  177-178,  217,  270,  281 

Feminine  traits,  378,  380 

Fetus,  96 

Fiber,  49 

Fidelity,  294,  300 

Field  of  vision,  51,  128 

Fish,  14,  37,  41,  258,  261 

Fixation,  267-269 

Fixations,  267 

Fixed-interval  schedules,  199 
Fixed-ratio  schedules,  196 
Flattery,  7,  17 
Flexibility,  45,  64,  147,  287 
Flooding,  335 

Fluid,  96,  116,  247,  281,  328,  385 
Foreclosure,  300 
Forgetting,  281 
repression,  281 
Form  perception,  99 
Formal  operational  thinking,  141,  151 
Formal  operations,  122,  140-141,  143-144,  146,  151, 
160,  229,  310,  411, 414 
Fossils,  36 
Framing,  357 
Free  association,  262-263 
Free  speech,  176 
Frequency,  178,  195,  354 
Frequency  distribution,  354 
Freud,  S.,  403,  406-407 
Freud,  Sigmund,  261,  279,  406,  409 
theory  of  dreams,  406 
Freudian  theory,  281, 284,  326 
Friendliness,  63 

Friends,  58-59,  65,  72,  164,  233,  249,  289,  300,  303, 
344 

Friendship,  383 
seeking,  383 
Frontal  lobe,  246 
Frontal  lobes,  246 
Fulfillment,  390,  394 
Funeral,  262 

future,  4,  9,  13,  17-18,  59,  68,  90,  130,  142,  146,  192, 
236,  258-259,  274,  278,  289,  293,  299-300, 
307,  310,  400 

G 

Gandhi,  Mohandas,  166 
Gardner,  Howard,  110 

Gender,  176-177,  216,  377-378,  385,  398,  403,  408 
aggression,  403 
development  and,  398 
differences,  176-177,  378,  398 
Gender  differences,  176-177,  378,  398 
Gender  differences  in,  177 
Gender  roles,  216 
Generalization,  186,  189,  195 
Generalizations,  392 
Generativity,  294,  302,  307 
Generativity  versus  self-absorption,  302 
Genes,  23-25,  36,  39,  172 
Genetic  factors,  412 
developmental,  412 
Genital  stage,  275,  298 


Germany,  168,  289 
Gesell,  Arnold,  1, 22 
Gestalt  principles,  94 
Gestalt  psychologists,  93,  379 
Gestalt  psychology,  93-94 
Gesture,  50 
Gilligan,  Carol,  176 

Girls,  136,  161,  176-177,  216,  242,  270,  274-276,  287 
Glove  anesthesia,  262 

Goals,  31,  55,  80,  87,  89,  96,  116,  191,  198,  218-219, 
228,  259,  293,  296-297,  300,  306-307,  313, 
380 

and  values,  313,  382-383 
Grammar,  13,  74-75,  106,  351-352,  355,  358, 

360-361,  365-366,  369-372,  417 
acquisition  of,  74,  351,  361,  365,  370,  403,  417 
Grandparents,  65,  250 
Grasp  reflex,  51,  53,  291 
Grasping,  24-25,  74,  122-124,  136,  291 
reflex,  123-124,  291 
Grief,  44 

Group,  24,  39,  47,  98,  128,  137,  147,  154,  165,  172, 
174,  180,  211,  217,  220,  261,  316 
experimental,  217 

Groups,  39,  45,  48,  154,  165,  178-180,  220,  226,  238, 
250,  254,  264,  286 
decision  making,  180 
performance  of,  215 

Growth,  3,  10-11,  13,  19,  22-23,  25-26,  28-31,  88,  129, 
143,  145,  147,  213,  238,  266-267,  283-285, 
303,  310,  312,  339,  341,  370,  378,  388, 
390-395,  398,  402,  414 
Guided  imagery,  226 
Guilt,  265,  272,  279,  294,  296-297,  395 

H 

Habitats,  397 
Hair,  53,  100,  363 
Hallucinations,  277,  283 
Hallucinogenic  drugs,  97 
Hallucinogens,  105 
Hand-eye  coordination,  25-26,  83 
Happiness,  7,  54,  199,  388 
children  and,  7 
Harlow,  Harry,  390 
Hartmann,  Heinz,  283 
Havighurst,  R.,  408 

Health,  6,  16,  47,  51,  56,  64-65,  115,  226,  303,  317, 
325,  337,  339-340,  382,  395,  398 
lifestyles,  303 

mental,  47,  115,  310,  325,  333,  337,  339-340 
Health  care,  65 

Hearing,  38,  105,  291,  311,  338,  343-344,  357,  362, 
371, 413 
aid,  38 
impaired,  371 
loss,  343,  371 

Heart,  23,  328,  372,  402,  411 
Heinz  dilemma,  162,  165-166,  169,  174 
Helpfulness,  217,  225 
Hemispheres,  26 
Heteronomy,  137,  139-140 
High  school,  77,  93,  120,  180,  191,  390,  416 
Higher  education,  316 
Higher-order  conditioning,  186 
History,  11,  17,  37,  58,  69,  71,  92,  100,  213,  233-235, 
245,  374,  400-401, 406-407,  414-418 
of  psychology,  233,  407,  415,  417-418 
reinforcement,  213,  401, 417 
Holistic  approach,  407 
homicides,  215 
Homunculus,  2-3 
Honesty,  107 
Hospitalization,  325 
Hospitals,  47,  65,  201 
Hostility,  282 
Hue,  101 

Human  development,  14,  39,  46,  65,  260,  406-407, 
410-412,  414-416,  418 
Human  evolution,  61, 235,  237 
Human  thinking,  236,  241,  389 
Human  traits,  235 

Humanistic  psychology,  387-398,  404 
Humor,  211 

Hunger,  69,  199,  319-320,  343,  390 
Hyperactivity,  113 
Hypnosis,  262 

Hypotheses,  69,  141,  151,  287,  392 

Hypothesis,  90,  141,  175-176,  238,  342,  354,  356-357, 


371,  392,  397 
forming,  356 

Hysteria,  262-263,  284,  403 

I 

Idealism,  142 
Identical  twins,  24 
Identification,  163,  271, 401, 412 
Identifications,  299-300 
Identity,  132-134,  294,  299-301,  306-307,  310, 
312-313,  405,  411, 413,  415 
foreclosure,  300 
formation,  299-300 
Identity  confusion,  299 
Identity  foreclosure,  300 
Identity  formation,  299-300 
Identity  status,  413,  415 
Identity  versus  role  confusion,  299 
ideology,  410,  413 
Illness,  280,  282 
Illusion,  317-320 

Imagery,  100-101,  187,  226,  251,  396 
eidetic,  101 

Images,  33,  43,  92,  97-98,  122,  129,  153,  212-213, 
277,  343,  358,  378,  396 
Imagination,  87-88,  228,  309,  389,  397 
Imitation,  6,  32,  127,  153-154,  210,  215-216,  221-222, 
228,  401, 405,  408,  413,  415,  419 
deferred,  127,  153-154,  401, 413,  419 
Imitation  of  models,  127 
Imprint,  44-45,  48 

Imprinting,  42,  44-46,  49,  56-57,  75,  401, 408 

Incest,  286,  306 

Incidence,  218,  333 

Incidental  learning,  401 

Independent  thinking,  19,  180-181,  258 

India,  173-174 

Individual  differences,  23,  141, 400,  417,  419 

Individualism,  162 

Industry  versus  inferiority,  298 

Infancy,  13,  27,  29,  60,  63,  96,  155,  194,  319, 

342-343,  395-396,  400,  406,  411-413,  418 
behavior  in,  96,  411,413 
Infancy  and  early  childhood,  319,  342 
Infant  intelligence,  22 
Infantile  amnesia,  341,  346 
Infants,  13-14,  28,  50,  54,  60-62,  64-67,  73,  96,  115, 
123-126,  128,  130,  142,  145,  151,  153-155, 
187-188,  221,  306,  318-319,  325,  342,  403 
imprinting,  401 
nervous  system,  28,  96,  294 
perception,  342,  397,  403 
Infants  and  toddlers,  66 
Information,  22,  42,  47,  80,  88,  123,  139,  145, 
179-180,  202-203,  206,  220,  228,  237, 
246-247,  253,  257-258,  365-366,  383,  389 
sources  of,  220 
In-groups,  299 
Inheritance,  36 

Initiative  versus  guilt,  296,  307 
Injuries,  113,  246 
Innate  behavior,  40 

Insight,  73,  154,  286,  301,  304,  377,  397,  405 
Instinct,  41-42,  46,  49,  412,  415,  417 
Integration,  28,  95,  171-172,  300,  307,  377,  397-398 
Integrity  versus  despair,  303 
Intellectual  abilities,  337 

Intellectual  development,  66,  90,  120,  125,  143,  249, 
407 

Intelligence,  22,  38,  91,  121-122,  124,  141,  157, 
234-235,  252,  298,  389,  407,  414-416 
creative,  38,  91,  389 
linguistic,  415 
tests,  22,  121,  234,  252 
theories,  38,  389,  414 
thinking  and,  121 
Intelligence  testing,  121 
Intelligence  tests,  234,  252 
Interactionism,  410 
Intermittent  reinforcement,  196 
Internal  conflict,  263 
Internalization,  244,  324 
Interpersonal  relations,  47,  417 
Interpersonal  theory,  417 
Interpretation  of  dreams,  264,  406 
Interrater  reliability,  161 
Interval  schedules,  197,  199 
Interventions,  113,  201,  352 
Interviewing  children,  159 


424 


Interviews,  64,  176-177,  318 
Intimacy,  294,  301-302,  306,  322 
goals,  306 

Intimate  relationships,  274 
Intonation,  107 
Intrinsic  motivation,  10 
Introspection,  187,  385 
Ion,  109 
Iowa,  211 

IQ,  103,  254,  370,  398 
IQ  tests,  254,  398 
Iraq,  352 

Isolation,  24,  99,  249,  294,  300-302 
intimacy  vs.,  294 

J 

Japan,  63,  177 
Japanese,  146,  358 
Jefferson,  Thomas,  391 
Job,  1,  3,  76,  85,  120,  252,  259,  345,  416 
Journal  of  Abnormal  Psychology,  409 
Judgment,  11,  16,  87,  136,  149,  160,  172,  180, 
223-224,  402,  404-405,  407,  409-411, 
414-416 

self-efficacy,  223 

Judgments,  100,  115,  155-157,  160,  170,  178,  219, 
223,  339,  387,  393,  401, 411, 416 
Justice  orientation,  177 

K 

Kagan,  Jerome,  67 
Kant,  Immanuel,  93,  166 
Kanzi,  367-368,  416 

Knowledge,  3,  5,  9,  13,  17,  22,  30,  42,  55,  76,  143, 
145,  147,  149,  154-155,  177,  185-186,  194, 
202-203,  205,  249-250,  274,  288,  308,  347, 
354-355,  365,  397 
aspects  of,  76,  355 
Koffka,  Kurt,  94 

Kohlberg,  L.,  402,  404-405,  410-411, 414-416 
Kohlberg,  Lawrence,  138,  159,  415 
Kohler,  Wolfgang,  94 

L 

Labor,  14 

Laboratory  research,  327,  363-364 

Language,  4,  13,  22,  30,  41,  73-75,  81,  84,  88,  90, 

101,  105-108,  113-114,  116-117,  129-130, 
142,  185,  213,  250-251, 256,  283,  309, 
348-349,  351-372,  393-394,  402-405, 
407-409,  411-412,  414-418 
emergence  of,  371, 402,  414,  418 
grammar,  13,  74-75,  106,  351-352,  355,  358, 
360-361,  365-366,  369-372,  417 
instinct,  41, 412,  415,  417 
nonhuman,  368 

overregularizations,  360,  363,  369 
poverty,  411, 415 
private  speech,  411 
propositions,  412 
rules  of,  354 

scientific,  130,  250-251,  256,  356,  372,  408 
semantics,  404 
sensitive  periods,  73,  75 
sign  language,  366,  371, 407 
symbols  in,  129 

syntax,  351,  360,  366,  368-370,  403-404,  417 
syntax  in,  360,  368,  370,  403 
universal  grammar,  355,  358,  366 
vocabulary,  127,  370 

Language  acquisition,  75,  90,  364,  369,  371, 402,  404, 
409 

Language  and  thought,  404,  414-415 
Language  development,  352-372,  404,  417 
early  childhood,  417 
Language  instinct,  415 

Language  learning,  352,  362,  365,  371, 409,  414 
Latency  period,  272,  274-275,  290,  297 
Later  adulthood,  178 

Law,  137,  151,  162,  164-166,  168,  179,  233,  241-242, 
262,  284-285,  304,  341, 405 
Leaders,  146,  166,  168,  226,  279,  389 
Leadership,  63,  146 
Learned  behavior,  216 

Learning,  1,  3,  5-6,  9,  13-14,  17,  31-32,  74-76,  80-81, 
90,  123,  126,  144-147,  150-152,  183-207, 
209-229,  232,  237,  249-250,  252-255, 
259-260,  298,  326,  351-352,  354-355, 


362-363,  365,  371,  392,  401-404,  407-409, 
412,414-419 

active,  13,  74,  123,  147,  189,  191,  202-203 

by  modeling,  224 

by  observing,  210-211, 221 

cognitive  learning,  213 

cognitive  maps,  418 

during  early  childhood,  417 

from  models,  212 

incidental,  401 

observational,  210-212,  367,  404,  412 
observational  learning,  210-212,  367,  404,  412 
prepared,  75,  84 
self-regulated,  29,  414 
social-learning  theory,  401 
through  imitation,  6,  210,  401 
trial-and-error,  191,  211 
Learning  curve,  193 

Learning  theory,  1,  5,  9,  183-207,  209-229,  362,  401 

Levinson,  Daniel,  385 

Liebert,  Robert,  215 

Life  span,  98,  221 

Life  structure,  385 

Lifestyle,  221 

Lifestyles,  303 

Light,  9,  32,  48,  67,  105,  138,  150,  185,  193,  244-245, 
253,  282,  316,  347 
visible,  327 

Linguistic  structures,  369 
Linguistics,  351-352,  357,  404 
Links,  176 

Listening,  34,  91-92,  93,  206,  383 
Locke,  John,  1, 4,  411, 414-416 
Locomotion,  56,  109,  296,  306,  309,  312,  322-323 
Logic,  116,  130,  133,  148,  154-157,  277,  309,  404,  411 
of  formal  operations,  411 
Logical  concepts,  134 
Logical  intelligence,  157 
Logical  operation,  154 
Logical  thinking,  64,  130,  378,  409,  417 
Logical  thought,  378 
Longitudinal  studies,  171 
Longitudinal  study,  171-172,  290,  404 
Lorenz,  Konrad,  39 

Loss,  62,  85,  150,  188,  262,  268,  272,  274,  281,  310, 
343,  402 

Love,  8,  47,  49-51, 64,  66,  68,  72,  85-86,  90,  110,  114, 
135,  142,  157,  163,  167,  188,  258,  270-276, 
281-283,  287,  301-302,  304,  334-335,  402, 
410 

empty,  302,  402 
Love  needs,  390 
Luther,  Martin,  166-168,  181 

M 

Magazines,  187 

Males,  38-39,  42,  176-178,  270,  316 

Management,  409 

Mandala,  375-376 

Mandalas,  375,  379 

Marcia,  James,  313 

Marriage,  261,  301, 409 

Marx,  Karl,  234 

Masculine  traits,  380 

Maslow,  Abraham,  388-390,  407,  413 

Mass  media,  225-226 

Masturbation,  264,  270,  273 

Mathematics,  16-17,  220,  308,  352 

Mating,  40 

Matrix,  106,  419 

Matrix,  The,  419 

Maturational  theory,  21-34 

Mean,  64,  67,  97,  102,  152,  166,  172,  177,  194,  203, 
239,  252,  320,  347 
Meanings,  74,  248,  352,  382 
Measurement,  97,  109,  205,  387-388,  404 
Media,  225-226,  400,  410 
Media  violence,  400,  410 
Medicine,  4,  35,  40,  114,  316-317,  395,  411 
Meltzoff,  Andrew,  153 

memories,  64,  262-263,  274,  287,  304,  341,  346-347, 
381,  383,  415 
autobiographical,  341 

Memory,  84,  99,  101,  109,  213,  240,  256-257,  262, 
272,  341-343,  346,  354,  401, 407-408, 
413-414,  417-418 
conceptual,  101,  109 
explicit,  354 
field,  240,  262 


knowledge,  213,  272,  354 
photographic,  101 
photographic  memory,  101 
recall,  342-343,  346 
rehearsal,  213 
rehearsal  and,  213 
Memory  aids,  213,  240,  256-257 
Memory  capacity,  109 

men,  176-177,  236,  272,  274,  363,  374,  378-380,  382, 
384-385,  403,  418 
Mendel,  Gregor,  39 
Mental  disorders,  400 
common,  400 
Mental  events,  63 
Mental  functioning,  245,  406 
Mental  health,  47,  310,  325,  333,  337,  339-340 
Mental  retardation,  71,  113,  412 
Mental  states,  103,  187,  191 
Metacognition,  240 
Metacognitive  knowledge,  250 
Metamemory,  240 
Metaphor,  26,  239,  317 

Methods,  71-72,  77,  87-88,  148,  152,  201,  205,  317, 
367,  395 
Mickey  Mouse,  357 
Middle  school,  404 
movement,  404 
Midlife  crisis,  380 
Military,  352 

Mistrust,  152,  291-294,  308 
trust  versus,  291 ,  293 
Modalities,  10,  98,  105,  339,  343 
Model,  8,  14,  51,  55,  63,  68,  115-116,  127-128,  145, 
179-180,  190-192,  212-215,  217,  219,  221, 
224-227,  355,  390,  401 

Modeling,  9,  212,  221-229,  362-366,  401, 416,  419 

Monkeys,  37,  67-68 

Montessori  education,  85,  89,  91, 411 

Montessori,  Maria,  1, 411, 414 

Montessori  method,  81, 413 

Montessori  preschools,  89 

Montessori  schools,  76,  89-90 

Mood,  321-322 

Moral  behavior,  175 

Moral  development,  159-181, 402-403,  407,  409-411, 
417 

Kohlberg  and,  169,  180 
models,  403,  417 
Moral  dilemma,  224 
Moral  dilemmas,  160,  178,  180 
Moral  emotions,  38 

Moral  reasoning,  167-168,  172,  176,  223,  396 
stages  of,  167-168,  172,  176,  223,  396 
Moral  standards,  279-280 
Morality,  38,  121,  137,  162-165,  174,  176-177,  181, 
262,  287,  407,  412,  415-416,  418 
conventional,  163,  177 
justice  orientation,  177 
postconventional,  164,  174,  176-177,  181 
preconventional,  162-163,  177 
violations  of,  137 
Morality  of  justice,  181 

Mothers,  48,  50,  60-65,  255,  259,  266,  318-322,  325, 
327 

age  of,  63,  65,  319 
Motion,  75,  148,  226,  245 

Motivation,  10,  202,  219,  259,  273-274,  276,  390,  401, 
413,419 
and  goals,  219 

developmental  approach  to,  419 
rewards  and,  10 

Motives,  160,  163-164,  167,  171-172 
Motor  development,  2,  24 
Motor  skills,  81,  213-214,  259 
fine,  81,  214 

Movement,  11,  13,  72,  93,  125,  144,  167,  176,  188, 
196,  283,  296,  370,  388-389 
Movies,  198-199,  215 
Muscle,  81,  127 

Music,  11, 87,  93,  105,  276,  355 
Mutations,  37 
Mutual  gaze,  320 
Mutuality,  292,  301-302,  327 

N 

Narcissism,  266,  268 
Native  Americans,  103 
Natural  selection,  36,  39 
Naturalistic  observations,  60 


425 


Nazi  Germany,  168 
Negative  reinforcement,  197 
Neglect,  76,  115,  285,  302,  380 
Nerves,  37 

Nervous  system,  23,  25,  28,  93,  96,  144,  245,  294, 

412 

spinal  cord,  23 

Newborn,  32,  51,  319,  326-327,  400,  411, 420 
crying,  51 

Newborns,  1-2,  32,  327,  359 
Newton,  Isaac,  36 
NICHD,  65 

No-consequences  condition,  215 

Noise,  8,  51,  54,  188,  192 

Norms,  22,  28,  32,  124,  167,  174,  180 

o 

Obedience,  85,  137,  162,  164,  169,  287 
Obedience  to  authority,  169 
Object  constancy,  318,  324 
Object  permanence,  128-129,  153-154,  324,  401 
Observation,  22,  40,  77,  85-87,  90,  211-213,  215-217, 
219,  227-228,  254,  259,  296,  354,  419-420 
direct,  77,  212-213 

Observational  learning,  210-212,  367,  404,  412 
attention,  210,  212 
OCEAN,  67,  328 
Odors,  32,  50,  98,  342 
Oedipal  stage,  269,  282 

Oedipus  complex,  263,  270,  272-274,  281, 286,  297, 
406 

Old  age,  294,  303,  312,  383,  386 
On  Death  and  Dying,  411 
only  children,  217 

Operant  conditioning,  191-192,  194-195,  201,  214, 
362,  416 

discriminative  stimulus,  195 
primary  reinforcers,  194 
reinforcement,  194-195,  214 
reinforcers,  194 
Skinner  box,  192 
stimulus  generalization,  195 
Oral  fixation,  267-268 

Organization,  25-26,  47,  56,  64,  96,  123-125,  141, 

157,  168,  172,  176,  379,  400 
Orgasm,  265,  301 

Orientation,  73,  94-95,  98-99,  113-114,  157,  162,  174, 
176-178,  180,  227,  236,  338,  340,  383,  385, 
398 

Overregularizations,  360,  363,  369 
Overregularizing,  361 
Overtones,  100 

P 

Pain,  7-8,  13-14,  49,  51,  160,  194,  198,  226,  264-265, 

276- 277,  292,  323,  328 
sense  of,  226,  277,  292,  323,  328 
somatic,  292 

Palmar  grasp,  26 
Panic,  265,  292 
Parenting,  412 

Parents,  3,  6-8,  17-18,  29-31,  33-34,  41, 44-45,  47-49, 
58-59,  63-68,  72,  76-77,  89,  114,  139,  144, 
146,  168,  190,  195,  197,  210-211, 214,  250, 
255-256,  261,  268-271, 274-276,  292-293, 
295-298,  311,  333-335,  345,  354,  362-363 
as  models,  221 
single,  30,  41,  295-296,  335 
Passion,  281 

Pavlovian  conditioning,  187 
Peak  experience,  391 
Peak  experiences,  391 
Peer,  136,  254,  402 
groups,  254 

peers,  90,  136-137,  145,  147,  197,  219,  221,  252,  255, 
258,  260,  298,  344-345 
Penis  envy,  273,  287 
Percept,  109 

Perception,  94,  98-99,  101-104,  107-109,  117,  135, 

138,  157,  279,  283,  345,  396-397,  408,  416, 
419 

of  inequality,  416 

Period  of  concrete  operations,  135 
Periods  of  development,  122 
Person,  5,  8,  13-15,  22,  35,  49,  51,  53-54,  56-59,  62, 
88,  98,  101,  128,  140,  156,  162,  166-167, 
169,  177,  242,  248-250,  257,  265-268, 

277- 278,  302-304,  312,  321, 323-325,  327, 


380-383 

described,  22,  59,  128,  167,  177,  266,  282 
Persona,  377,  379 
Personal  unconscious,  378-379 
Personality,  25-26,  28,  62,  73,  96,  267,  273,  276, 

278-279,  307,  339,  380-382,  386,  398, 
400-401, 404,  408-409,  413-414,  416-419 
Erikson  and,  291,  307 
healthy,  333,  404 
psychoanalysis,  279,  408,  418 
psychosexual  stages,  419 
social  cognitive  theory,  401 
studies  of,  417 

traits,  267,  377-378,  380,  409 
traits  in,  267 
types,  62 

Personality  development,  96,  291,  398,  400-401, 404, 
417 

Perspective,  30,  39,  48,  67,  109,  113,  137,  140,  142, 
156,  164-165,  191, 232,  242,  256-257,  348, 
370-371, 405-406,  418 

Perspectives,  69,  136,  140,  142,  147,  175,  308-309, 
408-409,  411-412,  414 
Persuasion,  220,  301 
source  of,  220 
Phallic  (Oedipal)  stage,  296 
Phallic  stage,  265,  271,  297 
Phenomenological  approach,  338 
Phi,  191, 405 

Philosophy  of  science,  404 
Phobia,  226,  406 
Phobias,  282,  417 
social,  417 

Photographic  memory,  101 
Phrases,  320,  360 
Physical  growth,  213,  299 
Physical  health,  6 
Physiological  needs,  390 
Physiology,  40 
Piaget,  J.,  409,  414-415 
Piaget,  Jean,  1,  120,  405,  415 
Piagetian  theory,  174,  180,  222 
Pincer  grasp,  26 
Plague,  13,  403 

Play,  6,  11,  15,  23,  29,  32-33,  38,  60,  68-70,  75,  91-92, 
110,  114,  133-138,  146,  150,  189,  247-248, 
254-256,  261, 269-270,  284,  298-299, 
336-337,  369 
fighting,  144 

Pleasure  principle,  276,  343 
politeness,  7 
Popularity,  59,  257 
Population,  37,  365 
Positive  psychology,  418 
Postconventional  level,  177,  181 
Postconventional  morality,  164,  181 
Postnatal  development,  23 
Poverty,  411, 415 

Power,  6,  9,  87,  114,  125,  142,  167-168,  180-181, 

211- 213,  227,  245,  263,  281,  322,  324,  366, 
370,  403-404,  411 

Practice,  6,  8,  24,  65,  77,  81,  83,  92,  148,  200, 

212- 213,  284-285,  290,  375,  417,  419 
Precocious,  17,  32 

Preconscious,  279 
Preconventional  level,  163,  177 
Preconventional  morality,  162 
Preconventional  morality  stage,  162 
Prefixes,  75 
Prejudice,  287 
envy,  287 
Premise,  147,  202 
Prenatal  development,  23 
Prenatal  period,  306 

Preoperational  period,  129,  133,  139,  157,  369 
Preoperational  stage,  133,  157 
Preoperational  thinking,  139,  157 
early  childhood,  157 

Preoperational  thought,  122,  129,  142-143,  157 
Preschool  years,  403 
Pressure,  19,  42,  46,  80,  228,  344,  393 
sound,  393 
Primacy,  296 

Primary  circular  reactions,  125,  190 
Primary  process  thinking,  277 
Primary  reinforcers,  194 
Princeton  University,  376,  409 
Private  speech,  243 
Problem  solving,  69,  148,  240,  252 


Problems,  14,  16,  19,  29,  57,  65,  81, 98,  113,  142-143, 
146-148,  151-152,  168-169,  180,  187,  200, 
220,  222-223,  241-244,  254,  258,  267, 
272-273,  303,  307-308,  317,  340,  342, 
383-385 
Processing,  364 

Programmed  instruction,  202-204,  414 
Projection,  282 
Prosocial  behavior,  216,  218 
in  emergencies,  216 
Prototype,  248 

Proximity,  18,  48-49,  51,  54-55,  58,  61,  64,  67 
Psychiatrists,  47 

Psychiatry,  317,  374,  384,  403,  405,  411, 417 
Psychoanalysis,  279-280,  284,  286,  290,  317,  384, 
388-389,  406-408,418 
resistance,  406 

unconscious,  279-280,  384,  388,  406 
Psychoanalyst,  317,  326,  341,  395,  397 
Psychoanalytic  theories,  232,  264 
Psychoanalytic  theory,  261-288,  289,  308,  312,  374, 
405,  408 

Oedipus  complex  in,  263 

Psycholinguistics,  351, 400,  403-404,  410,  412,  417 
Psycholinguists,  358-360,  362 
Psychological  Bulletin,  402,  411, 413 
Psychological  research,  187,  371, 418 
Psychologists,  22,  31, 40,  46,  89,  93-95,  121-122, 

142,  150,  152,  154-156,  185,  221, 239-240, 
243-244,  248,  251, 256,  287,  303,  310, 
346-347,  351 ,  369-370,  379,  388-389, 
392-394,  418 

developmental,  31,  72,  89,  94-95,  121-122,  130, 
142,  150,  152,  154-156,  239,  251, 256, 
351,  392-394,  404,  418 

school,  22,  31, 40,  89,  93-95,  152,  233,  248,  251, 
351 ,  369-370 

Psychology,  1,  5,  11-12,  19,  59,  76,  93-95,  99,  105, 
109,  115-116,  120,  159-160,  191,  198,  202, 
210-211,  233-234,  239-240,  242,  253,  256, 
338,  384-385,  387-398,  401, 403-420 
applied,  415 
as  a  science,  187 

clinical,  115,  159,  211,  390,  405,  411-412,  417 
experimental,  105,  390,  401, 403,  405,  407,  412, 
415,  418-419 
feminist,  416 
field  of,  351 

humanistic,  19,  387-398,  404,  413 

intuitive,  115 

present-day,  417 

psychological  research,  187,  418 

research  in,  109,  120,  159,  404,  409,  413,  418-419 

scientific  method,  5 

traditional,  76,  256 

Psychosis,  33,  317-318,  325,  375,  384,  412 
Psychosocial  moratorium,  300 
Psychotherapies,  419 
Psychotherapy,  276,  393,  395,  419 
behavior  therapy,  419 

Puberty,  14,  264,  272,  275,  298-299,  307,  371 
beginning  of,  14 
Public  schools,  410 
Pudding,  147 
Punisher,  287 

Punishment,  7,  9-10,  162,  167,  173,  197-199,  204, 

225,  272,  280,  287,  296,  411 
vicarious  punishment,  215 
Puzzle  box,  192 

Q 

Qualitative  change,  109,  111 
Qualitative  changes,  109 
Quantitative  change,  305 

R 

Race,  89,  188,  221 
Ratio  schedules,  196-197 
Rational  thought,  38,  288 

Reading,  3,  7,  9,  11,  17,  71-72,  84,  90,  113-114,  123, 
150,  202-204,  223,  238,  254,  298,  359-360, 
374, 414 

writing  and,  84,  90,  114 

Reality,  59,  86-87,  91,  142,  214,  222,  235,  249,  275, 
277-280,  282-283,  288,  327,  402,  407 
Reasoning,  17-18,  130,  140-141,  143,  146,  149,  151, 
155-156,  161-162,  164-165,  167-168, 
171-174,  176,  223-224,  238,  274,  396,  405, 


426 


414-415 
ability,  18,  151 

abstract,  140,  143,  146,  173,  176,  238 
analytic,  151 

good,  161,  164-165,  167,  171-172,  224,  396 
Recapitulation,  100 
Recasts,  172 
Received  support,  149 
Reciprocal  teaching,  254 
Recognition,  29,  91,  125 
process,  29,  91,  125 
Recovery,  185-186,  194,  337 
Reflex,  27,  32,  42,  51-53,  123-124,  184-186,  291 
Reflexes,  42,  51-52,  123-124,  184,  187,  191-192, 
276-277,  414 
adaptive,  42 
Moro,  51-52 
primitive,  276 
startle,  192 

Regression,  108,  171,  267-269,  281,  396 
Rehearsal,  213,  419 

Reinforcement,  32,  194-199,  202-203,  205,  211-214, 
216-217,  222,  228,  363,  401, 403,  405,  408, 
417 

contingencies  of,  417 
continuous,  197 

extinction,  194,  197-198,  401, 403,  405 
immediacy  of,  194 
intermittent,  196-197 
internal,  198-199,  205,  212,  228,  403 
pattern  of,  213 

principle  of,  202-203,  222,  228,  363 
punishment,  197-199,  405 
shaping,  195-196,  202-203,  205,  211 
sliding,  202 

vicarious  reinforcement,  212 
Reinforcement  contingencies,  199,  214,  401 
Reinforcers,  194,  200 

Relationships,  14,  47,  57,  62,  66,  163-164,  176-177, 
284,  287,  318,  321,  339,  360,  382-383,  416 
close,  62,  66,  164 
therapeutic,  284,  318 
Relaxation,  226 
Reliability,  161,  269 
interrater,  161 

Remembering,  8,  136,  212,  344-346 
Reminiscence,  403 
Replication,  149 
Replications,  179 
Representations,  361, 404 
Representative  samples,  287 
Repression,  263,  271,  274,  281-282,  284,  309,  342, 
346,  394,413 
and  ego,  284 

Research,  31-33,  40,  42,  45,  47,  57,  59-60,  62-63, 
65-66,  69,  88-89,  91, 95,  97,  99,  109, 
112-114,  120-122,  148-149,  156,  159,  168, 
172,  175-177,  184,  191,  200,  207,  234, 
243-244,  246,  250,  255-258,  261-263,  288, 
346-347,  369,  371-372,  400-401 , 403-404, 
413,  417-419 

cross-cultural,  385,  404,  418-419 
in  child  development,  172,  400,  404,  409,  411, 413, 
419 

longitudinal,  172,  404,  409 
psychotherapy,  419 
sex,  263,  406,  410,  413 
techniques  for,  226 
with  animals,  187 

Research  in  developmental  psychology,  109 
Research  psychologist,  95 
Residential  treatment,  201 
Resistance,  46,  62,  67,  133,  263,  406 
Respondent  conditioning,  192,  195 
Response,  12,  42,  44-45,  51, 56-57,  146,  157, 

163-165,  171,  173,  185-186,  188-189,  192, 
195-197,  199-200,  203,  205,  211, 215,  224, 
359,  364,  403,  414-415 
conditioned,  185-186,  188-189,  414 
Response  generalization,  195 
Responsiveness,  33,  42,  49,  53,  55,  61,  63,  396,  402 
Retention,  212,  294,  312 
Retirement,  221, 303,  386 
activity,  303 
Reversibility,  128,  132 

Reward,  7,  80,  196-197,  199,  201, 213-215,  218-219, 
366 

Rewards,  6-7,  9-10,  80,  85,  193-194,  199,  201-202, 
210,  215,  222,  380-381,  384 


Ridicule,  263,  295 
Rogoff,  Barbara,  259 
Role  taking,  175 

Roles,  142,  166,  174-175,  226,  232,  300,  377, 
385-386,  408 

sex-role  development,  408 
Role-taking,  169,  175,405 
Romantic  attraction,  396 
Roosevelt,  Eleanor,  391 
Rousseau,  Jean-Jacques,  1,10,  404 

s 

Sadness,  103,  157 
Safety,  49,  67,  88,  325,  390 
Safety  needs,  390 

Sample,  122,  149,  161,  171,  176,  203,  214 
standardized,  122 
Samples,  61-63,  171,  287 
Sampling,  161 

Schedules  of  reinforcement,  196,  205 
Schema,  44,  124,  379 
Schizophrenia,  113,  268,  417 
School,  3-4,  22,  31, 40,  76-78,  80,  82-83,  85-90, 
93-95,  97,  111,  114,  148,  152,  159-160, 
179-180,  191,  197-198,  210-211, 226,  233, 
250-253,  257-258,  261,  332-339,  369-370, 
390,  403-404,  410,  413 
achievement,  31,  90,  201, 252,  337,  351, 404 
higher  education,  316 
middle  school,  404 
Schooling,  210,  248 

Schools,  3,  17,  31, 47,  68,  76-77,  89-90,  148,  180, 

228,  248-250,  259,  285,  298,  371, 405,  410, 
413-414 

Science,  4,  14,  16,  29,  97,  109,  116,  120,  146,  249, 
388-390,  392,  400-401 , 404-405,  411, 
413-417,  419-420 
Scientific  American,  408 
Scientific  method,  5,  207 
Scientific  psychology,  198,  388 
Sears,  Robert,  211 
Second  language  learning,  409 
Second  Step,  397 
Secondary  circular  reactions,  125 
Secondary  education,  87 
Secondary  process  thinking,  278 
Second-order  conditioning,  186,  189 
Secular,  167 
Secure  attachment,  63 
Selective  imitation,  419 

Self,  6-7,  11,  14,  25-26,  28-29,  33,  61-63,  88-89,  96, 
102,  124,  146,  167,  175,  177-178,  201,  204, 
210,  213,  218-223,  226-228,  241-245,  248, 
250,  254-255,  257-258,  263-264,  275, 
294-296,  301-304,  309-310,  333,  338, 
377-382,  388-394,  407-412,  414 
Self,  the,  381 

Self-actualization  needs,  390 
Self-actualizers,  391-393 
Self-control,  6,  244,  269,  275,  296,  306 
Self-efficacy,  210,  219-221,  223,  226-227,  401 
Self-esteem,  89,  390 
Self-evaluations,  228 
self-image,  278,  377 
Semantics,  404 
Sensation,  107,  196,  262,  396 
Sensations,  96-98,  114-115,  198,  251, 264,  268,  270, 
277,  294,  317,  319-320,  342-343 
Senses,  13-17,  71,  88,  104-105,  291, 293,  320, 
342-344,  348,  370,  379,  419 
cold,  13,  320,  342-343 

Sensitive  period,  45,  56-57,  73-76,  83-84,  90,  371 
Sensitive  periods,  73,  75-76,  78-79,  83,  87 
Sensitivity,  30,  63,  73,  75,  86,  117,  177,  320 
Sensorimotor  intelligence,  122,  124 
Sensorimotor  period,  129-130,  142,  149,  153-154 
Sensorimotor  stages,  128 

Sentences,  30,  75,  221,  250,  351-356,  358-361,  364, 
366,  368 

meaning,  221,  359 

Separation,  54,  56-58,  60-61,  91, 267,  282,  292, 
315-329 

Set,  5-6,  8,  16,  33,  75,  79-80,  89,  116,  120-121,  148, 
162,  164,  175,  180,  195-196,  218-219, 
228-229,  245,  248,  251,  253,  287,  289,  316, 
357-358,  393 

Sex,  11,  14,  144,  188,  199,  216,  263-264,  270, 
275-276,  285,  300,412-413 
Sex  differences,  410,  412 


in  perspective,  412 
Sexual  activity,  264 
Sexual  behavior,  44,  199,  310 
Sexual  intercourse,  264-265,  270,  276 
Sexuality,  263-264,  274,  406 
Shadow,  40,  247,  377-379,  382 
Shaping,  195-196,  202-203,  205,  211,  225,  362 
Shivering,  343 
Siblings,  195,  272,  274,  286 
Side  effects,  197 

Sight,  7-8,  41, 44,  49-51,  54,  57,  73,  76,  85,  154-155, 
190,  193,  195,  212,  246,  343-344 
Significant  others,  291 
Similarity,  107,  186 
Simple  reflexes,  192 

Situation,  36,  54,  60-65,  68-69,  102,  127,  129, 

140-141,  166,  176,  179,  188,  194,  236-237, 
247,  272-273,  286,  293,  337 
physical  environment,  102 
situations,  11, 40,  55,  127,  175,  177,  210-211, 
243-244,  246,  278,  362-363,  377,  386 

Size,  1,  3 
Skepticism,  38 
Skin,  101,  188,  298 
Slaves,  15,  18,  246 

Sleep,  28-30,  50,  129,  248,  266,  270,  273,  277, 
392-393 

Smell,  105,  342-343,  346 
loss  of,  343 
what  we  smell,  343 
Smoking,  267 

Social,  1,  3-4,  10-15,  17-19,  24,  29,  31, 44-45,  49-52, 
56-57,  59,  63,  66,  80,  88,  91,  116,  135-136, 
145,  149,  164-166,  172-176,  178,  181, 
209-229,  231-260,  265,  291, 295-296, 
298-300,  303-308,  310,  316,  320,  362, 
380-381,  385,  391-392,  394,  400-401, 
412-413,  416-419 
Social  adjustment,  340,  385 
Social  approval,  15 
Social  behavior,  44,  214,  295 
social  change,  226 
Social  comparison,  221 
Social  contract,  12,  164-166,  416 
Social  conventions,  18 
Social  development,  91 
Social  interaction,  51 
Social  learning  theorists,  216,  224-225 
Social  psychology,  401, 403,  408,  412-413,  416, 
418-419 

Social  relationships,  14 
Social  situations,  210-211,  246 
Social  smile,  50-51,  320 
Social  smiles,  50 
Social  speech,  242-243,  246 
Social  support,  413 

Socialization,  10,  214,  216,  225,  339,  344,  401, 410, 
413 

in  the  West,  346 
narrow,  346 

Social-learning  theory,  401 
self-efficacy,  401 

Society  for  Research  in  Child  Development,  172,  400, 
404,  409,  413,  419 
Socrates,  181 
Songbirds,  45 

Sound,  32,  44,  48,  51 ,  57,  81 , 83-84,  1 05,  1 07,  1 53, 
163-164,  178,  201, 206,  248,  256,  371,  377, 
393 

sensation  of,  1 07 

Sounds,  30,  32,  53,  75,  83,  98,  104-106,  113-114, 

116-117,  126,  143,  206,  291,  304,  320-321, 
359 

Source,  22,  130,  145,  206,  281, 291, 322,  376,  382 
Speech,  2,  13,  74-75,  106-107,  117,  136,  140,  201, 
233,  235-248,  250,  351,  353-354,  357, 
359-365,  370-372,  402-404,  410-412 
child-directed,  364 
inner,  107,  238,  241-247,  354 
Spin,  273 

Spinal  cord,  23,  261 
Spock,  Benjamin,  23 
Spontaneous  recovery,  185-186,  194 
Stability,  28,  30,  275,  308-309,  400 
Stage  theories,  305,  308 
Stages  of  moral  reasoning,  223,  396 
Stamina,  77 
Statistics,  339 

Status,  3,  100,  200,  206,  303,  415 


427 


Stereotypes,  287 
Stickleback  fish,  41 

Stimuli,  41-42,  56,  101-102,  152,  184,  186-192, 

194- 197,  203,  205-206,  212,  222,  236-237, 
240,  317-320,  327 

discriminative,  194-195,  205 
Stimulus,  41-42,  50-51,  185-186,  188-190,  192-193, 

195- 196,  212,  226,  245,  319,  326,  415 
conditioned  stimulus,  185,  188 
conditioned  stimulus  (CS),  185 
generalization,  186,  189,  195 

neutral,  186 

unconditioned  stimulus  (US),  185 
Stimulus  discrimination,  186 
Storage,  352 
Stranger  anxiety,  321 
Stress,  115,  258,  265,  269 
response,  258 
Strokes,  51,  96 

students,  60,  88-89,  95,  114,  159,  179-180,  196,  201, 
210-211, 233-234,  311 

Studying,  35,  50,  99,  111,  120,  222,  228,  245 

Sublimation,  283 

Subskills,  81, 223 

Sucking  reflex,  123-124 

Suffixes,  75 

Sullivan,  H.  S.,  417 

Surface  structure,  358 

Surgery,  300 

Surprise,  106,  366 

Survey,  413 

Survival,  18,  36,  39,  42,  51, 61,  116 
Sweets,  7 

Syllogisms,  238-239 
Symbolic  modeling,  212 
Symbolic  play,  336,  413 

Symbols,  106-107,  114,  116-117,  122,  129-130,  237, 
250,  367,  369,  375,  381-382,  384,  409 
Symptoms,  262-263,  284,  317,  337-340,  406 
Synchrony,  411 
Synesthesia,  104-105,  413 
Syntax,  351,  360,  366,  368-370,  403-404,  417 
and  semantics,  404 
Systematicity,  361 

T 

Tag  question,  353 
Taste,  105,  342-343,  346 
buds,  342 

Teaching  machine,  202 
Teens,  3,  163 

Television,  92,  212,  215,  225-226,  404 
Temperament,  28-29,  67-68,  418 
dimensions,  418 
Tertiary  circular  reactions,  126 
Test  scores,  89 

Tests,  22,  90,  121,  147-148,  150,  154,  159,  234,  252, 
254,  398,  413 
group,  147,  154,  252 
of  creativity,  1 50 
personality,  398,  413 

Theories,  1-19,  21,  35-70,  109,  114,  123,  142,  221, 
231-232,  264,  276,  308,  389,  395,  399-401, 
406,  408,  413-414 
ecological,  414 

Theories  of  child  development,  401 
Theory,  1,  5,  9,  13,  18,  21-34,  35-36,  48,  59,  68-69, 
72-73,  93-117,  119-158,  174,  177,  180-181, 
209-229,  231-260,  261-288,  305,  307-308, 
312-313,  315-329,  351-372,  387-398,  401, 
403-413,  415-418 
constructivist,  148,  405 

stage,  13,  18,  30,  122-129,  132-133,  135,  138-139, 
142-144,  146-147,  149-151,  153-155, 
157,  159-160,  174,  177,  180-181,  206, 
222-224,  229,  241,  257,  265-269, 
273-275,  282,  290,  297,  307-308, 

410-411 

Therapist,  113,  201-202,  226,  284,  384 
Therapists,  226,  325,  332 

Therapy,  112,  201, 246,  262,  284,  334,  337,  339,  419 
family,  262 
modeling,  419 

Thinking,  3,  5-6,  9-10,  13,  16-17,  19,  30,  38,  64,  90, 
97-100,  109-112,  114,  121-123,  129-130, 
132,  135-143,  145-152,  154-157,  159-162, 
166,  168-169,  173-181,  187,  198,  206, 
222-224,  229,  235-242,  257-260,  261, 266, 
275,  277-278,  313,  349,  389-390,  409-411 


concepts,  121,  123,  138,  159,  238,  249-250,  257, 
313,  410 

dreams  as,  139,  378 

thinking  about,  16,  74,  98,  136,  138,  141-142,  160, 
168,  247,  307 
Thompson,  Clara,  286 

Thought,  3-4,  6,  8,  15,  18-19,  32,  34,  38,  51,  89,  91, 

93,  97-100,  108-109,  111-113,  116,  127,  129, 
134,  142-144,  149-150,  152,  154-155,  157, 
159-162,  168-170,  174-176,  178,  181, 

191- 192,  204,  236-238,  261-262,  265, 
272-274,  281-282,  284-285,  287-288,  313, 
316,  337,  395-397,  401, 410-411 

concepts,  93,  113,  116,  134,  144,  238,  310,  313, 
397,  407,410 
critical,  160,  247 

judgments,  100,  155,  157,  160,  170,  178,  401, 411 
Threats,  17,  80,  85 
Threshold,  323-324 

Time,  5,  8-9,  11-15,  17-18,  29-34,  37-39,  41-44,  46-48, 
50-51,  54,  56,  61-67,  72-73,  75-80,  84,  91, 
95,  97-98,  107,  120,  125-130,  137,  142,  148, 
150-151,  153-155,  157,  169-171,  190, 

192- 197,  207,  212,  215-216,  219,  221-222, 
241-242,  247,  257,  265-267,  270,  272-277, 
285-286,  289-290,  292-293,  295,  297-300, 
305-307,  309-310,  327,  334-336,  346, 
351-357,  368-371,  384,  407,  414,  416 

Time  out,  289,  300 
Tinbergen,  Niko,  40 
Tonic  neck  reflex,  27 

Touch,  8,  13,  16,  74-75,  83-84,  106,  116,  228,  270, 
321,  342,  345-346,  377,  395 
Training,  9,  24,  47,  95,  152-153,  190-191,  222,  224, 

250,  295,  306,  324,  335,  341,  362,  367,  392, 
416-417,  419 

Traits,  36,  39,  216,  267,  269,  287,  377-378,  409 
Trance,  62 

Transformation,  353,  361,  380,  382,  412 
Transition,  133,  150,  169,  411, 414,  419 
Treatment,  113,  189,  201, 224,  226,  284-285,  287, 
331-340,  409,  412 
residential,  201,  334 
Trial-and-error  learning,  211 
Trust  versus  mistrust,  291,  293 
Truthfulness,  363 
Turning  points,  251 
Twins,  24,  407 
identical  twins,  24 
Two-word  stage,  367 

U 

Unconditioned  reflex,  185 
unconditioned  stimulus,  185 
Unconscious,  75,  205,  262,  264,  271-272,  274-276, 
279-281,  285,  300,  374-375,  377-385, 
393-394,  409 
collective,  378-379,  385 
collective  unconscious,  378-379,  385 
personal  unconscious,  378-379 
United  Kingdom,  57 

United  States,  46,  60,  63,  94-95,  121,  146,  190,  269, 
302,  332 

independence,  63 
Universal  grammar,  355,  358,  366 
Universals,  169,  306,  362 
Unlearned  response,  188 

V 

Validity,  150,  177,  206,  223,  288,  384 
of  research,  288 
Variable,  55,  141,  197,  206,  220 
Variable-interval  schedules,  197 
Variable-ratio  schedules,  197 
Variables,  63,  109,  141, 206,  212-213,  228-229,  232, 
256,  313,  387,  389 
Variations,  36,  201, 272 
Vegetables,  81,  83,  236-237,  259 
Verbal  codes,  212-213,  342-343 
Verbs,  351,  355,  360 
Vicarious  punishment,  215 
Vicarious  reinforcement,  212 
Victims,  69 

Violence,  225,  296,  400,  410 
and  media  violence,  410 
youth,  410 

Vision,  12,  25,  51,  90,  128-129,  142,  181,  375 
eye,  25 


eye  movements,  25 
eyes,  25,  51 
Visual  field,  241 
Visual  perception,  400 
Vocabulary  growth,  370 

Voice,  50-51,  107,  176,  266,  272,  319-320,  335,  393, 
407 

w 

Walden  Two,  191,  388,417 
Walking  reflex,  32 
Weight,  6,  105,  133-134,  165 
Well-being,  320 
Wertheimer,  Max,  94 
Widowhood,  59 
Withdrawal,  194 
Womb,  343 

Women,  11,  71-72,  176-177,  226,  270,  272,  274, 

286-287,  378-380,  382-383,  385,  403,  407, 
417 

moral  reasoning  of,  176 

Words,  9,  30,  74-75,  84,  97-98,  100-101,  106-108, 
113,  117,  129-130,  195,  201-203,  236-237, 
241, 243-247,  249,  262,  295,  303,  306,  335, 
341,  343,  347-349,  351-352,  359-360,  362, 
364-367,  369-370 

Work,  3,  5-7,  10,  14,  23-25,  28,  31-32,  36-37,  39-40, 
46-47,  59,  65-66,  72,  78-80,  82,  84-86, 
88-92,  93,  110,  112-113,  121-122,  125, 
147-148,  152,  157,  159-161,  167,  169,  171, 
174,  181,  187,  196-197,  200-201,  203-205, 
218-220,  225-229,  256-257,  259,  262-264, 
276-278,  281-285,  301-302,  309-310, 
324-325,  336-338,  354,  366-367,  369,  371, 
389-392,  404 
willingness  to,  147 
working  conditions,  234 
Workplace,  2,  91 

World,  3,  12-15,  17-19,  27,  29,  33,  40,  42,  45,  55-56, 
63-67,  72,  86,  88,  90,  96-97,  101-104, 
106-107,  110-112,  116-117,  121-123,  128, 
137,  142,  144,  150,  157,  187,  205-206, 
221-223,  227-229,  234,  248-249,  258,  261, 
265-268,  277,  279-280,  283,  285,  302, 
308-309,  316-323,  338-339,  343-346,  362, 
384-385,  388-389,  392-395,  397-398,  419 
World  Health  Organization,  47,  56,  64 
World  War  I,  375 
Worry,  66,  71,  139,  270,  277,  299 
Written  language,  81,  117 

X 

X-rays,  257 

Y 

Young  adulthood,  294,  301 
Young  adults,  178,  221,  302,  408 
wisdom,  178 

Young  people,  88-89,  96,  142,  144,  167,  174,  282, 
289,  299-301,  307,  313,  327,  380 
YouTube,  368 

Z 

Zone  of  proximal  development,  252-254,  257,  403, 
408,  416 


428